MONEY STORE D C INC
424B5, 1997-10-02
MORTGAGE BANKERS & LOAN CORRESPONDENTS
Previous: AMERICA SERVICE GROUP INC /DE, 8-K, 1997-10-02
Next: FRANKLIN MUNICIPAL SECURITIES TRUST, 497J, 1997-10-02



<PAGE>

                                                     RULE NO. 424(b)(5)
                                                     REGISTRATION NO. 333-20817

 
PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT
(TO PROSPECTUS DATED SEPTEMBER 11, 1997)
 
                                $1,300,000,000
 
                            LOGO THE MONEY STORE(R)
 
                         THE MONEY STORE TRUST 1997-C
 
  The Money Store Asset Backed Certificates, Series 1997-C (the
"Certificates"), will represent fractional undivided ownership interests in a
trust fund, designated as The Money Store Trust 1997-C (the "Trust"). The
primary assets of the Trust will be four
                                                 (cover continued on next page)
  SEE "RISK FACTORS" ON PAGE S-46 HEREIN AND ON PAGE 21 OF THE PROSPECTUS FOR
A DISCUSSION OF CERTAIN RISKS WHICH SHOULD BE CONSIDERED BY PROSPECTIVE
PURCHASERS OF THE CERTIFICATES OFFERED HEREBY.
                                ---------------
THE  CERTIFICATES REPRESENT INTERESTS  IN THE TRUST ONLY  AND, EXCEPT FOR  THE
 MBIA POLICIES  DESCRIBED HEREIN WHICH APPLY ONLY  TO THE POOL I AND  POOL IV
  CERTIFICATES, DO  NOT REPRESENT INTERESTS  IN OR OBLIGATIONS OF  THE MONEY
   STORE  INC.,  MBIA INSURANCE  CORPORATION  OR  ANY  OF THEIR  RESPECTIVE
    AFFILIATES OR  SUBSIDIARIES. EXCEPT FOR  THE FHA LOANS,  THE LOANS ARE
     NOT  INSURED  OR  GUARANTEED  BY  ANY  GOVERNMENTAL  AGENCY, AND  NO
      GOVERNMENTAL AGENCY HAS PASSED UPON THE ACCURACY OF THE INFORMATION
      CONTAINED  IN  THIS  PROSPECTUS  SUPPLEMENT  OR  THE  ACCOMPANYING
       PROSPECTUS.
                                ---------------
  THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN  APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES
   AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY  STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION NOR HAS THE
     SECURITIES  AND  EXCHANGE  COMMISSION   NOR  ANY  STATE  SECURITIES
      COMMISSION   PASSED  UPON  THE  ACCURACY  OR  ADEQUACY   OF  THIS
        PROSPECTUS  SUPPLEMENT OR  THE  ACCOMPANYING PROSPECTUS.  ANY
         REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL OFFENSE.
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                     INITIAL CLASS    PASS-THROUGH
                  CERTIFICATE BALANCE   RATE (1)
- --------------------------------------------------
<S>               <C>                 <C>
Pool I
 Certificates
- --------------------------------------------------
 Class AF-1
  Certificates...    $ 63,000,000        6.355%
- --------------------------------------------------
 Class AF-2
  Certificates...    $ 60,400,000        6.310%
- --------------------------------------------------
 Class AF-3
  Certificates...    $ 80,000,000        6.307%
- --------------------------------------------------
 Class AF-4
  Certificates...    $ 47,000,000        6.370%
- --------------------------------------------------
 Class AF-5
  Certificates...    $ 32,900,000        6.535%
- --------------------------------------------------
 Class AF-6
  Certificates...    $ 39,000,000        6.670%
- --------------------------------------------------
 Class AF-7
  Certificates...    $ 37,700,000        6.945%
- --------------------------------------------------
 Class AF-8
  Certificates...    $ 40,000,000        6.575%
- --------------------------------------------------
Pool II
 Certificates
- --------------------------------------------------
 Class AV
  Certificates...    $498,000,000           (2)
- --------------------------------------------------
 Class MV-1
  Certificates...    $ 45,000,000           (3)
- --------------------------------------------------
 Class MV-2
  Certificates...    $ 30,000,000           (3)
- --------------------------------------------------
 Class BV
  Certificates...    $ 27,000,000           (2)
</TABLE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                     INITIAL CLASS    PASS-THROUGH
                  CERTIFICATE BALANCE   RATE (1)
- --------------------------------------------------
<S>               <C>                 <C>
Pool III
 Certificates
- --------------------------------------------------
 Class AH-1
  Certificates...     $37,637,000        6.400%
- --------------------------------------------------
 Class AH-2
  Certificates...     $46,765,000        6.330%
- --------------------------------------------------
 Class AH-3
  Certificates...     $36,005,000        6.340%
- --------------------------------------------------
 Class AH-4
  Certificates...     $37,865,000        6.375%
- --------------------------------------------------
 Class AH-5
  Certificates...     $53,809,000        6.590%
- --------------------------------------------------
 Class AH-6
  Certificates...     $11,329,000        6.750%
- --------------------------------------------------
 Class MH-1
  Certificates...     $24,910,000        6.890%
- --------------------------------------------------
 Class MH-2
  Certificates...     $14,975,000        7.355%
- --------------------------------------------------
 Class BH
  Certificates...     $11,705,000        7.405%
- --------------------------------------------------
Pool IV
 Certificates
- --------------------------------------------------
 Class AMF
  Certificates...     $25,000,000        6.877%
</TABLE>
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(1) Interest will accrue at the applicable Pass-Through Rate from September 1,
 1997 for each Class of Pool I, Pool III and Pool IV Certificates, from
 September 15, 1997 for the Class AV and Class BV Certificates and from the
 Closing Date for the Class MV-1 and Class MV-2 Certificates.
(2) The Pass-Through Rate for the Class AV and Class BV Certificates will
 adjust based on one-month LIBOR, as described herein. See "Description of the
 Certificates--The Distribution Amounts."
(3) The Pass-Through Rate for the Class MV-1 and Class MV-2 Certificates will
 be determined pursuant to the Auction Procedures described in Appendix I to
 the Prospectus.
                                ---------------
  The Offered Certificates will be purchased by the underwriters indicated
below (the "Underwriters") from the Representative, on behalf of the
Originators, and will be offered by the Underwriters from time to time in
negotiated transactions or otherwise, at varying prices to be determined at
the time of sale. Aggregate proceeds to the Originators from the sale of the
Offered Certificates are expected to be approximately $1,296,800,000, plus
accrued interest, before deducting expenses payable by the Originators
estimated to be approximately $300,000. See "Underwriting" herein.
  The Offered Certificates are offered by the Underwriters, when, as and if
issued to and accepted by the Underwriters, subject to approval of certain
legal matters by counsel for the Underwriters. The Underwriters reserve the
right to withdraw, cancel or modify such offer and to reject orders in whole
or in part. It is expected that delivery of the Offered Certificates will be
made in book-entry form only through the Same Day Funds Settlement System of
The Depository Trust Company in the United States of Cedel Bank, societe
anonyme ("Cedel Bank") or the Euroclear System ("Euroclear") in Europe on or
about September 30, 1997.
                                ---------------
                        Pool I and Pool II Certificates
 
PRUDENTIAL SECURITIES INCORPORATED
            LEHMAN BROTHERS
                        SALOMON BROTHERS INC
                                    MERRILL LYNCH & CO.
                                                     MORGAN STANLEY DEAN WITTER
                                ---------------
                             Pool III Certificates
LEHMAN BROTHERS                              PRUDENTIAL SECURITIES INCORPORATED
                                ---------------
                             Pool IV Certificates
                      PRUDENTIAL SECURITIES INCORPORATED
September 26, 1997
<PAGE>
 
(cover continued from previous page)
separate cross-supported sub-trusts, each consisting of a pool ("Pool I," "Pool
II," "Pool III" and "Pool IV," respectively, and collectively, the "Pools") of
loans (the "Loans") having the characteristics described herein.  Pool I will
consist of one- to four-family ("single family"), and certain five- and six-
family, residential first and second mortgage loans having original terms to
stated maturity of up to 40 years with fixed rates.  Pool II will consist of
single family, residential first mortgage loans having original terms to stated
maturity of up to 30 years with adjustable rates.  The Loans in Pool I and Pool
II are collectively referred to herein as the "Home Equity Loans." Pool III will
consist primarily of fixed rate, single family residential first, second and
more junior home improvement mortgage loans (the "Home Improvement Loans"),
certain of which loans (the "FHA Loans") are partially insured by the Federal
Housing Administration (the "FHA") of the United States Department of Housing
and Urban Development ("HUD") under Title I of the National Housing Act of 1934
("Title I").  The FHA Loans will have original terms to stated maturity of up to
20 years and the other Home Improvement Loans (the "Conventional Home
Improvement Loans") will have original terms to stated maturity of up to 25
years.  Pool IV will consist of fixed and adjustable rate five or more unit
residential or mixed-use residential and commercial first mortgage loans (the
"Multifamily Loans") having original terms to stated maturity of up to 30 years.
The Trust will also include funds on deposit in a separate trust account (the
"Pre-Funding Account") to be established with the Trustee (as defined herein).
All of the Loans were originated or purchased by certain wholly-owned
subsidiaries (the "Originators") of The Money Store Inc. (the "Representative").
The Money Store Inc. will act as the servicer (in such capacity, the "Servicer")
of the Loans and the administrator (in such capacity, the "Claims
Administrator") of the FHA Loans.  Except for certain representations and
warranties relating to the Loans and certain other matters, The Money Store
Inc.'s obligations with respect to the Loans are limited to its contractual
servicing obligations.

  Certificate guaranty insurance policies (the "MBIA Policies") with respect to
the Pool I and Pool IV Certificates, as defined herein, will be issued by:

                           MBIA INSURANCE CORPORATION

  Full and complete payment to The Bank of New York, as Trustee for the holders
of the Pool I and Pool IV Certificates, of Insured Payments (as defined herein),
consisting primarily of interest due to such holders in respect of the
Certificates on each Remittance Date and principal at the times described
herein, is unconditionally and irrevocably guaranteed pursuant to the terms of
the MBIA Policies.  See "The MBIA Policies and MBIA" herein for a more complete
description of the MBIA Policies.  MBIA DOES NOT INSURE ANY AMOUNTS DUE TO
HOLDERS OF POOL II OR POOL III CERTIFICATES.

  Additional loans (collectively, the "Subsequent Loans") may be purchased by
the Trust from the Originators from time to time on or before the close of
business on December 26, 1997 from funds on deposit in the Pre-Funding Account.
Any Subsequent Loan acquired by the Trust will be assigned to the appropriate
sub-trust based upon the characteristics of such Subsequent Loan.  See "The Loan
Pools--General." On the Closing Date (as defined herein), an aggregate cash
amount not to exceed approximately $40,000,000, in the case of Pool I,
approximately $125,000,000, in the case of Pool II, approximately $100,000,000,
in the case of Pool III, and approximately $6,250,000, in the case of Pool IV
will be deposited into the Pre-Funding Account.  See "The Agreement--Pre-Funding
Account" herein.

  The Certificates will consist of the 22 Classes of regular certificates set
forth on the front cover (collectively, the "Offered Certificates"), one Class
of interest only subordinate certificates (the "Class X Certificates") and one
or more Classes of residual certificates (collectively, the "Class R
Certificates," and together with the Offered Certificates and the Class X
Certificates, the "Certificates").  Only the Offered Certificates are offered
hereby.  The Pool I Certificates generally will represent the right to receive
payments distributable on or with respect to the Home Equity Loans in Pool I.
The Pool II Certificates generally will represent the right to receive payments
distributable on or with respect to the Home Equity Loans in Pool II.  The Pool
III Certificates generally will represent the right to receive payments
distributable on or with respect to the Home Improvement Loans in Pool III.  The
Pool IV Certificates generally will represent the right to receive payments
distributable on or with respect to the Multifamily Loans in Pool IV.  HOWEVER,
DUE TO THE CROSS-SUPPORT PROVISIONS DESCRIBED HEREIN, THE HOLDERS OF EACH CLASS
OF 

                                      S-2
<PAGE>
 
CERTIFICATES MAY RECEIVE CASH AS CREDIT SUPPORT FROM ANY LOAN IN ANY POOL.
See "Description of the Certificates--Cross-Support Provisions and Spread
Amount" herein.

  Distributions of principal and interest to the holders of the Certificates
(the "Certificateholders" or "Holders") will be made on the 15th day of each
month or, if the 15th day is not a business day, the first business day
thereafter, commencing in October 1997 (each such day, a "Remittance Date").  On
each Remittance Date, the owners of each Class of Certificates as of the
preceding Record Date (as defined herein) will be entitled to receive interest
on the outstanding principal balances of the respective Class at the rates or in
the manner set forth on the front cover, and distributions with respect to
principal as described herein.  Additionally, any Pre-Funded Amount (as defined
herein) remaining in the Pre-Funding Account at the close of business on
December 26, 1997 will be distributed as a principal prepayment on December 29,
1997 (together with accrued interest at the applicable Pass-Through Rates on the
amount of such prepayment) to the Certificates then entitled to receive
distributions of principal.  The interest due such Certificates on the January
1998 Remittance Date will be adjusted to take account of such distribution.

  By purchasing a Class MV-1 or Class MV-2 Certificate (the "Auction Rate
Certificates"), whether in an Auction or otherwise, each prospective purchaser
will be deemed to have agreed (i) to participate in Auctions on the terms
described herein and (ii) so long as the beneficial ownership of the Auction
Rate Certificates is maintained in book-entry form to sell, transfer or
otherwise dispose of the Auction Rate Certificates only pursuant to a Bid or a
Sell Order in an Auction, or to or through a Broker-Dealer, provided that in the
case of all transfers other than those pursuant to an Auction, the owner of the
Auction Rate Certificates so transferred, its Participant or Broker-Dealer
advises the Auction Agent of such transfer.

  There is currently no secondary market for the Certificates.  The Underwriters
intend to make a secondary market for the Offered Certificates, but have no
obligation to do so. There can be no assurance that a secondary market for the
Offered Certificates will develop or, if one does develop, that it will offer
sufficient liquidity of investment or continue.

  As described herein, one or more real estate mortgage investment conduit
("REMIC") elections will be made in connection with certain assets of the Trust
for federal income tax purposes.  As described more fully herein, all of the
Classes of Certificates (other than the Class R Certificates) will be designated
as "regular interests" in a REMIC and each Class of Class R Certificates will
represent the "residual interest" in the related REMIC.  See "Federal Income Tax
Consequences" in the Prospectus and "Federal Income Tax Considerations" herein.

  The Classes of Offered Certificates offered by this Prospectus Supplement each
constitute a separate class of the series of Certificates being offered by the
Representative and the Originators pursuant to the Prospectus dated September
11, 1997, of which this Prospectus Supplement is a part and which accompanies
this Prospectus Supplement.  The Prospectus contains important information
regarding this offering which is not contained herein and prospective investors
are urged to read the Prospectus and this Prospectus Supplement in full.

                                                            (end of cover page)

  UNTIL 90 DAYS AFTER THE DATE HEREOF, ALL DEALERS EFFECTING TRANSACTIONS IN THE
OFFERED CERTIFICATES, WHETHER OR NOT PARTICIPATING IN THIS DISTRIBUTION, MAY BE
REQUIRED TO DELIVER A PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT AND THE PROSPECTUS. THIS IS IN
ADDITION TO THE OBLIGATION OF DEALERS TO DELIVER A PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT AND
PROSPECTUS WHEN ACTING AS UNDERWRITERS AND WITH RESPECT TO THEIR UNSOLD
ALLOTMENTS OR SUBSCRIPTIONS.

  THE ATTORNEY GENERAL OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK HAS NOT PASSED ON OR ENDORSED
THE MERITS OF THIS OFFERING. ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS UNLAWFUL.

                                      S-3
<PAGE>
 
                               SUMMARY OF TERMS

 This following summary of certain pertinent information is  qualified in its
entirety by reference to the detailed information appearing elsewhere in this
Prospectus Supplement and the accompanying Prospectus.  Capitalized terms used
but not defined in this Summary of Terms have the meanings assigned to such
terms elsewhere in this Prospectus Supplement.


Securities Offered................The Money Store Asset Backed Certificates,
                                   Series 1997-C, consisting of the Offered
                                   Certificates set forth on the cover, the
                                   Class X Certificates and the Class R
                                   Certificates (collectively, the
                                   "Certificates"), which are more particularly
                                   identified below under "--Transaction
                                   Structure."

                                  Each Class of Offered Certificates will be
                                   issued in the initial Class Principal Balance
                                   set forth for such Class on the cover page
                                   hereof.  Each Class of Offered Certificates
                                   (other than the Pool II Certificates) will
                                   bear interest for each Remittance Date at the
                                   per annum rate set forth for such Class on
                                   the cover page hereof.

                                  For the first Remittance Date, the Class AV
                                   and Class BV Certificates will bear interest
                                   at per annum rates of 5.83125% and 6.61625%,
                                   respectively.  For each Remittance Date
                                   thereafter, the Class AV and Class BV
                                   Certificates will bear interest at per annum
                                   rates equal to LIBOR (as defined herein) plus
                                   before the Optional Servicer Termination Date
                                   (as defined under " Optional Termination by
                                   the Servicer") 0.175% and 0.960%,
                                   respectively, and after the Optional Servicer
                                   Termination Date if termination has not
                                   occurred, 0.35% and 1.44%, respectively,
                                   subject in each case to the Net Funds Cap (as
                                   defined herein) but in no event exceeding 14%
                                   per annum and 14% per annum, respectively.

                                  For the first Remittance Date, the Class MV-1
                                   and Class MV-2 will bear interest at per
                                   annum rates of 5.70% and 5.80%, respectively.
                                   For each Remittance Date thereafter, the
                                   Class MV-1 and Class MV-2 Certificates will
                                   bear interest based upon the Auction
                                   Procedures described in Appendix I to the
                                   Prospectus, subject to the Net Funds Cap, but
                                   in no event exceeding 14% per annum and 14%
                                   per annum, respectively.

                                  The per annum rate of interest at which a
                                   Class of Certificates bears interest is
                                   referred to herein as the "Pass-Through Rate"
                                   for such Class.

                                  The statistical information presented in this
                                   Prospectus Supplement concerning the Pool I,
                                   Pool II, Pool III and Pool IV Loans (each as
                                   defined herein) is based on 

                                      S-4
<PAGE>
 
                                   preliminary Pools expected to be delivered to
                                   the Trustee and Co-Trustee on the Closing
                                   Date. The Representative expects that loans
                                   (including the Subsequent Loans) that were
                                   not contained in the preliminary Pools will
                                   be added to the final Pools. While the
                                   statistical distribution of the
                                   characteristics for the final Pools of Loans
                                   will vary somewhat from the statistical
                                   distribution of such characteristics for the
                                   preliminary Pools of Loans presented in this
                                   Prospectus Supplement, the Representative
                                   does not believe that the characteristics of
                                   the final Pools will differ materially.

                                  References in this Prospectus Supplement to
                                   the characteristics of the Loans as of the
                                   Cut-off Date are deemed to include the
                                   characteristics, as of the date of their
                                   origination, of those Loans originated after
                                   the Cut-off Date and up to the Closing Date.

Transaction Structure.............The primary assets of the Trust will be four
                                   separate cross-supported sub-trusts
                                   consisting of the Pool I, Pool II, Pool III
                                   and Pool IV Loans.  The Trust will issue the
                                   following Classes of Certificates:

  Pool I Certificates.............Class A F-1, Class AF-2, Class AF-3, Class
                                   4, Class AF-5, Class AF-6, Class AF-7 and
                                   Class AF-8 Certificates.

  Pool II Certificates............Class AV, Class MV-1, Class MV-2 and Class BV
                                   Certificates.

  Pool III Certificates...........Class AH-1, Class AH-2, Class AH-3, Class AH-
                                   4, Class AH-5, Class AH-6, Class MH-1, Class
                                   MH-2 and Class BH Certificates.

  Pool IV Certificates............Class AMF Certificates.

  Regular Certificates............All Classes of Certificates except the
                                   Residual Certificates.

  Residual Certificates...........Class R Certificates.

  Interest Only Certificates......Class X Certificates.

Other Designations................As used herein, certain Classes of
                                    Certificates have been assigned the
                                    following additional designations:

  Adjustable Rate Certificates....Class AV and Class BV Certificates.

  Auction Rate Certificates.......Class MV-1 and Class MV-2 Certificates.

  Pool I Class A Certificates.....All Pool I Certificates

                                      S-5
<PAGE>
 
  Pool II Class A Certificates....Class AV Certificates.

  Pool III Class A Certificates...Class AH-1, Class AH-2, Class AH-3, Class AH-
                                    4, Class AH-5 and Class AH-6 Certificates.

  Pool IV Class A Certificates....Class AMF Certificates.

  Pool Class A Certificates.......Pool I Class A Certificates or Pool II Class A
                                    Certificates or Pool III Class A
                                    Certificates or Pool IV Class A
                                    Certificates.

  Pool II Class M Certificates....Class MV-1 and Class MV-2 Certificates.

  Pool III Class M Certificates...Class MH-1 and Class MH-2 Certificates.

  Pool Class M Certificates.......Pool II Class M Certificates or Pool III Class
                                    M Certificates.

  Pool II Class B Certificates....Class BV Certificates.

  Pool III Class B Certificates...Class BH Certificates.

  Pool Class B Certificates.......Pool II Class B Certificates or Pool III Class
                                    B Certificates.

Cut-Off Date......................August 31, 1997.

Closing Date......................September 30, 1997.

Issuer............................The Money Store Trust 1997-C (the "Trust").

Representative, Servicer 
  and Claims Administrator........The Money Store Inc., a New Jersey corporation
                                   (in its capacity as sponsor of the Trust, the
                                   "Representative," in its capacity as the
                                   servicer of the Loans, the "Servicer," and in
                                   its capacity as the administrator of the
                                   insurance claims to the FHA (the "Claims")
                                   with respect to the FHA Loans, the "Claims
                                   Administrator"). In the Agreement (as defined
                                   herein), the Claims Administrator will
                                   appoint its subsidiary, TMS Mortgage Inc., a
                                   New Jersey corporation, to assist in
                                   performing the functions of the Claims
                                   Administrator. The principal offices of The
                                   Money Store Inc. are located at 2840 Morris
                                   Avenue, Union, New Jersey 07083 (telephone
                                   number (908) 686-2000) and 3301 C Street,
                                   Suite 100-M, Sacramento, California 95816
                                   (telephone number (916) 446-5000). See "The
                                   Representative and the Originators" herein
                                   and in the Prospectus.

                                      S-6
<PAGE>
 
Trustee...........................The Bank of New York, a New York banking
                                   corporation, in its capacity as trustee.  See
                                   "The Agreement--The Trustee" herein.

Co-Trustee........................First Union Trust Company, N.A., a national
                                   banking association headquartered in
                                   Wilmington, Delaware will be the Co-Trustee
                                   with respect to the Home Improvement Loans.
                                   See "The Agreement--The Co-Trustee" herein.

Custodian.........................First Trust National Association, a national
                                   banking association, headquartered in St.
                                   Paul, Minnesota will be the Custodian with
                                   respect to the Home Improvement Loans.  In
                                   such capacity, it will retain the files
                                   relating to the Home Improvement Loans.  The
                                   Custodian is a subsidiary of First Bank
                                   Systems, Minneapolis, Minnesota.  See "The
                                   Agreement--The The Custodian" herein.

Auction Agent.....................Bankers Trust Company, a New York banking
                                   corporation, will act as auction agent (in
                                   such capacity, the "Auction Agent") with
                                   respect to the Auction Rate Certificates.
                                   See "The Agreement--The Auction Agent"
                                   herein.

Originators of the Loans..........Each Loan will have been originated and
                                   underwritten, or purchased and re-
                                   underwritten, by certain wholly-owned
                                   subsidiaries of the Representative (the
                                   "Originators").  Additionally, each
                                   Subsequent Loan to be included in the Trust
                                   will have been originated and underwritten,
                                   or purchased and re-underwritten, by an
                                   Originator.

Description of the Certificates...The Certificates will be issued pursuant to a
                                    Pooling and Servicing Agreement (the
                                    "Agreement"), dated as of the Cut-Off Date,
                                    among the Representative, the Originators
                                    and The Bank of New York, as trustee (the
                                    "Trustee").

                                  The Certificates will represent fractional
                                   undivided ownership interests in the Trust,
                                   the assets of which will consist primarily of
                                   four separate cross-supported sub-trusts,
                                   each consisting of a pool ("Pool I," "Pool
                                   II," "Pool III" and "Pool IV," respectively)
                                   of Loans having the characteristics described
                                   herein.

                                  Pool I and Pool II will consist of one- to
                                   four-family ("single family") and, in the
                                   case of Pool I, certain five- and six-family,
                                   residential first and, in the case of Pool I,
                                   second mortgage loans expected to have
                                   aggregate principal balances as of the Cut-
                                   Off Date of not less than approximately
                                   $360,000,000 and $475,000,000, 

                                      S-7
<PAGE>
 
                                   respectively, and original terms to stated
                                   maturity of up to 40 and 30 years,
                                   respectively. As described herein, each of
                                   the Loans in Pool I (the "Pool I Home Equity
                                   Loans" or the "Pool I Loans," which terms
                                   include any Subsequent Loans acquired by Pool
                                   I, unless the context requires otherwise)
                                   will bear interest at a fixed rate and each
                                   of the Loans in Pool II (the "Pool II Home
                                   Equity Loans" or the "Pool II Loans," which
                                   terms include any Subsequent Loans acquired
                                   by Pool II, unless the context requires
                                   otherwise) will bear interest at an
                                   adjustable rate as described below. See "The
                                   Loan Pools--Home Equity Loans" herein.

                                  Pool III will consist primarily of fixed rate,
                                   single family residential first, second and
                                   more junior home improvement loans (the "Home
                                   Improvement Loans" or the "Pool III Loans,"
                                   which terms include any Subsequent Loans
                                   acquired by Pool III, unless the context
                                   requires otherwise) expected to have an
                                   aggregate principal balance as of the Cut-Off
                                   Date of not less than approximately
                                   $175,000,000 and original terms to stated
                                   maturity of up to 25 years or, in the case of
                                   the FHA Loans, 20 years.  Certain of the Pool
                                   III Loans are insured by the FHA under Title
                                   I.  See "Lending Programs--The Home
                                   Improvement Lending Program" herein.

                                  Pool IV will consist of fixed and adjustable
                                   rate five or more unit residential or mixed-
                                   use residential and commercial first mortgage
                                   loans (the "Multifamily Loans" or the "Pool
                                   IV Loans," which terms include any Subsequent
                                   Loans acquired by Pool IV, unless the context
                                   requires otherwise) expected to have an
                                   aggregate principal balance as of the Cut-Off
                                   Date of not less than approximately
                                   $18,750,000 and original terms to stated
                                   maturity of up to 30 years.  See "The Loan
                                   Pools--Multifamily Loans" herein.

                                  Collectively, the Home Equity Loans, the Home
                                   Improvement Loans and the Multifamily Loans
                                   are at times referred to herein as the
                                   "Loans."

                                  The Pool I Certificates generally will be
                                   entitled to receive payments distributable on
                                   or with respect to the Pool I Home Equity
                                   Loans.  The Pool II Certificates generally
                                   will be entitled to receive payments
                                   distributable on or with respect to the Pool
                                   II Home Equity Loans.  The Pool III
                                   Certificates generally will be entitled to
                                   receive payments distributable on or with
                                   respect to the Pool III Home Improvement
                                   Loans.  The Pool IV Certificates generally
                                   will be entitled to receive payments
                                   distributable on or with respect to the Pool
                                   IV 

                                      S-8
<PAGE>
 
                                  Multifamily Loans. HOWEVER, DUE TO THE CROSS-
                                   SUPPORT PROVISIONS DESCRIBED HEREIN, THE
                                   HOLDERS OF EACH CLASS OF CERTIFICATES MAY
                                   RECEIVE CASH AS CREDIT SUPPORT FROM ANY LOAN
                                   IN ANY POOL. See "Description of the
                                   Certificates--Cross-Support Provisions and
                                   Spread Amount" herein. Also, amounts, if any,
                                   on deposit in the Spread Account described
                                   herein will be available to cover shortfalls
                                   in amounts due holders of Pool I and Pool IV
                                   Certificates.

                                  The holders of the Pool I Certificates are
                                   also referred to herein as the "Pool I
                                   Certificateholders." The holders of the Pool
                                   II Certificates are also referred to herein
                                   as the "Pool II Certificateholders." The
                                   holders of the Pool III Certificates are also
                                   referred to herein as the "Pool III
                                   Certificateholders." The holders of the Pool
                                   IV Certificates are also referred to herein
                                   as the "Pool IV Certificateholders." Each
                                   holder of a Certificate is referred to herein
                                   as a "Certificateholder."

                                  The projected last Remittance Dates for each
                                   Class of Offered Certificates is as set forth
                                   herein under "Maturity, Prepayment and Yield
                                   Considerations." It is expected that the
                                   actual last Remittance Date for each Class of
                                   Offered Certificates will occur significantly
                                   earlier than its projected last Remittance
                                   Date. See "Maturity, Prepayment and Yield
                                   Considerations" herein.

                                  The Offered Certificates (other than the
                                   Auction Rate Certificates) are issuable in
                                   book-entry form in minimum denominations of
                                   $1,000 original principal amount and integral
                                   multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof and the
                                   Auction Rate Certificates are issuable in
                                   book-entry form in minimum denominations of
                                   $25,000 original principal amount and
                                   integral multiples of $25,000 in excess
                                   thereof, except that one certificate of each
                                   Class of Offered Certificates may be issued
                                   in a different denomination and, if so
                                   issued, will be held in physical form.

Pre-Funding Account...............On the Closing Date, an aggregate cash amount
                                   (the "Pre-Funded Amount") will be deposited
                                   into the Pre-Funding Account in an amount not
                                   to exceed approximately $40,000,000, in the
                                   case of Pool I, approximately $125,000,000,
                                   in the case of Pool II, approximately
                                   $100,000,000 in the case of Pool III and
                                   approximately $6,250,000, in the case of Pool
                                   IV.  Amounts allocated to Pool I, Pool II,
                                   Pool III and Pool IV, as the case may be, may
                                   be used only (i) to acquire Subsequent Loans
                                   for the related Pool and (ii) to make
                                   accelerated payments of principal on the
                                   Certificates of 

                                      S-9
<PAGE>
 
                                   the related Pool. During the period (the
                                   "Funding Period") from the Closing Date until
                                   the earliest of (i) the date on which the
                                   amount on deposit in the Pre-Funding Account
                                   is less than $200,000, (ii) the date on which
                                   an Event of Default occurs under the
                                   Agreement or (iii) the close of business on
                                   December 26, 1997, amounts will, from time to
                                   time, be withdrawn from the Pre-Funding
                                   Account to purchase Subsequent Loans in
                                   accordance with the Agreement. Any Pre-Funded
                                   Amount remaining at the end of the Funding
                                   Period will be distributed as a principal
                                   prepayment on the next Remittance Date to the
                                   Certificates of the related Pool as set forth
                                   herein. However, any Pre-Funded Amount
                                   remaining at the close of business on
                                   December 26, 1997 will be distributed as a
                                   principal prepayment on December 29, 1997
                                   (the "Special Remittance Date") to holders of
                                   the Certificates.

Capitalized Interest Account......On the Closing Date, the Representative also
                                   will make a cash deposit in an account (the
                                   "Capitalized Interest Account") in the name
                                   of the Trustee on behalf of the Trust.  The
                                   amount deposited  in the Capitalized Interest
                                   Account will be used by the Trustee on the
                                   Remittance Dates occurring in October,
                                   November and December 1997 to fund the
                                   excess, if any, of (i) the amount of interest
                                   accrued for each such Remittance Date at the
                                   weighted average Pass-Through Rates of the
                                   Certificates on the portion of the
                                   Certificates having principal balances
                                   exceeding the principal balances of the Loans
                                   over (ii) the amount of any earnings on funds
                                   in the Pre-Funding Account that are available
                                   to pay interest on the Certificates on each
                                   such  Remittance Date.  Additionally, if a
                                   principal prepayment is made on the Special
                                   Remittance Date to any Class of Certificates,
                                   such Certificates also will receive on such
                                   date, from the Capitalized Interest Account,
                                   accrued interest at the applicable Pass-
                                   Through Rates on the amount of such principal
                                   prepayment.  Any amounts remaining in the
                                   Capitalized Interest Account on the Special
                                   Remittance Date and not used for such
                                   purposes are required to be paid directly to
                                   the holders of the Class R Certificates on
                                   such Special Remittance Date.

Remittance and Record Dates.......Distributions on the Certificates will be made
                                   by or on behalf of the Trustee on the 15th
                                   day of each month, or if such day is not a
                                   business day, on the first business day
                                   thereafter, commencing October 15, 1997
                                   (each, a "Remittance Date"), to each person
                                   in whose name a Certificate is registered on
                                   the last day of the preceding calendar month
                                   (the "Record Date"), except that the final
                                   distribution on each Class of Certificates
                                   will be 

                                      S-10
<PAGE>
 
                                   made only upon presentation and surrender of
                                   such Certificates at the office or agency
                                   designated for that purpose. Any Pre-Funded
                                   Amount remaining at the close of business on
                                   December 29, 1997 (together with interest
                                   thereon) will be distributed by or on behalf
                                   of the Trustee on the Special Remittance Date
                                   to the Classes of Certificates of the related
                                   Pool then entitled to receive payments of
                                   principal in the order and percentages as
                                   described herein. Such distribution will be
                                   made to each person in whose name a
                                   Certificate of any such Class is registered
                                   on November 30, 1997.

Distributions.....................As more fully described herein, distributions
                                   with respect to each Class of Offered
                                   Certificates will be payable, after payment
                                   of certain fees, generally from (i) receipts
                                   on the Loans of the applicable Pool, (subject
                                   to certain adjustments as a result of the
                                   cross support provisions described herein),
                                   (ii) advances and payments of Compensating
                                   Interest (as defined under "--Compensating
                                   Interest") by the Servicer, (iii) with
                                   respect to the Pool I and Pool IV
                                   Certificates, amounts transferred from the
                                   Spread Account, if any, and payments under
                                   the related MBIA Policy, (iv) with respect to
                                   the Pool III Certificates, any FHA Payments,
                                   as defined below under "Obligations of the
                                   Claims Administrator") and (v) for the
                                   Remittance Dates occurring in October,
                                   November and December 1997, any amounts
                                   transferred to the Certificate Account (as
                                   defined under "The AgreementPayments on the
                                   Loans" herein) from the Pre-Funding Account
                                   or the Capitalized Interest Account (with
                                   respect to each Pool of Certificates, the
                                   "Pool Available Amount").

                                  The "Due Period" with respect to any
                                   Remittance Date is the calendar month
                                   preceding the month of such Remittance Date.

Current Interest..................On each Remittance Date, to the extent of the
                                   applicable Pool Available Amount, the holders
                                   of each Class of Offered Certificates will
                                   receive 30 days' interest (or in the case of
                                   the Adjustable Rate Certificates and Auction
                                   Rate Certificates, the actual number of days
                                   since the last Remittance Date (or, in the
                                   case of the first Remittance Date, from
                                   September 15, 1997 with respect to the
                                   Adjustable Rate Certificates and from the
                                   Closing Date, with respect to the Auction
                                   Rate Certificates) up to but not including
                                   the upcoming Remittance Date) at the related
                                   Pass-Through Rate on the respective Class
                                   Principal Balance outstanding immediately
                                   prior to such Remittance Date.

                                      S-11
<PAGE>
 
                                  Interest with respect to the Offered
                                   Certificates will accrue on the basis of a
                                   360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day
                                   months (or, in the case of the Adjustable
                                   Rate Certificates and Auction Rate
                                   Certificates, on the basis of a 360-day year
                                   consisting of the actual number of days
                                   elapsed since interest was last paid or in
                                   the case of the first Remittance Date, from
                                   September 15, 1997 for the Adjustable Rate
                                   Certificates and from the Closing Date for
                                   the Auction Rate Certificates).  See
                                   "Description of the Certificates" herein.

                                  The amount of interest each Class of
                                   Certificates is entitled to receive on each
                                   Remittance Date is referred to as the
                                   "Current Interest Requirement" for such
                                   Class.

                                  Notwithstanding the foregoing, if a principal
                                   prepayment is made to one or more Classes of
                                   Certificates on the Special Remittance Date,
                                   each such Class also will receive on such
                                   date accrued interest at the applicable Pass-
                                   Through Rate on the amount of such
                                   prepayment.  Further, the Current Interest
                                   Requirement for each such Class for the
                                   January 1998 Remittance Date will be based on
                                   the related Principal Balance on December
                                   29, 1997, after giving effect to such
                                   principal prepayment.

                                     Interest will first be allocated to the
                                   applicable Class A Certificates, pro rata in
                                   accordance with the Current Interest
                                   Requirements, then in the case of Pool II and
                                   Pool III Certificates, to the applicable Pool
                                   Class M Certificates in ascending numerical
                                   order and then to the applicable Pool Class B
                                   Certificates.

                                     If on a particular Remittance Date, the
                                   Pool Available Amount for a Pool of
                                   Certificates is less than the aggregate
                                   Current Interest Requirement for the related
                                   Pool Class A Certificates, the amount of the
                                   shortfall for each such Class of Pool Class A
                                   Certificates, together with interest thereon
                                   at the applicable Pass Through Rates to the
                                   extent permitted by law (each, a "Class
                                   Interest Shortfall Carryforward Amount") will
                                   be carried forward and distributed as
                                   described below.  In the case of Pool I and
                                   Pool IV Certificates, the Class Interest
                                   Shortfall Carryforward Amount will be paid by
                                   MBIA under the MBIA Policies and there should
                                   be no carry forward thereof.

                                     Similarly, if the Pool Available Amount for
                                   any Class of Pool Class M Certificates or
                                   Class of Pool Class B Certificates after
                                   making the distributions of the Current
                                   Interest Requirements to all classes which
                                   are prior in right of distribution as
                                   described in the second 

                                      S-12
<PAGE>
 
                                   preceding paragraph, is less than the Current
                                   Interest Requirement for such Class the
                                   remaining Pool Available Amount will be
                                   distributed with respect thereto and a Class
                                   Interest Shortfall Carryforward Amount will
                                   be created for such Class.

                                  Class Interest Shortfall Carryforward Amounts
                                   for Classes of Pool II Certificates do not
                                   include any Certificateholders' Interest
                                   Carryover (as defined below).

                                  For the first Remittance Date, the Class AV
                                   and Class BV Certificates will bear interest
                                   at per annum rates of 5.83125% and 6.61625%,
                                   respectively.  For each Remittance Date
                                   thereafter, the Class AV and Class BV
                                   Certificates will bear interest at per annum
                                   rates equal to LIBOR (as defined below) plus
                                   before the Optional Servicer Termination Date
                                   0.175% and 0.960%, respectively, and after
                                   the Optional Servicer Termination Date if
                                   termination has not occurred, 0.35% and
                                   1.44%, respectively, subject to the Net Funds
                                   Cap (as defined below) but in no event
                                   exceeding 14% per annum and 14% per annum,
                                   respectively.

                                  For the first Remittance Date, the Class MV-1
                                   and Class MV-2 Certificates will bear
                                   interest at the per annum rates of 5.70% and
                                   5.80%, respectively.  For each Remittance
                                   Date thereafter, the Class MV-1 and Class MV-
                                   2 Certificates will bear interest based upon
                                   the Auction Procedures described in Appendix
                                   I to the Prospectus, subject to the Net Funds
                                   Cap, but in no event exceeding 14% per annum
                                   and 14% per annum, respectively.

                                  LIBOR for each Remittance Date after the first
                                   Remittance Date will be determined on the
                                   LIBOR Determination Date preceding each such
                                   Remittance Date.  See "The Agreement--
                                   Calculation of LIBOR."

                                  As to any Remittance Date, the "Net Funds Cap"
                                   for the Pool II Certificates will be a
                                   percentage equal to the difference between
                                   (A) the weighted average Pool II Mortgage
                                   Interest Rate and (B) the sum of (i) the
                                   percentages used in determining the Servicing
                                   Fee, the Contingency Fee and the fee due the
                                   Trustee and (ii) with respect to the Auction
                                   Rate Certificates, the percentage used in
                                   determining the fees due the Auction Agent
                                   and the Broker-Dealer (as defined in the
                                   Auction Procedures described in Appendix I to
                                   the Prospectus).

                                      S-13
<PAGE>
 
                                  If on any Remittance Date the Pass-Through
                                   Rate for a Class of Adjustable Rate
                                   Certificates or Auction Rate Certificates is
                                   based upon the Net Funds Cap, the excess of
                                   (i) the amount of interest such Class of
                                   Certificates would be entitled to receive on
                                   such Remittance Date had interest been
                                   calculated based on LIBOR plus the applicable
                                   margin (but in no event exceeding the
                                   applicable maximum rate set forth above),
                                   over (ii) the amount of interest such Class
                                   will receive on such Remittance Date at the
                                   Net Funds Cap, together with the unpaid
                                   portion of any such excess from prior
                                   Remittance Dates (and interest accrued
                                   thereon at the then applicable Pass-Through
                                   Rate, without giving effect to the Net Funds
                                   Cap, but in no event exceeding the applicable
                                   maximum rate set forth above) is referred to
                                   herein as the "Certificateholders' Interest
                                   Carryover." Any Certificateholders' Interest
                                   Carryover will be paid on future Remittance
                                   Dates as set forth herein under "The
                                   Agreement--Flow of Funds." No
                                   Certificateholders' Interest Carryover will
                                   be paid to a Class of Certificates after its
                                   Class Principal Balance is reduced to zero.
                                   The ratings of the Pool II Certificates do
                                   not address the likelihood of the payment of
                                   the amount of any Certificateholders'
                                   Interest Carryover.

Class A Principal Distribution 
  Amounts.........................Holders of the applicable Pool Class A
                                   Certificates will be entitled to receive on
                                   each Remittance Date as payments of
                                   principal, in the order of priority set forth
                                   below, in the aggregate, the lesser of (i)
                                   the remaining applicable Pool Available
                                   Amount in the Certificate Account on such
                                   Remittance Date after payment of the Current
                                   Interest Requirements on all Classes of
                                   Offered Certificates in the applicable Pool
                                   and (ii) the applicable Senior Percentage of
                                   the applicable Pool Principal Distribution
                                   Amount (with respect to each Pool of
                                   Certificates, the "Class A Formula Principal
                                   Distribution Amount").

                                  The "Senior Percentage" for any Remittance
                                   Date (a) for the Pool I and Pool IV Class A
                                   Certificates is 100% and (b) for the Pool II
                                   and Pool III Class A Certificates (i) prior
                                   to the Pool II or Pool III Class B Cross-over
                                   Date (as defined under "--Pool II and Pool
                                   III Class B Pool Principal Distribution
                                   Amount"), respectively, and for any
                                   Remittance Date on or after the Pool II or
                                   Pool III Class B Cross-over Date on which the
                                   Trigger Event with respect to the applicable
                                   Pool is in effect (as described under
                                   "Description of the Certificates--
                                   Distributions on the Certificates--Pool II
                                   and Pool III Class B Pool Principal
                                   Distribution Amounts"), will be 100%, or (ii)
                                   on or after the Pool II  or Pool III Class B

                                      S-14
<PAGE>
 
                                   Cross-over Date on which the Trigger Event
                                   with respect to the applicable Pool is not in
                                   effect, the "Senior Percentage" will equal a
                                   fraction, expressed as a percentage, the
                                   numerator of which is the sum of the Class
                                   Principal Balances of the Pool II or Pool III
                                   Class A and Class M Certificates, as
                                   applicable, as of the immediately preceding
                                   Remittance Date and the denominator of which
                                   is the sum of the Class Principal Balances of
                                   the Pool II or Pool III Class A, Class M and
                                   Class B Certificates, as applicable, as of
                                   the immediately preceding Remittance Date.

                                  For any Remittance Date, the "Pool Principal
                                   Distribution Amount" is equal to the excess
                                   of (X) the sum, without duplication, of (i)
                                   each payment of principal received by the
                                   Servicer or any Subservicer (exclusive of
                                   Curtailments, Principal Prepayments and
                                   amounts described in clause (iii) hereof)
                                   during the related Due Period with respect to
                                   the Loans of the related Pool, (ii) all
                                   Curtailments and all Principal Prepayments
                                   received by the Servicer or any Subservicer
                                   during the related Due Period with respect to
                                   the Loans of the related Pool, (iii) the
                                   principal portion of all Insurance Proceeds,
                                   Released Mortgaged Property Proceeds and Net
                                   Liquidation Proceeds received by the Servicer
                                   or any Subservicer during the related Due
                                   Period with respect to the Loans of the
                                   related Pool (and, with respect to the Pool
                                   III Loans, any FHA Payments received by the
                                   Claims Administrator with respect to
                                   principal on a Pool III Loan during the
                                   related Due Period), (iv) that portion of the
                                   purchase price for any Loan of the related
                                   Pool repurchased by The Money Store Inc. as a
                                   remedy for breaches of representations and
                                   warranties which represents principal and any
                                   Substitution Adjustments, in either case to
                                   the extent received by the Trustee as of the
                                   related Determination Date, (v) any proceeds
                                   representing principal received by the
                                   Trustee in connection with the liquidation of
                                   a Pool or termination of the Trust, (vi) with
                                   respect to Pool I or Pool IV, the amount of
                                   any Subordination Deficit (as defined under
                                   "Description of the Certificates--Cross
                                   Support Provisions and Spread Amount" herein)
                                   for such Remittance Date, (vii) any moneys
                                   released from the Pre-Funding Account on the
                                   October, November or December 1997 Remittance
                                   Date as a prepayment of the Certificates of
                                   the related Pool, and (viii) with respect to
                                   Pool I or Pool IV, the amount of any
                                   Subordination Increase Amount (as defined
                                   under "Description of the Certificates--
                                   Cross-Support Provisions and Spread Amount"
                                   herein) with respect to the applicable Pool
                                   for such Remittance Date, over 

                                      S-15
<PAGE>
 
                                   (Y) the amount of any Subordination Reduction
                                   Amount with respect to the applicable Pool
                                   for such Remittance Date.

                                  The "Subordination Reduction Amount" for
                                   any Remittance Date is equal to the lesser of
                                   (i) the amount set forth in clause (X) of the
                                   definition of Pool Principal Distribution
                                   Amount and (ii) the excess, if any, of the
                                   then current Spread Amount over the then
                                   current Specified Subordinated Amount (as
                                   defined under "Description of the
                                   Certificates--Distributions on the
                                   Certificates--Class A Principal Distribution
                                   Amounts").

                                  The "Spread Amount" for any Remittance Date is
                                   equal to the excess, if any, of (i) the
                                   aggregate principal balances of the Loans in
                                   the applicable Pool as of the last day of the
                                   immediately preceding Due Period and any
                                   amounts on deposit in the Pre-Funding Account
                                   with respect to such applicable Pool over
                                   (ii) the aggregate principal balances of the
                                   related Certificates (after taking into
                                   account all distributions of principal on
                                   such Remittance Date).

                                  The "Class A Pool Principal Distribution
                                   Amount" with respect to a Pool of
                                   Certificates for any Remittance Date is
                                   intended to be equal to the Class A Formula
                                   Principal Distribution Amount for such Pool
                                   of Certificates.  If the Class A Formula
                                   Principal Distribution Amount exceeds the
                                   applicable Pool Available Amount in the
                                   Certificate Account on such Remittance Date
                                   (after payment of all Current Interest
                                   Requirements for the Certificates in such
                                   Pool), then the Class A Pool Principal
                                   Distribution Amount for such Pool of
                                   Certificates shall instead equal such
                                   remaining Pool Available Amount.

  Pool I..........................On each Remittance Date, the Class A Pool
                                   Principal Distribution Amount for Pool I will
                                   be distributed to the holders of the Pool I
                                   Class A Certificates in the following order
                                   of priority:  (i) first, to the holders of
                                   the Class AF-8 Certificates, an amount equal
                                   to the Class AF-8 Principal Distribution
                                   Amount (as defined below) for such Remittance
                                   Date, and (ii) second, to the holders of the
                                   Class AF-1, Class AF-2, Class AF-3, Class AF-
                                   4, Class AF-5, Class AF-6, Class AF-7 and
                                   Class AF-8 Certificates, sequentially in that
                                   order, until the Class Principal Balance of
                                   each such Class (in ascending order of
                                   numerical designation) is reduced to zero and
                                   the Certificateholders of each such Class
                                   have received an amount equal to the amount
                                   described in clause (iv) of the definition of
                                   Distribution Amount (as 

                                      S-16
<PAGE>
 
                                   defined herein) that is recovered from such
                                   Certificateholders.

                                  The "Class AF-8 Principal Distribution Amount"
                                   for any Remittance Date will be the product
                                   of (i) the applicable Class AF-8 Principal
                                   Percentage for such Remittance Date and (ii)
                                   the Class AF-8 Pro Rata Principal
                                   Distribution Amount for such Remittance Date.
                                   In no event will the Class AF-8 Principal
                                   Distribution Amount on any Remittance Date be
                                   greater than the Pool Principal Distribution
                                   Amount for Pool I for such Remittance Date or
                                   the Class Principal Balance of the Class AF-8
                                   Certificates.

                                  The "Class AF-8 Principal Percentage" for each
                                   Remittance Date shall be as follows:

                                                                   Class AF-8
                                                                   Principal
                                    Remittance Dates               Percentage

                                    October 1997 - September 2000  0%
                                    October 2000 - September 2002  45%
                                    October 2002 - September 2003  80%
                                    October 2003 - September 2004  100%
                                    October 2004 -  and thereafter 300%

                                  The "Class AF-8 Pro Rata Principal
                                   Distribution Amount" for each Remittance Date
                                   will be an amount equal to the product of (x)
                                   a fraction, the numerator of which is the
                                   Class Principal Balance of the Class AF-8
                                   Certificates immediately prior to such
                                   Remittance Date and the denominator of which
                                   is the aggregate Class Principal Balance of
                                   the Pool I Certificates immediately prior to
                                   such Remittance Date and (y) the Pool
                                   Principal Distribution Amount for Pool I for
                                   such Remittance Date.

                                  Notwithstanding the foregoing and only through
                                   the Remittance Date in July 1998, for
                                   purposes of making the foregoing
                                   distributions, the Class A Pool Principal
                                   Distribution Amount for Pool I shall not
                                   include the lesser of (a) the Total Monthly
                                   Excess Cashflow for Pool I less any Pool I
                                   Subordination Deficit and (b) an amount equal
                                   to 30 days' interest at a rate of 2.5% per
                                   annum on a notional amount equal to the Class
                                   Principal Balance of the Class AF-8
                                   Certificates prior to the distributions being
                                   made on the specified Remittance Date (the
                                   "Pool I Strip Amount").  The Pool I Strip
                                   Amount will be paid to the Holders of the
                                   Class X Certificates.

                                      S-17
<PAGE>
 
  Pool II........................ On each Remittance Date, the Class A Pool
                                   Principal Distribution Amount for Pool II
                                   will be distributed to the holders of the
                                   Class  AV Certificates, until the Class
                                   Principal Balance of such Class is reduced to
                                   zero.

  Pool III........................On each Remittance Date, the Class A Pool
                                   Principal Distribution Amount for Pool III
                                   will be distributed to the holders of the
                                   Pool III Class A Certificates in the order of
                                   their numerical designations, commencing with
                                   the Class AH-1 Certificates, until the Class
                                   Principal Balance of each such Class is
                                   reduced to zero; provided, however that on
                                   any Remittance Date on which the Class
                                   Principal Balances of the Pool III Class M
                                   and Class B Certificates have been reduced to
                                   zero, any amounts payable to the Pool III
                                   Class A Certificates on such Remittance Date
                                   shall be distributed pro rata and not
                                   sequentially.

  Pool IV.........................On each Remittance Date, the Class A Pool
                                   Principal Distribution Amount for Pool IV
                                   will be distributed to the holders of the
                                   Class AMF Certificates until the Class
                                   Principal Balance of such Certificates is
                                   reduced to zero and such Certificateholders
                                   have received an amount equal to the amount
                                   described in clause (iv) of the definition of
                                   Distribution Amount that is recovered from
                                   such Certificateholders.

Pool II and Pool III Class M Pool
  Principal Distribution Amounts..On each Remittance Date on and after the Class
                                   Principal Balances of the Pool II or Pool III
                                   Class A Certificates have been reduced to
                                   zero, the Holders of the Pool II or Pool III
                                   Class M Certificates, as applicable, will be
                                   entitled to receive, as payments of
                                   principal, the lesser of (i) the remaining
                                   applicable Pool Available Amount in the
                                   Certificate Account on such Remittance Date
                                   after payment of the Current Interest
                                   Requirements on all Classes of Offered
                                   Certificates in the applicable Pool and the
                                   applicable Class A Pool Principal
                                   Distribution Amount, if any, on such
                                   Remittance Date and (ii) the Senior
                                   Percentage of the Pool II or Pool III Pool
                                   Principal Distribution Amount (the "Class M
                                   Formula Principal Distribution Amount").
                                   Such Class M Pool Principal Distribution
                                   Amount shall be allocated between the Class M
                                   Certificates of the applicable Pool in the
                                   order of their numerical designations,
                                   commencing with the Class MV-1 and Class MH-1
                                   Certificates, respectively, until the Class
                                   Principal Balance of the respective Classes
                                   of Class M Certificates are reduced to zero.

                                  The "Class M Pool Principal Distribution
                                   Amount" with respect to Pool II or Pool III
                                   Certificates for any 

                                      S-18
<PAGE>
 
                                   Remittance Date is intended to be equal to
                                   the Class M Formula Principal Distribution
                                   Amount for such Pool of Certificates. If the
                                   Class M Formula Principal Distribution Amount
                                   exceeds the applicable remaining Pool
                                   Available Amount in the Certificate Account
                                   on such Remittance Date then the Class M Pool
                                   Principal Distribution Amount shall instead
                                   equal such remaining Pool Available Amount.

                                  On each Remittance Date on or after the
                                   related Class B Cross-over Date on which the
                                   Trigger Event is not in effect, payments of
                                   principal will be made to the related Class B
                                   Certificateholders, even if the related Class
                                   M Certificateholders are not yet entitled to
                                   receive payments of principal because the
                                   Class Principal Balances of the Class A
                                   Certificates have not been reduced to zero.

Pool II and Pool III Class B 
  Pool Principal Distribution 
  Amount..........................Prior to the related Class B Cross-over Date,
                                   there will be no distributions of principal
                                   on the Pool II or Pool III Class B
                                   Certificates.  The "Class B Cross-over Date-"
                                   will be the earlier of (A) the Remittance
                                   Date on which the Class MV-2 or Class MH-2
                                   Class Principal Balance, respectively, is
                                   reduced to zero, and (B) the first Remittance
                                   Date on or after the Remittance Date in
                                   October 2000 on which the fraction, expressed
                                   as a percentage, the numerator of which is
                                   the sum of the related Class A and Class M
                                   Class Principal Balances as of the
                                   immediately preceding Remittance Date and the
                                   denominator of which is the aggregate
                                   outstanding principal balance of the Loans in
                                   the respective Pool as of the end of the
                                   second preceding Due Period, is less than or
                                   equal to 87.0% in the case of Pool II and
                                   75.8% in the case of Pool III.

                                  On each Remittance Date on or after the
                                   related Class B Cross-over Date and prior to
                                   the Remittance Date on which the related
                                   Class A and Class M Class Principal Balances
                                   have been reduced to zero, holders of the
                                   related Class B Certificates will be entitled
                                   to distributions of principal only if the
                                   Trigger Event with respect to the applicable
                                   Pool (as described under "Description of the
                                   Certificates--Distributions on the
                                   Certificates--Pool II and Pool III Class B
                                   Pool Principal Distribution Amount" herein)
                                   is not in effect on such Remittance Date.

                                  On each Remittance Date on or after the
                                   Class B Cross-over Date, if the Trigger Event
                                   is not in effect on such Remittance Date, the
                                   Holders of the Class B Certificates will be
                                   entitled to receive, as payments of

                                      S-19
<PAGE>
 
                                   principal, the lesser of (i) the remaining
                                   applicable Pool Available Amount on such
                                   Remittance Date after payments of the Current
                                   Interest Requirements on all Classes of
                                   Offered Certificates in the applicable Pool
                                   and the applicable Class A and Class M Pool
                                   Principal Distribution Amounts, if any, on
                                   such Remittance Date and (ii) the Class B
                                   Percentage (as described under "Description
                                   of the Certificates--Distributions on the
                                   Certificates--Pool II and Pool III Class B
                                   Pool Principal Distribution Amount" herein)
                                   of the Pool II or Pool III Pool Principal
                                   Distribution Amount (the "Class B Formula
                                   Principal Distribution Amount"), until the
                                   respective Class B Class Principal Balance is
                                   reduced to zero.

                                  The "Class B Pool Principal Distribution
                                   Amount" with respect to Pool II or Pool III
                                   Certificates for any Remittance Date is
                                   intended to be equal to the Class B Formula
                                   Principal Distribution Amount for such Pool
                                   of Certificates.  If the Class B Formula
                                   Principal Distribution Amount exceeds the
                                   applicable remaining Pool Available Amount in
                                   the Certificate Account on such Remittance
                                   Date then the Class B Pool Principal
                                   Distribution Amount shall instead equal such
                                   remaining Pool Available Amount.

Remaining Pool II and Pool III
 Pool Available Amounts...........On each Remittance Date, after payments of
                                   amounts as set forth above with respect to
                                   Pool II and Pool III, the remaining Pool II
                                   and Pool III Pool Available Amounts shall be
                                   paid to the following Classes, in the
                                   following order of priority:

                                   (i) the aggregate Class A Class Interest
                                   Shortfall Carryforward Amounts will be paid
                                   concurrently to the Holders of the applicable
                                   Class or Classes of Class A Certificates pro
                                   rata in the case of Pool III Class A
                                   Certificates in accordance with their
                                   respective entitlements to Class A Interest
                                   Shortfall Carryforward Amounts, and any Class
                                   A Interest Shortfall Carryforward Amounts not
                                   paid shall be carried forward to the next
                                   Remittance Date;

                                   (ii) the Accelerated Principal Distribution
                                   Amount will be paid to the Holders of the
                                   applicable Class A, Class M and Class B
                                   Certificates in the same order and priority
                                   as payments of the Pool Principal
                                   Distribution Amount described above. (For any
                                   Remittance Date, the "Accelerated Principal
                                   Distribution Amount" equals the lesser of (i)
                                   the remaining Pool Available Amount in the
                                   Certificate Account on such Remittance Date
                                   less in the case of Pool II, and only through
                                   the Remittance Date in 

                                      S-20
<PAGE>
 
                                   April 1998, an amount equal to 30 days'
                                   interest at a rate of 4.0% per annum on a
                                   notional amount equal to the Class Principal
                                   Balance of the Class MV-1 Certificates prior
                                   to the distributions being made on the
                                   Remittance Date (the "Pool II Strip Amount")
                                   and (ii) the Subordinated Deficiency Amount
                                   for such Remittance Date. The "Subordinated
                                   Deficiency Amount" equals the excess, if any,
                                   of (i) the Specified Subordinated Amount for
                                   such Remittance Date over (ii) the then
                                   current Spread Amount, after giving effect to
                                   all payments previously made on such
                                   Remittance Date;

                                  (iii) the lesser of the remaining Pool II or
                                   Pool III Pool Available Amount and the
                                   applicable Pool Available Maximum
                                   Subordination Amount (as defined under
                                   "Description of the Certificates--
                                   Distributions on the Certificates--Remaining
                                   Pool II and Pool III Pool Available Amounts")
                                   will be paid in reduction of the related
                                   Class Interest Shortfall Carryforward Amounts
                                   and then the Class Realized Loss Amounts,
                                   first to the Class MV-1 and Class MH-1
                                   Certificates, respectively, second to the
                                   Class MV-2 and MH-2 Certificates,
                                   respectively, and then to the Class BV and BH
                                   Certificates, respectively. Any Class
                                   Interest Shortfall Carryforward Amounts or
                                   Class Realized Loss Amounts not paid shall be
                                   carried forward to the next Remittance Date
                                   subject to the applicable Pool Available
                                   Maximum Subordination Amount.

                                  (iv)  the Pool II Strip Amount will be paid
                                   to the Holders of the Class X Certificates.

                                  (v)  any remaining amounts, subject to the
                                   cross support provisions described under "--
                                   Credit Enhancement" will be paid to the Class
                                   X and/or Class R Certificates.

                                  When the applicable Pool Available Maximum
                                   Subordination Amount has been reduced to
                                   zero, (i) no further Class M or Class B Class
                                   Interest Shortfall Carryforward Amounts or
                                   Class M or Class B Class Realized Loss
                                   Amounts with respect to the same Pool shall
                                   be carried forward to succeeding Remittance
                                   Dates and (ii) interest shall cease to accrue
                                   on such remaining Class M or Class B Class
                                   Interest Shortfall Carryforward Amounts.


Credit Enhancement

  Pool I and Pool IV..............The credit enhancement provided for the
                                   benefit of the Pool I and Pool IV
                                   Certificates consists of (i) the 

                                      S-21
<PAGE>
 
                                   Spread Amount (as defined below), the Spread
                                   Account and cross-support features, which
                                   utilize the internal cash flows of all the
                                   Pools as described herein and (ii) the MBIA
                                   Policies.

  Pool II and Pool III............The credit enhancement provided for the
                                   benefit of the Pool II and Pool III
                                   Certificates consists of (i) the Spread
                                   Amount, and cross-support features, which
                                   utilize the internal cash flows of all the
                                   Pools as described herein, (ii) certain
                                   subordination features and (iii) in the case
                                   of the Pool III Certificates, the benefit of
                                   the FHA Insurance described herein.

Spread Amount and Realized Losses.Certain provisions of the Trust are intended
                                   to provide for limited acceleration of the
                                   respective Pool of Certificates relative to
                                   the amortization of the related Loans,
                                   generally in the early months of the
                                   transaction.  This limited accelerated
                                   amortization is achieved by applying certain
                                   excess interest collected on the Loans to the
                                   payment of principal on the Certificates for
                                   the related Pool.  This acceleration feature
                                   is intended to create, with respect to each
                                   Pool of Loans, an amount (the "Spread
                                   Amount"), resulting from, and equal to, the
                                   excess of the aggregate principal balances of
                                   the Loans of the related Pool (plus any
                                   amounts allocated to such Pool on deposit in
                                   the Spread Account referred to below
                                   and the Pre-Funding Account) over the
                                   principal balances of the Certificates of the
                                   related Pool.  The Agreement provides that,
                                   subject to certain floors, caps and triggers,
                                   the required level of the Spread Amount with
                                   respect to each Pool of Loans (i.e., the
                                                                  ----     
                                   "Specified Subordinated Amount as defined
                                   under "Description of the Certificates--
                                   Distributions on the Certificates--Class A
                                   Principal Distribution Amounts") may increase
                                   or decrease over time.  An increase would
                                   result in a temporary period of accelerated
                                   amortization of the Certificates of the
                                   related Pool to increase the actual level of
                                   the Spread Amount to its required level; a
                                   decrease would result in a temporary period
                                   of decelerated amortization to reduce the
                                   actual level of the Spread Amount to its
                                   required level.  The Agreement also provides
                                   that such excess interest, together with
                                   certain other excess amounts, generated by
                                   one Pool of Loans may be used to fund losses
                                   in the other Pools of Loans, subject to
                                   certain prior requirements for application of
                                   such excess amounts.  See "Description of the
                                   Certificates--Cross-Support Provisions and
                                   Spread Amount" herein.

                                  If a Loan becomes a Liquidated Loan during
                                   a Due Period, the Net Liquidation Proceeds
                                   relating thereto and allocated to principal
                                   may be less than the then 

                                      S-22
<PAGE>
 
                                   outstanding balance of such Loan. The amount
                                   of such insufficiency is a "Realized Loss."

                                  To the extent that Realized Losses in a Pool
                                   are experienced, such Realized Losses will
                                   reduce the aggregate outstanding balance of
                                   the related Loans (i.e., a reduction in the
                                   collateral balance will occur).  Since the
                                   Spread Amount with respect to a Pool is the
                                   excess, if any, of the related aggregate
                                   principal balances of the Loans plus the
                                   related amounts on deposit in the Pre-Funding
                                   Account over the aggregate Class Principal
                                   Balances of the related Certificates,
                                   Realized Losses will in the first instance
                                   reduce the related Spread Amount.

                                  If on any Remittance Date after taking into
                                   account all Realized Losses experienced
                                   during the prior Due Period on Pool II and
                                   Pool III Loans and after taking into account
                                   the distribution of principal (including the
                                   Accelerated Principal Distribution Amount)
                                   with respect to the related Certificates on
                                   such Remittance Date, the aggregate Class
                                   Principal Balance of the Pool II or Pool III
                                   Certificates exceeds the aggregate balance of
                                   the related Loans as of the end of the
                                   related Due Period (i.e., if the level of
                                   overcollateralization is negative), then if
                                   cross support is not available from other
                                   Pools, the Class Principal Balances of the
                                   related Class B and Class M Certificates will
                                   be reduced (in effect, "written down") in the
                                   order described below such that the level of
                                   the applicable Spread Amount is zero, rather
                                   than negative. Such a negative level is an
                                   "Applied Realized Loss Amount," which will be
                                   applied as a reduction of the Class Principal
                                   Balance of the related Class B and Class M
                                   Certificates in reverse order of seniority,
                                   i.e., first against the Class B Class
                                   Principal Balance, then against the Class
                                   Principal Balances of the Class M
                                   Certificates in reverse numerical order,
                                   commencing with the Class MV-2 and Class MH-2
                                   Certificates, respectively, in each case
                                   until the respective Class Principal Balance
                                   is reduced to zero. The Agreement does not
                                   permit the "write down" of the Class
                                   Principal Balance of any Class A Certificate.

                                  Once the Class Principal Balance of a Class of
                                   Class M or Class B Certificates has been
                                   "written down," the amount of such write down
                                   will no longer bear interest, nor will such
                                   amount thereafter be "reinstated" or "written
                                   up," although the amount of such write down
                                   may, on future Remittance Dates, be paid to
                                   Holders of the Class M and Class B
                                   Certificates which experienced the write
                                   down, in 

                                      S-23
<PAGE>
 
                                   direct order of seniority (i.e., first, the
                                   Class M Certificates, commencing with the
                                   Class MV-1 and Class MH-1 Certificates,
                                   respectively, and then the Class B
                                   Certificates).

Subordination of Pool II 
  and Pool III Class M 
  and Class B Certificates........The rights of the Holders of Class M
                                   Certificates and Class B Certificates to
                                   receive distributions with respect to the
                                   Loans will be subordinated to such rights of
                                   the related Class A Certificateholders.  This
                                   subordination is intended to enhance the
                                   likelihood of regular receipt by the holders
                                   of the related Class A Certificates of the
                                   full amount of their monthly payments of
                                   interest and principal and to afford such
                                   holders protection against losses on
                                   Liquidated Loans.  The protection afforded to
                                   the Holders of the related Class A
                                   Certificates by means of the subordination
                                   feature will be accomplished by the
                                   preferential right of the Holders of the
                                   Class A Certificates (i) to receive, prior to
                                   any distribution being made on a Remittance
                                   Date in respect of principal or interest on
                                   the related Class M Certificates and Class B
                                   Certificates, the applicable Current Interest
                                   Requirement due them on each Remittance Date
                                   out of the respective Pool Available Amount
                                   on deposit on such date in the Certificate
                                   Account and (ii) to receive, prior to any
                                   distribution being made on a Remittance Date
                                   in respect of principal on the related Class
                                   M Certificates and Class B Certificates, the
                                   applicable Class A Pool Principal
                                   Distribution Amount due them on each
                                   Remittance Date out of the respective Pool
                                   Available Amount on deposit on such date in
                                   the Certificate Account.

                                  In addition, the rights of the Holders of
                                   the Class MV-2 and Class MH-2 Certificates
                                   and the related Class B Certificates to
                                   receive distributions with respect to the
                                   related Loans will be subordinate to such
                                   rights of the Holders of the Class MV-1 and
                                   Class MH-1 Certificates, respectively.  This
                                   subordination is intended to enhance the
                                   likelihood of regular receipt by the Holders
                                   of the Class MV-1 and Class MH-1 Certificates
                                   of the full amount of their monthly payments
                                   of interest and principal and to afford such
                                   holders protection against losses on
                                   Liquidated Loans.  The protection afforded to
                                   the Holders of the Class MV-1 and Class MH-1
                                   Certificates by means of the subordination
                                   feature will be accomplished by the
                                   preferential right of the Holders of the
                                   Class MV-1 and Class MH-1 Certificates (i) to
                                   receive, prior to any distribution being made
                                   on a Remittance Date in respect of principal
                                   or interest on the Class MV-2 and Class MH-2
                                   Certificates, respectively, and the related

                                      S-24
<PAGE>
 
                                   Class B Certificates, the applicable Current
                                   Interest Requirement due them on each
                                   Remittance Date out of the respective Pool
                                   Available Amount on deposit on such date in
                                   the Certificate Account and (ii) to receive,
                                   prior to any distribution being made on a
                                   Remittance Date in respect of principal on
                                   the Class MV-2 and Class MH-2 Certificates,
                                   respectively, and the related Class B
                                   Certificates, the applicable Class M Pool
                                   Principal Distribution Amount due them on
                                   each Remittance Date out of the respective
                                   Pool Available Amount on deposit on such date
                                   in the Certificate Account.

                                  In addition, the rights of the Holders of
                                   the Class B Certificates to receive
                                   distributions with respect to the related
                                   Loans will be subordinate to such rights of
                                   the Holders of the Class MV-2 and Class MH-2
                                   Certificates, as applicable.  This
                                   subordination is intended to enhance the
                                   likelihood of regular receipt by the Holders
                                   of the Class MV-2 and Class MH-2 Certificates
                                   of the full amount of their monthly payments
                                   of principal and interest and to afford such
                                   holders protection against losses on
                                   Liquidated Loans.  The protection afforded to
                                   the Holders of the Class MV-2 and Class MH-2
                                   Certificates by means of the subordination
                                   feature will be accomplished by the
                                   preferential right of the Holders of the
                                   Class MV-2 and Class MH-2 Certificates (i) to
                                   receive, prior to any distribution being made
                                   on a Remittance Date in respect of interest
                                   or principal on the related Class B
                                   Certificates, the applicable Current Interest
                                   Requirement due them on each Remittance Date
                                   out of the respective Pool Available Amount
                                   on deposit on such date in the Certificate
                                   Account and (ii) to receive, prior to any
                                   distribution being made on a Remittance Date
                                   in respect of principal on the related Class
                                   B Certificates, the applicable Class M Pool
                                   Principal Distribution Amount due them on
                                   each Remittance Date out of the respective
                                   Pool Available Amount on deposit on such date
                                   in the Certificate Account.

Cross Support Features............After distribution of amounts otherwise
                                   provided herein from funds available for a
                                   Pool of Certificates from the Total Monthly
                                   Excess Cashflow applicable to that Pool, any
                                   remaining Total Monthly Excess Cashflow with
                                   respect to Pool I and Pool IV will first be
                                   allocated to the other such Pool to reduce
                                   any Subordinated Deficiency Amount until the
                                   respective Specified Subordination Amount is
                                   reached and then any remaining Total Monthly
                                   Excess Cashflow from any Pool will be
                                   allocated to the Certificates then entitled
                                   to receive principal in the other Pools to
                                   cover 

                                      S-25
<PAGE>
 
                                   Realized Losses in the current period, pro
                                   rata, based on the amount so required by each
                                   such other Pool. See "Description of the
                                   CertificatesCross Support Provisions and
                                   Spread Amount".

Spread Account....................The Agreement may provide for an initial cash
                                   deposit into an account (the "Spread
                                   Account") to be maintained with the Trustee.
                                   The Agreement will provide that following the
                                   Funding Period the required level of the
                                   Spread Amount with respect to each Pool of
                                   Loans may be increased.  In such event, cash
                                   up to the amount of such increase may be
                                   deposited into the Spread Account.  Amounts,
                                   if any, on deposit in the Spread Account will
                                   be available to fund any Insured Payments (as
                                   defined below) otherwise required to be made
                                   on a Remittance Date with respect to the Pool
                                   I and Pool IV Certificates, without
                                   distinction as to the Pool, and, in certain
                                   circumstances, to make accelerated payments
                                   of principal on the Pool I and Pool IV
                                   Certificates.  Additionally, if the level of
                                   delinquencies for the Pool I and Pool IV
                                   Loans exceeds certain specified levels,
                                   excess interest received on the Pool I and
                                   Pool IV Loans will be deposited into the
                                   Spread Account.  The Agreement also will
                                   provide that certain excess interest
                                   otherwise payable to the holders of the Class
                                   X Certificates and Class R Certificates with
                                   respect to the Loans will, instead, be
                                   deposited into the Spread Account.

MBIA Policies.....................MBIA Insurance Corporation, a New York stock
                                   insurance corporation ("MBIA"), will provide
                                   separate insurance policies (collectively,
                                   the "MBIA Policies") relating to the Pool I
                                   and Pool IV Certificates.  Subject to the
                                   requirements of the MBIA Policies described
                                   under "The MBIA Policies and MBIA," MBIA
                                   unconditionally and irrevocably guarantees
                                   that the full amount of each Insured Payment
                                   (defined herein) will be received by the
                                   Insurance Paying Agent (the "Insurance Paying
                                   Agent"), which initially will be The Bank of
                                   New York, for distribution by the Trustee.
                                   MBIA's obligations under the MBIA Policies
                                   will be discharged to the extent funds equal
                                   to the amount required to be paid thereunder
                                   are received by the Insurance Paying Agent,
                                   whether or not such funds are properly
                                   applied by the Trustee or the Insurance
                                   Paying Agent.  The MBIA Policies are
                                   noncancellable for any reason.

                                  "Insured Payment" means (i) as of any
                                   Remittance Date, any Deficiency Amount and
                                   (ii) any Preference Amount (each, as defined
                                   under "The MBIA Policies and MBIA").

                                      S-26
<PAGE>
 
                                  As stated above, amounts, if any, in the
                                   Spread Account will be used to fund Insured
                                   Payments prior to draws being made on the
                                   MBIA Policies.
 
                                  The MBIA Policies do not (i) cover any amounts
                                   due to holders of the Pool II or Pool III
                                   Certificates, (ii) cover The Money Store
                                   Inc.'s obligation under the Agreement to
                                   repurchase or substitute for Loans with
                                   respect to which there has been a breach of
                                   representation, (iii) guarantee any specified
                                   rate of prepayments, or (iv) provide funds to
                                   redeem the Certificates on any specified
                                   date.

                                  Subject to the terms of the Agreement, MBIA
                                   will be subrogated to the rights of the
                                   Holders of the Pool I and Pool IV
                                   Certificates to the extent of any Insured
                                   Payments made under the applicable MBIA
                                   Policy, but its right to reimbursement will
                                   be subject to the prior rights of the holders
                                   of the Pool I and Pool IV Certificates to
                                   amounts to which such holders are entitled
                                   under the Agreement.

FHA Insurance.....................Subject to the then remaining Reserve Amount
                                   (as defined below) of the Co-Trustee, each
                                   FHA Loan will be insured by the FHA in an
                                   amount currently equal to 90% of the sum of
                                   the following:  (i) the unpaid principal and
                                   uncollected interest earned to the date of
                                   default, calculated on the actuarial method
                                   even if the Note (as defined herein) relating
                                   to such FHA Loan provides for simple
                                   interest, reduced by certain amounts received
                                   by the Claims Administrator in connection
                                   with enforcing a lien on the related
                                   Mortgaged Property prior to the lien of the
                                   related FHA Loan; (ii) the unpaid amount of
                                   interest on the unpaid principal from the
                                   date of default to the date of the initial
                                   submission of the related Claim to the FHA
                                   for payment plus 15 calendar days, but not
                                   for any period greater than nine months from
                                   the date of default, calculated at 7% per
                                   annum; and (iii) the amount of certain
                                   uncollected court costs, attorney's fees, and
                                   expenses for recording the assignment of the
                                   related Mortgage to the United States. See
                                   "The Trusts--FHA Loans" in the Prospectus and
                                   "Risk Factors--Limitations on FHA Insurance"
                                   and "Lending Programs--The Home Improvement
                                   Lending Program--FHA Loans" herein.

The Co-Trustee's Reserve Amount...Each of the FHA Loans will be insured by the
                                   FHA, to the extent described herein, under
                                   each Originator's FHA contract of insurance.
                                   In connection with the transfer of the FHA
                                   Loans from the Originators to the 

                                      S-27
<PAGE>
 
                                   Co-Trustee, the Originators also will file
                                   with the FHA all documents necessary to
                                   effect the transfer of the FHA insurance
                                   reserves applicable to the FHA Loans to the
                                   Co-Trustee's FHA contract of insurance.

                                  Based upon information provided by the FHA,
                                   The Money Store Inc. believes that upon the
                                   transfer referred to above and after the
                                   Funding Period, the FHA insurance available
                                   to the Co-Trustee will be equal to at least
                                   (A) 10% of the principal balance of the FHA
                                   Loans as of the Cut-Off Date or Subsequent
                                   Cut-Off Date, as the case may be; or (B)
                                   thereafter, 10% of the principal balance of
                                   all Title I loans originated or purchased and
                                   currently reported for FHA insurance by the
                                   Co-Trustee, less amounts for annual
                                   reductions as described below and for
                                   insurance claims previously paid to the Co-
                                   Trustee by the FHA, including payments in
                                   respect of loans other than the FHA Loans,
                                   and increased by an amount equal to 10% of
                                   the lesser of the original principal balance
                                   or the purchase price paid for Title I loans
                                   subsequently originated or purchased of
                                   record by the Co-Trustee (in the case of
                                   clause (A) or (B), the "Reserve Amount").
                                   See "The Trusts--FHA Insurance" in the
                                   Prospectus and "Risk Factor--Limitations on
                                   FHA Insurance" herein.

                                  FHA Claims paid to the Co-Trustee by the FHA
                                   with respect to Title I loans other than the
                                   FHA Loans may affect the total amount of the
                                   Reserve Amount.

                                  Since the adequacy of the Co-Trustee's Reserve
                                   Amount is dependent upon future events,
                                   including the reductions for the payment of
                                   claims, no assurance can be given that the
                                   Reserve Amount is or will be adequate to
                                   cover 90% of all potential losses on the FHA
                                   Loans. See "Risk Factors--Limitations on FHA
                                   Insurance" herein.

Obligation of the Claims 
  Administrator...................If any FHA Loan becomes a 90 Day Delinquent
                                   FHA Loan (as defined below), and if
                                   sufficient coverage is available in the
                                   Reserve Amount to make an FHA Payment with
                                   respect to such FHA Loan, the Claims
                                   Administrator may, in its sole discretion,
                                   during any subsequent Due Period, determine
                                   to file a Claim with the FHA with respect to
                                   such 90 Day Delinquent FHA Loan. If the
                                   Claims Administrator determines to file such
                                   a Claim, the Claims Administrator will so
                                   notify the Co-Trustee and the Custodian no
                                   later than the Determination Date following
                                   such determination and shall request delivery
                                   of the related loan file (the "Trustee's Loan
                                   File"). Upon receipt of such certification
                                   and request, the Custodian shall, no later

                                      S-28
<PAGE>
 
                                   than the related Remittance Date, release to
                                   the Claims Administrator the related
                                   Trustee's Loan File and the Co-Trustee and
                                   the Custodian shall execute and deliver such
                                   instruments necessary to enable the Claims
                                   Administrator to file a Claim with the FHA on
                                   behalf of the Co-Trustee. Within 120 days of
                                   its receipt of the related Trustee's Loan
                                   File, the Claims Administrator shall, in its
                                   sole discretion, either file a Claim with the
                                   FHA for an FHA Payment with respect to such
                                   90 Day Delinquent FHA Loan or, if the Claims
                                   Administrator determines not to file such a
                                   Claim, return to the Co-Trustee the related
                                   Trustee's Loan File.

                                  With respect to any 90 Day Delinquent FHA Loan
                                   transferred to the Claims Administrator as
                                   described above, the Claims Administrator
                                   shall deposit (or, if the Claims
                                   Administrator is not also the Servicer, the
                                   Claims Administrator shall instruct the
                                   Servicer to deposit) in the Principal and
                                   Interest Account within 24 hours of receipt
                                   or determination thereof the following
                                   amounts (such amounts to be net of certain
                                   amounts that would be reimbursable to the
                                   Servicer under the Agreement with respect to
                                   amounts in the Principal and Interest
                                   Account):  (i) any FHA Payments; (ii) the
                                   amount, if any, by which the FHA Payment was
                                   reduced in accordance with FHA Regulations
                                   due to the Claims Administrator enforcing a
                                   lien on the related Mortgaged Property prior
                                   to the lien of the related 90 Day Delinquent
                                   FHA Loan; and (iii) any principal and
                                   interest payments received with respect to a
                                   90 Day Delinquent FHA Loan after the Due
                                   Period in which the FHA Loan is transferred
                                   to the Claims Administrator and before either
                                   the related FHA Payment is paid or the
                                   related Trustee's Loan File is returned to
                                   the Co-Trustee, as the case may be (the
                                   amounts referred to in (ii) and (iii) above
                                   are referred to herein as "Related
                                   Payments").

                                  If an FHA Loan becomes a 90 Day Delinquent FHA
                                   Loan when there is insufficient coverage in
                                   the Reserve Amount or if the Claims
                                   Administrator determines not to file a Claim
                                   with the FHA with respect to such 90 Day
                                   Delinquent FHA Loan, the Co-Trustee will not
                                   transfer such FHA Loan to the Claims
                                   Administrator, no Claim will be made to the
                                   FHA and the Servicer may take other action,
                                   including the commencement of foreclosure
                                   proceedings on the related Mortgaged
                                   Property, if any.  The Servicer will continue
                                   to make Monthly Advances with respect to
                                   interest on 90 Day Delinquent FHA Loans as
                                   described under "Monthly Advances" herein.

                                      S-29
<PAGE>
 
                                  The Certificateholders will not have any
                                   direct right to receive the FHA Payments from
                                   the FHA.  See "Risk Factors--Dependence on
                                   Claims Administrator, Representative and
                                   Servicer for Making FHA Claims and Paying the
                                   FHA Payments" herein.

                                  A "90 Day Delinquent FHA Loan" is a Loan with
                                   respect to which four consecutive Monthly
                                   Payments have not been received by the
                                   Servicer as of the last day of the related
                                   Due Period unless, on or prior to the last
                                   day of the Due Period in which the fourth
                                   Monthly Payment is due, the Servicer has
                                   received from the related Obligor an amount
                                   at least equal to one unpaid Monthly Payment.

                                  An "FHA Payment" is any amount paid by the FHA
                                   pursuant to a Claim with respect to a 90 Day
                                   Delinquent FHA Loan.

FHA Premium Account...............The Trustee will establish with itself a
                                   separate account (an "FHA Premium Account")
                                   to reimburse the Claims Administrator for the
                                   payment to the FHA of the annual insurance
                                   premium (the "FHA Insurance Premium") on each
                                   FHA Loan in the Trust.  The FHA Insurance
                                   Premium is an annual premium equal to 0.5% of
                                   the original principal balance of each FHA
                                   Loan.  If the related Obligor pays the FHA
                                   Insurance Premium in addition to the monthly
                                   payment, any payment of the FHA Insurance
                                   Premium received during a Due Period will be
                                   deposited in the FHA Premium Account on the
                                   related Remittance Date by the Trustee from
                                   the related Certificate Account.  In certain
                                   states, the Servicer is prohibited from
                                   directly collecting the FHA Insurance Premium
                                   from the Obligor.  With respect to FHA Loans
                                   secured by Mortgaged Properties located in
                                   such states, the Servicer will cause to be
                                   deposited in the FHA Premium Account a
                                   specified percentage of each scheduled
                                   interest payment.  Since an Obligor pays
                                   interest on the declining principal balance
                                   of the related FHA Loan and the FHA Insurance
                                   Premium is based upon the original principal
                                   balance of the FHA Loan, the amount of
                                   interest allocated to the FHA Premium Account
                                   may be more or less than the amount of the
                                   related FHA Insurance Premium.  The Servicer
                                   has agreed to satisfy any resulting shortfall
                                   from its own funds.

The Pools

General...........................Unless otherwise noted, all statistical
                                   percentages in this Prospectus Supplement
                                   concerning the Loans are measured by the
                                   aggregate principal balances of the 

                                      S-30
<PAGE>
 
                                   related Pool of Loans described herein at the
                                   close of business on the Cut-Off Date and all
                                   dollar amounts are based on the principal
                                   balances of such Loans at the close of
                                   business on the Cut-Off Date. The Loans that
                                   will comprise Pool I and Pool II as of the
                                   Closing Date are referred to herein as the
                                   "Initial Pool I Home Equity Loans" and the
                                   "Initial Pool II Home Equity Loans,"
                                   respectively, and collectively, as the
                                   "Initial Home Equity Loans." The Loans that
                                   will comprise Pool III as of the Closing Date
                                   are referred to herein as the "Initial Home
                                   Improvement Loans." The Loans that will
                                   comprise Pool IV as of the Closing Date are
                                   referred to herein as the "Initial
                                   Multifamily Loans" and, together with the
                                   Initial Home Equity Loans and the Initial
                                   Home Improvement Loans, the "Initial Loans."

Pool I and Pool II................The Pool I and Pool II Home Equity Loans will
                                   consist of mortgages, deeds of trust or other
                                   security instruments (the "Home Equity
                                   Mortgages" or "Mortgages"), and the related
                                   promissory notes (the "Home Equity Mortgage
                                   Notes" or "Notes") secured by one- to four-
                                   family residences (and, in the case of Pool
                                   I, certain five- and six-family residences),
                                   units in planned unit developments ("PUDs")
                                   and units in condominium developments (the
                                   "Home Equity Mortgaged Properties" or
                                   "Mortgaged Properties").

                                  As stated above, the Agreement will provide
                                   that Subsequent Home Equity Loans may be
                                   purchased by the Trust from the Originators
                                   from time to time on or before the close of
                                   business on December 26, 1997 from funds on
                                   deposit in the Pre-Funding Account allocated
                                   to Pools I and II.  Prior to the Closing
                                   Date, each Subsequent Home Equity Loan will
                                   have been originated and underwritten, or
                                   purchased and re-underwritten, by one of the
                                   Originators, substantially in accordance with
                                   the Originators' underwriting criteria
                                   described in the Prospectus under the caption
                                   "The Single Family Loan Lending Program--
                                   Underwriting Criteria." The purchase price
                                   for each Subsequent Home Equity Loan will be
                                   no greater than its unpaid principal balance
                                   as of the last day of the month preceding the
                                   month in which it is purchased by the Trust
                                   (each such date, a "Subsequent Cut-Off
                                   Date"). The Agreement will provide that the
                                   Pool I and Pool II Home Equity Loans,
                                   following the conveyance of any Subsequent
                                   Home Equity Loans to the appropriate Pool,
                                   must, in the aggregate, conform to certain
                                   specified characteristics. See "The 
                                   Agreement--Representations and Warranties" in
                                   the Prospectus.

                                      S-31
<PAGE>
 
                                  No more than approximately 15%, 15%, 12%, 12%,
                                   12%, 12%, 10% and 10% of the Pool I Home
                                   Equity Loans will be secured by Home Equity
                                   Mortgaged Properties located in New York,
                                   California, New Jersey, Pennsylvania,
                                   Illinois, Florida, Washington and Ohio,
                                   respectively.  No more than approximately
                                   15%, 12%, 12%, 12%, 12%, 10%, and 10% of the
                                   Pool II Home Equity Loans will be secured by
                                   Home Equity Mortgaged Properties located in
                                   Illinois, Michigan, California, Ohio,
                                   Washington, Pennsylvania and Massachusetts,
                                   respectively.  No more than approximately 5%
                                   of the Pool I Home Equity Loans and 5% of the
                                   Pool II Home Equity Loans will be secured by
                                   Home Equity Mortgaged Properties located in
                                   any other state.  Based on representations
                                   made by the obligor on a Home Equity Mortgage
                                   Note (the "Home Equity Mortgagor" or the
                                   "Mortgagor"), no less than approximately 92%
                                   of the Home Equity Loans in Pool I and 92% of
                                   the Home Equity Loans in Pool II will be
                                   secured by one- to four-family residences, no
                                   more than approximately 6% and 6% of the Pool
                                   I and Pool II Home Equity Loans,
                                   respectively, will be secured by vacation
                                   homes, secondary residences, or investment
                                   properties, no more than approximately 4% and
                                   4% of the Pool I and Pool II Home Equity
                                   Loans, respectively, will be secured by
                                   individual units in low rise condominiums, no
                                   more than approximately 10% and 12% of the
                                   Pool I and Pool II Home Equity Loans,
                                   respectively, will be secured by two-, three-
                                   or four-family houses, no more than
                                   approximately 2% of the Pool I Home Equity
                                   Loans will be secured by five- or six-family
                                   houses (which may be mixed-use buildings),
                                   and no more than approximately 1% and 1% of
                                   the Pool I and Pool II Home Equity Loans,
                                   respectively, will be secured by individual
                                   units of other types including high rise
                                   condominiums. No Home Equity Loan will be
                                   secured by a mobile home or a cooperative
                                   residence.

                                  No less than approximately 60% of the Pool I
                                   Home Equity Loans and all of the Pool II Home
                                   Equity Loans will constitute first mortgage
                                   liens on the related Home Equity Mortgaged
                                   Property and the remainder of the Pool I Home
                                   Equity Loans will constitute second mortgage
                                   liens on the related Home Equity Mortgaged
                                   Property.

                                  The "Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio--" of a Home
                                   Equity Loan is the ratio, expressed as a
                                   percentage, determined by dividing (x) the
                                   sum of the original principal balance of the
                                   Home Equity Loan (less the amount, if any, of
                                   the premium for credit life insurance) plus
                                   the 

                                      S-32
<PAGE>
 
                                   then-current principal balance of the related
                                   first lien, if any, by (y) the value of the
                                   Home Equity Mortgaged Property, based upon
                                   the appraisal or valuation made at the time
                                   of origination of the Home Equity Loan.

                                  Based upon the original principal balances of
                                   the Home Equity Loans, no more than
                                   approximately 45% and 45% of the Pool I and
                                   Pool II Home Equity Loans, respectively, will
                                   have a Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio exceeding
                                   80%.  No Pool I or Pool II Home Equity Loan
                                   will have a Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio
                                   exceeding 100%.  The weighted average
                                   Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio, based upon
                                   appraisals or valuations made at the times of
                                   origination of the Pool I and Pool II Home
                                   Equity Loans, will be no more than
                                   approximately 76% and 78%, respectively.  The
                                   Home Equity Loans are not insured or
                                   guaranteed by any governmental entity.

                                  The Home Equity Loans, other than Balloon Home
                                   Equity Loans discussed below, will provide
                                   for a schedule of payments which will be, if
                                   timely paid, sufficient to amortize fully the
                                   principal balance of the Home Equity Loan on
                                   or before its maturity date.  The Home Equity
                                   Loans will be either (i) " simple interest"
                                   loans, which means that payments are applied
                                   as they are received first to accrued
                                   interest, then to principal or (ii)
                                   "actuarial" loans, which means that payments
                                   received either earlier or later (other than
                                   delinquent) than the scheduled due dates of
                                   such Home Equity Loans will not affect the
                                   amortization schedule or the relative
                                   application of such payments to principal and
                                   interest.  The Pool I Home Equity Loans will
                                   bear interest at fixed rates (each, a "Pool I
                                   Mortgage Interest Rate") which, as of the
                                   Cut-Off Date, ranged from approximately 7.55%
                                   to approximately 18% per annum.

                                  The Pool II Home Equity Loans will bear
                                   interest at adjustable rates (each, a "Pool
                                   II Mortgage Interest Rate") which, as of the
                                   Cut-Off Date, ranged from approximately 5% to
                                   approximately 17% per annum, and which will
                                   adjust on the date set forth in the related
                                   Mortgage Note.  For each Pool II Home Equity
                                   Loan, the related Pool II Mortgage Interest
                                   Rate  will change  initially after the period
                                   set forth in the related Mortgage Note and
                                   periodically thereafter.  Each date on which
                                   a Pool II Mortgage Interest Rate changes is
                                   referred to as the "Change Date" for the
                                   related Pool II Home Equity Loan.   No more
                                   than approximately 35% of the Pool II Home
                                   Equity Loans will have their first Change
                                   Date occurring approximately 24 months after

                                      S-33
<PAGE>
 
                                   origination, no more than approximately 5% of
                                   the Pool II Home Equity Loans will have their
                                   first Change Date occurring approximately 36
                                   months after origination and no more than
                                   approximately 40% of the Pool II Home Equity
                                   Loans will have their first Change Date
                                   occurring approximately 48 months after
                                   origination.  The remainder of the Pool II
                                   Home Equity Loans will have their first
                                   Change Date occurring no later than 12 months
                                   after origination.

                                  The Pool II Mortgage Interest Rate relating to
                                   at least 90% of the Pool II Home Equity Loans
                                   will adjust on each applicable Change Date to
                                   equal the sum of (i) the applicable London
                                   Interbank Offered Rate for U.S. dollar
                                   deposits (the "LIBOR Index") and (ii) the
                                   number of basis points set forth in the
                                   related Mortgage Note (the "Gross Margin"),
                                   subject to rounding and to the effects of the
                                   Periodic Rate Cap, the applicable Lifetime
                                   Cap and the applicable Lifetime Floor.  The
                                   Pool II Mortgage Interest Rate relating to
                                   the remainder of the Pool II Home Equity
                                   Loans will adjust on each Change Date to
                                   equal the sum of (i) the applicable One-Year
                                   Constant Maturity Treasury Index ("CMT" or
                                   the "Treasury Index") as published by the
                                   Federal Reserve Board in the applicable
                                   Federal Reserve Board Statistical Release No.
                                   H.15, and (ii) the related Gross Margin,
                                   subject to rounding and to the effects of the
                                   Periodic Rate Cap, the applicable Lifetime
                                   Cap and the applicable Lifetime Floor.

                                  The Gross Margins for the Pool II Home Equity
                                   Loans will range from approximately 2.75% to
                                   12.0%.  The weighted average Gross Margin of
                                   the Pool II Home Equity Loans will be no less
                                   than approximately 6.0%.  The "Periodic Rate
                                   Cap" limits changes in the Pool II Mortgage
                                   Interest Rate for each Pool II Home Equity
                                   Loan on each Change Date to the Periodic Rate
                                   Cap as set forth in the related Mortgage
                                   Note. The Lifetime Caps of the Pool II Home
                                   Equity Loans will range from approximately 6%
                                   to 21%. The weighted average Lifetime Cap of
                                   the Pool II Home Equity Loans will be no less
                                   than approximately 16.0%. The Lifetime Floors
                                   of the Pool II Home Equity Loans will range
                                   from approximately 0% to 15%. The weighted
                                   average Lifetime Floor of the Pool II Home
                                   Equity Loans will be no less than
                                   approximately 10%.

                                  The weighted average Pool I Mortgage Interest
                                   Rate of the Initial Pool I Home Equity Loans
                                   will be no less than approximately 11.4%.
                                   The weighted average current Pool II Mortgage
                                   Interest Rate of the Initial Pool II Home
                                   Equity Loans will be no less than

                                      S-34
<PAGE>
 
                                   approximately 10%.  The lowest principal
                                   balances of any Initial Pool I and Initial
                                   Pool II Home Equity Loan as of the Cut-Off
                                   Date will be approximately $1,000 and $1,000,
                                   respectively, and the highest will be
                                   approximately $480,000 and $650,000,
                                   respectively.  As of the Cut-Off Date, the
                                   average principal balances of the Initial
                                   Pool I and Initial Pool II Home Equity Loans
                                   will be no less than approximately $35,000
                                   and $80,000, respectively.  Initial Home
                                   Equity Loans not originated by an Originator
                                   or having original principal balances less
                                   than or equal to $15,000 may not be covered
                                   by title insurance policies.  As of the Cut-
                                   Off Date, the weighted average remaining
                                   terms to stated maturity of the Initial Pool
                                   I and Initial Pool II Home Equity Loans will
                                   be no more than approximately 257 months and
                                   359 months, respectively.  The weighted
                                   average terms to stated maturity of the
                                   Initial Pool I and Initial Pool II Home
                                   Equity Loans at origination will be no more
                                   than approximately 258 months and 360 months,
                                   respectively.

                                  No more than approximately 10% of the Pool I
                                   Home Equity Loans will provide for a stated
                                   maturity of less than the period of time of
                                   the corresponding amortization schedule
                                   ("Balloon Loans").  As a result, upon the
                                   maturity of a Balloon Loan, the Home Equity
                                   Mortgagor will be required to make a final
                                   payment which will be substantially larger
                                   than such Home Equity Mortgagor's previous
                                   monthly payments.  No Pool II Home Equity
                                   Loan will be a Balloon Loan.  See "Risk
                                   Factors--Nature of the Security" in the
                                   Prospectus.

Pool III..........................The Home Improvement Loans in Pool III will
                                   consist of fixed  rate home improvement
                                   mortgages (the "Home Improvement Mortgages")
                                   and the related promissory notes, retail
                                   installment contracts or obligations, or
                                   sales agreements (the "Home Improvement
                                   Mortgage Notes" or "Notes") secured, except
                                   as set forth below, by one- to four-family
                                   residences, units in planned unit
                                   developments ("PUDs") and units in
                                   condominium developments (the "Home
                                   Improvement Mortgaged Properties" or
                                   "Mortgaged Properties").

                                  As stated above, the Agreement will provide
                                   that Subsequent Home Improvement Loans may be
                                   purchased by the Trust from the Originators
                                   from time to time on or before the close of
                                   business on December 26, 1997 from funds on
                                   deposit in the Pre-Funding Account allocated
                                   to Pool III.  Each Subsequent Home
                                   Improvement Loan (including Dealer Loans, as
                                   defined herein under "Lending Programs--The
                                   Home 

                                      S-35
<PAGE>
 
                                   Improvement Lending Program--
                                   Dealer/Contractor Origination") will have
                                   been originated and underwritten, or
                                   purchased and re-underwritten, by one of the
                                   Originators, substantially in accordance with
                                   the Originators' underwriting criteria
                                   described herein under the caption "Lending
                                   Programs--The Home Improvement Lending
                                   Program--FHA Loans--Title I Underwriting
                                   Requirements," in connection with Subsequent
                                   Home Improvement Loans that are FHA Loans,
                                   and "Lending Programs--The Home Improvement
                                   Lending Program--Conventional Home
                                   Improvement Loans--Underwriting Criteria," in
                                   connection with Subsequent Home Improvement
                                   Loans that are Conventional Home Improvement
                                   Loans. The purchase price for each Subsequent
                                   Home Improvement Loan will be no greater than
                                   its unpaid principal balance as of the
                                   related Subsequent Cut-Off Date. The
                                   Agreement will provide that the Home
                                   Improvement Loans, following the conveyance
                                   of any Subsequent Home Improvement Loans to
                                   Pool III, must, in the aggregate, conform to
                                   certain specified characteristics. See "The
                                   Agreement--Representations and Warranties" in
                                   the Prospectus.

                                  Between approximately 10% and 20% of the
                                   Initial Home Improvement Loans will be FHA
                                   Loans and the remainder will be Conventional
                                   Home Improvement Loans.  The Home Improvement
                                   Loans will have been originated and
                                   underwritten, or purchased and re-
                                   underwritten, by one of the Originators
                                   substantially in accordance with the
                                   Originators' underwriting criteria described
                                   herein under the caption "Lending Programs--
                                   The Home Improvement Lending Program--FHA
                                   Loans--Title I Underwriting Requirements," in
                                   connection with FHA Loans, and "Lending
                                   Programs--The Home Improvement Lending
                                   Program--Conventional Home Improvement Loans-
                                   -Underwriting Criteria," in connection with
                                   Conventional Home Improvement Loans.

                                  No more than approximately 40%, 15%, 12%, 12%,
                                   10%, 10%, 10% and 7% of the Home Improvement
                                   Loans will be secured by Home Improvement
                                   Mortgaged Properties located in California,
                                   Illinois, Texas, Florida, Nevada, Arizona,
                                   New York, and Georgia, respectively.  No more
                                   than approximately 5% of the Home Improvement
                                   Loans will be secured by Home Improvement
                                   Mortgaged Properties located in any other
                                   state.  Based on representations made by the
                                   mortgagor on a Home Improvement Mortgage Note
                                   (the "Home Improvement Mortgagor" or
                                   "Obligor"), no less than approximately 95% of
                                   the Home 

                                      S-36
<PAGE>
 
                                   Improvement Loans will be secured by one- to
                                   four-family residences, no more than
                                   approximately 2% of the Home Improvement
                                   Loans will be secured by vacation homes,
                                   secondary residences, or investment
                                   properties, no more than approximately 2% of
                                   the Home Improvement Loans will be secured by
                                   individual units in low rise condominiums, no
                                   more than approximately 2% of the Home
                                   Improvement Loans will be secured by two-,
                                   three- or four-family houses, no more than
                                   approximately 3% of the Home Improvement
                                   Loans will be secured by Multifamily
                                   Mortgaged Properties and no more than
                                   approximately 2% of the Home Improvement
                                   Loans will be secured by individual units of
                                   other types including high rise condominiums
                                   and mixed-use buildings. No more than
                                   approximately 2% of the Home Improvement
                                   Loans will be secured by a manufactured home
                                   or a cooperative residence.

                                  No less than approximately 5% of the Home
                                   Improvement Loans will be secured by first
                                   mortgage liens on the related Home
                                   Improvement Mortgaged Property, no less than
                                   approximately 75% of the Home Improvement
                                   Loans will be secured by second mortgage
                                   liens on the related Home Improvement
                                   Mortgaged Property and the remainder of the
                                   Home Improvement Loans will be secured by
                                   more junior mortgage liens on the related
                                   Home Improvement Mortgaged Property.

                                  The FHA Loans are insured by the FHA to the
                                   extent described herein.  The Conventional
                                   Home Improvement Loans are not insured by any
                                   governmental entity.

                                  The Home Improvement Loans will provide for a
                                   schedule of payments which will be, if timely
                                   paid, sufficient to amortize fully the
                                   principal balance of the Home Improvement
                                   Loan on or before its maturity date.  The
                                   Home Improvement Loans will be "simple
                                   interest" loans. However, with respect to FHA
                                   Loans secured by Mortgaged Properties located
                                   in states where the Servicer collects the FHA
                                   Insurance Premium directly from the related
                                   Obligor, payments are applied to the FHA
                                   Insurance Premium prior to accrued interest.
                                   The Home Improvement Loans will bear interest
                                   at fixed rates (each, a "Pool III Home
                                   Improvement Interest Rate").

                                  The Home Improvement Loans will bear interest
                                   at fixed Pool III Home Improvement Interest
                                   Rates which range from approximately 7.95% to
                                   approximately 17% per 

                                      S-37
<PAGE>
 
                                   annum. The weighted average Pool III Home
                                   Improvement Interest Rate of the Initial Home
                                   Improvement Loans will be no less than
                                   approximately 12.75%. The lowest principal
                                   balances of any Initial Home Improvement Loan
                                   as of the Cut-Off Date will be approximately
                                   $1,000, and the highest will be approximately
                                   $100,000. As of the Cut-Off Date, the average
                                   principal balance of the Initial Home
                                   Improvement Loans will be no less than
                                   approximately $15,000. As of the Cut-Off
                                   Date, the weighted average remaining term to
                                   stated maturity of the Initial Home
                                   Improvement Loans will be no more than
                                   approximately 221 months. The weighted
                                   average term to stated maturity of the
                                   Initial Home Improvement Loans at origination
                                   will be no more than approximately 222
                                   months. Each Home Improvement Loan that is a
                                   first lien is covered by a title insurance
                                   policy.

Pool IV...........................The Multifamily Loans in Pool IV will consist
                                   of mortgages, deeds of trust or other
                                   security instruments (the "Multifamily
                                   Mortgages"), and the related promissory notes
                                   (the "Multifamily Mortgage Notes" or "Notes")
                                   secured by five or more unit residential or
                                   mixed-use residential and commercial
                                   properties (the "Multifamily Mortgaged
                                   Properties" or "Mortgaged Properties").

                                  As stated above, the Agreement will provide
                                   that Subsequent Multifamily Loans may be
                                   purchased by the Trust from the Originators
                                   from time to time on or before the close of
                                   business on December 26, 1997 from funds on
                                   deposit in the Pre-Funding Account allocated
                                   to Pool IV.  Each Subsequent Multifamily Loan
                                   will have been originated and underwritten,
                                   or purchased and re-underwritten, by one of
                                   the Originators, substantially in accordance
                                   with the Originators' underwriting criteria
                                   described under "Lending Programs--The
                                   Multifamily Lending Program" herein.  The
                                   purchase price for each Subsequent
                                   Multifamily Loan will be no greater than its
                                   unpaid principal balance as of the related
                                   Subsequent Cut-Off Date. The Agreement will
                                   provide that the Multifamily Loans, following
                                   the conveyance of any Subsequent Multifamily
                                   Loans to Pool IV, must, in the aggregate,
                                   conform to certain specified characteristics.
                                   See "The Agreement--Representations and
                                   Warranties" in the Prospectus.

                                  The Initial Multifamily Loans were originated
                                   and underwritten, or purchased and re-
                                   underwritten, by one of the Originators,
                                   substantially in accordance with the

                                      S-38
<PAGE>
 
                                   Originators' underwriting criteria described
                                   under "Lending Programs--The Multifamily
                                   Lending Program" herein.

                                  No more than approximately 40%, 35%, 30% and
                                   20% of the Multifamily Loans will be secured
                                   by Multifamily Mortgaged Properties located
                                   in Texas, California, New York and Georgia,
                                   respectively.  No more than approximately 10%
                                   of the Multifamily Loans will be secured by
                                   Multifamily Mortgaged Properties located in
                                   any other state.  Based on representations
                                   made by the obligor on a Multifamily Mortgage
                                   Note (the "Multifamily Mortgagor" or
                                   "Obligor"), all of the Multifamily Loans will
                                   be secured by five or more unit residential
                                   or mixed-use residential and commercial
                                   properties.

                                  All of the Multifamily Loans will constitute
                                   first mortgage liens on the related
                                   Multifamily Mortgaged Property.

                                  No Multifamily Loan will have a Combined Loan-
                                   to-Value Ratio exceeding approximately 70%.
                                   The weighted average Combined Loan-to-Value
                                   Ratio, based upon appraisals or valuations
                                   made at the times of origination of the Pool
                                   IV Multifamily Loans will be no more than
                                   approximately 65%.  The Multifamily Loans
                                   will not be insured or guaranteed by any
                                   governmental entity.

                                  The Multifamily Loans will provide for a
                                   schedule of payments which will be, if timely
                                   paid, sufficient to amortize fully the
                                   principal balance of the Multifamily Loan on
                                   or before its maturity date.  The Multifamily
                                   Loans will be "simple interest" loans.  The
                                   Multifamily Loans will bear interest at fixed
                                   rates (each, a "Multifamily Mortgage Interest
                                   Rate").

                                  The Initial Multifamily Loans will bear
                                   interest rates which range from approximately
                                   9% to approximately 15% per annum.  The
                                   weighted average Multifamily Mortgage
                                   Interest Rate of the Initial Multifamily
                                   Loans will be no less than approximately
                                   11.5%. The lowest principal balance of any
                                   Initial Multifamily Loan as of the Cut-Off
                                   Date will be approximately $25,000, and the
                                   highest will be approximately $1,000,000. As
                                   of the Cut-Off Date, the average principal
                                   balance of the Initial Multifamily Loans will
                                   be no less than approximately $190,000. All
                                   Initial Multifamily Loans will be covered by
                                   title insurance policies. As of the Cut-Off
                                   Date, the weighted average remaining term to
                                   stated maturity of the Initial Multifamily
                                   Loans will be 

                                      S-39
<PAGE>
 
                                   no more than approximately 345 months. The
                                   weighted average term to stated maturity of
                                   the Initial Multifamily Loans at origination
                                   will be no more than approximately 346
                                   months.

                                  Each Multifamily Loan contains provisions
                                   requiring the related Mortgagor to pay a
                                   penalty in connection with certain
                                   prepayments made within three or five years,
                                   depending on the terms of such Multifamily
                                   Loan, of its origination.

Servicing of the Loans............The Servicer will serve as master servicer for
                                   the Loans in accordance with the Agreement.
                                   The Servicer may act through subservicers,
                                   including the Originators or other affiliates
                                   of the Servicer.

Monthly Advances..................The Servicer is required to remit to the
                                   Trustee no later than the day of each month
                                   which is at least three business days prior
                                   to the Remittance Date and is in no case
                                   earlier than the seventh business day of such
                                   month (the "Determination Date") the amount
                                   (a "Monthly Advance"), if any, by which, for
                                   each Pool (a) the sum of (x) 30 days'
                                   interest (or, with respect to the Adjustable
                                   Rate Certificates and the Auction Rate
                                   Certificates, the actual number of days since
                                   the last Remittance Date (or, in the case of
                                   the first Remittance Date, from September 15,
                                   1997 with respect to the Adjustable Rate
                                   Certificates and from the Closing Date with
                                   respect to the Auction Rate Certificates) up
                                   to but not including the upcoming Remittance
                                   Date) at the weighted average Adjusted
                                   Mortgage Loan Remittance Rates of such Pool
                                   on the aggregate outstanding Class Principal
                                   Balances of each Class of Certificates in
                                   such Pool immediately prior to the related
                                   Remittance Date and (y) the Excess Spread (as
                                   defined herein under "Description of the
                                   Certificates--Cross-Support Provisions and
                                   Spread Amount"), if any, for the related
                                   Remittance Date relating to the Loans of the
                                   related Pool exceeds (b) the amount received
                                   by the Servicer in respect of interest on the
                                   Loans of the related Pool as of the related
                                   Record Date (and with respect to the
                                   Remittance Dates in October, November and
                                   December 1997, the sum of (i) all funds to be
                                   transferred to the applicable Certificate
                                   Account from the Capitalized Interest Account
                                   for such Remittance Date and (ii)
                                   certain investment earnings on amounts in the
                                   Pre-Funding Account for the applicable
                                   Remittance Date).  Such advances by the
                                   Servicer are reimbursable in the first
                                   instance from late collections of interest
                                   including amounts received in connection with
                                   the liquidation of defaulted Loans
                                   ("Liquidation Proceeds"), amounts paid by any
                                   insurer pursuant to any insurance policy

                                      S-40
<PAGE>
 
                                   covering a Loan, Mortgaged Property or REO
                                   Property ("Insurance Proceeds"), FHA Payments
                                   and proceeds received by the Servicer in
                                   connection with condemnation, eminent domain
                                   or a release of lien ("Released Mortgaged
                                   Property Proceeds") collected with respect to
                                   the related Loan as to which the advances
                                   were made, and any other amount that
                                   otherwise would be distributed on the Class X
                                   and Class R Certificates.  Notwithstanding
                                   the foregoing, the Servicer will not be
                                   required to make an advance if it determines,
                                   in its good faith judgment, that such advance
                                   will not be recoverable from the foregoing
                                   sources.  Monthly Advances will not cover any
                                   Certificateholders' Interest Carryover.

                                  The "Adjusted Mortgage Loan Remittance Rate,"
                                   for a Class of Certificates will equal the
                                   sum of the Pass-Through Rate for such Class
                                   and a rate used to determine certain expenses
                                   of the Trust.  Certain of the Loans in each
                                   Pool may bear interest at a rate below the
                                   Adjusted Mortgage Loan Remittance Rate for
                                   the related Class.  Any such Loan will be
                                   sold to the Trust at a discount so as to
                                   create, for each such Loan, a mortgage
                                   interest rate that, when applied to the
                                   purchase price paid by such Trust for such
                                   Loan, will at least equal the related
                                   Adjusted Mortgage Loan Remittance Rate.

Compensating Interest.............Not later than each Determination Date, with
                                   respect to each Loan to which the Servicer
                                   received a principal payment in full in
                                   advance of the final scheduled due date (a
                                   "Principal Prepayment") or received a
                                   principal payment that is in excess of five
                                   times the scheduled monthly payment due, but
                                   which was not intended by the Mortgagor to
                                   satisfy the Loan in full or to cure a
                                   delinquency (a "Curtailment") during the
                                   related Due Period, the Servicer is required
                                   to remit to the Trustee from amounts
                                   otherwise payable to the Servicer as
                                   servicing compensation (including the
                                   Contingency Fee), an amount ("Compensating
                                   Interest") equal to any excess of (a) 30
                                   days' interest (or, with respect to a Pool II
                                   Loan, the actual number of days since the
                                   last Remittance Date (or, in the case of the
                                   first Remittance Date, from September 15,
                                   1997) up to but not including the upcoming
                                   Remittance Date) on the principal balance of
                                   each such Loan as of the beginning of the
                                   related Due Period, at the weighted average
                                   Adjusted Mortgage Loan Remittance Rates of
                                   the related Pool applicable to the Remittance
                                   Date on which the Compensating Interest will
                                   be distributed over (b) the amount of
                                   interest actually received on the related
                                   Loan during such Due Period.

                                      S-41
<PAGE>
 
Servicing and Contingency Fees....The Servicer is entitled to a servicing fee of
                                   0.25% per annum of the principal balance of
                                   each Loan (the "Servicing Fee"), and a
                                   contingency fee of 0.25% per annum of the
                                   principal balance of each Loan (the
                                   "Contingency Fee"), each calculated and
                                   payable monthly from the interest portion of
                                   scheduled monthly payments, Liquidation
                                   Proceeds and certain other Proceeds
                                   collected.

Rating............................It is a condition to the issuance of the
                                   Certificates that each Class of Offered
                                   Certificates receive the following ratings
                                   from Standard & Poor's Ratings Services, a
                                   division of The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc.
                                   ("S&P"), Moody's Investors Service, Inc.
                                   ("Moody's") and/or Fitch Investors Service,
                                   L.P. ("Fitch"):

                                                    RATING
                                   Class     S&P      MOODY'S    FITCH  
                                             ---      -------    -----  
                                   AF-1      AAA      Aaa         --       
                                   AF-2      AAA      Aaa         --       
                                   AF-3      AAA      Aaa         --       
                                   AF-4      AAA      Aaa         --       
                                   AF-5      AAA      Aaa         --       
                                   AF-6      AAA      Aaa         --       
                                   AF-7      AAA      Aaa         --       
                                   AF-8      AAA      Aaa         --       
                                   AV        AAA      Aaa         --       
                                   MV-1      AA       Aa2         --       
                                   MV-2      A        A2          --       
                                   BV        BBB      Baa3        --        
                                   AH-1      AAA      --          AAA   
                                   AH-2      AAA      --          AAA   
                                   AH-3      AAA      --          AAA   
                                   AH-4      AAA      --          AAA   
                                   AH-5      AAA      --          AAA   
                                   AH-6      AAA      --          AAA   
                                   MH-1      AA       --          AA    
                                   MH-2      A        --           A    
                                   BH        BBB      --          BBB   
                                   AMF       AAA      Aaa         --

                                  The ratings assigned by S&P and Moody's to the
                                   Pool I and Pool IV Certificates are based, in
                                   large part, on the creditworthiness of MBIA
                                   and the MBIA Policies.

                                  A security rating is not a recommendation to
                                   buy, sell or hold securities and may be
                                   subject to revision or withdrawal at any
                                   time.  No person is obligated to maintain the
                                   rating on any Class of Certificates.  The
                                   ratings of the Pool II Certificates by S&P
                                   and Moody's do not address the likelihood of
                                   the payment of the 

                                      S-42
<PAGE>
 
                                   amount of any Certificateholders' Interest
                                   Carryover. In general, the ratings address
                                   credit risk and do not address the likelihood
                                   or rate of principal prepayments. See "Rating
                                   of the Offered Certificates" herein.

Optional Termination by the 
  Servicer........................On any Remittance Date from and after the
                                   Remittance Date on which the aggregate
                                   principal balances of the Loans are less than
                                   10% of the sum of (i) the aggregate principal
                                   balances of the Initial Home Equity Loans,
                                   the Initial Home Improvement Loans and the
                                   Initial Multifamily Loans (collectively, the
                                   "Initial Loans") as of the Cut-Off Date (the
                                   "Original Pool Principal Balance") and (ii)
                                   the original Pre-Funded Amount (such date,
                                   the "Optional Servicer Termination Date"),
                                   the Servicer may, at its option, and in the
                                   absence of the exercise thereof by the
                                   Servicer, MBIA may, at its option, purchase,
                                   on the next succeeding Remittance Date, all
                                   of the Loans and any related Mortgaged
                                   Property title to which has been acquired in
                                   foreclosure or by deed in lieu of foreclosure
                                   (an "REO Property") at a price set forth in
                                   the Agreement (the "Termination Price") at
                                   least equal to the sum of (x) 100% of the
                                   Principal Balances of the Loans, including
                                   those evidenced by REO Properties, and
                                   including the portion of the principal
                                   balance of each 90 Day Delinquent FHA Loan
                                   for which the Certificateholders have not
                                   received payment and for which a Claim was
                                   submitted to the FHA, and (y) 30 days'
                                   interest (or, with respect to the Adjustable
                                   Rate Certificates and the Auction Rate
                                   Certificates, the actual number of days from
                                   the last Remittance Date to but not including
                                   the upcoming Remittance Date) thereon at the
                                   then applicable weighted average Pass-Through
                                   Rates of the Certificates plus an amount
                                   equal to the interest portion of any
                                   unreimbursed Insured Payments made by MBIA
                                   with respect to the applicable Pool of Loans.
                                   See "The Agreement" herein and in the
                                   Prospectus.

Optional Termination by
  MBIA............................On and after the date on which the Pool
                                   Available Maximum Subordination Amounts for
                                   all Pools are zero, on any Remittance Date on
                                   which Pool I and/or Pool IV Loans with
                                   aggregate principal balances as of the Cut-
                                   Off Date equal to or exceeding 25% or more of
                                   the sum of (i) the Original Pool Principal
                                   Balance and (ii) the original Pre-Funded
                                   Amount, if any, with respect to Pool I and
                                   Pool IV have become Liquidated Loans,
                                   MBIA may purchase all of the Loans and any
                                   related REO Properties in respect thereof at
                                   a price equal to the sum of the Termination
                                   Prices for all Pools and the outstanding and
                                   unpaid fees and expenses of 

                                      S-43
<PAGE>
 
                                   the Trustee and the Servicer. See "The
                                   Agreement" herein and in the Prospectus.

REMIC Election and Tax Status.....For Federal income tax purposes, one or more
                                   elections will be made to treat certain
                                   assets of the Trust as real estate mortgage
                                   investment conduits ("REMICs").  Each Class
                                   of Certificates (other than the Class R
                                   Certificates) will constitute "regular
                                   interests" in a REMIC and each Class of Class
                                   R Certificates will constitute the sole
                                   "residual interest" in the related REMIC.
                                   See "Federal Income Tax Considerations"
                                   herein and "Federal Income Tax Consequences"
                                   in the Prospectus.

ERISA Considerations..............As described under "ERISA Considerations"
                                   herein, the Class A Certificates may be
                                   purchased by a pension or other employee
                                   benefit plan subject to the Employee
                                   Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as
                                   amended ("ERISA"), or by individual
                                   retirement accounts or Keogh plans covering
                                   only a sole proprietor or partner which are
                                   not subject to ERISA but are subject to
                                   Section 4975 of the Code ("Plans"), pursuant
                                   to certain exemptions from potential
                                   prohibited transaction rules of ERISA which
                                   prohibit a broad range of transactions
                                   involving Plan assets and persons having
                                   certain specified relationships to a Plan and
                                   related excise tax provisions of Section 4975
                                   of the Code. Two such exemptions are
                                   Prohibited Transaction Exemption 90-32, 55
                                   Fed. Reg. 23,147 (June 6, 1990) and
                                   Prohibited Transaction Exemption 91-14, 56
                                   Fed. Reg. 7,413 (February 22, 1991)
                                   (collectively, the "Exemption"), which
                                   provides an exemption for transactions
                                   involving the purchase, holding or transfer
                                   of certain asset backed certificates by
                                   Plans.  As the Class M and Class B
                                   Certificates are subordinated and, therefore,
                                   are not eligible for exemptive relief under
                                   the Exemption, they may not be purchased
                                   directly or indirectly, for or on behalf of a
                                   Plan or any entity whose underlying assets
                                   include plan assets; provided that insurance
                                   company general accounts may purchase Class M
                                   and Class B Certificates pursuant to
                                   Prohibited Transaction Class Exemption 95-60,
                                   60 Fed. Reg. 35925 (July 12, 1995).  See
                                   "ERISA Considerations" herein and in the
                                   Prospectus.

Legal Investment Considerations....Only the Class AV and Class MV-1 Certificates
                                    will constitute "mortgage related
                                    securities" under the Secondary Mortgage
                                    Market Enhancement Act of 1984 ("SMMEA").
                                    Each investor should consult its own legal
                                    advisers in determining whether and the
                                    extent to which a Class of Offered
                                    Certificates 

                                      S-44
<PAGE>
 
                                    constitutes a legal investment for such
                                    investor. See "Legal Investment
                                    Considerations" herein.

Registration of the Certificates...The Offered Certificates will be represented
                                    by global certificates registered in the
                                    name of Cede & Co. ("Cede"), as the nominee
                                    of The Depository Trust Company ("DTC") in
                                    the United States, or Cedel Bank, sociJtJ
                                    anonyme ("Cedel Bank") or the Euroclear
                                    System ("Euroclear") in Europe.  No
                                    Certificateholder will be entitled to
                                    receive definitive certificates ("Definitive
                                    Certificates") representing such person's
                                    interest, except in the event that
                                    Definitive Certificates are issued under the
                                    limited circumstances described herein. All
                                    references herein to "Certificateholders" or
                                    "Holders" will reflect the rights of the
                                    beneficial owners of Certificates, as such
                                    rights may be exercised through DTC and
                                    Participants except as otherwise specified
                                    herein.  See "Risk Factors--Book-Entry
                                    Registration" in the Prospectus and
                                    "Description of the Certificates--Book-Entry
                                    Certificates" herein.

                                      S-45
<PAGE>
 
                                  RISK FACTORS

    Prospective Certificateholders should consider, in addition to the factors
described under "Risk Factors" in the Prospectus, the following factors.

TRUST ASSETS ARE THE ONLY SOURCE OF CREDIT ENHANCEMENT FOR POOL II AND POOL III
CERTIFICATES.

  The subordination provisions described below and the overcollateralization
provisions of the Trust are the sole sources of protection for the Pool II and
Pool III Certificates against losses on Loans and other shortfalls in available
funds.  If losses or other shortfalls exceed the protection afforded by such
mechanisms, Holders of the Pool II and Pool III Certificates will bear such
losses and shortfalls as described herein.  See "Description of the
Certificates--Cross-Support and Spread Amount."  The assets of the Trust are the
sole source of funds for distributions on the Pool II and Pool III Certificates.
In certain instances available funds with respect to another Pool of
Certificates may be used to cover current Applied Realized Loss Amounts (as
defined herein) in Pool II or Pool III.

SUBORDINATION--LIMITED PROTECTION AFFORDED TO POOL II AND POOL III CLASS A AND
CLASS M CERTIFICATES.

  The rights of the Holders of the Class M Certificates to receive distributions
with respect to the Loans will be subordinate to the rights of the holders of
the Class A Certificates in the same Pool to receive such distributions, the
rights of Holders of the Class MV-2 and Class MH-2 Certificates to receive
distributions with respect to the applicable Pool of Loans will be subordinate
to the rights of the Holders of the related Class A Certificates and the Class
MV-1 and Class MH-1 Certificates, respectively, to receive such distributions
and the rights of the Holders of the Class BV and Class BH Certificates to
receive distributions with respect to the applicable Pool of Loans will be
subordinate to the rights of the Holders of the related Class A Certificates and
Class M Certificates to receive such distributions.  The subordination of the
Class B Certificates relative to the related Class A Certificates (and of the
more junior Classes of Class M Certificates to the less junior Classes thereof)
is intended to enhance the likelihood of regular receipt by the Holders of the
Class A Certificates (and such less junior Classes of Class M Certificates) of
the full amount of the monthly distributions allocable to them, and to afford
such Holders protection against losses.

DEPENDENCE ON CLAIMS ADMINISTRATOR, REPRESENTATIVE, AND SERVICER FOR MAKING FHA
CLAIMS AND PAYING THE FHA PAYMENTS

    The Trustee, the Co-Trustee and the Certificateholders are dependent on the
Claims Administrator to (1) assure that the FHA Loans will be insured by the
FHA, (2) make Claims on 90 Day Delinquent FHA Loans and (3) remit all FHA
Payments received from the FHA to the Trustee in accordance with the terms of
the Agreement.  See "The Agreement--Obligations of The Claims Administrator"
herein.

LIMITATIONS ON FHA INSURANCE

    The FHA Loans are covered by FHA insurance to the extent described herein.
The Agreement provides that if an FHA Loan becomes a 90 Day Delinquent FHA Loan
and if sufficient coverage is available in the related Reserve Amount, the
Claims Administrator may, in its sole option, file a Claim with the FHA with
respect to such 90 Day Delinquent FHA Loan.  If such a Claim is submitted and
assuming the Representative, the Originators and the Claims Administrator comply
with the provisions described herein, the FHA will pay with respect to such 90
Day Delinquent FHA Loan the amount set forth under "The Home Improvement Lending
Program--FHA Loans--Insurance Claims Procedures for Title I Loans" herein
regardless of whether, in the case of FHA Loans, the related Mortgaged Property
has available equity over and above all liens on such property.

    The availability of FHA insurance following a default on an FHA Loan is
subject to a number of conditions, including strict compliance with FHA
regulations in originating and servicing the FHA Loan and limits on the
aggregate insurance coverage available with respect to all FHA Title I loans
then owned and reported for FHA insurance by the Co-Trustee.  Although the
Claims Administrator is an FHA-approved lender and believes, and 

                                      S-46
<PAGE>
 
represents and warrants in the Agreement, that it has complied with FHA
regulations, such regulations are susceptible to substantial interpretation. The
Claims Administrator is not required to obtain, and has not obtained, approval
from the FHA of its origination and servicing practices. Failure to comply with
FHA regulations may result in a denial of FHA insurance claims, and there can be
no assurance that the FHA's enforcement of its regulations will not change in
the future. In addition, any Claim paid by the FHA will cover only 90% of the
sum of the unpaid principal (determined on the actuarial basis) on the FHA Loan,
a portion of the unpaid interest and certain other liquidation costs.

    Prior to the transfer of the FHA Loans to the Co-Trustee, the FHA Loans will
be insured by the FHA, to the extent described herein, under the related
Originator's FHA contract of insurance.  In connection with the transfer of the
FHA Loans from the Originators to the Co-Trustee, the Originators also will file
with the FHA all documents necessary to effect the transfer of the FHA insurance
reserves applicable to the FHA Loans to the Co-Trustee's FHA contract of
insurance.

    Based upon information provided by the FHA, The Money Store Inc. believes
that upon the transfer referred to above and after the Funding Period, the FHA
insurance available to the Co-Trustee will be equal to at least (A) 10% of the
principal balance of the FHA Loans as of the Cut-Off Date or Subsequent Cut-Off
Date, as the case may be; or (B) thereafter, 10% of the principal balance of all
Title I loans originated or purchased and currently reported for FHA insurance
by the Co-Trustee, less amounts for insurance claims previously paid to the Co-
Trustee by the FHA, including payments in respect of loans other than the FHA
Loans, and increased by an amount equal to 10% of the lesser of the original
principal balance or the purchase price paid for Title I loans subsequently
originated or purchased of record by the Co-Trustee.

    FHA Claims paid to the Co-Trustee by the FHA with respect to Title I loans
other than the FHA Loans may affect the total amount of the Reserve Amount.

    Since the adequacy of the Co-Trustee's Reserve Amount is dependent upon
future events, including the annual reductions in the Reserve Amount and the
reductions for the payment of claims, no assurance can be given that the Reserve
Amount is or will be adequate to cover 90% of all potential losses on the FHA
Loans.

    In connection with the FHA Loans, pursuant to FHA underwriting criteria in
effect at the time substantially all the FHA Loans were originated, there was no
requirement that the Mortgaged Property have any available equity over and above
the total of all liens on such property, including the Title I loan.  However,
loans originated between November 18, 1991 and August 15, 1994 that exceeded
$15,000 were limited to a maximum encumbrance of 100% loan to value of all liens
on such property, including the Title I loan, and non-owner occupied property
loans originated after November 18, 1991 were limited to a maximum encumbrance
of 100% loan to value of all liens on such property, including the Title I loan.
See "The Trusts--FHA Loans" in the Prospectus and "Lending Programs--The Home
Improvement Lending Program--FHA Loans--The Title I Loan Program-General"
herein.

MULTIFAMILY LOANS

    Multifamily lending may be viewed as exposing the lender to a greater risk
of loss than single family residential lending.  Owners of multifamily
residential properties rely on monthly lease payments from tenants to pay for
maintenance and other operating expenses of such properties, to fund capital
improvements and to service any mortgage loan and any other debt that may be
secured by such properties.  Various factors, many of which are beyond the
control of the owner or operator of such a property, may affect the economic
viability of that property.

    Changes in payment patterns by tenants may result from a variety of social,
legal and economic factors.  Economic factors including the rate of inflation,
unemployment levels and relative rates offered for various types of housing may
be reflected in changes in payment patterns including increased risks of
defaults by tenants and higher vacancy rates.  Adverse economic conditions,
either local or national, may limit the amount of rent that can be charged and
may result in a reduction in timely lease payments or a reduction in occupancy
levels.  Occupancy and rent levels may also be affected by construction of
additional housing units, competition and local politics, including rent
stabilization or rent control laws and policies.  In addition, the level of
mortgage interest rates may encourage tenants to 

                                      S-47
<PAGE>
 
purchase single family housing. The Money Store Inc. is unable to determine and
has no basis to predict whether, or to what extent, economic, legal or social
factors will affect future rental or payment patterns.

    The location and construction quality of a particular building may affect
the occupancy level as well as the rents that may be charged for individual
units.  The characteristics of a neighborhood may change over time or in
relation to newer developments.  The effects of poor construction quality will
increase over time in the form of increased maintenance and capital
improvements.  Even good construction will deteriorate over time if adequate
maintenance is not performed in a timely fashion.

    Many of the foregoing conditions may not have been present or significant on
the Closing Date, and certain of those conditions may change.

NET FUNDS CAP AND CERTIFICATEHOLDERS' INTEREST CARRYOVER

    The Pass-Through Rate for the Adjustable Rate Certificates is based
generally on LIBOR and the Pass-Through Rate for the Auction Rate Certificates
will be determined pursuant to the Auction Procedures described in Appendix I to
the Prospectus.  Although the Mortgage Interest Rates on the Pool II Loans
(which rates will be used in determining the Net Funds Cap for such Pool) are
also subject to adjustment, the Mortgage Interest Rates with respect to most of
the Pool II Loans adjust less frequently than the Pass-Through Rates on the
Adjustable Rate Certificates and the Auction Rate Certificates and adjust by
reference to either the London Interbank Offered Rate ("LIBOR"), which will be
calculated differently for the Pool II Loans and the Adjustable Rate
Certificates, or the Treasury Index, which may not necessarily correspond to
changes in one-month LIBOR.

    If in respect of any Remittance Date there does not exist a positive spread
between (a) the Net Funds Cap applicable to the Adjustable Rate Certificates and
the Auction Rate Certificates and (b) the interest accrued on each such Class at
LIBOR plus the applicable margin (in the case of the Adjustable Rate
Certificates) or the Auction Rate determined for such Remittance Date (in the
case of the Auction Rate Certificates), but in no event exceeding 14% per annum,
the Pass-Through Rate for such Class on such Remittance Date will be based upon
the applicable Net Funds Cap.  Any Certificateholders' Interest Carryover
arising as a result of the applicable Pass-Through Rate being based upon the Net
Funds Cap, together with interest thereon at the then applicable Pass-Through
Rate (without giving effect to the Net Funds Cap but in no event exceeding 14%
per annum) will be paid on the following Remittance Date or on any succeeding
Remittance Date to the extent funds are allocated and available therefor after
making all required prior distributions and deposits with respect to such
Remittance Date.  Further, such payments will be made to the Certificateholders
of record of such Class for such Remittance Date, regardless of whether they
owned Certificates when the related Certificateholders' Interest Carryover was
created.  See "Description of the Certificates--Distributions on the
Certificates." The ratings of the Certificates do not address the likelihood of
the payment of any Certificateholders' Interest Carryover.

                                      S-48
<PAGE>
 
                                LENDING PROGRAMS


    Prospective Certificateholders should consider, in addition to the
information described under "The Single Family Loan Lending Program" in the
Prospectus, the following with respect to the Home Improvement Loans, the
Multifamily Loans and a new lending program applicable to Home Equity and Home
Improvement Loans.

THE HOME IMPROVEMENT LENDING PROGRAM

FHA LOANS

    The Title I Loan Program-General

    The National Housing Act of 1934 (the "NHA Act"), in Sections 1 and 2(a)
thereof, authorized the creation of the FHA and the Title I credit insurance
program (the "Title I Loan Program"). Several types of loans may be made under
the Title I Loan Program, including, among others, property improvement loans
(the "Title I Property Improvement Loans") which may be made by approved lenders
to finance alterations, repair or improvement of existing single family,
multifamily and nonresidential structures.  See "The Trusts--FHA Loans" in the
Prospectus for a general description of the Title I Loan Program.

    Requirements for Title I Property Improvement Loans

    The following is a description of the requirements for Title I Property
Improvement Loans currently in effect.

    A Title I Property Improvement Loan cannot be used to purchase property.
The loan proceeds may only be used to finance property improvements which
substantially protect or improve the basic livability or utility of the property
to be improved.  The loan amount may include the cost of the proposed
improvements and (i) architectural and engineering services; (ii) building
permit costs; (iii) credit report costs; (iv) a fee for an actual inspection of
the property by the lender or its agent, not to exceed $75, but only where the
total principal obligation is $7,500 or more; (v) title examination costs; (vi)
appraisal fees in connection with a loan or combination of loans on the same
property with a total principal balance in excess of $15,000; and (vii)
commencing July 5, 1995, origination fees charged by the lender.

    One borrower may have multiple loans on multiple properties.  In addition, a
borrower may obtain more than one loan to improve one property as long as the
total balance does not exceed the maximum permitted for the particular type of
loan involved.

    The following maximum dollar limits applied to Title I property improvement
loans when the FHA Loans were originated:

          Type of Property    Loan Limit
          ----------------    ----------

          Single Family       $25,000 per property (non-manufactured home)
                              $17,500 per property (manufactured home)

          Multifamily         $60,000 per property or an average of $12,000 per
                              unit

          Nonresidential      $25,000 per property

          Unsecured           $7,500 per property

     Title I loans bear fixed rates of interest and are fully amortizing with
equal installment payments (except for the first or last payments, which may not
exceed 150% of the regular installment payment).  Weekly, biweekly, semi-

                                      S-49
<PAGE>
 
monthly or monthly payments are permitted at the lender's option. Where the
borrower has an irregular flow of income, the loan may be repaid in quarterly or
semi-annual installments which correspond with the borrower's flow of income.
The loan maturity may not be less than six months nor greater than 20 years plus
32 days. The interest rate is established by each lender. For applications taken
after June 3, 1996, lenders may not charge any prepayment penalty.

     The lender is entitled to recover the following costs from the borrower:
(i) origination fee; (ii) for applications taken after June 3, 1996, discount
points (which may be payable by the borrower or dealer, if applicable); and
(iii) certain other specified fees and charges.  These costs set forth in item
(i) with respect to loans for which the credit application was received prior to
July 5, 1995, and the costs set forth in items (ii) and (iii) cannot be paid out
of the loan proceeds.

     An eligible borrower of a secured Title I loan must have at least a one-
half interest in one of the following: (i) fee simple title to the related
mortgaged property; (ii) a lease on the mortgaged property which runs at least
six months longer than the loan term; or (iii) a recorded land installment
contract on the mortgaged property.

     There are two different types of FHA Loans and Conventional Home
Improvement Loans:  (1) direct loans ("Direct Loans") and (2) dealer or dealer-
contractor loans ("Dealer Loans").  On a Direct Loan, the proceeds of the loan
are disbursed directly to the borrower, and there is no participation in the
loan application process by a dealer-contractor.  On a Dealer Loan, the dealer-
contractor participates in the financing in some fashion, such as presenting the
loan application to the lending institution, receiving the check or money order
(although made payable to the borrower) or accompanying the borrower to the
institution for the purpose of receiving payment.  On Dealer Loans, before it
may disburse funds, the lender must have in its possession a properly signed and
dated completion certificate, a copy of the dealer-contractor's contract or
sales agreement, and a borrower's authorization certificate, if the loan
proceeds are to be disbursed to the dealer-contractor.

     Title I Underwriting Requirements

     Specified loan underwriting requirements must be satisfied prior to loan
approval and disbursement of funds.  For secured Title I loans the lender must
verify that the borrower has at least a one-half interest in the mortgaged
property.  Additionally, the Originator requires that all owners in fee simple
have signed the lien instrument.  A copy of the cost estimated on a direct loan
or a contract signed by the contractor and borrower must be reviewed with the
nature of the work to be done specifically described in the contract.  In
addition, the loan file must contain the promissory note, lien instrument and
other documents required by regulation.

     The borrower's current paying habits and previous credit history must be
ascertained by obtaining a consumer credit report and by other credit
investigation.  Written verification of income and employment is also required.
This may include any one of the following:  (i) recent payroll stubs (year-to-
date plus current); (ii) verification of employment forms; (iii) signed tax
returns (self-employed); or (iv) financial statements (self-employed).

     Generally, any Title I loan originated after August 1994 in excess of
$7,500 must be secured by a recorded lien on the improved property which is
evidenced by a mortgage or deed of trust executed by the borrower and all other
owners in fee simple.  Prior to August 1994, any Title I loan in excess of
$5,000 was required to be secured by such a recorded lien.  In order to
facilitate the financing of small home improvement projects, the FHA does not
require loans of $7,500 or less, in the case of Title I loans originated after
August 1994, and $5,000 or less, in the case of Title I loans originated prior
to August 1994, to be secured by the property being improved.  Notwithstanding
the preceding sentence, such loans must be secured by a recorded lien on the
improved property, if, including such loan, the total amount of all Title I
loans obtained by the borrower exceeds $7,500, or $5,000, as the case may be.

     Effective November 18, 1991, for any secured Title I loan or combination of
loans on the same property with a total unpaid principal balance in excess of
$15,000, the borrower is required to have equity in the property being improved
in an amount at least equal to the loan amount, except for certain loans
originated by a governmental institution.

                                      S-50
<PAGE>
 
     Effective August 15, 1994, for secured Title I loans the requirement that
the borrower have equity in the property was eliminated for owner-occupied
properties if the structure being improved has been completed and occupied
at least six months prior to the date of the related application.  For non-owner
occupied properties, or owner occupied properties not meeting this requirement,
the borrower is required to have equity in the property being improved in an
amount at least equal to the loan amount and all existing liens on such
property.

     Effective June 3, 1996, for secured Title I loans, the requirement that the
borrower have equity in the property was eliminated for both owner-occupied and
non owner-occupied properties.

     Insurance Claims Procedures for Title I Loans

     The FHA has specific requirements for servicing of loans in default and
filing of claims.  The FHA requires the lender to make a reasonable effort to
contact the borrower and have a face-to-face meeting or conduct a telephone
interview prior to accelerating the maturity of the note and filing an insurance
claim.

     If the lender's efforts to have the loan brought current are unsuccessful,
the lender is required to notify credit reporting agencies, file a claim with
the FHA for insurance and assign the loan to the United States government,
unless the lender chooses to proceed against the mortgaged property under its
Title I security instrument.  If the lender chooses so to proceed, it may not,
without the approval of FHA, also file an insurance claim.  However, if the
lender holds an obligation secured by the mortgaged property which is senior to
the Title I loan, it may both proceed against the mortgaged property under the
senior lien instrument and file an insurance claim for the Title I loan.  When a
lender files an insurance claim with the FHA, the FHA reviews the claim, the
submitted loan documents relating to the loan and the lender's servicing
practices in order to verify compliance with FHA Title I requirements.  Based
upon this review, the loan is either accepted or rejected for insurance claims.

     Subject to the then remaining reserve amount, the amount of the insurance
claim payment, when made, is equal to 90% of the sum of the following amounts:

          (1)  The unpaid amount of the loan obligation (net of unpaid principal
and the uncollected interest earned to the date of default calculated according
to the actuarial method).

          (2)  The unpaid amount of interest on the unpaid amount of the loan
obligation from the date of default to the date of the claim's initial
submission for payment plus 15 calendar days, calculated at the rate of 7% per
annum.  (However, interest will not be paid for any period greater than nine
months from the date of default).

          (3)  The amount of uncollected court costs including fees paid for
issuing, serving and filing a summons.

          (4)  The amount of attorneys' fees on an hourly or other basis for
time actually expended and billed, not to exceed $500.

          (5)  The amount of expenses for recording the assignment of the loan
to the United States.

     Because Certificateholders do not hold a contract of insurance, the FHA
will not recognize the Certificateholders as owners of the FHA Loans, or any
portion thereof, who are entitled to submit Claims to the FHA.
Certificateholders will have no direct right to receive insurance payments from
the FHA.

Dealer/Contractor Origination

     The Originators originate loans through and purchase contracts from home
improvement contractors located in various states throughout the United States.
An Originator employs account executives who contact home improvement
contractors and explain the merits and features of the Originator's available
financing plans.  Account executives review contractor needs and discuss the
Originator's prevailing home improvement loan rates, terms, credit 

                                      S-51
<PAGE>
 
standards and policies. If a contractor desires to utilize the Originator's
financing programs, it must make application to the Originator for contractor
approval. The Originator has a contractor approval process pursuant to which the
financial condition, business experience, and qualifications of the contractor
are reviewed prior to its approval to sell or refer loans to the Originator. An
approved contractor's qualifications are reviewed annually in order to determine
whether such approval will be continued. The annual re-approval process includes
the updating of financial and business reference information. Contractors are
also monitored as to default levels, delinquency trends and customer complaint
resolution.

     All contractor loans are written on an Originator's approved documents and
are either executed by the borrower in the presence (i) of the Originator's
employees or designated agents or (ii) of the contractor.  All contracts which
are purchased are written on forms provided or approved by the Originator.  Each
loan or contract is individually approved in accordance with the Originator's
guidelines.  The contractor submits the customer credit application and
construction contract to the appropriate Originator office where the customer's
credit worthiness is determined.  Credit analysis includes a review of the
customer's previous credit experience, paying habits, length and likelihood of
continued employment, ability to repay the debt, and other factors.  The credit
analysis also includes the determination of the ratio of a customer's long-term
debt payments in relation to their gross monthly income.

     The Originators require that all secured home improvement loans and
contracts be secured by a recorded lien on the property to be improved.  Liens
may be in first, second or more junior position.  Certain other criteria for FHA
insured loans and contracts are described under the caption"--FHA Loans." If an
Originator determines that the application meets the Originator's underwriting
guidelines (and FHA regulations where applicable) and the credit is approved,
the Originator originates the loan or purchases the contract.  Unless a customer
has specifically requested staged funding of a contract, contracts are not
purchased until the customer has verified satisfactory completion of the home
improvement project.  Where staged funding is used, the Originator requests a
completion certificate from the customer within 60 days of funding.

     Property values are generally determined by a drive-by "as-is" appraisal
with the cost of the improvement added to the appraisal to reflect the "after
improvement" value of the property.  Title insurance is required on some FHA
Loans where the mortgage is in first position.

CONVENTIONAL HOME IMPROVEMENT LOANS - UNDERWRITING CRITERIA

     Conventional Home Improvement Loans are underwritten in the same manner as
the FHA Loans except that the loan proceeds may be used for projects that do not
qualify for FHA Loans, the amount of the loan may exceed applicable FHA limits
and the loan maturity may be for up to 25 years from origination.  However, the
maximum amount of an unsecured Conventional Home Improvement Loan is $12,500.

     Conventional Home Improvement Loans and contracts are not insured by the
FHA.

     The original principal amount of a Conventional Home Improvement Loan
generally may not exceed $50,000 for the Originator's secured no equity program,
a program in which no appraisal is required and no Loan-to-Value ratio is
calculated, and generally may not exceed $75,000 for the Originator's other
secured contractor programs.

THE MULTIFAMILY LENDING PROGRAM

     The Originators originate Multifamily Loans in several states.  Typically,
Multifamily Loans are 25 to 30 year term fully amortizing loans consisting of 5
or more units (some of which may be non-residential units) for non-purchase
money loans.  All of the Multifamily Loans are first liens with a minimum loan
amount of $50,000 and a maximum loan amount of $1,000,000, a maximum Loan-to-
Value ratio of approximately 65% and minimum debt service coverage of
approximately 1.25 to 1, although these guidelines can be varied with the
approval of senior management.  All Multifamily Loans are underwritten centrally
in Sacramento, California.  Appraisals, field inspections and environmental
inspections (performed by outside and certified inspectors) are required for
each Multifamily Loan.  Title insurance is obtained for all Multifamily Loans.
Substantially all of the mixed used properties 

                                      S-52
<PAGE>
 
securing Multifamily Loans will be properties with no less than approximately
90%, measured by square footage, number of units and projected rent, being
allocated to residential units.

90-DAY DEFERRED PROGRAM

     With respect to Home Equity and Home Improvement Loans, a borrower is
offered the opportunity to defer the first two scheduled payments of principal
and interest on his loan.  The interest that accrues for that period is
accounted for separately and is collected either from monthly payments made
which are in excess of the borrower's scheduled monthly payment or when the loan
is paid in full.  Payment of principal during the period is similarly deferred.
No principal reduction occurs until the first payment is made. The term to
maturity and other loan terms are no different than those for loan products
without this feature and are not changed due to the deferral.


                     THE REPRESENTATIVE AND THE ORIGINATORS

     The Money Store Inc. will act as the Servicer of the Loans.  Except for
certain representations and warranties relating to the Loans and certain other
matters, The Money Store Inc.'s obligations with respect to the Loans are
limited to its contractual servicing obligations.

     The Money Store Inc. is a New Jersey corporation and the parent company of
the Originators and their affiliates. The Money Store Inc. is headquartered in
Sacramento, California and Union, New Jersey.

     The Money Store Inc. is a financial services company engaged, through its
subsidiaries (including the Originators), in the business of originating,
purchasing, selling and servicing consumer and commercial loans of specified
types and offering related services. Loans originated by The Money Store Inc.
and its subsidiaries primarily consist of home equity loans, loans (the "SBA
Loans") guaranteed in part by the United States Small Business Administration
(the "SBA") and government guaranteed student loans ("Student Loans").  The
Money Store Inc. began providing financing for new and used vehicles (the "Auto
Loans") in early 1995.

     Since 1967, The Money Store Inc. and its subsidiaries have been active in
the development of the residential home equity lending industry in the United
States. Based upon industry sources, the Representative believes that during
1995 The Money Store Inc. and its subsidiaries were among the largest
originators, by principal amount, of home equity loans in the United States. In
1979, The Money Store Inc. and its subsidiaries began to originate SBA Loans
and, based upon statistics compiled by the SBA, the Representative believes that
during each of the last 14 SBA fiscal years it originated a greater principal
amount of SBA Loans than any other originator of such loans in the United
States.  In 1984, The Money Store Inc. and its subsidiaries entered into the
government guaranteed student loan origination market.

     For the year ended December 31, 1996 and the six months ended June 30,
1997, The Money Store Inc. and its subsidiaries originated or purchased
approximately $5.7 billion and $3.3 billion of loans, respectively.  Of those
loans, approximately 73% and 73%, respectively, by principal amount were home
equity loans, approximately 11% and 10%, respectively, by principal amount were
SBA Loans, approximately 8% and 7%, respectively, by principal amount were
Student Loans and approximately 8% and 10%, respectively, by principal amount
were Auto Loans.  The business strategy of The Money Store Inc. has been to
identify and pursue niche lending opportunities which management believes have
had widespread unsatisfied demand.

     At June 30, 1997, The Money Store Inc. and its subsidiaries operated out of
227 branch locations in 50 states, the District of Columbia and the Commonwealth
of Puerto Rico.

                                      S-53
<PAGE>
 
     The following table shows the originations and portfolio balances of The
Money Store Inc. and its subsidiaries for the periods indicated:

             ORIGINATIONS AND SERVICED LOAN PORTFOLIO BY LOAN TYPE
                             (Dollars in thousands)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                         Year Ended December 31,
                           --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                       1994                                                1995
                                       ----                                                 ----                                  
                                   Originations                                         Originations                              
                           ------------------------------                    -----------------------------------                   
                                             Number of     Serviced Loan                          Number of       Serviced Loan   
                                Amount         Loans         Portfolio               Amount         Loans           Portfolio     
                                ------         -----         ---------               ------         -----           ---------     
<S>                        <C>            <C>            <C>                    <C>            <C>              <C>
Home Equity Loans..........  $2,013,027        38,644        $3,725,918           $2,885,044        67,828         $5,751,677
% of Total.................    72.4%                            63.2%                75.5%                            66.7%
SBA Loans..................   420,416          1,143         1,605,645              440,728          1,461          1,907,050
% of Total.................    15.1%                            27.2%                11.5%                            22.1%
Student Loans..............   345,965         136,354          566,906              369,129         139,946          845,501
% of Total.................    12.5%                            9.6%                  9.7%                             9.8%
Auto Loans.................                                                         128,070          13,141          117,239
% of Total.................                                                           3.3%                            1.4%
                                                                                   -------                         -------
 
     Total................. $2,779,408        176,141       $5,898,469           $3,822,971         222,376       $8,621,467
                            ==========        =======       ==========           ==========         =======       ==========
</TABLE>


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                      Year Ended December 31, 1996          Six months Ended June 30, 1997
                                  -------------------------------------  -------------------------------------
 
                                      Originations                           Originations
                                -----------------------               ------------------------
                                                Number   Serviced Loan                 Number   Serviced Loan
                                    Amount     of Loans    Portfolio       Amount     of Loans    Portfolio
                                  -----------  --------  --------------  -----------  --------  --------------
<S>                               <C>          <C>       <C>             <C>          <C>       <C>
Home Equity Loans...............  $4,150,992    104,519    $ 8,230,776   $2,435,846     65,090    $ 9,538,069
% of Total......................     72.9%                     67.5%        73.0%                     67.9%
SBA Loans.......................    635,498      1,769      2,282,384      316,975        761      2,461,069
% of Total......................     11.2%                     18.7%         9.5%                     17.5%
Student Loans...................    458,459     168,837      1,203,739     240,218      39,955      1,342,955
% of Total......................     8.0%                      9.9%          7.2%                     9.6%
Auto Loans......................    448,105     45,124        475,533      343,919      34,270      710,886
% of Total......................     7.9%                      3.9%         10.3%                     5.0%
                                  ----------               -----------   ----------               -----------
 
                                  $5,693,054    320,249    $12,192,432   $3,336,958    140,076    $14,052,979
                                  ==========    =======    ===========   ==========    =======    ===========
</TABLE>
                                        

                                      S-54
<PAGE>
 
     Although the Originators have no maximum dollar amount for home equity
loans, the actual maximum amount that the Originators will lend is determined by
the applicant's ability to repay the loan, the value of the borrower's equity in
the real estate and the ratio of such equity to the home's appraised value.  For
home equity loans originated in 1994, 1995, 1996 and the first six months of
1997, the average loan size was approximately $52,000, $43,000, $40,000 and
$37,000, respectively.

     In July 1993, the Originators introduced a revised program of originating
home equity loans (the "Equity Advantage Loans") with Combined Loan-to-Value
Ratios exceeding 80%.  Equity Advantage Loans are secured by first or second
liens, generally possess lower debt-to-income ratios and bear a higher rate of
interest than home equity loans with lower Combined Loan-to-Value Ratios.

     The following table illustrates The Money Store Inc.'s delinquency and
charge-off experience with respect to home equity loans in its servicing
portfolio:

                 HOME EQUITY LOAN DELINQUENCIES AND CHARGE-OFFS
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                        AS OF AND FOR THE YEARS       AS OF AND FOR THE SIX MONTHS
                                                                           Ended December 31,              Ended June 30, 1997
                                                                        -----------------------       -----------------------------
 
                                                                       1994      1995      1996
                                                                       ----      ----      ---- 
<S>                                                                 <C>       <C>       <C>           <C> 
30-59 days past due.......................................             1.77%     1.76%     1.31%                  1.48%
60-89 days past due.......................................             0.42%     0.68%     0.81%                  0.82%
90+ days past due.........................................             1.86%     2.42%     3.83%                  4.19%
Loans charged-off, net....................................          $19,942   $24,205   $37,039                $26,033
Loans charged-off, net, as a percentage of                                                            
   the home equity serviced loan portfolio(1).............             0.54%     0.42%     0.45%                  0.55%
</TABLE>

_________________________

(1)  The percentage of Home Equity Loan charge-offs is calculated based upon the
dollar amount of charge-offs divided by the dollar amount of Home Equity Loans
contained in the Serviced Loan Portfolio.

     While the above delinquency and charge-off experience represents the
Servicer's recent experience, there can be no assurance that the future
delinquency and charge-off experience on the Home Equity Loans included in the
Trust will be similar. The Servicer can neither quantify the impact of any
recent property value declines on the Home Equity Loans nor predict whether, to
what extent or how long such declines may continue. In a period of such decline,
the rates of delinquencies, foreclosures and losses on the Home Equity Loans
could be higher than those heretofore experienced in the mortgage lending
industry in general. In addition, adverse economic conditions (which may or may
not affect real property values) may affect the timely payment by borrowers of
scheduled payments of principal and interest on the Home Equity Loans and,
accordingly, the actual rates of delinquencies, foreclosures and losses.  See
"Description of the Certificates--The Distribution Amounts" herein for a
discussion of the effect to Certificateholders of delinquencies in payments on
The Home Equity Loans.

     The Money Store Inc. does not separately report the delinquency and charge-
off experience of its Home Improvement Loans and Multifamily Loans and there can
be no assurance, and no representation is made, that the delinquency and charge-
off experience with respect to the Home Improvement Loans and the Multifamily
Loans will be similar to that reflected in the table above.

LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

     Because the nature of the business of The Money Store Inc. involves the
collection of numerous accounts, the validity of liens and compliance with state
and federal lending laws, The Money Store Inc. is subject to claims and legal
actions in the ordinary course of its business. While it is impossible to
estimate with certainty the ultimate legal and financial liability with respect
to such claims and actions, The Money Store Inc. believes that the 

                                      S-55
<PAGE>
 
aggregate amount of such liabilities will not result in monetary damage which
would have a material adverse effect on the financial condition of The Money
Store Inc.

RECENT DEVELOPMENTS

     On September 15, 1997 the Representative announced estimates that
annualized net charge-offs on the auto loan portfolio of TMS Auto Holdings, Inc.
("Auto Holdings"), one of its subsidiaries, will be as much as 7% for the
quarter ended September 30, 1997 (as compared to 3.82% for the quarter ending
June 30, 1997) and thirty day-and-over delinquencies at September 30, 1997 will
be as much as 10% (as compared to 4.25% at June 30, 1997).  The Representative
believes that deterioration in the performance of the auto loan portfolio is
largely attributable to inconsistent application of underwriting standards
resulting in a diminution in the credit quality of auto loan originations.  The
overall deterioration in the credit quality of such portfolio also put pressure
on servicing resources which further contributed to the decline in performance.
The Representative believes that the decentralization of processing through the
Auto Holdings' branch network together with the rapid growth of Auto Holdings'
auto loan originations led to less control over the credit quality of such loan
originations.  In response to these developments, the Representative is
implementing a number of changes affecting Auto Holdings including strengthening
the quality of the management team, centralizing more processing functions and
consolidating its branch structure.  The Representative anticipates a reduction
in auto loan originations while these changes are being implemented.  No auto
loan receivables are included in any Pool of Loans.



                                 THE LOAN POOLS

GENERAL

     Certain data with respect to the Initial Loans expected to be included in
the Trust is set forth below.  References in this Prospectus Supplement to the
characteristics of the Loans as of the Cut-Off Date are deemed to include the
characteristics, as of the date of their origination, of those Loans originated
after the Cut-Off Date and up to the Closing Date.  A Current Report on Form 8-K
containing a detailed description (the "Detailed Description") of the Initial
Loans will be available to purchasers of the Offered Certificates upon request
and will be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission within 15 days
after issuance of the Offered Certificates.  The Detailed Description will
specify the principal balance of the Loans of each Pool as of the Cut-Off Date,
the initial principal balance of each Class of the Certificates and will also
include the following information regarding such Loans of each Pool (in each
case, presented by (i) principal balance of the applicable Pool as of the Cut-
Off Date; (ii) percentage of the applicable Pool by principal balance and (iii)
number of Initial Loans for the applicable Pool): geographical distribution of
the Mortgaged Properties, Combined Loan-to-Value Ratios (except with respect to
the Initial Pool III Home Improvement Loans), interest rates, original principal
balances, number of months since origination, months remaining to stated
maturity, Gross Margins with respect to the Initial Pool II Home Equity Loans,
Lifetime Caps with respect to the Initial Pool II Home Equity Loans, Lifetime
Floors with respect to the Initial Pool II Home Equity Loans and the months to
next Change Date with respect to the Initial Pool II Home Equity Loans.

     The statistical information presented in this Prospectus Supplement
concerning the Loans is based on preliminary Pools expected to be delivered to
the Trustee and the Co-Trustee on the Closing Date.  The Representative expects
that loans (including the Subsequent Loans) that were not contained in the
preliminary Pools will be added to the final Pools.  While the statistical
distribution of the characteristics for the final Pools of Loans will vary
somewhat from the statistical distribution of such characteristics for the
preliminary Pools of Loans presented in this Prospectus Supplement, the
Representative does not believe that the characteristics of the final Pools will
differ materially.

     The Agreement will provide that Subsequent Loans may be purchased by the
Trust from the Originators from time to time on or before the close of business
on December 26, 1997 from funds on deposit in the Pre-

                                      S-56
<PAGE>
 
Funding Account. Any Subsequent Pool I or Pool II Loan so acquired will have
been originated and underwritten, or purchased and re-underwritten, by one of
the Originators, substantially in accordance with the Originator's underwriting
criteria described in the Prospectus under the caption "The Home Equity Lending
Program--Underwriting Criteria." Any Subsequent Pool III Loan so acquired will
have been originated and underwritten, or purchased and re-underwritten, by one
of the Originators, substantially in accordance with the Originator's
underwriting criteria described herein under the caption "Lending Programs--The
Home Improvement Lending Program--FHA Loans--Title I Underwriting Requirements,"
in the case of FHA Loans, or "Lending Programs--The Home Improvement Lending
Program--Conventional Home Improvement Loans--Underwriting Criteria," in the
case of Conventional Home Improvement Loans. Any Subsequent Pool IV Loan so
acquired will have been originated and underwritten, or purchased and re-
underwritten, by one of the Originators, substantially in accordance with the
Originator's underwriting criteria described herein under the caption "Lending
Program--The Multifamily Lending Program." The purchase price for each
Subsequent Loan will be no greater than its unpaid principal balance as of the
related Subsequent Cut-Off Date. The Agreement will provide that each Pool of
Loans, following the conveyance of any Subsequent Loans to the appropriate Pool,
must, in the aggregate, conform to certain specified characteristics. See "The
Agreement--Representations and Warranties" in the Prospectus.

HOME EQUITY LOANS

     The Home Equity Loans consist of mortgages, deeds of trust or other
security instruments (the "Home Equity Mortgages" or "Mortgages"), and the
related promissory notes (the "Home Equity Mortgage Notes" or "Notes") secured
by one- to four-family residences (and, in the case of Pool I, certain five and
six family residences), units in planned unit developments and units in
condominium developments (the "Home Equity Mortgaged Properties" or "Mortgaged
Properties").  The aggregate principal balance of the Initial Pool I Home Equity
Loans as of the Cut-Off Date will be not less than approximately $360,000,000,
and the aggregate principal balance of the Initial Pool II Home Equity Loans as
of the Cut-Off Date will be not less than approximately $475,000,000.  The Home
Equity Loans will be originated and underwritten, or purchased and re-
underwritten, by one of the Originators, substantially in accordance with the
underwriting criteria described in the Prospectus under the heading "The Home
Equity Lending Program--Underwriting Criteria." However, with respect to up to
0.50% of the Pool I Home Equity Loans, based upon their original principal
balances, the Originators may not have independently verified the income of the
related Obligors.  Certain of the Pool I and Pool II Home Equity Loans may
contain provisions requiring the related Mortgagor to pay a penalty in
connection with certain prepayments.  Unless otherwise noted, all percentages in
this general discussion are measured by the expected principal balance of the
Initial Home Equity Loans described herein on the Cut-Off Date, and the
statistics are given as of the Cut-Off Date.

     Each Pool II Home Equity Loan (including Subsequent Pool II Home Equity
Loans) will bear interest at an adjustable rate (each, a "Pool II Mortgage
Interest Rate") which will adjust on the date set forth in the related Mortgage
Note.  For each Pool II Home Equity Loan, the related Pool II Mortgage Interest
Rate will change initially after the period set forth in the related Mortgage
Note and periodically thereafter.  Each date on which a Pool II Mortgage
Interest Rate changes is referred to as the "Change Date" for the related Pool
II Home Equity Loan.  No more than approximately 35% of the Pool II Home Equity
Loans will have their first Change Date occurring approximately 24 months after
origination, no more than approximately 5% of the Pool II Home Equity Loans will
have their first Change Date occurring approximately 36 months after origination
and no more than approximately 40% of the Pool II Home Equity Loans will have
their first Change Date occurring approximately 48 months after origination.
The remainder of the Pool II Home Equity Loans will have their first Change Date
occurring no later than 12 months after origination.  The Pool II Mortgage
Interest Rate relating to at least 90% of the Pool II Home Equity Loans will
adjust on each applicable Change Date to equal the sum of (i) the applicable
London Interbank Offered Rate for U.S. dollar deposits (the "LIBOR Index") and
(ii) the number of basis points set forth in the related Mortgage Note (the
"Gross Margin"), subject to rounding and to the effects of the Periodic Rate
Cap, the applicable Lifetime Cap and the applicable Lifetime Floor.  The Pool II
Mortgage Interest Rate relating to the remainder of the Pool II Home Equity
Loans will adjust on each Change Date to equal the sum of (i) the applicable
One-Year Constant Maturity Treasury Index ("CMT" or the "Treasury Index") as
published by the Federal Reserve Board in the applicable Federal Reserve 

                                      S-57
<PAGE>
 
Board Statistical Release No. H.15, and (ii) the related Gross Margin, subject
to rounding and to the effects of the Periodic Rate Cap, the applicable Lifetime
Cap and the applicable Lifetime Floor.

     The Gross Margins for the Pool II Home Equity Loans will range from
approximately 2.75% to 12.0%.  The weighted average Gross Margin of the Pool II
Home Equity Loans will be no less than approximately 6.0%.  The "Periodic Rate
Cap" limits changes in the Pool II Mortgage Interest Rate for each Pool II Home
Equity Loan on each Change Date to the Periodic Rate Cap as set forth in the
related Mortgage Note. The Lifetime Caps of the Pool II Home Equity Loans will
range from approximately 6% to 21%. The weighted average Lifetime Cap of the
Pool II Home Equity Loans will be no less than approximately 16.0%. The Lifetime
Floors of the Pool II Home Equity Loans will range from approximately 0% to 15%.
The weighted average Lifetime Floor of the Pool II Home Equity Loans will be no
less than approximately 10%. The Pool II Home Equity Loans do not provide for
negative amortization.

     No less than approximately 60% of the Pool I Home Equity Loans and all of
the Pool II Home Equity Loans will be secured by first mortgage liens and the
remainder of the Pool I Home Equity Loans will be secured by second mortgage
liens.  Based on representations made by the Obligors, no less than
approximately 92% of the Home Equity Loans in Pool I and 92% of the Home Equity
Loans in Pool II will be secured by one-to four-family residences, no more than
approximately 6% and 6% of the Pool I and Pool II Home Equity Loans,
respectively, are secured by vacation homes, secondary residences, or investment
properties, no more than approximately 4% and 4% of the Pool I and Pool II Home
Equity Loans, respectively, will be secured by individual units in low-rise
condominiums, no more than approximately 10% and 12% of the Pool I and Pool II
Home Equity Loans, respectively, will be secured by two-, three- or four-family
houses, no more than approximately 2% of the Pool I Home Equity Loans will be
secured by five- or six-family houses (which may be mixed-use buildings) and no
more than approximately 1% of the Pool and Pool II Home Equity Loans,
respectively, will be secured by individual units of other types including high-
rise condominiums.  No Home Equity Loan will be secured by a mobile home or a
cooperative residence.

     No more than approximately 15%, 15%, 12%, 12%, 12%, 12%, 10% and 10% of the
Pool I Home Equity Loans are secured by Mortgaged Properties located in New
York, California, New Jersey, Pennsylvania, Illinois, Florida, Washington and
Ohio, respectively .  No more than approximately 15%, 12%, 12%, 12%, 12%, 10%
and 10% of the Pool II Home Equity Loans will be secured by Mortgaged Properties
located in Illinois, Michigan, California, Ohio, Washington, Pennsylvania  and
Massachusetts.  No more than approximately 5% of the Pool I Home Equity Loans
and 5% of the Pool II Home Equity Loans will be secured by Mortgaged Properties
located in any other state.

     Improvements on Mortgaged Properties located in California may be more
susceptible to certain types of special hazards not covered by insurance (such
as earthquakes) than properties located in other parts of the country.

     Based upon the original principal balances of the Home Equity Loans, no
more than approximately 45% and 45% of the Pool I and Pool II Home Equity Loans,
respectively, will have a Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio exceeding 80%.  No Pool I
or Pool II Home Equity Loan will have a Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio exceeding
100%.  The weighted average Combined Loan-to-Value Ratios of the Pool I and Pool
II Home Equity Loans will be no more than approximately 76% and 78%,
respectively.  The Home Equity Loans will not be insured or guaranteed by any
governmental entity.

     The Initial Pool I Home Equity Loans will bear interest at fixed rates
which, as of the Cut-Off Date, range from approximately 7.55% to 18% per annum.
The Initial Pool II Home Equity Loans will bear interest at adjustable rates
which, as of the Cut-Off Date, ranged from 5% to 17% per annum.  The weighted
average Pool I Mortgage Interest Rate on the Initial Pool I Home Equity Loans
will be no less than approximately 11.4% per annum.  The weighted average
current Pool II Mortgage Interest Rate on the Initial Pool II Home Equity Loans
will be no less than approximately 10% per annum.  The lowest principal balances
of any Initial Pool I and Initial Pool II Home Equity Loans will be
approximately $1,000 and $1,000, respectively, and the highest will be no less
than approximately $480,000 and $650,000, respectively.  As of the Cut-Off Date,
the average principal balances of the Initial Pool I and Initial Pool II Home
Equity Loans will be no less than approximately $35,000 and $80,000,

                                      S-58
<PAGE>
 
respectively.  Home Equity Loans not originated by an Originator or Home Equity
Loans having original principal balances less than or equal to $15,000 may not
be covered by title insurance policies.  The weighted average remaining terms to
stated maturity of the Initial Pool I and Initial Pool II Home Equity Loans will
be no more than approximately 257 months and 359 months, respectively.  The
weighted average terms to stated maturity of the Initial Pool I and Initial Pool
II Home Equity Loans at origination will be no more than approximately 258
months and 360 months, respectively.  No more than approximately 10% of the Pool
I Home Equity Loans will be Balloon Loans.  No Pool II Home Equity Loan will be
a Balloon Loan.

HOME IMPROVEMENT LOANS

     The Home Improvement Loans consist of fixed-rate, residential home
improvement mortgages, deeds of trust or other security instruments (the "Home
Improvement Mortgages" or "Mortgages"), and the related promissory notes, retail
installment contracts or obligations, or sales agreements (the "Home Improvement
Mortgage Notes" or "Notes") secured, except as set forth below, by one- to four-
family residences, units in planned unit developments and units in condominium
developments (the "Home Improvement Mortgaged Properties" or "Mortgaged
Properties").  Between approximately 10% and 20% of the Initial Home Improvement
Loans will be FHA Loans and the remainder will be Conventional Home Improvement
Loans.  The Initial Home Improvement Loans will have been originated and
underwritten, or purchased and re-underwritten, by one of the Originators,
substantially in accordance with the Originators' underwriting criteria
described herein under the caption "Lending Programs--The Home Improvement
Lending Program--Title I Underwriting Requirements," in the case of FHA Loans,
or "Lending Programs--The Home Improvement Lending Programs--Conventional Home
Improvement Loans--Underwriting Criteria," in the case of Conventional Home
Improvement Loans. Certain of the Conventional Home Improvement Loans may
contain provisions requiring the related Mortgagor to pay a penalty in
connection with certain prepayments.   Unless otherwise noted, all percentages
in this general discussion are measured by the expected principal balance of the
Initial Home Improvement Loans described herein on the Cut-Off Date and the
statistics are given as of the Cut-Off Date.

     No less than approximately 5% of the Home Improvement Loans will be secured
by first mortgage liens, no less than approximately 75% of the Home Improvement
Loans will be secured by second mortgage liens and the remainder of the Home
Improvement Loans will be secured by more junior mortgage liens.  Based on
representations made by the Obligors, no less than approximately 95% of the Home
Improvement Loans will be secured by one-to four-family residences, no more than
approximately 2% of the Home Improvement Loans are secured by vacation homes,
secondary residences, or investment properties, no more than approximately 2% of
the Home Improvement Loans will be secured by individual units in low-rise
condominiums, no more than approximately 2% of the Home Improvement Loans will
be secured by two-, three- or four-family houses, no more than approximately 3%
of the Home Improvement Loans will be secured by Multifamily Mortgaged
Properties and no more than approximately 2% of the Home Improvement Loans will
be secured by individual units of other types including high-rise condominiums
and mixed-use buildings.  No more than approximately 2% of the Home Improvement
Loans will be secured by a manufactured home or a cooperative residence.

     No more than approximately 40%, 15%, 12%, 12%, 10%, 10%, 10% and 7% of the
Home Improvement Loans are secured by Mortgaged Properties located in
California, Illinois, Texas, Florida, Nevada, Arizona, New York and Georgia,
respectively.   No more than approximately 5% of the Home Improvement Loans will
be secured by Mortgaged Properties located in any other state.

     The FHA Loans are insured by the FHA to the extent described herein.  The
Conventional Home Improvement Loans are not insured or guaranteed by any
governmental entity.

     The Initial Home Improvement Loans will bear interest at fixed rates which
range from approximately 7.95% to 17% per annum.  The weighted average Mortgage
Interest Rate on the Initial Home Improvement Loans will be no less than
approximately 12.75% per annum.  The lowest principal balance of any Initial
Home Improvement Loans will be approximately $1,000 and the highest will be
approximately $100,000.  The average principal balance of the Initial Home
Improvement Loans will be no less than approximately $15,000.  As of the 

                                      S-59
<PAGE>
 
Cut-Off Date, the weighted average remaining terms to stated maturity of the
Initial Home Improvement Loans will be no more than be approximately 221 months.
The weighted average term to stated maturity of the Initial Home Improvement
Loans at origination will be no more than approximately 222 months. None of the
Home Improvement Loans will be Balloon Loans.

MULTIFAMILY LOANS

     The Multifamily Loans consist of home improvement mortgages, deeds of trust
or other security instruments (the "Multifamily Mortgages" or "Mortgages"), and
the related promissory notes (the "Multifamily Mortgage Notes" or "Notes")
secured by five or more unit residential or mixed-use residential and commercial
properties (the "Multifamily Mortgaged Properties" or "Mortgaged Properties").
The Multifamily Loans will have been originated and underwritten, or purchased
and re-underwritten, by one of the Originators, substantially in accordance with
the underwriting criteria described herein under the heading "Lending Programs--
The Multifamily Lending Program."

     No more than approximately 40%, 35%, 30% and 20% of the Multifamily Loans
will be secured by Mortgaged Properties located in Texas, California, New York
and Georgia, respectively.  No more than approximately 10% of the Initial
Multifamily Loans will be secured by Mortgaged Properties located in any other
state.  All the Multifamily Loans will be secured by first mortgage liens.

     Based upon the original principal balances of the Multifamily Loans, none
of the Multifamily Loans will have a Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio exceeding
approximately 70%.  The weighted average Combined Loan-to-Value Ratios of the
Multifamily Loans will be approximately 65%.  The Multifamily Loans will not be
insured or guaranteed by any governmental entity.

     The Initial Multifamily Loans will bear interest rates which range from
approximately 9% to 15% per annum.  The weighted average Mortgage Interest Rate
on the Initial Multifamily Loans will be no less than approximately 11.5% per
annum.  The lowest principal balance of any Initial Multifamily Loans will be
approximately $25,000 and the highest will be approximately $1,000,000.  As of
the Cut-Off Date, the average principal balance of the Initial Multifamily Loans
will be no less than approximately $190,000.  All Initial Multifamily Loans will
be covered by title insurance policies.  As of the Cut-Off Date, the weighted
average remaining term to stated maturity of the Initial Multifamily Loans will
be no more than approximately 345 months.  The weighted average term to stated
maturity of the Initial Multifamily Loans at origination will be no more than
approximately 346 months.

PAYMENTS ON THE LOANS

     The Initial Loans, other than Balloon Loans, will generally provide for a
schedule of payments which will be, if timely paid, sufficient to amortize fully
the principal balance of the related Initial Loan on or before its maturity
date.  Interest with respect to the Initial Loans will accrue on either an
actuarial interest method or a simple interest method.

     The actuarial interest method provides that interest is charged and
payments are due as of a scheduled day of each month which is fixed at the time
of origination.  Scheduled monthly payments on such Loans received either
earlier or later (other than delinquent) than the scheduled due dates thereof
will not affect the amortization schedule or the relative application of such
payments to principal and interest.  With respect to the Pool II Home Equity
Loans, on each Change Date, the Mortgagor's monthly payment will be adjusted
prospectively to fully amortize such Pool II Home Equity Loans at the then
current Pool II Mortgage Interest Rate over its stated remaining term to
maturity.

     The simple interest method provides for the amortization of the amount of
each loan over a series of equal monthly payments. However, unlike the monthly
payment under the actuarial interest method, each monthly payment consists of an
installment of interest which is calculated on the basis of the outstanding
principal balance at 

                                      S-60
<PAGE>
 
the stated interest rate and based upon the period elapsed since the preceding
payment of principal was made, using the method permitted by applicable law. As
payments are received under the loan, the amount received is applied first to
interest accrued to the date of payment and the balance, if any, is applied to
reduce the unpaid principal balance; provided, however, that with respect to FHA
Loans secured by Mortgaged Properties located in states where the Servicer
collects the FHA Insurance Premium directly from the related Mortgagor, payments
are applied first to the FHA Insurance Premium. Accordingly, if a borrower pays
a fixed monthly installment on such a loan before its scheduled due date, the
portion of the payment allocable to interest for the period since the preceding
payment was made will be less than it would have been had the payment been made
as scheduled, and the portion of the payment applied to reduce the unpaid
principal balance will be correspondingly greater. Conversely, if a borrower
pays a fixed monthly installment on the loan after its scheduled due date, the
portion of the payment allocable to interest for the period since the preceding
payment was made will be greater than it would be had the payment been made as
scheduled, and the portion of the payment applied to reduce the unpaid principal
balance will be correspondingly reduced. In addition, a late charge may be
imposed with respect to the past due amount.

     The amount of interest payable to the Certificateholders on each Remittance
Date will not be affected by interest accruing on the Loans based on the simple
interest method.  On each Remittance Date, the Certificateholders are entitled
to receive 30 days' interest (or, with respect to the Adjustable Rate
Certificates and Auction Rate Certificates, the actual number of days from the
last Remittance Date (or, in the case of the first Remittance Date, from
September 15, 1997 with respect to the Adjustable Rate Certificates and from the
Closing Date with respect to the Auction Rate Certificates) to but not including
the upcoming Remittance Date) at the applicable Pass-Through Rate on the
outstanding principal balances of the applicable Class of Certificates
immediately prior to such Remittance Date.  The Servicer is required to remit to
the Trustee the excess, if any, of the amount of interest the Certificateholders
are entitled to receive on each Remittance Date over the interest collected on
the Loans during the related Due Period and available to pay interest on the
Certificates.  See "The Agreement--Monthly Advances and Compensating Interest"
herein.

     Similarly, the compensation payable to the Servicer will not be affected by
interest accruing on the Loans based on the simple interest method.  The
Servicer is entitled to receive a fee based on the principal balance of the
Loans, not upon the portion of a monthly payment allocable to interest.  See
"The Agreement--Servicing and Other Compensation and Payment of Expenses"
herein.

     If a payment is received on a Loan before its due date, more of such
payment will be used on the related Remittance Date to pay principal on the
Certificates than if such payment was received on such due date.  Conversely, if
a payment is received on a Loan after its scheduled due date, less of such
payment will be used on the related Remittance Date to pay principal on the
Certificates than if such payment was received on its due date.  This will not
affect the total amount of principal to be received by the Certificateholders
over the life of the transaction, but it may affect the weighted average lives
of the Certificates.


                 MATURITY, PREPAYMENT AND YIELD CONSIDERATIONS

     The effective yield on the Certificates (other than the Adjustable Rate
Certificates and Auction Rate Certificates) will be slightly lower than the
yield otherwise produced by the applicable Pass-Through Rate because, while
interest will accrue on such Certificates from the first day of each month, the
distribution of such interest will not be made until the 15th day (or if such
15th day is not a business day, the next succeeding business day) of the month
following the month of accrual.  For the Adjustable Rate Certificates and
Auction Rate Certificates, interest will accrue generally from the 15th day of
each month until the 14th day of the next month.

     In general, because the Pool I, Pool III and Pool IV Loans will bear fixed
interest rates, when the level of prevailing interest rates for similar loans
significantly declines, the rate of prepayment of such Loans is likely to
increase, although the prepayment rate is influenced by a number of other
factors, including general economic conditions and homeowner mobility.
Similarly, when the level of interest rates for similar loans significantly
rises, 

                                      S-61
<PAGE>
 
the rate of prepayment of such Loans may decrease. No prediction can be made as
to the prepayment rate that the Loans will actually experience.

     All of the Pool II Loans bear adjustable rates.  However, the Pool II Loans
still may be subject to increased principal prepayments in a low interest rate
environment.  For example, if prevailing interest rates were to fall, Mortgagors
with Pool II Loans may be inclined to refinance their Pool II Loans with a fixed
rate loan to "lock in" a lower interest rate.  The existence of the Periodic
Rate Cap, Lifetime Cap and Lifetime Floor also may affect the likelihood of
prepayments resulting from refinancings. In addition, the delinquency and loss
experience on the Pool II Loans may differ from that on the Loans in the other
Pools because the amount of the monthly payments on the Pool II Loans are
subject to adjustment on each Change Date. If such different experience were to
occur, the prepayment experience on the Adjustable Rate Certificates and the
Auction Rate Certificates may differ from that on the other Classes of
Certificates.

     Generally, junior priority mortgage loans have smaller average principal
balances than first priority mortgage loans and are not viewed by borrowers as
permanent financing.  Accordingly, the Loans included in the Trust that are
secured by junior liens may experience a higher rate of prepayment than
traditional first priority mortgage loans. In addition, any future limitations
on the right of borrowers to deduct interest payments on mortgage loans for
Federal income tax purposes may result in a higher rate of prepayment of such
junior Loans.  The obligation of the Servicer to enforce the "due-on-sale"
provisions of the Loans may also increase prepayments. The prepayment experience
of the Pools may be affected by a wide variety of factors, including general and
local economic conditions, mortgage market interest rates, the availability of
alternative financing and homeowner mobility. The Money Store Inc. is unaware of
any reliable studies that would project the prepayment risks associated with the
Loans based upon current interest rates and economic conditions and the
historical prepayment experience of The Money Store Inc.'s portfolios of home
equity  and home improvement loans.

     Unscheduled payments, delinquencies, repurchases of defective Loans,
defaults on the Loans and distributions from the Pre-Funding Account will affect
the amount of funds available to make distributions on each Remittance Date. In
addition, the Servicer may, at its option, and in the absence of the exercise
thereof by the Servicer, MBIA may, at its option, on any Remittance Date on and
after the Optional Servicer Termination Date, purchase from the Trust all of the
Loans and any related REO Properties at the Termination Prices for all Pools.
MBIA may, at its option, similarly purchase all the Loans and REO Properties on
any Remittance Date, on or after the Cross-Over Date, on which the aggregate
principal balances as of the Cut-Off Date of the Pool I and Pool IV Loans that
have been liquidated (each, a "Liquidated Loan") is equal to or exceeds 25% of
the sum of (i) the Original Pool I and Pool IV Principal Balance and (ii) the
original Pre-Funded Amount relating to Pool I and Pool IV.  The Cross-Over Date
is defined in the Agreement as the date on which the Pool Available Maximum
Subordination Amounts for all of the Pools are reduced to zero.  See "The MBIA
Policies and MBIA" herein.

     If prepayments of principal are received on the Loans at a rate greater
than that assumed by an investor (including distributions from the Pre-Funding
Account and receipt of amounts from the Loans in other Pools as a result of the
cross support features described herein), the yield will be increased on Offered
Certificates purchased by such investor at a price less than par (i.e., the
principal balance of a Offered Certificate at the time of its purchase).
Similarly, if prepayments of principal are received on the Loans at a rate
greater than that assumed by an investor, the yield will be decreased on Offered
Certificates purchased at a price greater than par.  The effect on an investor's
yield of principal prepayments on the Loans occurring at a rate that is faster
(or slower) than the rate anticipated by the investor in the period immediately
following the issuance of the applicable Class of Offered Certificates may not
be offset by a subsequent like reduction (or increase) in the rate of principal
payments.  The weighted average lives of the Offered Certificates will also be
affected by the amount and timing of delinquencies and defaults on the Loans in
the related Pool and the liquidations of defaulted Loans.  Delinquencies and
defaults will generally slow the rate of payment of principal to the Offered
Certificateholders since (i) neither the Servicer nor MBIA in the case of Pool I
and Pool IV is obligated to advance for delinquent payments of principal and
(ii) Insured Payments with respect to principal generally are not required until
the occurrence of a Subordination Deficit (as defined herein under "Description
of the Certificates--Cross-Support Provisions and Spread Amount").  However,
this effect will be offset to the extent that lump sum recoveries on defaulted
Loans and foreclosed 

                                      S-62
<PAGE>
 
Mortgaged Properties result in principal payments on the Loans faster than
otherwise scheduled. Additionally, the holders of the Pool III Certificates will
be entitled to any FHA Payments received by the Claims Administrator.

     As described herein, certain Classes of Certificates in a Pool will be
entitled to receive payments of principal prior to other Classes of Certificates
in the related Pool.  As a result, the Classes of Certificates in a Pool
receiving payments of principal first will immediately be affected by the
prepayment rate on the Loans in the related Pool.  However, the timing of
commencement of principal distributions and the weighted average lives of each
Class of Offered Certificates will be affected by the prepayment rate
experienced both before and after the commencement of principal distributions on
any such Class.

     If during the Funding Period the entire original Pre-Funded Amount has not
been used to purchase Subsequent Loans, on the Special Remittance Date, certain
Classes of Offered Certificates will be prepaid in part from and to the extent
of such remaining amounts.  Although no assurances can be given, it is
anticipated by the Representative that the principal amount of Subsequent Loans
sold to the Trust will require the application of substantially all the amounts
on deposit in the Pre-Funding Account, and that there should be no material
principal prepaid on the Offered Certificates from such amounts.

     The Loans are either (i) "simple interest" or "date-of-payment loans" or
(ii) "actuarial method" loans.  If a payment is received on a Loan which is a
"simple interest" loan later than scheduled, a smaller portion of such payment
will be applied to principal and a greater portion will be applied to interest
than would have been the case had the payment been received on the scheduled due
date, resulting in such Loan having a longer weighted average life than would
have been the case had the payment been made as scheduled. Conversely, if a
payment on a Loan is received earlier than scheduled, more of such payment will
be applied to principal and less to interest than would have been the case had
the payment been received on its scheduled due date, resulting in such Loan
having a shorter weighted average life than would have been the case had the
payment been made as scheduled.

     In the event that less than 30 days' interest is collected on a Loan during
a Due Period, whether due to prepayment in full or a Curtailment, the Servicer
is obligated to pay Compensating Interest with respect thereto, but only to the
extent of the aggregate Servicing Fee and Contingency Fee for the related
Remittance Date.  To the extent such shortfalls exceed the amount of
Compensating Interest that the Servicer is obligated to pay, and are not
otherwise covered by Excess Spread (as defined herein under "Description of the
Certificates--Cross-Support Provisions and Spread Amount") or Insured Payments,
the yield on the Certificates of the related Pool will be adversely affected.
Any shortfall in collections of interest resulting from the early receipt of a
scheduled payment will not be covered by Compensating Interest, but will be
covered by Monthly Advances.

     The Pass-Through Rate on the Adjustable Rate Certificates will be adjusted
by reference to changes in the level of one-month LIBOR, subject to the effects
of the applicable Net Funds Cap.  Although the Pool II Mortgage Interest Rates
also are subject to adjustment, the Pool II Mortgage Interest Rates with respect
to most of the Pool II Loans adjust less frequently than the Pass-Through Rate
on the Adjustable Rate Certificates and Auction Rate Certificates and adjust by
reference to either the London Interbank Offered Rate, which will be calculated
differently for the Pool II Loans and the Adjustable Rate Certificates, or the
Treasury Index, which will not necessarily correspond to changes in one-month
LIBOR.  Changes in one-month LIBOR or the Pass-Through Rates determined pursuant
to the Auction Procedures.  Changes in one-month LIBOR or changes in the LIBOR
Index or the Treasury Index may not correlate to each other or to changes in
prevailing interest rates.  It is possible that an increased level of one-month
LIBOR could occur simultaneously with a lower level of prevailing interest
rates, which would be expected to result in faster prepayments, thereby reducing
the weighted average life of the Adjustable Rate Certificates and the Auction
Rate Certificates.

     Certain of the Pool II Loans were originated with initial Pool II Mortgage
Interest Rates that were based on competitive conditions and did not equal the
sum of the applicable Index and the related Gross Margin.  As a result, the Pool
II Mortgage Interest Rates on such Pool II Loans are more likely to adjust on
their first, and possibly subsequent, Change Dates, subject to the effects of
the Periodic Rate Cap and the Lifetime Cap.  Because the Pass-Through Rate on
the Adjustable Rate Certificates and the Auction Rate Certificates is limited by
the Net Funds Cap, 

                                      S-63
<PAGE>
 
on each Remittance Date, limits on changes in the Pool II Mortgage Interest
Rates of the Pool II Loans may limit changes in the Pass-Through Rate on the
Adjustable Rate Certificates and the Auction Rate Certificates.

     The Net Funds Cap for the related Pool on a Remittance Date will depend, in
part, on the weighted average of the then-current Pool II Mortgage Interest
Rates.  If the Pool II Loans bearing higher Mortgage Interest Rates were to
prepay, the weighted average Mortgage Interest Rate of the Pool II Mortgage
Loans, and consequently the Net Funds Cap, would be lower than otherwise would
be the case.

     The projected last Remittance Dates for each Class of Offered Certificates
is as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                 Projected Last                          Projected Last  
Class            Remittance Date        Class            Remittance Date 
- -----            ---------------        -----            --------------- 
                                                
<S>        <C>                          <C>        <C>
AF-1            October 15, 2003        BV              January 15, 2029
AF-2              May 15, 2008          AH-1             March 15, 2003
AF-3             August 15, 2012        AH-2             March 15, 2007
AF-4             August 15, 2017        AH-3            January 15, 2010
AF-5              June 15, 2021         AH-4             March 15, 2012
AF-6            February 15, 2025       AH-5            February 15, 2015
AF-7            January 15, 2039        AH-6             August 15, 2015
AF-8            January 15, 2039        MH-1           September 15, 2018
AV                May 15, 2026          MH-2            February 15, 2024
MV-1            February 15, 2027       BH              February 15, 2024
MV-2            January 15, 2029        AMF             January 15, 2029
</TABLE>


     The projected last Remittance Date for the Class AF-7, Class AF-8, Class
MV-2, Class BV, Class MH-2, Class BH and Class AMF Certificates is the
Remittance Date following the latest date upon which a Loan in the related Pool
matures, including Subsequent Loans, plus 12 months.  The projected last
Remittance Date for each other Class of Offered Certificates is the date on
which the Class Principal Balance of the respective Class would be reduced to
zero, assuming that no prepayments are received on the Loans, that payment of
principal of and interest on each of the Loans is timely received, each Class of
Offered Certificates receives payments of principal as described herein and the
Spread Amount is equal to zero.  The weighted average lives of the Offered
Certificates are likely to be shorter than would be the case if payments
actually made on the Loans conformed to the foregoing assumptions, and the final
Remittance Dates with respect to each Class of Offered Certificates could occur
significantly earlier than the last projected Remittance Dates because (i)
Excess Spread will be used to make accelerated payments of principal (i.e.,
Subordination Increase Amounts) and (ii) the Servicer or MBIA may purchase all
of the Loans under the limited circumstances described herein.  In addition,
prepayments are likely to occur on the Loans, which also would shorten the
weighted average life of the Offered Certificates.

     "Weighted average life" refers to the average amount of time that will
elapse from the date of issuance of a security until each dollar of principal of
such security will be repaid to the investor. The weighted average lives of the
Offered Certificates will be influenced by the priorities established in the
Agreement, and by the rate at which principal payments on the Loans in the
related Pool are paid, which may be in the form of scheduled amortization or
prepayments (for this purpose, the term "prepayment" includes Principal
Prepayments, Curtailments, FHA 

                                      S-64
<PAGE>
 
Payments and liquidations due to default). Prepayments on mortgage loans are
commonly measured relative to a prepayment standard or model.

     The following tables have been prepared assuming that each of the Pools are
comprised of loan groups having the following characteristics:

                                      S-65
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
POOL I
      ASSUMED          INITIAL     ORIGINAL       REMAINING     REMAINING
    CUT-OFF DATE      MORTGAGE      TERM OF        TERM OF       TERM TO                           ASSUMED 
     PRINCIPAL        INTEREST   AMORTIZATION   AMORTIZATION    MATURITY    AMORTIZATION          DELIVERY OF 
      BALANCE           RATE      (IN MONTHS)    (IN MONTHS)   (IN MONTHS)     METHOD               LOANS
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                   <C>        <C>            <C>            <C>          <C>                  <C>
$13,732,488.06          12.211%       109            107           107         Level                Closing
$43,750,402.41          12.071%       179            177           177         Level                Closing
$11,696,094.26          11.934%       240            237           237         Level                Closing
$6,001,999.98           12.294%       300            298           298         Level                Closing
$38,131,401.39          11.329%       360            357           357         Level                Closing
$3,100,798.75           11.739%       107            105           105         Level                Closing
$12,131,043.19          11.570%       180            178           178         Level                Closing
$4,359,724.25           11.756%       239            237           237         Level                Closing
$1,089,873.74           11.698%       296            294           294         Level                Closing
$14,491,557.97          10.899%       360            358           358         Level                Closing
$17,359,897.38          12.315%       109            107           107         Level                Closing
$50,088,617.58          11.973%       179            177           177         Level                Closing
$13,451,330.58          11.698%       240            238           238         Level                Closing
$13,390,590.39          12.180%       300            298           298         Level                Closing
$49,497,202.99          10.915%       360            358           358         Level                Closing
$2,957,489.26           10.738%       480            478           478         Level                Closing
$4,769,487.83           12.793%       360            356           176         Balloon              Closing
$3,149,210.96           12.211%       109            109           109         Level                Nov. 97
$10,271,138.01          12.071%       179            179           179         Level                Nov. 97
$2,513,715.64           11.934%       240            240           240         Level                Nov. 97
$742,406.44             12.294%       300            300           300         Level                Nov. 97
$9,746,859.21           11.329%       360            360           360         Level                Nov. 97
$8,248,517.11           11.739%       107            105           105         Level                Nov. 97
$25,052,216.39          11.570%       180            178           178         Level                Nov. 97
$7,322,000.72           11.756%       239            237           237         Level                Nov. 97
$6,085,081.60           11.698%       296            294           294         Level                Nov. 97
$25,279,024.64          10.899%       360            358           358         Level                Nov. 97
$1,589,829.28           12.793%       360            360           180         Balloon              Nov. 97
</TABLE>

                                      S-66
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
POOL II
ASSUMED                 INITIAL     ORIGINAL       REMAINING     REMAINING    GROSS   PERIODIC CAP   LIFETIME   LIFETIME   
CUT-OFF DATE           MORTGAGE      TERM OF        TERM OF       TERM TO    MARGIN                     CAP       FLOOR    
PRINCIPAL              INTEREST   AMORTIZATION   AMORTIZATION    MATURITY                                                  
BALANCE                  RATE      (IN MONTHS)    (IN MONTHS)   (IN MONTHS)                                                
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                    <C>        <C>            <C>            <C>          <C>      <C>            <C>        <C>        
6-MONTH LIBOR                                                                                                              
- -------------                                                                                                              
$31,900,747.05            8.938%           360            358          358    5.299%         1.199%    14.442%     8.438%  
$63,737,729.67           10.698%           360            358          358    6.252%       1.000%*     16.198%    10.198%  
$15,307,821.73            8.792%           360            358          358    5.238%         1.317%    14.292%     8.292%  
$33,622,444.21           10.637%           360            358          358    6.268%       1.000%*     16.137%    10.137%  
$18,309,704.85           10.023%           356            352          352    6.420%         1.043%    15.790%     9.499%  
$17,701,628.96           10.098%           358            355          355    6.461%         1.029%    15.830%     9.572%  
$35,661,509.65            9.638%           359            357          357    5.733%         1.026%    15.164%     9.119%  
$15,574,794.02            9.698%           356            354          354    5.852%         1.140%    15.227%     9.136%  
$7,530,357.60             9.003%           360            358          358    5.542%         1.292%    14.549%     8.471%  
$20,251,483.30           10.638%           358            353          353    6.486%       1.105%*     16.633%    10.138%  
$31,588,288.12           10.752%           360            357          357    6.410%       1.122%*     16.729%    10.221%  
$49,577,272.08           10.552%           360            358          358    6.219%       1.061%*     16.258%    10.052%  
$34,549,302.42           10.178%           360            359          359    5.734%       1.042%*     15.840%     9.678%  
$13,245,061.74           10.738%           360            357          357    6.152%       1.009%*     16.309%    10.238%  
$37,301,130.79           10.712%           360            358          358    6.284%       1.000%*     16.213%    10.212%  
$16,636,996.26           10.650%           360            359          359    6.154%       1.000%*     16.150%    10.150%  
$12,719,092.22            8.792%           360            358          358    5.238%         1.317%    14.292%     8.292%  
$26,107,259.59           10.637%           360            358          358    6.268%       1.000%*     16.137%    10.137%  
$24,669,882.79            9.003%           360            360          360    5.542%         1.292%    14.549%     8.471%  
$36,034,107.77           10.178%           360            360          360    5.734%       1.042%*     15.840%     9.678%  
$3,485,542.56            10.738%           360            360          360    6.152%       1.009%*     16.309%    10.238%  
$13,430,502.57           10.650%           360            360          360    6.154%       1.000%*     16.150%    10.150%  
                                                                                                                           
1-YEAR LIBOR                                                                                                               
- ---------------------                                                                                                      
$3,363,124.52             9.655%           360            358          358    5.694%         2.000%    15.237%     9.155%  
                                                                                                                           
1-YEAR CMT                                                                                                                 
- ---------------------                                                                                                      
$6,727,760.63             9.067%           360            353          353    5.447%         2.000%    14.579%     8.567%  
$22,412,842.40            9.701%           359            355          355    6.143%         2.000%    15.213%     9.212%  
$8,553,612.50             9.701%           360            360          360    6.143%         2.000%    15.213%     9.212%  
</TABLE>


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
POOL II
ASSUMED                MONTHS TO      RESET       AMORTIZATION       ASSUMED
CUT-OFF DATE           RESET          FREQUENCY   METHOD             DELIVERY OF 
PRINCIPAL              DATE                                          LOANS 
BALANCE                  
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                    <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>
6-MONTH LIBOR        
- -------------
$31,900,747.05             4             6           Level            Closing
$63,737,729.67            46             6           Level            Closing
$15,307,821.73             4             6           Level            Closing
$33,622,444.21            46             6           Level            Closing
$18,309,704.85             2             6           Level            Closing
$17,701,628.96             3             6           Level            Closing
$35,661,509.65             4             6           Level            Closing
$15,574,794.02             5             6           Level            Closing
$7,530,357.60              6             6           Level            Closing
$20,251,483.30            19             6           Level            Closing
$31,588,288.12            21             6           Level            Closing
$49,577,272.08            22             6           Level            Closing
$34,549,302.42            23             6           Level            Closing
$13,245,061.74            33             6           Level            Closing
$37,301,130.79            46             6           Level            Closing
$16,636,996.26            47             6           Level            Closing
$12,719,092.22             4             6           Level            Nov. 97
$26,107,259.59            46             6           Level            Nov. 97
$24,669,882.79             6             6           Level            Nov. 97
$36,034,107.77            24             6           Level            Nov. 97
$3,485,542.56             36             6           Level            Nov. 97
$13,430,502.57            48             6           Level            Nov. 97
                                                                     
1-YEAR LIBOR                                                         
- ---------------------                                                
$3,363,124.52             10            12           Level            Closing
                                                                     
1-YEAR CMT                                                           
- ---------------------                                                
$6,727,760.63              5            12           Level            Closing
$22,412,842.40             8            12           Level            Closing
$8,553,612.50             12            12           Level            Nov. 97
*For the first reset date, the periodic cap is 3.00%.
</TABLE>

                                      S-67
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
POOL III
      ASSUMED         INITIAL     ORIGINAL       REMAINING     REMAINING
   CUT-OFF DATE      MORTGAGE      TERM OF        TERM OF       TERM TO                       ASSUMED
     PRINCIPAL       INTEREST   AMORTIZATION   AMORTIZATION    MATURITY    AMORTIZATION  DELIVERY OF LOANS
      BALANCE          RATE      (IN MONTHS)    (IN MONTHS)   (IN MONTHS)     METHOD
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
<S>                  <C>        <C>            <C>            <C>          <C>           <C>
$26,247,810.91         12.933%       105            104          104           Level         Closing
$38,411,922.12         12.750%       178            177          177           Level         Closing
$53,279,006.57         13.300%       240            239          239           Level         Closing
$48,172,042.06         12.593%       300            299          299           Level         Closing
$108,889,218.34        12.910%       222            222          222           Level         Closing
</TABLE>

                                      S-68
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>              
<CAPTION>            
POOL IV              
ADJUSTABLE RATE LOANS
ASSUMED               INITIAL     ORIGINAL       REMAINING     REMAINING                                             
CUT-OFF DATE         MORTGAGE      TERM OF        TERM OF       TERM TO                                                  MONTHS TO 
PRINCIPAL            INTEREST   AMORTIZATION   AMORTIZATION    MATURITY     GROSS   PERIODIC CAP   LIFETIME   LIFETIME     RESET  
BALANCE                RATE      (IN MONTHS)    (IN MONTHS)   (IN MONTHS)  MARGIN                     CAP       FLOOR      DATE    
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 
                                                                                                                                   
6-MONTH LIBOR                                                                                                                      
- -------------                                                                                                                     
<S>                  <C>        <C>            <C>            <C>          <C>      <C>            <C>        <C>        <C>      
$4,503,023.00          10.323%        360            356          356       5.292%       1.000%    15.685%     9.685%        4 
$1,422,007.27          10.323%        360            360          360       5.292%       1.000%    15.685%     9.685%        6 
</TABLE>


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
POOL IV
ADJUSTABLE RATE LOANS
ASSUMED             
CUT-OFF DATE                                      ASSUMED
PRINCIPAL            RESET         AMORTIZATION   DELIVERY OF
BALANCE              FREQUENCY     METHOD         LOANS
- ----------------------------------------------------------------
                    
6-MONTH LIBOR       
- -------------       
<S>                  <C>          <C>    <C>
$4,503,023.00            6           Level           Closing
$1,422,007.27            6           Level           Nov-97
</TABLE>

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
POOL IV
FIXED RATE LOANS            INITIAL     ORIGINAL       REMAINING     REMAINING
ASSUMED                    MORTGAGE      TERM OF        TERM OF       TERM TO                         ASSUMED 
CUT-OFF DATE PRINCIPAL     INTEREST   AMORTIZATION   AMORTIZATION    MATURITY    AMORTIZATION         DELIVERY OF 
BALANCE                      RATE      (IN MONTHS)    (IN MONTHS)   (IN MONTHS)  METHOD               LOANS 
 
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
<S>                        <C>        <C>            <C>            <C>          <C>                  <C>
$14,496,977.00               11.592%       346            344          344           Level                Closing
$4,577,992.73                11.592%       346            346          346           Level                Nov. 97
</TABLE>

                                      S-69
<PAGE>
 
         The following tables also have been prepared assuming (i) all
distributions with respect to the Certificates will be made at the scheduled
times as described below under "Description of the Certificates--Distributions
on the Certificates," (ii) distributions on the Certificates are received in
cash on the 15th day of each month, commencing in October 1997, (iii)
prepayments represent payment in full of individual Loans and are received on
the last day of each month (commencing in September, 1997) and include 30 days'
interest thereon at the applicable Mortgage Interest Rate, (iv) the Servicing
Fee and Contingency Fee for each Loan will be 0.25% and 0.25% per annum,
respectively, of the principal balance thereof, (v) no delinquencies or defaults
in payments by Obligors of principal and interest on the Loans are experienced,
(vi) no right of optional termination is exercised except as noted below, (vii)
the Offered Certificates are purchased on September 30, 1997, (viii) with
respect to the Loans, one-month LIBOR, six-month LIBOR, one-year LIBOR and one-
year CMT remain constant at 5.65625%, 5.81250%, 5.98050% and 5.59000 %,
respectively, (ix) with respect to the Pool II Certificates, one-month LIBOR
remains constant at 5.65625% and (x) the Specified Subordinated Amount (as
defined herein under "Description of the Certificates--Distributions on the
Certificates--Class A Principal Distribution Amounts") with respect to each Pool
initially is set at the highest level specified by the Agreement and thereafter
decreases in accordance with the provisions of the Agreement.

         For each Class of Offered Certificates, the scenarios presented below
assume that the Representative exercises its option to establish the Pre-Funding
Account and that the Pre-Funded Amount equals its maximum permitted amount. The
scenarios also assume that the entire Pre-Funded Amount is used to purchase
Subsequent Loans by November 30, 1997 for all Pools other than Pool III and by
the Closing Date for Pool III.

         The model used in this Prospectus Supplement is a prepayment assumption
(the "Prepayment Assumption") which represents an assumed rate of prepayment
each month relative to the then outstanding principal balance of a pool of
mortgage loans for the life of such mortgage loans. The tables relating to the
Pool I and Pool III Certificates are priced at various Home Equity Prepayment
("HEP") assumptions. HEP assumes that a pool of loans prepays in the first month
at a constant prepayment rate ("CPR") that corresponds in CPR to one-tenth the
given HEP percentage and increases by an additional one-tenth each month
thereafter until the tenth month, where it remains at a CPR equal to the given
HEP percentage. With respect to Pool I and Pool III, the "100% Prepayment
Assumption" assumes a CPR of 2.4% and 1.7% per annum, respectively, of the then
outstanding principal balance of the respective Pool I Home Equity Loans and
Pool III Home Improvement Loans in the first month of the life of such Loans and
an additional 2.4% and 1.7% per annum, respectively, in each month thereafter
until the tenth month. Beginning in the tenth month and in each month thereafter
during the life of the respective Loans, the 100% Prepayment Assumption with
respect to Pool I and Pool III assumes a CPR of 24% and 17%, respectively, per
annum each month. With respect to Pool II, the "100% Prepayment Assumption"
assumes a CPR of 26% per annum of the then outstanding principal balance of the
adjustable rate Pool II Home Equity Loans each month. With respect to Pool IV,
the "100% Prepayment Assumption" assumes a CPR of 2% per annum of the then
outstanding principal balance of the Multifamily Loans in Pool IV in each month
in the first 48 months of the life of such Multifamily Loans. Beginning in the
forty-ninth month and in each month thereafter during the life of such
Multifamily Loans, 100% Prepayment Assumption assumes a CPR of 10% per annum
each month. As used in the table below, 0% Prepayment Assumption assumes
prepayment rates equal to 0% of the Prepayment Assumption, i.e., no prepayments
on the mortgage loans having the characteristics described below.
Correspondingly, 100% Prepayment Assumption assumes prepayment rates equal to
100% of the related Prepayment Assumption, 125% Prepayment Assumption assumes
125% of each of the rates described above; and so forth. The Prepayment
Assumption does not purport to be a historical description of prepayment
experience or a prediction of the anticipated rate of prepayment of any pool,
including the related Loans.

         Neither the Prepayment Assumption nor any other prepayment model or
assumption purports to be an historical description of prepayment experience or
a prediction of the anticipated rate of prepayment of any pool of mortgage
loans, including the Loans included in the Trust. Variations in the actual
prepayment experience and the balance of the Loans that prepay may increase or
decrease each weighted average life shown in the following tables. 

                                      S-70
<PAGE>
 
Such variations may occur even if the average prepayment experience of all such
Loans equals any of the specified percentages of the Prepayment Assumption.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                            CLASS AF-1 CERTIFICATES
PERCENTAGE                          WEIGHTED
OF PREPAYMENT                       AVERAGE                    EXPECTED
ASSUMPTION                        LIFE (YEARS)                 MATURITY
<S>                           <C>                  <C>
0%                                    2.73                     4/15/03
75%                                   0.59                    10/15/98
100% (2)                              0.50                     8/15/98
125%                                  0.45                     7/15/98
150%                                  0.41                     6/15/98
</TABLE>


                            CLASS AF-2 CERTIFICATES

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
PERCENTAGE                          WEIGHTED
OF PREPAYMENT                       AVERAGE                    EXPECTED
ASSUMPTION                        LIFE (YEARS)                 MATURITY
<S>                                 <C>                      <C>
0%                                    7.73                     10/15/07
75%                                   1.45                      8/15/99
100% (2)                              1.18                      4/15/99
125%                                  1.01                      1/15/99
150%                                  0.89                     11/15/98
</TABLE>


                            CLASS AF-3 CERTIFICATES

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
PERCENTAGE                          WEIGHTED
OF PREPAYMENT                       AVERAGE                    EXPECTED
ASSUMPTION                        LIFE (YEARS)                 MATURITY
<S>                                 <C>                     <C>
0%                                   12.67                      5/15/12
75%                                   2.60                      2/15/01
100% (2)                              2.04                      5/15/00
125%                                  1.69                     11/15/99
150%                                  1.44                      7/15/99
</TABLE>

                                      S-71
<PAGE>
 
                            CLASS AF-4 CERTIFICATES

PERCENTAGE                          WEIGHTED
OF PREPAYMENT                       AVERAGE                    EXPECTED
ASSUMPTION                        LIFE (YEARS)                 MATURITY

0%                                   16.96                     4/15/17
75%                                   4.04                     6/15/02
100% (2)                              3.07                     5/15/01
125%                                  2.48                     8/15/00
150%                                  2.08                     2/15/00


                            CLASS AF-5 CERTIFICATES

PERCENTAGE                          WEIGHTED
OF PREPAYMENT                       AVERAGE                    EXPECTED
ASSUMPTION                        LIFE (YEARS)                 MATURITY

0%                                   21.54                      3/15/21
75%                                   5.37                     11/15/03
100% (2)                              4.04                      4/15/02
125%                                  3.19                      4/15/01
150%                                  2.63                      8/15/00


                            CLASS AF-6 CERTIFICATES

PERCENTAGE                          WEIGHTED
OF PREPAYMENT                       AVERAGE                    EXPECTED
ASSUMPTION                        LIFE (YEARS)                 MATURITY

0%                                   25.30                    11/15/24
75%                                   7.70                     6/15/07
100% (2)                              5.40                     4/15/04
125%                                  4.20                     9/15/02
150%                                  3.39                     9/15/01

                                      S-72
<PAGE>
 
                            CLASS AF-7 CERTIFICATES


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
PERCENTAGE                            WEIGHTED                                          EARLIEST
OF PREPAYMENT                          AVERAGE                 EXPECTED                 RETIREMENT
ASSUMPTION                          LIFE (YEARS)               MATURITY                 DATE (1)
<S>                       <C>                                <C>                       <C>
0%                                      28.63                   11/15/27                   1/15/26
75%                                     12.86                    3/15/18                  11/15/08
100% (2)                                 9.91                   10/15/13                   5/15/06
125%                                     7.41                    1/15/11                   9/15/04
150%                                     5.50                   11/15/08                   6/15/03
</TABLE>


                            CLASS AF-8 CERTIFICATES

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
PERCENTAGE                            WEIGHTED                                           EARLIEST
OF PREPAYMENT                          AVERAGE                 EXPECTED                  RETIREMENT
ASSUMPTION                          LIFE (YEARS)               MATURITY                  DATE (1)
<S>                       <C>                                <C>                        <C>
0%                                      10.75                    8/15/27                   1/15/26
75%                                      6.78                   12/15/17                  11/15/08
100% (2)                                 6.31                    8/15/13                   5/15/06
125%                                     5.97                   11/15/10                   9/15/04
150%                                     5.69                    9/15/08                   6/15/03
</TABLE>


                             CLASS AV CERTIFICATES

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
PERCENTAGE                            WEIGHTED                                            EARLIEST
OF PREPAYMENT ASSUMPTION               AVERAGE                 EXPECTED                   RETIREMENT
                                    LIFE (YEARS)               MATURITY                   DATE (1)
<S>                       <C>                                <C>                        <C>
0%                                      20.23                    4/15/26                    1/15/26
75%                                      2.90                    6/15/06                    6/15/06
100% (2)                                 2.10                    1/15/04                    1/15/04
125%                                     1.61                    7/15/02                    7/15/02
150%                                     1.28                    6/15/01                    6/15/01
</TABLE>

                                      S-73
<PAGE>
 
                           CLASS MV-1 CERTIFICATES(3)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
PERCENTAGE                             WEIGHTED                                           EARLIEST
OF PREPAYMENT                          AVERAGE                 EXPECTED                   RETIREMENT
ASSUMPTION                           LIFE (YEARS)              MATURITY                   DATE (1)
<S>                        <C>                               <C>                        <C>
0%                                      28.97                    2/15/27                    1/15/26
75%                                     10.37                    4/15/10                   11/15/08
100% (2)                                 7.53                   11/15/06                    5/15/06
125%                                     5.71                    9/15/04                    9/15/04
150%                                     4.44                    3/15/03                    3/15/03
</TABLE>

                           CLASS MV-2 CERTIFICATES(3)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
PERCENTAGE                             WEIGHTED                                           EARLIEST
OF PREPAYMENT                          AVERAGE                 EXPECTED                   RETIREMENT
ASSUMPTION                           LIFE (YEARS)              MATURITY                   DATE (1)
<S>                        <C>                               <C>                        <C>
0%                                      29.62                    9/15/27                    1/15/26
75%                                     15.69                   12/15/19                   11/15/08
100% (2)                                11.58                    9/15/14                    5/15/06
125%                                     8.90                   12/15/10                    9/15/04
150%                                     7.02                    5/15/08                    6/15/03
</TABLE>

                             CLASS BV CERTIFICATES

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
PERCENTAGE                             WEIGHTED                                            EARLIEST
OF PREPAYMENT                          AVERAGE                 EXPECTED                    RETIREMENT
ASSUMPTION                           LIFE (YEARS)              MATURITY                    DATE(1)
<S>                        <C>                               <C>                        <C>
0%                                      27.36                    9/15/27                    1/15/26
75%                                      7.51                   12/15/19                   11/15/08
100% (2)                                 6.13                    9/15/14                    5/15/06
125%                                     5.42                   12/15/10                    9/15/04
150%                                     4.94                    5/15/08                    6/15/03
</TABLE>

                                      S-74
<PAGE>
 
                            CLASS AH-1 CERTIFICATES

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
PERCENTAGE                          WEIGHTED
OF PREPAYMENT                       AVERAGE                        EXPECTED
ASSUMPTION                        LIFE (YEARS)                     MATURITY
<S>                              <C>                               <C>
0%                                    1.01                          7/15/00
75%                                   0.50                          8/15/98
100% (2)                              0.45                          7/15/98
125%                                  0.41                          6/15/98
150%                                  0.38                          5/15/98
</TABLE>

                            CLASS AH-2 CERTIFICATES

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
PERCENTAGE                          WEIGHTED
OF PREPAYMENT                       AVERAGE                        EXPECTED
ASSUMPTION                        LIFE (YEARS)                     MATURITY
<S>                              <C>                              <C>
0%                                    5.49                         6/15/05
75%                                   1.36                         9/15/99
100% (2)                              1.15                         4/15/99
125%                                  1.02                         2/15/99
150%                                  0.93                        12/15/98
</TABLE>

                            CLASS AH-3 CERTIFICATES

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
PERCENTAGE                          WEIGHTED
OF PREPAYMENT ASSUMPTION            AVERAGE                        EXPECTED
                                  LIFE (YEARS)                     MATURITY
<S>                        <C>                                     <C>
0%                                    9.16                         6/15/08
75%                                   2.51                        11/15/00
100% (2)                              2.00                         3/15/00
125%                                  1.67                        10/15/99
150%                                  1.45                         6/15/99
</TABLE>

                                      S-75
<PAGE>
 
                            CLASS AH-4 CERTIFICATES

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
PERCENTAGE                          WEIGHTED
OF PREPAYMENT ASSUMPTION            AVERAGE                        EXPECTED
                                  LIFE (YEARS)                     MATURITY
<S>                       <C>                                <C>
0%                                   12.08                         1/15/11
75%                                   3.80                         4/15/02
100% (2)                              3.00                         5/15/01
125%                                  2.48                         9/15/00
150%                                  2.11                         4/15/00
</TABLE>

                            CLASS AH-5 CERTIFICATES

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
PERCENTAGE                          WEIGHTED                                                  EARLIEST
OF PREPAYMENT ASSUMPTION            AVERAGE                        EXPECTED                   RETIREMENT
                                  LIFE (YEARS)                     MATURITY                   DATE (1)
<S>                       <C>                                <C>                        <C>
0%                                   15.24                        12/15/14                    5/15/12
75%                                   6.29                         2/15/06                    2/15/06
100% (2)                              5.00                         7/15/04                    7/15/04
125%                                  4.11                         4/15/03                    4/15/03
150%                                  3.41                         5/15/02                    5/15/02
</TABLE>                                                           
                                                                   
                            CLASS AH-6 CERTIFICATES                
                                                                   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
PERCENTAGE                          WEIGHTED                                                  EARLIEST
OF PREPAYMENT ASSUMPTION            AVERAGE                        EXPECTED                   RETIREMENT
                                  LIFE (YEARS)                     MATURITY                   DATE (1)
<S>                       <C>                                <C>                        <C>
0%                                   17.52                         8/15/15                    5/15/12
75%                                   9.01                         6/15/07                   12/15/06
100% (2)                              7.25                         7/15/05                    7/15/05
125%                                  6.00                         3/15/04                    3/15/04
150%                                  5.00                         2/15/03                    2/15/03
</TABLE>

                                      S-76
<PAGE>
 
                            CLASS MH-1 CERTIFICATES

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
PERCENTAGE                          WEIGHTED                                                  EARLIEST
OF PREPAYMENT ASSUMPTION            AVERAGE                        EXPECTED                   RETIREMENT
                                  LIFE (YEARS)                     MATURITY                   DATE (1)
<S>                       <C>                                <C>                        <C>
0%                                   18.89                         9/15/18                    5/15/12
75%                                  11.61                         9/15/11                   12/15/06
100% (2)                              9.44                         6/15/09                    5/15/06
125%                                  7.85                         7/15/07                   12/15/05
150%                                  6.60                        12/15/05                    8/15/05
</TABLE>

                            CLASS MH-2 CERTIFICATES

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
PERCENTAGE                          WEIGHTED                                                  EARLIEST
OF PREPAYMENT ASSUMPTION            AVERAGE                        EXPECTED                   RETIREMENT
                                  LIFE (YEARS)                     MATURITY                   DATE (1)
<S>                       <C>                                <C>                        <C>
0%                                   23.04                         6/15/22                    5/15/12
75%                                  16.36                         3/15/18                   12/15/06
100% (2)                             14.29                         2/15/16                    5/15/06
125%                                 12.32                         9/15/14                   12/15/05
150%                                 10.55                        11/15/12                    8/15/05
</TABLE>

                             CLASS BH CERTIFICATES

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
PERCENTAGE                          WEIGHTED                                                  EARLIEST
OF PREPAYMENT ASSUMPTION            AVERAGE                        EXPECTED                   RETIREMENT
                                  LIFE (YEARS)                     MATURITY                   DATE (1)
<S>                       <C>                                <C>                        <C>
0%                                   17.54                         6/15/22                    5/15/12
75%                                   9.32                         3/15/18                   12/15/06
100% (2)                              7.70                         2/15/16                    5/15/06
125%                                  6.43                         9/15/14                   12/15/05
150%                                  5.98                        11/15/12                    8/15/05
</TABLE>

                                      S-77
<PAGE>
 
                             CLASS AMF CERTIFICATES

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
PERCENTAGE                          WEIGHTED                                                  EARLIEST
OF PREPAYMENT ASSUMPTION            AVERAGE                        EXPECTED                   RETIREMENT
                                  LIFE (YEARS)                     MATURITY                   DATE (1)
<S>                       <C>                                <C>                        <C>
0%                                   15.50                         5/15/27                    1/15/26
75%                                   8.48                         5/15/26                   11/15/08
100% (2)                              7.47                         2/15/26                    5/15/06
125%                                  6.73                         7/15/25                    9/15/04
150%                                  6.16                         7/15/24                    6/15/03
</TABLE>


__________

(1)       Assuming early termination of the Trust when the aggregate principal
          balance of the Loans declines to a level equal to 10% of the sum of
          (i) the Original Pool Principal Balance and (ii) the original Pre-
          Funded Amount.

(2)       Pricing Assumption.

(3)       Reflects experience of the Auction Rate Certificates in the aggregate,
          without taking into account random distributions of principal by lot
          or distributions of principal in integral multiples of $25,000.
          Therefore, it is unlikely that any individual holder of an Auction
          Rate Certificate will realize the Weighted Average Life and Expected
          Maturity set forth for the Percentage of Prepayment Assumptions listed
          above.

                                      S-78
<PAGE>
 
                        DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES

       The Certificates will be issued pursuant to the Agreement, a copy of
     which will be included as an exhibit to a Current Report on Form 8-K to be
     filed by the Representative on behalf of the Trust.  The following
     summaries describe material provisions of the Certificates and the
     Agreement, but do not purport to be complete and are subject to, and are
     qualified in their entirety by reference to, all of the provisions of the
     Agreement. Terms used herein and not otherwise defined will have the
     meanings set forth in the Agreement.

     GENERAL

       The Pool I Certificates generally will represent the right to receive
     payments distributable on or with respect to the Home Equity Loans in Pool
     I.  The Pool II Certificates generally will represent the right to receive
     payments distributable on or with respect to the Home Equity Loans in Pool
     II.  The Pool III Certificates generally will represent the right to
     receive payments distributable on or with respect to the Home Improvement
     Loans in Pool III.  The Pool IV Certificates generally will represent the
     right to receive payments distributable on or with respect to the
     Multifamily Loans in Pool IV.  The Trust also will issue the Class X and
     the Class R Certificates.  Only the Offered Certificates are offered
     hereby.

       However, as a result of the cross-support provisions described herein,
     the holders of each Class of Certificates may receive cash as credit
     support from any Loan in any Pool.  See"--Cross Support Provisions and
     Spread Amount." Also, amounts, if any, on deposit in the Spread Account
     will be available to cover shortfalls in amounts otherwise distributable to
     Certificateholders in both Pool I and Pool IV.

       The Certificates will not represent obligations of the Representative,
     the Originators or any of their respective affiliates. The Offered
     Certificates (other than the Auction Rate Certificates) will be issued in
     book-entry form in minimum denominations of $1,000 original principal
     amount and integral multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof and the Auction
     Rate Certificates will be issued in minimum denominations of $25,000 and
     integral multiples of $25,000 in excess thereof, except that one
     certificate of each Class of Offered Certificates may be issued in a
     different denomination and, if so issued, will be held in physical form.

       Definitive Certificates, if issued, will be transferable and exchangeable
     at the corporate trust office of the Trustee or, at the election of the
     Trustee, at the office of a Certificate Registrar appointed by the Trustee.
     No service charge will be made for any registration of exchange or
     transfer, but the Trustee may require payment of a sum sufficient to cover
     any tax or other governmental charge.

       The assets of the Trust will consist of (a) the Home Equity Loans, Home
     Improvement Loans and, Multifamily Loans that from time to time are subject
     to the Agreement; (b) amounts that from time to time are required by the
     Agreement to be deposited in the Certificate Account, the Principal and
     Interest Account, the Expense Account, the Insurance Account, the FHA
     Premium Account, the Spread Account, the Pre-Funding Account and the
     Capitalized Interest Account, or to be invested in Permitted Investments;
     (c) all rights under any insurance policy covering a Loan or the related
     Mortgaged Property; (d) property and any proceeds thereof acquired by
     foreclosure of a Loan, deed in lieu of foreclosure or a comparable
     conversion; and (e) the MBIA Policies and any proceeds thereof.

     DISTRIBUTIONS ON THE CERTIFICATES

       On the 15th day of each month or, if such 15th day is not a Business Day,
     the first Business Day immediately following, commencing in October 1997
     (each such day being a "Remittance Date," provided, however, that in no
     event shall the Remittance Date occur less than three business days
     following the Determination Date), until the Class Principal Balance of
     each Class of Certificates has been reduced to zero, the Trustee or Paying
     Agent will be required to distribute to the persons in whose name a
     Certificate  is registered at the close of business on the last day of the
     month immediately preceding the month of the related Remittance Date (the
     "Record Date"), such Holder's Percentage Interest multiplied by the amount
     available to be paid to the respective Class of Offered Certificates for
     such Remittance Date.  

                                      S-79
<PAGE>
 
     Any Pre-Funded Amount remaining at the close of business on December 26,
     1997 will be distributed by or on behalf of the Trustee on the Special
     Remittance Date (together with accrued interest) at the applicable Pass-
     Through Rates on the amount of such prepayment) to the Classes of Offered
     Certificates then entitled to receive payments of principal as described
     herein. Such distribution will be made to each person in whose name an
     Offered Certificate of any such Class is registered on November 30, 1997.
     For so long as the Offered Certificates are in book-entry form with DTC,
     the only "Holder" of the Offered Certificates will be Cede. See"--Book-
     Entry Certificates."

       With respect to the Auction Rate Certificates, on each Remittance Date,
     the Trustee or Paying Agent will be required to distribute to the persons
     in whose name an Auction Rate Certificate is registered at the close of
     business on the related Record Date, such Holder's Percentage Interest
     multiplied by that portion of the Current Interest Requirement allocable to
     the respective Class of Auction Rate Certificates for such Remittance Date.
     The remainder of the amount being distributed to such Class of Auction Rate
     Certificates on such Remittance Date will be allocated as principal to the
     specific Certificates of such Class selected no later than 5 business days
     prior to the related Remittance Date by lot or such other manner as may be
     determined, which allocations will be made only in amounts equal to $25,000
     and integral multiplies of $25,000 in excess thereof.

       Notwithstanding the foregoing, if on the Special Remittance Date the
     amount of principal allocated to the Auction Rate Certificates is not equal
     to $25,000 or an integral multiple of $25,000 in excess thereof, the entire
     amount (if less than $25,000) or the amount exceeding an integral multiple
     of $25,000 will, instead, be distributed to any remaining Adjustable Rate
     Certificates.

       The "Class Principal Balance" of a Class of Offered Certificates as of
     any date of determination is the original principal balance of such Class
     of Certificates, less (i) the sum of all amounts (including, with respect
     of Pool I and Pool IV Certificates, the principal portion of any related
     Insured Payments and, with respect to the Pool III Certificates, FHA
     Payments) previously distributed by the Trustee as principal on the
     applicable Class of Certificates, and (ii) any actual loss of principal
     suffered by the related Certificateholders due, in the case of Pool I and
     Pool IV Certificates, to the failure of MBIA to perform its obligations
     under the related MBIA Policy and, in the case of Pool II and Pool III
     Certificates, the amount, if any, of Applied Realized Loss Amounts
     previously allocated to such Class.  Any such loss with respect to a Loan
     will be allocated among the Classes of Certificates as described herein.

       A Certificateholder's "Percentage Interest" is that fraction, expressed
     as a percentage, the numerator of which is the original denomination of
     such Certificateholder's Certificate and the denominator of which is the
     original aggregate Class Principal Balance of the respective Class of
     Certificates.

       A "Business Day" is any day other than (i) a Saturday or Sunday or (ii) a
     day on which banking institutions in the States of New York, New Jersey,
     Minnesota or Delaware are authorized or obligated by law or executive order
     to be closed.

       As more fully described herein, distributions with respect to each Class
     of Offered Certificates will be payable, after payment of certain fees,
     generally from (i) receipts on the Loans of the applicable Pool, (subject
     to certain adjustments described herein as a result of the cross support
     provisions), (ii) advances and payments of Compensating Interest by the
     Servicer, (iii) with respect to the Pool I and Pool IV Certificates,
     amounts transferred from the Spread Account, if any, and payments under the
     related MBIA Policy, (iv) with respect to the Pool III Certificates, any
     FHA Payments and (v) for the Remittance Dates occurring in October,
     November and December 1997, any amounts transferred to the Certificate
     Account from the Pre-Funding Account or the Capitalized Interest Account
     (with respect to each Pool of Certificates, the "Pool Available Amount").

       The "Due Period" with respect to any Remittance Date is the calendar
     month preceding the month of such Remittance Date.

                                      S-80
<PAGE>
 
     Current Interest

       On each Remittance Date, to the extent of the applicable Pool Available
     Amount, the holders of each Class of Offered Certificates will receive 30
     days' interest (or in the case of the Adjustable Rate Certificates and
     Auction Rate Certificates, the actual number of days since the last
     Remittance Date (or, in the case of the first Remittance Date, from
     September 15, 1997 with respect to the Adjustable Rate Certificates and
     from the Closing Date, with respect to the Auction Rate Certificates) up to
     but not including the upcoming Remittance Date) at the related Pass-Through
     Rate on the respective Class Principal Balance outstanding immediately
     prior to such Remittance Date.

       Interest with respect to the Offered Certificates will accrue on the
     basis of a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day months (or, in the case
     of the Adjustable Rate Certificates and Auction Rate Certificates, on the
     basis of a 360-day year consisting of the actual number of days elapsed
     since interest was last paid or in the case of the first Remittance Date,
     from September 15, 1997 for the Adjustable Rate Certificates and from the
     Closing Date for the Auction Rate Certificates).

       The amount of interest each Class of Certificates is entitled to receive
     on each Remittance Date is referred to as the "Current Interest
     Requirement" for such Class.

       Notwithstanding the foregoing, if a principal prepayment is made to one
     or more Classes of Certificates on the Special Remittance Date, each such
     Class also will receive on such date accrued interest at the applicable
     Pass-Through Rate on the amount of such prepayment.  Further, the Current
     Interest Requirement for each such Class for the January 1998 Remittance
     Date will be based on the related Principal Balance on December  29, 1997,
     after giving effect to such principal prepayment.

       Interest will first be allocated to the applicable Class A Certificates,
     pro rata in accordance with the Current Interest Requirements, then in the
     case of Pool II and Pool III Certificates, to the applicable Pool Class M
     Certificates in ascending numerical order and then to the applicable Pool
     Class B Certificates.

       If on a particular Remittance Date, the Pool Available Amount for a Pool
     of Certificates is less than the aggregate Current Interest Requirement for
     the related Pool Class A Certificates, the amount of the shortfall for each
     such Class of Pool Class A Certificates, together with interest thereon at
     the applicable Pass Through Rates to the extent permitted by law (each, a
     "Class Interest Shortfall Carryforward Amount") will be carried forward and
     distributed as described below.  In the case of Pool I and Pool IV
     Certificates, the Class Interest Shortfall Carryforward Amount will be paid
     by MBIA under the MBIA Policies and there should be no carry forward
     thereof.

       Similarly, if the Pool Available Amount for any Class of Pool Class M
     Certificates or Class of Pool Class B Certificates after making the
     distributions of the Current Interest Requirements to all classes which are
     prior in right of distribution as described in the second preceding
     paragraph, is less than the Current Interest Requirement for such Class the
     remaining Pool Available Amount will be distributed with respect thereto
     and a Class Interest Shortfall Carryforward Amount will be created for such
     Class.

       Any Class Interest Shortfall Carryforward Amounts for Classes of Pool II
     Certificates do not include any Certificateholders' Interest Carryover (as
     defined below).

       For the first Remittance Date, the Class AV and Class BV Certificates
     will bear interest at per annum rates of 5.83125% and 6.61625%,
     respectively.  For each Remittance Date thereafter, the Class AV and Class
     BV Certificates will bear interest at per annum rates equal to LIBOR (as
     defined below) plus before the Optional Servicer Termination Date 0.175%
     and 0.960%, respectively, and after the Optional Servicer Termination Date
     if termination has not occurred, 0.35% and 1.44%, respectively, subject in
     each case to the Net Funds Cap (as defined below) but in no event exceeding
     14% per annum and 14% per annum, respectively.

                                      S-81
<PAGE>
 
       For the first Remittance Date, the Class MV-1 and Class MV-2 Certificates
     will bear interest at the per annum rates of 5.70% and 5.80%, respectively.
     For each Remittance Date thereafter, the Class MV-1 and Class MV-2
     Certificates will bear interest based upon the Auction Procedures described
     in Appendix I to the Prospectus, subject to the Net Funds Cap, but in no
     event exceeding 14% per annum and 14% per annum, respectively.

       LIBOR for each Remittance Date after the first Remittance Date will be
     determined on the LIBOR Determination Date preceding each such Remittance
     Date.  See "The Agreement--Calculation of LIBOR."

       As to any Remittance Date, the "Net Funds Cap" for the Pool II
     Certificates will be a percentage equal to the difference between (A) the
     weighted average Pool II Mortgage Interest Rate and (B) the sum of (i) the
     percentages used in determining the Servicing Fee, the Contingency Fee and
     the fee due the Trustee and (ii) with respect to the Auction Rate
     Certificates, the percentage used in determining the fees due the Auction
     Agent and the Broker-Dealer (as defined in the Auction Procedures described
     in Appendix I to the Prospectus).

       If on any Remittance Date the Pass-Through Rate for a Class of Adjustable
     Rate Certificates or Auction Rate Certificates is based upon the Net Funds
     Cap, the excess of (i) the amount of interest such Class of Certificates
     would be entitled to receive on such Remittance Date had interest been
     calculated based on LIBOR plus the applicable margin (but in no event
     exceeding the applicable maximum rate set forth above), over (ii) the
     amount of interest such Class will receive on such Remittance Date at the
     Net Funds Cap, together with the unpaid portion of any such excess from
     prior Remittance Dates (and interest accrued thereon at the then applicable
     Pass-Through Rate, without giving effect to the Net Funds Cap, but in no
     event exceeding the applicable maximum rate set forth above) is referred to
     herein as the "Certificateholders' Interest Carryover." Any
     Certificateholders' Interest Carryover will be paid on future Remittance
     Dates as set forth herein under "--Cross-Support Provisions and Spread
     Amount." No Certificateholders' Interest Carryover will be paid to a Class
     of Certificates after its Class Principal Balance is reduced to zero.  The
     ratings of the Pool II Certificates do not address the likelihood of the
     payment of the amount of any Certificateholders' Interest Carryover.

     Class A Principal Distribution Amounts

       Holders of the applicable Pool Class A Certificates will be entitled to
     receive on each Remittance Date as payments of principal, in the order of
     priority set forth below, in the aggregate, the lesser of (i) the remaining
     applicable Pool Available Amount in the Certificate Account on such
     Remittance Date after payment of the Current Interest Requirements on all
     Classes of Offered Certificates in the applicable Pool and (ii) the
     applicable Senior Percentage of the applicable Pool Principal Distribution
     Amount (with respect to each Pool of Certificates, the "Class A Formula
     Principal Distribution Amount")

       The "Senior Percentage" for any Remittance Date (a) for the Pool I and
     Pool IV Class A Certificates is 100% and (b) for the Pool II and Pool III
     Class A Certificates (i) prior to the Pool II or Pool III Class B Cross-
     over Date (as defined herein), respectively, and for any Remittance Date on
     or after the Pool II or Pool III Class B Cross-over Date on which the
     Trigger Event with respect to the applicable Pool is in effect (as
     described under "--Pool II and Pool III Class B Pool Principal Distribution
     Amount"), will be 100%, or (ii) on or after the Pool II  or Pool III Class
     B Cross-over Date on which the Trigger Event with respect to the applicable
     Pool is not in effect, the "Senior Percentage" will equal a fraction,
     expressed as a percentage, the numerator of which is the sum of the Class
     Principal Balances of the Pool II or Pool III Class A and Class M
     Certificates, as applicable, as of the immediately preceding Remittance
     Date and the denominator of which is the sum of the Class Principal
     Balances of the Pool II or Pool III Class A, Class M and Class B
     Certificates, as applicable, as of the immediately preceding Remittance
     Date.

                                      S-82
<PAGE>
 
       For any Remittance Date, the "Pool Principal Distribution Amount" is
     equal to the excess of

          (X) the sum, without duplication, of

               (i) each payment of principal received by the Servicer or any
          Subservicer (exclusive of Curtailments, Principal Prepayments and
          amounts described in clause (iii) hereof) during the related Due
          Period with respect to the Loans of the related Pool,

               (ii) all Curtailments and all Principal Prepayments received by
          the Servicer or any Subservicer during the related Due Period with
          respect to the Loans of the related Pool,

               (iii) the principal portion of all Insurance Proceeds, Released
          Mortgaged Property Proceeds and Net Liquidation Proceeds received by
          the Servicer or any Subservicer during the related Due Period with
          respect to the Loans of the related Pool (and, with respect to the
          Pool III Loans, any FHA Payments received by the Claims Administrator
          with respect to principal on a Pool III Loan during the related Due
          Period),

               (iv) that portion of the purchase price for any Loan of the
          related Pool repurchased by The Money Store Inc. as a remedy for
          breaches of representations and warranties which represents principal
          and any Substitution Adjustments, in either case to the extent
          received by the Trustee as of the related Determination Date,

               (v) any proceeds representing principal received by the Trustee
          in connection with the liquidation of a Pool or termination of the
          Trust,

               (vi) with respect to Pool I or Pool IV, the amount of any
          Subordination Deficit (as defined under "--Cross Support Provisions
          and Spread Amount" herein) for such Remittance Date,

               (vii) any moneys released from the Pre-Funding Account on the
          October, November or December 1997 Remittance Date as a prepayment of
          the Certificates of the related Pool, and

               (viii) with respect to Pool I or Pool IV, the amount of any
          Subordination Increase Amount (as defined under"--Cross-Support
          Provisions and Spread Amount" herein) with respect to the applicable
          Pool for such Remittance Date, OVER

                    (Y) the amount of any Subordination Reduction Amount with
          respect to the applicable Pool for such Remittance Date.

          The "Subordination Reduction Amount" for any Remittance Date is equal
     to the lesser of (i) the amount set forth in clause (X) of the definition
     of Pool Principal Distribution Amount and (ii) the excess, if any, of the
     then current Spread Amount over the then current Specified Subordinated
     Amount.

          The "Spread Amount" for any Remittance Date is equal to the excess, if
     any, of (i) the aggregate principal balances of the Loans in the applicable
     Pool as of the last day of the immediately preceding Due Period and any
     amounts on deposit in the Pre-Funding Account with respect to such
     applicable Pool over (ii) the aggregate principal balances of the related
     Certificates (after taking into account all distributions of principal on
     such Remittance Date).

          The "Specified Subordinated Amount" means, for any Remittance Date (i)
     with respect to Pool I and Pool IV such amounts as are required by MBIA and
     are set forth in the Agreement and (ii) with respect to Pool II, (a) prior
     to the related Pool Spread Amount Stepdown Date, 2.0% of the Pool II
     Original Collateral Amount (as defined below) and (b) on and after the
     related Pool Spread Amount Stepdown Date, the greater of (A) 4.0% of the
     then current aggregate principal balance of the Pool II Loans as of the
     last day of the related Due Period and (B) 0.5% of the Pool II Original
     Collateral Amount; provided that upon the occurrence and during the
     continuance of (x) a Trigger Event (as defined 

                                      S-83
<PAGE>
 
     under "--Pool II and Pool III Class B Pool Principal Distribution Amount")
     no stepdown may occur and (y) an S&P Trigger Event (as defined below), the
     Specified Subordinated Amount for Pool II will equal 3.75% of the Pool II
     Original Collateral Amount on or prior to October 2000 and 7.50% of the
     then current aggregate principal balance of the Pool II Loans as of the
     last day of the related Due Period thereafter, and in any event the
     Specified Subordinated Amount shall never exceed the then Class Principal
     Balance of the Pool II Certificates, and (iii) with respect to Pool III,
     (a) prior to the related Pool Spread Amount Stepdown Date, 7.85% of the
     Pool III Original Collateral Amount and (b) on and after the related Pool
     Spread Amount Stepdown Date, the greater of (A) 15.70% of the then current
     aggregate principal balance of the Pool III Loans as of the last day of the
     related Due Period and (B) 0.5% of the Pool III Original Collateral Amount;
     provided that upon the occurrence and during the continuance of a Trigger
     Event, the Specified Subordinated Amount for Pool III will equal 9.2% of
     the Pool III Original Collateral Amount and in any event, the Specified
     Subordinated Amount shall never exceed the then Class Principal Balance of
     the Pool III Certificates.

          The "Pool Spread Amount Stepdown Date" for either Pool II or Pool III
     means the later to occur of (i) the Distribution Date occurring in October
     2000 and (ii) the first Distribution Date on which the aggregate principal
     balances of the Loans in the related Loan Pool as of the last day of the
     related Due Period is less than 50% of the sum of (a) the aggregate
     principal balances of the Initial Pool II Home Equity Loans or the Initial
     Home Improvement Loans, as applicable, and (b) the related original Pre-
     Funded Amount the "Original Collateral Amount".  Notwithstanding the
     foregoing, the Pool II Specified Subordinated Amount will not be reduced
     if, commencing with the Remittance Date in October 2000, cumulative
     Realized Losses exceed certain percentages set forth in the Agreement of
     the Pool II Original Collateral Amount.

          An "S&P Trigger Event" will be in effect on a Remittance Date for Pool
     II or Pool III if the Sixty-Day Delinquency Ratio (as defined in the
     Agreement) as of such Remittance Date exceeds 50% of the applicable Pool
     Senior Specified Enhancement Percentage (as defined under "--Pool II and
     Pool III Class B Pool Principal Distribution Amount").

          The "Class A Pool Principal Distribution Amount" with respect to a
     Pool of Certificates for any Remittance Date is intended to be equal to the
     Class A Formula Principal Distribution Amount for such Pool of
     Certificates.  If the Class A Formula Principal Distribution Amount exceeds
     the applicable Pool Available Amount in the Certificate Account on such
     Remittance Date (after payment of all Current Interest Requirements for the
     Certificates in such Pool), then the Class A Pool Principal Distribution
     Amount for such Pool of Certificates shall instead equal such remaining
     Pool Available Amount.

     Pool I

          On each Remittance Date, the Class A Pool Principal Distribution
     Amount for Pool I will be distributed to the holders of the Pool I Class A
     Certificates in the following order of priority:  (i) first, to the holders
     of the Class AF-8 Certificates, an amount equal to the Class AF-8 Principal
     Distribution Amount (as defined below) for such Remittance Date, and (ii)
     second, to the holders of the Class AF-1, Class AF-2, Class AF-3, Class AF-
     4, Class AF-5, Class AF-6, Class AF-7 and Class AF-8 Certificates,
     sequentially in that order, until the Class Principal Balance of each such
     Class (in ascending order of numerical designation) is reduced to zero and
     the Certificateholders of each such Class have received an amount equal to
     the amount described in clause (iv) of the definition of Distribution
     Amount (as defined herein) that is recovered from such Certificateholders.

          The "Class AF-8 Principal Distribution Amount" for any Remittance Date
     will be the product of (i) the applicable Class AF-8 Principal Percentage
     for such Remittance Date and (ii) the Class AF-8 Pro Rata Principal
     Distribution Amount for such Remittance Date.  In no event will the Class
     AF-8 Principal Distribution Amount on any Remittance Date be greater than
     the Pool Principal Distribution Amount for Pool I for such Remittance Date
     or the Class Principal Balance of the Class AF-8 Certificates.

                                      S-84
<PAGE>
 
          The "Class AF-8 Principal Percentage" for each Remittance Date shall
     be as follows:

                                                    Class AF-8
                                                    Principal
                    Remittance Dates                Percentage

                    October 1997 - September 2000   0%
                    October 2000 - September 2002   45%
                    October 2002 - September 2003   80%
                    October 2003 - September 2004   100%
                    October 2004 -  and thereafter  300%

          The "Class AF-8 Pro Rata Principal Distribution Amount" for each
     Remittance Date will be an amount equal to the product of (x) a fraction,
     the numerator of which is the  Class Principal Balance of the Class AF-8
     Certificates immediately prior to such Remittance Date and the denominator
     of which is the aggregate Class Principal Balance of the Pool I
     Certificates immediately prior to such Remittance Date and (y) the Pool
     Principal Distribution Amount for Pool I for such Remittance Date.

          Notwithstanding the foregoing and only through the Remittance Date in
     July 1998, for purposes of making the foregoing distributions, the Class A
     Pool Principal Distribution Amount for Pool I shall not include the lesser
     of (a) the Total Monthly Excess Cashflow for Pool I less any Pool I
     Subordination Deficit and (b) an amount equal to 30 days' interest at a
     rate of 2.5% per annum on a notional amount equal to the Class Principal
     Balance of the Class AF-8 Certificates prior to the distributions being
     made on the specified Remittance Date (the "Pool I Strip Amount).  The Pool
     I Strip Amount will be paid to the Holders of the Class X Certificates.

     Pool II

          On each Remittance Date, the Class A Pool Principal Distribution
     Amount for Pool II will be distributed to the holders of the Class  AV
     Certificates, until the Class Principal Balance of such Class is reduced to
     zero.

     Pool III

          On each Remittance Date, the Class A Pool Principal Distribution
     Amount for Pool III will be distributed to the holders of the Pool III
     Class A Certificates in the order of their numerical designations,
     commencing with the Class AH-1 Certificates, until the Class Principal
     Balance of each such Class is reduced to zero; provided, however that on
     any Remittance Date on which the Class Principal Balances of the Pool III
     Class M and Class B Certificates have been reduced to zero, any amounts
     payable to the Pool III Class A Certificates on such Remittance Date shall
     be distributed pro rata and not sequentially.

     Pool IV

          On each Remittance Date, the Class A Pool Principal Distribution
     Amount for Pool IV will be distributed to the holders of the Class AMF
     Certificates until the Class Principal Balance of such Certificates is
     reduced to zero and such Certificateholders have received an amount equal
     to the amount described in clause (iv) of the definition of Distribution
     Amount that is recovered from such Certificateholders.

     Pool II and Pool III Class M Pool Principal Distribution Amounts

          On each Remittance Date on and after the Class Principal Balances of
     the Pool II or Pool III Class A Certificates have been reduced to zero, the
     Holders of the Pool II or Pool III Class M Certificates, as applicable,
     will be entitled to receive, as payments of principal, the lesser of (i)
     the remaining applicable Pool Available Amount in the Certificate Account
     on such Remittance Date after payment of the Current Interest Requirements
     on all Classes of 

                                      S-85
<PAGE>
 
     Offered Certificates in the applicable Pool and the applicable Class A Pool
     Principal Distribution Amount, if any, on such Remittance Date and (ii) the
     Senior Percentage of the Pool II or Pool III Pool Principal Distribution
     Amount (the "Class M Formula Principal Distribution Amount"). Such Class M
     Pool Principal Distribution Amount shall be allocated between the Class M
     Certificates of the applicable Pool in the order of their numerical
     designations, commencing with the Class MV-1 and Class MH-1 Certificates,
     respectively, until the Class Principal Balance of the respective Classes
     of Class M Certificates are reduced to zero.

          The "Class M Pool Principal Distribution Amount" with respect to Pool
     II or Pool III Certificates for any Remittance Date is intended to be equal
     to the Class M Formula Principal Distribution Amount for such Pool of
     Certificates.  If the Class M Formula Principal Distribution Amount exceeds
     the applicable remaining Pool Available Amount in the Certificate Account
     on such Remittance Date then the Class M Pool Principal Distribution Amount
     shall instead equal such remaining Available Amount.

          On each Remittance Date on or after the related Class B Cross-over
     Date on which the Trigger Event is not in effect, payments of principal
     will be made to the related Class B Certificateholders, even if the related
     Class M Certificateholders are not yet entitled to receive payments of
     principal because the Class Principal Balances of the Class A Certificates
     have not been reduced to zero.

     Pool II and Pool III Class B Pool Principal Distribution Amount

          Prior to the related Class B Cross-over Date, there will be no
     distributions of principal on the Pool II or Pool III Class B Certificates.
     The "Class B Cross-over Date" will be the earlier of (A) the Remittance
     Date on which the Class MV-2 or Class MH-2 Class Principal Balance,
     respectively,  is reduced to zero, and (B) the first Remittance Date on or
     after the Remittance Date in October 2000 on which the fraction, expressed
     as a percentage, the numerator of which is the sum of the related Class A
     and Class M Class Principal Balances as of the immediately preceding
     Remittance Date and the denominator of which is the aggregate outstanding
     principal balance of the Loans in the respective Pool as of the end of the
     second preceding Due Period, is less than or equal to 87.0% in the case of
     Pool II and 75.8% in the case of Pool III.

          On each Remittance Date on or after the related Class B Cross-over
     Date for Pool II or Pool III and prior to the Remittance Date on which the
     related Class A and Class M Class Principal Balances have been reduced to
     zero, holders of the related Class B Certificates will be entitled to
     distributions of principal only if the Trigger Event is not in effect on
     such Remittance Date.

          A "Trigger Event" will be in effect on a Remittance Date for Pool II
     if the Sixty-Day Delinquency Ratio (as defined in the Agreement) as of such
     Remitance Date exceeds 40% of the Pool Senior Specified Enhancement
     Percentage (as defined below).

          A "Trigger Event" will be in effect on a Remittance Date for Pool III
     if either (i) the Sixty-Day Delinquency Ratio as of such Remittance Date
     exceeds 50% of the Pool Senior Specified Enhancement Percentage; or (ii)
     both (A) either (x) the Weighted Average Five-Month Sixty-Day Delinquency
     Ratio (as defined in the Agreement) as of such Remittance Date exceeds 9%
     or (y) the Cumulative Realized Losses (as defined in the Agreement) as of
     such Remittance Date exceed $32,175,000; and (B) either (x) the Weighted
     Average Five-Month Sixty-Day Delinquency Ratio as of such Remittance Date
     exceeds 15% or (y) the Cumulative Realized Losses as of such Remittance
     Date exceed $10,725,000; or (iii) the fraction, expressed as a percentage,
     the numerator of which is the sum of the Class A and Class M Current
     Principal Balances as of the immediately preceding Remittance Date and the
     denominator of which is the aggregate outstanding principal balance of the
     Loans as of the end of the second preceding Due Period is greater than
     75.8%.

          The Pool Senior Specified Enhancement Percentage on any Remittance
     Date is 38% with respect to Pool II and 62.2% with respect to Pool III.

                                      S-86
<PAGE>
 
          On each Remittance Date on or after the Class B Cross-over Date, if
     the Trigger Event is not in effect on such Remittance Date, the Holders of
     the Class B Certificates will be entitled to receive, as payments of
     principal, the lesser of (i) the remaining applicable Pool Available Amount
     on such Remittance Date after payments of the Current Interest Requirements
     on all Classes of Offered Certificates in the applicable Pool and the
     applicable Class A and Class M Pool  Principal Distribution Amounts, if
     any, on such Remittance Date and (ii) the Class B Percentage of the Pool II
     or Pool III Pool Principal Distribution Amount (the Class B Formula
     Principal Distribution Amount"), until the respective Class B Class
     Principal Balance is reduced to zero.

          Until such time as the Class A and Class M Class Principal Balances
     have been reduced to zero, the "Class B Percentage" for any Remittance Date
     will be 100% minus the Senior Percentage.  The "Class B Percentage" for
     each Remittance Date, if any, after the Class A and Class M Class Principal
     Balances have been reduced to zero will equal 100%.

          The "Class B Pool Principal Distribution Amount" with respect to Pool
     II or Pool III Certificates for any Remittance Date is intended to be equal
     to the Class B Formula Principal Distribution Amount for such Pool of
     Certificates.  If the Class B Formula Principal Distribution Amount exceeds
     the applicable remaining Pool Available Amount in the Certificate Account
     on such Remittance Date then the Class B Pool Principal Distribution Amount
     shall instead equal such remaining Pool Available Amount.

     Remaining Pool II and Pool III  Pool Available Amounts

          On each Remittance Date, after payments of amounts as set forth above
     with respect to Pool II and Pool III, the remaining Pool II and Pool III
     Pool Available Amounts shall be paid to the following Classes, in the
     following order of priority:

               (i) the aggregate Class A Class Interest Shortfall Carryforward
          Amounts will be paid concurrently to the Holders of the applicable
          Class or Classes of Class A Certificates pro rata in the case of Pool
          III Class A Certificates in accordance with their respective
          entitlements to Class A Interest Shortfall Carryforward Amounts, and
          any Class A Interest Shortfall Carryforward Amounts not paid shall be
          carried forward to the next Remittance Date;

               (ii) the Accelerated Principal Distribution Amount will be paid
          to the Holders of the applicable Class A, Class M and Class B
          Certificates in the same order and priority as payments of the Pool
          Principal Distribution Amount described above.  (For any Remittance
          Date, the "Accelerated Principal Distribution Amount" equals the
          lesser of (i) the remaining Pool Available Amount in the Certificate
          Account on such Remittance Date less in the case of Pool II, and only
          through the Remittance Date in April 1998, an amount equal to 30 days'
          interest at a rate of 4.0% per annum on a notional amount equal to the
          Class Principal Balance of the Class MV-1 Certificates prior to the
          distributions being made on the Remittance Date (the "Pool II Strip
          Amount") and (ii) the Subordinated Deficiency Amount for such
          Remittance Date, and the "Subordinated Deficiency Amount" equals the
          excess, if any, of (i) the Specified Subordinated Amount for such
          Remittance Date over (ii) the then current Spread Amount, after giving
          effect to all payments previously made on such Remittance Date;

               (iii) the lesser of the remaining Pool II or Pool III Pool
          Available Amount and the applicable Pool Available Maximum
          Subordination Amount will be paid in reduction of the related Class
          Interest Shortfall Carryforward Amounts and then the Class Realized
          Loss Amounts, first to the Class MV-1 and Class MH-1 Certificates,
          respectively, second to the Class MV-2 and MH-2 Certificates,
          respectively, and then to the Class BV and BH Certificates,
          respectively.  Any Class Interest Shortfall Carryforward Amounts or
          Class Realized Loss Amounts not paid shall be carried forward to the
          next Remittance Date subject to the applicable Pool Available Maximum
          Subordination Amount.

               (iv)  the Pool II Strip Amount will be paid to the Holders of the
          Class X Certificates.

                                      S-87
<PAGE>
 
               (v)  any remaining amounts, subject to the cross support
          provisions described under "--Cross-Support Provisions and Spread
          Amount" will be paid to the Class X and/or Class R Certificates.

          When the applicable Pool Available Maximum Subordination Amount has
     been reduced to zero, (i) no further Class M or Class B Class Interest
     Shortfall Carryforward Amounts or Class M or Class B Class Realized Loss
     Amounts with respect to the same Pool shall be carried forward to
     succeeding Remittance Dates and (ii) interest shall cease to accrue on such
     remaining Class M or Class B Class Interest Shortfall Carryforward Amounts.

          For so long as any Pool II or Pool III Certificates shall be
     outstanding, at no time shall the cumulative sum of all related (i) Class M
     and Class B Interest Shortfall Carryforward Amounts and (iii) Class M or
     Class B Realized Loss Amounts (such amounts with respect to Pool II or Pool
     III being hereinafter referred to collectively as "Pool Shortfall Amounts")
     exceed $7,970,000 in the case of Pool II and $4,469,531 in the case of Pool
     III  (each, a "Pool Maximum Subordination Amount").  The "Pool Available
     Maximum Subordination Amount" at any time shall be the applicable Pool
     Maximum Subordination Amount less all distributions previously made in
     respect of the related Pool Shortfall Amounts, irrespective of whether any
     such distribution is derived from another Pool.

     MBIA RELATED PROVISIONS FOR POOL I AND POOL IV

          On any Remittance Date, the "Distribution Amount" for Pool I or Pool
     IV Certificates will equal the sum of (i) the Current Interest Requirement
     for such Pool, (ii) the Pool Principal Distribution Amount for such Pool,
     (iii) the Carry-Forward Amount for such Pool, and (iv) any amount received
     by the Trustee from the Servicer that constitutes a Monthly Advance with
     respect to a Loan in such Pool and that is recoverable and sought to be
     recovered as a voidable preference by a trustee in bankruptcy pursuant to
     the Bankruptcy Code in accordance with a final, nonappealable order of a
     court having competent jurisdiction.

          The Carry-Forward Amount for Pool I or Pool IV with respect to any
     Remittance Date will equal the sum of (i) the amount, if any, by which (x)
     the Distribution Amount for such Pool as of the immediately preceding
     Remittance Date exceeded (y) the amount of the actual distribution to the
     Holders of the Certificates of such Pool made on such Remittance Date (less
     the amount of Insured Payments, if any, on such date), and (ii) interest on
     the amount, if any, described in clause (i) at one-twelfth the applicable
     Pass-Through Rate for the related Class of Certificates.

          The Carry-Forward Amounts are primarily intended to measure the amount
     of money for which MBIA is entitled to reimbursement.  As set forth herein,
     MBIA is subrogated to the rights of the Pool I and Pool IV
     Certificateholders to receive payments under the Pool I and Pool IV
     Certificates to the extent of any Insured Payments made under the
     applicable MBIA Policy.  See "The MBIA Policies and MBIA." This right of
     subrogation, however, is subordinate to the right of the Pool I and Pool IV
     Certificateholders to receive the entire Distribution Amount on each
     Remittance Date.

          In the event any amounts referenced in clause (iv) of the definition
     of Distribution Amount or clause (X) (iv) of the definition of Pool
     Principal Distribution Amount are covered by Insured Payments or any
     portion thereof, payment of such amounts will be disbursed to the trustee
     in bankruptcy named in the final order of the court exercising jurisdiction
     and not to any Pool I or Pool IV Class A Certificateholder directly unless
     such Class A Certificateholder has returned principal or interest paid on a
     related Class A Certificate to such trustee in bankruptcy, in which case
     such payment will be disbursed to such Class A Certificateholder.

          The definitions of the Pool Principal Distribution Amount for each
     Pool are determined with regard to actual amounts received on the Loans and
     without any regard to a schedule for the recovery of principal.

          Pursuant to the MBIA Policies, MBIA has agreed to make Insured
     Payments on each Remittance Date. See "The MBIA Policies and MBIA."

                                      S-88
<PAGE>
 
          The Agreement provides that the Trustee or Paying Agent will (i)
     receive as attorney-in-fact of each Holder of the Pool I and Pool IV
     Certificates any Insured Payment from MBIA and (ii) disburse such payment
     pursuant to the Agreement.  The Agreement provides that to the extent MBIA
     makes Insured Payments, either directly or indirectly (as by paying through
     the Trustee), to the Holders of the Class A Certificates, MBIA will be
     subrogated to the rights of such Holders with respect to such Insured
     Payments, will be deemed, to the extent of the payments so made, to be a
     registered Holder of Class A Certificates and will receive reimbursement
     for such Insured Payments as provided in the Agreement, but only from the
     sources (other than Insured Payments) and in the manner provided in the
     Agreement.

          Each Holder of a Pool I or Pool IV Certificate is required by the
     Agreement to notify the Trustee promptly upon the receipt of a court order
     to the effect that amounts previously received by such Pool I or Pool IV
     Certificateholder and described in clause (iv) of the definition of Pool
     Principal Distribution Amount or clause (iv) of the definition of
     Distribution Amount constitute voidable preferences and to provide a copy
     of such order with such notice.

          As set forth above, clause (i) of the definition of Pool Principal
     Distribution Amount includes only payments of principal actually received
     by the Servicer or any Subservicer.  Neither the Servicer nor MBIA is
     required to advance any delinquent payments of principal.  Accordingly, the
     holders of Pool I and Pool IV Certificates will not receive delinquent
     payments of principal until such time as the delinquency is cured or, if
     such delinquency is not cured, following the time such Loan becomes a
     Liquidated Loan or, with respect to 90 Day Delinquent FHA Loans, following
     the time the related FHA Payment is received.

          The Trustee will have the right, on behalf of Pool I and Pool IV
     Certificateholders, to sue MBIA in the event any required Insured Payment
     is not made in accordance with the terms of the applicable MBIA Policy.

     CROSS-SUPPORT PROVISIONS AND SPREAD AMOUNT

          As a result of the cross-support provisions described below, on each
     Remittance Date the "Excess Spread" for each Pool of Loans (i.e., an amount
                                                                 ----           
     generally equal to the interest due on the Loans remaining after each Class
     of Certificates in the related Pool has been allocated its interest for
     such Remittance Date and certain expenses of the Trust have been paid) and
     any Subordination Reduction Amount (collectively, the "Total Monthly Excess
     Cashflow") will be available to fund certain payments.   Such Total Monthly
     Excess Cashflow, net in the case of Pool I and Pool IV of certain amounts
     used to reimburse MBIA, will be applied in the following order of priority
     on such Remittance Date:

               (i) first, to make accelerated payments of principal to the
          Offered Certificates of the related Pool in the order provided for
          payments of the applicable Pool Principal Distribution Amounts as
          described above until the Spread Amount of such Pool equals its
          Specified Subordinated Amount (the "Subordination Increase Amount");

               (ii) second, in the case of Pool II and Pool III to reduce the
          related  Class Interest Shortfall Carryforward Amounts and then the
          Class Realized Loss Amounts in the order provided under "--
          Distributions on the Certificates--Remaining Pool II and Pool III Pool
          Available Amounts;"

               (iii)  third, in the case of Pool I and Pool IV, to make deposits
          into the Spread Account, if any, until the amount therein is at its
          required level;

               (iv) fourth, to reimburse the Servicer and/or The Money Store,
          Inc. for certain amounts owing to it with respect to the applicable
          Pool;

               (v) fifth, to pay the holders of the Pool II Certificates any
          Certificateholders' Interest Carryover owing for such Remittance Date
          and all prior Remittance Dates (but only with respect to collections
          relating to Pool II Home Equity Loans);

                                      S-89
<PAGE>
 
               (vi) sixth, in the case of Pool I and Pool IV, to pay the
          Certificateholders of the other such Pool (in the order provided for
          the payment of principal in the case of Pool I) an amount up to the
          amount of any Subordinated Deficiency Amount until its Specified
          Subordination Amount is reached;

               (vii)  seventh, to provide funds to the Certificates of the other
          Pools to cover current Realized Losses, pro rata, based on the amount
          so required by each such other Pool; and

               (viii)  eighth, to pay any remainder to the holders of the Class
          X Certificates and Class R Certificates as specified in the Agreement.

          The amount of principal received on a Pool of Loans and transferred to
     the other Pools pursuant to clauses (vi) and (vii) is referred to as the
     "Subordination Reduction Amount" with respect to the Pool from which such
     amounts are being transferred.

          The acceleration feature described above is intended to create, with
     respect to each Pool of Loans, an amount (the "Spread Amount"), resulting
     from, and generally equal to, the excess of (x) the sum of (i) the
     aggregate principal balances of the Loans in the related Pool as of the
     close of business on the last day of the related Due Period and (ii) any
     amount on deposit in the Pre-Funding Account and the Spread Account, if
     any, at such time and allocated to the related Pool and (y) the principal
     balances of the Certificates of the related Pool after making all
     distributions on such Remittance Date.  Applying Excess Spread to payment
     of principal on the Class A Certificates has the effect of accelerating the
     amortization of the Class A Certificates relative to the amortization of
     the Loans.  As a result of the foregoing, the holders of each Class of
     Class A Certificates may receive cash as credit support from any Loan in
     any Pool.

          The Spread Amount for a Pool constitutes the first level of credit
     support for the related Certificates.  If any Loan becomes a Liquidated
     Loan, the Net Liquidation Proceeds related thereto and allocated to
     principal may be less than the principal balance of the related Loan.  The
     amount of any such insufficiency is an "Unrecovered Portion." The existence
     of an Unrecovered Portion will reduce the Spread Amount with respect to the
     related Pool of Loans.  However, Certificateholders of the related Pool
     will be entitled to receive Excess Spread, either from the related Pool of
     Loans or the other Pools, in an amount equal to the Unrecovered Portion,
     subject to the limits described above.  Therefore, if sufficient Excess
     Spread is available (either on the current Remittance Date or on future
     Remittance Dates), Certificateholders will not realize a loss with respect
     to an Unrecovered Portion.

          If insufficient Excess Spread is available to pay Unrecovered
     Portions, the related Pool may experience a Subordination Deficit.  The
     Agreement defines a "Subordination Deficit" with respect to a Pool of Loans
     and Remittance Date to be the amount, if any, by which (x) the Principal
     Balances of the Certificates of the related Pool, after taking into account
     all distributions to be made on such Remittance Date (other than in the
     case of Pool I and Pool IV Certificates amounts payable with respect to
     principal under the applicable MBIA Policy) exceeds (y) the aggregate
     principal balances of the related Pool of Loans as of the close of business
     on the last day of the prior Due Period plus the amount, if any, on deposit
     in the Pre-Funding Account, and in the case of Pool I and Pool IV the
     amount, if any, in the Spread Account, on such date and allocated to such
     Pool of Loans.  The Trustee is required to make a claim for an Insured
     Payment under the related MBIA Policy with respect to any Remittance Date
     as to which the Trustee has determined that a Subordination Deficit will
     occur for the purpose of applying the proceeds of such Insured Payment as a
     payment of principal to the Certificateholders of the related Pool on such
     Remittance Date.  The MBIA Policies are thus similar to the provisions
     described above insofar as the MBIA Policies guarantee ultimate, rather
     than current, payment of the amounts of any Unrecovered Portions.
     Consequently, investors in the Pool I and Pool IV Class A Certificates
     should realize that, under extreme loss or delinquency scenarios applicable
     to the related Pool of Loans, so long as a Subordination Deficit has not
     resulted, they may temporarily receive no distributions of principal.

                                      S-90
<PAGE>
 
     CREDIT ENHANCEMENT DOES NOT APPLY TO PREPAYMENT AND CERTAIN OTHER RISKS

          In general, the protection afforded by the subordination provisions
     and by the MBIA Policies is protection for credit risk and not for
     prepayment risk and does not apply to the Certificateholders' Interest
     Carryover.  The subordination provisions may not be adjusted, nor may a
     claim be made under the MBIA Policies to guarantee or insure that any
     particular rate of prepayment is experienced by the Trust.

     REPORTS TO CERTIFICATEHOLDERS

          On each Remittance Date, the Trustee will be required to forward to
     each Holder of the Offered Certificates (which will be Cede, as registered
     Holder of each Class of Offered Certificates and the nominee of DTC, unless
     and until Definitive Certificates are issued), a statement which will set
     forth, among other things:

          (X) With respect to Pool I and Pool IV Certificates:

               (a) the Distribution Amounts for each such Pool on such
          Remittance Date, in the aggregate and by component and listed
          separately for the portions relating to each related Class of Pool I
          or Pool IV Certificates;

               (b) the Pool Principal Distribution Amounts for each such Pool
          for such Remittance Date, in the aggregate and listed separately for
          the portion relating to each related Class of Pool I or Pool IV
          Certificates;

               (c) the Current Interest Requirements for each related Class of
          Pool I or Pool IV Certificates for such Remittance Date;

               (d) the total amount of any Insured Payments included in the
          Distribution Amount for each such Pool on such Remittance Date, listed
          separately for each related Class of Pool I or Pool IV Certificates;

               (e) the Spread Amount and Specified Subordinated Amount for such
          Remittance Date, listed separately for each such Pool; and

               (f) the Class Principal Balances for each Class of Pool I or Pool
          IV Certificates and the Principal Factors (as defined below) after
          giving effect to the distributions of principal on each related Class
          of Pool I or Pool IV Certificates on such Remittance Date.

          (Y) With respect to Pool II and Pool III Certificates:

               (a) the amount of such distribution to Holders of each related
          Class of Certificates allocable to interest;

               (b) the amount of such distribution to holders of each related
          Class of Certificates allocable to principal;

               (c) the amount, if any, by which the applicable Formula Principal
          Distribution Amount for each Class exceeds the applicable Principal
          Distribution Amount for such Class for such Remittance Date;

               (d) the Class Principal Balance of related each Class of related
          Certificates after giving effect to the distribution of principal on
          such Remittance Date;

               (e) the applicable rate of LIBOR for such Remittance Date;

               (f) the Pass-Through Rate for each Class of Adjustable Rate
          Certificates or Auction Rate Certificates for such Remittance Date and
          if such Pass-Through Rate for any such Class was based on the
          applicable Net 

                                      S-91
<PAGE>
 
          Funds Cap, what it would be if based on LIBOR plus the applicable
          margin or Auction Rate, as the case may be;

               (g) the Net Funds Cap for the related Pool for such Remittance
          Date, stated separately, when applicable, for each Class of Adjustable
          Rate Certificates and Auction Rate Certificates;

               (h) if the Pass-Through Rate for any Class of Adjustable Rate
          Certificates or Auction Rate Certificates for such Remittance Date is
          based on the Net Funds Cap and such Class is entitled to receive
          Certificateholders' Interest Carryover, the amount of any
          Certificateholders' Interest Carryover allocated to such Class of
          Certificates for such Remittance Date;

               (i) the amount of the distribution, if any, allocable to
          Certificateholders' Interest Carryover and the amount of any unpaid
          Certificateholders' Interest Carryover for all prior Remittance Dates
          after giving effect to such distribution for each Class of Adjustable
          Rate Certificates or Auction Rate Certificates entitled to receive
          Certificateholders' Interest Carryover;

               (j) with respect to the FHA Loans, the dollar amounts of Claims
          filed, paid and denied during the related Due Period.

               (k) the related Senior Percentage and Class B Percentage for the
          current Remittance Date;

               (l) the Principal Factor for each related Class;

               (m) the Spread Amount and Specified Subordinated Amount for the
          related Pool for such Remittance Date;

               (n) the aggregate principal balance of the related Loans at the
          end of the preceding Due Period;

               (o) whether a Trigger Event or an S&P Trigger Event with respect
          to such Pool is in effect;

               (p) the amount of any Applied Realized Loss Amount, Realized Loss
          Amount and Unpaid Realized Loss Amount for each related Class as of
          the close of Business on such Remittance Date; and

               (q) the remaining Pool available Maximum Subordination Amount for
     the related Pool following such Remittance Date.

          (Z) With respect to all Classes of Offered Certificates:

               (a) the number and aggregate Principal Balances of Loans in each
          Pool delinquent (i) 31 to 59 days, (ii) 60 days to 89 days and (iii)
          90 days or more as of the end of the related Due Period; and

               (b) the number and aggregate Principal Balances of all Loans in
          each Pool in foreclosure or other similar proceedings and the number
          and aggregate Principal Balance of all Loans in each Pool relating to
          any REO Properties.

          As to any Remittance Date, the "Principal Factor" for a Class of
     Certificates will be a fraction, expressed as a percentage, the numerator
     of which is the Class Principal Balance for such Class (after giving effect
     to the distribution of principal on such Remittance Date), and the
     denominator of which is the original Class Principal Balance for such
     Class.

          In the case of information furnished pursuant to clauses (X)(a)
     through (c) and (Y)(a) through (d) above, the amounts will be expressed as
     a dollar amount per Certificate with a $1,000 principal denomination.

                                      S-92
<PAGE>
 
          Within 90 days after the end of each calendar year, the Trustee will
     be required to mail to each person who at any time was a Holder of an
     Offered Certificate during such year, a statement containing the
     information set forth in clauses (X)(a) through (c) and (Y)(a) through (d)
     above aggregated for such calendar year, or, in the case of each person who
     was a Holder of an Offered Certificate for a portion of such calendar year,
     setting forth such information for each month thereof.

          All reports prepared by the Trustee will be based upon statements
     supplied to the Trustee by the Servicer and the Claims Administrator.

     BOOK-ENTRY CERTIFICATES

          The Certificates will be book-entry Certificates (the "Book-Entry
     Certificates").  Persons acquiring beneficial ownership interests in the
     Certificates ("Certificate Owners") will hold their Certificates through
     DTC in the United States, or Cedel Bank or Euroclear (in Europe) if they
     are participants of such systems, or indirectly through organizations which
     are participants in such systems.  The Book-Entry Certificates will be
     issued in one or more certificates which equal the aggregate principal
     balance of the Certificates and will initially be registered in the name of
     Cede & Co., the nominee of DTC.  Cedel Bank and Euroclear will hold omnibus
     positions on behalf of their participants through customers' securities
     accounts in Cedel Bank's and Euroclear's names on the books of their
     respective depositaries which in turn will hold such positions in
     customers' securities accounts in the depositaries' names on the books of
     DTC.  Citibank N.A. will act as depositary for Cedel Bank and Morgan
     Guaranty Trust Company of New York, Brussels Office, will act as depositary
     for Euroclear (in such capacities, individually the "Relevant Depositary"
     and collectively the "European Depositaries").  Investors may hold such
     beneficial interests in the Book-Entry Certificates in minimum
     denominations representing Original Certificate Principal Balances of
     $1,000 and integral multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof (except for the
     Auction Rate Certificates, which may be held in minimum denominations
     representing Original Certificate Balances of $25,000 and integral
     multiples of $25,000 in excess thereof).  Except as described below, no
     person acquiring a Book-Entry Certificate (each, a "beneficial owner") will
     be entitled to receive a physical certificate representing such Certificate
     (a "Definitive Certificate").  Unless and until Definitive Certificates are
     issued, it is anticipated that the only "Certificateholder" of the
     Certificates will be Cede & Co., as nominee of DTC.  Certificate Owners
     will not be Certificateholders as that term is used in the Agreement.
     Certificate Owners are only permitted to exercise their rights indirectly
     through Participants and DTC.

          The beneficial owner's ownership of a Book-Entry Certificate will be
     recorded on the records of the brokerage firm, bank, thrift institution or
     other financial intermediary (each, a "Financial Intermediary") that
     maintains the beneficial owner's account for such purpose.  In turn, the
     Financial Intermediary's ownership of such Book-Entry Certificate will be
     recorded on the records of DTC (or of a participating firm that acts as
     agent for the Financial Intermediary, whose interest will in turn be
     recorded on the records of DTC, if the beneficial owner's Financial
     Intermediary is not a DTC participant and on the records of Cedel Bank or
     Euroclear, as appropriate).

          Certificate Owners will receive all distributions of principal of, and
     interest on, the Offered Certificates from the Trustee through DTC and DTC
     participants.  While the Offered Certificates are outstanding (except under
     the circumstances described below), under the rules, regulations and
     procedures creating and affecting DTC and its operations (the "Rules"), DTC
     is required to make book-entry transfers among Participants on whose behalf
     it acts with respect to the Offered Certificates and is required to receive
     and transmit distributions of principal of, and interest on, the Offered
     Certificates.  Participants and indirect participants with whom Certificate
     Owners have accounts with respect to Offered Certificates are similarly
     required to make book-entry transfers and receive and transmit such
     distributions on behalf of their respective Certificate Owners.
     Accordingly, although Certificate Owners will not possess certificates, the
     Rules provide a mechanism by which Certificate Owners will receive
     distributions and will be able to transfer their interest.

          Certificate Owners will not receive or be entitled to receive
     certificates representing their respective interests in the Offered
     Certificates, except under the limited circumstances described below.
     Unless and until Definitive 

                                      S-93
<PAGE>
 
     Certificates are issued, Certificate Owners who are not Participants may
     transfer ownership of Offered Certificates only through Participants and
     indirect participants by instructing such Participants and indirect
     participants to transfer Offered Certificates, by book-entry transfer,
     through DTC for the account of the purchasers of such Offered Certificates,
     which account is maintained with their respective Participants. Under the
     Rules and in accordance with DTC's normal procedures, transfers of
     ownership of Offered Certificates will be executed through DTC and the
     accounts of the respective Participants at DTC will be debited and
     credited. Similarly, the Participants and indirect participants will make
     debits or credits, as the case may be, on their records on behalf of the
     selling and purchasing Certificate Owners.

          Because of time zone differences, credits of securities received in
     Cedel Bank or Euroclear as a result of a transaction with a Participant
     will be made during subsequent securities settlement processing and dated
     the business day following the DTC settlement date.  Such credits or any
     transactions in such securities settled during such processing will be
     reported to the relevant Euroclear or Cedel Bank Participants on such
     business day.  Cash received in Cedel Bank or Euroclear as a result of
     sales of securities by or through a Cedel Bank Participant (as defined
     below) or Euroclear Participant (as defined below) to a DTC Participant
     will be received with value on the DTC settlement date but will be
     available in the relevant Cedel Bank or Euroclear cash account only as of
     the business day following settlement in DTC.  For information with respect
     to tax documentation procedures relating to the Certificates, see "GLOBAL
     CLEARANCE, SETTLEMENT AND TAX DOCUMENTATION PROCEDURES--Certain U.S.
     Federal Income Tax Documentation Requirements" in Annex I hereto.

          Transfers between Participants will occur in accordance with DTC
     rules.  Transfers between Cedel Bank Participants and Euroclear
     Participants will occur in accordance with their respective rules and
     operating procedures.

          Cross-market transfers between persons holding directly or indirectly
     through DTC, on the one hand, and directly or indirectly through Cedel Bank
     Participants or Euroclear Participants, on the other, will be effected in
     DTC in accordance with DTC rules on behalf of the relevant European
     international clearing system by the Relevant Depositary; however, such
     cross market transactions will require delivery of instructions to the
     relevant European international clearing system by the counterparty in such
     system in accordance with its rules and procedures and within its
     established deadlines (European time).  The relevant European international
     clearing system will, if the transaction meets its settlement requirements,
     deliver instructions to the Relevant Depositary to take action to effect
     final settlement on its behalf by delivering or receiving securities in
     DTC, and making or receiving payment in accordance with normal procedures
     for same day funds settlement applicable to DTC.  Cedel Bank Participants
     and Euroclear Participants may not deliver instructions directly to the
     European Depositaries.

          DTC, which is a New York-chartered limited purpose trust company,
     performs services for its participants, some of which (and/or their
     representatives) own DTC.  In accordance with its normal procedures, DTC is
     expected to record the positions held by each DTC participant in the Book-
     Entry Certificates, whether held for its own account or as a nominee for
     another person.  In general, beneficial ownership of Book-Entry
     Certificates will be subject to the rules, regulations and procedures
     governing DTC and DTC participants as in effect from time to time.

          Cedel Bank is incorporated under the laws of Luxembourg as a
     professional depository.  Cedel Bank holds securities for its participating
     organizations ("Cedel Bank Participants") and facilitates the clearance and
     settlement of securities transactions between Cedel Bank Participants
     through electronic book-entry changes in accounts of Cedel Bank
     Participants, thereby eliminating the need for physical movement of
     certificates.  Transactions may be settled in Cedel Bank in any of 28
     currencies, including United States dollars.  Cedel Bank provides to its
     Cedel Bank Participants, among other things, services for safekeeping,
     administration, clearance and settlement of internationally traded
     securities and securities lending and borrowing.  Cedel Bank interfaces
     with domestic markets in several countries.  As a professional depository,
     Cedel Bank is subject to regulation by the Luxembourg Monetary Institute.
     Cedel Bank Participants are recognized financial institutions around the
     world, including underwriters, securities brokers and dealers, banks, trust
     companies, clearing corporations and certain other organizations.  Indirect
     access to Cedel Bank is also available to others, such as banks, brokers,
     dealers and trust companies that clear through or maintain a custodial
     relationship with a Cedel Bank Participant, either directly or indirectly.

                                      S-94
<PAGE>
 
          Euroclear was created in 1968 to hold securities for its participants
     ("Euroclear Participants") and to clear and settle transactions between
     Euroclear Participants through simultaneous electronic book-entry delivery
     against payment, thereby eliminating the need for physical movement of
     certificates and any risk from lack of simultaneous transfers of securities
     and cash.  Transactions may be settled in any of 32 currencies, including
     United States dollars.  Euroclear includes various other services,
     including securities lending and borrowing and interfaces with domestic
     markets in several countries generally similar to the arrangements for
     cross-market transfers with DTC described above.  Euroclear is operated by
     the Brussels, Belgium office of Morgan Guaranty Trust Company of New York
     (the "Euroclear Operator"), under contract with Euroclear Clearance Systems
     S.C., a Belgian cooperative corporation (the "Cooperative").  All
     operations are conducted by the Euroclear Operator, and all Euroclear
     securities clearance accounts and Euroclear cash accounts are accounts with
     the Euroclear Operator, not the Cooperative.  The Cooperative establishes
     policy for Euroclear on behalf of Euroclear Participants.  Euroclear
     Participants include banks (including central banks), securities brokers
     and dealers and other professional financial intermediaries.  Indirect
     access to Euroclear is also available to other firms that clear through or
     maintain a custodial relationship with a Euroclear Participant, either
     directly or indirectly.

          The Euroclear Operator is the Belgian branch of a New York banking
     corporation which is a member bank of the Federal Reserve System.  As such,
     it is regulated and examined by the Board of Governors of the Federal
     Reserve System and the New York State Banking Department, as well as the
     Belgian Banking Commission.

          Securities clearance accounts and cash accounts with the Euroclear
     Operator are governed by the Terms and Conditions Governing Use of
     Euroclear and the related Operating Procedures of the Euroclear System and
     applicable Belgian law (collectively, the "Terms and Conditions").  The
     Terms and Conditions govern transfers of securities and cash within
     Euroclear, withdrawals of securities and cash from Euroclear, and receipts
     of payments with respect to securities in Euroclear.  All securities in
     Euroclear are held on a fungible basis without attribution of specific
     certificates to specific securities clearance accounts.  The Euroclear
     Operator acts under the Terms and Conditions only on behalf of Euroclear
     Participants, and has no record of or relationship with persons holding
     through Euroclear Participants.

          Distributions on the Book-Entry Certificates will be made on each
     Distribution Date by the Trustee to DTC.  DTC will be responsible for
     crediting the amount of such payments to the accounts of the applicable DTC
     participants in accordance with DTC's normal procedures.  Each DTC
     participant will be responsible for disbursing such payments to the
     beneficial owners of the Book-Entry Certificates that it represents and to
     each Financial Intermediary for which it acts as agent.  Each such
     Financial Intermediary will be responsible for disbursing funds to the
     beneficial owners of the Book-Entry Certificates that it represents.

          Under a book-entry format, beneficial owners of the Book-Entry
     Certificates may experience some delay in their receipt of payments, since
     such payments will be forwarded by the Trustee to Cede.  Distributions with
     respect to Certificates held through Cedel Bank or Euroclear will be
     credited to the cash accounts of Cedel Bank Participants or Euroclear
     Participants in accordance with the relevant system's rules and procedures,
     to the extent received by the Relevant Depositary.  Such distributions will
     be subject to tax reporting in accordance with relevant United States tax
     laws and regulations.  Because DTC can only act on behalf of Financial
     Intermediaries, the ability of a beneficial owner to pledge Book-Entry
     Certificates to persons or entities that do not participate in the
     Depository system, or otherwise take actions in respect of such Book-Entry
     Certificates, may be limited due to the lack of physical certificates for
     such Book-Entry Certificates.  In addition, issuance of the Book-Entry
     Certificates in book-entry form may reduce the liquidity of such
     Certificates in the secondary market since certain potential investors may
     be unwilling to purchase Certificates for which they cannot obtain physical
     certificates.

          Monthly and annual reports on the Trust will be provided to Cede &
     Co., as nominee of DTC, and may be made available by Cede & Co. to
     beneficial owners upon request, in accordance with the rules, regulations
     and procedures creating and affecting the Depository, and to the Financial
     Intermediaries to whose DTC accounts the Book-Entry Certificates of such
     beneficial owners are credited.

                                      S-95
<PAGE>
 
          DTC has advised the Trustee that, unless and until Definitive
     Certificates are issued, DTC will take any action permitted to be taken by
     the holders of the Book-Entry Certificates under the Agreement only at the
     direction of one or more Financial Intermediaries to whose DTC accounts the
     Book-Entry Certificates are credited, to the extent that such actions are
     taken on behalf of Financial Intermediaries whose holdings include such
     Book-Entry Certificates, Cedel Bank or the Euroclear Operator, as the case
     may be, will take any other action permitted to be taken by a
     Certificateholder under the Agreement on behalf of a Cedel Bank Participant
     or Euroclear Participant only in accordance with its relevant rules and
     procedures and subject to the ability of the Relevant Depositary to effect
     such actions on its behalf through DTC.  DTC may take actions, at the
     direction of the related Participants, with respect to some Offered
     Certificates which conflict with actions taken with respect to other
     Offered Certificates.

          Definitive  Certificates will be issued to beneficial owners of the
     Book-Entry Certificates, or their nominees, rather than to DTC, only if (a)
     DTC or the Depositor advises the Trustee in writing that DTC is no longer
     willing, qualified or able to discharge properly its responsibilities as
     nominee and depository with respect to the Book-Entry Certificates and the
     Depositor or the Trustee is unable to locate a qualified successor, (b) the
     Depositor, at its sole option, with the consent of the Trustee, elects to
     terminate a book-entry system through DTC or (c) after the occurrence of an
     Event of Servicing Termination (as defined herein), beneficial owners
     having Percentage Interests aggregating not less than 51% of the aggregate
     Principal Balance of the Book-Entry Certificates advise the Trustee and DTC
     through the Financial Intermediaries and the DTC participants in writing
     that the continuation of a book-entry system through DTC (or a successor
     thereto) is no longer in the best interests of beneficial owners.

          Upon the occurrence of any of the events described in the immediately
     preceding paragraph, the Trustee will be required to notify all beneficial
     owners of the occurrence of such event and the availability through DTC of
     Definitive Offered Certificates.  Upon surrender by DTC of the global
     certificate or certificates representing the Book-Entry Certificates and
     instructions for re-registration, the Trustee will issue Definitive
     Certificates, and thereafter the Trustee will recognize the holders of such
     Definitive Certificates and Certificateholders under the Agreement.

          Although DTC, Cedel Bank and Euroclear have agreed to the foregoing
     procedures in order to facilitate transfers of Offered Certificates among
     participants of DTC, Cedel Bank and Euroclear, they are under no obligation
     to perform or continue to perform such procedures and such procedures may
     be discontinued at any time.

          None of the Seller, the Servicer or the Trustee will have any
     responsibility for any aspect of the records relating to or payments made
     on account of beneficial ownership interests of the Book-Entry Certificates
     held by Cede & Co., as nominee for DTC, or for maintaining, supervising or
     reviewing any records relating to such beneficial ownership interests.

                           THE MBIA POLICIES AND MBIA

          The following information has been furnished by MBIA for use herein.

          MBIA, in consideration of the payment of the premium and subject to
     the terms of the MBIA Policies, unconditionally and irrevocably guarantees
     to any Owner (as described below) that an amount equal to each full and
     complete Insured Payment will be received by the Trustee, or its successor,
     on behalf of the Owners, for distribution by the Trustee to each Owner of
     each Owner's proportionate share of the Insured Payment. MBIA's obligations
     under the MBIA Policies with respect to a particular Insured Payment shall
     be discharged to the extent funds equal to the applicable Insured Payment
     are received by the Trustee, whether or not such funds are properly applied
     by the Trustee.  Insured Payments shall be made only at the time set forth
     in the MBIA Policies and no accelerated Insured Payments shall be made
     regardless of any acceleration of the Class A Certificates, unless such
     acceleration is at the sole option of MBIA.

          THE MBIA POLICIES DO NOT COVER ANY AMOUNTS DUE ON POOL II OR POOL III
     CERTIFICATES.  In addition, notwithstanding the foregoing paragraph, the
     MBIA Policies do not cover shortfalls, if any, attributable to the
     liability 

                                      S-96
<PAGE>
 
     of the Trust, the REMICs or the Trustee for withholding taxes, if any
     (including interest and penalties in respect of any such liability).
     Further, the MBIA Policies do not guaranty payment of any
     Certificateholders' Interest Carryover.

          MBIA will pay any Insured Payment that is a Preference Amount on the
     Business Day (as described below) following receipt on a Business Day by
     the Fiscal Agent (as defined below) of (i) a certified copy of the order
     requiring the return of a preference payment, (ii) an opinion of counsel
     satisfactory to MBIA that such order is final and not subject to appeal,
     (iii) an assignment in such form as is reasonably required by MBIA,
     irrevocably assigning to MBIA all rights and claims of the Owner relating
     to or arising under the applicable Class of Pool I or Pool IV Certificates
     against the debtor which made such preference payment or otherwise with
     respect to such preference payment and (iv) appropriate instruments to
     effect the appointment of MBIA as agent for such Owner in any legal
     proceeding related to such preference payment, such instruments being in a
     form satisfactory to MBIA, provided that if such documents are received
     after 12:00 noon New York City time on such Business Day, they will be
     deemed to be received on the following Business Day. Such payments shall be
     disbursed to the receiver or trustee in bankruptcy named in the final order
     of the court exercising jurisdiction on behalf of the Owner and not to any
     Owner directly unless such Owner has returned principal or interest paid on
     the applicable Class of Pool I or Pool IV Certificate to such receiver or
     trustee in bankruptcy, in which case such payment shall be disbursed to
     such Owner.

          MBIA will pay any other amount payable under the MBIA Policies no
     later than 12:00 noon New York City time on the later of the Remittance
     Date on which the Distribution Amount is due or the Business Day following
     receipt in New York, New York on a Business Day by State Street Bank and
     Trust Company, N.A., as Fiscal Agent for MBIA or any successor fiscal agent
     appointed by MBIA (the "Fiscal Agent") of a Notice (as described below);
     provided that if such Notice is received after 12:00 noon New York City
     time on such Business Day, it will be deemed to be received on the
     following Business Day.  If any such Notice received by the Fiscal Agent is
     not in proper form or is otherwise insufficient for the purpose of making
     claim under the MBIA Policies, such Notice shall be deemed not to have been
     received by the Fiscal Agent for purposes of this paragraph, and MBIA or
     the Fiscal Agent, as the case may be, shall promptly so advise the Trustee
     and the Trustee may submit an amended Notice.

          Insured Payments due under the MBIA Policies unless otherwise stated
     in the MBIA Policies will be disbursed by the Fiscal Agent to the Trustee
     on behalf of the Owners by wire transfer of immediately available funds in
     the amount of the Insured Payment less, in respect of Insured Payments
     related to Preference Amounts, any amount held by the Trustee for the
     payment of such Insured Payment and legally available therefor.

          The Fiscal Agent is the agent of MBIA only and the Fiscal Agent shall
     in no event be liable to Owners for any acts of the Fiscal Agent or any
     failure of MBIA to deposit, or cause to be deposited, sufficient funds to
     make payments due under the MBIA Policies.

          As used in the MBIA Policies, the following terms shall have the
     following meanings:

          "Agreement" means the Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of
     August 31, 1997 among The Money Store Inc., as Representative, Servicer and
     Claims Administrator, the Originators listed therein and the Trustee, as
     trustee, without regard to any amendment or supplement thereto.

          "Business Day" means any day other than a Saturday, a Sunday or a day
     on which MBIA and banking institutions in New York City or in the city in
     which the corporate trust office of the Trustee under the Agreement is
     located are authorized or obligated by law or executive order to close.

          "Deficiency Amount" means with respect to any Remittance Date and with
     respect to the Pool I or Pool IV Certificates, (i) the excess, if any, of
     (a) the Current Interest Requirement for such Pool over (b) the sum of the
     Available Remittance Amount for such Pool (minus amounts withdrawn to pay
     required premiums to MBIA), and the Excess Spread and the Subordination
     Reduction Amount applicable to such Pool, plus (ii) the Subordination
     Deficit, if any, for such Pool with respect to such Remittance Date.

                                      S-97
<PAGE>
 
          "Insured Payment" means (i) as of any Remittance Date, any Deficiency
     Amount and (ii) any Preference Amount.

          "Notice" means the telephonic or telegraphic notice, promptly
     confirmed in writing by telecopy substantially in the form of Exhibit A
     attached to the related MBIA Policy, the original of which is subsequently
     delivered by registered or certified mail, from the Trustee specifying the
     Insured Payment which shall be due and owing on the applicable Remittance
     Date.

          "Owner" means each holder (other than the Trust) of a Pool I and Pool
     IV Certificate who, on the applicable Remittance Date, is entitled under
     the terms of the applicable Class of Pool I and Pool IV Certificates to
     payment thereunder.

          "Preference Amount" means any amount previously distributed to an
     Owner on the Certificates that is recoverable and sought to be recovered as
     a voidable preference by a trustee in bankruptcy pursuant to the United
     States Bankruptcy Code (11 U.S.C.), as amended from time to time, in
     accordance with a final nonappealable order of a court having competent
     jurisdiction.

          Capitalized terms used in the MBIA Policies and not otherwise defined
     therein shall have the respective meanings set forth in the Agreement as of
     the date of execution of the MBIA Policies, without giving effect to any
     subsequent amendment or modification to the Agreement.

          Any notice under the MBIA Policies or service of process on the Fiscal
     Agent may be made at the address listed below for the Fiscal Agent or such
     other address as MBIA shall specify in writing to the Trustee.

          The notice address of the Fiscal Agent is 15/th/ Floor, 61 Broadway,
     New York, New York 10006, Attention: Municipal Registrar and Paying Agency,
     or such other address as the Fiscal Agent shall specify to the Trustee in
     writing.

          The MBIA Policies were issued under and pursuant to, and shall be
     construed under, the laws of the State of New York, without giving effect
     to the conflict of laws principles thereof.

          The insurance provided by the MBIA Policies are not covered by the
     Property/Casualty Insurance Security Fund specified in Article 76 of the
     New York Insurance Law.

          The MBIA Policies are not cancelable for any reason.  The premiums on
     the MBIA Policies are not refundable for any reason including payment, or
     provision being made for payment, prior to maturity of the Pool I or Pool
     IV Certificates.

          MBIA is the principal operating subsidiary of MBIA Inc., a New York
     Stock Exchange listed company.  MBIA Inc. is not obligated to pay the debts
     of or claims against MBIA.  MBIA is domiciled in the State of New York and
     licensed to do business in and is subject to regulation under the laws of
     all 50 states, the District of Columbia, the Commonwealth of Puerto Rico,
     the Commonwealth of the Northern Mariana Islands, the Virgin Islands of the
     United States and the Territory of Guam.  MBIA has two European branches,
     one in the Republic of France and the other in the Kingdom of Spain.  New
     York has laws prescribing minimum capital requirements, limiting classes
     and concentrations of investments and requiring the approval of policy
     rates and forms.  State laws also regulate the amount of both the aggregate
     and individual risks that may be insured, the payment of dividends by MBIA,
     changes in control and transactions among affiliates.  Additionally, MBIA
     is required to maintain contingency reserves on its liabilities in certain
     amounts and for certain periods of time.

          The consolidated financial statements of MBIA, a wholly owned
     subsidiary of MBIA Inc., and its subsidiaries  as of December 31, 1996 and
     December 31, 1995 and for each of the three years in the period ended
     December 31, 1996, prepared in accordance with generally accepted
     accounting principles, included in the Annual Report on Form 

                                      S-98
<PAGE>
 
     10-K for MBIA Inc. for the year ended December 31, 1996 and the
     consolidated financial statements of MBIA and its subsidiaries as of June
     30, 1997 and for the six month periods ended June 30, 1997 and June 30,
     1996 included in the Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for MBIA Inc. for the
     period ending June 30, 1997, are hereby incorporated by reference into this
     Prospectus Supplement and shall be deemed to be a part hereof. Any
     statement contained in a document incorporated by reference herein shall be
     modified or superseded for purposes of this Prospectus Supplement to the
     extent that a statement contained herein or in any other subsequently filed
     document which is also incorporated by reference herein modifies or
     supersedes such statement. Any statement so modified or superseded shall
     not be deemed, except as so modified or superseded, to constitute a part of
     this Prospectus Supplement.

          All financial statements of MBIA and its subsidiaries included in
     documents filed by MBIA Inc. pursuant to Section 13(a), 13(c), 14 or 15(d)
     of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, subsequent to the date
     of this Prospectus Supplement and prior to the termination of the offering
     of the Class A Certificates shall be deemed to be incorporated by reference
     into this Prospectus Supplement and to be a part hereof from the respective
     dates of filing such documents.

          The table below presents selected financial information of MBIA
     determined in accordance with statutory accounting practices prescribed or
     permitted by insurance regulatory authorities ("SAP") and generally
     accepted accounting principles ("GAAP"):

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                  SAP                                                           GAAP
                                  ------------------------------------                              -----------------------------
                                     DECEMBER 31          JUNE 30                                   DECEMBER 31       JUNE 30
                                        1996               1997                                         1996           1997
                                  -----------------  -----------------                              ------------  ---------------
                                      (AUDITED)         (UNAUDITED)                                  (AUDITED)      (UNAUDITED)
                                             (IN MILLIONS)                                                  (IN MILLIONS)
<S>                               <C>                <C>                <C>                         <C>           <C>
Admitted Assets.................            $4,476             $4,824   Assets....................       $5,066           $5,408
Liabilities.....................             3,009              3,259   Liabilities...............        2,262            2,412
Capital and Surplus.............             1,467              1,565   Shareholder's Equity......        2,804            2,996
</TABLE>


          Copies of the financial statements of MBIA incorporated by reference
     herein and copies of MBIA's 1996 year-end audited financial statements
     prepared in accordance with statutory accounting practices are available,
     without charge, from MBIA. The address of MBIA is 113 King Street, Armonk,
     New York 10504. The telephone number of MBIA is (914) 273-4545.

          MBIA does not accept any responsibility for the accuracy or
     completeness of this Prospectus Supplement or the Prospectus or any
     information or disclosure contained herein or therein, or omitted herefrom
     or therefrom, other than with respect to the accuracy of the information
     regarding the MBIA Policies and MBIA set forth under the heading "The MBIA
     Policies and MBIA" herein. Additionally, MBIA makes no representation
     regarding the Offered Certificates or the advisability of investing in the
     Offered Certificates.

          Moody's rates the claims paying ability of MBIA "Aaa." S&P rates the
     claims paying ability of MBIA "AAA." Fitch Investors Service, L.P. rates
     the claims paying ability of MBIA "AAA." Each rating of MBIA should be
     evaluated independently. The ratings reflect the respective rating agency's
     current assessment of the creditworthiness of MBIA and its ability to pay
     claims on its policies of insurance. Any further explanation as to the
     significance of the above ratings may be obtained only from the applicable
     rating agency.

          The above ratings are not recommendations to buy, sell or hold the
     Certificates, and such ratings may be subject to revisions or withdrawal at
     any time by the rating agencies.  Any downward revision or withdrawal of
     any of the above ratings may have an adverse effect on the market price of
     the Pool I and Pool IV Certificates.  MBIA does not guaranty the market
     price of the Pool I or Pool IV Certificates nor does it guaranty that the
     ratings on the Pool I of Pool IV Certificates will not be revised or
     withdrawn.

                                      S-99
<PAGE>
 
                                 THE AGREEMENT

          In addition to the provisions of the Agreement summarized elsewhere in
     this Prospectus Supplement, set forth below is a summary of certain other
     provisions thereof. Certain capitalized terms used in this section and not
     otherwise defined, have the meanings set forth in the Prospectus.

     REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES

          In addition to the representations and warranties as to each Loan
     described under the caption "The Agreements--Representations and
     Warranties" in the Prospectus, (i) the Representative will represent in the
     Agreement that each FHA Loan is an FHA Title I loan, underwritten in
     accordance with applicable FHA requirements and submitted to the FHA for
     insurance; (ii) each Originator will represent that, assuming sufficient
     coverage remains available in the Reserve Amount, each Claim filed by the
     Claims Administrator with respect to a 90 Day Delinquent FHA Loan will be
     honored by the FHA in accordance with the rules and regulations of the FHA;
     (iii) substantially all the proceeds of each Pool III Loan have been or
     will be used to acquire or to improve or protect an interest in real
     property that, at the origination date of such Pool III Loan, was the only
     security for such Pool III Loan; and (iv) for each Pool III Loan, after
     giving effect to all improvements to be made on the related Mortgaged
     Property with the proceeds of such Loan, and based upon representations of
     the related Obligor, the value of the related Mortgaged Property will at
     least be equal to the amount of such Pool III Loan and the outstanding
     amount of all other loans secured by prior liens on such Mortgaged
     Property.

          The Servicer will also covenant that it will: (a) comply with all FHA
     rules and regulations and will maintain its status as an approved lender
     and will at all times hold a valid contract of insurance (unless such
     contract is terminated so as not to affect the obligation of FHA to provide
     insurance coverage with respect to the FHA Loans); (b) promptly pay all
     insurance charges and take all action necessary to maintain insurance on
     the FHA Loans; (c) immediately pay, or, if the Servicer is no longer the
     Claims Administrator, cause the Claims Administrator to pay, in full, any
     FHA Payment into the Principal and Interest Account; and (d) with certain
     exceptions, not allow any modifications or assumptions of the FHA Loans
     that would vary their terms.

     OBLIGATION OF THE CLAIMS ADMINISTRATOR

          If any FHA Loan becomes a 90 Day Delinquent FHA Loan, and if
     sufficient coverage is available in the Reserve Amount to make an FHA
     Payment with respect to such FHA Loan, the Claims Administrator may, in its
     sole discretion, during any subsequent Due Period, determine to file a
     Claim with the FHA with respect to such 90 Day Delinquent FHA Loan. If the
     Claims Administrator determines to file such a Claim, the Claims
     Administrator will so notify the Co-Trustee and the Custodian no later than
     the Determination Date following such determination and shall request
     delivery of the related Trustee's Loan File. Upon receipt of such
     certification and request, the Custodian shall, no later than the related
     Remittance Date, release to the Claims Administrator the related Trustee's
     Loan File and the Co-Trustee and the Custodian shall execute and deliver
     such instruments necessary to enable the Claims Administrator to file a
     Claim with the FHA on behalf of the Co-Trustee. Within 120 days of its
     receipt of the related Trustee's Loan File, the Claims Administrator shall,
     in its sole discretion, either file a Claim with the FHA for an FHA Payment
     with respect to such 90 Day Delinquent FHA Loan or, if the Claims
     Administrator determines not to file such a Claim, return to the Co-Trustee
     the related Trustee's Loan File.

          With respect to any 90 Day Delinquent FHA Loan transferred to the
     Claims Administrator as described above, the Claims Administrator shall
     deposit (or, if the Claims Administrator is not also the Servicer, the
     Claims Administrator shall instruct the Servicer to deposit) in the
     Principal and Interest Account within 24 hours of receipt or determination
     thereof the following amounts (such amounts to be net of certain amounts
     that would be reimbursable to the Servicer under the Agreement with respect
     to amounts in the Principal and Interest Account): (i) any FHA Payments;
     (ii) the amount, if any, by which the FHA Payment was reduced in accordance
     with FHA Regulations due to the Claims Administrator enforcing a lien on
     the FHA Property prior to the lien of the related 90 Day Delinquent FHA
     Loan; and (iii) any principal and interest payments received with respect
     to a 90 Day Delinquent FHA Loan after the 

                                     S-100
<PAGE>
 
          Due Period in which the FHA Loan is transferred to the Claims
     Administrator and before either the related FHA Payment is paid or the
     related Trustee's Loan File is returned to the Co-Trustee, as the case may
     be (the amounts referred to in (ii) and (iii) above are referenced to
     herein as "Related Payments").

          If an FHA Loan becomes a 90 Day Delinquent FHA Loan when there is
     insufficient coverage in the Reserve Amount, or if the Claims Administrator
     determines not to file a Claim with the FHA with respect to such 90 Day
     Delinquent FHA Loan, the Co-Trustee will not transfer such FHA Loan to the
     Claims Administrator, no Claim will be made to the FHA and the Servicer may
     take other action, including the commencement of foreclosure proceedings,
     on the related Mortgaged Property.

     FHA PREMIUM ACCOUNT

          The FHA Premium Account will be established with the Trustee and will
     be available to reimburse the Claims Administrator for the payment to the
     FHA of the FHA Insurance Premium on each FHA Loan in the Trust. The FHA
     Insurance Premium is an annual premium equal to 0.5% of the original
     principal balance of the FHA Loan. If the related Mortgagor pays the FHA
     Insurance Premium in addition to the Monthly Payment, any payment of the
     FHA Insurance Premium received during a Due Period will be deposited in the
     FHA Premium Account on the related Remittance Date. In certain states, the
     Servicer is prohibited from directly collecting the FHA Insurance Premium
     from the related Mortgagor. With respect to FHA Loans secured by Mortgaged
     Properties located in such states, the Servicer will cause to be deposited
     in the FHA Premium Account a specified percentage of each scheduled
     interest payment. Since a Mortgagor pays interest on the declining
     principal balance of the related FHA Loan and the FHA Insurance Premium is
     based upon the original principal balance of the FHA Loan, the amount of
     interest allocated to the FHA Premium Account may be more or less than the
     amount of the related FHA Insurance Premium. The Servicer has agreed to
     satisfy any resulting shortfall from its own funds.

     PRE-FUNDING ACCOUNT

          On the Closing Date, an aggregate cash amount (the "Pre-Funded
     Amount") will be deposited into the Pre-Funding Account in an amount not to
     exceed approximately $40,000,000, in the case of Pool I, approximately
     $125,000,000, in the case of Pool II, approximately $100,000,000, in the
     case of Pool III and approximately $6,250,000, in the case of Pool IV.
     Amounts allocated to Pool I, Pool II, Pool III and Pool IV, as the case may
     be, may be used only (i) to acquire Subsequent Loans for the related Pool
     and (ii) to make accelerated payments of principal on the Certificates of
     the related Pool. During the period (the "Funding Period") from the Closing
     Date until the earliest of (i) the date on which the amount on deposit in
     the Pre-Funding Account is less than $200,000, (ii) the date on which an
     Event of Default occurs under the Agreement or (iii) at the close of
     business on December 26, 1997, amounts will, from time to time, be
     withdrawn from the Pre-Funding Account to purchase Subsequent Loans in
     accordance with the Agreement. Any Pre-Funded Amount remaining at the end
     of the Funding Period will be distributed as a principal prepayment on the
     next Remittance Date to the Certificates of the related Pool. However, any
     Pre-Funded Amount remaining at the close of business on December 26, 1997
     will be distributed as a principal prepayment on the Special Remittance
     Date to the Certificates of the related Pool. The Pre-Funding Account
     moneys funded from the sale of the Certificates of a given Pool, may not be
     used to acquire Loans relating to the other Pool.

          All funds in the Pre-Funding Account are required to be held (i)
     uninvested, up to the limits insured by the Federal Deposit Insurance
     Corporation or (ii) invested in instruments designated as "Permitted
     Instruments" in the Agreement. Any investment earnings on funds in the Pre-
     Funding Account will be applied to payment of interest on the Certificates.

     CAPITALIZED INTEREST ACCOUNT

          On the Closing Date, the Representative also will make a cash deposit
     in an account (the "Capitalized Interest Account") in the name of the
     Trustee on behalf of the Trust. The amount deposited therein will be used
     by the Trustee on the Remittance Dates occurring in October, November and
     December 1997 to fund the excess, if any, of (i) the 

                                     S-101
<PAGE>
 
     amount of interest accrued for each such Remittance Date at the weighted
     average Pass-Through Rate of the Certificates on the portion of the
     Certificates having principal balances exceeding the principal balances of
     the Loans over (ii) the amount of any earnings on funds in the Pre-Funding
     Account that are available to pay interest on the Certificates on each such
     Remittance Date. Additionally, if a principal prepayment is made on the
     Special Remittance Date to the Certificates, such Certificates also will
     receive on such date, from the Capitalized Interest Account, accrued
     interest at the applicable Pass-Through Rates on the amount of such
     principal prepayment. Any amounts remaining in the Capitalized Interest
     Account on the Special Remittance Date and not used for such purposes are
     required to be paid directly to the holders of the Class R Certificates on
     such Special Remittance Date.

          All funds in the Capitalized Interest Account are required to be held
     (i) uninvested, up to the limits insured by the Federal Deposit Insurance
     Corporation or (ii) invested in Permitted Instruments. Any investment
     earnings on funds in the Capitalized Interest Account will be applied to
     payment of interest on the Certificates.

     PAYMENTS ON THE LOANS

          The Agreement requires the Servicer to establish and maintain one or
     more principal and interest accounts (each, a "Principal and Interest
     Account") at one or more institutions designated as a "Designated
     Depository Institution" in the Agreement.

          All funds in the Principal and Interest Accounts are required to be
     held (i) uninvested, up to the limits insured by the Federal Deposit
     Insurance Corporation or (ii) invested in Permitted Instruments. Any
     investment earnings on funds held in the Principal and Interest Accounts
     are for the account of the Servicer.

          The Servicer is required to deposit in the related Principal and
     Interest Account (within 24 hours of receipt) all payments received after
     the Cut-Off Date on account of principal and interest on the related Loans
     (but net of the Servicing Fee and the Contingency Fee with respect to each
     Loan, other servicing compensation payable to the Servicer as permitted by
     the Agreement and any amounts required to be deposited into the Servicing
     Accounts referred to below).

          Not later than the day of each month which is the later of (i) the
     third Business Day prior to the 15th day of such month and (ii) the seventh
     Business Day of such month (each such day a "Determination Date"), the
     Servicer is required to wire transfer to the Trustee the Available
     Remittance Amounts for each Pool for deposit in the segregated trust
     accounts maintained with the Trustee for such purpose (each a "Certificate
     Account").

          The "Available Remittance Amount" for each Pool is defined in the
     Agreement to include, with respect to any Remittance Date, without
     duplication:

               (i) the sum of all amounts received by the Servicer or any
          Subservicer on the Loans of such Pool (including amounts paid by the
          Servicer and the Representative and excluding (a) any Excess Spread
          and Subordination Reduction Amounts included in such amounts, (b)
          amounts paid as reimbursement to the Servicer of advances, (c) amounts
          retained by the Servicer with respect to the Servicing Fee and the
          Contingency Fee, (d) amounts deposited into the Servicing Accounts and
          (e) amounts recovered as voidable preferences), during the immediately
          preceding calendar month (the "Due Period"), plus

               (ii) the amount of any Monthly Advances and Compensating Interest
          payments with respect to the Loans of such Pool remitted by the
          Servicer for such Remittance Date, plus

               (iii) amounts to be transferred to the applicable Certificate
          Account from the Pre-Funding Account and the Capitalized Interest
          Account.

          The term Available Remittance Amount does not include Insured
     Payments.

                                     S-102
<PAGE>
 
          The Agreement also will require the Servicer to establish and
     maintain, in addition to the Principal and Interest Accounts one or more
     accounts (each a "Servicing Account") in a depository institution the
     deposits of which are insured by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation
     to the maximum extent permitted by law.  The Servicer will deposit and
     retain therein all collections from the Obligors for the payment of taxes,
     assessments, insurance premiums, or comparable items as agent of the
     Obligors and in trust as provided in the Agreement.  Amounts in any
     Servicing Account may relate to mortgage loans in more than one mortgage
     pool or to mortgage loans not yet included in a mortgage pool.  All funds
     in the Servicing Accounts are required to be held (i) uninvested, up to the
     limits insured by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation or (ii)
     invested in Permitted Instruments.  Any investment earnings on funds held
     in the Servicing Accounts are for the account of the Servicer.  Withdrawals
     of amounts from the Servicing Accounts may be made only to effect timely
     payment of taxes, assessments, insurance premiums, or comparable items, to
     reimburse the Servicer for any advances made with respect to such items, to
     refund to any Obligors any sums as may be determined to be overages, to pay
     interest, if required, to Obligors on balances in the Servicing Accounts,
     to pay earnings not required to be paid to Obligors to the Servicer or to
     clear and terminate the Servicing Accounts at or at any time after the
     termination of the Agreement.

     MONTHLY ADVANCES AND COMPENSATING INTEREST

          Not later than the close of business on each Determination Date, the
     Servicer is required to remit to the Trustee for deposit in the applicable
     Certificate Account an amount equal to the amount, if any, by which, for
     each Pool (a) the sum of (x) 30 days' interest (or, with respect to the
     Adjustable Rate Certificates and the Auction Rate Certificates, the actual
     number of days from the last Remittance Date (or, in the case of the first
     Remittance Date, from September 15, 1997 with respect to the Adjustable
     Rate Certificates and from the Closing Date with respect to the Auction
     Rate Certificates) up to but not including the upcoming Remittance Date) at
     the weighted average Adjusted Mortgage Loan Remittance Rates of such Pool
     on the aggregate outstanding Class Principal Balances of each Class of
     Certificates in such Pool immediately prior to the related Remittance Date
     and (y) the Excess Spread, if any, for the related Remittance Date relating
     to the Loans of the related Pool exceeds (b) the amount received by the
     Servicer in respect of interest on the Loans of the related Pool as of the
     related Record Date (and, with respect to the Remittance Dates in October,
     November and December 1997, the sum of (i) all funds to be transferred to
     the applicable Certificate Account from the Capitalized Interest Account
     for such Remittance Date and (ii) certain investment earnings on amounts in
     the Pre-Funding Account for the applicable Remittance Date).  Such excess
     is defined as the "Monthly Advance." Monthly Advances will not cover any
     Certificateholders' Interest Carryover.

          Not later than the close of business on each Determination Date, with
     respect to each Loan for which a Principal Prepayment in full or
     Curtailment was received during the related Due Period, the Servicer is
     required to remit to the Trustee for deposit in the applicable Certificate
     Account from amounts otherwise payable to it as servicing compensation, an
     amount equal to the excess of (a) 30 days' interest (or, with respect to a
     Pool II Loan, the actual number of days since the last Remittance Date (or,
     in the case of the first Remittance Date, from September 15, 1997) up to
     but not including the upcoming Remittance Date) on the principal balance of
     each such Loan as of the beginning of the related Due Period at the
     weighted average Adjusted Mortgage Loan Remittance Rates of the related
     Pool applicable to the Remittance Date on which such amount will be
     distributed, over (b) the amount of interest actually received on the
     related Loan for such Due Period (such difference, "Compensating
     Interest").

     FLOW OF FUNDS

          From that portion of the Available Remittance Amount for the
     applicable Pool, the Agreement requires the Servicer to pay the MBIA
     Premium, the FHA Premium and the Auction Agent Fees and then to withdraw on
     each Determination Date that portion of the Available Remittance Amount for
     each Pool in the applicable Principal and Interest Account and to remit
     such amounts together with any Total Monthly Excess Cashflow Excess Spread
     and Subordination Reduction Amounts), for the related Remittance Date to
     the Trustee for deposit in the applicable Certificate Account. Upon receipt
     on each Determination Date of such amounts, the Trustee is required to
     deposit such amounts into the applicable Certificate Account.

                                     S-103
<PAGE>
 
          The Agreement provides that on each Remittance Date the Trustee is
     required to withdraw from the Certificate Accounts the Pool Available
     Amount, pay into an expense account, an amount equal to one-twelfth of the
     estimated annual fees and expenses of the Trustee and the Trust and make
     distributions of the remainder in the order of priority provided under
     "Description of the Certificates--Distributions on the Certificates" and "-
     -Cross-Support Provisions and Spread Amount."

     CALCULATION OF LIBOR

          The Trustee will determine the London interbank offered rate for
     deposits in U.S. dollars having a maturity of one month ("LIBOR")
     commencing on the second LIBOR Determination Date preceding each Remittance
     Date (the "One-Month Index Maturity") which appears on Telerate Page 3750
     as of 11:00 a.m., London time, on such LIBOR Determination Date.  If such
     rate does not appear on Telerate Page 3750, the rate for that day will be
     determined on the basis of the rates at which deposits in U.S. dollars,
     having the One-Month Index Maturity and in a principal amount of not less
     than U.S. $1,000,000, are offered at approximately 11:00 a.m., London time,
     on such LIBOR Determination Date to prime banks in the London interbank
     market by the Reference Banks.  The Trustee will request the principal
     London office of each of such Reference Banks to provide a quotation of its
     rate.  If at least two such quotations are provided, the rate for that day
     will be the arithmetic mean of the quotations.  If fewer than two
     quotations are provided, the rate for that day will be the arithmetic mean
     of the rates quoted by major banks in New York City, selected by the
     Trustee, at approximately 11:00 a.m., New York City time, on such LIBOR
     Determination Date for loans in U.S. dollars to leading European banks
     having the One-Month Index Maturity and in a principal amount equal to an
     amount of not less than U.S. $1,000,000; provided that if the banks
     selected as aforesaid are not quoting as mentioned in this sentence, LIBOR
     in effect for the applicable Interest Period will be LIBOR in effect for
     the previous Interest Period.

          "LIBOR Determination Date" means the date which is both a Business Day
     and a London Banking Day prior to the commencement of each related Interest
     Period.

          "Business Day" means any day other than (i) a Saturday or Sunday or
     (ii) a day on which banking institutions in the States of New York, New
     Jersey, Minnesota or Delaware are authorized or obligated by law or
     executive order to be closed.

          "London Banking Day" means any Business Day on which dealings in
     deposits in United States dollars are transacted in the London interbank
     market.

          "Interest Period" means, with respect to the Adjustable Rate
     Certificates, (i) initially, the period commencing on September 15, 1997
     and ending on the day immediately preceding the Remittance Date in October
     1997 and (ii) thereafter, the period commencing on a Remittance Date and
     ending on the day immediately preceding the next Remittance Date.

          "Reference Banks" means leading banks selected by the Trustee and
     engaged in transactions in Eurodollar deposits in the international
     Eurocurrency market.

          "Telerate Page 3750" means the display page currently so designated on
     the Dow Jones Telerate Service (or such other page as may replace that page
     on that service for the purpose of displaying comparable rates or prices)
     and "Reference Banks" means leading banks selected by the Trustee and
     engaged in transactions in Eurodollar deposits in the international
     Eurocurrency market.

          The establishment of LIBOR on each Libor Determination Date by the
     Trustee and the Trustee's calculation of the rate of interest applicable to
     the Adjustable Rate Certificates for the related Remittance Date shall (in
     the absence of manifest error) be final and binding.  Each such rate of
     interest may be obtained by telephoning the Trustee at (212) 815-2793.

                                     S-104
<PAGE>
 
     SERVICING AND OTHER COMPENSATION AND PAYMENT OF EXPENSES

          The Servicer is entitled to a servicing fee of 0.25% per annum of the
     principal balance of each Loan (the "Servicing Fee") and a contingency fee
     of 0.25% per annum of the principal balance of each Loan (the "Contingency
     Fee").  The Contingency Fee is meant to provide additional servicing
     compensation to a successor servicer if The Money Store Inc. is replaced as
     Servicer under the Agreement. However, as long as The Money Store Inc. acts
     as Servicer, it is entitled to receive the Contingency Fee, although such
     amount is not deemed servicing compensation.  The Servicing Fee and
     Contingency Fee are each calculated and payable monthly from the interest
     portion of scheduled monthly payments, liquidation proceeds and certain
     other collected proceeds.  In addition, the Servicer is entitled under the
     Agreement to retain additional servicing compensation in the form of
     assumption and other administrative fees, prepayment penalties and
     premiums, late payment charges, interest paid on funds in the Principal and
     Interest Accounts, interest paid on earnings realized on Permitted
     Instruments, and certain other excess amounts.

     TERMINATION; PURCHASE OF LOANS

          The Trust will terminate upon distribution to the Certificateholders
     of amounts due them following the earlier to occur of (i) the final payment
     or other liquidation of the last Loan remaining in the Trust or the
     disposition of all REO Property, (ii) the optional purchase of the assets
     of the Trust by the Servicer or MBIA, as described below or (iii) the
     occurrence of a "qualified liquidation" of the Trust, as permitted by the
     REMIC provisions of the Code as described below; provided, however, that in
     no event will the Trust terminate later than twenty-one years after the
     death of the last survivor of the person named in the Agreement.

          As set forth under "The MBIA Policies and MBIA" no accelerated Insured
     Payments will be made regardless of any acceleration of the Pool I or Pool
     IV Certificates, unless such acceleration is at the sole option of MBIA.
     This will not affect the Pool I or Pool IV Certificateholders since, as
     described below, as a condition to any optional termination of the Trust
     the Certificateholders will receive an amount equal to the outstanding
     Class Principal Balance of the related Class, plus accrued interest.

          Subject to provisions in the Agreement concerning adopting a plan of
     complete liquidation, on any date on which the aggregate principal balances
     of the Loans are less than 10% of the sum of (i) the Original Pool
     Principal Balance and (ii) the original Pre-Funded Amount the Servicer may,
     at its option, and in the absence of the exercise thereof by the Servicer,
     MBIA may, at its option, purchase, on the next succeeding Remittance Date,
     all of the Loans and any related REO Properties at a price equal to the
     Termination Price relating to the Trust.

          On and after the date on which the Pool Available Maximum
     Subordination Amounts for all Pools are zero, on any Remittance Date on
     which the Pool I and Pool IV Loans with aggregate principal balances as of
     the Cut-Off Date that equal or exceed 25% of the sum of (i) the Original
     Pool Principal Balance of the Pool I and Pool IV Loans and (ii) the
     original Pre-Funded Amount have become Liquidated Loans, MBIA may determine
     to purchase and may cause the purchase from the Trust of all Loans and REO
     Properties in the Pools at a price equal to the sum of the Termination
     Price for each Pool and the outstanding and unpaid fees and expenses of the
     Trustee and the Servicer.

          Following a final determination by the Internal Revenue Service (the
     "IRS") or by a court of competent jurisdiction, in either case from which
     no appeal is taken within the permitted time for such appeal, or if any
     appeal is taken, following a final determination of such appeal from which
     no further appeal can be taken, to the effect that either REMIC does not
     and will no longer qualify as a REMIC pursuant to Section 860D of the Code
     (the "Final Determination"), at any time on or after the date which is 30
     calendar days following such Final Determination (i) the Holders of greater
     than 50 percent in Percentage Interest of the Offered Certificates (the
     "Applicable Majority Certificateholders") may direct the Trustee on behalf
     of the Trust to adopt a "plan of complete liquidation" (within the meaning
     of Section 860F(a)(4)(B)(i) of the Code) with respect to the related REMIC
     and (ii) MBIA may notify the Trustee of MBIA's determination to purchase
     from the Trust all Loans and all property theretofore acquired by
     foreclosure, deed in lieu of foreclosure, or otherwise in respect of any
     Loan then remaining in such REMIC at a price equal to the aggregate
     Termination Price.  Upon receipt of such direction by the Applicable
     Majority Certificateholders 

                                     S-105
<PAGE>
 
     or of such notice from MBIA, the Trustee will notify the holders of the
     Class R Certificates of such election to liquidate or such determination to
     purchase, as the case may be (the "Termination Notice"). The Holders of a
     majority of the percentage interest of the Class R Certificates then
     outstanding may, within 60 days from the date of receipt of the Termination
     Notice (the "Purchase Option Period"), at their option, purchase from the
     Trust all the Loans and all property theretofore acquired by foreclosure,
     deed in lieu of foreclosure, or otherwise in respect of any Loan then
     remaining in the REMIC at a purchase price equal to the Termination Price
     of the Trust.

          If, during a Purchase Option Period, the holders of the Class R
     Certificates have not exercised the option described in the immediately
     preceding paragraph, then upon the expiration of the Purchase Option Period
     (i) in the event that the Applicable Majority Certificateholders have given
     the Trustee the direction described in clause (i) above, the Trustee is
     required to sell the Loans and such other property in the related REMIC and
     distribute the proceeds of the liquidation of such REMIC, each in
     accordance with the plan of complete liquidation, such that, if so
     directed, the liquidation of such REMIC and the distribution of the
     proceeds of the liquidation occur no later than the close of the 60th day,
     or such later day as the Applicable Majority Certificateholders shall
     permit or direct in writing, after the expiration of the Purchase Option
     Period and (ii) in the event that MBIA has given the Trustee notice of
     MBIA's determination to purchase the assets described in clause (ii)
     preceding, MBIA shall so purchase such assets within 60 days after the
     expiration of the Purchase Option Period.

          Following a Final Determination, the holders of a majority of the
     percentage interest of the Class R Certificates then outstanding may, at
     their option and upon delivery to the Trustee and MBIA of an opinion of
     nationally recognized tax counsel selected by the Holders of such Class R
     Certificates, which opinion shall be reasonably satisfactory in form and
     substance to the Applicable Majority Certificateholders and MBIA, that the
     effect of the Final Determination is to increase substantially the
     probability that the gross income of the related REMIC will be subject to
     federal taxation, purchase from the Trust all Loans and all property
     theretofore acquired by foreclosure, deed in lieu of foreclosure, or
     otherwise in respect of any Loan then remaining in the related REMIC at a
     purchase price equal to the Termination Price of the Trust.  The foregoing
     opinion shall be deemed satisfactory unless the Applicable Majority
     Certificateholders give the holders of a majority of percentage interests
     in the Class R Certificates notice that such opinion is not satisfactory
     within thirty days after receipt of such opinion.

          If the Trust were to lose its qualification as a REMIC, it might be
     taxable as a grantor trust, a partnership, or an association taxable as a
     corporation.  If the Trust is treated as a grantor trust or a partnership,
     such Trust would not be subject to a separate entity level tax, and it is
     not expected that the tax treatment of the investors would be materially
     different from the tax treatment if the REMIC election of such Trust had
     not been revoked.  However, if the Trust were treated as an association
     taxable as a corporation it would be subject to Federal income taxes at
     corporate rates on its net income.  Moreover, distributions on the Offered
     Certificates would probably not be deductible in computing such Trust's
     taxable income, and all or part of the distributions to the holders of such
     Offered Certificates would probably be treated as dividend income to the
     holders.  Such an entity level tax could result in reduced distributions to
     the holders of the Offered Certificates and such Certificateholders could
     also be liable for a share of such a tax.  Any such corporate level tax
     would be borne first by the holders of the Class R Certificates from
     amounts otherwise distributable to such holders.  Any remaining corporate
     level tax would be borne by holders of all Classes of Offered Certificates
     pro rata in proportion to the outstanding principal balances of such
     Classes.

     THE TRUSTEE

          The Bank of New York will be the Trustee under the Agreement. The
     Agreement will provide that the Trustee may resign at any time, in which
     event the Representative will be obligated to appoint a successor Trustee.
     The Representative may also remove the Trustee if the Trustee ceases to be
     eligible to continue as such under the Agreement or if the Trustee becomes
     insolvent. Any resignation or removal of the Trustee and appointment of a
     successor Trustee will not become effective until acceptance of the
     appointment by the successor Trustee.

                                     S-106
<PAGE>
 
     THE CO-TRUSTEE

          First Union Trust Company, N.A., a national banking association
     headquartered in Wilmington, Delaware, will be the Co-Trustee with respect
     to the Home Improvement Loans.

     THE CUSTODIAN

          First Trust National Association, a national banking association
     headquartered in St. Paul, Minnesota, will be the Custodian with respect to
     the Home Improvement Loans.  In such capacity, it will retain the files
     relating to the Home Improvement Loans.  The Custodian is a subsidiary of
     First Bank Systems, Minneapolis, Minnesota.

     THE AUCTION AGENT

          Bankers Trust Company, a New York banking corporation, will act as
     Auction Agent with respect to the Auction Rate Certificates pursuant to an
     Auction Agent Agreement to be entered into among the Representative, the
     Trustee and the Auction Agent.


                       FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSIDERATIONS

          For federal income tax purposes, one or more elections will be made to
     treat certain assets of the Trust as REMICs.  Each Class of Certificates
     (other than the Class R Certificates) (the "Regular Certificates") will
     constitute "regular interests" in a REMIC and each Class of Class R
     Certificates will constitute the sole "residual interest" in the related
     REMIC.  See "Federal Income Tax Consequences" in the Prospectus.

          Because the Regular Certificates will be considered REMIC regular
     interests, they generally will be taxable as debt obligations under the
     Code, and interest paid or accrued on such Regular Certificates, including
     original issue discount with respect to any such Regular Certificates
     issued with original issue discount, will be taxable to Certificateholders
     in accordance with the accrual method of accounting.  See "Federal Income
     Tax Consequences--REMIC Regular Certificates--Current Income on REMIC
     Regular Certificates."

          The prepayment assumption that will be used in determining the rate of
     accrual of original issue discount with respect to the Certificates is 100%
     Prepayment Assumption, as 100% Prepayment Assumption is defined herein with
     respect to each Pool of Certificates.  See "Maturity, Prepayment and Yield
     Considerations" herein.  However, no representation is made as to the rate
     at which prepayments actually will occur.


                              ERISA CONSIDERATIONS

          ERISA imposes certain requirements on employee benefit plans and
     collective investment funds and separate accounts in which such plans or
     arrangements are invested to which it applies and on those persons who are
     fiduciaries with respect to such benefit plans.  Certain employee benefit
     plans, such as governmental plans (as defined in Section 3(32) of ERISA)
     and certain church plans (as defined in Section 3(33) of ERISA), are not
     subject to ERISA. In accordance with ERISA's general fiduciary standards,
     before investing in a Certificate a benefit plan fiduciary should determine
     whether such an investment is permitted under the governing benefit plan
     instruments and is appropriate for the benefit plan in view of its overall
     investment policy and the composition and diversification of its portfolio.

          In addition, benefit plans subject to ERISA and individual retirement
     accounts or certain types of Keogh plans not subject to ERISA but subject
     to Section 4975 of the Code and entities in which such plans or accounts
     are invested (each a "Plan") are prohibited from engaging in a broad range
     of transactions involving Plan assets and persons having certain specified
     relationships to a Plan ("parties in interest" and "disqualified persons").
     Such transactions are treated as "prohibited transactions" under Sections
     406 and 407 of ERISA and excise taxes are imposed upon such persons by

                                     S-107
<PAGE>
 
     Section 4975 of the Code. The Representative, the Originators, MBIA, the
     Underwriter and the Trustee and certain of their affiliates might be
     considered "parties in interest" or "disqualified persons" with respect to
     a Plan. If so, the acquisition or holding or transfer of Certificates by or
     on behalf of such Plan could be considered to give rise to a "prohibited
     transaction" within the meaning of ERISA and the Code unless an exemption
     is available. Furthermore, if an investing Plan's assets were deemed to
     include an interest in the Loans and any other assets of the Trust and not
     merely an interest in the related Certificates, transactions occurring in
     the servicing of the Loans might constitute prohibited transactions unless
     an administrative exemption applies.  One exemption which may be applicable
     to the acquisition and holding of the Certificates or to the servicing of
     the Loans is noted below.

          The Department of Labor ("DOL") has issued a regulation (29 C.F.R.
     Section 2510.3-101) concerning the definition of what constitutes the
     assets of a Plan (the "Plan Asset Regulations"), which provides that, as a
     general rule, the underlying assets and properties of corporations,
     partnerships, trusts and certain other entities in which a Plan makes an
     "equity" investment will be deemed for purposes of ERISA to be assets of
     the investing Plan unless certain exceptions apply. Thus, a Plan fiduciary
     considering an investment in Certificates should also consider whether such
     an investment might constitute or give rise to a prohibited transaction
     under ERISA or the Code.

          DOL has granted administrative exemptions to Prudential Securities
     Incorporated (Prohibited Transaction Exemption 90-32, 55 Fed. Reg. 23,147
     (June 6, 1990)) and Lehman Brothers (Prohibited Transaction Exemption 91-
     14; 56 Fed. Reg. 7,413 (February 22, 1991)) (collectively, the "Exemption")
     from certain of the prohibited transaction rules of ERISA with respect to
     the initial purchase, the holding and the subsequent resale in the
     secondary market by Plans of pass-through certificates representing a
     beneficial undivided ownership interest in the assets of a trust that
     consist of certain receivables, loans and other obligations that meet the
     conditions and requirements of the Exemption which may be applicable to the
     Class A Certificates if Prudential Securities Incorporated or Lehman
     Brothers, respectively, or any of their affiliates is either the sole
     underwriter or the manager or co-manager of the underwriting syndicate, or
     a selling or placement agent. The conditions which must be satisfied for
     the Exemption to apply to the purchase, holding and transfer of the Class A
     Certificates are the following:

               (i) The acquisition of the Class A Certificates by a Plan is on
          terms (including the price for the Class A Certificates) that are at
          least as favorable to the Plan as they would be in an arm's length
          transaction with an unrelated party.

               (ii) The rights and interest evidenced by a Class of Class A
          Certificates acquired by the Plan are not subordinated to the rights
          and interest evidenced by any other Certificates of the Trust.

               (iii) The Class A Certificates acquired by the Plan have received
          a rating at the time of such acquisition that is in one of the three
          highest generic rating categories from any of Moody's, Duff & Phelps
          Credit Rating Co., S&P or Fitch ("Authorized Rating Agencies") and the
          investment pool consists only of assets of the type enumerated in the
          Exemption, and which have been included in other investment pools;
          certificates evidencing interests in such other investment pools have
          been rated in one of the three highest generic rating categories by an
          Authorized Rating Agency for at least one year prior to a Plan's
          acquisition of certificates; and certificates evidencing interests in
          such other investment pools have been purchased by investors other
          than Plans for at least one year prior to a plan's acquisition of the
          Class A Certificates.

               (iv) The sum of all payments made to the Underwriters in
          connection with the distribution of the Class A Certificates
          represents not more than reasonable compensation for distributing the
          Class A Certificates. The sum of all payments made to and retained by
          the Representative and the Originators pursuant to the sale of the
          Loans to the Trust represents not more than the fair market value of
          such Loans. The sum of all payments made to and retained by the
          Servicer or any other servicer represents not more than reasonable
          compensation for such services under the Agreement and reimbursement
          of the servicer's reasonable expenses in connection therewith.

                                     S-108
<PAGE>
 
               (v) The Trustee and Co-Trustee must not be affiliates of any
          member of the Restricted Group as defined below.

          In addition, it is a condition that the Plan investing in the Class A
     Certificates is an "accredited investor" as defined in Rule 501(a)(1) of
     Regulation D under the Securities Act.  Any Plan purchasing Class A
     Certificates will be deemed to have represented, by virtue of such
     purchase, that it is an accredited investor.

          The Exemption does not apply to Plans sponsored by the Originators,
     the Representative, MBIA, the Underwriters, the Trustee, the Co-Trustee,
     the Custodian, the Servicer, any other servicers or any obligor with
     respect to Loans included in the Trust constituting more than 5% of the
     aggregate unamortized principal balance of the assets in such Trust or any
     affiliate of such parties (the "Restricted Group"). No exemption is
     provided from the restrictions of ERISA for the acquisition or holding of a
     Class A Certificate on behalf of an "Excluded Plan" by any person who is a
     fiduciary with respect to the assets of such Excluded Plan.  For purposes
     of the Class A Certificates, an Excluded Plan is a Plan sponsored by any
     member of the Restricted Group.  In addition, the Exemption provides relief
     from certain self-dealing/conflict of interest prohibited transactions that
     may occur when a Plan fiduciary causes a Plan to acquire Class A
     Certificates and the fiduciary (or its affiliate) is an obligor on any Loan
     held in the Trust provided that, among other requirements, (i) such
     fiduciary (or its affiliate) is an obligor with respect to 5% or less of
     the fair market value of the Loans contained in the Trust, (ii) the Plan's
     investment in any Class of Class A Certificates does not exceed 25% of all
     of the Certificates of such Class outstanding at the time of the Plan's
     acquisition and after the Plan's acquisition of such Class of Class A
     Certificates, no more than 25% of the assets over which the fiduciary has
     investment authority are invested in securities of a trust containing
     assets which are sold or serviced by the same entity, and (iii) in the case
     of initial issuance (but not secondary market transactions), at least 50%
     of each Class of Class A Certificates, and at least 50% of the aggregate
     interest in the Trust, are acquired by persons independent of the
     Restricted Group.

          On July 21, 1997, the DOL published in the Federal Register a final
     amendment to the Exemption which extends exemptive relief to certain
     mortgage-backed and asset-backed securities transactions using pre-funding
     accounts for trusts issuing pass-through certificates.  With respect to the
     Certificates, the amendment generally allows a portion of the Loans
     supporting payments to Certificateholders and having a principal amount
     equal to no more than 25% of the total principal amount of the Loans to be
     transferred to the Trust within a 90-day or three-month period following
     the Closing Date ("Pre-Funding Period"), instead of requiring that all such
     Loans be either identified or transferred on or before the Closing Date.
     The relief is effective for transactions occurring on or after May 23,
     1997, provided that the following conditions are met:

          (1) The ratio of the amount allocated to the Pre-Funding Account to
     the total principal amount of the Certificates being offered ("Pre-Funding
     Limit") must not exceed twenty-five percent (25%).

          (2) All Loans transferred after the Closing Date ("Additional Loans")
     must meet the same terms and conditions for eligibility as the original
     Loans used to create the Trust, which terms and conditions have been
     approved by the Authorized Rating Agency.

          (3) The transfer of such Additional Loans to the Trust during the Pre-
     Funding Period must not result in the Certificates receiving a lower credit
     rating from the Authorized Rating Agency upon termination of the Pre-
     Funding Period than the rating that was obtained at the time of the initial
     issuance of the Certificates by the Trust.

          (4) Solely as a result of the use of pre-funding, the weighted average
     annual percentage interest rate (the "average interest rate") for all of
     the Loans in the Trust at the end of the Pre-Funding Period must not be
     more than 100 basis points lower than the average interest rate for the
     Loans which were transferred to the Trust on the Closing Date.

          (5) Either: (i) the characteristics of the Additional Loans must be
     monitored by an insurer or other credit support provider which is
     independent of the Originator; or (ii) an independent accountant retained
     by the Originator must provide the Originator with a letter (with copies
     provided to the Authorized Rating Agency,  the 

                                     S-109
<PAGE>
 
     Underwriter and the Trustee) stating whether or not the characteristics of
     the Additional Loans conform to the characteristics described in the
     Prospectus, Prospectus Supplement, Private Placement Memorandum ("Offering
     Documents") and/or Pooling and Servicing Agreement ("Pooling Agreement").
     In preparing such letter, the independent accountant must use the same type
     of procedures as were applicable to the Loans which were transferred as of
     the Closing Date.

          (6) The Pre-Funding Period must end no later than three months or 90
     days after the Closing Date or earlier, in certain circumstances, if the
     amount on deposit in the Pre-Funding Account is reduced below the minimum
     level specified in the Pooling Agreement or an event of default occurs
     under the Pooling Agreement.

          (7) Amounts transferred to any Pre-Funding Account and/or Capitalized
     Interest Account used in connection with the pre-funding may be invested
     only in investments which are permitted by the authorized Rating Agency and
     (i) are direct obligations of, or obligations fully guaranteed as to timely
     payment of principal and interest by, the United States or any agency or
     instrumentality thereof (provided that such obligations are backed by the
     full faith and credit of the United States); or (ii) have been rated (or
     the obligor has been rated) in one of the three highest generic rating
     categories by the Authorized Rating Agency ("Permitted Investments").

          (8) The Offering Documents must describe:  (i) any Pre-Funding Account
     and/or Capitalized Interest Account used in connection with a Pre-Funding
     Account; (ii) the duration of the Pre-Funding Period; (iii) the percentage
     and/or dollar amount of the Pre-Funding Limit for the Trust; and (iv) that
     the amounts remaining in the Pre-Funding Account at the end of the Pre-
     Funding Period will be remitted to Certificateholders as repayments of
     principal.

          (9) The Pooling Agreement must describe the Permitted Investments for
     the Pre-Funding Account and Capitalized Interest Account and, if not
     disclosed in the Offering Documents, the terms and conditions for
     eligibility of the Additional Loans.

          As the Class M and Class B Certificates are subordinated they are not
     eligible for prohibited transaction exemptive relief under the Exemption.
     Consequently, transfers of the Class M and Class B Certificates may not be
     made to any Plan unless such Plan is purchasing such Class B or Class M
     Certificates pursuant to Section III of Prohibited Transaction Class
     Exemption 95-60, 60 Fed. Reg. 35925 (July 12, 1995) relating to
     acquisitions by insurance company general accounts.  The purchase of a
     Class B or Class M Certificate will be deemed a representation by the
     purchaser that either (i) it is not purchasing such Class B or Class M
     Certificate, directly or indirectly, for, or on behalf of, a "benefit plan
     investor" as such term is defined in the Plan Asset Regulations with
     respect to a Plan which is subject to Title I of ERISA or (ii) the
     purchaser is an insurance company which is purchasing such Class B or Class
     M Certificate with funds contained in an "insurance company general
     account" as such term is defined in Section V(e) of PTCE 95-60 and that the
     purchase and holding of such Class B or Class M Certificate is covered
     under PTCE 95-60.


          Before purchasing a Certificate in reliance on the Exemption, PTCE 95-
     60  or any other exemption, a fiduciary of a Plan should confirm that all
     applicable requirements would be satisfied.  Any Plan fiduciary considering
     the purchase of a Certificate should consult with its counsel with respect
     to the potential applicability of ERISA and the Code to such investment.
     Moreover, each Plan fiduciary should determine whether, under the general
     fiduciary standards of investment prudence and diversification, an
     investment in the Certificates is appropriate for the Plan, taking into
     account the overall investment policy of the Plan and the composition of
     the Plan's investment portfolio.  Special caution ought to be exercised
     before a Plan purchases a Certificate in such circumstances.  See "ERISA
     Considerations" in the Prospectus.

                                     S-110
<PAGE>
 
                        LEGAL INVESTMENT CONSIDERATIONS

          Only the Class AV and Class MV-1 Certificates will constitute
     "mortgage related securities" for purposes of SMMEA.  Accordingly, many
     institutions with legal authority to invest in comparably rated securities
     based on first mortgage loans or deeds of trust may not be legally
     authorized to invest in the other Classes of Offered Certificates.  No
     representation is made herein as to whether and the extent to which a Class
     of the Offered Certificates constitutes legal investments for any entity
     under any applicable statute, law, rule, regulation or order.  Each
     prospective purchasers urged to consult with it counsel concerning the
     status of the Offered Certificates as legal investments for such purchaser
     prior to investing therein.

                                     S-111
<PAGE>
 
                                  UNDERWRITING

          Subject to the terms and conditions set forth in the Underwriting
     Agreement dated September 26, 1997 (the "Underwriting Agreement"), the
     Representative, on behalf of the Originators, has agreed to sell and each
     Underwriter has agreed to purchase the principal amount of each Class of
     Offered Certificates set forth below it name.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
 
                     Prudential                                                                         
               Securities Incorporated  Lehman Brothers Inc.  Salomon Brothers Inc.  Merrill Lynch & Co.
               -----------------------  --------------------  ---------------------  -------------------
Pool I        
Certificates                                                                                 
- ------------  
<S>                 <C>                    <C>                    <C>                   <C>                  
 Class AF-1          $ 27,500,000             $ 11,000,000          $  9,000,000           $  9,000,000 
 Class AF-2          $ 28,900,000             $ 10,500,000          $  7,500,000           $  7,500,000 
 Class AF-3          $ 38,000,000             $ 14,000,000          $ 10,000,000           $ 10,000,000 
 Class AF-4          $ 22,000,000             $  8,000,000          $  6,000,000           $  6,000,000 
 Class AF-5          $ 15,900,000             $  6,000,000          $  4,000,000           $  4,000,000 
 Class AF-6          $ 18,000,000             $  7,000,000          $  5,000,000           $  5,000,000 
 Class AF-7          $ 18,030,000             $  6,500,000          $  4,700,000           $  4,700,000 
 Class AF-8          $ 19,000,000             $  7,000,000          $  5,000,000           $  5,000,000 
Pool II       
Certificates                                                                                    
- ------------  
 Class AV            $276,000,000             $ 25,000,000          $ 70,000,000           $ 70,000,000 
 Class MV-1          $          0             $ 45,000,000          $          0           $          0 
 Class MV-2          $          0             $ 30,000,000          $          0           $          0 
 Class BV            $ 11,670,000             $  5,000,000          $  3,800,000           $  3,800,000 
Pool III      
Certificates                                                                                   
- ------------  
 Class AH-1          $ 12,546,000             $ 25,091,000          $          0           $          0 
 Class AH-2          $ 15,588,000             $ 31,177,000          $          0           $          0 
 Class AH-3          $ 12,000,000             $ 24,005,000          $          0           $          0 
 Class AH-4          $ 12,622,000             $ 25,243,000          $          0           $          0 
 Class AH-5          $ 17,936,000             $ 35,873,000          $          0           $          0 
 Class AH-6          $  3,776,000             $  7,553,000          $          0           $          0 
 Class MH-1          $  8,303,000             $ 16,607,000          $          0           $          0 
 Class MH-2          $  4,992,000             $  9,983,000          $          0           $          0 
 Class BH            $  3,902,000             $  7,803,000          $          0           $          0 
Pool IV       
Certificates                                                                                    
- ------------  
 Class AMF           $ 25,000,000             $          0          $          0           $          0 
                                                                                                        
Total                $591,665,000             $358,335,000          $125,000,000           $125,000,000 
                     ============             ============          ============           ============         
</TABLE>                           
                                   
                                   
                                Morgan Stanley
                              & Co. Incorporated                  Total
                              ------------------                  -----
Pool I 
Certificates 
- ------------
 Class AF-1                        $  6,500,000                 $   63,000,000
 Class AF-2                        $  6,000,000                 $   60,400,000
 Class AF-3                        $  8,000,000                 $   80,000,000
 Class AF-4                        $  5,000,000                 $   47,000,000
 Class AF-5                        $  3,000,000                 $   32,900,000
 Class AF-6                        $  4,000,000                 $   39,000,000
 Class AF-7                        $  3,770,000                 $   37,700,000
 Class AF-8                        $  4,000,000                 $   40,000,000
Pool II 
Certificates 
- ------------
 Class AV                          $ 57,000,000                 $  498,000,000
 Class MV-1                        $          0                 $   45,000,000
 Class MV-2                        $          0                 $   30,000,000
 Class BV                          $  2,730,000                 $   27,000,000
Pool III 
Certificates
- ------------
 Class AH-1                        $          0                 $   37,637,000
 Class AH-2                        $          0                 $   46,765,000
 Class AH-3                        $          0                 $   36,005,000
 Class AH-4                        $          0                 $   37,865,000
 Class AH-5                        $          0                 $   53,809,000
 Class AH-6                        $          0                 $   11,329,000
 Class MH-1                        $          0                 $   24,910,000
 Class MH-2                        $          0                 $   14,975,000
 Class BH                          $          0                 $   11,705,000
Pool IV 
Certificates    
- ------------
 Class AMF                         $          0                 $   25,000,000
                                                                  
Total                              $100,000,000                 $1,300,000,000
                                   ============                 ==============
                

          The Representative has been advised by the Underwriters that the
     Underwriters propose initially to offer the Offered Certificates to the
     public from time to time in negotiated transactions or otherwise, at
     varying prices to be determined at the time of sale.

          The Representative has agreed to indemnify the Underwriters against
     certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act of
     1933, as amended.

          Each of the Underwriters may provide investment banking and other
     services for the Representative for which it will receive additional
     compensation.

                                     S-112
<PAGE>
 
                                    EXPERTS

          The consolidated financial statements of MBIA Insurance Corporation
     and Subsidiaries as of December 31, 1996 and 1995 and for each of the three
     years in the period ended December 31, 1996, incorporated by reference into
     this Prospectus Supplement have been audited by Coopers & Lybrand L.L.P.,
     independent accountants, as set forth in their report thereon incorporated
     by reference herein in reliance upon the authority of such firm as experts
     in accounting and auditing.


                                 LEGAL MATTERS

          Certain legal matters relating to the validity of the issuance of the
     Certificates will be passed upon for the Representative by Eric R. Elwin,
     Esq., Corporate Counsel of the Representative.  Certain legal matters
     relating to the validity of the issuance of the Certificates will be passed
     upon for the Underwriters by Stroock & Stroock & Lavan LLP, New York, New
     York.  Certain legal matters will be passed upon for MBIA by Kutak Rock,
     Omaha, Nebraska.  Stroock & Stroock & Lavan LLP has performed legal
     services for the Representative and it is expected that it will continue to
     perform such services in the future.


                       RATING OF THE OFFERED CERTIFICATES

          It is a condition to the issuance of the Certificates that each Class
     of Offered Certificate receive the following ratings from S&P, Moody's
     and/or Fitch (collectively, the "Rating Agencies"):



                                    RATING
CLASS              S&P                   MOODY'S              FITCH
- -----              ---                   -------              -----
AF-1               AAA                   Aaa                   --
AF-2               AAA                   Aaa                   --
AF-3               AAA                   Aaa                   --
AF-4               AAA                   Aaa                   --
AF-5               AAA                   Aaa                   --
AF-6               AAA                   Aaa                   --
AF-7               AAA                   Aaa                   --
AF-8               AAA                   Aaa                   --
AV                 AAA                   Aaa                   --
MV-1               AA                    Aa2                   --
MV-2               A                     A2                    --
BV                 BBB                   Baa3                  --
AH-1               AAA                   --                   AAA
AH-2               AAA                   --                   AAA
AH-3               AAA                   --                   AAA
AH-4               AAA                   --                   AAA
AH-5               AAA                   --                   AAA
AH-6               AAA                   --                   AAA
MH-1               AA                    --                   AA
MH-2               A                     --                   A
BH                 BBB                   --                   BBB
AMF                AAA                   Aaa                   --

                                     S-113
<PAGE>
 
       The ratings given to the Pool I and Pool IV Certificates will be based,
     among other things, upon the ratings assigned to the claims paying ability
     of MBIA.  Any reduction in such rating of MBIA would most likely result in
     a reduction in the ratings given to the Pool I and Pool IV Certificates. A
     security rating is not a recommendation to buy, sell or hold securities and
     may be subject to revision or withdrawal at any time by the assigning
     Rating Agency. No person is obligated to maintain the rating on any Class
     of Class A Certificates.  In general, the ratings address credit risk and
     do not address the likelihood or rate of principal prepayments.  The
     ratings of the Pool II Certificates by S&P and Moody's do not reflect the
     likelihood of payment of the Certificateholder's Interest Carryover since
     MBIA does not insure payment of such amounts.


                             FINANCIAL INFORMATION

       The Representative has determined that its financial statements are not
     material to the offering made hereby.

       The Trust has been formed to own the Loans and to issue the Certificates.
     The Trust had no assets or obligations prior to the issuance of the
     Certificates and will not engage in any activities other than those
     described herein. Accordingly, no financial statements with respect to the
     Trust are included in this Prospectus Supplement.

                                     S-114
<PAGE>
 
                           INDEX OF PRINCIPAL TERMS

 
90 Day Delinquent FHA Loan.................................................S-30
Accelerated Principal Distribution Amount..................................S-20
Adjustable Rate Certificates................................................S-5
Adjusted Mortgage Loan Remittance Rate.....................................S-41
Agreement...................................................................S-7
Applicable Majority Certificateholders....................................S-105
Applied Realized Loss Amount...............................................S-23
Auction Agent...............................................................S-7
Auction Rate Certificates...................................................S-3
Authorized Rating Agencies................................................S-108
Auto Loans.................................................................S-53
Available Remittance Amount...............................................S-102
Balloon Loans..............................................................S-35
beneficial owner...........................................................S-93
Book-Entry Certificates....................................................S-93
Business Day...............................................................S-80
Capitalized Interest Account...............................................S-10
Cede.......................................................................S-45
Cedel Bank..................................................................S-2
Cedel Bank Participants....................................................S-94
Certificate Account.......................................................S-102
Certificate Owners.........................................................S-93
Certificateholder..........................................................S-93
Certificateholders..........................................................S-3
Certificateholders' Interest Carryover.....................................S-14
Certificates................................................................S-1
Change Date................................................................S-33
Claims......................................................................S-6
Claims Administrator........................................................S-2
Class A Certificates.......................................................S-12
Class A Formula Principal Distribution Amount..............................S-14
Class A Pool Principal Distribution Amount.................................S-16
Class AF-8 Principal Distribution Amount...................................S-17
Class AF-8 Principal Percentage............................................S-17
Class AF-8 Pro Rata Principal Distribution Amount..........................S-17
Class B Cross-over Date....................................................S-19
Class B Formula Principal Distribution Amount..............................S-20
Class B Percentage.........................................................S-87
Class B Pool Principal Distribution Amount.................................S-20
Class Interest Shortfall Carryforward Amount...............................S-12
Class M Formula Principal Distribution Amount..............................S-18
Class M Pool Principal Distribution Amount.................................S-18
Class Principal Balance....................................................S-80
Class R Certificates........................................................S-2
Class X Certificates........................................................S-2
Closing Date................................................................S-5
CMT........................................................................S-57

                                     S-115
<PAGE>
 
Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio...............................................S-32
Compensating Interest......................................................S-11
Contingency Fee............................................................S-42
Conventional Home Improvement Loans.........................................S-2
Cooperative................................................................S-95
Co-Trustee..................................................................S-5
CPR........................................................................S-70
Current Interest Requirement...............................................S-12
Curtailment................................................................S-41
Custodian...................................................................S-7
Cut-off Date................................................................S-5
Dealer Loans...............................................................S-50
Deficiency Amount..........................................................S-97
Definitive Certificates....................................................S-45
Designated Depository Institution.........................................S-102
Detailed Description.......................................................S-56
Determination Date.........................................................S-40
Direct Loans...............................................................S-50
Distribution Amount........................................................S-88
DOL.......................................................................S-108
DTC........................................................................S-45
Due Period.................................................................S-11
Equity Advantage Loans.....................................................S-55
ERISA......................................................................S-44
ERISA Considerations.......................................................S-44
Euroclear...................................................................S-2
Euroclear Operator.........................................................S-95
Euroclear Participant......................................................S-95
European Depositaries......................................................S-93
Excess Spread..............................................................S-89
Exemption..................................................................S-44
FHA........................................................................ S-2
FHA Insurance Premium......................................................S-30
FHA Loans.................................................................. S-2
FHA Payment................................................................S-30
FHA Premium Account........................................................S-30
Final Determination.......................................................S-105
Financial Intermediary.....................................................S-93
Fiscal Agent...............................................................S-97
Fitch......................................................................S-42
Funding Period.............................................................S-10
GAAP.......................................................................S-99
Gross Margin...............................................................S-34
HEP........................................................................S-70
Holders.....................................................................S-3
Home Equity Loans...........................................................S-2
Home Equity Mortgage Notes.................................................S-31
Home Equity Mortgaged Properties...........................................S-31
Home Equity Mortgages......................................................S-31
Home Equity Mortgagor......................................................S-32
Home Improvement Loans......................................................S-2
Home Improvement Mortgage Notes............................................S-35

                                     S-116
<PAGE>
 
Home Improvement Mortgaged Properties......................................S-35
Home Improvement Mortgages.................................................S-35
Home Improvement Mortgagor.................................................S-36
HUD.........................................................................S-2
Initial Home Equity Loans..................................................S-31
Initial Home Improvement Loans.............................................S-31
Initial Loans..............................................................S-31
Initial Multifamily Loans..................................................S-31
Initial Pool I Home Equity Loans...........................................S-31
Initial Pool II Home Equity Loans..........................................S-31
Insurance Paying Agent.....................................................S-26
Insurance Proceeds.........................................................S-41
Insured Payment............................................................S-26
Interest Period...........................................................S-104
IRS.......................................................................S-105
LIBOR......................................................................S-48
LIBOR Determination Date..................................................S-104
LIBOR Index................................................................S-34
Liquidated Loan............................................................S-62
Liquidation Proceeds.......................................................S-40
Loans.......................................................................S-2
London Banking Day........................................................S-104
MBIA.......................................................................S-26
MBIA Policies...............................................................S-2
Monthly Advances...........................................................S-29
Moody's....................................................................S-42
Mortgaged Properties.......................................................S-31
Mortgages..................................................................S-31
Mortgagor..................................................................S-32
Multifamily Loans...........................................................S-2
Multifamily Mortgage Interest Rate.........................................S-39
Multifamily Mortgage Notes.................................................S-38
Multifamily Mortgaged Properties...........................................S-38
Multifamily Mortgages......................................................S-38
Multifamily Mortgagor......................................................S-39
Net Funds Cap..............................................................S-13
Net Liquidation Proceeds...................................................S-15
NHA Act....................................................................S-49
Notes......................................................................S-31
Notice.....................................................................S-98
Obligor....................................................................S-39
Offered Certificates........................................................S-2
Optional Servicer Termination Date.........................................S-43
Original Pool Principal Balance............................................S-43
Originators................................................................ S-2
Owner......................................................................S-98
Pass-Through Rate.......................................................... S-4
Percentage Interest........................................................S-80
Periodic Rate Cap..........................................................S-34
Permitted Instruments.....................................................S-101
Plan Asset Regulations....................................................S-108
Plans......................................................................S-44

                                     S-117
<PAGE>
 
Pool Available Amount......................................................S-11
Pool Available Maximum Subordination Amount................................S-88
Pool Class A Certificates..................................................S-12
Pool Class B Certificates..................................................S-12
Pool Class M Certificates..................................................S-81
Pool I......................................................................S-2
Pool I Certificateholders...................................................S-9
Pool I Class A Certificates................................................S-16
Pool I Home Equity Loans....................................................S-8
Pool I Loans................................................................S-8
Pool I Mortgage Interest Rate..............................................S-33
Pool I Strip Amount........................................................S-17
Pool II.....................................................................S-2
Pool II Certificateholders..................................................S-9
Pool II Class A Certificates................................................S-6
Pool II Class B Certificates................................................S-6
Pool II Class M Certificates................................................S-6
Pool II Home Equity Loans...................................................S-8
Pool II Loans...............................................................S-8
Pool II Mortgage Interest Rate.............................................S-33
Pool II Strip Amount.......................................................S-87
Pool III....................................................................S-2
Pool III Certificateholders.................................................S-9
Pool III Certificates.......................................................S-5
Pool III Home Improvement Interest Rate....................................S-37
Pool III Loans..............................................................S-8
Pool IV.....................................................................S-2
Pool IV Certificateholders..................................................S-9
Pool IV Certificates........................................................S-5
Pool IV Loans...............................................................S-8
Pool Maximum Subordination Amount..........................................S-88
Pool Principal Distribution Amount.........................................S-15
Pool Senior Specified Enhancement Percentage...............................S-84
Pool Spread Amount Stepdown Date...........................................S-84
Pools...................................................................... S-2
Preference Amount..........................................................S-98
Pre-Funded Amount.......................................................... S-9
Prepayment Assumption......................................................S-70
Principal and Interest Account............................................S-102
Principal Factor...........................................................S-92
PUDs.......................................................................S-31
Purchase Option Period....................................................S-106
Rating Agencies...........................................................S-113
Realized Loss..............................................................S-23
Record Date................................................................S-10
Reference Banks...........................................................S-104
Related Payments...........................................................S-29
Released Mortgaged Property Proceeds.......................................S-41
Relevant Depositary........................................................S-93
REMIC.......................................................................S-3
Remittance Date.............................................................S-3
REO Property...............................................................S-43

                                     S-118
<PAGE>
 
Representative..............................................................S-2
Reserve Amount.............................................................S-28
Restricted Group..........................................................S-109
Rules......................................................................S-93
S&P........................................................................S-42
S&P Trigger Event..........................................................S-84
SAP........................................................................S-99
SBA........................................................................S-53
SBA Loans..................................................................S-53
Senior Percentage..........................................................S-14
Servicer....................................................................S-2
Servicing Account.........................................................S-103
Servicing Fee..............................................................S-42
Shortfall Amounts..........................................................S-88
single family...............................................................S-2
SMMEA......................................................................S-44
Special Remittance Date....................................................S-10
Specified Subordinated Amount..............................................S-22
Spread Account.............................................................S-26
Spread Amount..............................................................S-16
Student Loans..............................................................S-53
Subordinated Amount........................................................S-83
Subordinated Deficiency Amount.............................................S-21
Subordination Deficit......................................................S-90
Subordination Increase Amount..............................................S-89
Subordination Reduction Amount.............................................S-16
Subsequent Cut-Off Date....................................................S-31
Subsequent Loans........................................................... S-2
Telerate Page 3750........................................................S-104
Termination Notice........................................................S-106
Termination Price..........................................................S-43
Terms and Conditions.......................................................S-95
Title I.................................................................... S-2
Title I Loan Program.......................................................S-49
Title I Property Improvement Loans.........................................S-49
Total Monthly Excess Cashflow..............................................S-89
Treasury Index.............................................................S-34
Trust.......................................................................S-6
Trustee.....................................................................S-7
Trustee's Loan File........................................................S-28
Underwriters................................................................S-2
Underwriting Agreement....................................................S-112
Unrecovered Portion........................................................S-90
Weighted average life......................................................S-64

                                     S-119
<PAGE>
 
                                    ANNEX I

         GLOBAL CLEARANCE, SETTLEMENT AND TAX DOCUMENTATION PROCEDURES

          Except in certain limited circumstances, the globally offered Class A
     Certificates (the "Global Securities") will be available only in book-entry
     form.  Investors in the Global Securities may hold such Global Securities
     through any of The Depository Trust Company, Cedel Bank or Euroclear.  The
     Global Securities will be tradeable as home market instruments in both the
     European and U.S. domestic markets.  Initial settlement and all secondary
     trades will settle in same-day funds.

          Secondary market trading between investors holding Global Securities
     through Cedel Bank and Euroclear will be conducted in the ordinary way in
     accordance with their normal rules and operating procedures and in
     accordance with conventional Eurobond practice (i.e., seven calendar day
     settlement).

          Secondary market trading between investors holding Global Securities
     through DTC will be conducted according to the rules and procedures
     applicable to U.S. corporate debt obligations and prior Asset-Backed
     Certificates issues.

          Secondary, cross-market trading between Cedel Bank or Euroclear and
     DTC Participants holding Certificates will be effected on a delivery-
     against-payment basis through the respective Depositaries of Cedel Bank and
     Euroclear (in such capacity) and as DTC Participants.

          Non-U.S. holders (as described below) of Global Securities will be
     subject to U.S. withholding taxes unless such holders meet certain
     requirements and deliver appropriate U.S. tax documents to the securities
     clearing organizations or their participants.

     INITIAL SETTLEMENT

          All Global Securities will be held in book-entry form by DTC in the
     name of Cede & Co. as nominee of DTC.  Investors' interests in the Global
     Securities will be represented through financial institutions acting on
     their behalf as direct and indirect Participants in DTC.  As a result,
     Cedel Bank and Euroclear will hold positions on behalf of their
     participants through their respective Depositaries, which in turn will hold
     such positions in accounts as DTC Participants.


          Investors electing to hold their Global Securities through DTC will
     follow the settlement practices applicable to prior Asset-Backed
     Certificates issues.  Investor securities custody accounts will be credited
     with their holdings against payment in same-day funds on the settlement
     date.

          Investors electing to hold their Global Securities through Cedel Bank
     or Euroclear accounts will follow the settlement procedures applicable to
     conventional Eurobonds, except that there will be no temporary global
     security and no "lock-up" or restricted period.  Global Securities will be
     credited to the securities custody accounts on the settlement date against
     payment in same-day funds.

     SECONDARY MARKET TRADING

          Since the purchaser determines the place of delivery, it is important
     to establish at the time of the trade where both the purchaser's and
     seller's accounts are located to ensure that settlement can be made on the
     desired value date.

          Trading between DTC Participants.  Secondary market trading between
     DTC Participants will be settled using the procedures applicable to prior
     Home Equity Loan Asset-Backed Certificates issues in same-day funds.

                                      A-1
<PAGE>
 
          Trading between Cedel Bank and/or Euroclear Participants.  Secondary
     market trading between Cedel Bank Participants or Euroclear Participants
     will be settled using the procedures applicable to conventional eurobonds
     in same-day funds.

          Trading between DTC Seller and Cedel Bank or Euroclear Purchaser.
     When Global Securities are to be transferred from the account of a DTC
     Participant to the account of a Cedel Bank Participant or a Euroclear
     Participant, the purchaser will send instructions to Cedel Bank or
     Euroclear through a Cedel Bank Participant or Euroclear Participant at
     least one business day prior to settlement.  Cedel Bank or Euroclear will
     instruct the respective Depositary, as the* case may be, to receive the
     Global Securities against payment.  Payment will include interest accrued
     on the Global Securities from and including the last coupon payment date to
     and excluding the settlement date, on the basis of the actual number of
     days in such accrual period and a year assumed to consist of 360 days.  For
     transactions settling on the 31st of the month, payment will include
     interest accrued to and excluding the first day of the following month.
     Payment will then be made by the respective Depositary of the DTC
     Participant's account against delivery of the Global Securities.  After
     settlement has been completed, the Global Securities will be credited to
     the respective clearing system and by the clearing system, in accordance
     with its usual procedures, to the Cedel Bank Participant's or Euroclear
     Participant's account.  The securities credit will appear the next day
     (European time) and the cash debt will be back-valued to, and the interest
     on the Global Securities will accrue from, the value date (which would be
     the preceding day when settlement occurred in New York.)  If settlement is
     not completed on the intended value date (i.e., the trade fails), the Cedel
     Bank, or Euroclear cash debt will be valued instead as of the actual
     settlement date.

          Cedel Bank Participants and Euroclear Participants will need to make
     available to the respective clearing systems the funds necessary to process
     same-day funds settlement.  The most direct means of doing so is to
     preposition funds for settlement, either from cash on hand or existing
     lines of credit, as they would for any settlement occurring within Cedel
     Bank or Euroclear.  Under this approach, they may take on credit exposure
     to Cedel Bank or Euroclear until the Global Securities are credited to
     their accounts one day later.

          As an alternative, if Cedel Bank or Euroclear has extended a line of
     credit to them, Cedel Bank Participants or Euroclear Participants can elect
     not to preposition funds and allow that credit line to be drawn upon the
     finance settlement.  Under this procedure, Cedel Bank Participants or
     Euroclear Participants purchasing Global Securities would incur overdraft
     charges for one day, assuming they cleared the overdraft when the Global
     Securities were credited to their accounts.  However, interest on the
     Global Securities would accrue from the value date.  Therefore, in many
     cases the investment income on the Global Securities earned during that
     one-day period may substantially reduce or offset the amount of such
     overdraft charges, although this result will depend on each Cedel Bank
     Participant's or Euroclear Participant's particular cost of funds.

          Since the settlement is taking place during New York business hours,
     DTC Participants can employ their usual procedures for sending Global
     Securities to the respective European Depositary for the benefit of Cedel
     Bank Participants or Euroclear Participants.  The sale proceeds will be
     available to the DTC seller on the settlement date.  Thus, to the DTC
     Participants a cross-market transaction will settle no differently than a
     trade between two DTC Participants.

          Trading between Cedel Bank or Euroclear Seller and DTC Purchaser.  Due
     to time zone differences in their favor, Cedel Bank Participants and
     Euroclear Participants may employ their customary procedures for
     transactions in which Global Securities are to be transferred by the
     respective clearing system, through the respective Depositary, to a DTC
     Participant.  The seller will send instructions to Cedel Bank or Euroclear
     through a Cedel Bank Participant or Euroclear Participant at least one
     business day prior to settlement.  In these cases Cedel Bank or Euroclear
     will instruct the respective Depositary, as appropriate, to deliver the
     Global Securities to the DTC Participant's account against payment.
     Payment will include interest accrued on the Global Securities from and
     including the last coupon payment to and excluding the settlement date on
     the basis of the actual number of days in such accrual period and a year
     assumed to consist of 360 days.  For transactions settling on the 31st of
     the month, payment will include interest accrued to and excluding the first
     day of the following month.  The payment will then be reflected in the
     account of the Cedel Bank Participant or Euroclear Participant the
     following day, and receipt of the cash proceeds in the Cedel Bank
     Participant's 

                                      A-2
<PAGE>
 
     or Erouroclear Participant's account would be back-valued to the value date
     (which would be the preceding day, when settlement occurred in New York).
     Should the Cedel Bank Participant or Euroclear Participant have a line of
     credit with its respective clearing system and elect to be in debt in
     anticipation of receipt of the sale proceeds in its account, the back-
     valuation will extinguish any overdraft incurred over that one-day period.
     If settlement is not completed on the intended value date (i.e., the trade
     fails), receipt of the cash proceeds in the Cedel Bank Participant's or
     Euroclear Participant's account would instead be valued as of the actual
     settlement date.

          Finally, day traders that use Cedel Bank or Euroclear and that
     purchase Global Securities from DTC Participants for delivery to Cedel Bank
     Participants or Euroclear Participants should note that these trades would
     automatically fail on the sale side unless affirmative action were taken.
     At least three techniques should be readily available to eliminate this
     potential problem:

          (a) borrowing through Cedel Bank or Euroclear for one day (until the
     purchase side of the day trade is reflected in their Cedel Bank or
     Euroclear accounts) in accordance with the clearing system's customary
     procedures;

          (b) borrowing the Global Securities in the U.S. from a DTC Participant
     no later than one day prior to settlement, which would give the Global
     Securities sufficient time to be reflected in their Cedel Bank or Euroclear
     account in order to settle the sale side of the trade; or

          (c) staggering the value dates for the buy and sell sides of the trade
     so that the value date for the purchase from the DTC' Participant is at
     least one day prior to the value date for the sale to the Cedel Bank
     Participant or Euroclear Participant.

     CERTAIN U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX DOCUMENTATION REQUIREMENTS

          A beneficial owner of Global Securities holding securities through
     Cedel Bank, or Euroclear (or through DTC if the holder has an address
     outside the U.S.) will be subject to the 30% U.S. withholding tax that
     generally applies to payments of interest (including original issue
     discount) on registered debt issued by U.S. Persons, unless (i) each
     clearing system, bank or other financial institution that holds customers'
     securities in the ordinary course of its trade or business in the chain of
     intermediaries between such beneficial owner and the U.S. entity required
     to withhold tax complies with applicable certification requirements and
     (ii) such beneficial owner takes one of the following steps to obtain an
     exemption or reduced tax rate.

          Exception for non-U.S. Persons (Form W-8).  Beneficial owners of
     Global Securities that are non-U.S. Persons can obtain a complete exemption
     from the withholding tax by filing a signed Form W-8 (Certificate of
     Foreign Status).  If the information shown on Form W-8 changes, a new Form
     W-8 must be filed within 30 days of such change.

          Exemption for non-U.S. Persons with effectively connected income (Form
     4224).  A non-U.S. Person including a non-U.S. corporation or bank with a
     U.S. branch, for which the interest income is effectively connected with
     its conduct of a trade or business in the United States, can obtain an
     exemption from the withholding tax by filing Form 4224 (Exemption from
     Withholding of Tax on Income Effectively Connected with the Conduct of a
     Trade or Business in the United States).

          Exemption or reduced rate for non-U.S. Persons resident in treaty
     countries. (Form 1001).  Non-U.S. Persons that are Certificate Owners
     residing in a country that has a tax treaty with the United States can
     obtain an exemption or reduced tax rate (depending on the treaty terms) by
     filing Form 1001 (Ownership, Exemption or Reduced Rate Certificate).  If
     the treaty provides only for a reduced rate, withholding tax will be
     imposed at that rate unless the filer alternatively files Form W-8.  Form
     1001 may be filed by the Certificate Owners or his agent.

          Exemption for U.S. Persons (Form W-9).  U.S. Persons can obtain a
     complete exemption from the withholding tax by filing Form W-9 (Payer's
     Request for Taxpayer Identification Number and Certification).

                                      A-3
<PAGE>
 
          U.S. Federal Income Tax Reporting Procedure.  The Certificate Owner of
     a Global Security or, in the case of a Form 1001 or a Form 4224 filer, his
     agent, files by submitting the appropriate form to the person through whom
     it holds (the clearing agency, in the case of persons holding directly on
     the books of the clearing agency).  Form W-8 and Form 1001 are effective
     for three calendar years and Form 4224 is effective for one calendar year.

          The term "U.S. Person" means (i) a citizen or resident of the United
     States, (ii) a corporation or partnership organized in or under the laws of
     the United States or any political subdivision thereof, (iii) an estate the
     income of which is includible in gross income for United States tax
     purposes, regardless of its source or (iv) a trust other than a "Foreign
     Trust," as defined in Section 7701(a)(31) of the Code.  This summary does
     not deal with all aspects of U.S. Federal income tax withholding that may
     be relevant to foreign holders of the Global Securities.  Investors are
     advised to consult their own tax advisors for specific tax advise
     concerning their holding and disposing of the Global Securities.


                                      A-4
<PAGE>
 
PROSPECTUS
- ----------


                             THE MONEY STORE INC.
                               (REPRESENTATIVE)



                   THE MONEY STORE ASSET BACKED CERTIFICATES
                      THE MONEY STORE ASSET BACKED NOTES
                                        
                             (ISSUABLE IN SERIES)


  This Prospectus relates to The Money Store Asset Backed Certificates (the
"Certificates") and The Money Store Asset Backed Notes (the "Notes" and
collectively with the Certificates, the "Securities") described herein, issuable
in one or more series (each a "Series"), which may be sold from time to time on
terms determined at the time of sale and described in the related Supplement to
this Prospectus (each a "Prospectus Supplement"), evidencing specified interests
in, or rights to receive payments from, one or more trust funds (each, a
"Trust"), the primary assets of which will consist of one or more pools (each, a
"Pool") of certain mortgage loans and certain other mortgage-related or other
similar assets more particularly described herein (the "Mortgage Assets").  The
Mortgage Assets and other assets of any Trust will be described in the
Prospectus Supplement for the related Series of Certificates and/or Notes.
Certain of the Mortgage Assets may have been originated by wholly-owned
subsidiaries (the "Originators") of The Money Store Inc. ("The Money Store" or
the "Representative").  Certain other of the Mortgage Assets may have been
acquired by The Money Store, an Originator or an affiliate thereof from other
lenders or government agencies, or may consist of mortgage pass-through or
mortgage-backed securities issued by government agencies or private lenders.  In
addition, if so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Trust will
include monies on deposit in one or more trust accounts to be established with a
Trustee (as defined herein), which may include a Pre-Funding Account (as defined
herein) which would be used to purchase additional Mortgage Assets for the
related Trust from time to time during the Funding Period (as defined herein)
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.  If specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, certain of the related Securities may evidence a
fractional undivided ownership interest in a Trust which will hold a beneficial
ownership interest in another trust fund which will contain the Mortgage Assets.
Securities may also be entitled to the benefits of insurance policies, cash
accounts, letters of credit, financial guaranty insurance policies, third party
guarantees, guaranties of The Money Store, supplemental interest payments or
other forms of credit enhancement, maturity protection or derivative
instruments, to the extent described in the related Prospectus Supplement.  The
Prospectus Supplement for each Series of Securities will name the entities
(which will include The Money Store or one of its affiliates and may include
other entities) which will act, directly or through one or more sub-servicers,
as master servicers (each, in such capacity, the "Master Servicer") of such
Mortgage Assets.

  Each Series of Securities will be issued in one or more classes (each, a
"Class").  Each Class of Securities of any series will represent the right to
receive, or be secured by, a specified amount of payments of principal and/or
interest on the related Mortgage Assets in the manner described herein and in
the related Prospectus Supplement.  The right of each Class of Securities to
receive payments may be senior or subordinate to the rights of one or more of
the other Classes of such Series.  The right of the holders of any Class of
Notes ("Noteholders") and the right of the holders of any Class of Certificates
("Certificateholders" and collectively with the Noteholders, "Securityholders"
or "Holders") to receive any distributions of principal and interest will be set
forth in the related Prospectus Supplement.  A Series may include two or more
Classes of Certificates and/or Notes which differ as to the timing and priority
of payment, interest rate or amount of distributions in respect of principal or
interest or both.  A Series may include one or more Classes of Certificates
and/or Notes entitled to distributions in respect of principal, with
disproportionate, nominal or no interest distributions, or to interest
distributions, with disproportionate, nominal or no distributions in respect of
principal.  Distributions on Certificates of any Series will be subordinated to
prior payments due on the related Notes, if any, to the extent described herein
and in the related Prospectus Supplement.  The Securities of each Series will
represent fractional undivided ownership interests in the related Trust.

  SEE RISK FACTORS ON PAGE 21 HEREIN FOR A DISCUSSION OF CERTAIN RISK FACTORS
WHICH SHOULD BE CONSIDERED BY PROSPECTIVE PURCHASERS OF THE SECURITIES OFFERED
HEREBY.

                           ________________________

               The date of this Prospectus is September 11, 1997
<PAGE>
 
          Distributions to Holders of Securities will be made on certain dates
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement (each, a "Remittance Date"),
which may be monthly, quarterly, semi-annually or at such other intervals as are
specified therein.  The rate at which any Class of Certificates (the "Pass-
Through Rate") or the rate at which any Class of Notes (the "Interest Rate")
bear interest or  the method of calculating such Pass-Through Rate or Interest
Rate, which may be fixed or variable,  will be set forth in the related
Prospectus Supplement.  Distributions on the Certificates and/or Notes of a
Series will be made only from the assets of the related Trust and certain
related property. The Pass-Through Rate for a Class of Certificates or the
Interest Rate for a Class of Notes that bear interest based upon a floating rate
of interest, as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, may base such
floating rate upon any of following: (i) the auction procedures described herein
(such Securities being referred to herein as "Auction Rate Securities"), (ii)
the London interbank offered rate for U.S. dollar deposits for a specified
period ("LIBOR") plus an amount set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement ,
(iii) the average bond equivalent rates of weekly auctions of Treasury bills for
a specified period (the "T-Bill Rate") plus an amount set forth in the related
Prospectus Supplement or (iv) any such other method or procedures used to
determine the floating rate of interest as may be described in the applicable
Prospectus Supplement.

  The Securities will not represent an obligation of or interest in the
Representative (except for any Guaranty (as defined herein) issued in connection
with a Series), the Originators, or any affiliate thereof and, except to the
extent described herein or specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, will
not be insured or guaranteed by any governmental agency or instrumentality or
(except as otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement) by any
other person.  Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement,
the only obligations of the Representative or the Originators with respect to a
Series of Securities will be pursuant to certain limited representations and
warranties.  Except for certain representations and warranties relating to the
Mortgage Assets and certain other exceptions, the Master Servicer's obligations
with respect to the related Series of Certificates and/or Notes will be limited
to its contractual servicing obligations.  If the amount available for
distribution to Holders on any Remittance Date is less than the amount due to
them, the Master Servicer, to the extent provided in the related Prospectus
Supplement, may be obligated, under certain terms and conditions, to advance
cash to such Holders, to the extent such deficiency is attributable to
delinquent payments of principal and/or interest during the immediately
preceding Due Period (as defined herein).  See "Description of the Securities
Monthly Advances and Compensating Interest."

  The yield to Holders on each Class of Certificates and/or Notes of a Series
may be affected by the rate of payment of principal (including prepayments) of
the Mortgage Assets in the related Trust and the timing of receipt of such
payments as described herein and in the related Prospectus Supplement.  A Trust
may be subject to early termination under the circumstances described herein and
in the related Prospectus Supplement.

  If specified in a Prospectus Supplement, an election may be made to treat each
Trust as a "real estate mortgage investment conduit" ("REMIC") for federal
income tax purposes.  See "Federal Income Tax Consequences."



  THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES AND
EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION NOR HAS THE COMMISSION OR
  ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION PASSED UPON THE ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF THIS
  PROSPECTUS OR THE RELATED PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT.  ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE
                        CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL OFFENSE.

                          ___________________________

             THE ATTORNEY GENERAL OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK HAS NOT
               PASSED ON OR ENDORSED THE MERITS OF THIS OFFERING.
                ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS UNLAWFUL.
                                        

                                      -2-
<PAGE>
 
  Offers of the Securities may be made through one or more different methods,
including offerings through underwriters, as more fully described under "Plan of
Distribution" herein and in the related Prospectus Supplement. The intention of
any underwriter to make a secondary market in the Securities will be set forth
in the related Prospectus Supplement.  There can be no assurance that a
secondary market for the Securities will develop, or if it does develop, that it
will continue.  This Prospectus may not be used to consummate sales of a Series
of Securities unless accompanied by a Prospectus Supplement.

  Until 90 days after the date of each Prospectus Supplement, all dealers
effecting transactions in the securities covered by such Prospectus Supplement,
whether or not participating in the distribution thereof, may be required to
deliver such Prospectus Supplement and this Prospectus.  This is in addition to
the obligation of dealers to deliver a Prospectus and Prospectus Supplement when
acting as underwriters and with respect to their unsold allotments or
subscriptions.


                                PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT


  The Prospectus Supplement relating to a Series of Certificates and/or Notes to
be offered hereunder, among other things, will set forth with respect to such
Series of Certificates and/or Notes:  (i) the aggregate principal amount, the
Pass-Through Rate, Interest Rate or Rates or other applicable annual rate or
rates of interest (or the manner of determining such rate or rates) and
authorized denominations of each Class of such Certificates and/or Notes; (ii)
certain information concerning the Mortgage Assets and insurance policies, cash
accounts, letters of credit, financial guaranty insurance policies, third party
guarantees, guaranties of The Money Store, supplemental interest payments or
other forms of credit enhancement or maturity protection or other derivative
instruments, if any, relating to the Pools or all or part of the related
Certificates and/or Notes; (iii) the specified interest of each Class of
Certificates and/or Notes in, and manner and priority of, the distributions on
the Mortgage Assets; (iv) information as to the nature and extent of
subordination with respect to such Series of Certificates and/or Notes, if any;
(v) the Remittance Dates; (vi) information as to the Master Servicer; (vii) the
circumstances, if any, under which each Trust may be subject to early
termination; (viii) whether the Representative intends to elect to cause the
Trust to be treated as a REMIC; and (ix) additional information with respect to
the plan of sale of such Certificates and/or Notes.


                                AVAILABLE INFORMATION


  The Representative has filed a Registration Statement under the Securities Act
of 1933, as amended (the "1933 Act"), with the Securities and Exchange
Commission (the "Commission") with respect to the Securities.  The Registration
Statement and amendments thereof and to the exhibits thereto, as well as such
reports and other information, are available for inspection without charge at
the public reference facilities maintained by the Commission at 450 Fifth
Street, N.W., Washington, D.C. 20549; 7 World Trade Center, 13th Floor, New
York, New York 10048; and Northwestern Atrium Center, 500 West Madison Street,
Suite 1400, Chicago, Illinois 60661-2511.  Copies of the Registration Statement
and amendments thereof and exhibits thereto may be obtained from the Public
Reference Section of the Commission, 450 Fifth Street, N.W., Washington, D.C.
20549, at prescribed rates.  The Commission maintains a Web site that contains
reports, proxy and information statements and other information regarding
registrants that file electronically with the Commission.  The address of such
site is http://www.sec.gov.

  No person has been authorized to give any information or to make any
representation other than those contained in this Prospectus and any Prospectus
Supplement with respect hereto and, if given or made, such information or
representations must not be relied upon.  This Prospectus and any Prospectus
Supplement with respect hereto do not constitute an offer to sell or a
solicitation of an offer to buy any securities other than the Securities offered
hereby and thereby nor an offer of the Securities to any person in any state or
other jurisdiction in which such offer would be unlawful. The delivery of this
Prospectus at any time does not imply that information herein is correct as of
any time subsequent to its date.


                                REPORTS TO SECURITYHOLDERS



  Periodic and annual reports concerning any Securities and the related Trust
will be provided to the Securityholders as described in the related Prospectus
Supplement.  If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, 

                                      -3-
<PAGE>
 
a Series of Certificates and/or Notes may be issuable in book-entry form. In
such event, the related Certificates and/or Notes may be registered in the name
of Cede & Co. ("Cede"), the nominee of The Depository Trust Company ("DTC") or
another nominee. All reports will be provided to Cede or such other nominee,
which in turn will provide such reports to Participants and Indirect
Participants (as defined herein) of DTC or such other entities as described in
the related Prospectus Supplement. Such Participants and Indirect Participants
will then forward such reports to the beneficial owners of Securities. See
"Description of the Securities Book-Entry Registration."


                INCORPORATION OF CERTAIN DOCUMENTS BY REFERENCE


  All documents filed by or on behalf of the Trust referred to in the
accompanying Prospectus Supplement with the Commission pursuant to Section
13(a), 13(c), 14 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended
(the "Exchange Act"), subsequent to the date of this Prospectus and prior to the
termination of the offering of the Certificates issued by such Trust shall be
deemed to be incorporated by reference in this Prospectus and the related
Prospectus Supplement and to be a part hereof  from the date of the filing of
such documents.  With respect to any Class of Certificates and/or Notes that is
supported by a Guaranty of The Money Store (a "Guaranty"), The Money Store's
Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1996, and Quarterly
Reports on Form 10-Q for the periods ended March 31 and June 30, 1997, which
have been filed with the Commission, are hereby incorporated by reference in
this Prospectus and the related Prospectus Supplement .  With respect to any
Class of Securities that is supported by a Guaranty, all documents filed by The
Money Store pursuant to Section 13(a), 13(c), 14 or 15(d) of the Securities
Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, subsequent to the date of this Prospectus and
prior to the termination of the offering of the Securities shall be deemed to be
incorporated by reference into this Prospectus  and the related Prospectus
Supplement and to be a part hereof from the respective dates of filing such
documents.  Any statement contained herein or in a document incorporated or
deemed to be incorporated by reference herein shall be deemed to be modified or
superseded for purposes of this Prospectus to the extent that a statement
contained herein (or in the accompanying Prospectus Supplement) or in any other
subsequently filed document which also is or is deemed to be incorporated by
reference herein modifies or supersedes such statement.  Any such statement so
modified or superseded shall not be deemed, except as so modified or superseded,
to constitute part of this Prospectus.  The Representative will provide without
charge to each person to whom a copy of the Prospectus is delivered, on the
written or oral request of any such person, a copy of any or all of the
documents incorporated herein by reference, except the exhibits to such
documents (unless such exhibits are specifically incorporated by reference in
such documents).  Requests for such copies should be directed to The Money Store
Inc., 3301 C Street, Suite 100-M, Sacramento, California 95816, Attention:
Investor Relations, Telephone: (916) 446-5000.

                                      -4-
<PAGE>
 
                               SUMMARY OF TERMS



  This summary is qualified in its entirety by reference to the detailed
information appearing elsewhere in this Prospectus and in the related Prospectus
Supplement.  Capitalized terms used but not defined in this Prospectus shall
have the meanings assigned to such terms elsewhere in this Prospectus.



Securities
Offered............  The Money Store Asset Backed Certificates (the
                     "Certificates") and The Money Store Asset  Backed Notes
                     (the "Notes"). Notes are issuable from time to time in
                     Series pursuant to an Indenture (an "Indenture"), and
                     Certificates are issuable from time to time in Series
                     pursuant to either a Pooling and Servicing Agreement (a
                     "Pooling and Servicing Agreement") or a Trust Agreement (a
                     "Trust Agreement").  As used herein, "Agreements" means,
                     collectively, with respect to a Series of Certificates, the
                     related Pooling and Servicing Agreement or the related
                     Trust Agreement, with respect to a Series of Notes, the
                     related Indenture and the related Sale and Servicing
                     Agreement, as the context requires, and with respect to a
                     Series of Securities, the relevant combination of
                     Agreements for such Series.  Each Certificate of a Series
                     will evidence an interest in the Trust Fund or Trust Funds
                     for such Series, as specified in the related Prospectus
                     Supplement.  Each Series of Securities will consist of one
                     or more Classes, each Class may differ in, among other
                     things, the amounts allocated to and the priority of
                     principal and interest payments.  The Securities of each
                     Class will be issued in fully registered form in the
                     denominations specified in the related Prospectus
                     Supplement.  If so specified in the related Prospectus
                     Supplement, the Securities or certain Classes of such
                     Securities offered thereby may be available in book-entry
                     form only.



Issuers............  Certain trust funds (each, a "Trust") represented by The
                     Money Store or its affiliates, the primary assets of which
                     will be one or more Pools of Mortgage Loans and certain
                     other Mortgage Assets.


Representative
and Master
Servicer...........  The Money Store Inc. ("The Money Store"), a New Jersey
                     corporation, or certain of its affiliates.  The Prospectus
                     Supplement relating to any Series of Certificates and/or
                     Notes will name the entities (which may include The Money
                     Store or one of its affiliates and may additionally include
                     other unrelated entities) which will act, directly or
                     through one or more Sub-Servicers (as defined herein), as
                     master servicers (each, in such capacity, the "Master
                     Servicer"), on the terms and conditions set forth in the
                     related Pooling and Servicing Agreement or Sale and
                     Servicing Agreement (a "Sale and Servicing Agreement").
                     The principal offices of The Money Store are located in
                     Sacramento, California and Union, New Jersey.  See "The
                     Representative and the Originators."


The Mortgage
Assets.............  The Securities will evidence fractional undivided ownership
                     interests in certain Trusts further described herein.  The
                     primary assets of each Trust may consist of one or more
                     pools (each, a "Pool") of Mortgage Loans and certain other
                     mortgage-related assets ("Mortgage Assets") specified in
                     the related Prospectus Supplements, which may include (i)
                     first, second and more junior lien mortgage loans, deeds of
                     trust or participations therein secured by one- to four-
                     family residential properties, including low-rise
                     condominiums, single family detached homes, single-family
                     attached homes, planned unit developments and mixed use

                                      -5-
<PAGE>
 
                     properties (collectively, "Single Family Loans," which
                     Single Family Loans may be "Conventional Loans" (i.e.,
                                                                      ---- 
                     loans that are not insured or guaranteed by any
                     governmental agency) or loans that are insured by the
                     Federal Housing Authority ("FHA") or partially guaranteed
                     by the Veterans' Administration ("VA") as specified in the
                     related Prospectus Supplement), (ii) loans or
                     participations therein secured by security interests or
                     similar liens on shares in private, non-profit cooperative
                     housing corporations ("Cooperatives") and on the related
                     proprietary leases or occupancy agreements granting
                     exclusive rights to occupy specific dwelling units in such
                     Cooperatives' buildings ("Cooperative Loans"), (iii) first,
                     second and more junior lien mortgage loans, deeds of trust
                     or participations therein secured by multifamily
                     residential or mixed-use properties, such as rental
                     apartment buildings (including buildings owned by
                     Cooperatives) or projects containing five or more
                     residential units ("Multifamily Loans"), (iv) conditional
                     sales contracts and installment sales or loan agreements or
                     participations therein secured by manufactured housing
                     ("Contracts"), (v) mortgage-backed securities issued or
                     guaranteed by the Government National Mortgage Association
                     ("GNMA"), the Federal National Mortgage Association
                     ("FNMA") or the Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation
                     ("FHLMC") (the "Agency Securities"), (vi) privately issued
                     mortgage-backed securities not constituting Agency
                     Securities ("Private Mortgage-Backed Securities" or
                     "PMBS"), (vii) first, second and more junior home
                     improvement mortgage loans that are either conventional
                     loans ("Secured Conventional Home Improvement Loans") or
                     loans originated under the Title I credit insurance program
                     created under the National Housing Act of 1934 by the
                     Federal Housing Administration ("FHA Loans"), and (viii)
                     unsecured home improvement loans consisting of conventional
                     unsecured home improvement loans and FHA insured home
                     improvement loans (the "Unsecured Home Improvement Loans").
                     The Single Family Loans, Cooperative Loans, Multifamily
                     Loans, Secured Conventional Home Improvement Loans, FHA
                     Loans and Unsecured Home Improvement Loans are sometimes
                     referred to herein collectively as the "Mortgage Loans."
                     The Mortgage Loans may be closed-end or revolving as
                     described in the related Prospectus Supplement.


A.  Mortgage
  Loans............  The payment terms of the Mortgage Loans to be included in
                     any Pool will be described in the related Prospectus
                     Supplement and may include any of the following features,
                     combinations thereof or other features described in the
                     related Prospectus Supplement:



                   (a)  Interest may be payable at a fixed rate (a "Fixed Rate")
                        or may be payable at a rate that is adjustable from time
                        to time in relation to an index, that may be fixed for a
                        period of time or under certain circumstances and is
                        followed by an adjustable rate, a rate that other-wise
                        varies from time to time, or a rate that is convertible
                        from an adjustable rate to a fixed rate (each, an
                        "Adjustable Rate").  The specified rate of interest on a
                        Mortgage Loan is its "Mortgage Interest Rate."  Changes
                        to an Adjustable Rate may be subject to periodic
                        limitations, maximum rates, minimum rates or a
                        combination of such limitations.  Accrued interest may
                        be deferred and added to the principal of a Mortgage
                        Loan for such periods and under such circumstances as
                        may be specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.
                        Mortgage Loans may permit the payment of interest at a
                        rate lower than the Mortgage Interest Rate for a period
                        of time or for the life of the Mortgage Loan, and the
                        amount of any difference may be contributed from funds
                        supplied by the seller of the properties securing the
                        related 

                                      -6-
<PAGE>
 
                        Mortgage Loan (the "Mortgaged Properties") or another
                        source or may be treated as accrued interest and added
                        to the principal of the Mortgage Loan.


                   (b)  Principal may be payable on a level basis to fully
                        amortize the Mortgage Loan over its term, may be
                        calculated on the basis of an assumed amortization
                        schedule that is significantly longer than the original
                        term to maturity or on an interest rate that is
                        different from the Mortgage Interest Rate, or may not be
                        amortized during all or a portion of the original term.
                        Payment of all or a substantial portion of the principal
                        may be due on maturity (a "balloon" payment).  From time
                        to time, principal may include interest that has been
                        deferred and added to the principal balance of the
                        Mortgage Loan.

                   (c)  Monthly payments of principal and interest may be fixed
                        for the life of the Mortgage Loan, may increase over a
                        specified period of time ("graduated payments"), or may
                        change from period to period.  Mortgage Loans may
                        include limits on periodic increases or decreases in the
                        amount of monthly payments and may include maximum or
                        minimum amounts of monthly payments.

                   (d)  Prepayments of principal may be subject to a prepayment
                        fee, which may be fixed for the life of the Mortgage
                        Loan or may adjust or decline over time, and may be
                        prohibited for the life of the Mortgage Loan or for
                        certain periods ("Lockout Periods").  Certain Mortgage
                        Loans may permit prepayments after expiration of the
                        applicable Lockout Period and may require the payment of
                        a prepayment fee in connection with any such subsequent
                        prepayment.  Other Mortgage Loans may permit prepayments
                        without payment of a fee unless the prepayment occurs
                        during specified time periods.  The Mortgage Loans may
                        include due-on-sale clauses which permit the mortgagee
                        to demand payment of the entire Mortgage Loan in
                        connection with the sale or certain other transfers of
                        the related Mortgaged Properties.  Other Mortgage Loans
                        may be assumable by persons meeting the then applicable
                        underwriting standards of the originator.



                     The Mortgaged Properties relating to Mortgage Loans may be
                     located in any one of the fifty states, the District of
                     Columbia, the Commonwealth of Puerto Rico or any other
                     commonwealth, territory or possession of the United States.
                     The Mortgaged Properties generally will be covered by
                     standard hazard insurance policies ("Standard Hazard
                     Insurance Policies") insuring against losses due to fire
                     and various other causes.  The Mortgage Loans may be
                     covered by Primary Mortgage Insurance Policies to the
                     extent provided in the related Prospectus Supplement.  As
                     set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement, certain of
                     the Mortgage Loans underlying a given Series of Securities
                     may have been originated by the Representative, the
                     Originators or affiliates thereof and certain Mortgage
                     Loans may have been purchased by the Representative, an
                     Originator or an affiliate thereof in the open market or in
                     privately negotiated transactions, including transactions
                     with entities affiliated with the Representative.

                     Certain of the Mortgage Loans may be partially insured by
                     the FHA, an agency of the United States Department of
                     Housing and Urban Development ("HUD"), pursuant to the
                     Title I credit insurance program (the "Title I Loan
                     Program") of the National Housing Act of 1934.  Several
                     types of loans may be made under 

                                      -7-
<PAGE>
 
                     the Title I Loan Program, including (1) property
                     improvement loans; (2) manufactured home purchase loans,
                     (3) manufactured home lot loans; and (4) combination loans
                     (to purchase a manufactured home and a lot). The Title I
                     Loan Program is a coinsurance program. The lender initially
                     is at risk for 10% of the principal balance of each loan.
                     The FHA will insure the remaining 90% of the principal
                     balance of each loan, subject to certain limits. Such FHA
                     insurance is accorded the full faith and credit of the
                     United States of America.

                     The Prospectus Supplement for each Series of Securities
                     generally will specify with respect to all Mortgage Loans
                     expected to be included in the related Pool as of the
                     related closing date, among other things, (i) the expected
                     aggregate outstanding principal balance and the expected
                     average outstanding principal balance of the Mortgage Loans
                     in such Pool as of the date specified in the Prospectus
                     Supplement, (ii) the largest expected principal balance and
                     the smallest expected principal balance of any of the
                     Mortgage Loans, (iii) the types of Mortgaged Properties
                     and/or other assets securing the Mortgage Loans and the
                     percentage, if any, of Unsecured Home Improvement Loans
                     expected to be included in the related Pool, (iv) the
                     original terms to maturity of the Mortgage Loans, (v) the
                     expected weighted average term to maturity of the Mortgage
                     Loans as of the date specified in the Prospectus Supplement
                     and the expected range of the terms to maturity, (vi) the
                     earliest origination date and latest maturity date of any
                     of the Mortgage Loans, (vii) the expected weighted average
                     Combined Loan-to-Value Ratios at origination  (viii) the
                     expected weighted average Mortgage Rate or APR and ranges
                     of Mortgage Rates or APRs borne by the Mortgage Loans or
                     Contracts (as the case may be), (ix) in the case of
                     Mortgage Loans having Adjustable Rates, the expected
                     weighted average of the Adjustable Rates as of the date set
                     forth in the Prospectus Supplement and maximum permitted
                     Adjustable Rates, if any, (x) the expected aggregate
                     outstanding principal balance, if any, of "buydown"
                     mortgage loans (as hereinafter described) and Mortgage
                     Loans having graduated payment provisions, as of the date
                     set forth in the Prospectus Supplement, (xi) the amount of
                     any Guaranty Insurance Policy, Mortgage Pool Insurance
                     Policy, Special Hazard Insurance Policy or Bankruptcy Bond
                     (each as defined herein) to be maintained with respect to
                     such Pool, (xii)  the amount, if any, and terms of any
                     other credit enhancement or other derivative instruments to
                     be provided with respect to all or any Mortgage Loans or
                     the Pool and (xiii) the expected geographic location of the
                     Mortgaged Properties, if any.

B.  Contracts......  Contracts will consist of conditional sales and installment
                     sales or loan agreements secured by new or used
                     Manufactured Homes (as defined herein).  To the extent
                     provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, each
                     Contract will be fully amortizing and will bear interest at
                     a fixed annual percentage rate ("APR").

C.  Agency
  Securities.......  The Agency Securities will consist of (i) fully modified
                     pass-through mortgage-backed certificates guaranteed as to
                     timely payment of principal and interest by the Government
                     National Mortgage Association ("GNMA Certificates"), (ii)
                     guaranteed mortgage pass-through certificates issued and
                     guaranteed as to timely payment of principal and interest
                     by the Federal National Mortgage Association ("FNMA
                     Certificates"), (iii) Mortgage Participation Certificates
                     issued and guaranteed as to timely payment of interest and,
                     unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus
                     Supplement, ultimate payment of principal by the Federal
                     Home Loan Mortgage Corporation 

                                      -8-
<PAGE>
 
                     ("FHLMC Certificates"), (iv) stripped mortgage-backed
                     securities representing an undivided interest in all or a
                     part of either the principal distributions (but not the
                     interest distributions) or the interest distributions (but
                     not the principal distributions) or in some specified
                     portion of the principal and interest distributions (but
                     not all of such distributions) on certain GNMA, FNMA, FHLMC
                     or other government agency or government-sponsored agency
                     Certificates and, unless otherwise specified in the
                     Prospectus Supplement, guaranteed to the same extent as the
                     underlying securities, (v) another type of guaranteed pass-
                     through certificate issued or guaranteed by GNMA, FNMA,
                     FHLMC or another government agency or government-sponsored
                     agency and described in the related Prospectus Supplement,
                     or (vi) a combination of such Agency Securities. All GNMA
                     Certificates will be backed by the full faith and credit of
                     the United States. No FNMA or FHLMC Certificates will be
                     backed, directly or indirectly, by the full faith and
                     credit of the United States. The Agency Securities may
                     consist of pass-through securities issued under the GNMA I
                     Program, the GNMA II Program, FHLMC's Cash or Guarantor
                     Program or another program specified in the Prospectus
                     Supplement. The payment characteristics of the Mortgage
                     Loans underlying the Agency Securities will be described in
                     the related Prospectus Supplement. See "The Trusts--Agency
                     Securities."
                     
D.  Private Mortgage-
  Backed
  Securities.......  Private Mortgage-Backed Securities may include (i) mortgage
                     participations or pass-through certificates representing
                     beneficial interests in certain mortgage loans or (ii)
                     Collateralized Mortgage Obligations ("CMOs") secured by
                     such mortgage loans.  Although individual mortgage loans
                     underlying a Private Mortgage-Backed Security (each an
                     "Underlying Mortgage Loan") may be insured or guaranteed by
                     the United States or an agency or instrumentality thereof,
                     they need not be, and the Private Mortgage-Backed
                     Securities themselves will not be, so insured or
                     guaranteed.  Unless otherwise specified in the Prospectus
                     Supplement relating to a Series of Securities, payments on
                     the Private Mortgage-Backed Securities will be distributed
                     directly to the Trustee as registered owner of such Private
                     Mortgage-Backed Securities.  See "The Trusts--Private
                     Mortgage-Backed Securities."


                     The Prospectus Supplement for each Series of Securities
                     will specify, with respect to any Private Mortgaged-Backed
                     Securities owned by the related Trust:  (i) the aggregate
                     approximate principal amount and type of Private Mortgage-
                     Backed Securities; (ii) certain characteristics of the
                     mortgage loans underlying the Private Mortgage-Backed
                     Securities, including (A) the payment features of such
                     mortgage loans, (B) the approximate aggregate principal
                     amount, if known, of the underlying mortgage loans which
                     are insured or guaranteed by a governmental entity, (C) the
                     servicing fee or range of servicing fees with respect to
                     such mortgage loans, and (D) the minimum and maximum stated
                     maturities of the mortgage loans at origination; (iii) the
                     maximum original term-to-stated maturity of the Private
                     Mortgage-Backed Securities; (iv) the weighted average term-
                     to-stated maturity of the Private Mortgage-Backed
                     Securities; (v) the pass-through or certificate rate or
                     ranges thereof for the Private Mortgage-Backed Securities;
                     (vi) the weighted average pass-through or certificate rate
                     of the Private Mortgage-Backed Securities; (vii) the issuer
                     of the Private Mortgage-Backed Securities (the "PMBS
                     Issuer"), the servicer of the Private Mortgage-Backed
                     Securities (the "PMBS Servicer") and the trustee of the
                     Private Mortgage-Backed Securities (the "PMBS Trustee");
                     (viii) certain 

                                      -9-
<PAGE>
 
                     characteristics of credit support, if any, such as reserve
                     funds, insurance policies, letters of credit, financial
                     guaranty insurance policies or third party guarantees,
                     relating to the mortgage loans underlying the Private
                     Mortgage-Backed Securities, or to such Private Mortgage-
                     Backed Securities themselves; (ix) the terms on which
                     underlying mortgage loans for such Private Mortgage-Backed
                     Securities may, or are required to, be repurchased prior to
                     stated maturity; and (x) the terms on which substitute
                     mortgage loans may be delivered to replace those initially
                     deposited with the PMBS Trustee. See "The Trusts."

Pre-Funding
Account............  If provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
                     original principal amount of a Series of Securities may
                     exceed the principal balance of the Mortgage Assets
                     initially being delivered to the Trustee.  Cash in an
                     amount up to the amount of such difference (such amount,
                     the "Pre-Funded Amount") will be deposited into a separate
                     trust account (the "Pre-Funding Account") maintained with
                     the Trustee for the benefit of the Holders.  During the
                     period set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement (the
                     "Funding Period"), the Pre-Funded Amount in the Pre-Funding
                     Account may be used to purchase additional Mortgage Assets
                     for the related Trust subject to the satisfaction of
                     certain conditions specified under the Agreements.



                     For a Trust that elects to be characterized as either a
                     REMIC or a grantor trust under current federal income tax
                     laws, the maximum length of the related Funding Period will
                     not exceed three calendar months or 90 days, respectively,
                     from the date of issuance of the Securities and otherwise
                     the maximum length of the Funding Period will not exceed
                     the period set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement.
                     The amount of the initial Pre-Funded Amount is intended not
                     to exceed the aggregate principal balance of additional
                     Mortgage Assets that the Representative anticipates will be
                     acquired and conveyed to the Trust during the applicable
                     Funding Period.



                     Prior to the conveyance of any additional Mortgage Assets
                     to the Trust, the Representative will be required to give
                     notice of the additional Mortgage Assets to be conveyed to
                     the Trust to the Trustee(s) and any third-party credit
                     enhancement provider.  Upon the satisfaction of the
                     conditions set forth in the Agreement, the Trustee will
                     release from the Pre-Funding Account the necessary funds to
                     purchase the additional Mortgage Assets to be conveyed to
                     the Trust on such date.  If any Pre-Funded Amount remains
                     on deposit in the Pre-Funding Account at the end of the
                     Funding Period, such amount, in the amounts and in the
                     manner specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, will
                     be used to prepay some or all Classes of the related Series
                     of Certificates and/or Notes.



Revolving Period and
Amortization Period;
Retained Interest... If the related Prospectus Supplement so provides, there may
                     be a period commencing on the date of issuance of a Class
                     or Classes of Notes and/or Certificates of a Series and
                     ending on the date set forth in the related Prospectus
                     Supplement (each, a "Revolving Period") during which
                     limited or no principal payments will be made to one or
                     more Classes of Notes and/or Certificates of the related
                     Series as are identified in such Prospectus Supplement.
                     Some or all collections of principal otherwise allocated to
                     such Classes of Notes or Certificates may be (i) utilized
                     during the Revolving Period to acquire 

                                      -10-
<PAGE>
 
                     additional Mortgage Assets which satisfy the criteria
                     described under "The Trusts--The Mortgage Loans" and the
                     criteria set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement,
                     (ii) held in an account and invested in Permitted
                     Investments (as defined herein), for later distribution to
                     Securityholders, (iii) applied to those Notes or
                     Certificates for such Series, if any, specified in the
                     related Prospectus Supplement as then are in amortization,
                     or (iv) otherwise applied as specified in the related
                     Prospectus Supplement.


                       An "Amortization Period" is the period during which an
                     amount of principal is payable to Holders of Securities
                     which, during the Revolving Period, were not otherwise
                     entitled to such payments.  If so specified in the related
                     Prospectus Supplement, during an Amortization Period all or
                     a portion of principal collections on the Mortgage Loans
                     may be applied as specified above for a Revolving Period
                     and, to the extent not so applied, will be distributed to
                     the Classes of Notes and/or Certificates for such Series
                     specified in the related Prospectus Supplement as then
                     being entitled to payments of principal.  In addition, if
                     so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, amounts
                     deposited in certain accounts for the benefit of one or
                     more Classes of Notes or Certificates  for such Series may
                     be released from time to time or on a specified date and
                     applied as a payment of principal on such Classes of Notes
                     and/or Certificates.  The related Prospectus Supplement
                     will set forth the circumstances which will result in the
                     commencement of an Amortization Period.


                       Each Series which has a Revolving Period may also issue
                     to the Representative or one of its affiliates a
                     certificate evidencing an undivided beneficial interest (a
                     "Retained Interest") in such Series not represented by the
                     other Securities issued by the related Trusts.  As further
                     described in the related Prospectus Supplement, the value
                     of such Retained Interest will fluctuate as the amount of
                     Notes and Certificates of the related Series of Securities
                     outstanding is reduced.


Description of the
Certificates.......  Each Certificate will represent a fractional undivided
                     ownership interest in the Trust created pursuant to the
                     related Agreement.  The primary assets of such Trust will
                     be a Pool of Mortgage Loans and certain other Mortgage
                     Assets.  The Certificates of any Series may be issued in
                     one or more Classes, as specified in the related Prospectus
                     Supplement.  A Series of Certificates may include one or
                     more Classes of senior Certificates (collectively, "Senior
                     Certificates") which receive certain preferential treatment
                     specified in the related Prospectus Supplement with respect
                     to one or more Classes of subordinate Certificates
                     (collectively, the "Subordinated Certificates").  In
                     addition, a Series may include one or more Series entitled
                     to (i) principal payments with disproportionate, nominal or
                     no interest payments or (ii) interest payments with
                     disproportionate, nominal or no principal payments (such
                     Certificates, "Strip Certificates").  Certain Series or
                     Classes of Certificates may be covered by a Guaranty
                     Insurance Policy, Mortgage Pool Insurance Policy, Special
                     Hazard Insurance Policy, Bankruptcy Bond or other insurance
                     policies, cash accounts, letters of credit, financial
                     guaranty insurance policies, third party guarantees,
                     supplemental interest payments or other forms of credit
                     enhancement or maturity protection, or derivative products
                     as described herein and in the related Prospectus
                     Supplement.



                     Each Class of Certificates within a Series will evidence
                     the interests specified in the related Prospectus
                     Supplement, which may (i) include the right to receive

                                      -11-
<PAGE>
 
                     distributions allocable only to principal, only to interest
                     or to any combination thereof; (ii) include the right to
                     receive distributions only of prepayments of principal
                     throughout the lives of the Certificates or during
                     specified periods; (iii) be subordinated in its right to
                     receive distributions of scheduled payments of principal,
                     prepayments of principal, interest or any combination
                     thereof to one or more other Classes of Certificates of
                     such Series throughout the lives of the Certificates or
                     during specified periods or may be subordinated with
                     respect to certain losses or delinquencies; (iv) include
                     the right to receive such distributions only after the
                     occurrence of events specified in the Prospectus
                     Supplement; (v) include the right to receive distributions
                     in accordance with a schedule or formula or on the basis of
                     collections from designated portions of the assets in the
                     related Trust; (vi) include, as to Certificates entitled to
                     distributions allocable to interest, the right to receive
                     interest at a fixed rate or a floating rate; and (vii)
                     include, as to Certificates entitled to distributions
                     allocable to interest, the right to distributions allocable
                     to interest only after the occurrence of events specified
                     in the related Prospectus Supplement, and in each case, may
                     accrue interest until such events occur, as specified in
                     such Prospectus Supplement.  The timing and amounts of such
                     distributions may vary among Classes, over time, or
                     otherwise as specified in the related Prospectus
                     Supplement.  The Pass-Through Rate for a Class of
                     Certificates that pay interest based upon a floating rate
                     of interest, as specified in the related Prospectus
                     Supplement, may base such floating rate upon any of
                     following: (i) the auction procedures for Auction Rate
                     Securities described herein, (ii) LIBOR plus an amount set
                     forth in the related Prospectus Supplement , (iii) the T-
                     Bill Rate plus an amount set forth in the related
                     Prospectus Supplement or (iv) any such other method or
                     procedures used to determine the floating rate of interest
                     as may be described in the applicable Prospectus
                     Supplement.



                       The Certificates will be issuable in fully registered
                     form, in minimum denominations of $1,000 and integral
                     multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof (or such other
                     amounts as may be set forth in a Prospectus Supplement),
                     except that one Certificate of each Class may be issued in
                     a different denomination.  See "Description of Securities."


                       With respect to any Series of Securities including one or
                     more Classes of Notes, distributions in respect of the
                     Certificates may be subordinated in priority of payment to
                     payments on the Notes of such Series, to the extent
                     specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.


Description of 
 the Notes.........  Any Series of Securities may include one or more Classes of
                     Notes, as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement,
                     each of which will be issued pursuant to an Indenture and
                     will be treated as debt obligations of the related Trust.



                       Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus
                     Supplement, Notes will be available for  purchase in
                     denominations of $1,000 and integral multiples of $1,000
                     (or such other accounts as may be set forth in a Prospectus
                     Supplement), except that one Note of each Class may be
                     issued in a different denomination, in book-entry form or
                     in definitive form, as specified in the related Prospectus
                     Supplement.  See "Description of the Securities."



                       Each Class of Notes will have a stated principal amount
                     and will bear interest at the Interest Rate or Rates as
                     specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, which may
                     be different for each Class of Notes and may be fixed,
                     variable, adjustable, or any combination of the foregoing.
                     The related Prospectus 

                                      -12-
<PAGE>
 
                     Supplement will specify the Interest Rate for each Class of
                     Notes or the method for determining the Interest Rate. The
                     Interest Rate for a Class of Notes that pay interest based
                     upon a floating rate of interest, as specified in the
                     related Prospectus Supplement, may base such floating rate
                     upon any of following: (i) the auction procedures for
                     Auction Rate Securities described herein, (ii) LIBOR plus
                     an amount set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement ,
                     (iii) the T-Bill Rate plus an amount set forth in the
                     related Prospectus Supplement or (iv) any such other method
                     or procedures used to determine the floating rate of
                     interest as may be described in the applicable Prospectus
                     Supplement. Each Note may also represent a fractional
                     undivided interest in, or be entitled to receive payments
                     from, monies on deposit, if any, in the Pre-Funding Account
                     as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement and any
                     other account established for the benefit of Noteholders,
                     as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.



                       A Series may include two or more Classes of Notes which
                     differ as to the timing and priority of payment, seniority,
                     allocations of loss, Interest Rate or amount of payments of
                     principal or interest, or as to which payments of principal
                     or interest may or may not be made upon the occurrence of
                     specified events or on the basis of collections from
                     designated portions of the Mortgage Assets for such Series.
                     In addition, a Series may include one or more Classes of
                     Notes entitled to (i) principal payments with
                     disproportionate, nominal or no interest payments or  (ii)
                     interest payments with disproportionate, nominal or no
                     principal payments (such Notes, "Strip Notes").  A Series
                     of Notes may include one or more Classes of senior Notes
                     (collectively, "Senior Notes") which receive certain
                     preferential treatment specified in the related Prospectus
                     Supplement with respect to one or more Classes of
                     subordinate Notes (collectively, the "Subordinated Notes").
                     Certain Series or Classes of Notes may be covered by a
                     Guaranty Insurance Policy, Mortgage Pool Insurance Policy,
                     Special Hazard Insurance Policy, Bankruptcy Bond or other
                     insurance policies, cash accounts, letters of credit,
                     financial guaranty insurance policies, third party
                     guarantees, supplemental interest payments or other forms
                     of credit enhancement or maturity protection or derivative
                     instruments, as described herein and in the related
                     Prospectus Supplement.


Credit
Enhancement........  The Mortgage Assets in a Trust or the Securities of one or
                     more Classes in the related Series may have the benefit of
                     one or more types of credit enhancement, as described in
                     the related Prospectus Supplement. The protection against
                     losses afforded by any such credit support may be limited.
                     Such credit enhancement may include one or more of the
                     following types:


A.  Subordination
  and Reserve
  Accounts ........  The rights of all Certificateholders will be subordinated
                     to the rights of all Noteholders of a Series to receive
                     distributions to the extent described in the related
                     Prospectus Supplement, with respect to the Mortgage Assets
                     and other assets in the related Trust.  The rights of the
                     holders of Subordinated Certificates and/or Subordinated
                     Notes, as the case may be (collectively, "Subordinated
                     Securities"), of a Series to receive distributions will be
                     subordinated to the rights of the holders of the Senior
                     Certificates and/or Senior Notes, as the case may be
                     (collectively, "Senior Securities"), of the same Series to
                     receive distributions to the extent described in the
                     related Prospectus Supplement. This subordination is
                     intended to enhance the likelihood of regular 

                                      -13-
<PAGE>
 
                     receipt by holders of Senior Securities of the full amount
                     of payments which such holders would be entitled to receive
                     if there had been no losses or delinquencies. The
                     protection afforded to the holders of Senior Securities
                     through subordination may be accomplished by the
                     preferential right of such holders to receive, prior to any
                     distribution being made in respect of the related
                     Subordinated Securities the amounts of principal and
                     interest due to them on each Remittance Date out of the
                     funds available for distribution on such date in the
                     related Distribution Account (as defined herein) to the
                     extent described in the related Prospectus Supplement. The
                     protection afforded to the holders of Senior Securities
                     through subordination also may be accomplished by
                     allocating certain types of losses or delinquencies to the
                     related Subordinated Securities to the extent described in
                     the related Prospectus Supplement.



                     If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
                     same Class of Securities may constitute Senior Certificates
                     and/or Senior Notes, as the case may be, with respect to
                     certain types of payments or certain losses or
                     delinquencies and Subordinated Certificates and/or
                     Subordinated Notes, as the case may be, with respect to
                     other types of payments or losses or delinquencies.  If so
                     specified in the related Prospectus Supplement,
                     subordination may apply only in the event of certain types
                     of losses not covered by other forms of credit support,
                     such as hazard losses not covered by Standard Hazard
                     Insurance Policies or losses due to the bankruptcy of a
                     Mortgagor not covered by a Bankruptcy Bond.  If further
                     specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, one or more
                     reserve accounts (each, a "Reserve Account") may be
                     established and maintained, in whole or in part, by the
                     deposit therein of distributions allocable to the holders
                     of Subordinated Certificates and/or Subordinated Notes, as
                     the case may be, for a specified time or until a specified
                     level is reached.  The related Prospectus Supplement will
                     set forth information concerning the amount of
                     subordination of a Class or Classes of Subordinated
                     Certificates and/or Subordinated Notes, as the case may be,
                     in a Series, the circumstances in which such subordination
                     will be applicable, the manner, if any, in which the amount
                     of subordination will decrease over time, the manner of
                     funding any Reserve Account, and the conditions under which
                     amounts in any such Reserve Account will be used to make
                     distributions to holders of Senior Certificates and/or
                     Senior Notes, as the case may be, or released to holders of
                     Subordinated Certificates and/or Subordinated Notes, as the
                     case may be, from the related Trust.


B. Guaranty
  Insurance
  Policy...........  A certificate or note guaranty insurance policy (each a
                     "Guaranty Insurance Policy") may be obtained and maintained
                     for each Class or Series of Certificates and/or Notes.
                     Guaranty Insurance Policies generally unconditionally and
                     irrevocably guarantee that the full amount of the
                     distributions of principal and interest, as well as any
                     other amounts specified in the related Prospectus
                     Supplement, will be received by an agent of the Trustee,
                     for distribution by the Trustee to holders of the covered
                     Securities.  Guaranty Insurance Policies may have certain
                     limitations set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement,
                     including (but not limited to) limitations on the insurer's
                     obligation to guarantee the Master Servicer's obligation to
                     repurchase or substitute for any Mortgage Loans, to
                     guarantee any specified rate of prepayments or to provide
                     funds to redeem Securities on any specified date.


C.  Spread

                                      -14-
<PAGE>
 
  Amount...........  If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement,
                     certain Classes of Certificates and/or Notes may be
                     entitled to receive limited acceleration of principal
                     relative to the amortization of the related Mortgage
                     Assets.  The accelerated amortization will be achieved by
                     applying certain excess interest collected on the Mortgage
                     Assets to the payment of principal on such Classes of
                     Securities.  This acceleration feature is intended to
                     create an amount (the "Spread Amount"), resulting from, and
                     generally equal to, the excess of the aggregate principal
                     balances of the applicable Mortgage Assets over the
                     principal balances of the applicable Classes of Securities.
                     Once the required Spread Amount is reached, and subject to
                     the provisions described in the next sentence and in the
                     related Prospectus Supplement, the acceleration feature
                     will cease, unless necessary to maintain the required level
                     of the Spread Amount.  The applicable Agreement may provide
                     that, subject to certain floors, caps and triggers, the
                     required level of the Spread Amount may increase or
                     decrease over time.  An increase would result in a
                     temporary period of accelerated amortization of the
                     applicable Classes of Securities to increase the actual
                     level of the Spread Amount to its required level; a
                     decrease would result in a temporary period of decelerated
                     amortization to reduce the actual level of the Spread
                     Amount to its required level.  An Agreement also may
                     provide that after one or more Classes of Securities have
                     been paid to the required level of the Spread Amount,
                     excess interest, together with certain other excess
                     amounts, may be applied to make-up shortfalls in, or
                     accelerate the amortization of, other Classes of
                     Securities.


D.  Mortgage Pool
  Insurance
  Policy...........  A mortgage pool insurance policy or policies ("Mortgage
                     Pool Insurance Policy") may be obtained and maintained for
                     each Series pertaining to Mortgage Loans and Contracts,
                     limited in scope, covering defaults on the related Mortgage
                     Loans or Contracts in an initial amount equal to a
                     specified percentage of the aggregate principal balance of
                     all Mortgage Loans or Contracts included in the Pool as of
                     the Cut-off Date or such other date as is specified in the
                     related Prospectus Supplement.


E.  Special Hazard
  Insurance
  Policy...........  In the case of Mortgage Loans or Contracts, certain
                     physical risks that are not otherwise insured against by
                     Standard Hazard Insurance Policies may be covered by a
                     special hazard insurance policy or policies (a "Special
                     Hazard Insurance Policy").  The level of coverage of each
                     Special Hazard Insurance Policy will be specified in the
                     related Prospectus Supplement.


F.  Bankruptcy
  Bonds............  A mortgagor bankruptcy bond or bonds ("Bankruptcy Bond")
                     may be obtained to cover certain losses resulting from a
                     reduction by a bankruptcy court of scheduled payments of
                     principal or interest on a Mortgage Loan or Contract or a
                     reduction by such court of the principal amount of a
                     Mortgage Loan or Contract, and will cover certain unpaid
                     interest on the amount of such a principal reduction.  The
                     level of coverage of each Bankruptcy Bond will be specified
                     in the related Prospectus Supplement.


G.  Cross
  Support..........  If so specified in the Prospectus Supplement, the ownership
                     interests of separate Trusts or separate groups of assets
                     may be evidenced by separate Classes of the 

                                      -15-
<PAGE>
 
                     related Series of Certificates and/or Notes. In such case,
                     credit support may be provided by a cross-support feature
                     which requires that distributions be made with respect to
                     certain Certificates and/or Notes evidencing interests in
                     one or more Trusts or asset groups prior to distributions
                     to other Certificates and/or Notes evidencing interests in
                     other asset groups or Trusts. If specified in the related
                     Prospectus Supplement, the coverage provided by one or more
                     forms of credit support may apply concurrently to two or
                     more separate Trusts, without priority among such Trusts,
                     until the credit support is exhausted. If applicable, the
                     Prospectus Supplement will identify the Trusts or asset
                     groups to which such credit support relates and the manner
                     of determining the amount of the coverage provided thereby
                     and of the application of such coverage to the identified
                     Trusts or asset groups.



H.  Supplemental
  Interest
  Payments.........  If so specified in the Prospectus Supplement, one or more
                     Classes of Certificates and/or Notes may be entitled to
                     receive supplemental interest payments under specified
                     circumstances.  Supplemental interest payments will be
                     available to fund some or all of the difference, if any,
                     between the interest owed to a Class of Securities on a
                     Remittance Date and the interest that would be available to
                     pay such interest assuming no defaults or delinquencies on
                     the Mortgage Assets.  Such differences may result if the
                     interest rates on the applicable Classes of Securities are
                     based upon an index that differs from the index used in
                     determining the interest rates on the Mortgage Assets.
                     Except as otherwise provided in  a Prospectus Supplement,
                     supplemental interest payments will not be available to
                     fund shortfalls resulting from delinquencies or defaults on
                     the Mortgage Assets.


I.  Maturity
 Protection........  If so specified in the Prospectus Supplement, one or more
                     Classes of Certificates and/or Notes may be entitled to
                     third-party payments to help provide that the holders of
                     such Securities receive their unpaid principal on or prior
                     to a specified date.


J.  The Guaranty...  If so specified in the Prospectus Supplement, and in order
                     to provide additional credit enhancement, The Money Store
                     may provide a guaranty of amounts due on certain Classes of
                     Certificates and/or Notes.  The amount and formula for
                     calculating such guaranty shall be as set forth in the
                     Prospectus Supplement.

K.  Other Insurance,
  Guarantees, Swaps,
  and Similar 
  Instruments
  or Agreements....  If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, a Trust
                     may include in lieu of some or all of the foregoing or in
                     addition thereto letters of credit, financial guaranty
                     insurance policies, other third party guarantees, limited
                     guarantees or insurance from agencies or instrumentalities
                     of the United States, and other arrangements for
                     maintaining timely payments or providing additional
                     protection against losses on the assets included in such
                     Trust, paying administrative expenses, or accomplishing
                     such other purpose as may be described in the Prospectus
                     Supplement.  The Trust may include a guaranteed investment
                     contract or reinvestment agreement pursuant to which funds
                     held in one or more accounts will be invested at a
                     specified rate.


                     If any Class of Securities has a floating interest rate, or
                     if any of the Mortgage Assets has a floating interest rate,
                     the Trust may include an interest rate swap 

                                      -16-
<PAGE>
 
                     contract, an interest rate cap agreement or similar hedge
                     contract providing limited protection against interest rate
                     risks. If provided in the related Prospectus Supplement,
                     interest and/or principal on one or more Classes of the
                     Securities of a Series may be paid to Holders thereof in a
                     currency other than U.S. dollars. If so provided, the Trust
                     may, in connection therewith, enter into one or more
                     currency rate swaps to provide limited protection against
                     foreign currency rate fluctuation risks. One or more
                     Classes of Securities also may be issued in conjunction
                     with a put or call feature entitling (in the case of a put)
                     or obligating (in the case of a call) the applicable
                     Securityholders to sell some or all of its Securities to
                     the party named in the applicable Prospectus Supplement on
                     the date or dates set forth therein. Any such arrangement
                     must be acceptable to each nationally recognized rating
                     agency that provides a rating for the related Series of
                     Securities (the "Rating Agency"). Additionally, to the
                     extent a significant portion of the Mortgage Loans
                     underlying a given Series of Securities consists of FHA
                     Loans, the related Prospectus Supplement will describe the
                     features of any related credit support including, but not
                     limited to, that provided by the FHA, if any.



Monthly Advances...  If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
                     Master Servicer will be required under each Agreement to
                     remit to the Trustee no later than the day of each month
                     which is at least three business days prior to the
                     Remittance Date and is in no case earlier than the seventh
                     business day of such month (the "Determination Date") the
                     amount (a "Monthly Advance"), if any, by which (a) the sum
                     of (x) 30 days' interest at the weighted average Adjusted
                     Mortgage Loan Remittance Rate (as defined herein under
                     "Description of the Securities--Monthly Advances and
                     Compensating Interest") on the then outstanding principal
                     balance of the related Series of Certificates and/or Notes
                     and (y) the amount, if any, required to be deposited into
                     the related Reserve Account (as specified in the related
                     Prospectus Supplement) for the related Remittance Date
                     exceeds (b) the amount received by the Master Servicer in
                     respect of interest on the Mortgage Loans as of the related
                     Record Date.  Such advances by the Master Servicer are
                     reimbursable in the first instance from late collections of
                     interest, including amounts received in connection with the
                     liquidation of defaulted Mortgage Loans ("Liquidation
                     Proceeds"), amounts paid by any insurer pursuant to any
                     insurance policy covering a Mortgage Loan, Mortgaged
                     Property or REO Property ("Insurance Proceeds"), and
                     proceeds received by the Master Servicer in connection with
                     condemnation, eminent domain or a release of lien
                     ("Released Mortgaged Property Proceeds") collected with
                     respect to the related Mortgage Loans as to which the
                     advances were made, and any other amount that would
                     otherwise be distributed on the Class R Certificates.  The
                     Master Servicer will not be required to make any Monthly
                     Advances which it determines, in good faith, would be
                     nonrecoverable from amounts received in respect of the
                     Mortgage Loans.  See "Description of the Securities--
                     Monthly Advances and Compensating Interest."


Compensating
Interest...........  If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, with
                     respect to each Mortgage Loan as to which the Master
                     Servicer receives a principal payment in full in advance of
                     the final scheduled due date (a "Principal Prepayment") or
                     receives a principal payment that exceeds the scheduled
                     payment by a specified multiple, but which was not intended
                     by the Mortgagor to satisfy the Mortgage Loan in full or to
                     cure a delinquency (a "Curtailment"), the Master Servicer
                     will be required to remit to the Trustee, from amounts
                     otherwise payable to the Master Servicer as servicing
                     compensation, an amount ("Compensating 

                                      -17-
<PAGE>
 
                     Interest") equal to any excess of (a) 30 days' interest on
                     the principal balance of each such Mortgage Loan as of the
                     beginning of the related Due Period at the applicable
                     weighted average Adjusted Mortgage Loan Remittance Rate
                     over (b) the amount of interest actually received on the
                     related Mortgage Loan during such Due Period.


Optional
Termination........  The Master Servicer, certain insurers, the holders of
                     certain classes of Certificates or Notes, or certain other
                     entities specified in the related Prospectus Supplement may
                     have the option to effect early retirement of a Series of
                     Securities through the purchase of the related Mortgage
                     Assets and other assets in the related Trust under the
                     circumstances and in the manner described in "The
                     Agreement--Termination; Purchase of Mortgage Loans."


Mandatory
Termination........  The Trustee, the Master Servicer or certain other entities
                     specified in the related Prospectus Supplement may be
                     required to effect early retirement of a Series of
                     Securities under the circumstances and in the manner
                     specified in the related Prospectus Supplement and herein
                     under "The Agreement--Termination; Purchase of Mortgage
                     Loans."



Trustee............  The trustee or trustees under any Agreement relating to a
                     Series of Securities (each, a "Trustee") will be specified
                     in the related Prospectus Supplement.  Additionally, any
                     Co-Trustees, Custodians or Co-Custodians will be set forth
                     in the related Prospectus Supplement.



Federal Income Tax
Consequences.......  The federal income tax consequences of the purchase,
                     ownership and disposition of the Certificates of each
                     series will depend on whether an election is made to treat
                     the corresponding Trust (or certain assets of the Trust) as
                     a "real estate mortgage investment conduit" ("REMIC") under
                     the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the "Code"),
                     and, if such election is not made, whether the Trust is
                     structured and intended to be treated as a grantor trust, a
                     partnership or otherwise.



                     REMIC.  If an election is to be made to treat the Trust (or
                     -----                                                      
                     certain assets of the Trust) for a Series of Certificates
                     as a REMIC for federal income tax purposes, the related
                     Prospectus Supplement will specify which Class or Classes
                     thereof will be designated as regular interests in the
                     REMIC ("REMIC Regular Certificates") and which class of
                     Certificates will be designated as the residual interest in
                     the REMIC ("REMIC Residual Certificates").  To the extent
                     provided herein and in the related Prospectus Supplement,
                     in the opinion of Stroock & Stroock & Lavan LLP, special
                     federal tax counsel ("Federal Tax Counsel"), Certificates
                     representing an interest in the REMIC generally will be
                     considered "real estate assets" for purposes of Section
                     856(c)(5)(A) of the Code and assets described in Section
                     7701(a)(19)(C) of the Code, but generally will not be
                     considered "residential loans" for purposes of Section
                     593(g)(4)(B) of the Code.



                     In the opinion of Federal Tax Counsel, for federal income
                     tax purposes, REMIC Regular Certificates generally will be
                     treated as debt obligations of the Trust with payment terms
                     equivalent to the terms of such Certificates.  Holders of
                     REMIC Regular Certificates will be required to report
                     income with respect to such Certificates under an accrual
                     method, regardless of their normal tax 

                                      -18-
<PAGE>
 
                     accounting method. Original issue discount, if any, on
                     REMIC Regular Certificates will be includible in the income
                     of the Holders thereof as it accrues, in advance of receipt
                     of the cash attributable thereto, which rate of accrual
                     will be determined based on a reasonable assumed prepayment
                     rate. The REMIC Residual Certificates generally will not be
                     treated as evidences of indebtedness for federal income tax
                     purposes, but instead, as representing rights to the
                     taxable income or net loss of the REMIC.



                     Each holder of a REMIC Residual Certificate will be
                     required to take into account separately its pro rata
                     portion of the REMIC's taxable income or loss.  Certain
                     income of a REMIC (referred to as "excess inclusions")
                     generally may not be offset by such a holder's net
                     operating loss carryovers or other deductions, and in the
                     case of a tax-exempt holder of a REMIC Residual Certificate
                     will be treated as "unrelated business taxable income."  In
                     certain situations, particularly in the early years of a
                     REMIC, holders of a REMIC Residual Certificate may have
                     taxable income, and possibly tax liabilities with respect
                     to such income, in excess of cash distributed to them.
                     "DISQUALIFIED ORGANIZATIONS," AS DEFINED IN "FEDERAL INCOME
                     TAX CONSEQUENCES--REMIC RESIDUAL CERTIFICATES--TAX ON
                     DISPOSITION OF REMIC RESIDUAL CERTIFICATES; RESTRICTION ON
                     TRANSFER; HOLDING BY PASS-THROUGH ENTITIES," ARE PROHIBITED
                     FROM ACQUIRING OR HOLDING ANY BENEFICIAL INTEREST IN THE
                     REMIC RESIDUAL CERTIFICATES.



                     Grantor Trust.  If no election is to be made to treat the
                     -------------                                            
                     Trust for a series of Certificates ("Non-REMIC
                     Certificates") as a REMIC, the Trust may be classified as a
                     grantor trust for federal income tax purposes and not as an
                     association taxable as a corporation or a taxable mortgage
                     pool.  In the opinion of Federal Tax Counsel, holders of
                     Non-REMIC Certificates will be treated for such purposes,
                     subject to the possible application of the stripped bond
                     rules, as owners of undivided interests in the related
                     Mortgage Assets, generally will be required to report as
                     income their pro rata share of the entire gross income
                     (including amounts paid as reasonable servicing
                     compensation) from the Mortgage Assets, and will be
                     entitled, subject to certain limitations, to deduct their
                     pro rata share of expenses of the Trust.



                     To the extent provided in the related Prospectus
                     Supplement, Non-REMIC Certificates generally will represent
                     interests in "real estate assets" for purposes of Section
                     856(c)(5)(A) of the Code and "Loans . . . principally
                     secured by an interest in real property" within the meaning
                     of Section 7701(a)(19)(C)(v) of the Code, but should not be
                     considered "residential loans" for purposes of Section
                     593(g)(4)(B) of the Code.


                     Partnership. If no election is to be made to treat the
                     -----------
                     Trust for a Series as a REMIC and it is so specified in the
                     related Prospectus Supplement, the Trust will be treated as
                     a partnership for federal income tax purposes, and Federal
                     Tax Counsel will deliver its opinion generally to the
                     effect that the Trust will not be an association (or
                     publicly traded partnership) taxable as a corporation, or a
                     taxable mortgage pool, for federal income tax purposes.
                     Each Noteholder, by the acceptance of a Note of such
                     series, will agree to treat such Note as indebtedness, and
                     each Certificateholder, by the acceptance of a Certificate
                     of such series, will agree to treat the related Trust as a
                     partnership in which such Certificateholder is a partner
                     for federal income and state tax purposes.

                                      -19-
<PAGE>
 
                     Investors are advised to consult their tax advisors and to
                     review "Federal Income Tax Consequences" herein and, if
                     applicable, in the related Prospectus Supplement.


ERISA
Considerations.....  Fiduciaries of employee benefit plans or other retirement
                     plans or arrangements, including individual retirement
                     accounts, certain Keogh plans, and collective investment
                     funds, separate accounts and insurance company general
                     accounts in which such plans, accounts or arrangements are
                     invested, that are subject to the Employee Retirement
                     Income  Security  Act  of  1974,  as  amended ("ERISA"), or
                     the Code should carefully review with their legal advisors
                     whether an investment in Securities will cause the assets
                     of the related Trust to be considered plan assets under the
                     Department of Labor ("DOL") regulations set forth in 29
                     C.F.R. Section 2510.3-101 (the "Plan Asset Regulations"),
                     thereby subjecting the Trustee and the Master Servicer to
                     the fiduciary investment standards of ERISA, and whether
                     the purchase, holding or transfer of Securities gives rise
                     to a transaction that is prohibited under ERISA or subject
                     to the excise tax provisions of Section 4975 of the Code,
                     unless a DOL administrative exemption applies.   See "ERISA
                     Considerations."


Legal
Investment.........  Each Prospectus Supplement will describe the extent, if
                     any, to which the Classes of Securities offered thereby
                     will constitute "mortgage-related securities" for purposes
                     of the Secondary Mortgage Market Enhancement Act of 1984
                     ("SMMEA") and whether they will be legal investments for
                     certain types of institutional investors under SMMEA.  See
                     "Legal Investment" herein.


Registration of
Securities.........  Securities may be represented by global certificates and
                     notes registered in the name of Cede, as nominee of DTC or
                     another nominee.  In such case, Securityholders will not be
                     entitled to receive definitive certificates and/or notes
                     representing such Holders' interests, except in certain
                     circumstances described in the related Prospectus
                     Supplement.  See "Description of the Securities--Book-Entry
                     Registration" herein.

                                      -20-
<PAGE>
 
                                 RISK FACTORS


LIMITED LIQUIDITY

     There can be no assurance that a secondary market for the Securities will
develop or, if a secondary market does develop, that it will provide Holders of
the Securities with liquidity of investment or that it will continue for the
lives of the Securities.

BOOK-ENTRY REGISTRATION

     Issuance of the Certificates and/or Notes in book-entry form may reduce the
liquidity of such Securities in the secondary trading market since investors may
be unwilling to purchase Securities for which they cannot obtain physical
Securities.

     Since transactions in Certificates and Notes will, in most cases, be able
to be effected only through DTC, Direct or Indirect Participants and certain
banks, the ability of a Securityholder to pledge a Certificate or Note to
persons or entities that do not participate in the DTC system, or otherwise to
take actions in respect of such Securities, may be limited due to lack of a
physical certificate or note representing such Securities.

     Securityholders may experience some delay in their receipt of distributions
of interest on and principal of the Securities since distributions may be
required to be forwarded by the Trustee to DTC and, in such a case, DTC will be
required to credit such distributions to the accounts of its Participants which
thereafter will be required to credit them to the accounts of the applicable
Class of Securityholders either directly or indirectly through Indirect
Participants or such other entities as described in the related Prospectus
Supplement.  See "Description of the Securities--Book-Entry Registration."

NATURE OF SECURITY

     Certain of the Mortgage Loans will be loans secured by junior liens
subordinate to the rights of the mortgagee under each related senior mortgage.
As a result, the proceeds from any liquidation, insurance or condemnation
proceedings will be available to satisfy the principal balance of a junior
mortgage loan only to the extent that the claims, if any, of each such senior
mortgagee are satisfied in full, including any related foreclosure costs.  In
addition, a mortgagee may not foreclose on the mortgaged property unless it
forecloses subject to any related senior mortgage or mortgages, in which case it
must either pay the entire amount of each senior mortgage to the applicable
mortgagee at or prior to the foreclosure sale or undertake the obligation to
make payments on each senior mortgage in the event of default thereunder.  In
servicing mortgage loans in their portfolios, it has been the Originators'
practice to satisfy each such senior mortgage at or prior to the foreclosure
sale only to the extent that they determine any amounts so paid will be
recoverable from future payments and collections on the mortgage loans or
otherwise.  The Trusts will not have any source of funds to satisfy any such
senior mortgage or make payments due to any senior mortgagee.  See "Certain
Legal Aspects of the Mortgage Loans--Foreclosure/Repossession."

     An overall decline in the market value of residential real estate, the
general condition of a Mortgaged Property, or other factors, could adversely
affect the values of the Mortgaged Properties such that the outstanding balances
of the Mortgage Loans which are junior mortgage loans, together with any senior
liens on the Mortgaged Properties, equal or exceed the value of the Mortgaged
Properties.  Such a decline could extinguish the interest of the related Trust
in the Mortgaged Property before having any effect on the interest of the
related senior mortgagee.  The Representative will not be able to quantify the
impact of any property value declines on the Mortgage Loans or predict whether,
to what extent or how long such declines may continue.  In periods of such
declines, the actual rates of delinquencies, foreclosures and losses on the
Mortgage Loans could be higher than those historically experienced in the
mortgage lending industry in general.  See "The Single Family Lending Program--
Servicing and Collections."



     Certain of the Mortgage Loans may constitute "Balloon Loans."  Balloon
Loans are originated with a stated maturity of less than the period of time of
the corresponding amortization schedule.  As a result, upon the maturity of a
Balloon Loan, the Mortgagor will be required to make a "balloon" payment which
will be significantly larger than 

                                      -21-
<PAGE>
 
such Mortgagor's previous monthly payments. The ability of such a Mortgagor to
repay a Balloon Loan at maturity frequently will depend on such borrower's
ability to refinance the Mortgage Loan. The ability of a Mortgagor to refinance
such a Mortgage Loan will be affected by a number of factors, including the
level of available mortgage rates at the time, the value of the related
Mortgaged Property, the Mortgagor's equity in the related Mortgaged Property,
the financial condition of the Mortgagor and the tax laws and general economic
conditions at the time.

     Although a low interest rate environment may facilitate the refinancing of
a balloon payment, the receipt and reinvestment by Securityholders of the
proceeds in such an environment may produce a lower return than that previously
received in respect of the related Mortgage Loan.  Conversely, a high interest
rate environment may make it more difficult for the Mortgagor to accomplish a
refinancing and may result in delinquencies or defaults.  None of the
Representative, the Originators, the Master Servicer or the Trustee will be
obligated to provide funds to refinance any Mortgage Loan.

     General economic conditions have an impact on the ability of borrowers to
repay mortgage loans.  Loss of earnings, illness and other similar factors may
lead to an increase in delinquencies and bankruptcy filings by borrowers.  In
the event of bankruptcy of a Mortgagor, it is possible that a Trust could
experience a loss with respect to such Mortgagor's Mortgage Loan.  In
conjunction with a Mortgagor's bankruptcy, a bankruptcy court may suspend or
reduce the payments of principal and interest to be paid with respect to such
Mortgage Loan or permanently reduce the principal balance of such Mortgage Loan,
thus either delaying or permanently limiting the amount received by the Trust
with respect to such Mortgage Loan.  Moreover, in the event a bankruptcy court
prevents the transfer of the related Mortgaged Property to a Trust, any
remaining balance on such Mortgage Loan may not be recoverable.

     Even assuming that the Mortgaged Properties provide adequate security for
the Mortgage Loans, substantial delays could be encountered in connection with
the liquidation of defaulted Mortgage Loans and corresponding delays in the
receipt of related proceeds by the Securityholders could occur.  An action to
foreclose on a Mortgaged Property securing a Mortgage Loan is regulated by state
statutes and rules and is subject to many of the delays and expenses of other
lawsuits if defenses or counterclaims are interposed, sometimes requiring
several years to complete.  Furthermore, in some states an action to obtain a
deficiency judgment is not permitted following a nonjudicial sale of a Mortgaged
Property.  In the event of a default by a Mortgagor, these restrictions, among
other things, may impede the ability of the Master Servicer to foreclose on or
sell the Mortgaged Property or to obtain Liquidation Proceeds (net of expenses)
sufficient to repay all amounts due on the related Mortgage Loan.  The Master
Servicer will be entitled to deduct from Liquidation Proceeds all expenses
reasonably incurred in attempting to recover amounts due on the related
liquidated Mortgage Loan and not yet repaid, including payments to prior
lienholders, legal fees and costs of legal action, real estate taxes, and
maintenance and preservation expenses.  In the event that any Mortgaged
Properties fail to provide adequate security for the related Mortgage Loans and
insufficient funds are available from applicable Credit Enhancement,
Certificateholders could experience a loss on their investment.

     Liquidation expenses with respect to defaulted mortgage loans do not vary
directly with the outstanding principal balance of the loan at the time of
default.  Therefore, assuming that a servicer took the same steps in realizing
upon a defaulted mortgage loan having a small remaining principal balance as it
would in the case of a defaulted mortgage loan having a larger principal
balance, the amount realized after expenses of liquidation would be smaller as a
percentage of the outstanding principal balance of the smaller mortgage loan
than would be the case with a larger loan.  Because the average outstanding
principal balances of the Mortgage Loans which are junior mortgage loans are
small relative to the size of the loans in a typical pool composed entirely of
first mortgages, realizations net of liquidation expenses on defaulted Mortgage
Loans which are junior mortgage loans may also be smaller as a percentage of the
principal amount of such junior mortgage loans than would be the case with a
typical pool of first mortgage loans.

     Under environmental legislation and case law applicable in various states,
including California, a secured party that takes a deed in lieu of foreclosure,
acquires a mortgaged property at a foreclosure sale or which, prior to
foreclosure, has been involved in decisions or actions which may lead to
contamination of a property, may be liable for the costs of cleaning up a
contaminated site.  Although such costs could be substantial, it is unclear
whether they would be imposed on a holder of a mortgage note (such as a Trust)
which, under the terms of the Agreement, is not 

                                      -22-
<PAGE>
 
required to take an active role in operating the Mortgaged Properties. See
"Certain Legal Aspects of the Mortgage Loans--Environmental Considerations."

     Certain of the Mortgaged Properties relating to Mortgage Loans may not be
owner occupied.  It is possible that the rate of delinquencies, foreclosures and
losses on Mortgage Loans secured by non-owner occupied properties could be
higher than for loans secured by the primary residence of the borrower.

UNSECURED HOME IMPROVEMENT LOANS

     The obligations of the borrower under any Unsecured Home Improvement Loan
included in a Pool will not be secured by an interest in the related real estate
or otherwise, and the related Trust Fund, as the owner of such Unsecured Home
Improvement Loan, will be a general unsecured creditor as to such obligations.
As a consequence, in the event of a default under an Unsecured Home Improvement
Loan, the related Trust Fund will have recourse only against the borrower's
assets generally, along with all other general unsecured creditors of the
borrower.  In a bankruptcy or insolvency proceeding relating to a borrower on an
Unsecured Home Improvement Loan, the obligations of the borrower under such
Unsecured Home Improvement Loan may be discharged in their entirety,
notwithstanding the fact that the portion of such borrower's assets made
available to the related Trust Fund as a general unsecured creditor to pay
amounts due and owing thereunder are insufficient to pay all such amounts.  A
borrower on an Unsecured Home Improvement Loan may not demonstrate the same
degree of concern over performance of the borrower's obligations under such Home
Improvement Loan as if such obligations were secured by the real estate or other
assets owned by such borrower.

PRE-FUNDING ACCOUNTS

     If a Trust Fund includes a Pre-Funding Account and the principal balance of
additional Mortgage Loans delivered to the Trust Fund during the Pre-Funding
Period is less than the original Pre-Funded Amount, the Holders of the
Securities of the related Series will receive a prepayment of principal as and
to the extent described in the related Prospectus Supplement.  Any such
principal prepayment may adversely affect the yield to maturity of the
applicable Securities.

     The ability of a Trust Fund to obtain subsequent Mortgage Loans during the
related Pre-Funding Period will be dependent on the ability of the Originators
to originate or acquire Mortgage Loans that satisfy the requirements for
transfer to the Trust Fund.  The ability of the Originators to originate or
acquire such Mortgage Loans will be affected by a variety of social and economic
factors, including the prevailing level of market interest rates, unemployment
levels and consumer perception of general economic conditions.

COMBINED LOAN-TO-VALUE RATIOS


  The Originators' underwriting standards allow loans to be approved with
Combined Loan-to-Value Ratios (as defined below) that exceed 100%.  Because the
original Combined Loan-to-Value Ratios of certain of the Mortgage Loans may be
high relative to that of other similar mortgage loans, recoveries on defaulted
Mortgage Loans may be lower than the level of recoveries experienced by such
other defaulted mortgage loans.


LEGAL CONSIDERATIONS

     Applicable state laws generally regulate interest rates and other charges,
require certain disclosures, and require licensing of the Originators and the
Master Servicer.  In addition, most states have other laws, public policy and
general principles of equity relating to the protection of consumers, unfair and
deceptive practices and practices which may apply to the origination, servicing
and collection of the Mortgage Loans. Depending on the provisions of the
applicable law and the specific facts and circumstances involved, violations of
these laws, policies and principles may limit the ability of the Master Servicer
to collect all or part of the principal of or interest on the Mortgage Loans,
may entitle the borrower to a refund of amounts previously paid and, in
addition, could subject the Master Servicer to damages and administrative
sanctions.  See "Certain Legal Aspects of the Mortgage Loans."

                                      -23-
<PAGE>
 
     The Mortgage Loans may also be subject to federal laws, including:  (i) the
Federal Truth in Lending Act and Regulation Z promulgated thereunder, which
require certain disclosures to the borrowers regarding the terms of the Mortgage
Loans; (ii) the Equal Credit Opportunity Act and Regulation B promulgated
thereunder, which prohibit discrimination on the basis of age, race, color, sex,
religion, marital status, national origin, receipt of public assistance or the
exercise of any right under the Consumer Credit Protection Act, in the extension
of credit; (iii) the Fair Credit Reporting Act, which regulates the use and
reporting of information related to the borrower's credit experience; and (iv)
the NHA Act (as defined herein) with respect to FHA Loans.

     The Mortgage Loans may be subject to the Home Ownership and Equity
Protection Act of 1994 (the "Home Ownership Act") which amended the Federal
Truth in Lending Act as it applies to mortgages subject to the Home Ownership
Act.  The Home Ownership Act requires certain additional disclosures, specifies
the timing of such disclosures and limits or prohibits the inclusion of certain
provisions in mortgages subject to the Home Ownership Act.  The Home Ownership
Act also provides that any purchaser or assignee of a mortgage covered by the
Home Ownership Act is subject to all of the claims and defenses which the
borrower could assert against the original lender.  The maximum damages that may
be recovered in an action under the Home Ownership Act from an assignee is the
remaining amount of indebtedness plus the total amount paid by the borrower in
connection with the mortgage loan.  Any Trust for which the Mortgage Assets
include Mortgage Loans subject to the Home Ownership Act would be subject to all
of the claims and defenses which the borrower could assert against the original
lender.  Any violation of the Home Ownership Act which would result in such
liability would be a breach of the applicable Originator's representations and
warranties, and the Representative would be obligated to cure, repurchase or, if
permitted by the related Agreement, substitute for the Mortgage Loan in
question.

PREPAYMENT CONSIDERATIONS

     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Mortgage Loans may be prepaid in full or in part at any time; however, a
prepayment penalty or premium may still be imposed in connection therewith.  The
rate of prepayments of the Mortgage Loans cannot be predicted and may be
affected by a wide variety of economic, social, and other factors, including
prevailing interest rates, the availability of alternative financing and
homeowner mobility.  Therefore, no assurance can be given as to the level of
prepayments that a Trust will experience.



     A number of factors suggest that the prepayment behavior of a pool
including junior mortgage loans may be significantly different from that of a
pool composed entirely of first mortgage loans with equivalent interest rates
and maturities.  One such factor is the smaller average principal balance of a
pool of junior mortgage loans which may result in a higher prepayment rate than
that of a pool of first mortgage loans with a larger average balance, regardless
of the interest rate environment.  A small principal balance, however, also may
make refinancing a junior mortgage loan at a lower interest rate less attractive
to the borrower relative to refinancing a larger balance first mortgage loan, as
the perceived impact to the borrower of lower interest rates on the size of the
monthly payment for a junior mortgage loan may be less than for a first mortgage
loan with a larger balance.  Other factors that might be expected to affect the
prepayment rate of a pool of junior mortgage loans include the amounts of, and
interest rates on, the underlying senior mortgage loans, and the use of first
mortgage loans as long-term financing for home purchase and junior mortgage
loans as shorter-term financing for a variety of purposes, including home
improvement, education expenses and purchases of consumer durables such as
automobiles.  Accordingly, the Mortgage Loans which are junior mortgage loans
may experience a higher rate of prepayment than traditional fixed-rate mortgage
loans.  In addition, any future limitations on the right of borrowers to deduct
interest payments on home equity mortgage loans for federal income tax purposes
may further increase the rate of prepayments of such junior mortgage loans.  See
"Maturity, Prepayment and Yield Considerations."

     Prepayments may result from voluntary early payments by borrowers
(including payments in connection with refinancings of the related senior
mortgage loan or loans), sales of Mortgaged Properties subject to "due-on-sale"
provisions and liquidations due to default, as well as the receipt of proceeds
from physical damage, credit life and disability insurance policies and, if so
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, amounts on deposit in the Pre-
Funding Account at the end of the Funding Period being applied to the payment of
principal of the Securities.  In addition, repurchases or purchases from a Trust
of Mortgage Loans required to be made by the Representative under the Agreement
will have the same effect on the affected Securityholders as a prepayment of
such Mortgage Loans.  

                                      -24-
<PAGE>
 
Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, all of the
secured Mortgage Loans contain "due-on-sale" provisions, and the Master Servicer
will be required to enforce such provisions unless (i) such enforcement would
materially increase the risk of default or delinquency on, or materially
decrease the security for, such Mortgage Loan or (ii) such enforcement is not
permitted by applicable law, in which case the Master Servicer is authorized to
permit the purchaser of the related Mortgaged Property to assume the Mortgage
Loan. See "The Agreement" in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     Collections on the Mortgage Loans may vary due to the level of incidence of
delinquent payments and of prepayments. Collections on the Mortgage Loans may
also vary due to seasonal purchasing and payment habits of borrowers.

     Certain of the Mortgage Loans may be "simple interest" or "date-of-payment
loans."  If a payment is received on such a Mortgage Loan later than scheduled,
a smaller portion of such payment will be applied to principal and a greater
portion will be applied to interest than would have been the case had the
payment been received on the scheduled due date, resulting in such Mortgage Loan
having a longer average life than would have been the case had the payment been
made as scheduled.  Conversely, if a payment on such a Mortgage Loan is received
earlier than scheduled, more of such payment will be applied to principal and
less to interest than would have been the case had the payment been received on
its scheduled due date, resulting in such Mortgage Loan having a shorter average
life than would have been the case had the payment been made as scheduled.

THE STATUS OF THE MORTGAGE LOANS IN THE EVENT OF
BANKRUPTCY OF THE REPRESENTATIVE OR AN ORIGINATOR

     In the event of the bankruptcy of the Representative or an Originator at a
time when it or any affiliate thereof holds a subordinated interest in a Trust
Fund, a trustee in bankruptcy of the Representative or its creditors could
attempt to recharacterize the sale of the Mortgage Loans to the related Trust as
a borrowing by the Representative, the Originator or such affiliate with the
result, if such recharacterization is upheld, that the Securityholders would be
deemed to be creditors of the Representative, the Originator or such affiliate,
secured by a pledge of the Mortgage Loans.  If such an attempt were successful,
a trustee in bankruptcy could elect to accelerate payment of the Securities and
liquidate the Mortgage Loans, with the Securityholders entitled to the then
outstanding principal amount thereof together with accrued interest.  Thus, the
Securityholders could lose the right to future payments of interest, and might
suffer reinvestment loss in a lower interest rate environment.

LIMITATIONS ON INTEREST PAYMENTS AND FORECLOSURES

     Generally, under the terms of the Soldiers' and Sailors' Civil Relief Act
of 1940, as amended (the "Relief Act"), or similar state legislation, a
Mortgagor who enters military service after the origination of the related
Mortgage Loan (including a Mortgagor who is a member of the National Guard or is
in reserve status at the time of the origination of the Mortgage Loan and is
later called to active duty) may not be charged interest (including fees and
charges) above an annual rate of 6% during the period of such Mortgagor's active
duty status, unless a court orders otherwise upon application of the lender.  It
is possible that such action could have an effect, for an indeterminate period
of time, on the ability of the Master Servicer to collect full amounts of
interest on certain of the Mortgage Loans.  In addition, the Relief Act imposes
limitations which would impair the ability of the Master Servicer to foreclose
on an affected Mortgage Loan during the Mortgagor's period of active duty
status.  Thus, in the event that such a Mortgage Loan goes into default, there
may be delays and losses occasioned by the inability to realize upon the
Mortgaged Property in a timely fashion.

SECURITY RATING

     If set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement, the rating of one or
more Classes of Securities may depend, to a large extent, on the
creditworthiness of a third party provider of credit enhancement.  In such
event, any reduction in the rating assigned to the claims-paying ability of such
provider below the rating initially given to such Class of Securities would
likely result in a reduction in the rating of such Class of Securities.  See
"Rating."

                                      -25-
<PAGE>
 
OTHER

     To the extent a significant portion of the Mortgage Loans underlying a
given series of Securities consists of FHA Loans and/or Secured Conventional
Home Improvement Loans, the related Prospectus Supplement will describe any
additional Risk Factors related to such Mortgage Loans.



                                  THE TRUSTS


     A Trust for any Series of Securities will include the Mortgage Assets
consisting of (A) one or more Pools* comprised of (i) Single Family Loans, (ii)
Cooperative Loans, (iii) Multifamily Loans, (iv) Contracts, (v) FHA Loans, (vi)
Secured Conventional Home Improvement Loans, (vii) Unsecured Home Improvement
Loans, or (B) Agency Securities or Private Mortgage-Backed Securities, in each
case, as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, together with payments
in respect of such Mortgage Assets and certain other accounts, obligations or
agreements, in each case as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.  The
Mortgage Loans may be closed-end or revolving as described in the related
Prospectus Supplement.

     The Notes of each Series will be secured by the pledge of the assets of the
related Trust, and the Certificates of each Series will represent interest in
the assets of the related Trust.  The Securities will be entitled to payment
only from the assets of the related Trust and, to the extent specified in a
Prospectus Supplement, payments in respect of the assets of other trusts
established by the Representative, the Originators or any of their affiliates.
If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, certain Securities will
evidence the entire fractional undivided ownership interest in a Trust which
will contain a beneficial ownership interest in another Trust which will contain
all or some of the Mortgage Assets.

     Certain of the Mortgage Assets may have been originated by the Originators.
Other Mortgage Assets may have been acquired by the Representative, an
Originator or an affiliate thereof in the open market or in privately negotiated
transactions, including transactions with entities affiliated with the
Representative.  See "Mortgage Loan Program--Underwriting Criteria."

     The following is a brief description of the Mortgage Assets expected to be
included in the Trusts.  If specific information respecting the Mortgage Assets
is not known at the time the related Series of Securities initially is offered,
more general information of the nature described below will be provided in the
Prospectus Supplement, and specific information will be set forth in a report on
Form 8-K to be filed with the Commission within fifteen days after the initial
issuance of such Securities (the "Detailed Description").  A copy of the
Agreement with respect to each Series of Securities will be attached to the Form
8-K and will be available for inspection at the corporate trust office of the
Trustee specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.  A schedule of the
Mortgage Assets relating to such Series (the "Mortgage Asset Schedule") will be
attached to the Agreement delivered to the Trustee upon delivery of the
Securities.

THE MORTGAGE LOANS--GENERAL

     The real property and Manufactured Homes, as the case may be, which secure
repayment of the Mortgage Loans and Contracts (the "Mortgaged Properties") may
be located in any one of the fifty states, the District of Columbia, the
Commonwealth of Puerto Rico or any other commonwealth, territory or possession
of the United States.  

- -------------------------------------
*  Whenever the terms "Pool," "Certificates," "Notes," and "Securities" are used
   in this Prospectus, such terms will be deemed to apply, unless the context
   indicates otherwise, to one specific Pool, the Certificates representing
   certain undivided fractional interests, as described below, in a single Trust
   consisting primarily of the Mortgage Loans in such Pool, and the Notes shall
   refer to debt obligations of such Trust secured by the related Pool of
   Mortgage Loans. Similarly, the term "Pass-Through Rate" will refer to the
   Pass-Through Rate borne by the Certificates of one specific Series, the terms
   "Interest Rate will refer to the Interest Rate borne by the Notes of one
   specific Series and the term "Trust" will refer to one specific Trust.

                                      -26-
<PAGE>
 
It is expected that the Mortgage Loans or Contracts will be Conventional Loans
(i.e., loans that are not insured or guaranteed by any governmental agency).
However, if specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, certain of the
Single Family Loans may be insured by the FHA or partially guaranteed by the VA.
Mortgage Loans with Combined Loan-to-Value Ratios and/or certain principal
balances may be covered wholly or partially by Primary Mortgage Insurance
Policies. The Mortgage Loans may be covered by Standard Hazard Insurance
Policies.



     All of the Mortgage Loans in a Pool will provide for payments to be made
monthly ("monthly pay"), bi-weekly or on such other terms as may be described in
a Prospectus Supplement.  The payment terms of the Mortgage Loans to be included
in a Trust will be described in the related Prospectus Supplement and may
include any of the following features or combinations thereof or other features
described in the related Prospectus Supplement:


          (a)  Interest may be payable at a Fixed Rate, or an Adjustable Rate
     (i.e., a rate that is adjustable from time to time in relation to an index,
     a rate that is fixed for a period of time or under certain circumstances
     and is followed by an adjustable rate, a rate that otherwise varies from
     time to time, or a rate that is convertible from an adjustable rate to a
     fixed rate).  The specified rate of interest on a Mortgage Loan is its
     Mortgage Interest Rate.  Changes to an Adjustable Rate may be subject to
     periodic limitations, maximum rates, minimum rates or a combination of such
     limitations.  Accrued interest may be deferred and added to the principal
     of a Mortgage Loan for such periods and under such circumstances as may be
     specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.  Mortgage Loans may provide
     for the payment of interest at a rate lower than the Mortgage Interest Rate
     for a period of time or for the life of the Mortgage Loan, and the amount
     of any difference may be contributed from funds supplied by the seller of
     the Mortgaged Property securing the related Mortgage Loan or another source
     or may be treated as accrued interest added to the principal of the
     Mortgage Loan.



          (b)  Principal may be payable on a level basis to fully amortize the
     Mortgage Loan over its term, may be calculated on the basis of an assumed
     amortization schedule that is significantly longer than the original term
     to maturity or on an interest rate that is different from the Mortgage
     Interest Rate, or may not be amortized during all or a portion of the
     original term.  Payment of all or a substantial portion of the principal
     may be due on maturity ("balloon" payments).  Principal may include
     interest that has been deferred and added to the principal balance of the
     Mortgage Loan.



          (c)  Monthly payments of principal and interest may be fixed for the
     life of the Mortgage Loan, may increase over a specified period of time
     ("graduated payments") or may change from period to period.  Mortgage Loans
     may include limits on periodic increases or decreases in the amount of
     monthly payments and may include maximum or minimum amounts of monthly
     payments.  Mortgage Loans may require the monthly payments of principal and
     interest to increase for a specified period, provide for deferred payment
     of some or all of the payments due during a specified period, which may be
     recouped as deferred interest through negative amortization or otherwise.
     Other Mortgage Loans sometimes referred to as "growing equity" mortgage
     loans may provide for periodic scheduled payment increases for a specified
     period with the full amount of such increases being applied to principal.



          (d)  Prepayments of principal may be subject to a prepayment fee,
     which may be fixed for the life of the Mortgage Loan or may decline over
     time, and may be prohibited for the life of the Mortgage Loan or for
     certain periods ("lockout periods").  Certain Mortgage Loans may permit
     prepayments after expiration of the applicable lockout period and may
     require the payment of a prepayment fee in connection with any such
     subsequent prepayment.  Other Mortgage Loans may permit prepayments without
     payment of a fee unless the prepayment occurs during specified time
     periods.  The Mortgage Loans may include due-on-sale clauses which permit
     the mortgagee to demand payment of the entire Mortgage Loan in connection
     with the sale or certain transfers of the related Mortgaged Property.
     Other Mortgage Loans may be assumable by persons meeting the then
     applicable underwriting standards of the Originator.


     To the extent a significant portion of the Mortgage Loans underlying a
given Series of Securities consist of FHA Loans and/or Secured Conventional Home
Improvement Loans, the related Prospectus Supplement will describe the material
provisions of such Mortgage Loans and the programs under which they were
originated.  The Prospectus 

                                      -27-
<PAGE>
 
Supplement for each Series of Securities will contain information with respect
to all the Mortgage Loans expected to be included in the related Pools as of the
related closing date, including (i) the expected aggregate outstanding principal
balance and the expected average outstanding principal balance of the Mortgage
Loans as of the date set forth in the Prospectus Supplement, (ii) the largest
expected principal balance and the smallest expected, principal balance of any
of the Mortgage Loans, (iii) the types of Mortgaged Properties and/or other
assets securing the Mortgage Loans (e.g., one- to four-family houses, vacation
and second homes, Manufactured Homes, multifamily apartments or other real
property) and the percentage, if any, of Unsecured Home Improvement Loans
expected to be included in the related Pool, (iv) the original terms to maturity
of the Mortgage Loans, (v) the expected weighted average term to maturity of the
Mortgage Loans as of the date set forth in the Prospectus Supplement and the
expected range of the terms to maturity, (vi) the earliest origination date and
latest maturity date of any of the Mortgage Loans, (vii) the expected weighted
average Combined Loan-to-Value Ratios at origination (except with respect to
home improvement loans), (viii) the expected Mortgage Interest Rate or APR and
ranges of Mortgage Interest Rates or APRs borne by the Mortgage Loans, (ix) in
the case of Mortgage Loans having Adjustable Rates, the expected weighted
average of the Adjustable Rates, if any, (x) the expected aggregate outstanding
principal balance, if any, of Buy-Down Loans and Mortgage Loans having graduated
payment provisions as of the date set forth in the Prospectus Supplement, (xi)
the amount of any Mortgage Pool Insurance Policy, Special Hazard Insurance
Policy or Bankruptcy Bond to be maintained with respect to such Pool, (xii) the
amount, if any, and terms of any other credit enhancement or other derivative
instruments to be provided with respect to all or a material portion of the
Mortgage Loans or the Pool and (xiii) the expected geographic location of the
Mortgaged Properties. If specific information respecting the Mortgage Loans is
not known to the Representative at the time the related Securities are initially
offered, more general information of the nature described above will be provided
in the Prospectus Supplement and specific information will be set forth in the
Detailed Description.

     The Combined "Loan-to-Value Ratio" of a Single Family Loan at any given
time is the ratio, expressed as a percentage, determined by dividing (x) the sum
of the original principal balance of the Single Family Loan (less the amount, if
any, of the premium for credit life insurance) plus the then-current principal
balance of the related first lien, if any, by (y) the value of the related
Mortgaged Property, based upon the appraisal or valuation made at the time of
origination of the Single Family Loan.  To the extent a significant portion of
the Mortgage Loans underlying a given Series of Securities consists of FHA loans
and/or Secured Conventional Home Improvement Loans, the related Prospectus
Supplement may describe the method for calculating the Combined Loan-to-Value
Ratio, if deemed relevant by the Representative.  In the case of Refinance
Loans, the value of the related Mortgaged Property generally will be based on an
appraisal or valuation obtained at the time of refinancing.  For purposes of
calculating the Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio of a Contract relating to a new
Manufactured Home, the value of such Manufactured Home generally will be no
greater than the sum of a fixed percentage of the list price of the unit
actually billed by the manufacturer to the dealer (exclusive of freight to the
dealer site) including "accessories" identified in the invoice (the
"Manufacturer's Invoice Price"), plus the actual cost of any accessories
purchased from the dealer, a delivery and set-up allowance, depending on the
size of the unit, and the cost of state and local taxes, filing fees and up to
three years prepaid hazard insurance premiums.  The value of a used Manufactured
Home generally will be the least of the sales price, appraised value, and, if
applicable, National Automobile Dealer's Association book value plus prepaid
taxes and hazard insurance premiums.  The appraised value of a Manufactured Home
will be based upon the age and condition of the manufactured housing unit and
the quality and condition of the mobile home park in which it is situated, if
applicable.


     The Mortgage Loans in any Trust may include Mortgage Loans whose Combined
Loan to Value Ratios exceed 100%.  The related Mortgaged Properties are unlikely
to provide adequate security for such Mortgage Loans.  Even assuming that a
Mortgaged Property provides adequate security for the related Mortgage Loan,
substantial delays could be encountered in connection with the liquidation of a
Mortgage Loan that would result in current shortfalls in payments to
Securityholders to the extent such shortfalls are not covered by any credit
enhancement as described in the related Prospectus Supplement.  In addition,
liquidation expenses relating to any liquidated Mortgage Loan (such as legal
fees, real estate taxes, and maintenance and preservation expenses) will reduce
the liquidation proceeds otherwise available for payment to Securityholders.  In
the event that any Mortgaged Property fails to provide adequate security for the
related Mortgage Loan, any losses in connection with such Mortgage Loan will be
borne by Securityholders as described in the related Prospectus Supplement to
the extent that the applicable credit enhancement described in the related
Prospectus Supplement is insufficient to absorb all such losses.

                                      -28-
<PAGE>
 
     No assurance can be given that values of the Mortgaged Properties have
remained or will remain at their levels on the dates of origination of the
related Mortgage Loans.  If the real estate market should experience an overall
decline in property values such that the outstanding principal balances of the
Mortgage Loans (plus any additional financing by other lenders on the same
Mortgaged Properties), in a particular Pool become equal to or greater than the
value of such Mortgaged Properties, the actual rates of delinquencies,
foreclosures and losses could be higher than those now generally experienced in
the mortgage lending industry.  An overall decline in the market value of real
estate, the general condition of a Mortgaged Property, or other factors, could
adversely affect the values of the Mortgaged Properties such that the
outstanding balances of the Mortgage Loans, together with any additional liens
on the Mortgaged Properties, equal or exceed the value of the Mortgaged
Properties.  Under such circumstances, the actual rates of delinquencies,
foreclosures and losses could be higher than those now generally experienced in
the mortgage lending industry.

     Certain of the residential mortgage loans to be included in a Trust are
expected to be residential mortgage loans secured by second, third or fourth
liens ("Home Equity Loans") subordinate to the rights of the mortgagee under
each related senior mortgage.  The proceeds from any liquidation, insurance or
condemnation of Mortgaged Properties relating to Home Equity Loans in a Pool
will be available to satisfy the principal balance of such Home Equity Loans
only to the extent that the claims, if any, of the related senior mortgagee,
including any related foreclosure costs, are satisfied in full.  In addition,
the Master Servicer may not foreclose on a Mortgaged Property relating to a Home
Equity Loan unless it forecloses subject to the related senior mortgage or
mortgages, in which case it must either pay the entire amount of each senior
mortgage to the applicable mortgagee at or prior to the foreclosure sale or
undertake the obligation to make payments on each senior mortgage in the event
of default thereunder.  Generally, in servicing Home Equity Loans in their loan
portfolios, it has been the Originators' practice to satisfy each senior
mortgage at or prior to a foreclosure sale only to the extent that they
determine any amounts so paid will be recoverable from future payments and
collections on the Home Equity Loans or otherwise.  The Trusts will not have any
source of funds to satisfy any such senior mortgage or make payments due to any
senior mortgagee.  See "Certain Legal Aspects of the Mortgage Loans--
Foreclosure/Repossession."

     In addition, general economic conditions and other factors (which may or
may not effect real property values) have an impact on the ability of mortgagors
to repay mortgage loans.  Loss of earnings, illness and other similar factors
may lead to an increase in delinquencies and bankruptcy filings by mortgagors.
In the event of bankruptcy of a mortgagor, it is possible that a Trust could
experience a loss with respect to the related Mortgage Loan. In conjunction with
a mortgagor's bankruptcy, a bankruptcy court may suspend or reduce the payments
of principal and interest to be paid with respect to such Mortgage Loan or
permanently reduce the principal balance of such Mortgage Loan, thus either
delaying or permanently limiting the amount received by such Trust with respect
thereto.  Moreover, in the event a bankruptcy court prevents the transfer of the
related Mortgaged Property to the Trust, any remaining balance on such Mortgage
Loan may not be recoverable.

     Other factors affecting mortgagors' ability to repay Mortgage Loans include
excessive building resulting in an oversupply of housing stock or a decrease in
employment reducing the demand for units in an area; federal, state or local
regulations and controls affecting rents; prices of goods and energy;
environmental restrictions; increasing labor and material costs; and the
relative attractiveness of the Mortgaged Properties.  To the extent that such
losses are not covered by credit enhancements, such losses will be borne, at
least in part, by the Securityholders of the related Series.

     The Representative will cause the Mortgage Loans comprising each Pool to be
assigned to the Trustee named in the related Prospectus Supplement for the
benefit of the holders of the Securities of the related Series.  One or more
Master Servicers named in the related Prospectus Supplement will service the
Mortgage Loans, either directly or through Sub-Servicers, pursuant to the
Agreement and will receive a fee for such services.  See "Mortgage Loan Program"
and "The Agreement."  With respect to Mortgage Loans serviced through a Sub-
Servicer, the Master Servicer will remain liable for its servicing obligations
under the related Agreement as if the Master Servicer alone were servicing such
Mortgage Loans.

     The only obligations of the Representative or the Originators with respect
to a Series of Securities will be to provide (or, where the Representative or an
Originator acquired a Mortgage Loan from another originator, obtain from 

                                      -29-
<PAGE>
 
such originator) certain representations and warranties concerning the Mortgage
Loans and to assign to the Trustee for such Series of Securities the
Representative's or Originator's rights with respect to such representations and
warranties. See "The Agreements--Sale of Mortgage Loans." The obligations of the
Master Servicer with respect to the Mortgage Loans will consist principally of
its contractual servicing obligations under the related Agreement and its
obligation to make certain cash advances in the event of delinquencies in
payments on or with respect to the Mortgage Loans in the amounts described
herein under "Description of the Securities--Advances." The obligations of a
Master Servicer to make advances may be subject to limitations, to the extent
provided herein and in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     If provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, the original principal
amount of a Series of Securities may exceed the principal balance of the
Mortgage Assets initially being delivered to the Trustee.  Cash in an amount
equal to such difference (the "Pre-Funded Amount") will be deposited into a
separate trust account (the "Pre-Funding Account") maintained with the Trustee.
During the period set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement (the "Funding
Period"), amounts on deposit in the Pre-Funding Account may be used to purchase
additional Mortgage Assets for the related Trust subject to the satisfaction of
certain conditions specified under the Agreements.  Any amounts remaining in the
Pre-Funding Account at the end of such period will be distributed as a principal
prepayment to the holders of the related Series of Securities at the time and in
the manner set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement.



SINGLE FAMILY AND COOPERATIVE LOANS

     Single Family Loans will consist of mortgage loans, deeds of trust or
participation or other beneficial interests therein, secured by first, second or
more junior liens on one- to four-family residential properties.  If so
specified in a Prospectus Supplement, the Single Family Loans may include loans
or participations therein secured by mortgages or deeds of trust on condominium
units in low-rise condominium buildings together with such condominium units'
appurtenant interests in the common elements of the condominium buildings.
Cooperative Loans generally will be secured by security interests in or similar
liens on stock, shares or membership certificates issued by Cooperatives and in
the related proprietary leases or occupancy agreements granting exclusive rights
to occupy specific dwelling units in such Cooperatives' buildings.

     The Mortgaged Properties relating to Single Family Loans will consist of
detached or semi-detached one-family dwelling units, two- to four-family
dwelling units, townhouses, rowhouses, individual condominium units in low-rise
condominium buildings, individual units in planned unit developments, and
certain mixed use and other dwelling units.  Such Mortgaged Properties may
include vacation and second homes or investment properties.  A portion of a
dwelling unit may contain a commercial enterprise.

MULTIFAMILY LOANS

     "Multifamily Loans" will consist of mortgage loans, deeds of trust or
participation or other beneficial interests therein, secured by first, second or
more junior liens on rental apartment buildings, mixed-use properties or
projects containing five or more residential units.

     Mortgaged Properties which secure Multifamily Loans may include high-rise,
mid-rise and garden apartments.  Certain of the Multifamily Loans may be secured
by apartment buildings owned by Cooperatives. In such cases, the Cooperative
owns all the apartment units in the building and all common areas.  The
Cooperative is owned by tenant-stockholders who, through ownership of stock,
shares or membership certificates in the corporation, receive proprietary leases
or occupancy agreements which confer exclusive rights to occupy specific
apartments or units.  Generally, a tenant-stockholder of a Cooperative must make
a monthly payment to the Cooperative representing such tenant-stockholder's pro
rata share of the Cooperative's payments for its mortgage loans, real property
taxes, maintenance expenses and other capital or ordinary expenses.  Those
payments are in addition to any payments of principal and interest the tenant-
stockholder must make on any loans to the tenant-stockholder secured by its
shares in the Cooperative.  The Cooperative will be directly responsible for
building management and, in most cases, payment of real estate taxes and hazard
and liability insurance.  A Cooperative's ability to meet debt service
obligations on a Multifamily Loan, as well as all other operating expenses, will
be dependent in large part on the receipt of maintenance payments from the
tenant-stockholders, as well as any rental income from units or commercial areas
the Cooperative 

                                      -30-
<PAGE>
 
might control. Unanticipated expenditures may in some cases have to be paid by
special assessments on the tenant-stockholders.

     Substantially all of the Multifamily Loans will be secured by mixed-use
properties, with no less than approximately 90% of such properties, measured by
square footage, number of units and projected rent, being allocated to
residential units.

CONTRACTS

     Contracts will consist of manufactured housing conditional sales contracts
and installment sales or loan agreements each secured by a Manufactured Home.
Contracts may be conventional, insured by the Federal Housing Administration
("FHA") or partially guaranteed by the Veterans Administration ("VA"), as
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.  Unless otherwise specified in
the related Prospectus Supplement, each Contract will be fully amortizing and
will bear interest at its APR.

     The "Manufactured Homes" securing the Contracts will consist of
manufactured homes within the meaning of 42 United States Code, Section 5402(6),
which defines a "manufactured home" as "a structure, transportable in one or
more sections, which, in the traveling mode, is eight body feet or more in width
or forty body feet or more in length, or, when erected on site, is three hundred
twenty or more square feet, and which is built on a permanent chassis and
designed to be used as a dwelling with or without a permanent foundation when
connected to the required utilities, and includes the plumbing, heating, air
conditioning, and electrical systems contained therein; except that such term
shall include any structure which meets all the requirements of [this] paragraph
except the size requirements and with respect to which the manufacturer
voluntarily files a certification required by the Secretary of Housing and Urban
Development and complies with the standards established under [this] chapter."

     The related Prospectus Supplement will specify for the Contracts contained
in the related Trust, among other things, the date of origination of the
Contracts; the APRs on the Contracts; the Contract loan-to-value ratios; the
minimum and maximum outstanding principal balances as of the Cut-off Date and
the average outstanding principal balance; the outstanding principal balances of
the Contracts included in the related Trust; and the original maturities of the
Contracts and the last maturity date of any Contract.

FHA LOANS

     The FHA Loans will consist of home improvement loans originated under Title
I (the "Title I Loan Program") of the National Housing Act of 1934 (the "NHA
Act").  Under the NHA Act, the Federal Housing Administration (the "FHA"), an
agency of the United States Department of Housing and Urban Development ("HUD"),
is authorized and empowered to insure qualified lending institutions against
losses on eligible loans.  Several types of loans may be made under the Title I
Loan Program, including (1) property improvement loans; (2) manufactured home
purchase loans; (3) manufactured home lot loans; and (4) combination loans (to
purchase a manufactured home and a lot).  Property improvement loans (the "Title
I Property Improvement Loans") may be made by approved lenders to finance
alterations, repair or improvement of existing single family, multifamily,
manufactured housing and nonresidential structures.

     Title I Property Improvement Loans, in addition to improvements to protect
the livability or utility of single family, multifamily or manufactured housing
or nonresidential property, also include loans for the renovation or
preservation of historic residential structures and loans to finance the
installation of fire safety equipment in existing health care facilities.  Loan
processing and credit determinations are done by an approved financial
institution.  Each lender is required to use prudent lending standards in
underwriting individual loans.

     Under the Title I Loan Program, the FHA does not review individual loans at
the time of approval (as is typically the case with some other federal loan
programs), except when the amount of a Title I Property Improvement Loan would
result in any borrower having a total unpaid principal obligation on such loans
in excess of certain specified amounts, in which case HUD approval must be
obtained.

                                      -31-
<PAGE>
 
     The Title I Loan Program is a coinsurance program.  The lender initially is
at risk for 10% of the principal balance of each loan.  The FHA will insure the
remaining 90% of the principal balance of each loan, subject to the limits of
the reserve amount discussed below.  Such FHA insurance is accorded the full
faith and credit of the United States of America.  Thus, a lender under the
program risks the loss of up to 10% of the principal balance on every loan
submitted to the FHA for an insurance claim (or a greater amount if the lender's
reserve amount is diminished or exhausted), plus a portion of the interest on
such loans.

     At the time the FHA receives a new loan origination or transfer of note
report from an approved lender, the FHA adds to the balance in the reserve
amount established by the FHA for the lender originating or purchasing such loan
an amount equal to 10% of the amount disbursed, advanced or expended by the
lender in originating or purchasing the loan.  The balance in the reserve amount
limits the amount of claims the FHA is required to pay.

     The reserve amount established by the FHA for each lender will be reduced
by the amount of all insurance claims approved for payment in conjunction with
losses on such loans.  The lender's reserve amount will be increased based upon
additions made pursuant to the origination or purchase of eligible loans
registered for insurance.

     The FHA charges a fee of 0.50% per annum of the original balance for each
loan it insures, on a non-declining basis.  The FHA bills the lender annually
(on the anniversary date of origination) for the insurance premium, unless the
loan has a maturity of 25 months or less, in which case the insurance charge is
payable in one lump sum.  If a loan is prepaid during the year, the FHA will not
rebate the insurance premium nor reduce the balance in the lender's insurance
coverage reserve account.  The unused insurance charge will, however, be rebated
when a Title I loan is refinanced.

SECURED CONVENTIONAL HOME IMPROVEMENT LOANS

     The Secured Conventional Home Improvement Loans will consist of secured
conventional loans, the proceeds of which generally will be used for purposes
similar to those described under the heading "--FHA Loans."  To the extent set
forth in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Secured Conventional Home
Improvement Loans will be fully amortizing and will bear interest at a fixed or
variable annual percentage rate.



UNSECURED HOME IMPROVEMENT LOANS

     The Unsecured Home Improvement Loans will consist of conventional unsecured
home improvement loans and FHA insured unsecured home improvement loans.  To the
extent set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Unsecured Home
Improvement Loans will be fully amortizing and will bear interest at a fixed or
variable annual percentage rate.

AGENCY SECURITIES

     Government National Mortgage Association.  GNMA is a wholly-owned corporate
instrumentality of the United States within the United Stated Department of
Housing and Urban Development HUD.  Section 306(g) of Title II of the National
Housing Act of 1934, as amended (the "Housing Act"), authorizes GNMA to, among
other things, guarantee the timely payment of the principal of and interest on
certificates which represent an interest in a pool of mortgage loans insured by
FHA under the Housing Act, or Title V of the Housing Act of 1949 ("FHA Loans"),
or partially guaranteed by the VA under the Servicemen's Readjustment Act of
1944, as amended, or chapter 37 of Title 38, United States Code ("VA Loans").

     Section 306(g) of the Housing Act provides that "the full faith and credit
of the United States is pledged to the payment of all amounts which may be
required to be paid under any guarantee under this subsection."  In order to
meet its obligations under any such guarantee, GNMA may, under Section 306(d) of
the Housing Act, borrow from the United States Treasury in an amount which is at
any time sufficient to enable GNMA, with no limitations as to amount, to perform
its obligations under its guarantee.

                                      -32-
<PAGE>
 
     GNMA Certificates.  Each GNMA Certificate held in a Trust Fund (which may
be a GNMA I Certificate or a GNMA II Certificate) will be a "fully modified
pass-through" mortgaged-backed certificate issued and serviced by a mortgage
banking company or other financial concern ("GNMA Issuer") approved by GNMA or
approved by FNMA as a seller-servicer of FHA Loans and/or VA Loans.  The
mortgage loans underlying the GNMA Certificates held in a Trust Fund will
consist of FHA Loans and/or VA Loans.  Each such mortgage loan is secured by a
one- to four-family residential property or a manufactured home.  GNMA will
approve the issuance of each such GNMA Certificate in accordance with a guaranty
agreement (a "Guaranty Agreement") between GNMA and the GNMA Issuer.  Pursuant
to its Guaranty Agreement, a GNMA Issuer will be required to advance its own
funds in order to make timely payments of all amounts due on each such GNMA
Certificate, even if the payments received by the GNMA Issuer on the FHA Loans
or VA Loans underlying each such GNMA Certificate are less than the amounts due
on each such GNMA Certificate.

     The full and timely payment of principal of and interest on each GNMA
Certificate will be guaranteed by GNMA, which obligation is backed by the full
faith and credit of the United States.  Each such GNMA Certificate will have an
original maturity of not more than 40 years (but may have original maturities of
substantially less than 40 years).  Each such GNMA Certificate will provide for
the payment by or on behalf of the GNMA Issuer to the registered holder of such
GNMA Certificate of scheduled monthly payments of principal and interest equal
to the registered holder's proportionate interest in the aggregate amount of the
monthly principal and interest payment on each FHA Loan or VA Loan underlying
such GNMA Certificate, less the applicable servicing and guarantee fee which
together equal the difference between the interest on the FHA Loans or VA Loans
and the pass-through rate on the GNMA Certificate.  In addition, each payment
will include proportionate pass-through payments of any prepayments of principal
on the FHA Loans or VA Loans underlying such GNMA Certificate and liquidation
proceeds in the event of a foreclosure or other disposition of any such FHA
Loans or VA Loans.

     If a GNMA Issuer is unable to make the payments on a GNMA Certificate as it
becomes due, it must promptly notify GNMA and request GNMA to make such payment.
Upon notification and request, GNMA will make such payments directly to the
registered holder of such GNMA Certificate.  In the event no payment is made by
a GNMA Issuer and the GNMA Issuer fails to notify and request GNMA to make such
payment, the holder of such GNMA Certificate will have recourse only against
GNMA to obtain such payment.  The Trustee or its nominee, as registered holder
of the GNMA Certificates held in a Trust Fund, will have the right to proceed
directly against GNMA under the terms of the Guaranty Agreements relating to
such GNMA Certificates for any amounts that are not paid when due.

     All mortgage loans underlying a particular GNMA Certificate must have the
same interest rate (except for pools of mortgage loans secured by manufactured
homes) over the term of the loan.  The interest rate on such GNMA I Certificate
will equal the interest rate on the mortgage loans included in the pool of
mortgage loans underlying such GNMA I Certificate, less one-half percentage
point per annum of the unpaid principal balance of the mortgage loans.

     Mortgage loans underlying a particular GNMA II Certificate may have per
annum interest rates that vary from each other by up to one percentage point.
The interest rate on each GNMA II Certificate will be between one-half
percentage point and one and one-half percentage points lower than the highest
interest rate on the mortgage loans included in the pool of mortgage loans
underlying such GNMA II Certificate (except for pools of mortgage loans secured
by manufactured homes).

     Regular monthly installment payments on each GNMA Certificate held in a
Trust Fund will be comprised of interest due as specified on such GNMA
Certificate plus the scheduled principal payments on the FHA Loans or VA Loans
underlying such GNMA Certificate due on the first day of the month in which the
scheduled monthly installments on such GNMA Certificate is due.  Such regular
monthly installments on each such GNMA Certificate are required to be paid to
the Trustee as registered holder by the 15th day of each month in the case of a
GNMA I Certificate and are required to be mailed to the Trustee by the 20th day
of each month in the case of a GNMA II Certificate.  Any principal prepayments
on any FHA Loans or VA Loans underlying a GNMA Certificate held in a Trust Fund
or any other early recovery of principal on such loan will be passed through to
the Trustee as the registered holder of such GNMA Certificate.

                                      -33-
<PAGE>
 
     GNMA Certificates may be backed by graduated payment mortgage loans or by
"buydown" mortgage loans for which funds will have been provided (and deposited
into escrow accounts) for application to the payment of a portion of the
borrowers' monthly payments during the early years of such mortgage loan.
Payments due the registered holders of GNMA Certificates backed by pools
containing "buydown" mortgage loans will be computed in the same manner as
payments derived from other GNMA Certificates and will include amounts to be
collected from both the borrower and the related escrow account.  The graduated
payment mortgage loans will provide for graduated interest payments that, during
the early years of such mortgage loans, will be less than the amount of stated
interest on such mortgage loans.  The interest not so paid will be added to the
principal of such graduated payment mortgage loans and, together with interest
thereon, will be paid in subsequent years.  The obligations of GNMA and of a
GNMA Issuer will be the same irrespective of whether the GNMA Certificates are
backed by graduated payment mortgage loans or "buydown" mortgage loans.  No
statistics comparable to the FHA's prepayment experience on level payment, non-
buydown loans are available in respect of graduated payment or buydown
mortgages.  GNMA Certificates related to a Series of Securities may be held in
book-entry form.

     GNMA also guarantees the timely payment of principal of and interest on
"fully modified pass-through" mortgage-backed securities issued and serviced by
certain mortgage banking companies and other financial concerns ("FNMA Project
Issuers") based upon and backed by pools of multi-family residential mortgage
loans coinsured by FHA and GNMA Project Issuers under the Housing Act ("GNMA
Project Certificates").  The Prospectus Supplement for a Series of Securities
that includes GNMA Project Certificates will set forth additional information
regarding the GNMA guaranty program, servicing of the mortgage pool, the payment
of principal and interest on GNMA Project Certificates and other matters with
respect to multi-family residential mortgage loans that qualify for the GNMA
guaranty.

     Federal National Mortgage Association.  FNMA is a federally chartered and
privately owned corporation organized and existing under the Federal National
Mortgage Association Charter Act (the "Charter Act").  FNMA was originally
established in 1938 as a United States government agency to provide supplemental
liquidity to the mortgage market and was transformed into a stockholder-owned
and privately-managed corporation by legislation enacted in 1968.

     FNMA provides funds to the mortgage market primarily by purchasing mortgage
loans from lenders, thereby replenishing their funds for additional lending.
FNMA acquires funds to purchase mortgage loans from many capital market
investors that may not ordinarily invest in mortgages, thereby expanding the
total amount of funds available for housing.  Operating nationwide, FNMA helps
to redistribute mortgage funds from capital-surplus to capital-short areas.

     FNMA Certificates.  FNMA Certificates are either Guaranteed Mortgage Pass-
Through Certificates ("FNMA MBS") or Stripped Mortgage-Backed Securities ("FNMA
SMBS").  The following discussion of FNMA Certificates applies equally to both
FNMA MBS and FNMA SMBS, except as otherwise indicated.  Each FNMA Certificate
included in the Trust for a Series will represent a fractional undivided
interest in a pool of mortgage loans formed by FNMA.  Each such pool will
consist of mortgage loans of one of the following types:  (i) fixed-rate level
installment conventional mortgage loans; (ii) fixed-rate level installment
mortgage loans that are insured by FHA or partially guaranteed by the VA; (iii)
adjustable rate conventional mortgage loans; or (iv) adjustable rate mortgage
loans that are insured by the FHA or partially guaranteed by the VA.  Each
mortgage loan must meet the applicable standards set forth under the FNMA
purchase program.  Each such mortgage loan will be secured by a first lien on a
one-family or two- to four-family residential property.  Each such FNMA
Certificate will be issued pursuant to a trust indenture.  Original maturities
of substantially all of the conventional, level payment mortgage loans
underlying a FNMA Certificate are expected to be between either 8 to 15 years or
20 to 40 years.  The original maturities of substantially all of the fixed rate
level payment FHA Loans or VA Loans are expected to be 30 years.

     Mortgage loans underlying a FNMA Certificate may have annual interest rates
that vary by as much as two percentage points from each other.  The rate of
interest payable on a FNMA MBS (and the series pass-through rate payable with
respect to a FNMA SMBS) is equal to the lowest interest rate of any mortgage
loan in the related pool, less a specified minimum annual percentage
representing servicing compensation and FNMA's guaranty fee.  Under a regular
servicing option (pursuant to which the mortgagee or other servicer assumes the
entire risk of foreclosure 

                                      -34-
<PAGE>
 
losses), the annual interest rates on the mortgage loans underlying a FNMA
Certificate will be between 50 basis points and 250 basis points greater than
the annual pass-through rate if a FNMA MBS or the series pass-through rate if a
FNMA SMBS; and under a special servicing option (pursuant to which FNMA assumes
the entire risk for foreclosure losses), the annual interest rates on the
mortgage loans underlying a FNMA Certificate will generally be between 55 basis
points and 255 basis points greater than the annual FNMA Certificate pass-
through rate if a FNMA MBS, or the series pass-through rate if a FNMA SMBS.

     FNMA guarantees to each registered holder of a FNMA Certificate that it
will distribute on a timely basis amounts representing such holder's
proportionate share of scheduled principal and interest payments at the
applicable pass-through rate provided for by such FNMA Certificate on the
underlying mortgage loans, whether or not received, and such holder's
proportionate share of the full principal amount of any foreclosed or other
finally liquidated mortgage loan, whether or not such principal amount is
actually recovered.  The obligations of FNMA under its guarantees are
obligations solely of FNMA and are not backed by, nor entitled to, the full
faith and credit of the United States.  If FNMA were unable to satisfy its
obligations, distributions to holders of FNMA Certificates would consist solely
of payments and other recoveries on the underlying mortgage loans and,
accordingly, monthly distributions to holders of FNMA Certificates would be
affected by delinquent payments and defaults on such mortgage loans.

     FNMA SMBS are issued in series of two or more classes, with each class
representing a specified undivided fractional interest in principal
distributions and interest distributions (adjusted to the series pass-through
rate) on the underlying pool of mortgage loans.  The fractional interests of
each class in principal and interest distributions are not identical, but the
classes in the aggregate represent 100% of the principal distributions and
interest distributions (adjusted to the series pass-through rate) on the
respective pool.  Because of such difference between the fractional interests in
principal and interest of each class, the effective rate of interest on the
principal of each class of FNMA SMBS may be significantly higher or lower than
the series pass-through rate and/or the weighted average interest rate of the
underlying mortgage loans.

     Unless otherwise specified by FNMA, FNMA Certificates evidencing interests
in pools of mortgages formed on or after May 1, 1985 will be available in book-
entry form only.  Distributions of principal and interest on each FNMA
Certificate will be made by FNMA on the 25th day of each month to the persons in
whose name the FNMA Certificate is entered in the books of the Federal Reserve
Banks (or registered on the FNMA Certificate register in the case of fully
registered FNMA Certificates) as of the close of business on the last day of the
preceding month.  With respect to FNMA Certificates issued in book-entry form,
distributions thereon will be made by wire, and with respect to fully registered
FNMA Certificates, distributions thereon will be made by check.

     Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation.  FHLMC is a publicly held United
States government-sponsored enterprise created pursuant to the Federal Home Loan
Mortgage Corporation Act, Title III of the Emergency Home Finance Act of 1970,
as amended (the "FHLMC Act").  The common stock of FHLMC is owned by the Federal
Home Loan Banks.  FHLMC was established primarily for the purpose of increasing
the availability of mortgage credit for the financing of urgently needed
housing.  It seeks to provide an enhanced degree of liquidity for residential
mortgage investments primarily by assisting in the development of secondary
markets for conventional mortgages.  The principal activity of FHLMC currently
consists of the purchase of first lien conventional mortgage loans or
participation interests in such mortgage loans and the sale of the mortgage
loans or participations so purchased in the form of mortgage securities,
primarily FHLMC Certificates.  FHLMC is confined to purchasing, so far as
practicable, mortgage loans that it deems to be of such quality, type and class
as to meet generally the purchase standards imposed by private institutional
mortgage investors.



     FHLMC Certificates.  Each FHLMC Certificate represents an undivided
interest in a pool of mortgage loans that may consist of first lien conventional
loans, FHA Loans or VA Loans (a "FHLMC Certificate Group").  FHLMC Certificates
are sold under the terms of a Mortgage Participation Certificate Agreement.  A
FHLMC Certificate may be issued under either FHLMC's Cash Program or Guarantor
Program.

     Unless otherwise described in the Prospectus Supplement, Mortgage loans
underlying the FHLMC Certificates held by a Trust Fund will consist of mortgage
loans with original terms to maturity of between 10 and 40 years.  Each such
mortgage loan must meet the applicable standards set forth in the FHLMC Act.  A
FHLMC 

                                      -35-
<PAGE>
 
Certificate Group may include whole loans, participation interests in whole
loans and undivided interests in whole loans and/or participations comprising
another FHLMC Certificate Group. Under the Guarantor Program, any such FHLMC
Certificate Group may include only whole loans or participation interests in
whole loans.

     FHLMC guarantees to each registered holder of a FHLMC Certificate the
timely payment of interest on the underlying mortgage loans to the extent of the
applicable Security rate on the registered holder's pro rata share of the unpaid
principal balance outstanding on the underlying mortgage loans in the FHLMC
Certificate Group represented by such FHLMC Certificate, whether or not
received.  FHLMC also guarantees to each registered holder of a FHLMC
Certificate ultimate receipt by such holder of all principal on the underlying
mortgage loans, without any offset or deduction, to the extent of such holder's
pro rata share thereof, but does not, except if and to the extent specified in
the Prospectus Supplement for a Series of Securities, guarantee the timely
payment of scheduled principal.  Under FHLMC's Gold PC Program, FHLMC guarantees
the timely payment of principal based on the difference between the pool factor,
published in the month preceding the month of distribution and the pool factor
published in such month of distribution.  Pursuant to its guarantees, FHLMC
indemnifies holders of FHLMC Certificates against any diminution in principal by
reason of charges for property repairs, maintenance and foreclosure.  FHLMC may
remit the amount due on account of its guarantee of collection of principal at
any time after default on an underlying mortgage loan, but not later than (i) 30
days following foreclosure sale, (ii) 30 days following payment of the claim by
any mortgage insurer, or (iii) 30 days following the expiration of any right of
redemption, whichever occurs later, but in any event no later than one year
after demand has been made upon the mortgagor for accelerated payment of
principal.  In taking actions regarding the collection of principal after
default on the mortgage loans underlying FHLMC Certificates, including the
timing of demand for acceleration, FHLMC reserves the right to exercise its
judgment with respect to the mortgage loans in the same manner as for mortgage
loans which it has purchased but not sold.  The length of time necessary for
FHLMC to determine that a mortgage loan should be accelerated varies with the
particular circumstances of each mortgagor, and FHLMC has not adopted standards
which require that the demand be made within any specified period.

     FHLMC Certificates are not guaranteed by the United States or by any
Federal Home Loan Bank and do not constitute debts or obligations of the United
States or any Federal Home Loan Bank.  The obligations of FHLMC under its
guarantee are obligations solely of FHLMC and are not backed by, nor entitled
to, the full faith and credit of the United States.  If FHLMC were unable to
satisfy such obligations, distributions to holders of FHLMC Certificates would
consist solely of payments and other recoveries on the underlying mortgage loans
and, accordingly, monthly distributions to holders of FHLMC Certificates would
be affected by delinquent payments and defaults on such mortgage loans.

     Registered holders of FHLMC Certificates are entitled to receive their
monthly pro rata share of all principal payments on the underlying mortgage
loans received by FHLMC, including any scheduled principal payments, full and
partial prepayments of principal and principal received by FHLMC by virtue of
condemnation, insurance, liquidation or foreclosure, and repurchases of the
mortgage loans by FHLMC or the seller thereof.  FHLMC is required to remit each
registered FHLMC Certificateholder's pro rata share of principal payments on the
underlying mortgage loans, interest at the FHLMC pass-through rate and any other
sums such as prepayment fees, within 60 days of the date on which such payments
are deemed to have been received by FHLMC.

     Under FHLMC's Cash Program, with respect to pools formed prior to June 1,
1987, there is no limitation on the amount by which interest rates on the
mortgage loans underlying a FHLMC Certificate may exceed the pass-through rate
on the FHLMC Certificate.  With respect to FHLMC Certificates issued on or after
June 1, 1987, the maximum interest rate on the mortgage loans underlying such
FHLMC Certificates may exceed the pass through rate of the FHLMC Certificates by
50 to 100 basis points.  Under such program, FHLMC purchases groups of whole
mortgage loans from sellers at specified percentages of their unpaid principal
balances, adjusted for accrued or prepaid interest, which when applied to the
interest rate of the mortgage loans and participations purchased, results in the
yield (expressed as a percentage) required by FHLMC.  The required yield, which
includes a minimum servicing fee retained by the servicer, is calculated using
the outstanding principal balance.  The range of interest rates on the mortgage
loans and participations in a FHLMC Certificate group under the Cash Program
will vary since mortgage loans and participations are purchased and assigned to
a FHLMC Certificate group based upon their yield to FHLMC rather than on the
interest rate on the underlying mortgage loans.

                                      -36-
<PAGE>
 
     Under FHLMC's Guarantor Program, the pass-through rate on a FHLMC
Certificate is established based upon the lowest interest rate on the underlying
mortgage loans, minus a minimum servicing fee and the amount of FHLMC's
management and guaranty income as agreed upon between the seller and FHLMC.  For
FHLMC Certificate Groups formed under the Guarantor Program with certificate
numbers beginning with 18-012, the range between the lowest and the highest
annual interest rates on the mortgage loans in a FHLMC Certificate group may not
exceed two percentage points.

     FHLMC Certificates duly presented for registration of ownership on or
before the last business day of a month are registered effective as of the first
day of the month.  The first remittance to a registered holder of a FHLMC
Certificate will be distributed so as to be received normally by the 15th day of
the second month following the month in which the purchaser became a registered
holder of the FHLMC Certificates.  Thereafter, such remittance will be
distributed monthly to the registered holder so as to be received normally by
the 15th day of each month.  The Federal Reserve Bank of New York maintains
book-entry accounts with respect to FHLMC Certificates sold by FHLMC on or after
January 2, 1985, and makes payments of principal and interest each month to the
registered holders thereof in accordance with such holders' instructions.

     FHLMC also issues mortgage participation certificates representing an
undivided interest in a group of multi-family residential mortgage loans or
participations in multi-family residential mortgage loans purchased by FHLMC
("FHLMC Project Certificates").  The Prospectus Supplement for a Series of
Securities issued by a Trust that included FHLMC Project Certificates will set
forth additional information regarding multi-family residential mortgage loans
that qualify for purchase by FHLMC.

     Stripped Mortgage-Backed Securities.  Agency Securities may consist of one
or more stripped mortgage-backed securities, each as described herein and in the
related Prospectus Supplement.  Each such Agency Security will represent an
undivided interest in all or part of either the principal distributions (but not
the interest distributions) or the interest distributions (but not the principal
distributions), or in some specified portion of the principal and interest
distributions (but not all of such distributions) on certain FHLMC, FNMA, GNMA
or other government agency or government-sponsored agency certificates.  The
underlying securities will be held under a trust agreement by FHLMC, FNMA, GNMA
or another government agency or government- sponsored agency, each as trustee,
or by another trustee named in the related Prospectus Supplement.  FHLMC, FNMA,
GNMA or another government agency or government-sponsored agency will guarantee
each stripped Agency Security to the same extent as such entity guarantees the
underlying securities backing such stripped Agency Security, unless otherwise
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     Other Agency Securities.  If specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, a Trust Fund may include other mortgage pass-through certificates
issued or guaranteed by GNMA, FNMA, FHLMC or other government agencies or
government-sponsored agencies.  The characteristics of any such mortgage pass-
through certificates will be described in such Prospectus Supplement.  If so
specified, a combination of different types of Agency Securities  may be held in
a Trust Fund.

PRIVATE MORTGAGE-BACKED SECURITIES

     General.  Private Mortgage-Backed Securities may consist of (a) mortgage
participations or pass-through certificates representing beneficial interests in
certain mortgage loans or (b) CMOs secured by such mortgage loans.  Private
Mortgage-Backed Securities will have been issued pursuant to a PMBS agreement
(the "PMBS Agreement").  The seller/servicer of the underlying mortgage loans
will have entered into the PMBS Agreement with the PMBS Trustee under the PMBS
Agreement.  The PMBS Trustee or its agent, or a custodian, will possess the
mortgage loans underlying such Private Mortgage-Backed Security.  Mortgage loans
underlying a Private Mortgage-Backed Security will be serviced by the PMBS
Servicer directly or by one or more sub-servicers who may be subject to the
supervision of the PMBS Servicer.  The PMBS Servicer will be approved as a
servicer by FNMA or FHLMC and, if FHA Loans underlie the Private Mortgage-Backed
Securities, approved by the Department of Housing and Urban Development ("HUD")
as an FHA mortgagee.

                                      -37-
<PAGE>
 
     The PMBS Issuer will be a financial institution or other entity engaged
generally in the business of mortgage lending or the acquisition of mortgage
loans, a public agency or instrumentality of a state, local or federal
government, or a limited purpose or other corporation organized for the purpose
of among other things, establishing trusts and acquiring and selling housing
loans to such trusts and selling beneficial interests in such trusts.  If so
specified in the Prospectus Supplement, the PMBS Issuer may be an affiliate of
the Representative.  The obligations of the PMBS Issuer will generally be
limited to certain representations and warranties with respect to the assets
conveyed by it to the related trust.  Unless otherwise specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, the PMBS Issuer will not have guaranteed any of the
assets conveyed to the related trust or any of the Private Mortgage-Backed
Securities issued under the PMBS Agreement.  Additionally, although the mortgage
loans underlying the Private Mortgage-Backed Securities may be guaranteed by an
agency or instrumentality of the United States, the Private Mortgage-Backed
Securities themselves will not be so guaranteed.

     Distributions of principal and interest will he made on the Private
Mortgage-Backed Securities on the dates specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement.  The Private Mortgage-Backed Securities may be entitled to receive
nominal or no principal distributions or nominal or no interest distributions.
Principal and interest distributions will be made on the Private Mortgage-Backed
Securities by the PMBS Trustee or the PMBS Servicer.  The PMBS Issuer or the
PMBS Servicer may have the right to repurchase assets underlying the Private
Mortgage-Backed Securities after a certain date or under other circumstances
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     Underlying Mortgage Loans.  The Underlying Mortgage Loans underlying the
Private Mortgage-Backed Securities may consist of fixed rate, level payment,
fully amortizing loans or graduated payment mortgage loans, buydown loans,
adjustable rate mortgage loans, or loans having balloon or other special payment
features.  Such Underlying Mortgage Loans may be Single Family Loans,
Multifamily Loans, Cooperative Loans or Contracts secured by Manufactured Homes.
As specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, (i) no Underlying Mortgage
Loan will have had a Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio at origination in excess of
the percentage set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement, (ii) each
underlying mortgage loan will have had an original term to stated maturity of
not less than 5 years and not more than 40 years, (iii) each Underlying Mortgage
Loan (other than Cooperative Loans) will be required to be covered by a standard
hazard insurance policy (which may be a blanket policy), and (iv) each mortgage
loan (other than Cooperative Loans or Contracts secured by a Manufactured Home)
will be covered by a title insurance policy.

     Credit Support Relating to Private Mortgage-Backed Securities.  Credit
support in the form of subordination of other private mortgage certificates
issued under the PMBS Agreement, reserve funds, insurance policies, letters of
credit, financial guaranty insurance policies, guarantees or other types of
credit support may be provided with respect to the Underlying Mortgage Loans or
with respect to the Private Mortgage-Backed Securities themselves.

     Additional Information.  The Prospectus Supplement for a Series for which
the related Trust includes Private Mortgage-Backed Securities will specify (i)
the aggregate approximate principal amount and type of the Private Mortgage-
Backed Securities to be included in the Trust Fund, (ii) certain characteristics
of the Underlying Mortgage Loans including (A) the payment features of such
Underlying Mortgage Loans, (B) the approximate aggregate principal balance, if
known, of Underlying Mortgage Loans insured or guaranteed by a governmental
entity, (C) the servicing fee or range of servicing fees with respect to the
Underlying Mortgage Loans, and (D) the minimum and maximum stated maturities of
the Underlying Mortgage Loans at origination, (iii) the maximum original term-
to-stated maturity of the Private Mortgage-Backed Securities, (iv) the weighted
average term-to-stated maturity of the Private Mortgage-Backed Securities, (v)
the pass-through or certificate rate of the Private Mortgage-Backed Securities,
(vi) the weighted average pass-through or certificate rate of the Private
Mortgage-Backed Securities, (vii) the PMBS Issuer, the PMBS Servicer (if other
than the PMBS Issuer) and the PMBS Trustee for such Private Mortgage-Backed
Securities, (viii) certain characteristics of credit support, if any, such as
reserve funds, insurance policies, letters of credit or guarantees relating to
the Underlying Mortgage Loans or to such Private Mortgage-Backed Securities
themselves, (ix) the terms on which the Underlying Mortgage Loans for such
Private Mortgage-Backed Securities may, or are required to, be purchased prior
to their stated maturity or the stated maturity of the Private Mortgage-Backed
Securities and (x) the terms on which other mortgage loans may be substituted
for those originally underlying the Private Mortgage-Backed Securities.

                                      -38-
<PAGE>
 
                                USE OF PROCEEDS



     The Representative and the Originators may use the net proceeds to be
received from the sale of the Securities of each Series for general corporate
purposes, including repayment of debt, including but not limited to warehouse
facilities, and the origination and acquisition of residential mortgage loans
and other loans.  The Representative expects Securities to be sold in Series
from time to time.



                    THE REPRESENTATIVE AND THE ORIGINATORS


     The Mortgage Loans will have been originated or acquired by the
Originators.  The Money Store will act as the Master Servicer of the Mortgage
Loans and other Mortgage Assets. Except for certain representations and
warranties relating to the Mortgage Loans and other Mortgage Assets and certain
other matters, the obligations of The Money Store with respect to the Mortgage
Loans and other Mortgage Assets will be limited to its contractual servicing
obligations.

     The Money Store is a New Jersey corporation and is headquartered in
Sacramento, California and Union, New Jersey.

     The Money Store is a financial services company engaged, through its
subsidiaries (including the Originators), in the business of originating,
purchasing, selling and servicing consumer and commercial loans of specified
types and offering related services.  Loans originated by The Money Store and
its subsidiaries have consisted primarily of mortgage loans, loans partially
guaranteed by the United States Small Business Administration, student loans,
and automobile loans.

     Since 1967, The Money Store and its subsidiaries have been active in the
development of the residential home equity lending industry in the United
States.



                    THE SINGLE FAMILY LOAN LENDING PROGRAM


OVERVIEW

     The Money Store's and the Originators' mortgage lending activities consist
primarily of originating, purchasing, selling and servicing mortgage loans that
are primarily secured by one- to four-family residential properties, including
low-rise condominiums, single-family detached homes, single-family attached
homes, planned unit developments and mixed use properties (collectively, "Single
Family Loans").  It has been the Originators' policy generally not to make
mortgage loans secured by high-rise condominiums, cooperative residences or
other categories of properties that management believes have demonstrated
relatively high levels of risk.  The majority of Single Family Loans are to
borrowers owning a single-family detached home.  Single Family Loans are made to
borrowers for, among other purposes, education, home improvements and debt
consolidation.  The Money Store and its subsidiaries also originate, with the
intention of selling and servicing, Multifamily Loans, FHA Loans, Secured
Conventional Home Improvement Loans, Unsecured Home Improvement Loans and loans
partially guaranteed by the United States Small Business Administration.  In
addition, The Money Store and its subsidiaries from time to time purchase
packages of loans from other lenders or government agencies.

     The Originators originate and purchase Single Family Loans with original
terms of up to 40 years.  The following is a description of the origination,
underwriting, servicing and other procedures used by The Money Store and the
Originators in connection with their Single Family Loan program.  If a
significant portion of the Mortgage Loans underlying a given Series of
Securities consists of FHA Loans, Secured Conventional Home Improvement Loans
and/or Unsecured Home Improvement Loans, the related Prospectus Supplement will
contain a similar description of the program relating to such Mortgage Loans.

                                      -39-
<PAGE>
 
SINGLE FAMILY LOAN ORIGINATION

     The Originators' Single Family Loan origination offices are generally
located in small and medium-sized suburban communities.  All Single Family Loan
origination offices have a manager who reports to senior management.  Each
regional office supervises the operations of a group of states.  The supervision
of all of the Originator's underwriting and administrative functions is
conducted from the Sacramento, California headquarters.

     The entire application and approval process for Single Family Loans is
generally conducted by telephone.  The Originators attempt to grant approvals of
loans quickly to borrowers meeting their underwriting criteria. A loan officer
is responsible for completing, evaluating and processing the loan application of
a prospective borrower based on information obtained from the borrower and
verified with third parties.  Depending on the size of the loan applied for,
loan applications must be approved by an underwriter located in the Sacramento,
California headquarters.  Loan officers are trained to structure loans that meet
the applicant's needs, while satisfying the Originators' lending criteria.  If
an applicant does not meet the lending criteria, the loan officer may offer to
make a smaller loan, if a smaller loan would meet the lending criteria, or
suggest a debt consolidation package that better suits the applicant's needs.

     The Originators also acquire Single Family Loans through an indirect
lending program, from independent brokers.  Such Single Family Loans are
underwritten by the Originators using the same criteria applied to loans
originated by such Originator.  Brokers participating in this program must
satisfy certain requirements established by the Originators pertaining to
experience, size of business and various licenses and approvals.  The
Originators also acquire, from time to time, portfolios of Single Family Loans
from various third parties.  The Originators will not sell such acquired loans
to a Trust unless the Originators determine that such loans, when originated,
were underwritten using the same criteria applied to loans originated by the
Originators.

     Starting in October 1995, the Originators began originating Single Family
Loans under a program that will result in lower interest rates for borrowers
that make timely payments during the early years of the related loan.  Under
this program, if a borrower remits all scheduled payments during the first year
of the loan on a timely basis, the interest rate on the loan will be reduced
0.50% per annum.  If the borrower remits all scheduled payments during the
second year of the loan on a timely basis, the interest rate will be reduced an
additional 0.50% per annum and, if all payments are made during the third year
of the loan on a timely basis, the interest rate will be reduced a final 0.50%
per annum.  Once the interest rate on a loan is reduced, it will not be
increased, regardless of the borrowers future payment record.

UNDERWRITING CRITERIA

     The following is a brief description of certain of the underwriting
standards used by the Originators to underwrite Single Family Loans.  The
underwriting process is intended to assess both the prospective borrower's
ability to repay and the adequacy of the real property security as collateral
for the loan granted.  To the extent that the relevant underwriting criteria
differ from those described herein, the related Prospectus Supplement for such
Series will specifically describe such criteria.


     In certain cases deemed appropriate by an Originator's underwriters, loans
may be made outside of the Originator's guidelines with the prior approval of
pre-designated senior officials.  No information is available with respect to
the portion of the Mortgage Loans which was originated outside of these
guidelines.


     The Originators' objective in originating Single Family Loans is to provide
loans to borrowers with satisfactory income and credit histories deemed
sufficient to demonstrate the ability to repay their loan.  The primary and
initial origination policy is to analyze the applicant's creditworthiness (i.e.,
a determination of the applicant's ability to repay the loan).  Creditworthiness
is assessed by examination of a number of factors, which may include calculating
a debt-to-income ratio obtained by dividing a borrower's fixed monthly debt by
the borrower's gross monthly income.  Fixed monthly debt generally includes (i)
the monthly payment under the related prior mortgages (which generally includes
an escrow for real estate taxes) based, in the case of an adjustable-rate first
mortgage, on the assumption that the then-current rate is the rate at which
interest will accrue on such loan, (ii) the monthly payment on the loan applied
for and (iii) other installment debt, including, for revolving debt, the
required monthly payment thereon or if no such payment is specified, 5% of the
balance as of the date of calculation. Fixed monthly debt does not 

                                      -40-
<PAGE>
 
include any debt (other than revolving credit debt) described above that matures
within less than 10 months of the date of calculation. Except as otherwise set
forth in the related Prospectus Supplement, the debt-to-income ratio of any
borrower will not have exceeded 50% as of origination of the related loan.
Creditworthiness is also assessed by examining the applicant's credit history
through standard credit reporting bureaus, and by checking the applicant's
payment history with respect to the first mortgage, if any, on the property.

     The second origination policy for Single Family Loans is a determination of
the Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio.  Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio guidelines are
established depending on the type of loan.  For each Single Family Loan, the
Originator confirms the value of the property to be mortgaged by appraisals
(which in certain cases may be drive-by appraisals) performed by independent
appraisers.  Drive-by appraisals involve a visual observation of the exterior of
the characteristics and condition of the property and the neighborhood.  Because
the interior dimensions, improvements and conditions are not inspected, a drive-
by appraisal produces only a general approximation of value for the particular
property.  If the Originator has previously originated a loan to the same
borrower secured by the same property within one year, the Originator may rely
on the prior appraisal in conjunction with a new drive-by appraisal.  If an
appraisal is not required to be obtained for a Single Family Loan, the value of
the related mortgaged property, as represented by the borrower, may be evaluated
through other methods such as a drive-by appraisal, a review of comparable sales
or tax assessments or reliance upon a recent sales price for such mortgaged
property.  Such methods do not constitute an appraisal of the related mortgaged
property.  All Combined Loan-to-Value Ratios are determined prior to approval of
the loans.

     The Originators have several procedures which they use to verify
information obtained from an applicant.  The applicant's outstanding balance and
payment history on any senior mortgage may be verified by calling the senior
mortgage lender.  If the senior mortgage lender cannot be reached by telephone
to verify this information, the Originator may rely upon information provided by
the applicant, such as a recent statement from the senior lender and
verification of payment, such as canceled checks, or upon information provided
by national credit bureaus.

     In order to verify an applicant's employment status, the Originators may
obtain from the applicant recent tax returns or other tax forms (e.g., W-2
forms) or current pay stubs or may telephone the applicant's employer or obtain
written verification from the employer.  As in the case of the senior mortgage
lender verification procedures, if the employer will not verify employment
history over the telephone, the Originator may rely solely on the other
information provided by the applicant.

     The Originators will not close a Single Family Loan prior to receiving
evidence that the property securing the loan is insured.  In addition, at the
closing, the borrower is required to sign a letter addressed to his insurance
carrier naming the Originator as a loss payee under the insurance policy, which
the Originator will thereafter mail to the insurer.  Accordingly, the Originator
normally will not be named as a loss payee with respect to the property securing
the Single Family Loan at the time the loan is closed.

     A title search is ordered to verify the vesting of title to the Mortgaged
Property, along with the existence of any mortgages, tax or other liens that
have been levied on the property, to assure that the lien priority will be as
represented by the borrower.

     Most Single Family Loans originated or purchased by the Originators
generally are scheduled to amortize over their terms and provide for equal
monthly payments over their terms.  The Originators also offer a "balloon"
mortgage on a limited basis.  The Originators collect nonrefundable points, late
charges and various fees in certain states in connection with their mortgage
loans.  Other fees charged, where allowable, include those related to credit
reports, lien searches, title insurance and recordings, prepayment fees and
appraisal fees.  From time-to-time, the Originators may originate or purchase
Single Family Loans containing other features.  To the extent that a substantial
portion of a Trust Fund consists of such Single Family Loans such features will
be described in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     Although the Originators have no maximum dollar amount for Single Family
Loans, the actual maximum amount that they will lend is determined by an
evaluation of the applicant's ability to repay the loan, the value of the
borrower's equity in the real estate and the ratio of such equity to the real
estate's appraised value.

                                      -41-
<PAGE>
 
     Commencing in 1997, the Originators began originating Single Family Loans
with Combined Loan-to-Value Ratios exceeding 100%.  Such Single Family Loans are
originated to borrowers believed by the Originators to have the income capacity
and credit history to offset the lack of equity in the related Mortgaged
Property.  Such Single Family Loans generally bear a higher rate of interest
than Single Family Loans with lower Combined Loan-to-Value Ratios.

QUALITY CONTROL

     Quality control is exercised in two areas: lending and documentation
standards.  In the case of Single Family Loans, a centralized quality control
staff checks to confirm that lending and documentation standards are met.  Every
month, at least one office is audited and every loan type originated during the
prior month by such office is reviewed for compliance with lending and
documentation standards.  Five percent of all Single Family Loans originated by
the Originators are audited at random on a monthly basis for compliance with
lending and documentation standards.  Additional offices receive audits on a
random, monthly basis.  In order to confirm the validity of appraisals obtained
at the time loans are made, reappraisals are obtained for the property securing
the loans in approximately two percent to five percent of the transactions.

REFINANCING POLICY

     Where the Originators believe that borrowers having existing loans with
them are likely to refinance such loans due to interest rate changes or other
reasons, the Originators actively attempt to retain such borrowers through
solicitations of such borrowers to refinance with the Originators.  Such
refinancings generate fee and servicing income for the Originators.  Since the
solicited borrowers may refinance their existing loans in any case, the
Representative believes that this practice will be unlikely to affect the
prepayment experience of the Single Family Loans in a material respect.  The
Originators also have solicited their borrowers who are in good standing to
apply for additional loans, consistent with their origination standards, where
deemed appropriate.

SERVICING AND COLLECTIONS

     The Money Store or one of its affiliates, as Master Servicer, will be
required under the related Agreement to master service the Mortgage Loans and
other Mortgage Assets underlying a particular Series of Securities with the same
degree of skill and care that it exercises with respect to all comparable loans
and assets that it master services for its own account.  Servicing includes, but
is not limited to, post-origination loan processing, customer service,
remittance handling, collections and liquidations.

     Borrowers are sent payment coupon books or monthly statements that specify
the fixed payment due and the late payment amount, if any.  Due dates for
payments occur throughout the calendar month.  If payment is not received within
fifteen working days of the due date, an initial collection effort is made by
telephone in an attempt to bring the delinquent account current.  The various
stages of delinquency are monitored and evaluated on a monthly basis.

     Means of contacting delinquent accounts include, but are not limited to,
telephone calls and collection letters.  When an account is 30 days past due,
the collection supervisor analyzes the account to determine the appropriate
course of action.  If a borrower is experiencing difficulty in making payments
on time, the Servicer may modify the payment schedule (as permitted by the
Agreement) but will not remove the loan from a delinquency status.

     The course of action taken by the Servicer is dependent upon a number of
factors including the borrower's payment history, the amount of equity in the
related Mortgaged Property and the reason for the current inability to make
timely payments.

     When a loan is 90 days past due, the related Mortgaged Property is required
to be reappraised and the results evaluated by the Company to determine a course
of action.  Foreclosure regulations and practices and the rights of the owner in
default vary from state to state, but generally procedures may be initiated if:
(i) the loan is 90 days or more delinquent; (ii) a notice of default on a senior
lien is received or (iii) the servicer discovers circumstances indicating

                                      -42-
<PAGE>
 
potential loss exposure.  During the foreclosure process, any expenses incurred
by the Servicer may be added to the amount owed by the borrower, as permitted by
applicable law.  Upon completion of the foreclosure, the property is sold to an
outside bidder, or passes to the mortgagee, in which case the Servicer proceeds
to liquidate the asset.

     The Servicer may not foreclose on the property securing a junior mortgage
loan unless it forecloses subject to the related senior mortgages.  In such
cases, the Servicer generally will pay the amount due on the senior mortgages to
the senior mortgagees, if the Servicer considers it to be in the best interest
of the related Securityholders to do so.  In the event that foreclosure
proceedings have been instituted on a senior mortgage prior to the initiation of
the Servicer's foreclosure action, the Servicer will either satisfy such
mortgage at the time of the foreclosure sale or take other appropriate action.
The Servicer retains "in-house" counsel in part to help assist with problem
accounts.  Such counsel may be utilized by all levels of management to help
avoid legal problems, including those associated with consumer lending.


     Servicing and charge-off policies and collection practices may change over
time in accordance with the servicer's business judgment, changes in its real-
estate loan portfolio and applicable laws and regulations, as well as other
items.


     Regulations and practices regarding the liquidation of properties (e.g.,
foreclosure) and the rights of the borrower in default vary greatly from state
to state.  Only if a delinquency cannot otherwise be cured will the servicer
decide that liquidation is the appropriate course of action.  If, after
determining that purchasing a property securing a mortgage loan will minimize
the loss associated with such defaulted loan, the servicer may bid at the
foreclosure sale for such property or accept a deed in lieu of foreclosure.



                         DESCRIPTION OF THE SECURITIES


     Each Series of Certificates will be issued, from time to time, pursuant to
either a Pooling and Servicing Agreement or a Trust Agreement, and each Series
of Notes will be issued, from time to time, pursuant to an Indenture, each to be
dated as of the date set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement (each such
date, a "Cut-off Date"), among The Money Store, the applicable Originators
and/or certain affiliates thereof and the Trustee for the benefit of the related
Certificateholders or Noteholders, as the case may be, of such Series.  A Series
may contain either Certificates or Notes or a combination thereof.  The
provisions of each Agreement will vary depending upon the nature of the
Securities to be issued thereunder and the nature of the related Trust.  A form
of a Pooling and Servicing Agreement, Trust Agreement, Sale and Servicing
Agreement and an Indenture have each been filed as an exhibit to the
Registration Statement of which this Prospectus is a part.  The following
summaries describe certain material provisions which may appear in each
Agreement.  The Prospectus Supplement for a Series of Securities will describe
any provision of the Agreement relating to such Series that materially differs
from the description thereof contained in this Prospectus.  The summaries do not
purport to be complete and are subject to, and are qualified in their entirety
by reference to, all of the provisions of the Agreement for each Series of
Securities and the applicable Prospectus Supplement.  The Representative will
provide a copy of the Agreement (without exhibits) relating to any Series
without charge upon written request of a holder of a Security of such Series
addressed to The Money Store, 2840 Morris Avenue, Union, New Jersey 07083,
Attention:  Corporate Counsel.


GENERAL

     The Securities of each Series will represent debt obligations of, in the
case of Notes, or fractional undivided ownership interests in, in the case of
Certificates, a Trust created pursuant to the related Agreement and/or such
other assets as may be described in the related Prospectus Supplement.  The
Securities will be issued in fully registered form, in minimum denominations of
$1,000 and integral multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof (or such other amounts
do may be set forth in a Prospectus Supplement), except that one Certificate or
Note of each Class may be issued in a different denomination.


     Definitive Securities, if issued, will be transferable and exchangeable at
the corporate trust office of the Trustee or, at the election of the Trustee, at
the office of a Security Registrar appointed by the Trustee.  No service 

                                      -43-
<PAGE>
 
charge will be made for any registration of exchange or transfer, but the
Trustee may require payment of a sum sufficient to cover any tax or other
governmental charge. If provided in the related Agreement, a security
administrator may perform certain duties in connection with the administration
of the Securities.

     The Securities will not represent obligations of the Representative (except
with respect to a Guaranty issued in connection with a Series), the Originators
or any affiliate thereof.  The assets of each Trust will consist of one or more
of the following, as set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement, (a) the
Mortgage Loans that from time to time are subject to the related Agreement and
which are held in the related Pool; (b) the assets for the Trust that from time
to time are required by the Agreement to be deposited in certain reserve
accounts, including the Distribution Account, the Principal and Interest
Account, the Expense Account, the Letter of Credit Fee Account and the Insurance
Account (each, as defined herein), or to be invested in Permitted Investments
(as defined herein); (c) property and any proceeds thereof acquired by
foreclosure of the Mortgage Loans in such Pool, deed in lieu of foreclosure or a
comparable conversion; (d) any Primary Mortgage Insurance Policies; (e) any
Mortgage Pool Insurance Policies; (f) any Special Hazard Insurance Policies; (g)
any Bankruptcy Bonds; and (h) all rights under any other insurance policies,
guarantees, supplemental interest payments, surety bonds, letters of credit,
guaranties of The Money Store or other credit enhancement or maturity protection
or other derivative instrument covering any Securities, any Mortgage Loan in the
related Pool or any related Mortgaged Property which is required to be
maintained pursuant to the related Agreement.

     Each Series of Securities will be issued in one or more Classes.  Each
Class of Securities of a Series will evidence beneficial ownership of the
interest in assets of the related Trust specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement.  A Class of Securities may be divided into two or more Sub-Classes,
as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.


     A Series may include two or more Classes of Certificates, as specified in
the related Prospectus Supplement, which differ as to the timing and priority of
payment, seniority, allocations of loss, Pass-Through Rate or amount of payments
of principal or interest, or as to which payments of principal or interest may
or may not be made upon the occurrence of specified events or on the basis of
collections from designated portions of the Mortgage Assets for such Series.  A
Series of Certificates may include one or more Classes of Senior Certificates
that receive certain preferential treatment, specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, with respect to one or more Classes of Subordinated Certificates of
such Series. Certain Series or Classes of Certificates within a Series may be
covered by a Guaranty Insurance Policy, Mortgage Pool Insurance Policy, Special
Hazard Insurance Policy, Bankruptcy Bond or other insurance policies, cash
accounts, letters of credit, financial guaranty insurance policies, third party
guarantees, supplemental interest payments or other forms of credit enhancement
or maturity protection, or derivative products, in each case as described herein
and in the related Prospectus Supplement. The Pass-Through Rate for a Class of
Certificates that pay interest based upon a floating rate of interest, as
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, may base such floating rate upon
any of the following: (i) the auction procedures for Auction Rate Securities
described herein, (ii) LIBOR plus an amount set forth in the related Prospectus
Supplement , (iii) the T-Bill Rate plus an amount set forth in the related
Prospectus Supplement or (iv) any such other method or procedures used to
determine the floating rate of interest as may be described in the applicable
Prospectus Supplement. In addition, a Series may include one or more Classes of
Certificates entitled to (a) principal payments with disproportionate, nominal
or no interest payments or (b) interest payments with disproportionate, nominal
or no principal payments (Strip Certificates).



          A Series may include two or more Classes of Notes, as specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement, which differ as to the timing and priority of
payment, seniority, allocations of loss, Interest Rate or amount of payments of
principal or interest, or as to which payments of principal or interest may or
may not be made upon the occurrence of specified events or on the basis of
collections from designated portions of the Mortgage Assets for such Series.  A
Series of Notes may include one or more Classes of Senior Notes which receive
certain preferential treatment specified in the related Prospectus Supplement
with respect to one or more Classes of Subordinated Notes of such Series.
Certain Series or Classes of Notes within a Series may be covered by a Guaranty
Insurance Policy, Mortgage Pool Insurance Policy, Special Hazard Insurance
Policy, Bankruptcy Bond or other insurance policies, cash accounts, letters of
credit, financial guaranty insurance policies, third party guarantees,
supplemental interest payments or other forms of credit enhancement or maturity
protection, or derivative products, in each case as described herein and in the
related Prospectus Supplement.  The Interest Rate for a Class of Notes that pay
interest based upon a floating rate of interest, as specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, may base such floating rate upon any of following: (i)
the auction 

                                      -44-
<PAGE>
 
procedures for Auction Rate Securities described herein, (ii) LIBOR plus an
amount set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement , (iii) the T-Bill Rate
plus an amount set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement or (iv) any such
other method or procedures used to determine the floating rate of interest as
may be described in the applicable Prospectus Supplement. In addition, a Series
may include one or more Classes of Notes entitled to (a) principal payments with
disproportionate, nominal or no interest payments or (b) interest payments with
disproportionate, nominal or no principal payments (Strip Notes).



  With respect to any Series of Securities that includes one or more Classes of
Notes, distributions in respect of the Certificates may be subordinated in
priority of payment to payments on the Notes of such Series, to the extent
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.


     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement,
distributions of principal and interest (or, where applicable, of principal only
or interest only) on the related Securities will be made by the Trustee on each
Remittance Date, in the amounts specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.
Distributions will be made to the persons in whose names the Securities are
registered at the close of business on the record dates specified in the
Prospectus Supplement unless Definitive Securities have been issued, the
registered holder of all Securities will be Cede or such other nominee specified
in the related Prospectus Supplement.  Distributions will be made by check
mailed to the persons entitled thereto at the address appearing in the register
maintained for holders of Securities (the "Security Register") or, to the extent
described in the related Prospectus Supplement, by wire transfer or by such
other means as are described therein, except that the final distribution in
retirement of the Securities will be made only upon presentation and surrender
of the Securities at the office or agency of the Trustee or other person
specified in the final distribution notice to Securityholders.

DISTRIBUTIONS ON SECURITIES


     Each Class of Securities within a Series will evidence the interests
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, which may (i) include the right
to receive distributions allocable only to principal, only to interest or to any
combination thereof; (ii) include the right to receive distributions only of
prepayments of principal throughout the lives of the Securities or during
specified periods; (iii) be subordinated in its right to receive distributions
of scheduled payments of principal, prepayments of principal, interest or any
combination thereof to one or more other Classes of Securities of such Series
throughout the lives of the Securities or during specified periods or may be
subordinated with respect to certain losses or delinquencies; (iv) include the
right to receive such distributions only after the occurrence of events
specified in the Prospectus Supplement; (v) include the right to receive
distributions in accordance with a schedule or formula or on the basis of
collections from designated portions of the assets in the related Trust; (vi)
include, as to Securities entitled to distributions allocable to interest, the
right to receive interest at a Fixed Rate or an Adjustable Rate; and (vii)
include, as to Securities entitled to distributions allocable to interest, the
right to distributions allocable to interest only after the occurrence of events
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, and in each case, may accrue
interest until such events occur, as specified in such Prospectus Supplement.


     Distributions allocable to principal and interest on the Securities will be
made by the Trustee out of, and only to the extent of, funds available in the
related Distribution Account and other accounts to the extent described in the
related Prospectus Supplement.  To the extent described in the related
Prospectus Supplement, on each Remittance Date, the Master Servicer will
withdraw from the applicable Distribution Account and such other accounts as may
be described in the related Prospectus Supplement and distribute to the
Securityholders of each Class (other than a Series having a Class of
Subordinated Certificates, as described below), either the specified interest of
such Class in the Pool times the aggregate of all amounts on deposit in the
Distribution Account as of the Determination Date, or, in the case of Classes
which have been assigned an aggregate principal balance and Pass-Through Rate or
Interest Rate, payments of interest and payments in reduction of such aggregate
principal balance from all amounts on deposit in the Distribution Account on the
Determination Date, in the priority and calculated in the manner set forth in
the related Prospectus Supplement, except, in each case, for (i) all payments on
the Mortgage Loans that were due on or before the Cut-off Date; (ii) all
Principal Prepayments, Liquidation Proceeds and Insurance Proceeds received
after the period specified in the related Prospectus Supplement (the "Principal
Prepayment Period"); (iii) all scheduled payments of principal and interest due
on a date or dates subsequent to the Determination Date; (iv) amounts
representing reimbursement for Advances, as specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement; (v) amounts representing 

                                      -45-
<PAGE>
 
reimbursement for any unpaid Servicing Fee or Contingency Fee and expenses from
Liquidation Proceeds, condemnation proceeds and proceeds of insurance policies
with respect to the related Mortgage Loans; (vi) all income from any Permitted
Investments held in the Distribution Account for the benefit of the Master
Servicer; and (vii) any Advances deposited in the Distribution Account prior to
the applicable Remittance Date.

     The timing and amounts of distributions allocable to interest and principal
and, if applicable, Principal Prepayments and scheduled payments of principal,
to be made on any Remittance Date may vary among Classes, over time or otherwise
as specified in the Prospectus Supplement.  Differing allocations of principal
and interest to different Classes of Securityholders will have the effect of
accelerating the amortization of Senior Notes or Senior Certificates, as the
case may be, while increasing the interests evidenced by the Subordinated Notes
or Senior Certificates, as the case may be, in the related Trust.  Distributions
to any Class of Certificates or Notes will be made pro rata to all
Securityholders of that Class, or as otherwise described in a Prospectus
Supplement.


SUMMARY OF AUCTION PROCEDURES


  The following  summarizes certain procedures that will be used in determining
the interest rates on any Notes or Certificates that are Auction Rate
Securities.  Appendix I hereto contains a more detailed description of these
procedures.  Prospective investors in the Auction Rate Securities should read
carefully the following summary, along with the more detailed description in
Appendix I.



  The interest rate on each Class of Auction Rate Securities will be determined
periodically (generally, for periods ranging from 7 days to one year) by means
of a "Dutch Auction."  In this Dutch Auction, investors and potential investors
submit orders through an eligible broker/dealer as to the principal amount of
Auction Rate Securities such investors wish to buy, hold or sell at various
interest rates.  The broker/dealers submit their clients' orders to the auction
agent, who processes all orders submitted by all eligible broker/dealers and
determines the interest rate for the upcoming interest period.  The
broker/dealers are notified by the auction agent of the interest rate for the
upcoming interest period and are provided with settlement instructions relating
to purchases and sales of Auction Rate Securities.



  In the auction procedures, the following types of orders may be submitted:



          (i)  Bid/Hold Orders - the minimum interest rate that a current
               investor is willing to accept in order to continue to hold some
                                                                     ----     
               or all of its Auction Rate Securities for the upcoming interest
               period;



          (ii) Sell Orders - an order by a current investor to sell a specified
                                                               ----            
               principal amount of Auction Rate Securities, regardless of the
               upcoming interest rate; and



          (iii)  Potential Bid Orders - the minimum interest rate that a
               potential investor (or a current investor wishing to purchase
               additional Auction Rate Securities) is willing to accept in order
               to buy a specified principal amount of Auction Rate Securities.
                  ---                                                         



  If an existing investor does not submit orders with respect to all its Auction
Rate Securities of the applicable Class, the investor will be deemed to have
submitted a Hold Order at the new interest rate for that portion of the Auction
Rate Securities for which no order was received.



  In connection with each auction, Auction Rate Securities will be purchased and
sold between investors and potential investors at a price equal to their then
outstanding principal balance (i.e., par) plus any accrued interest.  The
                               ----                                      
following example helps illustrate how the above-described procedures are used
in determining the interest rate on the Auction Rate Securities.

                                      -46-
<PAGE>
 
  (a)  Assumptions:

  1. Denominations (Units) = $100,000
  2. Interest Period = 28 Days

  3. Principal Amount Outstanding   = $50 Million (500 Units)



  (b) Summary of All Orders Received For The Auction


 
Bid/Hold Orders        Sell Orders    Potential Bid Orders
- --------------------  --------------  ---------------------
 
 10 Units at 2.90%    50 Units Sell   20 Units at 2.95%
 30 Units at 3.02%    50 Units Sell   30 Units at 3.00%
 
 60 Units at 3.05%    100 Units Sell  50 Units at 3.05%
                      --------------
100 Units at 3.10%    200 Units       50 Units at 3.10%
100 Units at 3.12%                    50 Units at 3.11%
- --------------------
  300 Units                           50 Units at 3.14%
                                     100 Units at 3.15%
                                     ------------------
                                          350 Units


Total units under existing Bid/Hold Orders and Sell Orders always equal issue
size (in this case 500 units).


  (c) Auction Agent Organizes Orders In Ascending Order


     Order       Number  Cumulative     Order  Number  Cumulative  Total
     Number    of Units  Total (Units)    %     Number  of Units   (Units)  %
     ------    --------  -------------   ---    ------  ---------  ------- ----
 
 
      1           10(W)     10           2.90%     7      100(W)  300     3.10% 
      2           20(W)     30           2.95%     8       50(W)  350     3.10% 
      3           30(W)     60           3.00%     9       50(W)  400     3.11% 
      4           30(W)     90           3.02%    10      100(W)  500     3.12% 
      5           50(W)    140           3.05%    11       50(L)          3.14% 
      6           60(W)    200           3.05%    12      100(L)          3.15% 
 

  (W) Winning Order (L) Losing Order



  Order #10 is the order that clears the market of all available units. All
winning orders are awarded the winning rate (in this case, 3.12%) as the
interest rate for the next period that interest will accrue (each an "Interest
Period"), when another auction will be held.  Multiple orders at the winning
rate are allocated units on a pro rata basis.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, in
no event will the interest rate exceed the lesser of the Net Loan Rate or the
Maximum Auction Rate (each as described in Appendix I).

  The above example assumes that a successful auction has occurred (i.e., all
                                                                    ----     
Sell Orders and all Bid/Hold Orders below the new interest rate were fulfilled).
In certain circumstances, there may be insufficient Potential Bid Orders to
purchase all the Auction Rate Securities offered for sale.  In such
circumstances, the interest rate for the upcoming Interest Period will equal the
lesser of the Net Loan Rate and the Maximum Auction Rate.  Also, if all the
Auction Rate Securities are subject to Hold Orders (i.e., each holder of Auction
                                                    ----                        
Rate Securities wishes to continue holding its Auction Rate Securities,
regardless of the interest rate) the interest rate for the upcoming Interest
Period will equal the lesser of the Net Loan Rate and the All Hold Rate (as
defined below).

  As stated above, the foregoing is only a summary of the auction procedures.  A
more detailed description of these procedures is contained in Appendix I.



MONTHLY ADVANCES AND COMPENSATING INTEREST

                                      -47-
<PAGE>
 
     In order to maintain a regular flow of scheduled interest payments to
Securityholders (rather than to guarantee or insure against losses) if provided
in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Master Servicer will be required to
advance to the Trustee, on or before each Remittance Date (from its own funds),
the amount, if any, by which (a) the sum of (x) 30 days' interest at the
applicable weighted average Adjusted Mortgage Loan Remittance Rate (as defined
below) on the then outstanding principal balance of the related Series of
Securities and (y) the amount, if any, required to be deposited into the related
Reserve Account (as specified in the Prospectus Supplement) for the related
Remittance Date exceeds (b) the amount received by the Master Servicer and any
Sub-Servicers in respect of interest on the Mortgage Loans as of the related
Record Date (such excess, the "Monthly Advance").  For each Class of Securities,
the "Adjusted Mortgage Loan Remittance Rate" will equal the sum of the related
Pass-Through Rate or Interest Rate and the rate used in determining certain
expenses payable by the related Trust, as more specifically set forth in the
related Prospectus Supplement.  The Master Servicer  will not be required to
make any Monthly Advances which it determines, in good faith, would be
nonrecoverable from amounts received in respect of the Mortgage Loans.

     If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, not later than the
close of business on each Determination Date, with respect to each Mortgage Loan
for which a Principal Prepayment in full or Curtailment was received during the
related Due Period, the Master Servicer will be required to remit to the Trustee
for deposit in the Distribution Account from amounts otherwise payable to it as
servicing compensation, an amount equal to the excess of (a) 30 days' interest
on the principal balance of each such Mortgage Loan as of the beginning of the
related Due Period at the applicable weighted average Adjusted Mortgage Loan
Remittance Rate, over (b) the amount of interest actually received on the
related Mortgage Loan for such Due Period (such difference, "Compensating
Interest").


REVOLVING PERIOD AND AMORTIZATION PERIOD; RETAINED INTEREST

  If the related Prospectus Supplement so provides, there may be a period
commencing on the date of issuance of a Class or Classes of Notes and/or
Certificates of a Series and ending on the date set forth in the related
Prospectus Supplement (each, a "Revolving Period") during which limited or no
principal payments will be made to one or more Classes of Notes or Certificates
of the related Series as are identified in such Prospectus Supplement.  Some or
all collections of principal otherwise allocated to such Classes of Notes or
Certificates may be (i) utilized during the Revolving Period to acquire
additional Mortgage Assets which satisfy the criteria specified above and the
criteria set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement, (ii) held in an account
and invested in Permitted Investments for later distribution to Securityholders,
(iii) applied to those Notes or Certificates for such Series, if any, specified
in the related Prospectus Supplement as then are in amortization, or (iv)
otherwise applied as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

  An "Amortization Period" is the period during which an amount of principal is
payable to Holders of a Series which, during the Revolving Period, were not
otherwise entitled to such payments.  If so specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, during an Amortization Period all or a portion of principal
collections on the Mortgage Loans may be applied as specified above for a
Revolving Period and, to the extent not so applied, will be distributed to the
Classes of Notes or Certificates for such Series specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement as then being entitled to payments of principal.  In
addition, if so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, amounts
deposited in certain accounts for the benefit of one or more Classes of Notes or
Certificates for such Series may be released from time to time or on a specified
date and applied as a payment of principal on such Classes of Notes or
Certificates.  The related Prospectus Supplement will set forth the
circumstances which will result in the commencement of an Amortization Period.

  Each Series which has a Revolving Period may also issue to the Representative
or one of its affiliates a certificate evidencing an undivided beneficial
interest (a "Retained Interest") in such Series not represented by the other
Securities issued by the Representative.  As further described in the related
Prospectus Supplement, the value of such Retained Interest will fluctuate as the
amount of Notes and Certificates of the related Series of Securities outstanding
is reduced.


BOOK-ENTRY REGISTRATION

                                      -48-
<PAGE>
 
     If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Certificates
and/or Notes of a Series initially will be registered in the name of Cede, the
nominee of DTC.  DTC is a limited purpose trust company organized under the laws
of the State of New York, a member of the Federal Reserve System, a "clearing
corporation" within the meaning of the Uniform Commercial Code ("UCC") and a
"clearing agency" registered pursuant to the provisions of Section 17A of the
Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.  DTC was created to hold securities
for its participating organizations ("Participants") and facilitate the
clearance and settlement of securities transactions between Participants through
electronic book-entry changes in their accounts, thereby eliminating the need
for physical movement of certificates.  Participants include securities brokers
and dealers, banks, trust companies and clearing corporations and may include
certain other organizations.  Indirect access to the DTC system also is
available to others such as brokers, dealers, banks and trust companies that
clear through or maintain a custodial relationship with a Participant, either
directly or indirectly ("Indirect Participant").

     Under a book-entry format, Certificateholders and/or Noteholders, as
applicable, that are not Participants or Indirect Participants but desire to
purchase, sell or otherwise transfer ownership of Certificates and/or Notes of a
Series registered in the name of Cede, as nominee of DTC, may do so only through
Participants and Indirect Participants.  In addition, such Securityholders will
receive all distributions of principal of and interest on the Securities and
reports relating to the Securities from the Trustee through DTC and its
Participants.  Under a book-entry format, Securityholders will receive payments
and reports relating to the Securities after the related Remittance Date
because, while payments and such reports are required to be forwarded to Cede,
as nominee for DTC, on each such date, DTC will forward such payments and
reports to its Participants which thereafter will be required to forward them to
Indirect Participants or Securityholders.  Unless and until Definitive
Securities are issued, it is anticipated that the only Securityholder will be
Cede, as nominee of DTC, and that the beneficial holders of Securities will not
be recognized by the Trustee as Securityholders under the Agreement.  The
beneficial holders of such Certificates and/or Notes of a Series will only be
permitted to exercise the rights of Certificateholders and/or Noteholders, as
applicable, under the applicable Agreement indirectly through DTC and its
Participants who in turn will exercise their rights through DTC.

     Under the rules, regulations and procedures creating and affecting DTC and
its operations, DTC is required to make book-entry transfers among Participants
on whose behalf it acts with respect to the Securities and is required to
receive and transmit reports and payments of principal of and interest on the
Securities.  Participants and Indirect Participants with which Securityholders
have accounts with respect to the Securities similarly are required to make
book-entry transfers and receive and transmit such reports and payments on
behalf of their respective Securityholders.  Accordingly, although
Securityholders will not possess Securities, the rules provide a mechanism by
which Securityholders will receive distributions and reports and will be able to
transfer their interests.

     Unless and until Definitive Securities are issued, Securityholders who are
not Participants may transfer ownership of Securities only through Participants
by instructing such Participants to transfer Securities, by book-entry transfer,
through DTC for the account of the purchasers of such Securities, which account
is maintained with their respective Participants. Under the Rules and in
accordance with DTC's normal procedures, transfers of ownership of Securities
will be executed through DTC and the accounts of the respective Participants at
DTC will be debited and credited.  Similarly, the respective Participants will
make debits or credits, as the case may be, on their records on behalf of the
selling and purchasing Securityholders.

     Because DTC can only act on behalf of Participants, who in turn act on
behalf of Indirect Participants and certain banks, the ability of a
Securityholder to pledge Securities to persons or entities that do not
participate in the DTC system, or otherwise take actions in respect of such
Securities may be limited due to the lack of a physical certificate for such
Securities.

     DTC in general advises that it will take any action permitted to be taken
by a Securityholder under an Agreement only at the direction of one or more
Participants to whose account with DTC the Securities are credited.
Additionally, DTC in general advises that it will take such actions with respect
to specified percentages of the Securityholders only at the direction of and on
behalf of Participants whose holdings include current principal amounts of
outstanding Securities that satisfy such specified percentages.  DTC may take
conflicting actions with respect to 

                                      -49-
<PAGE>
 
other current principal amounts of outstanding Securities to the extent that
such actions are taken on behalf of Participants whose holdings include such
current principal amounts of outstanding Securities.

     Any Notes and/or Certificates initially registered in the name of Cede, as
nominee of DTC, will be issued in fully registered, certificated form to
Securityholders or their nominees ("Definitive Securities"), rather than to DTC
or its nominee only under the events specified in the related Agreement and
described in the related Prospectus Supplement.  Upon the occurrence of any of
the events specified in the related Agreement and Prospectus Supplement, DTC
will be required to notify all Participants of the availability through DTC of
Definitive Securities.  Upon surrender by DTC of the certificates and/or notes
representing the Securities and instruction for re-registration, the Trustee
will issue the Notes and/or Certificates in the form of Definitive Securities,
and thereafter the Trustee will recognize the holders of such Definitive
Securities as Securityholders.  Thereafter, payments of principal of and
interest on the Securities will be made by the Trustee directly to
Securityholders in accordance with the procedures set forth herein and in the
related Agreement.  The final distribution of any Security (whether Definitive
Securities or Securities registered in the name of Cede), however, will be made
only upon presentation and surrender of such Securities on the final Remittance
Date at such office or agency as is specified in the notice of final payment to
Securityholders.



                               CREDIT ENHANCEMENT
                                        

GENERAL

     Credit enhancement may be provided with respect to one or more Classes of a
Series of Securities or with respect to the Mortgage Assets in the related
Trust.  Credit enhancement may be in the form of (i) the subordination of one or
more Classes of the Notes and/or Certificates of such Series, (ii) the use of a
Guaranty Insurance Policy, Spread Amount, Mortgage Pool Insurance Policy,
Special Hazard Insurance Policy, Bankruptcy Bond, Reserve Accounts, Supplemental
Interest Payments, a letter of credit, a limited financial guaranty insurance
policy, a Guaranty of The Money Store, other third party guarantees or maturity
protection, derivative instruments, another method of credit enhancement
described in the related Prospectus Supplement, or the use of a cross-support
feature, or (iii) any combination of the foregoing.  Credit enhancement will not
provide protection against all risks of loss and will not guarantee repayment of
the entire principal balance of the Securities and interest thereon.  If losses
occur which exceed the amount covered by credit enhancement or which are not
covered by the credit enhancement, holders of one or more Classes of Securities
will bear their allocable share of deficiencies.  If a form of credit
enhancement applies to several Classes of Securities, and if principal payments
equal to the aggregate principal balances of certain Classes will be distributed
prior to such distributions to other Classes, the Classes which receive such
distributions at a later time are more likely to bear any losses which exceed
the amount covered by credit enhancement.  Coverage under any credit enhancement
may be canceled or reduced by the Master Servicer or the Representative if such
cancellation or reduction would not adversely affect the rating or ratings of
the related Securities.  The Trustee of the related Trust will have the right to
sue providers of credit enhancement if a default is made on a required payment.


SUBORDINATION

     All Classes of Certificates are Subordinated in right of payment to any
Class of Notes in a given Series to the extent described in the related
Prospectus Supplement.  To enhance the likelihood of regular receipt by holders
of Senior Certificates or Senior Notes, as the case may be, of the full amount
of payments which they would be entitled to receive in the absence of any losses
or delinquencies, if so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement,
distributions of scheduled principal, Principal Prepayments, interest or any
combination thereof that otherwise would have been payable to one or more
Classes of Subordinated Certificates or Subordinated Notes, as the case may be,
of a Series will instead be payable to holders of one or more Classes of Senior
Certificates or Senior Notes, as the case may be, under the circumstances and to
the extent specified in the Prospectus Supplement.  If specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, the holders of Senior Certificates or Senior Notes, as
the case may be, will receive the amounts of principal and/or interest due to
them on each Remittance Date, out of the funds available for distribution on
such date in the related Distribution Account, prior to any such distribution
being made to holders of the related Subordinated Certificates or Subordinated
Notes, a the case may be, in each case under the circumstances and subject to
the limitations specified in the Prospectus Supplement.  The protection afforded
to the holders of Senior Certificates 

                                      -50-
<PAGE>
 
or Senior Notes, as the case may be, through subordination also may be
accomplished by first allocating certain types of losses or delinquencies to the
related Subordinated Certificates or Subordinated Notes, as the case may be, to
the extent described in the related Prospectus Supplement. If aggregate losses
and delinquencies in respect of such Mortgage Loans were to exceed the total
amounts payable and available for distribution to holders of Subordinated
Certificates or Subordinated Notes, as the case may be, or, if applicable, were
to exceed the specified maximum amount, holders of Senior Certificates or Senior
Notes, as the case may be, would experience losses on the Securities.


     In addition to or in lieu of the foregoing, if so specified in the
Prospectus Supplement, all or any portion of distributions otherwise payable to
holders of Subordinated Certificates or Subordinated Notes, as the case may be,
on any Remittance Date may instead be deposited into one or more Reserve
Accounts established and maintained with the Trustee.  If so specified in the
Prospectus Supplement, such deposits may be made on each Remittance Date, on
each Remittance Date for specified periods or until the balance in the Reserve
Account has reached a specified amount and, following payments from the Reserve
Account to holders of Senior Certificates or Senior Notes, as the case may be,
or otherwise, thereafter to the extent necessary to restore the balance in the
Reserve Account to required levels, in each case as specified in the Prospectus
Supplement.  If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, amounts on
deposit in the Reserve Account may be released to the holders of the Class of
Securities specified in the Prospectus Supplement at the times and under the
circumstances specified in the Prospectus Supplement.  See "--Reserve Accounts"
below.

     If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the same Class of
Securities may be Senior Certificates or Senior Notes, as the case may be, with
respect to certain types of payments or certain types of losses or delinquencies
and Subordinated Certificates or Subordinated Notes, as the case may be, with
respect to other types of payment or types of losses or delinquencies.  If
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, various Classes of Senior
Certificates or Senior Notes, as the case may be, and Subordinated Certificates
or Subordinated Notes, as the case may be,  may themselves be subordinate in
their right to receive certain distributions to other Classes of Senior and
Subordinated Certificates or Subordinated Notes, as the case may be,
respectively, through a cross support mechanism or otherwise.  As between
Classes of Senior Certificates or Senior Notes, as the case may be,  and as
between Classes of Subordinated Certificates or Subordinated Notes, as the case
may be, distributions may be allocated among such Classes (i) in the order of
their scheduled final Remittance Dates, (ii) in accordance with a schedule or
formula, (iii) in relation to the occurrence of events, or (iv) otherwise, in
each case as specified in the Prospectus Supplement.  The related Prospectus
Supplement will set forth information concerning the amount of subordination of
a Class or Classes of Subordinated Certificates or Subordinated Notes, as the
case may be, in a Series, the circumstances in which such subordination will be
applicable, the manner, if any, in which the amount of subordination will
decrease over time, the manner of funding any Reserve Account, and the
conditions under which amounts in any such Reserve Account will be used to make
distributions to Senior Holders of Senior Certificates or Senior Notes, as the
case may be, or released to Holder of Subordinated Certificates or Subordinated
Notes, as the case may be, from the related Trust.

GUARANTY INSURANCE POLICIES

     If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, a Guaranty Insurance
Policy may be obtained and maintained for any Class or Series of Certificates
and/or Notes.  The issuer of any Guaranty Insurance Policy (a "Security Guaranty
Insurer") will be described in the related Prospectus Supplement.  A copy of any
such Guaranty Insurance Policy will be attached as an exhibit to the related
Prospectus Supplement.

     If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, a Guaranty Insurance
Policy will unconditionally and irrevocably guarantee to Securityholders that an
amount equal to each full and complete Insured Payment will be received by an
agent of the Trustee (an "Insurance Paying Agent") on behalf of Securityholders,
for distribution by the Trustee to each Securityholder.  The "Insured Payment"
will equal the full amount of the distributions of principal and interest to
which Securityholders are entitled under the related Agreement plus any other
amounts specified therein or in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     The specific terms of any Guaranty Insurance Policy will be as set forth in
the related Prospectus Supplement.  Guaranty Insurance Policies may have
limitations including (but not limited to) limitations on the 

                                      -51-
<PAGE>
 
insurer's obligation to guarantee the Master Servicer's obligation to repurchase
or substitute for any Mortgage Loans, to guarantee any specified rate of
prepayments or to provide funds to redeem Securities on any specified date.

     Subject to the terms of the related Agreement, the Security Guaranty
Insurer may be subrogated to the rights of each Securityholder to receive
payments under the Securities to the extent of any payments by such Security
Guaranty Insurer under the related Guaranty Insurance Policy.


SPREAD AMOUNT

     If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, certain Classes of
Securities may be entitled to receive limited acceleration of principal relative
to the amortization of the related Mortgage Assets.  The accelerated
amortization will be achieved by applying certain excess interest collected on
the Mortgage Assets to the payment of principal on such Classes of Securities.
This acceleration feature is intended to create an amount (the "Spread Amount"),
resulting from, and generally equal to, the excess of the aggregate principal
balances of the applicable Mortgage Assets over the principal balances of the
applicable Classes of Securities.  Once the required Spread Amount is reached,
and subject to the provisions described in the next sentence and in the related
Prospectus Supplement, the acceleration feature will cease, unless necessary to
maintain the required level of the Spread Amount.  The applicable Agreement will
provide that, subject to certain floors, caps and triggers, the required level
of the Spread Amount may increase or decrease over time.  An increase would
result in a temporary period of accelerated amortization of the applicable
Classes of Securities to increase the actual level of the Spread Amount to its
required level; a decrease would result in a temporary period of decelerated
amortization to reduce the actual level of the Spread Amount to its required
level.  An Agreement also may provide that after one or more Classes of
Securities have been paid to the required level of the Spread Amount, excess
interest, together with certain other excess amounts, may be applied to make-up
shortfalls in, or accelerate the amortization of, other Classes of Securities.

MORTGAGE POOL INSURANCE POLICIES

     If specified in the Prospectus Supplement related to any Pool of Mortgage
Loans, a Mortgage Pool Insurance Policy issued by the insurer (the "Pool
Insurer") named in such Prospectus Supplement will be obtained and maintained
for each Series pertaining to Mortgage Loans.  Each Mortgage Pool Insurance
Policy will, subject to the limitations described below or in the related
Prospectus Supplement, cover loss by reason of default in payment on the related
Mortgage Loans in the Pool in an amount initially equal to a specified
percentage of the aggregate principal balance of all Mortgage Loans included in
the Pool as of the Cut-off Date or such other date as is specified in such
Prospectus Supplement.  The Mortgage Pool Insurance Policies, however, are not
blanket policies against loss, since claims thereunder may only be made
respecting particular defaulted Mortgage Loans and only upon satisfaction of
certain conditions precedent described below.  The Mortgage Pool Insurance
Policies generally will not cover losses due to a failure to pay or denial of a
claim under a Primary Mortgage Insurance Policy.


     A Mortgage Pool Insurance Policy generally will not insure (and many
Primary Mortgage Insurance Policies do not insure) against loss sustained by
reason of a default arising from, among other things, (i) fraud or negligence in
the origination or servicing of a Mortgage Loan, including misrepresentation by
the Mortgagor, the originator or persons involved in the origination thereof, or
(ii) failure to construct a Mortgaged Property in accordance with plans and
specifications.  If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, an
endorsement to the Mortgage Pool Insurance Policy, a bond or other credit
support may cover fraud in connection with the origination of Mortgage Loans.
If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, a failure of coverage
attributable to an event specified in clause (i) or (ii) above might result in a
breach of the Master Servicer's representations described above and, in such
event, might give rise to an obligation on the part of the Master Servicer to
purchase the defaulted Mortgage Loan if the breach cannot be cured by the Master
Servicer.  No Mortgage Pool Insurance Policy will cover (and many Primary
Mortgage Insurance Policies do not cover) a claim in respect of a defaulted
Mortgage Loan occurring when the servicer of such Mortgage Loan, at the time of
default or thereafter, was not approved by the applicable insurer.


     The original amount of coverage under each Mortgage Pool Insurance Policy
will be reduced over the life of the related Securities by the aggregate dollar
amount of claims paid less the aggregate of the net amounts realized by 

                                      -52-
<PAGE>
 
the Pool Insurer upon disposition of all foreclosed properties. The amount of
claims paid will include certain expenses incurred by the Master Servicer as
well as accrued interest on delinquent Mortgage Loans to the date of payment of
the claim. Accordingly, if aggregate net claims paid under any Mortgage Pool
Insurance Policy reach the original policy limit, coverage under that Mortgage
Pool Insurance Policy will be exhausted and any further losses will be borne by
the Securityholders.

     The terms of any pool insurance policy relating to a pool of Contracts will
be described in the related Prospectus Supplement.

SPECIAL HAZARD INSURANCE POLICIES

     If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, a separate Special
Hazard Insurance Policy will be obtained for the Pool and will be issued by the
insurer (the "Special Hazard Insurer") named in such Prospectus Supplement.
Each Special Hazard Insurance Policy will, subject to limitations described
below, protect holders of the related Securities from (i) loss by reason of
damage to Mortgaged Properties caused by certain hazards (including earthquakes
and, to a limited extent, tidal waves and related water damage) not insured
against under the standard form of hazard insurance policy for the respective
states in which the Mortgaged Properties are located or under a flood insurance
policy if the Mortgaged Property is located in a federally designated flood
area, and (ii) loss caused by reason of the application of the coinsurance
clause contained in hazard insurance policies.  See "The Agreement--Hazard
Insurance."  No Special Hazard Insurance Policy will cover losses occasioned by
war, civil insurrection, certain governmental action, errors in design, faulty
workmanship or materials (except under certain circumstances), nuclear reaction,
flood (if the Mortgaged Property is located in a federally designated flood
area), chemical contamination and certain other risks.  The amount of coverage
under any Special Hazard Insurance Policy will be specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement.  Each Special Hazard Insurance Policy will provide that
no claim may be paid unless hazard and, if applicable, flood insurance on the
property securing the Mortgage Loan has been kept in force and other protection
and preservation expenses have been paid.

     Since each Special Hazard Insurance Policy will be designed to permit full
recovery under the Mortgage Pool Insurance Policy in circumstances in which such
recoveries would otherwise be unavailable because property has been damaged by a
cause not insured against by a standard hazard policy and thus would not be
restored, each Agreement will provide that, if the related Mortgage Pool
Insurance Policy shall have been terminated or been exhausted through payment of
claims, the Master Servicer will be under no further obligation to maintain such
Special Hazard Insurance Policy.

     The terms of any Special Hazard Insurance Policy relating to a pool of
Contracts will be described in the related Prospectus Supplement.


BANKRUPTCY BONDS

     If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, a Bankruptcy Bond for
proceedings under the federal Bankruptcy Code will be issued by an insurer named
in such Prospectus Supplement.  Each Bankruptcy Bond will cover certain losses
resulting from a reduction by a bankruptcy court of scheduled payments of
principal and interest on a Mortgage Loan or a reduction by such court of the
principal amount of a Mortgage Loan and will cover certain unpaid interest on
the amount of such a principal reduction from the date of the filing of a
bankruptcy petition. The required amount of coverage under each Bankruptcy Bond
will be set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement.  To the extent specified
in an applicable Prospectus Supplement, the Master Servicer may deposit cash, an
irrevocable letter of credit or any other instrument acceptable to each
nationally recognized rating agency rating the Securities of the related Series
in the Trust to provide protection in lieu of or in addition to that provided by
a Bankruptcy Bond.  See "Certain Legal Aspects of the Mortgage Loans--Anti-
Deficiency Legislation and Other Limitations on Lenders."


     The terms of any Bankruptcy Bond relating to a pool of Contracts will be
described in the related Prospectus Supplement.

RESERVE ACCOUNTS

                                      -53-
<PAGE>
 
     If specified in a Prospectus Supplement, cash, U.S. Treasury securities,
instruments evidencing ownership of principal or interest payments thereon,
letters of credit, demand notes, certificates of deposit or a combination
thereof in the aggregate amount specified in the Prospectus Supplement may be
deposited by the Master Servicer or Representative on the date specified in the
Prospectus Supplement in one or more Reserve Accounts established with the
Trustee.  In addition to or in lieu of the foregoing, if so specified in such
Prospectus Supplement, all or any portion of distributions otherwise payable to
holders of Subordinated Certificates on any Remittance Date may instead be
deposited into such Reserve Accounts.  Such deposits may be made on the date
specified in the Prospectus Supplement, which may include each Remittance Date,
each Remittance Date for specified periods or until the balance in the Reserve
Account has reached a specified amount.  See "--Subordination" above.

     The cash and other assets in the Reserve Accounts will be used to enhance
the likelihood of timely payment of principal of, and interest on, or, if so
specified in the Prospectus Supplement, to provide additional protection against
losses in respect of, the assets in the related Trust, to pay the expenses of
the Trust or for such other purposes specified in the Prospectus Supplement.
Any cash in a Reserve Account and the proceeds upon maturity or liquidation of
any other asset or instrument therein will be invested, to the extent acceptable
to the applicable Rating Agency, in obligations of the United States and certain
agencies thereof, certificates of deposit, certain commercial paper, time
deposits and bankers acceptances sold by eligible commercial banks, certain
repurchase agreements of United States government securities with eligible
commercial banks and certain other instruments acceptable to the applicable
Rating Agency ("Permitted Investments").  Any asset or instrument deposited in
the Reserve Account generally will name the Trustee, in its capacity as trustee
for the Securityholders, as beneficiary and will be issued by an entity
acceptable to the applicable Rating Agency.  Additional information with respect
to such instruments deposited in the Reserve Accounts will be set forth in the
Prospectus Supplement.

     Any amounts so deposited and payments on assets and instruments deposited
in a Reserve Account will be available for withdrawal from such Reserve Account
for distribution to Securityholders for the purposes, in the manner and at the
times specified in the Prospectus Supplement.

SUPPLEMENTAL INTEREST PAYMENTS

     If so specified in the Prospectus Supplement, one or more Classes of
Securities may be entitled to receive supplemental interest payments under
specified circumstances.  Supplemental interest payments will be available to
fund some or all of the difference, if any, between the interest owed to a Class
of Securities on a Remittance Date and the interest that would be available to
pay such interest assuming no defaults or delinquencies on the Mortgage Assets.
Such differences may result if the interest rates on the applicable Classes of
Securities are based upon an index that differs from the index used in
determining the interest rates on the Mortgage Assets.  Except as otherwise
provided in  a Prospectus Supplement, supplemental interest payments will not be
available to fund shortfalls resulting from delinquencies or defaults on the
Mortgage Assets.

MATURITY PROTECTION

     If so specified in the Prospectus Supplement, one or more Classes of
Securities may be entitled to third-party payments to help provide that the
holders of such Securities receive their unpaid principal on or prior to a
specified date.

OTHER INSURANCE, GUARANTEES, SWAPS, AND SIMILAR INSTRUMENTS OR AGREEMENTS


     If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, a Trust may include in
lieu of some or all of the foregoing or in addition thereto letters of credit,
financial guaranty insurance policies, a Guaranty of The Money Store, other
third party guarantees, limited guarantees or insurance from agencies or
instrumentalities of the United States, and other arrangements for maintaining
timely payments or providing additional protection against losses on the assets
included in such Trust, paying administrative expenses, or accomplishing such
other purpose as may be described in the Prospectus Supplement.  The Trust may
include a guaranteed investment contract or reinvestment agreement pursuant to
which funds held in one or more accounts will be invested at a specified rate.

                                      -54-
<PAGE>
 
     If any Class of Securities has a floating interest rate, or if any of the
Mortgage Assets has a floating interest rate, the Trust may include an interest
rate swap contract, an interest rate cap agreement or similar hedge contract
providing limited protection against interest rate risks. If provided in the
related Prospectus Supplement, interest and/or principal on one or more Classes
of the Securities of a Series may be paid to Holders thereof in a currency other
than U.S. dollars.  If so provided, the Trust may, in connection therewith,
enter into one or more currency rate swaps to provide limited protection against
foreign currency rate fluctuation risks. One or more Classes of Securities also
may be issued in conjunction with a put or call feature entitling (in the case
of a put) or obligating (in the case of a call) the applicable Securityholders
to sell some or all of its Securities to the party named in the applicable
Prospectus Supplement on the date or dates set forth therein.  Any such
arrangements must be acceptable to each nationally recognized rating agency that
provides a rating for the related Series of Securities (the "Rating Agency").
Additionally, to the extent a significant portion of the Mortgage Loans
underlying a given Series of Securities consists of FHA Loans, the related
Prospectus Supplement will describe the features of any related credit support
including, but not limited to, that provided by the FHA, if any.


CROSS SUPPORT

     If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the beneficial ownership
of separate groups of assets included in a Trust may be evidenced by separate
Classes of the related Series of Securities.  In such case, credit support may
be provided by a cross-support feature which requires that distributions be made
with respect to Securities evidencing a beneficial ownership interest in other
asset groups within the same Trust.  The Prospectus Supplement for a Series
which includes a cross-support feature will describe the manner and conditions
for applying such cross-support feature.  If specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, the coverage provided by one or more forms of credit support may
apply concurrently to two or more separate Trusts.  If applicable, the
Prospectus Supplement will identify the Trusts to which such credit support
relates and the manner of determining the amount of the coverage provided
thereby and of the application of such coverage to the identified Trusts.



                 MATURITY, PREPAYMENT AND YIELD CONSIDERATIONS


     The yields to maturity of the Securities will be affected by the amount and
timing of principal payments on or in respect of the Mortgage Assets included in
the related Trusts, the allocation of available funds to various Classes of
Securities, the Pass-Through Rate or Interest Rate for various Classes of
Securities and the purchase price paid for the Securities.

     The original terms to maturity of the Mortgage Loans in a given Pool will
vary depending upon the type of Mortgage Loans included therein.  Each
Prospectus Supplement will contain information with respect to the type and
maturities of the Mortgage Loans in the related Pool.  Single Family Loans,
Cooperative Loans and Contracts generally may be prepaid without penalty in full
or in part at any time, although a prepayment fee or penalty may be imposed in
connection therewith.  Multifamily Loans may prohibit prepayment for a specified
period after origination, may prohibit partial prepayments entirely, and may
require the payment of a prepayment fee or penalty upon prepayment in full or in
part.

     In general, prepayment of Mortgage Loans is likely to increase when the
level of prevailing interest rates declines significantly, although the
prepayment rate is influenced by a number of other factors, some of which are
described below.  Similarly, when the level of prevailing interest rates rises,
prepayment rates may decrease.  No prediction can be made as to the prepayment
rate that the Mortgage Loans will actually experience.

     Generally, junior mortgage loans have smaller average principal balances
than senior or first mortgage loans and are not viewed by borrowers as permanent
financing.  Accordingly, Mortgage Loans which are junior mortgage loans may
experience a higher rate of prepayment than Mortgage Loans which represent first
liens.  In addition, any future limitations on the right of borrowers to deduct
interest payments on Mortgage Loans for Federal income tax purposes may result
in a higher rate of prepayment of the Mortgage Loans.  The obligation of the
Master Servicer to 

                                      -55-
<PAGE>
 
enforce due-on-sale provisions (described below) of the Mortgage Loans may also
increase prepayments. The prepayment experience of the Pools may be affected by
a wide variety of factors, including general and local economic conditions,
mortgage market interest rates, the availability of alternative financing and
homeowner mobility. The Representative is unaware of any reliable studies that
would project the prepayment risks associated with the Mortgage Loans based upon
current interest rates and economic conditions or the historical prepayment
experience of The Money Store's and its affiliates' portfolios of Mortgage
Loans.

     The secured conventional Mortgage Loans and Contracts generally will
contain due-on-sale provisions permitting the mortgagee or holder of the
Contract to accelerate the maturity of the Mortgage Loan or Contract upon sale
or certain transfers by the borrower of the underlying Mortgaged Property.  The
Master Servicer generally will enforce any due-on-sale or due-on-encumbrance
clause, to the extent it has knowledge of the conveyance or further encumbrance
or the proposed conveyance or proposed further encumbrance of the Mortgaged
Property and reasonably believes that it is entitled to do so under applicable
law; provided, however, that the Master Servicer will not take any enforcement
action that would impair or threaten to impair any recovery under any related
insurance policy.  See "The Agreement--Collection Procedures" and "Certain Legal
Aspects of the Mortgage Loans" for a description of certain provisions of each
Agreement and certain legal developments that may affect the prepayment
experience on the Mortgage Loans.

     Greater than anticipated prepayments of principal will increase the yield
on Securities purchased at a price less than par.  Similarly, greater than
anticipated prepayments of principal will decrease the yield on Securities
purchased at a price greater than par.  The effect on an investor's yield of
principal prepayments on the Mortgage Loans occurring at a rate that is faster
(or slower) than the rate anticipated by the investor in the period immediately
following the issuance of the applicable Class of Securities may not be offset
by a subsequent like reduction (or increase) in the rate of principal payments.

     The weighted average lives of Securities will also be affected by the
amount and timing of delinquencies and defaults on the Mortgage Loans and the
liquidations of defaulted Mortgage Loans.  Delinquencies and defaults will
generally slow the rate of payment of principal to the Securityholders.
However, this effect will be offset to the extent that lump sum recoveries on
defaulted Mortgage Loans and foreclosed Mortgaged Properties result in principal
payments on the Securities faster than otherwise scheduled.

     When a full prepayment or Curtailment occurs on a Mortgage Loan, the
Mortgagor will be charged interest on the principal amount of the Mortgage Loan
so prepaid only for the number of days in the month actually elapsed up to the
date of the prepayment rather than for a full month.  Interest shortfalls also
could result from the application of the Soldiers' and Sailors' Civil Relief Act
of 1940, as amended (the "Relief Act"), as described under "Certain Legal
Aspects of the Mortgage Loans-- Soldiers' and Sailors' Civil Relief Act" herein.
If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, in the event that less
than 30 days' interest is collected on a Mortgage Loan during a Due Period,
whether due to prepayment in full or a Curtailment, the Master Servicer will be
obligated to pay Compensating Interest with respect thereto, but only to the
extent of the aggregate Servicing Fee and Contingency Fee for the related
Remittance Date.  To the extent such shortfalls exceed the amount of
Compensating Interest that the Master Servicer is obligated to pay, and are not
otherwise covered by Insured Payments, the yield on the Securities could be
adversely affected.

     Under certain circumstances, the Master Servicer, certain insurers, the
holders of REMIC Residual Certificates or certain other entities specified in
the related Prospectus Supplement may have the option to purchase the Mortgage
Assets and other assets of a Trust, thereby effecting earlier retirement of the
related Series of Securities.  See "The Agreement--Termination; Purchase of
Mortgage Loans."

     If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the effective yield
to certain Securityholders may be slightly lower than the yield otherwise
produced by the applicable Remittance Rate and purchase price, because while
interest generally will accrue on such Securities from the first day of each
month, the distribution of such interest will not be made earlier than a
specified date in the month following the month of accrual.

                                      -56-
<PAGE>
 
     In addition, if so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement,
prepayments may result from amounts on deposit, if any, in the Pre-Funding
Account at the end of the Funding Period being applied to the payment of
principal of the Securities.

     The Prospectus Supplement relating to a Series of Securities will discuss
in greater detail the effect of the rate and timing of principal payments
(including prepayments) on the yield, weighted average lives and maturities of
such Securities.  Factors other than those identified herein and in the related
Prospectus Supplement could significantly affect principal prepayments at any
time and over the lives of the Securities.



                                THE AGREEMENTS


     Set forth below is a summary of certain provisions of each Agreement which
are not described elsewhere in this Prospectus.  The summary does not purport to
be complete and is subject to, and qualified in its entirety by reference to,
the provisions of each Agreement.  Where particular provisions or terms used in
the Agreements are referred to, such provisions or terms are as specified in the
Agreements.



SALE OF MORTGAGE LOANS

     Pursuant to each related Pooling and Servicing Agreement or Sale and
Servicing Agreement, as the case may be, at the time of issuance of Securities
of a Series the Originators and/or The Money Store will sell to the related
Trust, without recourse, all interest of the Originators and/or The Money Store
in each of the Mortgage Assets comprising the assets of such Trust and all
interest in all actual payments collected after the Cut-off Date with respect to
such Mortgage Assets.

     In addition, to the extent specified in the related Prospectus Supplement,
the net proceeds received from the sale of the Securities of a given Series will
be applied to the deposit of the Pre-Funded Amount into the Pre-Funding Account.
The aggregate principal balance of additional Mortgage Assets to be purchased
for the related Trust generally will be equal to the Pre-Funded Amount on the
date of the issuance of the related Series.  On each applicable purchase date,
the Originators and/or The Money Store will sell to the related Trust, without
recourse, the entire interest of the Originators and/or The Money Store in the
additional Mortgage Assets identified in a schedule attached to a supplemental
conveyance relating to such additional Mortgage Assets executed on such date by
the Originators and/or The Money Store.  In connection with each purchase of
additional Mortgage Assets, the related Trust will be required to pay to the
Originators and/or The Money Store a cash purchase price equal to the
outstanding principal balance of each additional Mortgage Asset as of its
related Cut-off Date.  The purchase price will be withdrawn from the Pre-Funding
Account and paid to the Originators and/or The Money Store so long as the
representations and warranties set forth in "--Representations and Warranties"
below apply to each additional Mortgage Asset to be conveyed, and the conditions
set forth in the paragraph below and in the related Agreement are satisfied.
The Originators and/or The Money Store will convey the additional Mortgage
Assets to the related Trust on the applicable purchase date pursuant to the
Agreement.

     Any conveyance of additional Mortgage Assets will be subject to the
following conditions, among others specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement:  (i) each such additional Mortgage Asset must satisfy the
eligibility criteria specified in the preceding paragraph as of its applicable
Cut-off Date and such additional criteria as may be specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement; (ii) if and to the extent specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, the third-party credit enhancement provider, if any,
shall have approved the transfer of such additional Mortgage Assets to the
related Trust; (iii) neither the Originator nor The Money Store will have
selected such additional Mortgage Assets in a manner that either believes is
adverse to the interests of Securityholders; and (iv) the Originator and The
Money Store will deliver certain opinions of counsel to the Trustee(s) and the
Rating Agencies with respect to the validity of the conveyance of such
additional Mortgage Assets.

     In connection with such sales of the Mortgage Loans, the Representative
will be required to deliver to the Trustee certain specified items (collectively
with respect to each Mortgage Loan, the "Trustee's Mortgage File") with respect
to each Mortgage Loan.  Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, each Trustee's 

                                      -57-
<PAGE>
 
Mortgage File will be required to include the following, together with certain
other specified items: (a) The original Mortgage Note; (b) either: (i) the
original Mortgage, with evidence of recording thereon or (ii) a certified copy
of the Mortgage where the original has been transmitted for recording or has
been lost; and (c) an assignment of the Mortgage Loan from the applicable
Originator to either the related Trustee or Initial Co-Trustee under the
Agreement with evidence of recording thereon (unless opinions of counsel are
delivered satisfactory to the Rating Agencies and the Security Guaranty Insurer,
if any, to the effect that recordation of such assignments is not required in
the relevant jurisdictions to protect the interests of the Trustee in the
Mortgage Loans).

     The Trustee will be required to review each such Trustee's Mortgage File to
ascertain that all required documents have been executed and received. If the
Security Guaranty Insurer, if any, or the Trustee finds any document
constituting a part of a Trustee's Mortgage File which is not properly executed,
has not been received, is unrelated to the Mortgage Loans of the related Trust
or does not conform in a material respect to the description thereof provided on
behalf of the Representative, the Securities Guaranties Insurer, if any, or the
Trustee is required promptly to notify the Master Servicer, The Money Store, and
the Trustee or the Security Guaranty Insurer, if any, respectively.  The Money
Store is required to use reasonable efforts to remedy a material defect in a
document constituting part of a Trustee's Mortgage File of which it is so
notified.  If, however, within 60 days after the Trustee's notice to it
respecting such defect The Money Store has not remedied the defect and the
defect materially and adversely affects the interest of the Trust in the related
Mortgage Loan or the interests of the Security Guaranty Insurer, if any, The
Money Store is required to (i) substitute in lieu of such Mortgage Loan a
substitute Mortgage Loan which qualifies for substitution under the Agreement (a
"Qualified Substitute Mortgage Loan") and, if the then outstanding principal
balance of such Qualified Substitute Mortgage Loan is less than the principal
balance of such Mortgage Loan as of the date of such substitution, deposit in
the related Principal and Interest Account (as defined herein under "--Payments
on the Mortgage Loans") the amount of such shortfall in principal balance
arising from such substitution (the "Substitution Adjustment") or (ii) purchase
such Mortgage Loan at a price equal to the principal balance of such Mortgage
Loan as of the date of purchase, plus 30 days' interest on such principal
balance, computed at the Adjusted Mortgage Loan Remittance Rate (as defined in
the related Prospectus Supplement) as of the next succeeding Determination Date,
plus any accrued unpaid Servicing Fees and Contingency Fees (each as defined
herein under "--Servicing and Other Compensation and Payment of Expenses") and
certain other amounts advanced by and reimbursable to the Master Servicer, plus
the interest portion of any unreimbursed Insured Payments made by the Security
Guaranty Insurer, if any, related to such Mortgage Loan, which purchase price
will be deposited in the Principal and Interest Account and delivered to the
Trustee on the next succeeding Determination Date, except for the amount
described above relating to unreimbursed Insured Payments, if any, which shall
be paid directly to the Security Guaranty Insurer; provided, however, that, if a
REMIC election has been made for the related Trust, The Money Store may not take
any such action unless it has theretofore caused to be delivered to the Trustee
an opinion of counsel knowledgeable in federal income tax matters (an "Opinion
of Counsel") which states that such a purchase or substitution would not
constitute a "prohibited transaction," as defined in Section 860F of the Code (a
"Prohibited Transaction").

REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES

     The Representative will represent, among other things, that as of the
related Cut-off Date as to each Mortgage Loan sold to the related Trust, the
information provided with respect to such Mortgage Loan was true and correct;
all of the original or certified documentation constituting the Trustee's
Mortgage Files (including all material documents related thereto) has been or
will be delivered to the Trustee or a custodian on its behalf (the "Custodian");
each Mortgage was a valid and subsisting lien of record on the Mortgaged
Property; immediately prior to such transfer and assignment, the Originators
were the sole owners of each Mortgage Loan conveyed by them; and as of the
related Cut-off Date, no Mortgage Loan will be more than 59 days delinquent in
payment, no Mortgage Loan originated within 12 months of the related Cut-off
Date will be delinquent more than 59 days as measured at the end of any month
during the 12 months immediately preceding such Cut-off Date, and with respect
to Mortgage Loans originated more than 12 months before such Cut-off Date, no
more than the percentage of Mortgage Loans specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement (measured by outstanding principal balance as of such Cut-off Date)
will have been on up to two occasions more than 59 days delinquent as measured
at the end of any month since the inception of each such Mortgage Loan.

                                      -58-
<PAGE>
 
     Pursuant to the Agreement, upon the discovery by The Money Store, the
Servicer, any Subservicer, the Custodian, the Security Guaranty Insurer, if any,
or the Trustee that any of the representations and warranties contained in the
Agreement have been breached in any material respect as of the related Cut-off
Date, with the result that the interests of the related Trust in the related
Mortgage Loan or the interests of the Security Guaranty Insurer, if any, were
materially and adversely affected, notwithstanding that such representation and
warranty was made to The Money Store's best knowledge, the party discovering
such breach is required to give prompt written notice to the other parties.
Within 60 days of the earlier to occur of The Money Store's discovery or its
receipt of notice of any such breach, The Money Store will be required to cure
promptly such breach in all material respects, or (i) remove such Mortgage Loan
and substitute one or more Qualified Substitute Mortgage Loans or (ii) purchase
such Mortgage Loan, in each case on the same terms and on the same conditions as
described above under "Sale of Mortgage Loans."  The obligation of The Money
Store to so substitute or purchase any Mortgage Loan will constitute the sole
remedy respecting a material breach of any such representation or warranty
available to the Securityholders or the Trustee.

PAYMENTS ON THE MORTGAGE LOANS

     The Agreement will require the Master Servicer to establish and maintain
one or more principal and interest accounts (each a "Principal and Interest
Account") at one or more institutions designated as a "Designated Depository
Institution" in the Agreement.

     All funds in the Principal and Interest Accounts will be required to be
held (i) uninvested, up to the limits insured by the Federal Deposit Insurance
Corporation or (ii) invested in instruments designated as "Permitted
Instruments" in the Agreement.  Any investment earnings on funds held in the
Principal and Interest Accounts are for the account of the Master Servicer.

     The Master Servicer will be required to deposit or cause to be deposited in
the related Principal and Interest Account (within 24 hours of receipt) all
payments received after the related Cut-off Date on account of principal and
interest on the related Mortgage Loans (but net of the Servicing Fee and the
Contingency Fee with respect to each Mortgage Loan and other servicing
compensation payable to the Master Servicer as permitted by the Agreement).

     Not later than the day of each month preceding a Remittance Date that is
set forth in a Prospectus Supplement (each such day a "Determination Date"), the
Master Servicer will be required to wire transfer to the Trustee the Available
Remittance Amount for deposit in the segregated trust accounts to be maintained
with the Trustee for such purpose (each a "Distribution Account").

     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
"Available Remittance Amount" will be defined in the Agreement to include, with
respect to any Remittance Date, without duplication:


          (i) the sum of all amounts received by the Master Servicer or any Sub-
     Servicer on the Mortgage Loans (including amounts paid by the Master
     Servicer and the Representative and excluding amounts required to be
     deposited into any related Reserve Account, amounts paid as reimbursement
     to the Master Servicer of advances and amounts recovered as voidable
     preferences) during the immediately preceding calendar month (the "Due
     Period"), plus



          (ii) the amount of any Monthly Advance and Compensating Interest
     payments with respect to the Mortgage Loans remitted by the Master Servicer
     for such Remittance Date.


     The term Available Remittance Amounts will not include Insured Payments, if
any.


GENERAL SERVICING STANDARDS


     The Master Servicer will agree to master service the Mortgage Loans in
accordance with the related Agreement and, where applicable, prudent mortgage
servicing standards.  "Prudent mortgage servicing standards" generally will
require the Master Servicer to exercise collection and foreclosure procedures
with respect to the Mortgage Loans with the same degree of care and skill that
it would use in master servicing mortgage loans for its own 

                                      -59-
<PAGE>
 
account. Pursuant to each Agreement, the Master Servicer will be required to
make reasonable efforts to collect all payments called for under the terms of
the related Mortgage Loan. Nonetheless, the Master Servicer, in determining the
type of action that is reasonable to pursue may consider, among other things,
the unpaid principal balance of a Mortgage Loan against the estimated cost of
collection or foreclosure action, the unpaid balance of the related prior
mortgage, if any, the condition and estimated market value ("as is" and "if
repaired"), the estimated marketability of the related Mortgaged Property and
the borrower's ability to repay.


SERVICING AND OTHER COMPENSATION AND PAYMENT OF EXPENSES


     The Master Servicer will be entitled to a servicing fee (the "Servicing
Fee") and a contingency fee (the "Contingency Fee") equal to the percentage per
annum specified in the related Prospectus Supplement of the principal balance of
each Mortgage Loan.  The Contingency Fee is meant to provide additional
servicing compensation to a successor servicer if The Money Store is replaced as
Master Servicer under the related Agreement.  However, as long as The Money
Store acts as Master Servicer, it will be entitled to receive the Contingency
Fee, although such amount is not deemed servicing compensation.  Unless
otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Servicing Fee and
Contingency Fee will each be calculated and payable monthly from the interest
portion of scheduled monthly payments, liquidation proceeds and certain other
collected proceeds.  In addition, the Master Servicer will be entitled under the
Agreement to retain additional servicing compensation in the form of assumption
and other administrative fees, prepayment penalties and premiums, late payment
charges, interest paid on funds in the Principal and Interest Account, interest
paid on earnings realized on Permitted Instruments, and certain other excess
amounts.

     The Master Servicer will be required to pay all reasonable and customary
"out-of-pocket" costs and expenses incurred in the performance of its
obligations under the Agreements, including, but not limited to, the cost of (i)
the preservation, restoration and protection of the Mortgaged Property, (ii) any
enforcement or judicial proceedings, including foreclosures, and (iii) the
management and liquidation of Mortgaged Property acquired in satisfaction of the
related Mortgage Loan.  Such expenditures may include costs of collection
efforts, reappraisals when a loan is 90 days past due, forced placement of
hazard insurance if a borrower allows his hazard policy to lapse, legal fees in
connection with foreclosure actions, advancing payments on the related senior
mortgage, if any, advances of delinquent property taxes, upkeep and maintenance
of the property if it is acquired through foreclosure and similar types of
expenses.  Each such expenditure constitutes a "Servicing Advance."  The Master
Servicer will be obligated to make the Servicing Advances incurred in the
performance of its servicing obligations.  The Master Servicer will be entitled
to recover Servicing Advances to the extent permitted by the Mortgage Loans or,
if not theretofore recovered from the Mortgagor on whose behalf such Servicing
Advance was made, from Liquidation Proceeds, Released Mortgaged Property
Proceeds, Insurance Proceeds and such other amounts as may be collected by the
Servicer from the Mortgagor or otherwise relating to the Mortgage Loan.
Servicing Advances will be reimbursable to the Servicer from the sources
described above out of the funds on deposit in the Principal and Interest
Account.

HAZARD INSURANCE

     The Master Servicer will be required to cause to be maintained fire and
hazard insurance with extended coverage customary in the area where the
Mortgaged Property is located, in an amount which is at least equal to the least
of (i) the outstanding principal balance owing on the Mortgage Loan and the
related senior mortgage, if any, (ii) the full insurable value of the premises
securing the Mortgage Loan, and (iii) the minimum amount required to compensate
for damage or loss on a replacement cost basis.  If the Mortgaged Property is in
an area identified in the Federal Register by the Flood Emergency Management
Agency as having special flood hazards (and such flood insurance has been made
available), the Master Servicer will be required to cause to be purchased a
flood insurance policy with a generally acceptable insurance carrier, in an
amount representing coverage not less than the least of (a) the outstanding
principal balance of the Mortgage Loan and the senior lien, if any, (b) the full
insurable value of the Mortgaged Property, or (c) the maximum amount of
insurance available under the National Flood Insurance Act of 1968, as amended.
The Master Servicer will also be required to maintain, to the extent such
insurance is available, on REO Property, fire and hazard insurance in the
applicable amounts described above, liability insurance and, to the extent
required and available under the National Flood Insurance Act of 1968, as
amended, flood insurance in an amount equal to that required above.  Any amounts
collected by the Master Servicer or any Sub-Servicer under any such policies
(other than amounts to be applied to the restoration or repair of the Mortgaged
Property, or to be released 

                                      -60-
<PAGE>
 
to the Mortgagor in accordance with customary first or second mortgage servicing
procedures) are required to be deposited in the Principal and Interest Account.

     In the event that the Master Servicer obtains and maintains a blanket
policy insuring against fire and hazards of extended coverage on all of the
Mortgage Loans, then, to the extent such policy names the Trustee as loss payee
and provides coverage in an amount equal to the aggregate unpaid principal
balance on the Mortgage Loans without individual fire and hazard insurance, and
otherwise complies with the requirements of the preceding paragraph, the Master
Servicer will be deemed conclusively to have satisfied its obligations with
respect to fire and hazard insurance coverage.

ENFORCEMENT OF DUE ON SALE CLAUSES

     When a Mortgaged Property has been or is about to be conveyed by the
Mortgagor, the Master Servicer, on behalf of the Trustee, will, to the extent it
has knowledge of such conveyance or prospective conveyance, be required to
enforce the rights of the Trustee as the mortgagee of record to accelerate the
maturity of the related Mortgage Loan under any "due-on-sale" clause contained
in the related Mortgage or Mortgage Note; provided, however, that the Master
Servicer will not be required to exercise any such right if the "due-on-sale"
clause, in the reasonable belief of the Master Servicer, is not enforceable
under applicable law or if such enforcement would materially increase the risk
of default or delinquency on, or materially decrease the security for, such
Mortgage Loan.  In such event, the Master Servicer will attempt to enter into an
assumption and modification agreement with the person to whom such property has
been or is about to be conveyed, pursuant to which such person becomes liable
under the Mortgage Note and, unless prohibited by applicable law or the mortgage
documents, the Mortgagor remains liable thereon.  The Master Servicer also will
be authorized with the prior approval of the Security Guaranty Insurer, if any,
to enter into a substitution of liability agreement with such person, pursuant
to which the original Mortgagor is released from liability and such person is
substituted as Mortgagor and becomes liable under the Mortgage Note.
Notwithstanding the foregoing, with respect to Mortgage Loans with Combined
Loan-to-Value Ratios exceeding 100%, the Master Servicer may, but will be under
no obligation to, permit a borrower who is selling his principal residence to
substitute the new mortgaged property as collateral for the related Mortgage
Loan.  In such event, the Master Servicer may require the borrower to make a
partial prepayment in reduction of the principal balance of the Mortgage Loan.

REALIZATION UPON DEFAULTED MORTGAGE

     The Master Servicer generally will foreclose upon or otherwise comparably
convert the ownership in the name of the Trustee of Mortgaged Properties
relating to defaulted Mortgage Loans as to which no satisfactory arrangements
can be made for collection of delinquent payments.  However, the Master Servicer
will be required to take into account the existence of any hazardous substances,
hazardous wastes or solid wastes on a Mortgaged Property in determining whether
to foreclose upon or otherwise comparably convert the ownership of such
Mortgaged Property.

WAIVERS AND DEFERMENTS OF CERTAIN PAYMENTS

     The Agreement will require the Master Servicer to make reasonable efforts
to collect all payments called for under the terms and provisions of the
Mortgage Loans.  Consistent with the foregoing, the Master Servicer may in its
discretion waive any late payment charge, prepayment charge, assumption fee or
any penalty interest in connection with the prepayment of a Mortgage Loan or any
other fee or charge which the Master Servicer would be entitled to retain as
servicing compensation and may waive, vary or modify any term of any Mortgage
Loan or consent to the postponement of strict compliance with any such term or
in any matter grant indulgence to any Mortgagor, subject to the limitations set
forth in the Agreement.  In the event the Master Servicer consents to the
deferment of the due dates for payments due on a Mortgage Note, the Master
Servicer will nonetheless make payment of any required Monthly Advance with
respect to the payments so extended to the same extent as if such installment
were due, owing and delinquent and had not been deferred.

SUB-SERVICERS

                                      -61-
<PAGE>
 
     The Master Servicer will be permitted under the related Agreement to enter
into sub-servicing arrangements with sub-servicers meeting the requirements of
the related Agreement (each, a "Sub-Servicer").  Such sub-servicing arrangements
will not relieve the Master Servicer of any liability it might otherwise have,
had the sub-servicing arrangement not been entered into.

REMOVAL AND RESIGNATION OF MASTER SERVICER

     With respect to each Series of Securities, the Security Guaranty Insurer,
if any, or the Holders of not less than 50 percent of each Class of Securities
of the related Series, other than the holders of residual interests (the
"Majority Securityholders"), by notice in writing to the Master Servicer and
with the prior written consent of the Security Guaranty Insurer, if any, which
consent may not be unreasonably withheld, generally may, pursuant to the related
Agreement, remove the Master Servicer upon the occurrence of any of the
following events:


          (i) (A) an Event of Nonpayment (as defined below) if the Series of
     Securities has the benefit of a Guaranty Insurance Policy; (B) the failure
     by the Master Servicer to make any required Servicing Advance to the extent
     such failure materially or adversely affects the interests of the Security
     Guaranty Insurer, if any, or the Securityholders; (C) the failure by the
     Master Servicer to make any required Monthly Advance; (D) the failure by
     the Master Servicer to remit any Compensating Interest; or (E) any failure
     by the Master Servicer to remit to the Trustee any payment required to be
     made under the terms of the related Agreement, which in each case continues
     unremedied (in the case of the events described in clauses (i)(A), (i)(B),
     (i)(D) and (i)(E) for 30 days) after the date upon which written notice of
     such failure, requiring the same to be remedied, shall have been given to
     the Master Servicer by the Trustee or to the Master Servicer and the
     Trustee by any Securityholder or the Security Guaranty Insurer, if any; or



          (ii) failure by the Master Servicer or The Money Store (so long as The
     Money Store is the Master Servicer) duly to observe or perform, in any
     material respect, any other covenants, obligations or agreements of the
     Master Servicer or the Representative, as set forth in the related
     Agreement, which failure continues unremedied for a period of 60 days after
     the date on which written notice of such failure, requiring the same to be
     remedied, shall have been given to the Master Servicer or The Money Store,
     as the case may be, by the Trustee or to the Master Servicer or The Money
     Store, as the case may be, and the Trustee by any Securityholder or the
     Security Guaranty Insurer, if any; or



          (iii) a decree or order of a court or agency or supervisory authority
     having jurisdiction for the appointment of a conservator or receiver or
     liquidator in any insolvency, readjustment of debt, marshaling of assets
     and liabilities or similar proceedings, or for the winding-up or
     liquidation of its affairs, shall have been entered against the Master
     Servicer and such decree or order shall have remained in force,
     undischarged or unstayed for a period of 60 days; or



          (iv) the Master Servicer shall consent to the appointment of a
     conservator or receiver or liquidator in any insolvency, readjustment of
     debt, marshaling of assets and liabilities or similar proceedings of or
     relating to the Master Servicer or of or relating to all or substantially
     all of the Master Servicer's property; or



          (v) the Master Servicer shall admit in writing its inability to pay
     its debts as they become due, file a petition to take advantage of any
     applicable insolvency or reorganization statute, make an assignment for the
     benefit of its creditors, or voluntarily suspend payment of its
     obligations.


     An "Event of Nonpayment" will generally be defined in the Agreements as a
shortfall on any Remittance Date in moneys (excluding any amounts representing
Insured Payments) available to fund the full amount of the Distribution Amounts
due on such Remittance Date.

     The Master Servicer may not assign its obligations under the Agreement nor
resign from the obligations and duties thereby imposed on it except by mutual
consent of the Master Servicer, the Security Guaranty Insurer, if any, the
Trustee and the Majority Securityholders, or upon the determination that the
Master Servicer's duties thereunder are no longer permissible under applicable
law and such incapacity cannot be cured by the Master Servicer.  No such

                                      -62-
<PAGE>
 
resignation shall become effective until a successor has assumed the Master
Servicer's responsibilities and obligations in accordance with the Agreement.

     Upon removal or resignation of the Master Servicer, the Trustee will be the
successor servicer (the "Successor Servicer"), except that the Trustee as
Successor Servicer will not be required to make Monthly Advances and certain
other advances to the extent that the Trustee determines reasonably and in good
faith that such advances would not be recoverable.  If, however, the Trustee is
unwilling or unable to act as Successor Servicer, or if the Majority
Securityholders or the Security Guaranty Insurer, if any, so request, the
Trustee may appoint, or petition a court of competent jurisdiction to appoint,
any established mortgage loan servicing institution acceptable to the Security
Guaranty Insurer, if any, having a net worth of not less than $15,000,000 and
which is approved as a servicer by FNMA and FHLMC as the Successor Servicer in
the assumption of all or any part of the responsibilities, duties or liabilities
of the Master Servicer.

     The Successor Servicer will be entitled to receive the Servicing Fee, the
Contingency Fee and such other compensation as is described under "--Servicing
and Other Compensation and Payment of Expenses" above.

TERMINATION; PURCHASE OF MORTGAGE LOANS

     Pooling and Servicing Agreement; Trust Agreement.  The Trust established
under a Pooling and Servicing Agreement or a Trust Agreement will terminate upon
notice to the Trustee following the earlier to occur of (i) the final payment or
other liquidation of such last Mortgage Loan remaining in the related Trust or
the disposition of all REO Property, (ii) the optional purchase of the assets of
the Trust by the Master Servicer or the Security Guaranty Insurer, if any, as
described below, (iii) mutual consent of the Master Servicer, the Security
Guaranty Insurer, if any, and all Securityholders in writing, or (iv) if a REMIC
election has been made for the related Trust, the occurrence of a "qualified
liquidation" of the Trust, as permitted by the REMIC provisions of the Code as
described below; provided, however, that in no event will any Trust terminate
later than twenty-one years after the death of the last survivor of the person
named in the related Agreement.

     Subject to provisions in an Agreement concerning adopting a plan of
complete liquidation, on any date on which the aggregate principal balances of
the Mortgage Loans are less than 10% of the Original Pool Principal Balance (or
such other percentage as may be specified in the related Prospectus Supplement),
the Master Servicer may, at its option, and in the absence of the exercise
thereof by the Master Servicer, the Security Guaranty Insurer, if any, may, at
its option, purchase, on the next succeeding Remittance Date, all of the
Mortgage Loans and any related REO Properties at a price equal to the
Termination Price.  If so provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Master Servicer or another entity may purchase some or all of the Mortgage
Assets under the circumstances described in such Prospectus Supplement.

     On any Remittance Date on or after the Cross-Over Date on which Mortgage
Loans with an aggregate principal balance as of the Cut-off Date that equals or
exceeds 25% of the Original Pool Principal Balance (or such other percentage as
may be specified in the related Prospectus Supplement) have become liquidated
Mortgage Loans, the Security Guaranty Insurer, if any, may determine to purchase
and may cause the purchase from the Trust of all Mortgage Loans and REO
Properties in the Pool at a price equal to the sum of the Termination Price and
the outstanding and unpaid fees and expenses of the Trustee and the Master
Servicer.

     Indenture.  The Indenture will be discharged with respect to a Series of
Notes (except with respect to certain continuing rights specified in the
Indenture) upon the delivery to the Trustee for cancellation of all the Notes of
such Series or, with certain limitations, upon deposit with the Trustee of funds
sufficient for the payment in full of all of the Notes of such Series.

     In addition to such discharge with certain limitations, the Indenture may
provide that, if so specified with respect to the Notes of any Series, the
related Trust Fund will be discharged from any and all obligations in respect of
the Notes of such Series (except for certain obligations relating to temporary
Notes and exchange of Notes, to register the transfer of or exchange Notes of
such Series, to replace stolen, lost or mutilated Notes of such Series, to
maintain paying agencies and to hold monies for payment in trust) upon the
deposit with the Trustee, in trust, of money and/or 

                                      -63-
<PAGE>
 
direct obligations of or obligations guaranteed by the United States of America
which, through the payment of interest and principal in respect thereof in
accordance with their terms, will provide money in an amount sufficient to pay
the principal of and each installment of interest on the Notes of such Series on
the final scheduled Remittance Date for such Notes and any installment of
interest on such Notes in accordance with the terms of the Indenture and the
Notes of such Series. In the event of any such defeasance and discharge of Notes
of such Series, holders of Notes of such Series would be able to look only to
such money and/or direct obligations for payment of principal and interest, if
any, on their Notes until maturity.

     REMIC Considerations.  If a REMIC election is made for a Series of
Securities, following a final determination by the Internal Revenue Service (the
"IRS") or by a court of competent jurisdiction, in either case from which no
appeal is taken within the permitted time for such appeal, or if any appeal is
taken, following a final determination of such appeal from which no further
appeal can be taken, to the effect that the REMIC does not and will no longer
qualify as a REMIC pursuant to Section 860D of the Code (the "Final
Determination"), at any time on or after the date which is 30 calendar days
following such Final Determination (i) the Majority Securityholders may direct
the Trustee on behalf of such Trust to adopt a "plan of complete liquidation"
(within the meaning of Section 860F(a)(4)(B)(i) of the Code) with respect to
such REMIC and (ii) the Security Guaranty Insurer, if any, may notify the
Trustee of the Security Guaranty Insurer's determination to purchase from the
Trust all Mortgage Loans and all property theretofore acquired by foreclosure,
deed in lieu of foreclosure, or otherwise in respect of any Mortgage Loan, then
remaining in such REMIC at a price (the "Termination Price") equal to the sum of
(x) 100% of the aggregate principal balances of such Mortgage Loans as of the
day of purchase minus amounts remitted from the Principal and Interest Account
to the Distribution Account representing collections of principal on such
Mortgage Loans during the current Due Period, (y) 30 days' interest on such
amount computed at the applicable weighted average of the Adjusted Mortgage Loan
Remittance Rates, and (z) the interest portion of any unreimbursed insured
payment made by the Security Guaranty Insurer, if any.  Upon receipt of such
direction by the Majority Securityholders or of such notice from the Security
Guaranty Insurer, the Trustee will notify the holders of the Class R
Certificates of such election to liquidate or such determination to purchase, as
the case may be (the "Termination Notice").  The Holders of a majority of the
percentage interest of the Class R Certificates then outstanding may, within 60
days from the date of receipt of the Termination Notice (the "Purchase Option
Period"), at their option, purchase from the related Trust all Mortgage Loans
and all property theretofore acquired by foreclosure, deed in lieu of
foreclosure, or otherwise in respect of any Mortgage Loan then remaining in the
REMIC at a purchase price equal to the Termination Price.

     If, during a Purchase Option Period, the holders of the Class R
Certificates have not exercised the option described in the immediately
preceding paragraph, then upon the expiration of the Purchase Option Period (i)
in the event that the Majority Securityholders have given the Trustee the
direction described in clause (i) above, the Trustee is required to sell the
Mortgage Loans and such other property in the REMIC and distribute the proceeds
of the liquidation of the REMIC, each in accordance with the plan of complete
liquidation, such that, if so directed, the liquidation of the REMIC and the
distribution of the proceeds of the liquidation occur no later than the close of
the 60th day, or such later day as the Majority Securityholders shall permit or
direct in writing, after the expiration of the Purchase Option Period and (ii)
in the event that the Security Guaranty Insurer has given the Trustee notice of
the Security Guaranty Insurer's determination to purchase the assets described
in clause (ii) preceding, the Security Guaranty Insurer shall so purchase such
assets within 60 days after the expiration of the Purchase Option Period.

     Following a Final Determination, the holders of a majority of the
percentage interest of the Class R Certificates then outstanding may, at their
option and upon delivery to the Trustee and the Security Guaranty Insurer, if
any, of an opinion of nationally recognized tax counsel selected by the Holders
of such Class R Certificates, which opinion shall be reasonably satisfactory in
form and substance to the Majority Securityholders and the Security Guaranty
Insurer, if any, that the effect of the Final Determination is to increase
substantially the probability that the gross income of the REMIC will be subject
to federal taxation, purchase from the Trust all Mortgage Loans and all property
theretofore acquired by foreclosure, deed in lieu of foreclosure, or otherwise
in respect of any Mortgage Loan then remaining in the applicable REMIC at a
purchase price equal to the Termination Price.  The foregoing opinion shall be
deemed satisfactory unless the Majority Securityholders give the holders of a
majority of percentage interests in the Class R Certificates notice that such
opinion is not satisfactory within thirty days after receipt of such opinion.

                                      -64-
<PAGE>
 
CONTROL BY HOLDERS



     Each Agreement will provide that the Majority Securityholders may exercise
any trust or power conferred on the Trustee with respect to the Securities or
the Trusts, upon satisfaction of certain conditions set forth in the Agreements;
provided, however, that with respect to any action or event affecting only one
or more Classes of Securities, only Holders of such Class or Classes may
exercise such trust or power.

EVENTS OF DEFAULT UNDER THE INDENTURE; RIGHTS OF NOTEHOLDERS

     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, Events of
Default under the Indenture for each Series of Notes include:  (i) a default for
thirty (30) days or more in the payment of any principal of or interest on any
Note of such Series; (ii) failure to perform any other covenant of the
Representative or the Trust Fund in the Indenture which continues for a period
of sixty (60) days after notice thereof is given in accordance with the
procedures described in the related Prospectus Supplement; (iii) any
representation or warranty made by the Representative or the Trust Fund in the
Indenture or in any certificate or other writing delivered pursuant thereto or
in connection therewith with respect to or affecting such Series having been
incorrect in a material respect as of the time made, and such breach is not
cured within sixty (60) days after notice thereof is given in accordance with
the procedures described in the related Prospectus Supplement;  (iv) certain
events of bankruptcy, insolvency, receivership or liquidation of the
Representative or the Trust Fund; or (v) any other Event of Default provided
with respect to Notes of that Series.

     If an Event of Default with respect to the Notes of any Series at the time
outstanding occurs and is continuing, either the Trustee or the Holders of a
majority of the then aggregate outstanding amount of the Notes of such Series
may declare the principal amount of all the Notes of such Series to be due and
payable immediately.  Such declaration  may, under certain circumstances, be
rescinded and annulled by the Holders of a majority in aggregate outstanding
amount of the Notes of such Series.

     If, following an Event of Default with respect to any Series of Notes, the
Notes of such Series have been declared to be due and payable, the Trustee may,
in its discretion, notwithstanding such acceleration, elect to maintain
possession of the collateral securing the Notes of such Series and to continue
to apply distributions on such collateral as if there had been no declaration of
acceleration if such collateral continues to provide sufficient funds for the
payment of principal of and interest on the Notes of such Series as they would
have become due if there had not been such a declaration.  In addition, the
Trustee may not sell or otherwise liquidate the collateral securing the Notes of
a Series following an Event of Default other than a default in the payment of
any principal or interest on any Note of such Series for thirty (30) days or
more, unless (a) the Holders of 100% of the then aggregate outstanding amount of
the Notes of such Series consent to such sale, (b) the proceeds of such sale or
liquidation are sufficient to pay in full the principal of and accrued interest
due and unpaid on the outstanding Notes of such Series at the date of such sale
or (c) the Trustee determines that such collateral would not be sufficient on an
ongoing basis to make all payments on such Notes as such payments would have
become due if such Notes had not been declared due and payable, and the Trustee
obtains the consent of the Holders of 66% of the then aggregate outstanding
amount of the Notes of such Series.

     In the event that the Trustee liquidates the collateral in connection with
an Event of Default involving a default for thirty (30) days or more in the
payment of principal of or interest on the Notes of a Series, the Indenture
provides that the Trustee will have a prior lien on the proceeds of any such
liquidation for unpaid fees and expenses.  As a result, upon the occurrence of
such an Event of Default, the amount available for distribution to the
Noteholders may be less than would otherwise be the case.  However, the Trustee
may not institute a proceeding for the enforcement of its lien except in
connection with a proceeding for the enforcement of the lien of the Indenture
for the benefit of the Noteholders after the occurrence of such an Event of
Default.

     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, in the
event the principal of the Note of a Series is declared due and payable, as
described above, the Holders of any such Notes issued at a discount from par may
be entitled to receive no more than an amount equal to the unpaid principal
amount thereof less the amount of such discount which is unamortized.

                                      -65-
<PAGE>
 
     Subject to the provisions of the Indenture relating to the duties of the
Trustee, in case an Event of Default shall occur and be continuing with respect
to a Series of Notes, the Trustee will be under no obligation to exercise any of
the rights or powers under the Indenture at the request or direction of any of
the Holders of Notes of such Series, unless such Holders offered to the Trustee
security or indemnity satisfactory to it against the costs, expenses and
liabilities which might be incurred by it in complying with such request or
direction.  Subject to such provisions for indemnification and certain
limitations contained in the Indenture, the Holders of a majority of the then
aggregate outstanding amount of the Notes of such Series shall have the right to
direct the time, method and place of conducting any proceeding for any remedy
available to the Trustee or exercising any trust or power conferred on the
Trustee with respect to the Notes of such Series, and the Holders of a majority
of the then aggregate outstanding amount of the Notes of such Series may, in
certain cases, waive any default with respect thereto, except a default in the
payment of principal or interest or a default in respect of a covenant or
provision of the Indenture that cannot be modified without the waiver or consent
of all the Holders of the outstanding Notes of such Series affected thereby.

AMENDMENT

     Each Agreement may be amended from time to time by the Master Servicer and
the Trustee by written agreement, upon the prior written consent of the Security
Guaranty Insurer, if any, without the notice to, or consent of, the
Securityholders, to cure any ambiguity, to correct or supplement any provisions
therein, to comply with any changes in the Code, or to make any other provisions
with respect to matters or questions arising under the Agreement which are not
inconsistent with the provisions of such Agreement, or any agreement for the
retention of each Trustee's Mortgage File; provided, however, that such action
shall not, as evidenced by an Opinion of Counsel delivered to the Trustee,
adversely affect the interest of any Securityholder or any other party and
further provided that no such amendment shall reduce in any manner the amount
of, or delay the timing of, any amounts which are required to be distributed on
any Security without the consent of the Holder of such Security, or change the
rights or obligations of any other party thereto without the consent of such
party.

     Each Agreement may be amended from time to time by The Money Store, the
Master Servicer and the Trustee with the consent of the Security Guaranty
Insurer, if any, and the Holders of the majority of the percentage interest in
each Class of Securities affected thereby for the purpose of adding any
provisions to or changing in any manner or eliminating any of the provisions of
such Agreement or of modifying in any manner any provisions thereof; provided,
however, that if a REMIC election is made for the applicable Trust, no such
amendment shall be made unless the Trustee receives an Opinion of Counsel, at
the expense of the party requesting the change, that such change will not
adversely affect the status of the Trust as a REMIC or cause a tax to be imposed
on the REMIC, and provided further, that no such amendment shall reduce in any
manner the amount of, or delay the timing of, any amounts which are required to
be distributed on any Securities without the consent of the Holders of 100% of
each Class of Securities affected thereby.

     Each Agreement may be amended from time to time by the Master Servicer, The
Money Store and the Trustee by written agreement, upon the prior written consent
of the Security Guaranty Insurer, if any, without the notice to or consent of
the Securityholders, in connection with the substitution of cash, a letter of
credit or any other collateral deposited in a Reserve Account.

     It will not be necessary for the consent of holders to approve the
particular form of any proposed amendment, but it will be sufficient if such
consent shall approve the substance thereof.

THE TRUSTEE

     Each Prospectus Supplement will name the Trustee under the related
Agreement.  The Agreement will provide that the Trustee may resign at any time,
in which event the Representative will be obligated to appoint a successor
Trustee.  The Representative may also remove the Trustee if the Trustee ceases
to be eligible to continue as such under the Agreement, if the Trustee becomes
insolvent or, if the Trustee enters into certain business combinations.  Any
resignation or removal of the Trustee and appointment of a successor Trustee
will not become effective until acceptance of the appointment by the successor
Trustee.

                                      -66-
<PAGE>
 
                  CERTAIN LEGAL ASPECTS OF THE MORTGAGE LOANS


GENERAL

     The following discussion contains summaries, which are general in nature,
of certain legal matters relating to the Mortgage Loans.  Laws and practices
relating to the legal effects and enforcement of mortgages and deeds of trust
vary somewhat from state to state.  In general, however, the most significant
applicable legal principles are similar in all states.  The following discussion
addresses the more significant legal principles applicable to mortgages and
deeds of trust in all states.  It should be noted that some of the Mortgage
Loans may relate to Mortgaged Properties located in California, which has
enacted various laws, not common to most other states, which impose special
limitations on the remedies available to the holders of mortgages and deeds of
trust.  These laws, called "anti-deficiency laws," are discussed below.

NATURE OF THE MORTGAGE ASSETS


     Single Family Loans, FHA Loans, Secured Conventional Home Improvement Loans
and Multifamily Loans.  The Single Family Loans, FHA Loans, Secured Conventional
Home Improvement Loans and Multifamily Loans generally will be secured by
mortgages, deeds of trust, security deeds or deeds to secure debt, depending
upon the prevailing practice in the state in which the property subject to the
loan is located.  A mortgage creates a lien upon the real property encumbered by
the mortgage, which lien is generally not prior to the lien for real estate
taxes and assessments.  Priority between mortgages depends on their terms and
generally on the order of recording with a state or county office.  There are
two parties to a mortgage, the mortgagor, who is the borrower and owner of the
mortgaged property, and the mortgagee, who is the lender.  The mortgagor
delivers to the mortgagee a note or bond and the mortgage.  Although a deed of
trust is similar to a mortgage, a deed of trust formally has three parties, the
borrower-property owner called the trustor (similar to a mortgagor), a lender
(similar to a mortgagee) called the beneficiary, and a third-party grantee
called the trustee.  Under a deed of trust, the borrower grants the property,
irrevocably until the debt is paid, in trust, generally with a power of sale, to
the trustee to secure payment of the obligation.  A security deed and a deed to
secure debt are special types of deeds which indicate on their face that they
are granted to secure an underlying debt.  By executing a security deed or deed
to secure debt, the grantor conveys title to, as opposed to merely creating a
lien upon, the subject property to the grantee until such time as the underlying
debt is repaid.  The mortgagee's authority under a mortgage, the trustee's
authority under a deed of trust and the grantee's authority under a security
deed or deed to secure debt are governed by law and, with respect to some deeds
of trust, the directions of the beneficiary.


     Condominiums.  Certain of the Mortgage Loans may be loans secured by
condominium units.  The condominium building may be a multi-unit building or
buildings, or a group of buildings whether or not attached to each other,
located on property subject to condominium ownership.  Condominium ownership is
a form of ownership of real property wherein each owner is entitled to the
exclusive ownership and possession of his or her individual condominium unit and
also owns a proportionate undivided interest in all parts of the condominium
building (other than the individual condominium units) and all areas or
facilities, if any, for the common use of the condominium units.  The
condominium unit owners appoint or elect the condominium association to govern
the affairs of the condominium.

     Cooperatives.  Certain of the Mortgage Loans may be Cooperative Loans.  The
Cooperative (i) owns all the real property that comprises the project, including
the land and the apartment building comprised of separate dwelling units and
common areas or (ii) leases the land generally by a long-term ground lease and
owns the apartment building.  The Cooperative is directly responsible for
project management and, in most cases, payment of real estate taxes and hazard
and liability insurance.  If there is a blanket mortgage on the Cooperative
and/or underlying land, as is generally the case, the Cooperative, as project
mortgagor, is also responsible for meeting these mortgage obligations.  A
blanket mortgage is ordinarily incurred by the Cooperative in connection with
the construction or purchase of the Cooperative's apartment building.  The
interest of the occupants under proprietary leases or occupancy agreements to
which the Cooperative is a party are generally subordinate to the interest of
the holder of the blanket mortgage in that 

                                      -67-
<PAGE>
 
building. If the Cooperative is unable to meet the payment obligations arising
under its blanket mortgage, the mortgagee holding the blanket mortgage could
foreclose on that mortgage and terminate all subordinate proprietary leases and
occupancy agreements. In addition, the blanket mortgage on a Cooperative may
provide financing in the form of a mortgage that does not fully amortize with a
significant portion of principal being due in one lump sum at final maturity.
The inability of the Cooperative to refinance this mortgage and its consequent
inability to make such final payment could lead to foreclosure by the mortgagee
providing the financing. A foreclosure in either event by the holder of the
blanket mortgage could eliminate or significantly diminish the value of any
collateral held by the lender who financed the purchase by an individual tenant-
stockholder of Cooperative shares or, in the case of a Trust including
Cooperative Loans, the collateral securing the Cooperative Loans.

     The Cooperative is owned by tenant-stockholders who, through ownership of
stock, shares or membership certificates in the corporation, receive proprietary
leases or occupancy agreements which confer exclusive rights to occupy specific
units.  Generally, a tenant-stockholder of a Cooperative must make a monthly
payment to the Cooperative representing such tenant-stockholder's pro rata share
of the Cooperative's payments for its blanket mortgage, real property taxes,
maintenance expenses and other capital or ordinary expenses.  An ownership
interest in a Cooperative and accompanying rights is financed through a
Cooperative share loan evidenced by a promissory note and secured by a security
interest in the occupancy agreement or proprietary lease and in the related
Cooperative shares.  The lender takes possession of the share certificate and a
counterpart of the proprietary lease or occupancy agreement, and a financing
statement covering the proprietary lease or occupancy agreement and the
Cooperative shares is filed in the appropriate state and local offices to
perfect the lender's interest in its collateral.  Subject to the limitations
discussed below, upon default of the tenant-stockholder, the lender may sue for
judgment on the promissory note, dispose of the collateral at a public or
private sale or otherwise proceed against the collateral or tenant-stockholder
as an individual as provided in the security agreement covering the assignment
of the proprietary lease or occupancy agreement and the pledge of Cooperative
shares.

     Contracts.  Each Contract evidences both (a) the obligation of the obligor
to repay the loan evidenced thereby, and (b) the grant of a security interest in
the Manufactured Home to secure repayment of such loan.  The Contracts generally
are "chattel paper" as defined in the UCC in effect in the states in which the
Manufactured Homes initially were registered.  Pursuant to the UCC, the rules
governing the sale of chattel paper are similar to those governing the
perfection of a security interest in chattel paper.  Unless otherwise specified
in the Prospectus Supplement, under the Agreement, the Representative will
transfer or cause the transfer of physical possession of the Contracts to the
Trustee or its custodian.  In addition, the Representative will make or cause to
be made an appropriate filing of a UCC-1 financing statement in the appropriate
states to give notice of the Trustee's ownership of the Contracts.

     Under the laws of most states, manufactured housing constitutes personal
property and is subject to the motor vehicle registration laws of the state or
other jurisdiction in which the unit is located.  In a few states, where
certificates of title are not required for Manufactured Homes, security
interests are perfected by the filing of a financing statement under Article 9
of the UCC.  Such financing statements are effective for five years and must be
renewed at the end of each five years.  The certificate of title laws adopted by
the majority of states provide that ownership of motor vehicles and manufactured
housing shall be evidenced by a certificate of title issued by the motor
vehicles department (or a similar entity) of such state.  In the states which
have enacted certificate of title laws, a security interest in a unit of
manufactured housing, so long as it is not attached to land in so permanent a
fashion as to become a fixture, is generally perfected by the recording of such
interest on the certificate of title to the unit in the appropriate motor
vehicle registration office or by delivery of the required documents and payment
of a fee to such office, depending on state law.  Unless otherwise specified in
the related Prospectus Supplement, the Master Servicer will be required to
effect such notation or delivery of the required documents and fees, and to
obtain possession of the certificate of title, as appropriate under the laws of
the state in which any Manufactured Home is registered.  If the Master Servicer
fails, due to clerical errors or otherwise, to effect such notation or delivery,
or files the security interest under the wrong law (for example, under a motor
vehicle title statute rather than under the UCC, in a few states), the Trustee
may not have a first priority security interest in the Manufactured Home
securing a Contract.

     As manufactured homes have become larger and often have been attached to
their sites without any apparent intention to move them, courts in many states
have held that manufactured homes may, under certain circumstances, 

                                      -68-
<PAGE>
 
become subject to real estate title and recording laws. As a result, a security
interest in a manufactured home could be rendered subordinate to the interests
of other parties claiming an interest in the home under applicable state real
estate law. In order to perfect a security interest in a Manufactured Home under
real estate laws, the holder of the security interest must file either a
"fixture filing" under the provisions of the UCC or a real estate mortgage under
the real estate laws of the state where the home is located. These filings must
be made in the real estate records office of the county where the home is
located. Generally, Contracts will contain provisions prohibiting the obligor
from permanently attaching the Manufactured Home to its site. So long as the
obligor does not violate this agreement, a security interest in the Manufactured
Home will be governed by the certificate of title laws or the UCC, and the
notation of the security interest on the certificate of title or the filing of a
UCC financing statement will be effective to maintain the priority of the
security interest in the Manufactured Home. If, however, a Manufactured Home is
permanently attached to its site, other parties could obtain an interest in the
Manufactured Home which is prior to the security interest originally retained by
the Seller and transferred to the Representative.

     The Representative will assign or cause to be assigned a security interest
in the Manufactured Homes to the Trustee, on behalf of the Securityholders.
Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, neither the
Representative, the Master Servicer nor the Trustee will amend the certificates
of title to identify the Trustee, on behalf of the Securityholders, as the new
secured party and, accordingly, the Representative or the Seller will continue
to be named as the secured party on the certificates of title relating to the
Manufactured Homes.  In most states, such assignment is an effective conveyance
of such security interest without amendment of any lien noted on the related
Certificate of title and the new secured party succeeds to the Representative's
rights as the secured party.  However, in some states there exists a risk that,
in the absence of an amendment to the certificate of title, such assignment of
the security interest might not be held effective against creditors of the
Representative or Seller.

     In the absence of fraud, forgery or permanent affixation of the
Manufactured Home to its site by the Manufactured Home owner, or administrative
error by state recording officials, the notation of the lien of the Trustee on
the certificate of title or delivery of the required documents and fees should
be sufficient to protect the Trustee against the rights of subsequent purchasers
of a Manufactured Home or subsequent lenders who take a security interest in the
Manufactured Home.  If there are any Manufactured Homes as to which the security
interest assigned to the Representative and the Trustee is not perfected, such
security interest would be subordinate to, among others, subsequent purchasers
for value of Manufactured Homes and holders of perfected security interests.
There also exists a risk in not identifying the Trustee, on behalf of the
Securityholders as the new secured party on the certificate of title that,
through fraud or negligence, the security interest of the Trustee could be
released.

     If the owner of a Manufactured Home moves it to a state other than the
state in which such Manufactured Home initially is registered, under the laws of
most states the perfected security interest in the Manufactured Home would
continue for four months after such relocation and thereafter until the owner
re-registers the Manufactured Home in such state.  If the owner were to relocate
a Manufactured Home to another state and re-register the Manufactured Home in
such state, and if steps are not taken to re-perfect the Trustee's security
interest in such state, the security interest in the Manufactured Home would
cease to be perfected.  A majority of states generally require surrender of a
certificate of title to re-register a Manufactured Home; accordingly, the
Trustee must surrender possession if it holds the certificate of title to such
Manufactured Home or, in the case of Manufactured Homes registered in states
which provide for notation of lien, the Master Servicer would receive notice of
surrender if the security interest in the Manufactured Home is noted on the
certificate of title.  Accordingly, the Trustee would have the opportunity to
re-perfect its security interest in the Manufactured Home in the state of
relocation.  In states which do not require a certificate of title for
registration of a Manufactured Home, re-registration could defeat perfection.
Similarly, when an obligor under a manufactured housing conditional sales
contract sells a Manufactured Home, the obligee must surrender possession of the
certificate of title or it will receive notice as a result of its lien noted
thereon and accordingly will have an opportunity to require satisfaction of the
related manufactured housing conditional sales contract before release of the
lien.  The Master Servicer will be obligated to take such steps, at the Master
Servicer's expense, as are necessary to maintain perfection of security
interests in the Manufactured Homes.

     Under the laws of most states, liens for repairs performed on a
Manufactured Home take priority even over a perfected security interest.  The
Representative will represent that it has no knowledge of any such liens with
respect to 

                                      -69-
<PAGE>
 
any Manufactured Home securing a Contract. However, such liens could arise at
any time during the term of a Contract. No notice will be given to the Trustee
or Securityholders in the event such a lien arises.

FORECLOSURE/REPOSSESSION

     Single Family Loans, FHA Loans, Secured Conventional Home Improvement Loans
and Multifamily Loans.  Foreclosure of a deed of trust is generally accomplished
by a non-judicial sale under a specific provision in the deed of trust which
authorizes the trustee to sell the property at public auction upon any default
by the borrower under the terms of the note or deed of trust.  In some states,
the trustee must record a notice of default and send a copy to the borrower-
trustor, to any person who has recorded a request for a copy of any notice of
default and notice of sale, to any successor in interest to the borrower-
trustor, to the beneficiary of any junior deed of trust and to certain other
persons.  Before such non-judicial sales take place, typically a notice of sale
must be posted in a public place and published during a specific period of time
in one or more newspapers, posted on the property, and sent to parties having an
interest of record in the property.

     Foreclosure of a mortgage is generally accomplished by judicial action.
The action is initiated by the service of legal pleadings upon all parties
having an interest in the real property.  Delays in completion of the
foreclosure may occasionally result from difficulties in locating necessary
parties.  When the mortgagee's right to foreclosure is contested, the legal
proceedings necessary to resolve the issue can be time-consuming.  After the
completion of a judicial foreclosure proceeding, the court generally issues a
judgment of foreclosure and appoints a referee or other court officer to conduct
the sale of the property.  In general, the borrower, or any other person having
a junior encumbrance on the real estate, may, during a statutorily prescribed
reinstatement period, cure a monetary default by paying the entire amount in
arrears plus other designated costs and expenses incurred in enforcing the
obligation.  Generally, state law controls the amount of foreclosure expenses
and costs, including attorney's fees, which may be recovered by a lender.  After
the reinstatement period has expired without the default having been cured, the
borrower or junior lienholder no longer has the right to reinstate the loan and
must pay the loan in full to prevent the scheduled foreclosure sale.  If the
mortgage is not reinstated, a notice of sale must be posted in a public place
and, in most states, published for a specific period of time in one or more
newspapers.  In addition, some state laws require that a copy of the notice of
sale be posted on the property and sent to all parties having an interest in the
real property.

     Although foreclosure sales are typically public sales, frequently no third
party purchaser bids in excess of the lender's lien because of the difficulty of
determining the exact status of title to the property, the possible
deterioration of the property during the foreclosure proceedings and a
requirement that the purchaser pay for the property in cash or by cashier's
check.  Thus the foreclosing lender often purchases the property from the
trustee or referee for an amount equal to the principal amount outstanding under
the loan, accrued and unpaid interest and the expenses of foreclosure.
Thereafter, the lender will assume the burden of ownership, including obtaining
hazard insurance and making such repairs at its own expense as are necessary to
render the property suitable for sale.  The lender will commonly obtain the
services of a real estate broker and pay the broker's commission in connection
with the sale of the property.  Depending upon market conditions, the ultimate
proceeds of the sale of the property may not equal the lender's investment in
the property.

     Courts have imposed general equitable principles upon foreclosure, which
are generally designed to mitigate the legal consequences to the borrower of the
borrower's defaults under the loan documents.  Some courts have been faced with
the issue of whether federal or state constitutional provisions reflecting due
process concerns for fair notice require that borrowers under deeds of trust
receive notice longer than that prescribed by statute.  For the most part, these
cases have upheld the notice provisions as being reasonable or have found that
the sale by a trustee under a deed of trust does not involve sufficient state
action to afford constitutional protection to the borrower.

     In the case of foreclosure on a building which was converted from a rental
building to a building owned by a Cooperative under a non-eviction plan, some
states require that a purchaser at a foreclosure sale take the property subject
to rent control and rent stabilization laws which apply to certain tenants who
elected to remain in the building but who did not purchase shares in the
Cooperative when the building was so converted.

                                      -70-
<PAGE>
 
     Cooperative Loans.  The Cooperative shares owned by the tenant-stockholder
and pledged to the lender are, in almost all cases, subject to restrictions on
transfer as set forth in the Cooperative's Certificate of Incorporation and
Bylaws, as well as the proprietary lease or occupancy agreement, and may be
canceled by the Cooperative for failure by the tenant-stockholder to pay rent or
other obligations or charges owed by such tenant-stockholder, including
mechanics' liens against the cooperative apartment building incurred by such
tenant-stockholder.  The proprietary lease or occupancy agreement generally
permits the Cooperative to terminate such lease or agreement in the event an
obligor fails to make payments or defaults in the performance of covenants
required thereunder.  Typically, the lender and the Cooperative enter into a
recognition agreement which establishes the rights and obligations of both
parties in the event of a default by the tenant-stockholder on its obligations
under the proprietary lease or occupancy agreement.  A default by the tenant-
stockholder under the proprietary lease or occupancy agreement will usually
constitute a default under the security agreement between the lender and the
tenant-stockholder.

     The recognition agreement generally provides that, in the event that the
tenant-stockholder has defaulted under the proprietary lease or occupancy
agreement, the Cooperative will take no action to terminate such lease or
agreement until the lender has been provided with an opportunity to cure the
default.  The recognition agreement typically provides that if the proprietary
lease or occupancy agreement is terminated, the Cooperative will recognize the
lender's lien against proceeds from the sale of the Cooperative apartment,
subject, however, to the Cooperative's right to sums due under such proprietary
lease or occupancy agreement.  The total amount owed to the Cooperative by the
tenant-stockholder, which the lender generally cannot restrict and does not
monitor, could reduce the value of the collateral below the outstanding
principal balance of the Cooperative Loan and accrued and unpaid interest
thereon.

     Recognition agreements also provide that in the event of a foreclosure on a
Cooperative Loan, the lender must obtain the approval or consent of the
Cooperative as required by the proprietary lease before transferring the
Cooperative shares or assigning the proprietary lease.

     In some states, foreclosure on the Cooperative shares is accomplished by a
sale in accordance with the provisions of Article 9 of the UCC and the security
agreement relating to those shares.  Article 9 of the UCC requires that a sale
be conducted in a "commercially reasonable" manner.  Whether a foreclosure sale
has been conducted in a "commercially reasonable" manner will depend on the
facts in each case.  In determining commercial reasonableness, a court will look
to the notice given the debtor and the method, manner, time, place and terms of
the foreclosure.  Generally, a sale conducted according to the usual practice of
banks selling similar collateral will be considered reasonably conducted.


     Article 9 of the UCC provides that the proceeds of the sale will be applied
first to pay the costs and expenses of the sale and then to satisfy the
indebtedness secured by the lender's security interest.  The recognition
agreement, however, generally provides that the lender's right to reimbursement
is subject to the right of the Cooperative to receive sums due under the
proprietary lease or occupancy agreement.  If there are proceeds remaining, the
lender must account to the tenant-stockholder for the surplus.  Conversely, if a
portion of the indebtedness remains unpaid, the tenant-stockholder is generally
responsible for the deficiency.  See "Anti-Deficiency Legislation and Other
Limitations on Lenders" below.


     Contracts.  The Master Servicer on behalf of the Trustee, to the extent
required by the related Agreement, may take action to enforce the Trustee's
security interest with respect to Contracts in default by repossession and
resale of the Manufactured Homes securing such Contracts in default.  So long as
the Manufactured Home has not become subject to the real estate law, a creditor
can repossess a Manufactured Home securing a Contract by voluntary surrender, by
"self-help" repossession that is "peaceful" (i.e., without breach of the peace)
or, in the absence of voluntary surrender and the ability to repossess without
breach of the peace, by judicial process.  The holder of a Contract must give
the debtor a number of days' notice, generally varying from 10 to 30 days
depending on the state, prior to commencement of any repossession.  The UCC and
consumer protection laws in most states place restrictions on repossession
sales, including requiring prior notice to the debtor and commercial
reasonableness in effecting such a sale.  The law in most states also requires
that the debtor be given notice of any sale prior to resale of the unit so that
the debtor may redeem at or before such resale.  In the event of such
repossession and resale of a Manufactured Home, the Trustee would be entitled to
be paid out of the sale proceeds before such proceeds could be applied to the
payment 

                                      -71-
<PAGE>
 
of the claims of unsecured creditors or the holders of subsequently perfected
security interests or, thereafter, to the debtor.

     Under the laws applicable in most states, a creditor is entitled to obtain
a deficiency judgment from a debtor for any deficiency on repossession and
resale of the Manufactured Home securing such a debtor's loan.  However, some
states impose prohibitions or limitations on deficiency judgments.

     Certain other statutory provisions, including federal and state bankruptcy
and insolvency laws and general equitable principles, may limit or delay the
ability of a lender to repossess and resell collateral.

RIGHTS OF REDEMPTION

     Single Family Loans, FHA Loans, Secured Conventional Home Improvement Loans
and Multifamily Loans.  In some states, after sale pursuant to a deed of trust
or foreclosure of a mortgage, the borrower and foreclosed junior lienors are
given a statutory period in which to redeem the property from the foreclosure
sale.  In some states, redemption may occur only upon payment of the entire
principal balance of the loan, accrued interest and expenses of foreclosure.  In
other states, redemption may be authorized if the former borrower pays only a
portion of the sums due.  The effect of a statutory right of redemption is to
diminish the ability of the lender to sell the foreclosed property.  The rights
of redemption would defeat the title of any purchaser from the lender subsequent
to foreclosure or sale under a deed of trust.  Consequently, the practical
effect of the redemption right is to force the lender to retain the property and
pay the expenses of ownership until the redemption period has run.

     Contracts.  While state laws do not usually require notice to be given
debtors prior to repossession, many states do require delivery of a notice of
default and of the debtor's right to cure defaults before repossession.  The law
in most states also requires that the debtor be given notice of sale prior to
the resale of the home so that the owner may redeem at or before resale.  In
addition, the sale must comply with the requirements of the UCC.  Manufactured
Homes are most often resold through private sale.

FORECLOSURE IN CALIFORNIA

     It is expected that a significant portion of the Mortgage Assets (by
principal balance) will be secured by properties located in California.
Foreclosure of a deed of trust in California may be effected by a judicial or
nonjudicial foreclosure proceeding, with the choice of remedy depending on the
circumstances.  Where the likelihood of a large recoverable deficiency is
present, a judicial foreclosure action may be preferred.  The discussion above
under the heading "Foreclosure/Repossession" and "Rights of Redemption" are
generally accurate with respect to foreclosure of a deed of trust in California.

     Generally, upon the completion of a non-judicial foreclosure sale in
California, the foreclosing lender is prohibited from obtaining a deficiency
judgment against the borrower.  A deficiency judgment is available following a
judicial foreclosure, subject to the limitation of the excess of the outstanding
debt over the fair market value of the property at the time of sale, and in no
event may the deficiency exceed the difference between the outstanding debt and
the purchase price at the foreclosure sale.  However, in the case of certain
purchase money mortgage loans, a lender may be prohibited by statute from
obtaining a deficiency judgment.  California law also requires the deed of trust
beneficiary to exhaust all real property security in a single action (i.e. in a
judicial foreclosure) before a deficiency judgment may be sought against the
borrower.

ANTI-DEFICIENCY LEGISLATION AND OTHER LIMITATIONS ON LENDERS

     Certain states (including California) have imposed statutory prohibitions
which limit the remedies of a beneficiary under a deed of trust or a mortgagee
under a mortgage.  In some states, statutes limit the right of the beneficiary
or mortgagee to obtain a deficiency judgment against the borrower following
foreclosure or sale under a deed of trust.  A deficiency judgment would be a
personal judgment against the former borrower equal in most cases to the
difference between the amount due to the lender and the fair market value of the
real property sold at the foreclosure sale.  As a result of these prohibitions,
it is anticipated that in many instances the Master Servicer will not 

                                      -72-
<PAGE>
 
seek deficiency judgments against defaulting mortgagors. Under the laws
applicable in most states, a creditor is entitled to obtain a deficiency
judgment for any deficiency following possession and resale of a Manufactured
Home. However, some states impose prohibitions or limitations on deficiency
judgments in such cases.

     In addition to anti-deficiency and related legislation, numerous other
federal and state statutory provisions, including the federal bankruptcy laws
and state laws (including California law) affording relief to debtors, may
interfere with or affect the ability of the secured mortgage lender to realize
upon collateral and/or enforce a deficiency judgment.  For example, in a
proceeding under the federal Bankruptcy Code, a lender may not foreclose on the
Mortgaged Property without the permission of the bankruptcy court.  The
rehabilitation plan proposed by the debtor may provide, if the court determines
that the value of the Mortgaged Property is less than the principal balance of
the mortgage loan, for the reduction of the secured indebtedness to the value of
the Mortgaged Property as of the date of the commencement of the bankruptcy,
rendering the lender a general unsecured creditor for the difference, and also
may reduce the monthly payments due under such mortgage loan, change the rate of
interest and alter the mortgage loan repayment schedule.  The effect of any such
proceedings under the federal Bankruptcy Code, including but not limited to any
automatic stay, could result in delays in receiving payments on the Mortgage
Loans underlying a Series of Securities and possible reductions in the aggregate
amount of such payments.  Some states also have homestead exemption laws which
would protect a principal residence from a liquidation in bankruptcy.

     Federal and local real estate tax laws provide priority to certain tax
liens over the lien of a mortgage or secured party.  Numerous federal and state
consumer protection laws impose substantive requirements upon mortgage lenders
and manufactured housing lenders in connection with the origination, servicing
and enforcement of Single Family Loans, Cooperative Loans and Contracts.  These
laws include the federal Truth-in-Lending Act, Real Estate Settlement Procedures
Act, Equal Credit Opportunity Act, Fair Credit Billing Act, Fair Credit
Reporting Act and related statutes and regulations.  These federal and state
laws impose specific statutory liabilities upon lenders who fail to comply with
the provisions of the law.  In some cases, this liability may affect assignees
of the loans or contracts.

     The so-called "Holder-in-Due-Course" Rule of the Federal Trade Commission
(the "FTC Rule") has the effect of subjecting a seller (and certain related
creditors and their assignees) in a consumer credit transaction and any assignee
of the creditor to all claims and defenses which the debtor in the transaction
could assert against the seller of the goods.  Liability under the FTC Rule is
limited to the amounts paid by a debtor on the contract, and the holder of the
contract may also be unable to collect amounts still due thereunder.

     Most of the Contracts in a Mortgage Pool will be subject to the
requirements of the FTC Rule.  Accordingly, the Trustee, as holder of the
Contracts, will be subject to any claims or defenses that the purchaser of the
related Manufactured Home may assert against the seller of the Manufactured
Home, subject to a maximum liability equal to the amounts paid by the obligor on
the Contract.  If an obligor is successful in asserting any such claim or
defense, and if the seller of such Contract had or should have had knowledge of
such claim or defense, the Master Servicer will have the right to require the
seller to repurchase the Contract because of a breach of such seller's
representation and warranty that no claims or defenses exist which would affect
the obligor's obligation to make the required payments under the Contract.

     Generally, Article 9 of the UCC governs foreclosure on Cooperative shares
and the related proprietary lease or occupancy agreement.  Some courts have
interpreted section 9-504 of the UCC to prohibit a deficiency award unless the
creditor establishes that the sale of the collateral (which, in the case of a
Cooperative Loan, would be the shares of the Cooperative and the related
proprietary lease or occupancy agreement) was conducted in a commercially
reasonable manner

DUE-ON-SALE CLAUSES

     Unless otherwise provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, each
Mortgage Loan may contain a due-on-sale clause which will generally provide that
if the mortgagor or obligor sells, transfers or conveys the Mortgaged Property,
the loan or contract may be accelerated by the mortgagor or secured party.  The
Garn-St. Germain Depository Institutions Act of 1982 (the "Garn-St. Germain
Act"), subject to certain exceptions, preempts state constitutional, statutory
and case law prohibiting the enforcement of due-on-sale clauses.  As to loans
secured by 

                                      -73-
<PAGE>
 
an owner-occupied residence (which would include a Manufactured Home), the Garn-
St. Germain Act sets forth nine specific instances in which a mortgagee covered
by the Act may not exercise its rights under a due-on-sale clause,
notwithstanding the fact that a transfer of the property may have occurred. The
inability to enforce a due-on-sale clause may result in transfer of the related
Mortgaged Property to an uncreditworthy person, which could increase the
likelihood of default.

PREPAYMENT CHARGES

     Under certain state laws, prepayment charges may not be imposed after a
certain period of time following origination of mortgage loans with respect to
prepayments on loans secured by liens encumbering owner-occupied residential
properties.  Since many of the Mortgaged Properties will be owner-occupied, it
is anticipated that prepayment charges may not be imposed with respect to many
of the Mortgage Loans.  The absence of such a restraint on prepayment,
particularly with respect to fixed rate Mortgage Loans having higher Mortgage
Rates or APR's, may increase the likelihood of refinancing or other early
retirement of such loans or contracts.  Legal restrictions, if any, on
prepayment of Multifamily Loans will be described in the related Prospectus
Supplement.


APPLICABILITY OF USURY LAWS


     Title V of the Depository Institutions Deregulation and Monetary Control
Act of 1980, enacted in March 1980 ("Title V"), provides that state usury
limitations shall not apply to certain types of residential first mortgage loans
originated by certain lenders after March 31, 1980.  The Office of Thrift
Supervision, as successor to the Federal Home Loan Bank Board, is authorized to
issue rules and regulations and to publish interpretations governing
implementation of Title V.  The statute authorized the states to reimpose
interest rate limits by adopting, before April 1, 1983, a law or constitutional
provision which expressly rejects an application of the federal law.  In
addition, even where Title V is not so rejected, any state is authorized by the
law to adopt a provision limiting discount points or other charges on mortgage
loans covered by Title V.  Certain states have taken action to reimpose interest
rate limits and/or to limit discount points or other charges.

     Title V also provides that, subject to the following conditions, state
usury limitations will not apply to any loan which is secured by a first lien on
certain kinds of manufactured housing.  The Contracts would be covered if they
satisfy certain conditions, among other things, governing the terms of any
prepayment, late charges and deferral fees and requiring a 30-day notice period
prior to instituting any action leading to repossession of or foreclosure with
respect to the related unit.  Title V authorized any state to reimpose
limitations on interest rates and finance charges by adopting before April 1,
1983 a law or constitutional provision which expressly rejects application of
the federal law.  Fifteen states adopted such a law prior to the April 1, 1983
deadline.  In addition, even where Title V was not so rejected, any state is
authorized by the law to adopt a provision limiting discount points or other
charges on loans covered by Title V.  In any state in which application of Title
V was expressly rejected or a provision limiting discount points or other
charges has been adopted, no Contract which imposes finance charges or provides
for discount points or charges in excess of permitted levels will be included in
any Trust Fund.

SOLDIERS' AND SAILORS' CIVIL RELIEF ACT

     Generally, under the terms of the Soldiers' and Sailors' Civil Relief Act
of 1940, as amended (the "Relief Act"), a borrower who enters military service
after the origination of such borrower's Mortgage Loan (including a borrower who
is a member of the National Guard or is in reserve status at the time of the
origination of the Mortgage Loan and is later called to active duty) may not be
charged interest above an annual rate of 6% during the period of such borrower's
active duty status, unless a court orders otherwise upon application of the
lender.  It is possible that such interest rate limitation could have an effect,
for an indeterminate period of time, on the ability of the Master Servicer to
collect full amounts of interest on certain of the Mortgage Loans.  Unless
otherwise provided in the applicable Prospectus Supplement, any shortfall in
interest collections resulting from the application of the Relief Act could
result in losses to the holders of the Securities.  In addition, the Relief Act
imposes limitations which would impair the ability of the Master Servicer to
foreclose on an affected Mortgage Loan during the borrower's period of active
duty status.  Thus, in the event that such a Mortgage Loan goes into default,
there may be delays and losses occasioned by the inability to realize upon the
Mortgaged Property in a timely fashion.

                                      -74-
<PAGE>
 
PRODUCT LIABILITY AND RELATED LITIGATION

     Certain environmental and product liability claims may be asserted alleging
personal injury or property damage from the existence of certain chemical
substances which may be present in building materials.  For example,
formaldehyde and asbestos have been and in some cases are incorporated into many
building materials utilized in manufactured and other housing.  As a
consequence, lawsuits may arise from time to time asserting claims against
manufacturers or builders of the housing, suppliers of component parts, and
related persons in the distribution process.  Plaintiffs have won such judgments
in certain such lawsuits.

     Under the FTC Rule described above, the holder of any Contract secured by a
Manufactured Home with respect to which a product liability claim has been
successfully asserted may be liable to the obligor for the amount paid by the
obligor on the related Contract and may be unable to collect amounts still due
under the Contract.  Unless otherwise described in the related Prospectus
Supplement, the successful assertion of such claim constitutes a breach of a
representation or warranty of the Seller, and the Securityholders would suffer a
loss only to the extent that (i) the Seller breached its obligation to
repurchase the Contract in the event an obligor is successful in asserting such
a claim, and (ii) the Seller, the Representative or the Trustee were
unsuccessful in asserting any claim of contribution or subrogation on behalf of
the Securityholders against the manufacturer or other persons who were directly
liable to the plaintiff for the damages.  Typical products liability insurance
policies held by manufacturers and component suppliers of manufactured homes may
not cover liabilities arising from formaldehyde and certain other chemicals in
manufactured housing, with the result that recoveries from such manufacturers,
suppliers or other persons may be limited to their corporate assets without the
benefit of insurance.

     To the extent described in the Prospectus Supplement, the Mortgage Loans
may include installment sales contracts entered into with the builders of the
homes located on the Mortgaged Properties.  The Mortgagors in some instances may
have claims and defenses against the builders which could be asserted against a
Trust.

ENVIRONMENTAL CONSIDERATIONS

     Environmental conditions may diminish the value of the Mortgage Assets and
give rise to liability of various parties.  There are many federal and state
environmental laws concerning hazardous waste, hazardous substances, gasoline,
radon and other materials which may affect the property securing the Mortgage
Assets.  For example, under the federal Comprehensive Environmental Response
Compensation and Liability Act, as amended, and possibly under state law in
certain states, a secured party which takes a deed in lieu of foreclosure or
purchases a mortgaged property at a foreclosure sale may become liable in
certain circumstances for the costs of a remedial action ("Cleanup Costs") if
hazardous wastes or hazardous substances have been released or disposed of on
the property.  Such Cleanup Costs may be substantial.  It is possible that such
costs could become a liability of a Trust and reduce the amounts otherwise
distributable to the Securityholders if a Mortgaged Property securing a Mortgage
Loan became the property of such Trust in certain circumstances and if such
Cleanup Costs were incurred.  Moreover, certain states by statute impose a lien
for any Cleanup Costs incurred by such state on the property that is the subject
of such Cleanup Costs (a "Superlien").  All subsequent liens on such property
are subordinated to such Superlien and, in some states, even prior recorded
liens are subordinated to such Superliens.  In the latter states, the security
interest of the Trustee in a property that is subject to such a Superlien could
be adversely affected.



                        FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES


     In the opinion of Stroock & Stroock & Lavan LLP, special Federal tax
counsel, ("Federal Tax Counsel"), the following are the material federal income
tax consequences of the purchase, ownership and disposition of the Certificates
or Notes offered hereby.  The discussion, and the opinions referred to below,
are based on laws, regulations, rulings and decisions now in effect (or, in the
case of certain regulations, proposed), all of which are subject to change or
possibly differing interpretations.  Because tax consequences may vary based on
the status or tax attributes of the owner of a Certificate, prospective
investors should consult their own tax advisors in determining the federal,
state, local and other tax consequences to them of the purchase, ownership and
disposition of Certificates or 

                                      -75-
<PAGE>
 
Notes. For purposes of this tax discussion (except with respect to information
reporting, or where the context indicates otherwise), the terms
"Certificateholder" and "holder" mean the beneficial owner of a Certificate.

REMIC ELECTIONS

     Under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the "Code"), an
election may be made with respect to each Trust related to a series of
Certificates to treat such Trust or certain assets of such Trust as a "real
estate mortgage investment conduit" ("REMIC").  The Prospectus Supplement for
each series of Certificates will indicate whether a REMIC election will be made
with respect to the related Trust.  In addition, if the related Prospectus
Supplement so provides, the transaction documents for a Trust may provide that
an election will be made on or after September 1, 1997 to qualify such trust as
a Financial Asset Securitization Investment Trust ("FASIT") pursuant to new
provisions of the Code which will be effective as of such date.  To the extent
provided in the Prospectus Supplement for a series, Certificateholders may also
have the benefit of a Reserve Account and of certain agreements (each, a "Yield
Supplement Agreement") under which payment will be made from the Reserve Account
in the event that interest accrued on the Mortgage Loans at their Mortgage
Interest Rates is insufficient to pay interest on the Certificates of such
Series (a "Basis Risk Shortfall").  If a REMIC election is to be made, the
Prospectus Supplement will designate the Certificates of such series as "regular
interests" ("REMIC Regular Certificates") in the REMIC (within the meaning of
Section 860G(a)(1) of the Code) or as the "residual interest" ("REMIC Residual
Certificates") in the REMIC (within the meaning of Section 860G(a)(2) of the
Code).  The terms "REMIC Certificates" and "Non-REMIC Certificates" denote,
respectively, Certificates of a series with respect to which a REMIC election
will, or will not, be made.

REMIC CERTIFICATES

     With respect to each series of REMIC Certificates, the Trustee will agree
in the Agreement to elect to treat the related Trust or certain assets of such
Trust as a REMIC.  Qualification as a REMIC requires ongoing compliance with
certain conditions.  Upon the issuance of each series of REMIC Certificates,
Federal Tax Counsel will deliver its opinion generally to the effect that, with
respect to each series of REMIC Certificates for which a REMIC election is to be
made, under then existing law and assuming a proper and timely REMIC election
and ongoing compliance with the provisions of the Agreement and applicable
provisions of the Code and applicable Treasury regulations, the related Trust or
certain assets of such Trust will be a REMIC and the REMIC Certificates will be
considered to evidence ownership of "regular interests" or "residual interests"
within the meaning of the REMIC provisions of the Code.

     To the extent provided in the Prospectus Supplement for a series, REMIC
Regular Certificateholders who are entitled to payments from the Reserve Account
in the event of a Basis Risk Shortfall will be required to allocate their
purchase price between their beneficial ownership interests in the related REMIC
regular interests and Yield Supplement Agreements, and will be required to
report their income realized with respect to each, calculated taking into
account such allocation.  In general, such allocation would be based on the
respective fair market values of the REMIC regular interests and the related
Yield Supplement Agreements on the date of purchase of the related REMIC Regular
Certificate.  However, a portion of the purchase price of a REMIC Regular
Certificate should be allocated to accrued but unpaid interest.  No
representation is or will be made as to the fair market value of the Yield
Supplement Agreements or the relative values of the REMIC regular interests and
the Yield Supplement Agreements, upon initial issuance of the related REMIC
Regular Certificates or at any time thereafter.  REMIC Regular
Certificateholders are advised to consult their own tax advisors concerning the
determination of such fair market values.  Under the Agreement, holders of
applicable classes of REMIC Regular Certificates will agree that, for federal
income tax purposes, they will be treated as owners of the respective class of
regular interests and of the corresponding Yield Supplement Agreement.

     Status of REMIC Certificates.  The REMIC Certificates will be "real estate
assets" for purposes of Section 856(c)(5)(A) of the Code and assets described in
Section 7701(a)(19)(C) of the Code (assets qualifying under one or both of those
sections, applying each section separately, "qualifying assets") to the extent
that the REMIC's assets are qualifying assets, but not to the extent that the
REMIC's assets consist of Yield Supplement Agreements.  However, if at least 95
percent of the REMIC's assets are qualifying assets, then 100 percent of the
REMIC Certificates will be qualifying assets. Similarly, income on the REMIC
Certificates will be treated as "interest on obligations secured by 

                                      -76-
<PAGE>
 
mortgages on real property" within the meaning of Section 856(c)(3)(B) of the
Code, subject to the limitations of the preceding two sentences. In addition to
Mortgage Assets, the REMIC's assets will include payments on Mortgage Assets
held pending distribution to holders of REMIC Certificates, amounts in reserve
accounts (if any), other credit enhancements (if any) and possibly buydown funds
("Buydown Funds"). The Mortgage Assets generally will be qualifying assets under
the foregoing sections of the Code except to the extent provided in the
Prospectus Supplement. However, Mortgage Assets that are not secured by
residential real property or real property used primarily for church purposes
may not constitute qualifying assets under Section 7701(a)(19)(C)(v) of the
Code. In addition, to the extent that the principal amount of a Mortgage Asset
exceeds the value of the property securing the Mortgage Asset, it is unclear and
Federal Tax Counsel is unable to opine whether the loans will be qualifying
assets. The regulations under Sections 860A through 860G of the Code (the "REMIC
Regulations") treat credit enhancements as part of the mortgage or pool of
mortgages to which they relate, and therefore credit enhancements generally
should be qualifying assets. Regulations issued in conjunction with the REMIC
Regulations provide that amounts paid on Mortgage Assets and held pending
distribution to holders of Certificates ("cash flow investments") will be
treated as qualifying assets. It is unclear whether amounts in a Reserve Account
or Buydown Funds would also constitute qualifying assets under any of those
provisions. The Prospectus Supplement for each series will indicate (if
applicable) that it has Buydown Funds. The REMIC Certificates will not be
"residential loans" for the purposes of the residential loan requirement of
Section 593(g)(4)(B) of the Code.

TIERED REMIC STRUCTURES



     For certain series of Certificates, two or more separate elections may be
made to treat designated portions of the related Trust as REMICs ("Tiered
REMICs") for federal income tax purposes.  Upon the issuance of any such series
of Certificates, Federal Tax Counsel will deliver its opinion generally to the
effect that, assuming compliance with all provisions of the related Pooling and
Servicing Agreement and applicable provisions of the Code and applicable
Treasury regulations and rulings, the Tiered REMICs will each qualify under then
existing law as a REMIC and the REMIC Certificates issued by the Tiered REMICs,
respectively, will be considered to evidence ownership of "regular interests" or
"residual interests" in the related REMIC within the meaning of the REMIC
provisions of the Code.

     Solely for purposes of determining whether the REMIC Certificates will be
"real estate assets" within the meaning of Section 856(c)(5)(A) of the Code and
assets described in Section 7701(a)(19)(C) of the Code, and whether the income
on such Certificates is interest described in Section 856(c)(3)(B) of the Code,
the Tiered REMICs will be treated as one REMIC.

REMIC REGULAR CERTIFICATES

     Current Income on REMIC Regular Certificates--General.  Except as otherwise
indicated herein, the REMIC Regular Certificates will be treated for federal
income tax purposes (but not necessarily for accounting or other purposes) as
debt instruments that are issued by the REMIC on the date of issuance of the
REMIC Regular Certificates and not as ownership interests in the REMIC or the
REMIC's assets.  Holders of REMIC Regular Certificates who would otherwise
report income under a cash method of accounting will be required to report
income with respect to REMIC Regular Certificates under an accrual method.

     Payments of interest on REMIC Regular Certificates may be based on a fixed
rate, a variable rate as permitted by the REMIC Regulations, or may consist of a
specified portion of the interest payments on qualified mortgages where such
portion does not vary during the period the REMIC Regular Certificate is
outstanding. The definition of a variable rate for purposes of the REMIC
Regulations is based on the definition of a qualified floating rate for purposes
of the rules governing original issue discount set forth in Sections 1271
through 1275 of the Code and the regulations thereunder (the "OID Regulations")
with certain modifications and permissible variations. See "REMIC Regular
Certificates-Current Income on REMIC Regular Certificates--Original Issue
Discount---Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificates," below, for a discussion of
the definition of a qualified floating rate for purposes of the OID Regulations.
In contrast to the OID Regulations, for purposes of the REMIC Regulations, a
qualified floating rate does not include any multiple of a qualified floating
rate (also excluding multiples of qualified floating rates that themselves would
constitute qualified floating rates under the OID Regulations), and the
characterization of a variable

                                      -77-
<PAGE>
 
rate that is subject to a cap, floor or similar restriction as a qualified
floating rate for purposes of the REMIC Regulations will not depend upon the OID
Regulations relating to caps, floors, and similar restrictions. See "REMIC
Regular Certificates-Current Income on REMIC Regular Certificates--Original
Issue Discount---Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificates," below, for a
discussion of the OID Regulations relating to caps, floors and similar
restrictions. A qualified floating rate, as defined above for purposes of the
REMIC Regulations (a "REMIC qualified floating rate"), qualifies as a variable
rate for purposes of the REMIC Regulations if such REMIC qualified floating rate
is set at a "current rate" as defined in the OID Regulations. In addition, a
rate equal to the highest, lowest or an average of two or more REMIC qualified
floating rates qualifies as a variable rate for REMIC purposes. A REMIC Regular
Certificate also may have a variable rate based on a weighted average of the
interest rates on some or all of the qualified mortgages held by the REMIC where
each qualified mortgage taken into account has a fixed rate or a variable rate
that is permissible under the REMIC Regulations. Further, a REMIC Regular
Certificate may have a rate that is the product of a REMIC qualified floating
rate or a weighted average rate and a fixed multiplier, is a constant number of
basis points more or less than a REMIC qualified floating rate or a weighted
average rate, or is the product, plus or minus a constant number of basis
points, of a REMIC qualified floating rate or a weighted average rate and a
fixed multiplier. An otherwise permissible variable rate for a REMIC Regular
Certificate, described above, will not lose its character as such because it is
subject to a floor or a cap, including a "funds available cap" as that term is
defined in the REMIC Regulations. Lastly, a REMIC Regular Certificate will be
considered as having a permissible variable rate if it has a fixed or otherwise
permissible variable rate during one or more payment or accrual periods and
different fixed or otherwise permissible variable rates during other payment or
accrual periods.

     Original Issue Discount.  REMIC Regular Certificates of certain series may
be issued with "original issue discount" within the meaning of Section 1273(a)
of the Code.  Holders of REMIC Regular Certificates issued with original issue
discount generally must include original issue discount in gross income for
federal income tax purposes as it accrues, in advance of receipt of the cash
attributable to such income, under a method that takes account of the
compounding of interest.  The Code requires that information with respect to the
original issue discount accruing on any REMIC Regular Certificate be reported
periodically to the Internal Revenue Service and to certain categories of
holders of such REMIC Regular Certificates.

     Each Trust will report original issue discount, if any, to the holders of
REMIC Regular Certificates based on the OID Regulations.  OID Regulations
concerning contingent payment debt instruments do not apply to the REMIC Regular
Certificates.

     The OID Regulations provide that, in the case of a debt instrument such as
a REMIC Regular Certificate, (i) the amount and rate of accrual of original
issue discount will be calculated based on a reasonable assumed prepayment rate
(the "Prepayment Assumption"), and (ii) adjustments will be made in the amount
and rate of accrual of such discount to reflect differences between the actual
prepayment rate and the Prepayment Assumption.  The method for determining the
appropriate assumed prepayment rate will eventually be set forth in Treasury
regulations, but those regulations have not yet been issued.  The applicable
legislative history indicates, however, that such regulations will provide that
the assumed prepayment rate for securities such as the REMIC Regular
Certificates will be the rate used in pricing the initial offering of the
securities.  The Prospectus Supplement for each series of REMIC Regular
Certificates will specify the Prepayment Assumption, but no representation is
made that the REMIC Regular Certificates will, in fact, prepay at a rate based
on the Prepayment Assumption or at any other rate.

     In general, a REMIC Regular Certificate will be considered to be issued
with original issue discount if its stated redemption price at maturity exceeds
its issue price.  Except as discussed below under "Payment Lag REMIC Regular
Certificates; Initial Period Considerations" and "Qualified Stated Interest,"
and in the case of certain Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificates (as defined
below) and accrual certificates, the stated redemption price at maturity of a
REMIC Regular Certificate is its principal amount.  The issue price of a REMIC
Regular Certificate is the initial offering price to the public (excluding bond
houses and brokers) at which a substantial amount of the class of REMIC Regular
Certificates was sold.  The issue price will be reduced if any portion of such
price is allocable to a related Yield Supplement Agreement.  Notwithstanding the
general definition of original issue discount, such discount will be considered
to be zero for any REMIC Regular Certificate on which such discount is less than
0.25% of its stated redemption price at maturity multiplied by its weighted
average life.  The weighted average life of a REMIC Regular Certificate
apparently is computed for purposes of this de minimis rule as the sum, for all
distributions included in the 

                                      -78-
<PAGE>
 
stated redemption price at maturity of the REMIC Regular Certificate, of the
amounts determined by multiplying (i) the number of complete years (rounding
down for partial years) from the Closing Date to the date on which each such
distribution is expected to be made, determined under the Prepayment Assumption,
by (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the amount of such distribution
and the denominator of which is the REMIC Regular Certificate's stated
redemption price at maturity. The OID Regulations provide that holders will
include any de minimis original issue discount ratably as payments of stated
principal are made on the REMIC Regular Certificates.

     The holder of a REMIC Regular Certificate issued with original issue
discount must include in gross income the sum of the "daily portions" of such
original issue discount for each day during its taxable year on which it held
such REMIC Regular Certificate.  In the case of an original holder of a REMIC
Regular Certificate, the daily portions of original issue discount are
determined first by calculating the portion of the original issue discount that
accrued during each period (an "accrual period") that begins on the day
following a Remittance Date (or in the case of the first such period, begins on
the Closing Date) and ends on the next succeeding Remittance Date.  The original
issue discount accruing during each accrual period is then allocated ratably to
each day during such period to determine the daily portion of original issue
discount for that day.

     The portion of the original issue discount that accrues in any accrual
period will equal the excess, if any, of (i) the sum of (A) the present value,
as of the end of the accrual period, of all of the distributions to be made on
the REMIC Regular Certificate, if any, in future periods and (B) the
distributions made on the REMIC Regular Certificate during the accrual period
that are included in such REMIC Regular Certificate's stated redemption price at
maturity, over (ii) the adjusted issue price of such REMIC Regular Certificate
at the beginning of the accrual period.  The present value of the remaining
distributions referred to in the preceding sentence will be calculated (i)
assuming that the REMIC Regular Certificates will be prepaid in future periods
at a rate computed in accordance with the Prepayment Assumption and (ii) using a
discount rate equal to the original yield to maturity of the REMIC Regular
Certificates.  For these purposes, the original yield to maturity of the REMIC
Regular Certificates will be calculated based on their issue price and assuming
that the REMIC Regular Certificates will be prepaid in accordance with the
Prepayment Assumption.  The adjusted issue price of a REMIC Regular Certificate
at the beginning of any accrual period will equal the issue price of such REMIC
Regular Certificate, increased by the portion of the original issue discount
that has accrued during prior accrual periods, and reduced by the amount of any
distributions made on such REMIC Regular Certificate in prior accrual periods
that were included in such REMIC Regular Certificate's stated redemption price
at maturity.

     The daily portions of original issue discount may increase or decrease
depending on the extent to which the actual rate of prepayments diverges from
the Prepayment Assumption.  If original issue discount accruing during any
accrual period computed as described above is negative, it is likely that a
holder will be entitled to offset such amount only against positive original
issue discount accruing on such REMIC Regular Certificate in future accrual
periods.  Although Federal Tax Counsel is unable to opine with respect to this
matter, such a holder may be entitled to deduct a loss to the extent that its
remaining basis would exceed the maximum amount of future payments to which such
holder is entitled.  It is unclear whether the Prepayment Assumption is taken
into account for this purpose.

     A subsequent holder that purchases a REMIC Regular Certificate issued with
original issue discount at a cost less than its remaining stated redemption
price at maturity will also generally be required to include in gross income,
for each day on which it holds such REMIC Regular Certificate, the daily
portions of original issue discount with respect to the REMIC Regular
Certificate, calculated as described above.  However, if (i) the excess of the
remaining stated redemption price at maturity over such cost is less than (ii)
the aggregate amount of such daily portions for all days after the date of
purchase until final retirement of such REMIC Regular Certificate, then such
daily portions will be reduced proportionately in determining the income of such
holder.

     Qualified Stated Interest.  Interest payable on a REMIC Regular Certificate
which qualifies as "qualified stated interest" for purposes of the OID
Regulations will not be includible in the stated redemption price at maturity of
the REMIC Regular Certificate.  Accordingly, if the interest on a REMIC Regular
Certificate does not constitute "qualified stated interest," the REMIC Regular
Certificate will have original issue discount.  Interest payments will not
qualify as qualified stated interest unless the interest payments are
"unconditionally payable."  The OID Regulations state that interest is
unconditionally payable if reasonable legal remedies exist to compel timely
payment, or the debt 

                                      -79-
<PAGE>
 
instrument otherwise provides terms and conditions that make the likelihood of
late payment (other than a late payment that occurs within a reasonable grace
period) or nonpayment of interest a remote contingency, as defined in the OID
Regulations. It is unclear whether the terms and conditions of the Mortgage
Assets underlying the REMIC Regular Certificates or the terms and conditions of
the REMIC Regular Certificates are considered when determining whether the
likelihood of late payment or nonpayment of interest is a remote contingency.
Any terms or conditions that do not reflect arm's length dealing or that the
holder does not intend to enforce are not considered. Accordingly, Federal Tax
Counsel is unable to opine whether interest payments on REMIC Regular
Certificates that otherwise would not be treated as having original issue
discount would be considered to have original issue discount because there are
not reasonable remedies to compel timely payment of interest or terms or
conditions that would make the likelihood of late payment or nonpayment remote.

     Premium.  A purchaser of a REMIC Regular Certificate that purchases such
REMIC Regular Certificate at a cost greater than its remaining stated redemption
price at maturity will be considered to have purchased such REMIC Regular
Certificate at a premium, and may, under Section 171 of the Code, elect to
amortize such premium under a constant yield method over the life of the REMIC
Regular Certificate.  The Prepayment Assumption is probably taken into account
in determining the life of the REMIC Regular Certificate for this purpose.
Except as provided in regulations, amortizable premium will be treated as an
offset to interest income on the REMIC Regular Certificate.

     Payment Lag REMIC Regular Certificates; Initial Period Considerations.
Certain REMIC Regular Certificates will provide for distributions of interest
based on a period that is the same length as the interval between Remittance
Dates but ends prior to each Remittance Date.  Any interest that accrues prior
to the Closing Date may be treated under the OID Regulations either (i) as part
of the issue price and the stated redemption price at maturity of the REMIC
Regular Certificates or (ii) as not included in the issue price or the stated
redemption price.  The OID Regulations provide a special application of the de
minimis rule for debt instruments with long first accrual periods where the
interest payable for the first period is at a rate which is effectively less
than that which applies in all other periods.  In such cases, for the sole
purpose of determining whether original issue discount is de minimis, the OID
Regulations provide that the stated redemption price is equal to the
instrument's issue price plus the greater of the amount of foregone interest or
the excess (if any) of the instrument's stated principal amount over its issue
price.

     Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificates.  Under the OID Regulations, REMIC
Regular Certificates paying interest at a variable rate (a "Variable Rate REMIC
Regular Certificate") are subject to special rules.  A Variable Rate REMIC
Regular Certificate will qualify as a "variable rate debt instrument" if (i) its
issue price does not exceed the total noncontingent principal payments due under
the Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificate by more than a specified de minimis
amount; (ii) it provides for stated interest, paid or compounded at least
annually, at (a) one or more qualified floating rates, (b) a single fixed rate
and one or more qualified floating rates, (c) a single objective rate or (d) a
single fixed rate and a single objective rate that is a qualified inverse
floating rate; and (iii) it does not provide for any principal payments that are
contingent, as defined in the OID Regulations, except as provided in (i), above.
Because the OID Regulations relating to contingent payment debt instruments do
not apply to REMIC regular interests, principal payments on the REMIC Regular
Certificates should not be considered contingent for this purpose.

     A "qualified floating rate" is any variable rate where variations in the
value of such rate can reasonably be expected to measure contemporaneous
variations in the cost of newly borrowed funds in the currency in which the
Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificate is denominated.  A multiple of a
qualified floating rate will generally not itself constitute a qualified
floating rate for purposes of the OID Regulations.  However, a variable rate
equal to (i) the product of a qualified floating rate and a fixed multiple that
is greater than 0.65 but not more than 1.35 or (ii) the product of a qualified
floating rate and a fixed multiple that is greater than 0.65 but not more than
1.35, increased or decreased by a fixed rate will constitute a qualified
floating rate for purposes of the OID Regulations.  In addition, under the OID
Regulations, two or more qualified floating rates that can reasonably be
expected to have approximately the same values throughout the term of the
Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificate will be treated as a single qualified
floating rate (a "Presumed Single Qualified Floating Rate").  Two or more
qualified floating rates with values within 25 basis points of each other as
determined on the Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificate's issue date will be
conclusively presumed to be a Presumed Single Qualified Floating Rate.
Notwithstanding the foregoing, a variable rate that would otherwise constitute a
qualified floating rate but which is subject to one or more restrictions such as
a cap or floor, will not be a qualified floating rate for purposes of the OID
Regulations unless the restriction is fixed 

                                      -80-
<PAGE>
 
throughout the term of the Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificate or the
restriction is not reasonably expected as of the issue date to significantly
affect the yield of the Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificate.

     An "objective rate" is a rate that is not itself a qualified floating rate
but which is determined using a single fixed formula and which is based upon
objective financial or economic information.  The OID Regulations also provide
that other variable rates may be treated as objective rates if so designated by
the Internal Revenue Service in the future.  An interest rate on a REMIC Regular
Certificate that is the weighted average of the interest rates on some or all of
the qualified mortgages held by the REMIC should constitute an objective rate.
Despite the foregoing, a variable rate of interest on a Variable Rate REMIC
Regular Certificate will not constitute an objective rate if it is reasonably
expected that the average value of such rate during the first half of the
Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificate's term will be either significantly less
than or significantly greater than the average value of the rate during the
final half of the Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificate's term.  Further, an
objective rate does not include a rate that is based on information that is
within the control of the issuer (or a party related to the issuer) or that is
unique to the circumstances of the issuer (or a party related to the issuer).
An objective rate will qualify as a "qualified inverse floating rate" if such
rate is equal to a fixed rate minus a qualified floating rate and variations in
the rate can reasonably be expected to inversely reflect contemporaneous
variations in the qualified floating rate.  The OID Regulations also provide
that if a Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificate provides for stated interest
at a fixed rate for an initial period of less than one year followed by a
variable rate that is either a qualified floating rate or an objective rate and
if the variable rate on the Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificate's issue date
is intended to approximate the fixed rate, then the fixed rate and the variable
rate together will constitute either a single qualified floating rate or
objective rate, as the case may be (a "Presumed Single Variable Rate").  If the
value of the variable rate and the initial fixed rate are within 25 basis points
of each other as determined on the Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificate's
issue date, the variable rate will be conclusively presumed to approximate the
fixed rate.

     For Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificates that qualify as a "variable
rate debt instrument" under the OID Regulations and provide for interest at
either a single qualified floating rate, a single objective rate, a Presumed
Single Qualified Floating Rate or a Presumed Single Variable Rate throughout the
term (a "Single Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificate"), original issue
discount is computed as described in "REMIC Regular Certificates-Current Income
on REMIC Regular Certificates--Original Issue Discount" based on the following:
(i) stated interest on the Single Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificate which
is unconditionally payable in cash or property (other than debt instruments of
the issuer) at least annually will constitute qualified stated interest; (ii) by
assuming that the variable rate on the Single Variable Rate REMIC Certificate is
a fixed rate equal to: (a) in the case of a Single Variable Rate REMIC Regular
Certificate with a qualified floating rate or a qualified inverse floating rate,
the value of, as of the issue date, of the qualified floating rate or the
qualified inverse floating rate or (b) in the case of a Single Variable Rate
REMIC Regular Certificate with an objective rate (other than a qualified inverse
floating rate), a fixed rate which reflects the reasonably expected yield for
such Single Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificate; and (iii) the qualified
stated interest allocable to an accrual period is increased (or decreased) if
the interest actually paid during an accrual period exceeds (or is less than)
the interest assumed to be paid under the assumed fixed rate described in (ii),
above.

     In general, any Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificate other than a Single
Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificate (a "Multiple Variable Rate REMIC Regular
Certificate") that qualifies as a "variable rate debt instrument" will be
converted into an "equivalent" fixed rate debt instrument for purposes of
determining the amount and accrual of original issue discount and qualified
stated interest on the Multiple Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificate.  The
OID Regulations generally require that such a Multiple Variable Rate REMIC
Regular Certificate be converted into an "equivalent" fixed rate debt instrument
by substituting any qualified floating rate or qualified inverse floating rate
provided for under the terms of the Multiple Variable Rate REMIC Regular
Certificate with a fixed rate equal to the value of the qualified floating rate
or qualified inverse floating rate, as the case may be, as of the Multiple
Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificate's issue date.  Any objective rate (other
than a qualified inverse floating rate) provided for under the terms of the
Multiple Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificate is converted into a fixed rate
that reflects the yield that is reasonably expected for the Multiple Variable
Rate REMIC Regular Certificate.  In the case of a Multiple Variable Rate REMIC
Regular Certificate that qualifies as a "variable rate debt instrument" and
provides for stated interest at a fixed rate in addition to either one or more
qualified floating rates or a qualified inverse floating rate, the fixed rate is
initially converted into a qualified floating rate (or a qualified inverse
floating rate, if the Multiple Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificate provides
for a qualified inverse floating rate).  Under such circumstances, 

                                      -81-
<PAGE>
 
the qualified floating rate or qualified inverse floating rate that replaces the
fixed rate must be such that the fair market value of the Multiple Variable Rate
REMIC Regular Certificate as of the Multiple Variable Rate REMIC Regular
Certificate's issue date is approximately the same as the fair market value of
an otherwise identical debt instrument that provides for either the qualified
floating rate or qualified inverse floating rate rather than the fixed rate.
Subsequent to converting the fixed rate into either a qualified floating rate or
a qualified inverse floating rate, the Multiple Variable Rate REMIC Regular
Certificate is then converted into an "equivalent" fixed rate debt instrument in
the manner described above.



     Once the Multiple Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificate is converted into
an "equivalent" fixed rate debt instrument pursuant to the foregoing rules, the
amount of original issue discount and qualified stated interest, if any, are
determined for the "equivalent" fixed rate debt instrument by applying the
original issue discount rules to the "equivalent" fixed rate debt instrument in
the manner described in "REMIC Regular Certificates-Current Income on REMIC
Regular Certificates--Original Issue Discount".  A holder of the Multiple
Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificate will account for such original issue
discount and qualified stated interest as if the holder held the "equivalent"
fixed rate debt instrument.  In each accrual period, appropriate adjustments
will be made to the amount of qualified stated interest or original issue
discount assumed to have been accrued or paid with respect to the "equivalent"
fixed rate debt instrument in the event that such amounts differ from the actual
amount of interest accrued or paid on the Multiple Variable Rate REMIC Regular
Certificate during the accrual period.

     If a Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificate does not qualify as a
"variable rate debt instrument" under the OID Regulations, then the Variable
Rate REMIC Regular Certificate would be treated as a contingent payment debt
obligation.  Federal Tax Counsel is unable to opine how a Variable Rate REMIC
Regular Certificate would be taxed if such REMIC Regular Certificate were
treated as a contingent payment debt obligation, since the OID Regulations
relating to contingent payment debt obligations do not apply to REMIC regular
interests.

     Interest-Only REMIC Regular Certificates.  The Trust intends to report
income from interest-only classes of REMIC Regular Certificates to the Internal
Revenue Service and to holders of interest-only REMIC Regular Certificates based
on the assumption that the stated redemption price at maturity is equal to the
sum of all payments determined under the Prepayment Assumption.  As a result,
such interest-only REMIC Regular Certificates will be treated as having original
issue discount.

     Market Discount.  A holder that acquires a REMIC Regular Certificate at a
market discount (that is, a discount that exceeds any unaccrued original issue
discount) will recognize gain upon receipt of a principal distribution,
regardless of whether the distribution is scheduled or is a prepayment.  In
particular, the REMIC Regular Certificateholder will be required to allocate
that principal distribution first to the portion of the market discount on such
REMIC Regular Certificate that has accrued but has not previously been
includible in income, and will recognize ordinary income to that extent.  In
general terms, unless Treasury regulations when issued state otherwise, market
discount on a REMIC Regular Certificate may be treated, at the REMIC
Certificateholder's election, as accruing either (i) under a constant yield
method, taking into account the Prepayment Assumption, or (ii) in proportion to
accruals of original issue discount (or, if there is no original issue discount,
in proportion to stated interest at the Pass Through Rate or Interest Rate).

     In addition, a holder may be required to defer deductions for a portion of
the holder's interest expense on any debt incurred or continued to purchase or
carry a REMIC Regular Certificate purchased with market discount.  The deferred
portion of any interest deduction would not exceed the portion of the market
discount on the REMIC Regular Certificate that accrues during the taxable year
in which such interest would otherwise be deductible and, in general, would be
deductible when such market discount is included in income upon receipt of a
principal distribution on, or upon the sale of, the REMIC Regular Certificate.
The Code requires that information necessary to compute accruals of market
discount be reported periodically to the Internal Revenue Service and to certain
categories of holders of REMIC Regular Certificates.

     Notwithstanding the above rules, market discount on a REMIC Regular
Certificate will be considered to be zero if such discount is less than 0.25% of
the remaining stated redemption price at maturity of such REMIC Regular
Certificate multiplied by its weighted average remaining life.  Weighted average
remaining life presumably is 

                                      -82-
<PAGE>
 
calculated in a manner similar to weighted average life (described above under
"Current Income on REMIC Regular Certificates-Original Issue Discount"), taking
into account distributions (including prepayments) prior to the date of
acquisition of such REMIC Regular Certificate by the subsequent purchaser. If
market discount on a REMIC Regular Certificate is treated as zero under this
rule, the actual amount of such discount must be allocated to the remaining
principal distributions on the REMIC Regular Certificate, and when each such
distribution is made, gain equal to the discount, if any, allocated to the
distribution will be recognized.

     Election to Treat All Interest Under the Constant Yield Rules.  The OID
Regulations provide that all holders may elect to include in gross income all
interest that accrues on a debt instrument issued after April 4, 1994 by using
the constant yield method.  For purposes of this election, interest includes
stated interest, original issue discount, and market discount, as adjusted to
account for any premium.  Holders should consult their own tax advisors
regarding the availability or advisability of such an election.

     Sales of REMIC Regular Certificates.  If a REMIC Regular Certificate is
sold, the seller will recognize gain or loss equal to the difference between the
amount realized on the sale and its adjusted basis in the REMIC Regular
Certificate.  A holder's adjusted basis in a REMIC Regular Certificate generally
equals the cost of the REMIC Regular Certificate to the holder, increased by
income reported by the holder with respect to the REMIC Regular Certificate and
reduced (but not below zero) by distributions on the REMIC Regular Certificate
received by the holder and by amortized premium.  Except as indicated in the
next two paragraphs, any such gain or loss generally will be capital gain or
loss provided the REMIC Regular Certificate is held as a capital asset.

     Gain from the sale of a REMIC Regular Certificate that might otherwise be
capital gain will be treated as ordinary income to the extent that such gain
does not exceed the excess, if any, of (i) the amount that would have been
includible in the seller's income with respect to the REMIC Regular Certificate
had income accrued thereon at a rate equal to 110% of "the applicable Federal
rate" (generally, an average of current yields on Treasury securities),
determined as of the date of purchase of the REMIC Regular Certificate, over
(ii) the amount actually includible in the seller's income.  In addition, gain
recognized on the sale of a REMIC Regular Certificate by a seller who purchased
the REMIC Regular Certificate at a market discount would be taxable as ordinary
income in an amount not exceeding the portion of such discount that accrued
during the period the REMIC Regular Certificate was held by such seller, reduced
by any market discount includible in income under the rules described above
under "Current Income on REMIC Regular Certificates--Market Discount."

     REMIC Regular Certificates will be "evidences of indebtedness" within the
meaning of Section 582(c)(1) of the Code, so that gain or loss recognized from a
sale of a REMIC Regular Certificate by a bank or other financial institution to
which such section applies would be ordinary income or loss.

     Termination.  The REMIC will terminate shortly following the REMIC's
receipt of the final payment in respect of the Mortgage Assets.  The last
distribution on a REMIC Regular Certificate should be treated as a payment in
full retirement of a debt instrument.

TAX TREATMENT OF YIELD SUPPLEMENT AGREEMENTS

     Whether a REMIC Regular Certificateholder of a series will have a separate
contractual right to payments under a Yield Supplement Agreement, and the tax
treatment of such payments, if any, will be addressed in the related Prospectus
Supplement.

REMIC RESIDUAL CERTIFICATES

     Because the REMIC Residual Certificates will be treated as "residual
interests" in the REMIC, each holder of a REMIC Residual Certificate will be
required to take into account its daily portion of the taxable income or net
loss of the REMIC for each day during the calendar year on which it holds its
REMIC Residual Certificate.  The daily portion is determined by allocating to
each day in a calendar quarter a ratable portion of the taxable income or net
loss of the REMIC for that quarter and allocating such daily amounts among the
holders on such day in proportion to their holdings.  All income or loss of the
REMIC taken into account by a REMIC Residual Certificateholder must be treated

                                      -83-
<PAGE>
 
as ordinary income or loss as the case may be.  Income from residual interests
is "portfolio income" which cannot be offset by "passive activity losses" in the
hands of individuals or other persons subject to the passive loss rules.  The
Code also provides that all residual interests must be issued on the REMIC's
startup day and designated as such.  For this purpose, "startup day" means the
day on which the REMIC issues all of its regular and residual interests, and
under the REMIC Regulations may, in the case of a REMIC to which property is
contributed over a period of up to ten consecutive days, be any day designated
by the REMIC within such period.

     The taxable income of the REMIC, for purposes of determining the amounts
taken into account by holders of REMIC Residual Certificates, is determined in
the same manner as in the case of an individual, with certain exceptions.  The
accrual method of accounting must be used and the taxable year of the REMIC must
be the calendar year.  The basis of property contributed to the REMIC in
exchange for regular or residual interests is its fair market value immediately
after the transfer.  The REMIC Regulations determine the fair market value of
the contributed property by deeming it equal to the aggregate issue prices of
all regular and residual interests in the REMIC.

     A REMIC Regular Certificate will be considered indebtedness of the REMIC.
Market discount on any of the Mortgage Assets held by the REMIC must be included
in the income of the REMIC as it accrues, rather than being included in income
only upon sale of the Mortgage Assets or as principal on the Mortgage Assets is
paid.  The REMIC is not entitled to any personal exemptions or to deductions for
taxes paid to foreign countries and U.S. possessions, charitable contributions
or net operating losses, or to certain other deductions to which individuals are
generally entitled.  Income or loss in connection with a "prohibited
transaction" is disregarded.  See "Prohibited Transactions."

     As previously discussed, the timing of recognition of negative original
issue discount, if any, on a REMIC Regular Certificate is uncertain.  As a
result, the timing of recognition of the REMIC taxable income related to a REMIC
Residual Certificate is also uncertain.  Although Federal Tax Counsel is unable
to opine as to this matter, the related REMIC taxable income may be recognized
when the adjusted issue price of such REMIC Regular Certificate would exceed the
maximum amount of future payments with respect to such REMIC Regular
Certificate.  It is unclear whether the Prepayment Assumption is taken into
account for this purpose.

     A REMIC Residual Certificate has a tax basis in its holder's hands that is
distinct from the REMIC's basis in its assets.  The tax basis of a REMIC
Residual Certificate in its holder's hands will be its cost (i.e., the purchase
price of the REMIC Residual Certificate), and will be reduced (but not below
zero) by the holder's share of cash distributions and losses and increased by
its share of taxable income from the REMIC.

     If, in any year, cash distributions to a holder of a REMIC Residual
Certificate exceed its share of the REMIC's taxable income, the excess will
constitute a return of capital to the extent of the holder's basis in its REMIC
Residual Certificate. A return of capital is not treated as income for federal
income tax purposes, but will reduce the tax basis of the holder in its REMIC
Residual Certificate (but not below zero).  If a REMIC Residual Certificate's
basis is reduced to zero, any cash distributions with respect to that REMIC
Residual Certificate in any taxable year in excess of its share of the REMIC's
income would be taxable to the holder as gain on the sale or exchange of its
interest in the REMIC.

     The losses of the REMIC taken into account by a holder of a REMIC Residual
Certificate in any quarter may not exceed the holder's basis in its REMIC
Residual Certificate.  Any excess losses may be carried forward indefinitely to
future quarters subject to the same limitation.



     There is no REMIC counterpart to the partnership election under Code
Section 754 to increase or decrease the partnership's basis in its assets by
reference to the adjusted basis to subsequent partners of their partnership
interest.  Consequently, a subsequent purchaser of a REMIC Residual Certificate
at a premium will not be able to use the premium to reduce his share of the
REMIC's taxable income.

     Mismatching of Income and Deductions; Excess Inclusions.  The taxable
income recognized by the holder of a REMIC Residual Certificate in any taxable
year will be affected by, among other factors, the relationship between the
timing of recognition of interest and discount income (or deductions for
amortization of premium) with respect to Mortgage Assets, on the one hand, and
the timing of deductions for interest (including original issue discount) on the

                                      -84-
<PAGE>
 
REMIC Regular Certificates, on the other.  In the case of multiple classes of
REMIC Regular Certificates issued at different yields, and having different
weighted average lives, taxable income recognized by the holders of REMIC
Residual Certificates may be greater than cash flow in earlier years of the
REMIC (with a corresponding taxable loss or less taxable income than cash flow
in later years).  This may result from the fact that interest expense
deductions, expressed as a percentage of the outstanding principal amount of the
REMIC Regular Certificates, will increase over time as the shorter term, lower
yielding classes of REMIC Regular Certificates are paid, whereas interest income
from the Mortgage Assets may not increase over time as a percentage of the
outstanding principal amount of the Mortgage Assets.

     In the case of Tiered REMICs, the OID Regulations provide that the regular
interests in the REMIC which directly owns the Mortgage Assets (the "Lower Tier
REMIC") will be treated as a single debt instrument for purposes of the original
issue discount provisions.  Therefore, the Trust will calculate the taxable
income of Tiered REMICs by treating the Lower Tier REMIC regular interests as a
single debt instrument.

     Any "excess inclusions" with respect to a REMIC Residual Certificate will
be subject to certain special rules.  The excess inclusions with respect to a
REMIC Residual Certificate are equal to the excess, if any, of its share of
REMIC taxable income for the quarterly period over the sum of the daily accruals
for such quarterly period.  The daily accrual for any day on which the REMIC
Residual Certificate is held is determined by allocating to each day in a
quarter its allocable share of the product of (A) 120% of the long-term
applicable Federal rate (for quarterly compounding) that would have applied to
the REMIC Residual Certificates (if they were debt instruments) on the closing
date under Code Section 1274(d)(1) and (B) the adjusted issue price of such
REMIC Residual Certificates at the beginning of a quarterly period.  For this
purpose, the adjusted issue price of such REMIC Residual Certificate at the
beginning of a quarterly period is the issue price of such Certificates plus the
amount of the daily accruals of REMIC taxable income for all prior quarters,
decreased by any distributions made with respect to such Certificates prior to
the beginning of such quarterly period.

     The excess inclusions of a REMIC Residual Certificate may not be offset by
other deductions, including net operating loss carryforwards, on a holder's
return.

     Recently enacted provisions governing the relationship between excess
inclusions and the alternative minimum tax provide that (i) the alternative
minimum taxable income of a taxpayer is based on the taxpayer's regular taxable
income computed without regard to the rule that taxable income cannot be less
than the amount of excess inclusions, (ii) the alternative minimum taxable
income of a taxpayer for a taxable year cannot be less than the amount of excess
inclusions for that year, and (iii) the amount of any alternative minimum tax
net operating loss is computed without regard to any excess inclusions.  While
these provisions are generally effective for tax years beginning after December
31, 1986, a taxpayer may elect to have these provisions apply only with respect
to tax years beginning after August 20, 1996.

     If the holder of a REMIC Residual Certificate is an organization subject to
the tax on unrelated business income imposed by Code Section 511, the excess
inclusions will be treated as unrelated business taxable income of such holder
for purposes of Code Section 511.  In addition, the Code provides that under
Treasury regulations, if a real estate investment trust ("REIT") owns a REMIC
Residual Certificate, to the extent excess inclusions of the REIT exceed its
real estate investment trust taxable income (excluding net capital gains), the
excess inclusions would be allocated among the shareholders of the REIT in
proportion to the dividends received by the shareholders from the REIT.  Excess
inclusions derived by regulated investment companies ("RICs"), common trust
funds, and subchapter T cooperatives must be allocated to the shareholders of
such entities using rules similar to those applicable to REITs.  The Internal
Revenue Service has not yet adopted or proposed such regulations as to REITs,
RICs, or similar entities.  A life insurance company cannot adjust its reserve
with respect to variable contracts to the extent of any excess inclusion, except
as provided in regulations.

     The Internal Revenue Service has authority to promulgate regulations
providing that if the aggregate value of the REMIC Residual Certificates is not
considered to be "significant," then the entire share of REMIC taxable income of
a holder of a REMIC Residual Certificate may be treated as excess inclusions
subject to the foregoing limitations.  This authority has not been exercised to
date.

                                      -85-
<PAGE>
 
     The REMIC is subject to tax at a rate of 100 percent on any net income it
derives from "prohibited transactions."  In general, "prohibited transaction"
means the disposition of a Mortgage Asset other than pursuant to specified
exceptions, the receipt of income as compensation for services, the receipt of
income from a source other than a Mortgage Loan or certain other permitted
investments, or gain from the disposition of an asset representing a temporary
investment of payments on the Mortgage Assets pending distribution on the REMIC
Certificates.  In addition, a tax is imposed on the REMIC equal to 100 percent
of the value of certain property contributed to the REMIC after its "startup
day."  No REMIC in which interests are offered hereunder will accept
contributions that would cause it to be subject to such tax.  This provision
will not affect the REMIC's ability to accept substitute Mortgage Loans or to
sell defective Mortgage Loans in accordance with the Agreement.

     A REMIC is subject to a tax (deductible from its income) on any "net income
from foreclosure property" (determined in accordance with Section 857(b)(4)(B)
of the Code as if the REMIC were a REIT).

     Any tax described in the two preceding paragraphs that may be imposed on
the Trust initially would be borne by the REMIC Residual Certificates in the
related REMIC rather than by the REMIC Regular Certificateholders, unless
otherwise specified in the Prospectus Supplement.

     Dealers' Ability to Mark-to-Market REMIC Residual Certificates.  Treasury
regulations provide that all REMIC Residual Certificates acquired on or after
January 4, 1995, and similar interests or arrangements acquired on or after
January 4, 1995 that are determined by the Commissioner to have substantially
the same economic effect as a REMIC Residual Certificate, are not securities and
cannot be marked to market pursuant to Section 475 of the Code.

TRANSFERS OF REMIC RESIDUAL CERTIFICATES

     Tax on Disposition of REMIC Residual Certificates.  The sale of a REMIC
Residual Certificate by a holder will result in gain or loss equal to the
difference between the amount realized on the sale and the adjusted basis of the
REMIC Residual Certificate.

     If the seller of a REMIC Residual Certificate held the REMIC Residual
Certificate as a capital asset, the gain or loss generally will be capital gain
or loss.  However, under Code Section 582(c), the sale of a REMIC Residual
Certificate by certain banks and other financial institutions will be considered
a sale of property other than a capital asset, resulting in ordinary income or
loss.  Although Federal Tax Counsel is unable to opine with respect to the tax
treatment of a REMIC Residual Certificate that has unrecovered basis after all
funds of the Trust have been distributed, the holder may be entitled to claim a
loss in the amount of the unrecovered basis.

     The Code provides that, except as provided in Treasury regulations (which
have not yet been issued), if a holder sells a REMIC Residual Certificate and
acquires the same or other REMIC Residual Certificates, residual interests in
another REMIC, or any similar interests in a "taxable mortgage pool" (as defined
in Section 7701(i) of the Code) during the period beginning six months before,
and ending six months after, the date of such sale, such sale will be subject to
the "wash sale" rules of Section 1091 of the Code.  In that event, any loss
realized by the seller on the sale generally will not be currently deductible.

     A tax is imposed on the transfer of any residual interest in a REMIC to a
"disqualified organization."  The tax is imposed on the transferor, or, where
the transfer is made through an agent of the disqualified organization, on the
agent.  "Disqualified organizations" include for this purpose the United States,
any State or political subdivision thereof, any foreign government, any
international organization or agency or instrumentality of the foregoing (with
an exception for certain taxable instrumentalities of the United States, of a
State or of a political subdivision thereof), any rural electrical and telephone
cooperative, and any tax-exempt entity (other than certain farmers'
cooperatives) not subject to the tax on unrelated business income.

     The amount of tax to be paid by the transferor on a transfer to a
disqualified organization is equal to the present value of the total anticipated
excess inclusions with respect to the interest transferred for periods after
such transfer multiplied by the highest corporate rate of tax.  The transferor
(or agent, as the case may be) will be relieved of 

                                      -86-
<PAGE>
 
liability so long as the transferee furnishes an affidavit that it is not a
disqualified organization and the transferor or agent does not have actual
knowledge that the affidavit is false. Under the REMIC Regulations, an affidavit
will be sufficient if the transferee furnishes (A) a social security number, and
states under penalties of perjury that the social security number is that of the
transferee, or (B) a statement under penalties of perjury that it is not a
disqualified organization.

     Treatment of Payments to a Transferee in Consideration of Transfer of a
REMIC Residual Certificate.  The federal income tax consequences of any
consideration paid to a transferee on a transfer of an interest in a REMIC
Residual Certificate are unclear and Federal Tax Counsel is unable to opine with
respect to this issue.  The preamble to the REMIC Regulations indicates that the
Internal Revenue Service is considering the tax treatment of these types of
residual interests.  A transferee of such an interest should consult its own tax
advisors.

     Restrictions on Transfer; Holding by Pass-Through Entities.  An entity
cannot qualify as a REMIC absent reasonable arrangements designed to ensure that
(1) residual interests in such entity are not held by disqualified organizations
and (2) information necessary to calculate the tax due on transfers to
disqualified organizations (i.e., a computation of the present value of the
excess inclusions) is made available by the REMIC.  The governing instruments of
a Trust will contain provisions designed to ensure the foregoing, and any
transferee of a REMIC Residual Certificate must execute and deliver an affidavit
stating that neither the transferee nor any person for whose account such
transferee is acquiring the REMIC Residual Certificate is a disqualified
organization.  In addition, as to the requirement that reasonable arrangements
be made to ensure that disqualified organizations do not hold a residual
interest in the REMIC, the REMIC Regulations require that notice of the
prohibition be provided either through a legend on the certificate that
evidences ownership, or through a conspicuous statement in the prospectus or
other offering document used to offer the residual interest for sale.  As to the
requirement that sufficient information be made available to calculate the tax
on transfers to disqualified organizations (or the tax, discussed below, on
pass-through entities, interests in which are held by disqualified
organizations), the REMIC Regulations further require that such information also
be provided to the Internal Revenue Service.

     A tax is imposed on "pass-through entities" holding residual interests
where a disqualified organization is a record holder of an interest in the pass-
through entity.  "Pass-through entity" is defined for this purpose to include
RICs, REITs, common trust funds, partnerships, trusts, estates and subchapter T
cooperatives.  Except as provided in regulations, nominees holding interests in
a "pass-through entity" for another person will also be treated as "pass-through
entities" for this purpose.  The tax is equal to the amount of excess inclusions
allocable to the disqualified organization for the taxable year multiplied by
the highest corporate rate of tax, and is deductible by the "pass-through
entity" against the gross amount of ordinary income of the entity.



     The Agreement provides that any attempted transfer of a beneficial or
record interest in a REMIC Residual Certificate will be null and void unless the
proposed transferee provides to the Trustee an affidavit that such transferee is
not a disqualified organization.

     Legislation has been introduced which would provide that partners of
certain partnerships having a large number of partners will be treated as
disqualified organizations for purposes of the tax imposed on pass-through
entities if such partnerships hold residual interests in a REMIC.  When
applicable, the legislation would disallow 70 percent of a large partnership's
miscellaneous itemized deductions, including deductions for servicing and
guaranty fees and any expenses of the REMIC, although the remaining deductions
would not be subject to the 2 percent floor applicable to individual partners.
See "Deductibility of Trust Expenses" below.  No prediction can be made
regarding whether such legislation will be enacted.

     The REMIC Regulations provide that a transfer of a "noneconomic residual
interest" will be disregarded for all federal income tax purposes unless
impeding the assessment or collection of tax was not a significant purpose of
the transfer.  A residual interest will be treated as a "noneconomic residual
interest" unless, at the time of the transfer (1) the present value of the
expected future distributions on the residual interest at least equals the
product of (x) the present value of all anticipated excess inclusions with
respect to the residual interest and (y) the highest corporate tax rate,
currently 35 percent, and (2) the transferor reasonably expects that for each
anticipated excess inclusion, the transferee will receive distributions from the
REMIC, at or after the time at which taxes on such excess inclusion 

                                      -87-
<PAGE>
 
accrue, sufficient to pay the taxes thereon. A significant purpose to impede the
assessment or collection of tax exists if the transferor, at the time of the
transfer, either knew or should have known (had "improper knowledge") that the
transferee would be unwilling or unable to pay taxes due on its share of the
taxable income of the REMIC. A transferor will be presumed not to have improper
knowledge if (i) the transferor conducts, at the time of the transfer, a
reasonable investigation of the financial condition of the transferee and, as a
result of the investigation, the transferor finds that the transferee has
historically paid its debts as they came due and finds no significant evidence
to indicate that the transferee will not continue to pay its debts as they come
due in the future, and (ii) the transferee represents to the transferor that (A)
the transferee understands that it might incur tax liabilities in excess of any
cash received with respect to the residual interest and (B) the transferee
intends to pay the taxes associated with owning the residual interest as they
come due. A different formulation of this rule applies to transfers of REMIC
Residual Certificates by or to foreign transferees. See "Foreign Investors"
below.

DEDUCTIBILITY OF TRUST EXPENSES

     A holder that is an individual, estate or trust will be subject to the
limitation with respect to certain itemized deductions described in Code Section
67, to the extent that such deductions, in the aggregate, do not exceed two
percent of the holder's adjusted gross income, and such holder may not be able
to deduct such fees and expenses to any extent in computing such holder's
alternative minimum tax liability.  In addition, the amount of itemized
deductions otherwise allowable for the taxable year for an individual whose
adjusted gross income exceeds the applicable amount (which amount will be
adjusted for inflation for taxable years beginning after 1990) will be reduced
by the lesser of (i) 3 percent of the excess of adjusted gross income over the
applicable amount, or (ii) 80 percent of the amount of itemized deductions
otherwise allowable for such taxable year.  Such deductions will include
servicing, guarantee, and administrative fees paid to the servicer of the
Mortgage Loans.  These deductions will be allocated entirely to the holders of
the REMIC Residual Certificates in the case of REMIC Trusts with multiple
classes of REMIC Regular Certificates that do not pay their principal amounts
ratably.  As a result, the REMIC will report additional taxable income to
holders of REMIC Residual Certificates in an amount equal to their allocable
share of such deductions, and individuals, estates, or trusts holding an
interest in such REMIC Residual Certificates may have taxable income in excess
of the cash received.  In the case of a "single-class REMIC," the expenses will
be allocated, under Treasury regulations, among the holders of the REMIC Regular
Certificates and the REMIC Residual Certificates on a daily basis in proportion
to the relative amounts of income accruing to each Certificateholder on that
day.  In the case of a holder of a REMIC Regular Certificate who is an
individual or a "pass-through interest holder" (including certain pass-through
entities, but not including real estate investment trusts), the deductibility of
such expenses will be subject to the limitations described above.  The reduction
or disallowance of these deductions may have a significant impact on the yield
of REMIC Regular Certificates to such a holder.  In general terms, a single-
class REMIC is one that either (i) would qualify, under existing Treasury
regulations, as a grantor trust if it were not a REMIC (treating all interests
as ownership interests, even if they would be classified as debt for federal
income tax purposes) or (ii) is similar to such a trust and which is structured
with the principal purpose of avoiding the single- class REMIC rules.

FOREIGN INVESTORS

     REMIC Regular Certificates.  Except as discussed below, a holder of a REMIC
Regular Certificate who is not a "United States person" (as defined below)
generally will not be subject to United States income or withholding tax in
respect of a distribution on a REMIC Regular Certificate, provided that (i) the
holder complies to the extent necessary with certain identification
requirements, including timely delivery of a statement, signed by the holder of
the REMIC Regular Certificate under penalties of perjury, certifying that the
holder of the REMIC Regular Certificate is not a United States person and
providing the name and address of the holder, (ii) the holder is not a "10-
percent shareholder" within the meaning of Code Section 871(h)(3)(B), which
could be interpreted to apply to a holder of a REMIC Regular Certificate who
holds a direct or indirect 10 percent interest in the REMIC Residual
Certificates, (iii) the holder is not a "controlled foreign corporation" (as
defined in the Code) related to the REMIC or related to a 10 percent holder of a
residual interest in the REMIC, and (iv) the holder is not engaged in a United
States trade or business, or otherwise subject to federal income tax as a result
of any direct or indirect connection to the United States other than through its
ownership of a REMIC Regular Certificate.  For these purposes, the term "United
States person" means (a) a citizen or resident of the United States, (b) a
corporation, partnership or other entity created or organized in or under the
laws of the United States or any political subdivision thereof, (c) an estate
whose income is includible 

                                      -88-
<PAGE>
 
in gross income for United States federal income taxation regardless of its
source, and (d) a trust for which one or more United States fiduciaries have the
authority to control all substantial decisions and for which a court of the
United States can exercise primary supervision over the trust's administration.
For years beginning before January 1, 1997, the term "United States person"
shall include a trust whose income is includible in gross income for United
States federal income taxation regardless of source, in lieu of trusts described
in (d), above, unless the trust elects to have its United States status
determined under the criteria set forth in (d) above for tax years ending after
August 20, 1996. Proposed Treasury regulations, which would be effective with
respect to payments made after December 31, 1997 if adopted in their current
form, would provide alternative certification requirements and means by which a
holder of REMIC Certificates could claim the exemption from federal income and
withholding tax.

     REMIC Residual Certificates.  The Conference Report to the Tax Reform Act
of 1986 states that amounts paid to foreign persons with respect to residual
interests should be considered interest for purposes of the withholding rules.
Interest paid to a foreign person which is not effectively connected with a
trade or business of the foreign person in the United States is subject to a 30%
withholding tax.  The withholding tax on interest does not apply, however, to
"portfolio interest" (if certain certifications as to beneficial ownership are
made, as discussed above under "Foreign Investors--Regular Certificates") or to
the extent a tax treaty reduces or eliminates the tax.  Treasury regulations
provide that amounts paid with respect to residual interests qualify as
portfolio interest only if interest on the qualified mortgages held by the REMIC
qualifies as portfolio interest.  Generally, interest on Mortgage Loans held by
a Trust will not qualify as portfolio interest, although interest on the Private
Mortgage-Backed Securities, other pass-through certificates, or REMIC regular
interests held by a Trust may qualify.  In any case, a holder of a REMIC
Residual Certificate will not be entitled to the portfolio interest exception
from the 30% withholding tax (or to any treaty exemption or rate reduction) for
that portion of a payment that constitutes excess inclusions.  Generally, the
withholding tax will be imposed when REMIC gross income is paid or distributed
to the holder of a residual interest or there is a disposition of the residual
interest.

     The REMIC Regulations provide that a transfer of a REMIC Residual
Certificate to a foreign transferee will be disregarded for all federal income
tax purposes if the transfer has "tax avoidance potential."  A transfer to a
foreign transferee will be considered to have tax avoidance potential unless at
the time of the transfer, the transferor reasonably expects that (1) the future
distributions on the REMIC Residual Certificate will equal at least 30 percent
of the anticipated excess inclusions and (2) such amounts will be distributed at
or after the time at which the excess inclusion accrues, but not later than the
close of the calendar year following the calendar year of accrual.  A safe
harbor in the REMIC Regulations provides that the reasonable expectation
requirement will be satisfied if the above test would be met at all assumed
prepayment rates for the Mortgage Assets from 50 percent of the Prepayment
Assumption to 200 percent of the Prepayment Assumption.  A transfer by a foreign
transferor to a domestic transferee will likewise be disregarded under the REMIC
Regulations if the transfer would have the effect of allowing the foreign
transferor to avoid the tax on accrued excess inclusions.

     Gain on Transfers of Certificates.  A Certificateholder that is a
nonresident alien or foreign corporation will not be subject to United States
federal income tax on gain realized on the sale, exchange, or redemption of a
REMIC Certificate, provided that (i) such gain is not effectively connected with
a trade or business carried on by the Certificateholder in the United States,
(ii) in the case of a Certificateholder that is an individual, such
Certificateholder is not present in the United States for 183 days or more
during the taxable year in which such sale, exchange or redemption occurs and
(iii) in the case of gain representing accrued interest, the Certificateholder
complies to the extent necessary with certain identification requirements,
including timely delivery of a statement, signed by the Certificateholder under
penalties of perjury, certifying that such Certificateholder is not a United
States person and providing the name and address of such holder.

BACKUP WITHHOLDING

     Distributions made on the REMIC Certificates and proceeds from the sale of
REMIC Certificates to or through certain brokers may be subject to a "backup"
withholding tax of 31 percent of "reportable payments" (including interest
accruals, original issue discount, and, under certain circumstances,
distributions in reduction of principal amount) unless, in general, the holder
of the REMIC Certificate complies with certain procedures or is an 

                                      -89-
<PAGE>
 
exempt recipient. Any amounts so withheld from distributions on the REMIC
Certificates would be refunded by the Internal Revenue Service or allowed as a
credit against the holder's federal income tax.

REMIC ADMINISTRATIVE MATTERS

     The federal information returns for a Trust (Form 1066 and Schedules Q
thereto) must be filed as if the Trust were a partnership for federal income tax
purposes.  Information on Schedule Q must be provided to holders of REMIC
Residual Certificates with respect to every calendar quarter.  Each holder of a
REMIC Residual Certificate will be required to treat items on its federal income
tax returns consistently with their treatment on the Trust's information returns
unless the holder either files a statement identifying the inconsistency or
establishes that the inconsistency resulted from an incorrect schedule received
from the Trust.  The Trust also will be subject to the procedural and
administrative rules of the Code applicable to partnerships, including the
determination of any adjustments to, among other things, items of REMIC taxable
income by the Internal Revenue Service.  (Treasury regulations exempt from
certain of these procedural rules REMICs having no more than one residual
interest holder.)  Holders of REMIC Residual Certificates will have certain
rights and obligations with respect to any administrative or judicial
proceedings involving the Internal Revenue Service.  Under the Code and
Regulations, a REMIC generally is required to designate a tax matters person.
Generally, subject to various limitations, the tax matters person has authority
to act on behalf of the REMIC and the holders of the REMIC Residual Certificates
in connection with administrative determinations and judicial review respecting
returns of taxable income of the REMIC.

     Unless otherwise indicated in the Prospectus Supplement, and to the extent
allowable, the Representative or its designee will act as the tax matters person
for each REMIC.  Each holder of a REMIC Residual Certificate, by the acceptance
of its interest in the REMIC Residual Certificate, agrees that the
Representative or its designee will act as the holder's fiduciary in the
performance of any duties required of the holder in the event that the holder is
the tax matters person.

NON-REMIC CERTIFICATES ISSUED BY A GRANTOR TRUST

     The discussion under this heading applies only to a series of Certificates
with respect to which a REMIC election is not made and for which the Trust is
classified as a grantor trust for federal income tax purposes.

     Tax Status of the Trust.  Upon the issuance of each series of Non-REMIC
Certificates, Federal Tax Counsel, will deliver its opinion to the effect that,
under then current law, assuming compliance with the Agreement, the related
Trust will be classified for federal income tax purposes as a grantor trust and
not as an association taxable as a corporation or a taxable mortgage pool.
Accordingly, each holder of a Non-REMIC Certificate will be treated for federal
income tax purposes as the owner of an undivided interest in the Mortgage Assets
included in the Trust.  As further described below, each holder of a Non-REMIC
Certificate therefore must report on its federal income tax return the gross
income from the portion of the Mortgage Assets that is allocable to such Non-
REMIC Certificate and may deduct the portion of the expenses incurred by the
Trust that is allocable to such Non-REMIC Certificate, at the same time and to
the same extent as such items would be reported by such holder if it had
purchased and held directly such interest in the Mortgage Assets and received
directly its share of the payments on the Mortgage Assets and incurred directly
its share of expenses incurred by the Trust when those amounts are received or
incurred by the Trust.

     A holder of a Non-REMIC Certificate that is an individual, estate, or trust
will be allowed deductions for such expenses only to the extent that the sum of
those expenses and the holder's other miscellaneous itemized deductions exceeds
two percent of such holder's adjusted gross income.  In addition, the amount of
itemized deductions otherwise allowable for the taxable year for an individual
whose adjusted gross income exceeds the "applicable amount" ($100,000 (or
$50,000 in the case of a separate return by a married individual), adjusted for
changes in the cost of living subsequent to 1990) will be reduced by the lesser
of (i) 3 percent of the excess of adjusted gross income over the applicable
amount, or (ii) 80 percent of the amount of itemized deductions otherwise
allowable for such taxable year.  Moreover, a holder of a Non-REMIC Certificate
that is not a corporation cannot deduct such expenses for purposes of the
alternative minimum tax (if applicable).  Such deductions will include
servicing, guarantee and administrative fees paid to the servicer of the
Mortgage Loans.  As a result, individuals, estates, or trusts holding Non-REMIC
Certificates may have taxable income in excess of the cash received.

                                      -90-
<PAGE>
 
     Status of the Non-REMIC Certificates.  The Non-REMIC Certificates generally
will be "real estate assets" for purposes of Section 856(c)(5)(A) of the Code
and "loans . . . secured by an interest in real property" within the meaning of
Section 7701(a)(19)(C)(v) of the Code, and interest income on the Non-REMIC
Certificates generally will be "interest on obligations secured by mortgages on
real property" within the meaning of Section 856(c)(3)(B) of the Code.  However,
the Non-REMIC Certificates may not be qualifying assets under any of the
foregoing sections of the Code to the extent that the Trust's assets include
Buydown Funds, amounts in a Reserve Account, or payments on mortgages held
pending distribution to Certificateholders.  Further, the Non-REMIC Certificates
may not be "real estate assets" to the extent loans held by the trust are not
secured by real property, and may not be "loans . . . secured by an interest in
real property" to the extent loans held by the trust are not secured by
residential real property or real property used primarily for church purposes.
In addition, to the extent that the principal amount of a loan exceeds the value
of the property securing the loan, it is unclear and Federal Tax Counsel is
unable to opine whether the loan will be a qualifying asset.  The Non-REMIC
Certificates should not be "residential loans made by the taxpayer" for purposes
of the residential loan requirement of Section 593(g)(4)(B) of the Code.

     Taxation of Non-REMIC Certificates Under Stripped Bond Rules.  The federal
income tax treatment of the Non-REMIC Certificates will depend on whether they
are subject to the rules of section 1286 of the Code (the "stripped bond
rules").  The Non-REMIC Certificates will be subject to those rules if stripped
interest-only Certificates are issued.  In addition, whether or not stripped
interest-only Certificates are issued, the Internal Revenue Service may contend
that the stripped bond rules apply on the ground that the Servicer's servicing
fee, or other amounts, if any, paid to (or retained by) the Servicer or its
affiliates, as specified in the applicable Prospectus Supplement, represent
greater than an arm's length consideration for servicing the Mortgage Loans and
should be characterized for federal income tax purposes as an ownership interest
in the Mortgage Loans.  The Internal Revenue Service has taken the position in
Revenue Ruling 91-46 that retained interest in excess of reasonable compensation
for servicing is treated as a "stripped coupon" under the rules of Code Section
1286.



     If interest retained for the Servicer's servicing fee or other interest is
treated as a "stripped coupon," the Non-REMIC Certificates will either be
subject to the original issue discount rules or the market discount rules.  A
holder of a Non-REMIC Certificate will account for any discount on the Non-REMIC
Certificate (other than an interest treated as a "stripped coupon") as market
discount rather than original issue discount if either (i) the amount of
original issue discount with respect to the Non-REMIC Certificate was treated as
zero under the original issue discount de minimis rule when the Non-REMIC
Certificate was stripped or (ii) no more than 100 basis points (including any
amount of servicing in excess of reasonable servicing) is stripped off from the
Mortgage Loans.  If neither of the above exceptions applies, the original issue
discount rules will apply to the Non-REMIC Certificates.

     If the original issue discount rules apply, the holder of a Non-REMIC
Certificate (whether a cash or accrual method taxpayer) will be required to
report interest income from the Non-REMIC Certificate in each taxable year equal
to the income that accrues on the Non-REMIC Certificate in that year calculated
under a constant yield method based on the yield of the Non-REMIC Certificate
(or, possibly, the yield of each Mortgage Asset underlying such Non-REMIC
Certificate) to such holder.  Such yield would be computed at the rate that, if
used in discounting the holder's share of the payments on the Mortgage Assets,
would cause the present value of those payments to equal the price at which the
holder purchased the Non-REMIC Certificate.  With respect to certain categories
of debt instruments, Section 1272(a)(6) of the Code requires that original issue
discount be accrued based on a prepayment assumption determined in a manner
prescribed by forthcoming regulations.  It is unclear whether such regulations
would apply this rule to the Non-REMIC Certificates, whether Section 1272(a)(6)
might apply to the Non-REMIC Certificates in the absence of such regulations, or
whether the Internal Revenue Service could require use of a reasonable
prepayment assumption based on other tax law principles and Federal Tax Counsel
is unable to opine with respect to these issues.  If required to report interest
income on the Non-REMIC Certificates to the Internal Revenue Service under the
stripped bond rules, it is anticipated that the Trustee will calculate the yield
of the Non-REMIC Certificates based on a representative initial offering price
of the Non-REMIC Certificates and a reasonable assumed rate of prepayment of the
Mortgage Assets (although such yield may differ from the yield to any particular
holder that would be used in calculating the interest income of such holder).
The Prospectus Supplement for each series of Non-REMIC Certificates will
describe the prepayment assumption that will be used for this purpose, but no
representation is made that the Mortgage Assets will prepay at that rate or at
any other rate.

                                      -91-
<PAGE>
 
     In the case of a Non-REMIC Certificate acquired at a price equal to the
principal amount of the Mortgage Assets allocable to the Non-REMIC Certificate,
the use of a reasonable prepayment assumption would not have any significant
effect on the yield used in calculating accruals of interest income.  In the
case, however, of a Non-REMIC Certificate acquired at a discount or premium
(that is, at a price less than or greater than such principal amount,
respectively), the use of a reasonable prepayment assumption would increase or
decrease such yield, and thus accelerate or decelerate the reporting of interest
income, respectively.

     If a Mortgage Loan is prepaid in full, the holder of a Non-REMIC
Certificate acquired at a discount or premium generally will recognize ordinary
income or loss equal to the difference between the portion of the prepaid
principal amount of the Mortgage Loan that is allocable to the Non-REMIC
Certificate and the portion of the adjusted basis of the Non-REMIC Certificate
(see "Sales of Non-REMIC Certificates" below) that is allocable to the Mortgage
Loan.  The method of allocating such basis among the Mortgage Loans may differ
depending on whether a reasonable prepayment assumption is used in calculating
the yield of the Non-REMIC Certificates for purposes of accruing original issue
discount.  It is not clear whether any other adjustments would be required to
reflect differences between the prepayment rate that was assumed in calculating
yield and the actual rate of prepayments.

     Non-REMIC Certificates of certain series ("Variable Rate Non-REMIC
Certificates") may provide for a Pass-Through Rate based on the weighted average
of the interest rates of the Mortgage Assets held by the Trust, which interest
rates may be fixed or variable.  In the case of a Variable Rate Non-REMIC
Certificate that is subject to the original issue discount rules, the daily
portions of original issue discount generally will be calculated under the
principles discussed in "REMIC Regular Certificates-Current Income on REMIC
Regular Certificates--Original Issue Discount--Variable Rate REMIC Regular
Certificates."

     Taxation of Non-REMIC Certificates If Stripped Bond Rules Do Not Apply.  If
the stripped bond rules do not apply to a Non-REMIC Certificate, then the holder
will be required to include in income its share of the interest payments on the
Mortgage Assets in accordance with its tax accounting method.  In addition, if
the holder purchased the Non-REMIC Certificate at a discount or premium, the
holder will be required to account for such discount or premium in the manner
described below.  The treatment of any discount will depend on whether the
discount is original issue discount as defined in the Code and, in the case of
discount other than original issue discount, whether such other discount exceeds
a de minimis amount.  In the case of original issue discount, the holder
(whether a cash or accrual method taxpayer) will be required to report as
additional interest income in each month the portion of such discount that
accrues in that month, calculated based on a constant yield method.  In general
it is not anticipated that the amount of original issue discount to be accrued
in each month, if any, will be significant relative to the interest paid
currently on the Mortgage Assets.  However, original issue discount could arise
with respect to a Mortgage Loan ("ARM") that provides for interest at a rate
equal to the sum of an index of market interest rates and a fixed number.  The
original issue discount for ARMs generally will be determined under the
principles discussed in "REMIC Regular Certificates-Current Income on REMIC
Regular Certificates--Original Issue Discount---Variable Rate REMIC Regular
Certificates."

     If discount other than original issue discount exceeds a de minimis amount
(described below), the holder will also generally be required to include in
income in each month the amount of such discount accrued through such month and
not previously included in income, but limited, with respect to the portion of
such discount allocable to any Mortgage Asset, to the amount of principal on
such Mortgage Asset received by the Trust in that month.  Because the Mortgage
Assets will provide for monthly principal payments, such discount may be
required to be included in income at a rate that is not significantly slower
than the rate at which such discount accrues (and therefore at a rate not
significantly slower than the rate at which such discount would be included in
income if it were original issue discount).  The holder may elect to accrue such
discount under a constant yield method based on the yield of the Non-REMIC
Certificate to such holder.  In the absence of such an election, it may be
necessary to accrue such discount under a more rapid straight-line method.
Under the de minimis rule, market discount with respect to a Non-REMIC
Certificate will be considered to be zero if it is less than the product of (i)
0.25% of the principal amount of the Mortgage Assets allocable to the Non-REMIC
Certificate and (ii) the weighted average life (in complete years) of the
Mortgage Assets remaining at the time of purchase of the Non-REMIC Certificate.

                                      -92-
<PAGE>
 
     If a holder purchases a Non-REMIC Certificate at a premium, such holder may
elect under Section 171 of the Code to amortize the portion of such premium that
is allocable to a Mortgage Loan under a constant yield method based on the yield
of the Mortgage Loan to such holder, provided that such Mortgage Loan was
originated after September 27, 1985.  Premium allocable to a Mortgage Loan
originated on or before that date should be allocated among the principal
payments on the Mortgage Loan and allowed as an ordinary deduction as principal
payments are made or, perhaps, upon termination.

     It is not clear whether the foregoing adjustments for discount or premium
would be made based on the scheduled payments on the Mortgage Loans or taking
account of a reasonable prepayment assumption, and Federal Tax Counsel is unable
to opine on this issue.

     If a Mortgage Loan is prepaid in full, the holder of a Non-REMIC
Certificate acquired at a discount or premium will recognize ordinary income or
loss equal to the difference between the portion of the prepaid principal amount
of the Mortgage Loan that is allocable to the Non-REMIC Certificate and the
portion of the adjusted basis of the Non-REMIC Certificate (see "Sales of Non-
REMIC Certificates" below) that is allocable to the Mortgage Loan.  The method
of allocating such basis among the Mortgage Loans may differ depending on
whether a reasonable prepayment assumption is used in calculating the yield of
the Non-REMIC Certificates for purposes of accruing original issue discount.
Other adjustments might be required to reflect differences between the
prepayment rate that was assumed in accounting for discount or premium and the
actual rate of prepayments.

     Sales of Non-REMIC Certificates.  A holder that sells a Non-REMIC
Certificate will recognize gain or loss equal to the difference between the
amount realized in the sale and its adjusted basis in the Non-REMIC Certificate.
In general, such adjusted basis will equal the holder's cost for the Non-REMIC
Certificate, increased by the amount of any income previously reported with
respect to the Non-REMIC Certificate and decreased by the amount of any losses
previously reported with respect to the Non-REMIC Certificate and the amount of
any distributions received thereon.  Any such gain or loss generally will be
capital gain or loss if the assets underlying the Non-REMIC Certificate were
held as capital assets, except that, for a Non-REMIC Certificate to which the
stripped bond rules do not apply and that was acquired with more than a de
minimis amount of discount other than original issue discount (see "Taxation of
Non-REMIC Certificates if Stripped Bond Rules Do Not Apply" above), such gain
will be treated as ordinary interest income to the extent of the portion of such
discount that accrued during the period in which the seller held the Non-REMIC
Certificate and that was not previously included in income.

     Foreign Investors.  A holder of a Non-REMIC Certificate who is not a
"United States person" (as defined below) and is not subject to federal income
tax as a result of any direct or indirect connection to the United States other
than its ownership of a Non-REMIC Certificate generally will not be subject to
United States income or withholding tax in respect of payments of interest or
original issue discount on a Non-REMIC Certificate to the extent attributable to
Mortgage Loans that were originated after July 18, 1984, provided that the
holder complies to the extent necessary with certain identification requirements
(including delivery of a statement, signed by the holder of the Non-REMIC
Certificate under penalties of perjury, certifying that such holder is not a
United States person and providing the name and address of such holder).
Proposed Treasury Regulations, which would be effective with respect to payments
made after December 31, 1997 if adopted in their current form, would provide
alternative certification requirements and means by which a holder of Non-REMIC
Certificates could claim an exemption from federal income and withholding tax.
Interest or original issue discount on a Non-REMIC Certificate attributable to
Mortgage Loans that were originated prior to July 19, 1984 will be subject to a
30% withholding tax (unless such tax is reduced or eliminated by an applicable
tax treaty).  For these purposes, the term "United States person" means a
citizen or a resident of the United States, a corporation, partnership or other
entity created or organized in, or under the laws of, the United States or any
political subdivision thereof, an estate the income of which is subject to
United States federal income taxation regardless of its source, and a trust for
which one or more United States fiduciaries have the authority to control all
substantial decisions and for which a court of the United States can exercise
primary supervision over the trust's administration.  For years beginning before
January 1, 1997, the term "United States person" shall include a trust whose
income is includible in gross income for United States federal income taxation
regardless of source, in lieu of trusts just described, unless the trust elects
to have its United States status determined under the criteria described in the
previous sentence for tax years ending after August 20, 1996.

                                      -93-
<PAGE>
 
TAXABLE MORTGAGE POOLS

     Effective January 1, 1992, certain entities classified as "taxable mortgage
pools" are subject to corporate level tax on their net income.  A "taxable
mortgage pool" is generally defined as an entity that meets the following
requirements: (i) the entity is not a REMIC (or, after September 1, 1997, a
FASIT) (ii) substantially all of the assets of the entity are debt obligations,
and more than 50 percent of such debt obligations consist of real estate
mortgages (or interests therein), (iii) the entity is the obligor under debt
obligations with two or more maturities, and (iv) payments on the debt
obligations on which the entity is the obligor bear a relationship to the
payments on the debt obligations which the entity holds as assets.  With respect
to requirement (iii), the Code authorizes the Internal Revenue Service to
provide by regulations that equity interests may be treated as debt for purposes
of determining whether there are two or more maturities.  If a Series of Non-
REMIC Certificates were treated as obligations of a taxable mortgage pool, the
Trust would be ineligible to file consolidated returns with any other
corporation and could be liable for corporate tax.  Treasury regulations do not
provide for the recharacterization of equity as debt for purposes of determining
whether an entity has issued debt with two maturities, except in the case of
transactions structured to avoid the taxable mortgage pool rules.


NON-REMIC CERTIFICATES AND NOTES OF A TRUST INTENDED TO BE CHARACTERIZED AS A
PARTNERSHIP

  The discussion under this heading applies only to a series of Certificates and
Notes with respect to which a REMIC election is not made and for which the Trust
is intended to be classified as a partnership for federal income tax purposes.

  Federal Tax Counsel will deliver its opinion for a Trust which is intended to
be a partnership for federal income tax purposes, as specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, generally to the effect that the Trust will not be an
association (or publicly traded partnership) taxable as a corporation for
federal income tax purposes.  This opinion will be based on the assumption that
the terms of the Agreements and related documents will be complied with, such
that an election has not been and will not be made to treat the Trust as an
association taxable as a corporation, and on counsel's conclusion that the
nature of the income of the Trust will exempt it from the rule that certain
publicly traded partnerships are taxable as corporations or  such rule is
otherwise inapplicable to the Trust, so that the Trust will not be characterized
as a publicly traded partnership taxable as a corporation.


  Certain entities classified as "taxable mortgage pools" are subject to
corporate level tax on their net income.  A "taxable mortgage pool" is generally
defined as an entity that meets the following requirements: (i) the entity is
not a REMIC (or, after September 1, 1997, a FASIT), (ii) substantially all of
the assets of the entity are debt obligations, and more than 50 percent of such
debt obligations consists of real estate mortgages (or interests therein), (iii)
the entity is the obligor under debt obligations with two or more maturities,
and (iv) payments on the debt obligations on which the entity is the obligor
bear a relationship to the payments on the debt obligations which the entity
holds as assets. With respect to requirement (iii), the Code authorizes the
Internal Revenue Service to provide by regulations that equity interests may be
treated as debt for purposes of determining whether there are two or more
maturities. If the Trust were treated as a taxable mortgage pool, it would be
ineligible to file consolidated returns with any other corporation and could be
liable for corporate tax. Treasury regulations do not provide for the
recharacterization of equity as debt for purposes of determining whether an
entity has issued debt with two maturities, except in the case of transactions
structured to avoid the taxable mortgage pool rules. Federal Tax Counsel will
deliver its opinion for a Trust which is intended to be a partnership for
federal income tax purposes, as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement,
generally to the effect that the Trust will not be a taxable mortgage pool. This
opinion will be based on the assumption that the terms of the Agreements and
related documents will be complied with, and on counsel's conclusion that either
the number of classes of debt obligations issued be the Trust, or the nature of
the assets held by the Trust, will exempt the Trust from treatment as a taxable
mortgage pool.


  If the Trust were taxable as a corporation for federal income tax purposes,
the Trust would be subject to corporate income tax on its taxable income.  The
Trust's taxable income would include all its income, possibly reduced by its
interest expense on the Notes.  Any such corporate income tax could materially
reduce cash available to make payments on the Notes and distributions on the
Certificates, and Certificateholders could be liable for any such tax that is
unpaid by the Trust.  In additions, all distributions to the Certificateholders
would be taxable as dividends.

                                      -94-
<PAGE>
 
TAX CONSEQUENCES TO HOLDERS OF THE NOTES ISSUED BY A PARTNERSHIP



  Treatment Of The Notes As Indebtedness.  The Trust will agree, and the
Noteholders will agree by their purchase of Notes, to treat the Notes as debt
for federal income tax purposes.  Except as otherwise provided in the related
Prospectus Supplement, Federal Tax Counsel will advise the Representative that
in its opinion the Notes will be classified as debt for federal income tax
purposes.

  Possible Alternative Treatments Of The Notes.  If, contrary to the opinion of
counsel, the IRS successfully asserted that one or more of the Notes did not
represent debt for federal income tax purposes, the Notes might be treated as
equity interests in the Trust.  If so treated, the Trust might be taxable as a
corporation with the adverse consequences described above (and the taxable
corporation would not be able to reduce its taxable income by deductions for
interest expense on Notes recharacterized as equity).  Alternatively, the Trust
might be treated as a publicly traded partnership that would not be taxable as a
corporation because it would meet certain qualifying income tests.  Nonetheless,
treatment of the Notes as equity interests in such a publicly traded partnership
could have adverse tax consequences to certain holders.  For example, income to
foreign holders generally would be subject to United States federal income tax
and United States federal income tax return filing and withholding requirements,
and individual holders might be subject to certain limitations on their ability
to deduct their share of the Trust's expenses.

  Interest Income On The Notes.  The stated interest on the Notes will be
taxable to a Noteholder as ordinary income when received or accrued in
accordance with such Noteholder's method of tax accounting.  It is not
anticipated that the Notes will be issued with original issue discount within
the meaning of Section 1273 of the Code.  A subsequent holder who purchases a
Note at a discount that exceeds a statutorily defined de minimis amount will be
subject to the "market discount" rules of the Code, and a holder who purchases a
Note at a premium will be subject to the premium amortization rules of the Code.

  Sale Or Other Disposition.  If a Noteholder sells a Note, the holder will
recognize gain or loss in an amount equal to the difference between the amount
realized on the sale and the holder's adjusted tax basis in the Note.  The
adjusted tax basis of a Note to a particular Noteholder will equal the holder's
cost for the Note, increased by any original issue discount (if any), market
discount and gain previously included by such Noteholder in income with respect
to the Note and decreased by the amount of bond premium (if any) previously
amortized and by the amount of principal payments previously received by such
Noteholder with respect to such Note.  Subject to the rules of the Code
concerning market discount on the Notes, any such gain or loss generally will be
capital gain or loss if the Note was held as a capital asset.  Capital losses
generally may be deducted only to  the extent the Noteholder has capital gains
for the taxable year, although under certain circumstances non-corporate
Noteholders can deduct losses in excess of available capital gains.

  Foreign Holders.  If interest paid (or accrued) to a Noteholder who is a
nonresident alien, foreign corporation or other non-United States person (a
"foreign person") is not effectively connected with the conduct of a trade or
business within the United States by the foreign person, the interest generally
will be considered "portfolio interest," and generally will not be subject to
United States Federal income tax and withholding tax, if the foreign person (i)
is not actually or constructively a "10 percent shareholder" of the Trust or
the Representative (including a holder of 10% of the outstanding Certificates)
or a  "controlled foreign corporation" with respect to which the Trust or the
Representative is a "related person" within the meaning  of the Code and (ii)
provides the person otherwise required to withhold United States tax with an
appropriate statement, signed under penalties of perjury, certifying that the
beneficial owner of the Note is a foreign person and providing the foreign
person's name and address.  If the information provided in the statement
changes, the foreign person must so inform the person otherwise required to
withhold United States tax within 30 days of such change.  The statement
generally must be provided in the year a payment occurs (prior to such payment)
or in either of the two preceding years.  If a Note is held through a securities
clearing organization or certain other financial institutions, the organization
or institution may provide a signed statement to the withholding agent.
However, in that case, the signed statement must be accompanies by a Form W-8 or
substitute form provided by the foreign person that owns the Note.  If such
interest in not portfolio interest, then it will be subject to United States
federal income and withholding tax at a rate of 30%, unless reduced or
eliminated pursuant to an applicable tax treaty.

                                      -95-
<PAGE>
 
  Any capital gain realized on the sale, redemption, retirement or other taxable
disposition of a Note by a foreign person will be exempt from United States
federal income and withholding tax, provided that (i) the gain is not
effectively connected with the conduct of a trade or business in the United
States by the foreign person and (ii) in the case of an individual foreign
person, the foreign individual is not present in the United States for 183 days
or more in the taxable year.

  If the interest, gain or income on a Note held by a foreign person is
effectively connected with the conduct of a trade or business in the United
States by the foreign person (although exempt from the withholding tax
previously discussed if the holder provides an appropriate statement), the
holder generally will be subject to United States federal income tax on the
interest, gain or income at regular federal income tax rates.  In addition, if
the foreign person is a foreign corporation, it may be subject to a branch
profits tax equal to 30% of its "effectively connected earnings and profits"
within the meaning of the Code for the taxable year, as adjusted for certain
items, unless it qualifies for a lower rate under an applicable tax treaty (as
modified by the branch profits tax rules).

  Proposed Treasury regulations, which would be effective with respect to
payments made after December 31, 1997 if adopted in their current form, would
provide alternative certification requirements and means for obtaining the
exemption from federal income and withholding tax.

  Information Reporting And Backup Withholding.  The Trust will be required to
report annually to the IRS, and to each Noteholder of record, the amount of
interest paid on the Notes (and the amount of interest withheld for federal
income taxes, if any) for each calendar year, except as to exempt holders
(generally, holders that are corporations, tax-exempt organizations, qualified
pension and profit-sharing trusts, individual retirement accounts, or
nonresident aliens who provide certification as to their status as
nonresidents).  Accordingly, each holder (other than exempt holders who are not
subject to the reporting requirements) will be required to provide, under
penalties of perjury, a certificate containing the holder's name, address,
correct federal taxpayer identification number and a statement that the holder
is not subject to backup withholding.  Should a nonexempt Noteholder fail to
provide the required certification, the Trust will be required to withhold 31%
of the amount otherwise payable to the holder, and remit the withheld amount to
the IRS, as a credit against the holder's federal income tax liability.

TAX CONSEQUENCES TO HOLDERS OF  CERTIFICATES ISSUED BY A PARTNERSHIP

  Treatment Of The Issuer As A Partnership.  In the case of a Trust intended to
qualify as a partnership for federal income tax purposes, the Trust and the
Representative will agree, and the Certificateholders will agree by their
purchase of Certificates, to treat the Trust as a partnership for purposes of
United States federal and state income tax, franchise tax and any other tax
measured in whole or in part by income, with the assets of the partnership being
the assets held by the Trust, the partners of the partnership being the
Certificateholders, and the Notes, if any, being debt of the partnership.
However, the proper characterization of the arrangement involving the Trust, the
Certificates, the Notes, and the Master Servicer is not clear because there is
no authority on transactions closely comparable to that contemplated herein.

  A variety of alternative characterizations are possible.  For example, because
the Certificates have certain features characteristic of debt, the Certificates
might be considered debt of the Trust.  Generally, provided the Certificates are
issued at or close to face value, any such characterization should not result in
materially adverse tax consequences to Certificateholders as compared to the
consequences from treatment of the Certificates as equity in a partnership,
described below.  The following discussion assumes that the Certificates
represent equity interests in a partnership.

  Partnership Taxation.  As a partnership, the Trust will not be subject to
federal income tax.  Rather, each Certificateholder will be required to
separately take into account such holder's allocated share of income, gains,
losses, deductions and credits of the Trust.  The Trust's income will consist
primarily of interest and finance charges earned on the Mortgage Loans
(including appropriate adjustments for market discount, original issue discount
and bond premium) and any gain upon collection or disposition of Mortgage Loans.
The Trust's deductions will consist primarily of interest and original issue
discount accruing with respect to the Notes, servicing and other fees, and
losses or deductions upon collection or disposition of Mortgage Loans.

                                      -96-
<PAGE>
 
  The tax items of a partnership are allocable to the partners in accordance
with the Code, Treasury regulations and the partnership agreement (here, the
Trust Agreement and related documents).  The Trust Agreement will provide, in
general, that the Certificateholders will be allocated taxable income of the
Trust for each month equal to the sum of (i) the interest that accrues on the
Certificates in accordance with their terms for such month, including interest
accruing at the Pass-Through Rate for such month and interest on amounts
previously due on the Certificates but not yet distributed; (ii) any Trust
income attributable to discount on the Mortgage Loans that corresponds to any
excess of the principal amount of the Certificates over their initial issue
price; (iii) prepayment premium payable to the Certificateholders for such
month; and (iv) any other amounts of income payable to the Certificateholders
for such month.  Such allocation will be reduced by any amortization by the
Trust of premium on Mortgage Loans that corresponds to any excess of the issue
price of Certificates over their principal amount.  All remaining taxable income
of the Trust will be allocated to the Representative.  Based on the economic
arrangement of the parties, this approach for allocating Trust income should be
permissible under applicable Treasury regulations, although no assurance can be
given that the IRS would not require a greater amount of income to be allocated
to Certificateholders.  Moreover, even under the foregoing method of allocation,
Certificateholders may be allocated income equal to the entire Pass-Through Rate
plus the other items described above even though the Trust might not have
sufficient cash to make current cash distributions of such amount.  Thus, cash
basis holders will in effect be required to report income from the Certificates
on the accrual basis and Certificateholders may become liable for taxes on Trust
income even if they have not received cash from the Trust to pay such taxes.  In
addition, because tax allocations and tax reporting will be done on a uniform
basis for all Certificateholders but Certificateholders may be purchasing
Certificates at different times and at different prices, Certificateholders may
be required to report on their tax returns taxable income that is greater or
less than the amount reported to them by the Trust.

  If Notes are also issued, some or all of the taxable income allocated to a
Certificateholder that is a pension, profit sharing or employee benefit plan or
other tax-exempt entity (including an individual retirement account) will
constitute "unrelated business taxable income" generally taxable to such a
holder under the Code.

  An individual taxpayer's share of expenses of the Trust (including fees to the
Servicer but not interest expense) would be miscellaneous itemized deductions.
Such deductions might be disallowed to the individual in whole or in part and
might result in such holder being taxed on an amount of income that exceeds the
amount of cash actually distributed to such holder over the life of the Trust.

  The Trust intends to make all tax calculations relating to income and
allocations to Certificateholders on an aggregate basis.  If the IRS were to
require that such calculations be made separately for each Mortgage Loan, the
Trust might be required to incur additional expense but it is believed that
there would not be a material adverse effect on Certificateholders.

  Discount And Premium.  It is believed that the Mortgage Loans were not issued
with original issue discount and, therefore, the Trust should not have original
issue discount income.  However, the purchase price paid by the Trust for the
Mortgage Loans may be greater or less than the remaining principal balance of
the Mortgage Loans at the time of purchase.  If so, the Mortgage Loan will have
been acquired at a premium or discount, as the case may be.  (As indicated
above, the Trust will make this calculation on an aggregate basis, but might be
required to recompute it on a Mortgage Loan by Mortgage Loan basis.)

  If the Trust acquires the Mortgage Loans at a market discount or premium, the
Trust will elect to include any such discount in income currently as it accrues
over the life of the Mortgage Loans or to offset any such premium against
interest income on the Mortgage Loans.  As indicated above, a portion of such
market discount income or premium deduction may be allocated to
Certificateholders.

  Section 708 Termination.  Under Section 708 of the Code, the Trust will be
deemed to terminate for federal income tax purposes if 50% or more of the
capital and profits interests in the Trust are sold or exchanged within a 12-
month period.  If such a termination occurs, the partnership will be considered
to transfer its assets and liabilities to a new partnership in exchange for
interests in that new partnership, which it would then be treated as
transferring to its partners.  The Trust will not comply with certain technical
requirements that might apply when such a constructive termination occurs.  As a
result, the Trust may be subject to certain tax penalties and may incur
additional expenses if 

                                      -97-
<PAGE>
 
it is required to comply with those requirements. Furthermore, the Trust might
not be able to comply due to lack of data.

  Disposition Of Certificates.  Generally, capital gain or loss will be
recognized on a sale of Certificates in an amount equal to the difference
between the amount realized and the seller's tax basis in the Certificates sold.
A Certificateholder's tax basis in a Certificate will generally equal the
holder's cost increased by the holder's share of Trust income (includible in
income) and decreased by any distributions received with respect to such
Certificate.  In addition, both the tax basis in the Certificates and the amount
realized on a sale of a Certificate would include the holder's share of the
Notes and other liabilities of the Trust.  A holder acquiring Certificates at
different prices may be required to maintain a single aggregate adjusted tax
basis in such Certificates, and, upon sale or other disposition of some of the
Certificates, allocate a portion of such aggregate tax basis to the Certificates
sold (rather than maintaining a separate tax basis in each Certificate for
purposes of computing gain or loss on a sale of that Certificate).

  Any gain on the sale of a Certificate attributable to the holder's share of
unrecognized accrued market discount on the Mortgage Loans would generally be
treated as ordinary income to the holder and would give rise to special tax
reporting requirements.  The Trust does not expect to have any other assets that
would give rise to such special reporting requirements.  Thus, to avoid those
special reporting requirements, the Trust will elect to include market discount
in income as it accrues.



  If a Certificateholder is required to recognize an aggregate amount of income
(not including income attributable to disallowed itemized deductions described
above) over the life of the Certificates that exceeds the aggregate cash
distributions with respect thereto, such excess will generally give rise to a
capital loss upon the retirement of the Certificates.

  Allocations Between Representative And Transferees.   In general, the Trust's
taxable income and losses will be determined monthly and the tax items for a
particular calendar month will be apportioned among the Certificateholders in
proportion to the principal amount of Certificates owned by them as of the close
of the last day of such month.  As a result, a holder purchasing Certificates
may be allocated tax items (which will affect its tax liability and tax basis)
attributable to periods before the actual transaction.

  The use of such a monthly convention may not be permitted by existing
regulations and federal tax counsel is unable to opine on the matter.  If a
monthly convention is not allowed (or only applies to transfers of less than all
of the partner's interest), taxable income or losses of the Trust might be
reallocated among the Certificateholders.  The Trust's method of allocation
between transferors and transferees may be revised to conform to a method
permitted by future regulations.

  Section 754 Election.  In the event that a Certificateholder sells its
Certificates at a profit (loss), the purchasing Certificateholder will have a
higher (lower) basis in the Certificates than the selling Certificateholder had.
The tax basis of the Trust's assets will not be adjusted to reflect that higher
(or lower) basis unless the Trust were to file an election under Section 754 of
the Code.  In order to avoid the administrative complexities that would be
involved in keeping accurate accounting records, as well as potentially onerous
information reporting requirements, the Trust currently does not intend to make
such election.  As a result, Certificateholders might be allocated a greater or
lesser amount of Trust income than would be appropriate based on their own
purchase price for Certificates.

  Administrative Matters.  The Trustee is required to keep or have kept complete
and accurate books of the Trust.  Such books will be maintained for financial
reporting and tax purposes on an accrual basis and the fiscal year of the Trust
will be the calendar year.  The Trustee will file a partnership information
return (IRS Form 1065) with the IRS for each taxable year of the Trust and will
report each Certificateholder's allocable share of items of Trust income and
expense to holders and the IRS on Schedule K-1.  The Trust will provide the
Schedule K-1 information to nominees that fail to provide the Trust with the
information statement described below and such nominees will be required to
forward such information to the beneficial owners of the Certificates.
Generally, holders must file tax returns that are consistent with the
information return filed by the Trust or be subject to penalties unless the
holder notifies the IRS of all such inconsistencies.

                                      -98-
<PAGE>
 
  Under Section 6031 of the Code, any person that holds Certificates as a
nominee at any time during a calendar year is required to furnish the Trust with
a statement containing certain information on the nominee, the beneficial owners
and the Certificates so held.  Such information includes (i) the name, address
and taxpayer identification number of the nominee and (ii) as to each beneficial
owner (x) the name, address and identification number of such person, (y)
whether such person is a United States person, a tax-exempt entity or a foreign
government, an international organization, or any wholly owned agency or
instrumentality of either of the foregoing, and (z) certain information on
Certificates that were held, bought or sold on behalf of such person throughout
the year.  In addition, brokers and financial institutions that hold
Certificates through a nominee are required to furnish directly to the Trust
information as to themselves and their ownership of Certificates.  A clearing
agency registered under Section 17A of the Exchange Act is not required to
furnish any such information statement to the Trust.  The information referred
to above for any calendar year must be furnished to the Trust on or before the
following January 31.  Nominees, brokers and financial institutions that fail to
provide the Trust with the information described above may be subject to
penalties.

  The Representative will be designated as the tax matters partner in the
related Trust Agreement and, as such, will be responsible for representing the
Certificateholders in any dispute with the IRS.  The Code provides for
administrative examination of a partnership as if the partnership were a
separate and distinct taxpayer.  Generally, the statute of limitations for
partnership items does not expire before three years after the date on which the
partnership information return is filed.  Any adverse determination following an
audit of the return of the Trust by the appropriate taxing authorities could
result in an adjustment of the returns of the Certificateholders, and, under
certain circumstances, a Certificateholder may be precluded from separately
litigating a proposed adjustment to the items of the Trust.  An adjustment could
also result in an audit of a Certificateholder's returns and adjustments of
items not related to the income and losses of the Trust.

  Tax Consequences To Foreign Certificateholders.  It is not clear and federal
tax counsel is unable to opine whether the Trust would be considered to be
engaged in a trade or business in the United States for purposes of federal
withholding taxes with respect to non-United States persons because there is no
clear authority dealing with that issue under facts substantially similar to
those described herein.  Although it is not expected that the Trust would be
engaged in a trade or business in the United States for such purposes, the Trust
will withhold as if it were so engaged in order to protect the Trust from
possible adverse consequences of a failure to withhold.  The Trust expects to
withhold on the portion of its taxable income that is allocable to foreign
Certificateholders pursuant to Section 1446 of the Code, as if such income were
effectively connected to a United States trade or business, at a rate of 35% for
foreign holders that are taxable as corporations and 39.6% for all other foreign
holders.  Subsequent adoption of Treasury regulations or the issuance of other
administrative pronouncements may require the Trust to change its withholding
procedures.

  If the trust is engaged in a United States trade or business, each foreign
holder might be required to file a United States individual or corporate income
tax return (including, in the case of a corporation, the branch profits tax) on
its share of the Trust's income.  A foreign holder generally would be entitled
to file with the IRS a claim for refund with respect to taxes withheld by the
Trust taking the position that no taxes were due because the Trust was not
engaged in a United States trade or business.  However, interest payments made
(or accrued) to a Certificateholder who is a foreign person generally will be
considered guaranteed payments to the extent such payments are determined
without regard to the income of the Trust, and for that reason or because of the
nature of the assets of the Trust probably will not be considered "portfolio
interest." As a result, even if the Trust was not considered to be engaged in a
United States trade or business, Certificateholders will be subject to United
States federal income tax which must be withheld at a rate of 30%, unless
reduced or eliminated pursuant to an applicable treaty.  A foreign holder would
be entitled to claim a refund for such withheld tax, taking the position that
the interest was portfolio interest and therefore not subject to United States
tax.  However, the IRS may disagree and no assurance can be given as to the
appropriate amount of tax liability.  As a result, each potential foreign
Certificateholder should consult its tax advisor as to whether an interest in a
Certificate is an unsuitable investment.

  Backup Withholding.  Distributions made on the Certificates and proceeds from
the sale of the Certificates will be subject to a "backup" withholding tax of
31% if, in general, the Certificateholder fails to comply with certain
identification procedures, unless the holder is an exempt recipient under
applicable provisions of the Code.

                                      -99-
<PAGE>
 
                                ERISA CONSIDERATIONS


     ERISA imposes certain requirements on employee benefit plans and collective
investment funds, separate accounts and insurance company general accounts in
which such plans or arrangements are invested to which it applies and on those
persons who are fiduciaries with respect to such benefit plans.  Certain
employee benefit plans, such as governmental plans (as defined in Section 3(32)
of ERISA) and certain church plans (as defined in Section 3(33) of ERISA), are
not subject to ERISA.  In accordance with ERISA's general fiduciary standards,
before investing in a Security a benefit plan fiduciary should determine whether
such an investment is permitted under the governing benefit plan instruments and
is appropriate for the benefit plan in view of its overall investment policy and
the composition and diversification of its portfolio and is prudent.

     In addition, benefit plans subject to ERISA and individual retirement
accounts or certain types of Keogh plans not subject to ERISA but subject to
Section 4975 of the Code (each a "Plan") are prohibited from engaging in a broad
range of transactions involving Plan assets and persons having certain specified
relationships to a Plan ("parties in interest" and "disqualified persons").
Such transactions are treated as "prohibited transactions" under Sections 406
and 407 of ERISA and excise taxes are imposed upon such persons by Section 4975
of the Code. The Representative, the Originators, the Security Guaranty Insurer,
the Underwriter and the Trustee and certain of their affiliates might be
considered "parties in interest" or "disqualified persons" with respect to a
Plan.  If so, the acquisition or holding or transfer of Securities by or on
behalf of such Plan could be considered to give rise to a "prohibited
transaction" within the meaning of ERISA and the Code unless an exemption is
available.  In addition, the U.S. Department of Labor ("DOL") has issued a
regulation (29 C.F.R. Section 2510.3-101) concerning the definition of what
constitutes the assets of a Plan (the "Plan Asset Regulations"), which provides
that, as a general rule, the underlying assets and properties of corporations,
partnerships, trusts and certain other entities in which a Plan makes an
"equity" investment will be deemed for purposes of ERISA to be assets of the
investing Plan unless certain exceptions apply.  If an investing Plan's assets
were deemed to include an interest in the Mortgage Loans and any other assets of
the Trust and not merely an interest in the Securities, the assets of the Trust
would become subject to the fiduciary investment standards of ERISA, and
transactions occurring between the Representative, the Trustee, the Servicer,
the Security Guaranty Insurer or any of their affiliates might constitute
prohibited transactions, unless an administrative exemption applies.  Certain
such exemptions which may be applicable to the acquisition and holding of the
Securities or to the servicing of the Mortgage Loans are noted below.

     Regardless of whether the Securities are treated as debt or equity for
purposes of ERISA, the acquisition or holding of Securities which are Notes by
or behalf of a Plan could still be considered to give rise to a prohibited
transaction if the Trust is or becomes a party in interest or disqualified
person with respect to such Plan or in the event that a subsequent transfer of a
Note is made between a Plan and such party in interest or disqualified person.
However, one or more Investor Based Exemptions referred to below may be
applicable to exempt such prohibited transaction.

     The DOL has issued an administrative exemption, Prohibited Transaction
Class Exemption 83-1 ("PTCE 83-1"), which, under certain conditions, exempts
from the application of the prohibited transaction rules of ERISA and the excise
tax provisions of Section 4975 of the Code transactions involving a Plan in
connection with the operation of a "mortgage pool" and the purchase, sale and
holding of "mortgage pool pass-through certificates."  A "mortgage pool" is
defined as an investment pool, consisting solely of interest bearing obligations
secured by first or second mortgages or deeds of trust on single-family
residential property, property acquired in foreclosure and undistributed cash.
A "mortgage pool pass-through certificate" is defined as a certificate which
represents a beneficial undivided interest in a mortgage pool which entitles the
holder to pass-through payments of principal and interest from the mortgage
loans.

     For the exemption to apply, PTCE 83-1 requires that (i) the Representative
and the Trustee maintain a system of insurance or other protection for the
Mortgage Loans and the property securing such Mortgage Loans, and for
indemnifying Certificateholders (except holders of the Class R Certificates)
against reductions in pass-through payments due to defaults in loan payments or
property damage in an amount at least equal to the greater of 1% of the
aggregate principal balance of the Mortgage Loans, or 1% of the principal
balance of the largest covered pooled Mortgage Loan; (ii) the Trustee may not be
an affiliate of the Representative; and (iii) the payments made to and retained
by the Representative in connection with the Trust, together with all funds
inuring to its benefit for 

                                     -100-
<PAGE>
 
administering the Trust, represent no more than "adequate consideration" for
selling the Mortgage Loans, plus reasonable compensation for services provided
to the Trust.

     In addition, PTCE 83-1 exempts the initial sale of Securities to a Plan
with respect to which the Representative, the Security Guaranty Insurer, the
Servicer, or the Trustee is a party in interest if the Plan does not pay more
than fair market value for such Securities and the rights and interests
evidenced by such Securities are not subordinated to the rights and interests
evidenced by other Securities of the same pool.  PTCE 83-1 also exempts from the
prohibited transaction rules and transactions in connection with the servicing
and operation of the Pool, provided that any payments made to the Servicer in
connection with the servicing of the Trust are made in accordance with a binding
agreement, copies of which must be made available to prospective investors.

     In the case of any Plan with respect to which the Representative, the
Servicer, the Security Guaranty Insurer, or the Trustee is a fiduciary, PTCE 83-
1 will only apply if, in addition to the other requirements:  (i) the initial
sale, exchange or transfer of Securities is expressly approved by an independent
fiduciary who has authority to manage and control those plan assets being
invested in Securities; (ii) the Plan pays no more for the Securities than would
be paid in an arm's length transaction; (iii) no investment management, advisory
or underwriting fee, sale commission, or similar compensation is paid to the
Representative with regard to the sale, exchange or transfer of Securities to
the Plan; (iv) the total value of the Securities purchased by such Plan does not
exceed 25% of the amount issued; and (v) at least 50% of the aggregate amount of
Securities is acquired by persons independent of the Representative, the
Trustee, the Servicer, and the Security Guaranty Insurer.


     Before purchasing Securities, a fiduciary of a Plan should confirm that the
Trust is a "mortgage pool," that the Securities constitute "mortgage pool pass-
through certificates," and that the conditions set forth in PTCE 83-1 would be
satisfied.  In addition to making its own determination as to the availability
of the exemptive relief provided in PTCE 83-1, the Plan fiduciary should
consider the availability of any other prohibited transaction exemptions.  The
Plan fiduciary also should consider its general fiduciary obligations under
ERISA in determining whether to purchase any Securities on behalf of a Plan.


     In addition, the DOL has granted to certain underwriters and/or placement
agents individual prohibited transaction exemptions (each an "Underwriter
Exemption") which may be applicable to avoid certain of the prohibited
transaction rules of ERISA with respect to the initial purchase, the holding and
the subsequent resale in the secondary market by Plans of pass-through
certificates representing a beneficial undivided ownership interest in the
assets of a trust that consist of certain receivables, loans and other
obligations that meet the conditions and requirements of the Underwriter
Exemption which may be applicable to the Securities.  The conditions of
Underwriter Exemption, if applicable, will be set forth in "ERISA
Considerations" in the Prospectus Supplement.

     One or more other prohibited transaction exemptions issued by the DOL may
be available to a Plan investing in Securities, depending in part upon the type
of Plan fiduciary making the decision to acquire a Security and the
circumstances under which such decision is made, including but not limited to:
PTCE 90-1, regarding investments by insurance company pooled separate accounts,
PTCE 91-38, regarding investments by bank collective investment funds, PTCE 84-
14, regarding investments effectuated by "qualified plan asset managers", PTCE
96-23, regarding investments effectuated by "in-house asset managers" and PTCE
95-60, regarding investments by insurance company general accounts ("Investor
Based Exemptions").  However, even if the conditions specified in an Underwriter
Exemption or one or more of these other exemptions are met, the scope of the
relief provided might or might not cover all acts which might be construed as
prohibited transactions.

     Any Plan fiduciary considering the purchase of a Security should consult
with its counsel with respect to the potential applicability of ERISA and the
Code to such investment.  Moreover, each Plan fiduciary should determine
whether, under the general fiduciary standards of investment prudence and
diversification, an investment in the Securities is appropriate for the Plan,
taking into account the overall investment policy of the Plan and the
composition of the Plan's investment portfolio.



                        LEGAL INVESTMENT CONSIDERATIONS

                                     -101-
<PAGE>
 
     Each Prospectus Supplement will describe the extent, if any, to which the
Classes of Securities offered thereby will constitute "mortgage related
securities" for purposes of SMMEA. No representation is made herein as to
whether the Securities will constitute legal investments for any entity under
any applicable statute, law, rule, regulation or order.  Prospective purchasers
are urged to consult with their counsel concerning the status of the Securities
as legal investments for such purchasers prior to investing in any Class of
Securities.



                             PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION


     The Securities offered hereby will be offered in Series, either directly by
the Representative or through one or more underwriters or underwriting
syndicates ("Underwriters").  The Prospectus Supplement for each Series will set
forth the terms of the offering of such Series and of each Class within such
Series, including the name or names of the Underwriters, the proceeds to and
their use by the Representative and the Originators, and either the initial
public offering price, the discounts and commissions to the Underwriters and any
discounts or concessions allowed or reallowed to certain dealers, or the method
by which the price at which the Underwriters will sell the Securities will be
determined.

     The Securities in a Series may be acquired by Underwriters for their own
account and may be resold from time to time in one or more transactions,
including negotiated transactions, at a fixed public offering price or at
varying prices determined at the time of sale.  The obligations of any
Underwriters will be subject to certain conditions precedent, and such
Underwriters will be severally obligated to purchase all of a Series of
Securities described in the related Prospectus Supplement, if they are
purchased.  If Securities of a Series are offered other than through
Underwriters, the related Prospectus Supplement will contain information
regarding the nature of such offering and any agreements to be entered into
between the seller and purchasers of Securities of such Series.

     The place and time of delivery for the Securities of a Series in respect of
which this Prospectus is delivered will be set forth in the related Prospectus
Supplement.



                                 LEGAL MATTERS


     Certain legal matters relating to the validly of the issuance of the
Securities of each Series will be passed upon for the Representative by Eric R.
Elwin, Esq., Corporate Counsel of the Representative and certain legal matters
relating to the validity of the issuance of the Securities of each Series will
be passed upon for the Underwriters of the Securities of each Series by Stroock
& Stroock & Lavan LLP, New York, New York.  Stroock & Stroock & Lavan LLP has
performed legal services for the Representative and it is expected that it will
continue to perform such services in the future.



                                    EXPERTS


     The consolidated financial statements of The Money Store Inc. as of
December 31, 1996 and 1995 and for each of the three years in the period ended
December 31, 1996 incorporated by reference herein have been audited by KPMG
Peat Marwick LLP, independent accountants, as stated in their opinion given upon
their authority as experts in accounting and auditing.



                             FINANCIAL INFORMATION


     A new Trust will be formed to own the Mortgage Assets and to issue each
Series of Securities.  Each such Trust will have no assets or obligations prior
to the issuance of the Securities and will not engage in any activities other
than those described herein.  Accordingly, no financial statements with respect
to such Trusts are included in this Prospectus.

                                     -102-
<PAGE>
 
                                    RATING


     It is a condition to the issuance of the Securities of each Series offered
hereby and by the Prospectus Supplement that they shall have been rated in one
of the four highest rating categories by the nationally recognized statistical
rating agency or agencies specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     Ratings on mortgage pass-through securities address the likelihood of
receipt by securityholders of all distributions on the underlying mortgage
loans.  These ratings address the structural, legal and issuer-related aspects
associated with such securities, the nature of the underlying mortgage loans and
the credit quality of the guarantor, if any.  Ratings on mortgage pass-through
securities do not represent any assessment of the likelihood of principal
prepayments by mortgagors or of the degree by which such prepayments might
differ from those originally anticipated.  As a result, securityholders might
suffer a lower than anticipated yield, and, in addition, holders of stripped
pass-through securities in extreme cases might fail to recoup their underlying
investments.


     A rating of a security is not a recommendation to buy, sell or hold
securities and may be subject to revision or withdrawal at any time by the
assigning rating organization.  Each security rating should be evaluated
independently of any other security rating.

                                     -103-
<PAGE>
 
                            INDEX OF PRINCIPAL TERMS


     Unless the context indicates otherwise, the following terms shall have the
meanings set forth on the page indicated below:
 
 
Adjustable Rate.................................    6
Adjusted Mortgage Loan Remittance Rate..........   48
Agency Securities...............................    6
Agreement.......................................    5
APR.............................................    8
ARM.............................................   93
Auction Rate Securities.........................    2
Available Remittance Amount.....................   60
Balloon Loans...................................   21
Bankruptcy Bond.................................   15
Basis Risk Shortfall............................   76
Buydown Funds...................................   77
Cede............................................    4
Certificate.....................................    1
Certificateholders..............................    1
Class...........................................    1
Cleanup Costs...................................   76
CMOs............................................    9
Code............................................   18
Commission......................................    3
Compensating Interest...........................   18
Contingency Fee.................................   60
Contracts.......................................    6
Conventional Loans..............................    6
Cooperative Loans...............................    6
Cooperatives....................................    6
Curtailment.....................................   18
Custodian.......................................   59
Cut-off Date....................................   43
Designated Depository Institution...............   59
Detailed Description............................   26
Determination Date..............................   17
Distribution Account............................   59
DTC.............................................    4
Due Period......................................   60
ERISA...........................................   20
Event of Nonpayment.............................   63
Federal Tax Counsel.............................   18
FHA.............................................    6
FHA Loans.......................................    6
FHLMC...........................................    9
FHLMC Act.......................................    9
FHLMC Certificate Group.........................   35
FHLMC Certificates..............................    9
FHLMC Project Certificates......................   37
Final Determination.............................   64
Fixed Rate......................................    6
FNMA............................................    6
FTC Rule........................................   73

                                     -104-
<PAGE>
 
Funding Period..................................   10
Garn-St. Germain Act............................   74
GNMA............................................    6
Guaranty Insurance Policy.......................   14
Home Equity Loans...............................   29
HUD.............................................    7
Indirect Participant............................   49
Insurance Proceeds..............................   17
Insurance Paying Agent..........................   52
Insured Payment.................................   52
Interest Period.................................   47
Interest Rate...................................    2
IRS.............................................   64
LIBOR...........................................    2
Liquidation Proceeds............................   17
Loan-to-Value Ratio.............................   28
Lockout Periods.................................    7
Lower Tier REMIC................................   85
Majority Securityholders........................   62
Manufactured Homes..............................   31
Manufacturer's Invoice Price....................   28
Master Servicer.................................    1
Monthly Advance.................................   17
Mortgage Asset Schedule.........................   26
Mortgage Assets.................................    1
Mortgage Interest Rate..........................    6
Mortgage Loans..................................    6
Mortgage Pool Insurance Policy..................   15
Mortgaged Properties............................    7
Multifamily Loans...............................    6
NHA Act.........................................   31
1933 Act........................................    3
Non-REMIC Certificates..........................   19
Noteholders.....................................    1
Notes...........................................    1
Opinion of Counsel..............................   58
Originators.....................................    1
Participants....................................   49
Pass-Through Rate...............................    2
Permitted Instruments...........................   59
Permitted Investments...........................   54
Plan............................................  100
PMBS............................................    6
PMBS Agreement..................................   37
PMBS Issuer.....................................    9
PMBS Servicer...................................   10
PMBS Trustee....................................   10
Pool............................................    1
Pool Insurer....................................   52
Pre-Funding Account.............................   10
Prepayment Assumption...........................   79
Principal and Interest Account..................   59
Principal Prepayment Period.....................   46
Principal Prepayment............................   17

                                     -105-
<PAGE>
 
Qualified Substitute Mortgage Loan..............   58
Rating Agency...................................   17
REIT............................................   86
Relief Act......................................   25
REMIC...........................................    2
REMIC Certificates..............................   76
REMIC Regular Certificates......................   18
REMIC Residual Certificates.....................   18
REMIC Regulations...............................   77
Remittance Date.................................    2
Representative..................................    1
Reserve Account.................................   14
Secured Conventional Home Improvement Loans.....    6
Security Guaranty Insurer.......................   52
Security Register...............................   45
Senior Certificates.............................   11
Senior Notes....................................   13
Servicing Advance...............................   60
Servicing Fee...................................   60
Single Family Loans.............................    6
Single Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificate..   81
SMMEA...........................................   20
Special Hazard Insurance Policy.................   15
Special Hazard Insurer..........................   53
Spread Amount...................................   15
Standard Hazard Insurance Policies..............    7
Subordinated Certificates.......................   11
Subordinated Notes..............................   13
Sub-Servicer....................................   62
Substitution Adjustment.........................   58
Successor Servicer..............................   63
Superlien.......................................   76
Supplemental Interest Payments..................   54
T-Bill Rate.....................................    2
Termination Notice..............................   64
Termination Price...............................   64
Tiered REMICs...................................   77
Title I Loan Program............................    8
Title I Property Improvement Loans..............   31
Title V.........................................   74
Trust...........................................    1
Trustee.........................................   18
Trustee's Mortgage File.........................   58
UCC.............................................   49
Underwriter Exemption...........................  102
Underwriters....................................  102
United States person............................   89
Unsecured Home Improvement Loans................    6
VA..............................................    6
Variable Rate Non-REMIC Certificates............   92
Variable Rate REMIC Regular Certificate.........   81
Yield Supplement Agreement......................   76

572309

                                     -106-
<PAGE>
 
                                                                      APPENDIX I



                              AUCTION PROCEDURES



     The following description of the Auction Procedures applies to each Class
of Auction Rate Securities (and may be different if otherwise set forth in a
related Prospectus Supplement).  The term "Security," as used in this Appendix,
refers to each Class of Auction Rate Securities that are either Notes or
Certificates and the term "Securityholder" refers to Holders of Auction Rate
Securities.

DEFINITIONS

     Capitalized terms used herein and not otherwise defined have the meanings
ascribed in the accompanying Prospectus and Prospectus Supplement.
Additionally, the following terms have the meanings ascribed to them:


     "All Hold Rate" means ninety percent (90%) of One-Month LIBOR or such other
rate as may be set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement.


     "Auction" means the implementation of the Auction Procedures on an Auction
Date.

     "Auction Agent" means the initial auction agent under the initial Auction
Agent Agreement unless and until a substitute Auction Agent Agreement becomes
effective, after which "Auction Agent" shall mean the substitute auction agent.

     "Auction Agent Agreement" means the initial Auction Agent Agreement unless
and until a substitute Auction Agent Agreement is entered into, after which
"Auction Agent Agreement" shall mean such substitute Auction Agent Agreement.

     "Auction Agent Fee" has the meaning set forth in the Auction Agent
Agreement.

     "Auction Agent Fee Rate" has the meaning set forth in the Auction Agent
Agreement.

     "Auction Date" means, with respect to the Initial Period for each Class of
Securities, the date set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement and
thereafter, the Business Day immediately preceding the first day of each Auction
Period for each Security, other than:


     (A) each Auction Period commencing after the ownership of the Securities is
         no longer maintained in Book-Entry Form by DTC;



     (B) each Auction Period commencing after and during the continuance of an
         Event of Default; or



     (C)  each Auction Period commencing less than two Business Days after the
         cure or waiver of an Event of Default.


Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Auction Date for one or more Auction Periods
may be changed pursuant to the related Agreement and the related Terms
Supplement, as described herein.

     "Auction Period" means, with respect to each Security, the Interest Period
applicable to such Security during which time the applicable Security Interest
Rate is determined pursuant to the related Agreement and the related Terms
Supplement, which Auction Period (after the Initial Period for such Security)
initially shall consist of between 7 days and one year (as set forth in the
related Prospectus Supplement), as the same may be adjusted pursuant to such
related Agreement and the related Terms Supplement.

                                      I-1
<PAGE>
 
     "Auction Period Adjustment" means an adjustment to the Auction Period as
provided in the related Terms Supplement, as described herein.

     "Auction Procedures" means the procedures set forth in the related Terms
Supplement and described herein by which the Auction Rate applicable to a
Security is determined.

     "Auction Rate" means, with respect to any Security, the rate of interest
per annum that results from the implementation of the Auction Procedures and is
determined as described in the related Agreement and the related Terms
Supplement and this Appendix I.

     "Authorized Denominations" means, the dollar amount set forth in the
related Prospectus Supplement and any integral multiple in excess thereof.

     "Broker-Dealer" means the initial broker-dealer under the initial Broker-
Dealer Agreement or any other broker or dealer (each as defined in the
Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended), commercial bank or other entity
permitted by law to perform the functions required of a Broker-Dealer set forth
in the Auction Procedures that (a) is a Participant (or an affiliate of a
Participant), (b) has been appointed as such by the Representative and the
Trustee pursuant to the related Agreement and (c) has entered into a Broker-
Dealer Agreement that is in effect on the date of reference.

     "Broker-Dealer Agreement" means each agreement between the Auction Agent
and a Broker-Dealer, and approved by Representative and the Trust, pursuant to
which the Broker-Dealer agrees to participate in Auctions as set forth in the
Auction Procedures, as from time to time amended or supplemented.

     "Broker-Dealer Fee" has the meaning set forth in the Auction Agent
Agreement.


     "Broker-Dealer Fee Rate" has the meaning set forth in the Auction Agent
Agreement.


     "Effective Interest Rate" means, for any Mortgage Loan and any collection
period, the per annum rate at which such Mortgage Loan accrues interest during
such collection period.

     "Existing Securityholder" means (i) with respect to and for the purpose of
dealing with the Auction Agent in connection with an Auction, a Person who is a
Broker-Dealer listed in the Existing Securityholder Registry at the close of
business on the Business Day immediately preceding such Auction and (ii) with
respect to and for the purpose of dealing with the Broker-Dealer in connection
with an Auction, a Person who is a beneficial owner of any Security.

     "Existing Securityholder Registry" means the registry of Persons who are
owners of the Securities, maintained by the Auction Agent as provided in the
Auction Agent Agreement.

     "Federal Funds Rate" means, for any date of determination, the federal
funds (effective) rate as published on page 118 of the Dow Jones Telerate
Service (or such other page as may replace that page on that service for the
purpose of displaying comparable rates or prices) on the immediately preceding
Business Day.  If no such rate is published on such page on such date, "Federal
Funds Rate" shall mean for any date of determination, the Federal funds
(effective) rate as published by the Federal Reserve Board in the most recent
edition of Federal Reserve Statistical Release No. H.15 (519) that is available
on the Business Day immediately preceding such date.

     "Initial Period" means, as to any Security, the period commencing on the
Closing Date of such Security and continuing through the day immediately
preceding the Security Initial Rate Adjustment Date for such Security.

     "Interest Period" means, with respect to a Security, the Initial Period for
such Security and each period commencing on the Rate Adjustment Date for such
Security and ending on the day before (i) the next Rate Adjustment Date for such
Security or (ii) the final maturity date of such Security, as applicable.

                                      I-2
<PAGE>
 
     "Market Agent" means the entity named as market agent  under the related
Agreement, or any successor to it in such capacity thereunder.

     "Maximum Auction Rate" generally means (i) for Auction Periods of 34 days
or less, either (A) the greater of (1) One-Month LIBOR plus 0.60% or (2) the
Federal Funds Rate plus 0.60% (if both ratings assigned by the Rating Agencies
to the applicable Security are "Aa3" or "AA-" or better) or (B) One-Month LIBOR
plus 1.50% (if any one of the ratings assigned by the Rating Agencies to the
Security is less than "Aa3" or "AA-") or (ii) for Auction Periods of greater
than or equal to 35 days, either (A) the greater of One-Month LIBOR or Three-
Month LIBOR, plus in either case, 0.60%  (if both of the ratings assigned by the
Rating Agencies to the applicable Security are "Aa3" or "AA-" or better) or (B)
the greater of One-Month LIBOR or Three-Month LIBOR, plus in either case, 1.50%
(if any one of the ratings assigned by the Rating Agencies to the applicable
Security is less than "Aa3" or "AA-") or such other rate as may be set forth in
the related Prospectus Supplement.  For purposes of the Auction Agent and the
Auction Procedures, the ratings referred to in this definition shall be the last
ratings of which the Auction Agent has been given notice pursuant to the Auction
Agent Agreement.

     "Net Loan Rate" for any Interest Period will equal the weighted average
Effective Interest Rate for the Collection Period immediately preceding such
Interest Period less the amount set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     "Non-Payment Rate" means One-Month LIBOR plus 1.50%, as the same may be
adjusted pursuant to a Terms Supplement or such other rate as may be set forth
in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     "Person" means any individual, corporation, estate, partnership, joint
venture, association, joint stock company, trust (including any beneficiary
thereof), unincorporated organization or government or any agency or political
subdivision thereof.

     "Potential Securityholder" means any Person (including an Existing
Securityholder that is (i) a Broker-Dealer when dealing with the Auction Agent
and (ii) a potential beneficial owner when dealing with a Broker-Dealer) who may
be interested in acquiring Securities (or, in the case of an Existing
Securityholder thereof, an additional principal amount of Securities).

     "Rate Adjustment Date" means, with respect to each Security, the date on
which the applicable Security Interest Rate is effective and means, with respect
to each such Security, the date of commencement of each Auction Period.

     "Rate Determination Date" means, with respect to any Security, the Auction
Date, or if no Auction Date is applicable to such Series, the Business Day
immediately preceding the date of commencement of an Auction Period.

     "Security Initial Rate" means, with respect to any Class of Notes or
Certificates, the rate identified as such in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     "Security Initial Rate Adjustment Date" means, with respect to any Class of
Notes, the date identified as such in the related Prospectus Supplement and,
with respect to any Class of Certificates, the date set forth in the related
Agreement or the related Terms Supplement.
 
     "Three-Month LIBOR" means the London interbank offered rate for deposits in
U.S. dollars having a maturity of three months commencing on the related LIBOR
Determination Date (the "Three-Month Index Maturity") which appears on Telerate
Page 3750 as of 11:00 a.m., London time, on such LIBOR Determination Date.  If
such rate does not appear on Telerate Page 3750, the rate for that day will be
determined on the basis of the rates at which deposits in U.S. dollars, having
the Three Month Index Maturity and in a principal amount of not less than U.S.
$1,000,000, are offered at approximately 11:00 a.m., London time, on such LIBOR
Determination Date to prime banks in the London interbank market by the
Reference Banks.  The Auction Agent will request the principal London office of
each of such Reference Banks to provide a quotation of its rate.  If at least
two such quotations are provided, the rate for that day will be the 

                                      I-3
<PAGE>
 
arithmetic mean of the quotations. If fewer than two quotations are provided,
the rate for that day will be the arithmetic mean of the rates quoted by major
banks in New York City, selected by the Auction Agent, at approximately 11:00
a.m., New York City time, on such LIBOR Determination Date for loans in U.S.
dollars to leading European banks having the Three Month Index Maturity and in a
principal amount equal to an amount of not less than U.S. $1,000,000; provided
that if the banks selected as aforesaid are not quoting as mentioned in this
sentence, Three-Month LIBOR in effect for the applicable Interest Period will be
Three-Month LIBOR in effect for the previous Interest Period.

EXISTING SECURITYHOLDERS AND POTENTIAL SECURITYHOLDERS

     Participants in each Auction will include:  (1) "Existing Securityholders,"
which shall mean any Securityholder according to the records of the Auction
Agent at the close of business on the Business Day preceding each Auction Date;
and (ii) "Potential Securityholders," which shall mean any person, including any
Existing Securityholder or a Broker/Dealer, who may be interested in acquiring
Securities (or, in the case of an Existing Securityholder, an additional
principal amount of the Security such Securityholder then holds).  See "--
Broker-Dealer."

     By purchasing a Security, whether in an Auction or otherwise, each
prospective purchaser of Securities or its Broker-Dealer must agree and will be
deemed to have agreed: (i) to participate in Auctions on the terms described
herein; (ii) so long as the beneficial ownership of the Securities is maintained
in Book-Entry Form to sell, transfer or otherwise dispose of the Securities only
pursuant to a Bid (as defined below) or a Sell Order (as defined below) in an
Auction, or to or through a Broker-Dealer, provided that in the case of all
transfers other than those pursuant to an Auction, the Existing Securityholder
of the Securities so transferred, its Participant or Broker-Dealer advises the
Auction Agent of such transfer; (iii) to have its beneficial ownership of
Securities maintained at all times in Book-Entry Form for the account of its
Participant, which in turn will maintain records of such beneficial ownership,
and to authorize such Participant to disclose to the Auction Agent such
information with respect to such beneficial ownership as the Auction Agent may
request; (iv) that a Sell Order placed by an Existing Securityholder will
constitute an irrevocable offer to sell the principal amount of the Security
specified in such Sell Order; (v) that a Bid placed by an Existing
Securityholder will constitute an irrevocable offer to sell the principal amount
of the Security specified in such Bid if the rate specified in such Bid is
greater than, or in some cases equal to, the Security Interest Rate of such
Security, determined as described herein; and (vi) that a Bid placed by a
Potential Securityholder will constitute an irrevocable offer to purchase the
amount, or a lesser principal amount, of the Security specified in such Bid if
the rate specified in such Bid is, respectively, less than or equal to the
Security Interest Rate of the specified Security, determined as described
herein.


     The principal amount of the Securities purchased or sold may be subject to
probation procedures on the Auction Date. Each purchase or sale of Securities on
the Auction Date will be made for settlement on the first day of the Interest
Period immediately following such Auction Date at a price equal to 100% of the
principal amount thereof, plus accrued but unpaid interest thereon.  The Auction
Agent is entitled to rely upon the terms of any Order submitted to it by a
Broker-Dealer.


     Auction Agent

     The entity named in the related Prospectus Supplement, will be appointed as
Auction Agent to serve as agent for a Trust in connection with Auctions.  The
Trustee and the Representative will enter into the Auction Agreement with the
Auction Agent.  Any Auction Agent or Substitute Auction Agent will be (i) a
bank, national banking association or trust company duly organized under the
laws of the United States of America or any state or territory thereof having
its principal place of business in the Borough of Manhattan, New York, or such
other location as approved by the Trustee and the Market Agent in writing and
having a combined capital stock or surplus of at least $50,000,000, or (ii) a
member of the National Association of Securities Dealers, Inc. having a
capitalization of at least $50,000,000, and, in either case, authorized by law
to perform all the duties imposed upon it under the related Agreement and under
the Auction Agent Agreement.  The Auction Agent may at any time resign and be
discharged of the duties and obligations created by the related Agreement by
giving at least 90 days notice to the Trustee, the Trust, the Representative and
the Market Agent.  The Auction Agent may be removed at any time by the Trustee
upon the written direction of the Security Guaranty Insurer, if applicable, or,
with the consent of the Security Guaranty Insurer, if applicable, the
Securityholders of 66% of the aggregate principal amount of the Securities then
outstanding, by an instrument signed by the Security Guaranty Insurer, if
applicable, or such Securityholders or their attorneys and filed with the
Auction Agent, the Representative, the Trustee and the Market Agent upon at
least 90 days' notice.  Neither resignation nor removal of the Auction Agent

                                      I-4
<PAGE>
 
pursuant to the preceding two sentences will be effective until and unless a
Substitute Auction Agent has been appointed and has accepted such appointment.
If required by the Trust or the Representative or by the Market Agent, with the
Trust's and the Representative's consent, a Substitute Auction Agent Agreement
shall be entered into with a Substitute Auction Agent.  Notwithstanding the
foregoing, the Auction Agent may terminate the Auction Agent Agreement if,
within 25 days after notifying the Trustee, the Trust, the Representative, the
Security Guaranty Insurer, if applicable, and the Market Agent in writing that
it has not received payment of any Auction Agent Fee due it in accordance with
the terms of the Auction Agent Agreement, the Auction Agent does not receive
such payment.

     If the Auction Agent should resign or be removed or be dissolved, or if the
property or affairs of the Auction Agent shall be taken under the control of any
state or federal court or administrative body because of bankruptcy or
insolvency, or for any other reason, the Trustee, at the direction of the
Representative (after receipt of a certificate from the Market Agent confirming
that any proposed Substitute Auction Agent meets the requirements described in
the immediately preceding paragraph above), shall use its best efforts to
appoint a Substitute Auction Agent.

     The Auction Agent is acting as agent for the Trust in connection with
Auctions.  In the absence of bad, faith, negligent failure to act or negligence
on its part, the Auction Agent will not be liable for any action taken, suffered
or omitted or any error of judgment made by it in the performance of its duties
under the Auction Agent Agreement and will not be liable for any error of
judgment made in good faith unless the Auction Agent will have been negligent in
ascertaining (or failing to ascertain) the pertinent facts.

     The Trustee will pay the Auction Agent the Auction Agent Fee on the Note
Remittance Date or Certificate Remittance Date set forth in the related
Prospectus Supplement, and will reimburse the Auction Agent upon its request for
all reasonable expenses, disbursements and advances incurred or made by the
Auction Agent in accordance with any provision of the Auction Agent Agreement or
the Broker-Dealer Agreements (including the reasonable compensation and the
expenses and disbursements of its agents and counsel).  The Trust will indemnify
and hold harmless the Auction Agent for and against any loss, liability or
expense incurred without negligence or bad faith on the Auction Agent's part,
arising out of or in connection with the acceptance or administration of its
agency under the Auction Agent Agreement and the Broker-Dealer Agreements
including the reasonable costs and expenses (including the reasonable fees and
expenses of its counsel) of defending itself against any such claim or liability
in connection with its exercise or performance of any of its respective duties
thereunder and of enforcing this indemnification provision; provided that the
Trust will not indemnify the Auction Agent as described in this paragraph for
any fees and expenses incurred by the Auction Agent in the normal course of
performing its duties under the Auction Agent Agreement and under the Broker-
Dealer Agreements, such fees and expenses being payable as described above.

     Broker-Dealer

     Existing Securityholders and Potential Securityholders may participate in
Auctions only by submitting orders (in the manner described below) through a
"Broker-Dealer," including the Broker-Dealer, as the sole Broker-Dealer or any
other broker or dealer (each as defined in the Securities Exchange Act of 1934,
as amended), commercial bank or other entity permitted by law to perform the
functions required of a Broker-Dealer set forth below which (i) is a Participant
or an affiliate of a Participant, (ii) has been selected by the Trust and (iii)
has entered into a Broker-Dealer Agreement with the Auction Agent that remains
effective, in which the Broker-Dealer agrees to participate in Auctions as
described in the Auction Procedures, as from time to time amended or
supplemented.

     The Broker-Dealers are entitled to a Broker-Dealer Fee, which is payable by
the Auction Agent from monies received from the Trustee, on the Note Remittance
Date or Certificate Remittance Date set forth in the related Prospectus
Supplement.

     Market Agent

     In connection with each Series of Notes and the Certificates, the "Market
Agent," will act solely as agent of the Trust and will not assume any obligation
or relationship of agency or trust for or with any of the Securityholders.

AUCTION PROCEDURES

                                      I-5
<PAGE>
 
     General

     Pursuant to the related Agreement and the related Terms Supplement,
Auctions to establish the Auction Rate for each Security issued by the Trust
will be held on each applicable Auction Date, except as described below, by
application of the Auction Procedures described herein.  Such procedures are to
be applicable separately to each Class of Notes and each Class of Certificates.

     The Auction Agent will calculate the Maximum Auction Rate, the All Hold
Rate and One-Month LIBOR or Three-Month LIBOR, as the case may be, on each
Auction Date.  The Administrator will calculate and, no later than the Business
Day preceding each Auction Date, will report to the Auction Agent in writing,
the Net Loan Rate.  If the ownership of a Security is no longer maintained in
Book-Entry Form, the Trustee will calculate the Maximum Auction Rate, and
Administrator will report to the Trustee in writing the Net Loan Rate, on the
Business Day immediately preceding the first day of each Interest Period
commencing after delivery of such Security. If an Event of Default has occurred,
under the Indenture or the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, as applicable, the
Trustee will calculate the Non-Payment Rate on the Rate Determination Date for
(i) each Interest Period commencing after the occurrence and during the
continuance of such Payment Default and (ii) any Interest Period commencing less
than two Business Days after the cure of any Event of Default. The Auction Agent
will determine One-Month LIBOR or the Three-Month LIBOR, as applicable, for each
Interest Period other than the Initial Period for a Security; provided, that if
the ownership of the Securities is no longer maintained in Book-Entry Form, or
if an Event of Default has occurred, then the Trustee will determine the One-
Month LIBOR or the Three-Month LIBOR, as applicable, for each such Interest
Period.  The determination by the Trustee or the Auction Agent, as the case may
be, of the One-Month LIBOR or the Three-Month LIBOR, as applicable, will (in the
absence of manifest error) be final and binding upon the Securityholders and all
other parties.  If calculated or determined by the Auction Agent, the Auction
Agent will promptly advise the Trustee of the One- Month LIBOR or the Three-
Month LIBOR, as applicable.

     Submission of Orders

     So long as the ownership of the Securities is maintained in Book-Entry
Form, an Existing Securityholder may sell, transfer or otherwise dispose of
Securities only pursuant to a Bid or Sell Order (as hereinafter defined) placed
in an Auction or through a Broker-Dealer, provided that, in the case of all
transfers other than pursuant to Auctions, such Existing Securityholder, its
Broker-Dealer or its Participant advises the Auction Agent of such transfer.
Auctions for each Class of Notes and each Class of Certificates will be
conducted on each applicable Auction Date, if there is an Auction Agent on such
Auction Date, in the following manner (such procedures to be applicable
separately to each Class of Notes and each Class of Certificates).

     Prior to the Submission Deadline (defined as 1:00 p.m., eastern time, on
any Auction Date or such other time on any Auction Date by which Broker-Dealers
are required to submit Orders to the Auction Agent as specified by the Auction
Agent from time to time) on each Auction Date relating to a Security:

         (a) each Existing Securityholder of the applicable Security may submit
to a Broker-Dealer by telephone or otherwise information as to: (i) the
principal amount and Class of outstanding Securities, if any, held by such
Existing Securityholder which such Existing Securityholder desires to continue
to hold without regard to the Security Interest Rate for such Securities for the
next succeeding Auction Period (a "Hold Order"); (ii) the principal amount and
Class of outstanding Securities, if any, which such Existing Securityholder
offers to sell if the Security Interest Rate for such Securities for the next
succeeding Auction Period will be less than the rate per annum specified by such
Existing Securityholder (a "Bid"); and/or (iii) the principal amount and Class
of outstanding Securities, if any, held by such Existing Securityholder which
such Existing Securityholder offers to sell without regard to the Security
Interest Rate for such Securities for the next succeeding Auction Period (a
"Sell Order"); and

         (b) one or more Broker-Dealers may contact Potential Securityholders to
determine the principal amount and Class of Securities which each such Potential
Securityholder offers to purchase, if the Security Interest Rate for such
Securities for the next succeeding Auction Period will not be less than the rate
per annum specified by such Potential Securityholder (also a "Bid").

                                      I-6
<PAGE>
 
     Each Hold Order, Bid and Sell Order will be an "Order."  Each Existing
Securityholder and each Potential Securityholder placing an Order is referred to
as a "Bidder."


     Subject to the provisions described below under "Validity of Orders," a Bid
by an Existing Securityholder will constitute an irrevocable offer to sell: (i)
the principal amount and Class of the outstanding Securities specified in such
Bid if the Security Interest Rate for such Securities will be less than the rate
specified in such Bid, (ii) such principal amount or a lesser principal amount
and Class of the outstanding Securities to be determined as described below in
"Acceptance and Rejection of Orders," if the Security Interest Rate for such
Securities will be equal to the rate specified in such Bid or (iii) such
principal amount or a lesser principal amount of the then outstanding Securities
to be determined as described below under "Acceptance and Rejection of Orders,"
if the rate specified therein will be higher than the Security Interest Rate for
such Securities and Sufficient Bids (as defined below) have not been made.


     Subject to the provisions described below under "Validity of Orders," a
Sell Order by an Existing Securityholder will constitute an irrevocable offer to
sell: (i) the principal amount of the Security specified in such Sell Order or
(ii) such principal amount or a lesser principal amount of outstanding
Securities of the specified Security as described below under "Acceptance and
Rejection of Orders," if Sufficient Bids have not been made.

     Subject to the provisions described below under "Validity of Orders," a Bid
by a Potential Securityholder will constitute an irrevocable offer to purchase:
(i) the principal amount of the Security specified in such Bid if the Security
Interest Rate for such Securities will be higher than the rate specified in such
Bid or (ii) such principal amount or a lesser principal amount of such
Securities as described below in "Acceptance and Rejection of Orders," if the
Security Interest Rate is equal to the rate specified in such Bid.

     Each Broker-Dealer will submit in writing to the Auction Agent prior to the
Submission Deadline on each Auction Date all Orders obtained by such Broker-
Dealer and will specify with respect to each such Order: (i) the name of the
Bidder placing such Order; (ii) the aggregate principal amount and Class of
Security that are the subject of such Order; (iii) to the extent that such
Bidder is an Existing Securityholder: (a) the principal amount and Class of
Securities, if any, subject to any Hold Order placed by such Existing
Securityholder; (b) the principal amount, and Class of Securities, if any,
subject to any Bid placed by such Existing Securityholder and the rate specified
in such Bid; and (c) the principal amount, and Class of Securities, if any,
subject to any Sell Order placed by such Existing Securityholder, and (iv) to
the extent such Bidder is a Potential Securityholder, the rate specified in such
Potential Securityholder's Bid.

     If any rate specified in any Bid contains more than three figures to the
right of the decimal point, the Auction Agent will round such rate up to the
next highest one-thousandth (.001) of one percent.

     If an Order or Orders covering all Securities of the applicable Class held
by any Existing Securityholder are not submitted to the Auction Agent prior to
the Submission Deadline, the Auction Agent will deem a Hold Order to have been
submitted on behalf of such Existing Securityholder covering the principal
amount of Securities held by such Existing Securityholder and not subject to an
Order submitted to the Auction Agent.

     Neither the Trust, the Representative, the Trustee nor the Auction Agent
will be responsible for any failure of a Broker-Dealer to submit an Order to the
Auction Agent on behalf of any Existing Securityholder or Potential
Securityholder.

     An Existing Securityholder may submit multiple Orders, of different types
and specifying different rates, in an Auction with respect to Securities then
held by such Existing Securityholder.  An Existing Securityholder that offers to
purchase additional Securities is, for purposes of such offer, treated as a
Potential Securityholder.

     Any Bid specifying a rate higher than the Maximum Auction Rate will (i) be
treated as a Sell Order if submitted by a Existing Securityholder and (ii) not
be accepted if submitted by a Potential Securityholder.

     Validity of Orders

                                      I-7
<PAGE>
 
     If any Existing Securityholder submits through a Broker-Dealer to the
Auction Agent one or more Orders covering in the aggregate more than the
principal amount of the Class of Securities held by such Existing
Securityholder, such Orders will be considered valid as follows and in the order
of priority described below.

     Hold Orders. All Hold Orders will be considered valid, but only up to the
     -----------                                                              
aggregate principal amount of the Class of Securities held by such Existing
Securityholder, and if the aggregate principal amount of the Class of Securities
subject to such Hold Orders exceeds the aggregate principal amount of the Class
of Securities held by such Existing Securityholder, the aggregate principal
amount of the Class of Securities subject to each such Hold Order will be
reduced pro rata so that the aggregate principal amount of the Class of
Securities subject to all such Hold Orders equals the aggregate principal amount
of the Class of Securities held by such Existing Securityholder.

     Bids.  Any Bid will be considered valid up to an amount equal to the excess
     ----                                                                       
of the principal amount of the Class of Securities held by such Existing
Securityholder over the aggregate principal amount of such Security, subject to
any Hold Orders referred to above.  Subject to the preceding sentence, if
multiple Bids with the same rate are submitted on behalf of such Existing
Securityholder and the aggregate principal amount of Securities subject to such
Bids is greater than such excess, such Bids will be considered valid up to an
amount equal to such excess.  Subject to the two preceding sentences, if more
than one Bid with different rates are submitted on behalf of such Existing
Securityholder, such Bids will be considered valid first in the ascending order
of their respective rates until the highest rate is reached at which such excess
exists and then at such rate up to the amount of such excess. In any event, the
aggregate principal amount of Securities, if any, subject to Bids not valid
under the provisions described above will be treated as the subject of a Bid by
a Potential Securityholder at the rate therein specified.

     Sell Orders.  All Sell Orders will be considered valid up to an amount
     -----------                                                           
equal to the excess of the principal amount of Securities of the Class held by
such Existing Securityholder over the aggregate principal amount of Securities
subject to valid Hold Orders and valid Bids as referred to above.

     If more than one Bid for a Class of Security is submitted on behalf of any
Potential Securityholder, each Bid submitted will be a separate Bid with the
rate and principal amount therein specified. Any Bid or Sell Order submitted by
an Existing Securityholder covering an aggregate principal amount of Securities
not equal to an Authorized Denomination or an integral multiple thereof will be
rejected and will be deemed a Hold Order.  Any Bid submitted by a Potential
Securityholder covering an aggregate principal amount of Securities not equal to
an Authorized Denomination or an integral multiple thereof will be rejected. Any
Order submitted in an Auction by a Broker-Dealer to the Auction Agent prior to
the Submission Deadline on any Auction Date will be irrevocable.

     A Hold Order, a Bid or a Sell Order that has been determined valid pursuant
to the procedures described above is referred to as a "Submitted Hold Order," a
"Submitted Bid" and a "Submitted Sell Order," respectively (collectively,
"Submitted Orders").

     Determination of Sufficient Bid and Bid Auction Rate

     Not earlier than the Submission Deadline on each Auction Date, the Auction
Agent will assemble all valid Submitted Orders and will determine:


         (a) for the applicable Security, the excess of the total principal
amount of such Securities over the sum of the aggregate principal amount of such
Securities subject to Submitted Hold Orders (such excess being hereinafter
referred to as the "Available Securities"); and



         (b) from such Submitted Orders whether the aggregate principal amount
of Securities of such Class subject to Submitted Bids by Potential
Securityholders specifying one or more rates equal to or lower than the Maximum
Auction Rate exceeds or is equal to the sum of (i) the aggregate principal
amount of Securities of such Class subject to Submitted Bids by Existing
Securityholders specifying one or more rates higher than the Maximum Auction
Rate and (ii) the aggregate principal amount of Securities of such Class subject
to Submitted Sell Orders (in the event such excess or such equality exists other
than because all of the Securities are subject to Submitted Hold Orders, such
Submitted Bids by Potential Securityholders above will be hereinafter referred
to collectively as "Sufficient Bids"); and

                                      I-8
<PAGE>
 
         (c) if Sufficient Bids exist, the "Bid Auction Rate," which will be the
lowest rate specified in such Submitted Bids such that if:


               (i)  each such Submitted Bid from Existing Securityholders of
         such Security specifying such lowest rate and all other Submitted Bids
         from Existing Securityholders of such Security specifying lower rates
         were rejected (thus entitling such Existing Securityholders to continue
         to hold the principal amount of Securities subject to such Submitted
         Bids); and



               (ii)  each such Submitted Bid from Potential Securityholders of
         such Security specifying such lowest rate and all other Submitted Bids
         from Potential Securityholders specifying lower rates, were accepted,
         the result would be that such Existing Securityholders described in
         subparagraph (c)(i) above would continue to hold an aggregate principal
         amount of Securities which, when added to the aggregate principal
         amount of Securities to be purchased by such Potential Securityholders
         described in this subparagraph (ii) would equal not less than the
         Available Securities.


     Determination of Auction Rate and Security Interest Rate, Notice

     Promptly after the Auction Agent has made the determinations described
above, the Auction Agent is to advise the Trustee of the Net Loan Rate, the
Maximum Auction Rate, the All Hold Rate and the components thereof on the
Auction Date, and based on such determinations, the Auction Rate for the next
succeeding Interest Period for the applicable Security as follows:

         (a) if Sufficient Bids exist, that the Auction Rate for the next
succeeding Interest Period will be equal to the Bid Auction Rate so determined;

         (b) if Sufficient Bids do not exist (other than because all of the
Securities of the applicable Security are subject to Submitted Hold Orders),
that the Auction Rate for the next succeeding Interest Period will be equal to
the Maximum Auction Rate; or

         (c) if all Securities of the applicable Security are subject to
Submitted Hold Orders, that the Auction Rate for the next succeeding Interest
Period will be equal to the All Hold Rate.

     Promptly after the Auction Agent has determined the Auction Rate, the
Auction Agent will determine and advise the Trustee of the Security Interest
Rate for each applicable Security, which rate will be the lesser of (a) the
Auction Rate for each such Security and (b) the Net Loan Rate.  In no event
shall a Security Interest Rate exceed the rate (the "Security Interest Rate
Limitation") set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     Acceptance and Rejection of Orders

     Existing Securityholders of the applicable Security will continue to hold
the principal amount of Securities of such Class that are subject to Submitted
Hold Orders.  If, with respect to a Security, the Net Loan Rate is equal to or
greater than the Bid Auction Rate and if Sufficient Bids, as described above
under "Determination of Sufficient Bids and Bid Auction Rate," have been
received by the Auction Agent, the Bid Auction Rate will be the Security
Interest Rate, and Submitted Bids and Submitted Sell Orders will be accepted or
rejected and the Auction Agent will take such other action as provided in the
related Agreement and described below under "Sufficient Bids."

     If the Net Loan Rate is less than the Auction Rate, the Security Interest
Rate will be the Net Loan Rate. If the Auction Rate and the Net Loan Rate are
both greater than the Security Interest Rate Limitation, the Security Interest
Rate for each series shall be equal to the Security Interest Rate Limitation. If
the Auction Agent has not received Sufficient Bids as described above under
"Determination of Sufficient Bids and Bid Auction Rate" (other than because all
of the Securities are subject to Submitted Holds Orders), the Security Interest
Rate will be the lesser of the Maximum Auction Rate or the Net Loan Rate.  In
any of the cases described above in this paragraph, Submitted Orders will be
accepted or rejected and the Auction Agent will take such other action as
described below under "Insufficient Bids."

                                      I-9
<PAGE>
 
     Sufficient Bids.  If Sufficient Bids have been made with a respect to a
     ---------------                                                        
Security and the Net Loan Rate is equal to or greater than the Bid Auction Rate
(in which case the Interest Rate shall be the Bid Auction Rate), all Submitted
Sell Orders will be accepted and, subject to the denomination requirements
described below, Submitted Bids will be accepted or rejected as follows in the
following order of priority and all other Submitted Bids will be rejected:

         (a) Existing Securityholders' Submitted Bids specifying any rate that
is higher than the Security Interest Rate will be accepted, thus requiring each
such Existing Securityholder to sell the aggregate principal amount of
Securities subject to such Submitted Bids;

         (b) Existing Securityholders' Submitted Bids specifying any rate that
is lower than the Security Interest Rate will be rejected, thus entitling each
such Existing Securityholder to continue to hold the aggregate principal amount
of Securities subject to such Submitted Bids;

         (c) Potential Securityholders' Submitted Bids specifying any rate that
is lower than the Security Interest Rate will be accepted;

         (d) Each Existing Securityholder's Submitted Bid specifying a rate that
is equal to the Security Interest Rate will be rejected, thus entitling such
Existing Securityholder to continue to hold the aggregate principal amount of
Securities subject to such Submitted Bid, unless the aggregate principal amount
of Securities subject to such Submitted Bids will be greater than the principal
amount of Securities (the "remaining principal amount") equal to the excess of
the Available Securities over the aggregate principal amount of Securities
subject to Submitted Bids described in subparagraphs (b) and (c) above, in which
event such Submitted Bid of such Existing Securityholder will be rejected in
part and such Existing Securityholder will be entitled to continue to hold the
principal amount of Securities subject to such Submitted Bid, but only in an
amount equal to the aggregate principal amount of Securities obtained by
multiplying the remaining principal amount by a fraction, the numerator of which
will be the principal amount of Securities held by such Existing Securityholder
subject to such Submitted Bid and the denominator of which will be the sum of
the principal amount of Securities subject to such Submitted Bids made by all
such Existing Securityholders that specified a rate equal to the Security
Interest Rate; and

         (e) Each Potential Securityholder's Submitted Bid specifying a rate
that is equal to the Security Interest Rate will be accepted, but only in an
amount equal to the principal amount of Securities obtained by multiplying the
excess of the aggregate principal amount of Available Securities over the
aggregate principal amount of Securities subject to Submitted Bids described in
subparagraphs (b), (c) and (d) above by a fraction, the numerator of which will
be the aggregate principal amount of Securities subject to such Submitted Bid
and the denominator of which will be the sum of the principal amount of
Securities subject to Submitted Bids made by all such Potential Securityholders
that specified a rate equal to the Security Interest Rate.

     Insufficient Bids. If Sufficient Bids have not been made with respect to a
     -----------------                                                         
Security (other than because all of the Securities of such Class are subject to
Submitted Hold Orders) or if the Net Loan Rate is less than the Bid Auction Rate
(in which case the Security Interest Rate shall be the Net Loan Rate) or if the
Security Interest Rate Limitation applies, subject to the denomination
requirements described below, Submitted Orders will be accepted or rejected as
follows in the following order of priority and all other Submitted Bids will be
rejected:



         (a) Existing Securityholders' Submitted Bids specifying any rate that
is equal to or lower than the Security Interest Rate will be rejected, thus
entitling such Existing Securityholders to continue to hold the aggregate
principal amount of Securities subject to such Submitted Bids;

         (b) Potential Securityholders' Submitted Bids specifying any rate that
is equal to or lower than the Security Interest Rate will be accepted, and
specifying any rate that is higher than the Security Interest Rate will be
rejected; and

         (c) each Existing Securityholder's Submitted Bid specifying any rate
that is higher than the Security Interest Rate and the Submitted Sell Order of
each Existing Securityholder will be accepted, thus entitling each Existing
Securityholder that submitted any such Submitted Bid or Submitted Sell Order to
sell the Securities subject to 

                                      I-10
<PAGE>
 
such Submitted Bid or Submitted Sell Order, but in both cases only in an amount
equal to the aggregate principal amount of Securities obtained by multiplying
the aggregate principal amount of Securities subject to Submitted Bids described
in subparagraph (b) above by a fraction, the numerator of which will be the
aggregate principal amount of Securities held by such Existing Securityholder
subject to such Submitted Bid or Submitted Sell Order and the denominator of
which will be the aggregate principal amount of Securities subject to all such
Submitted Bids and Submitted Sell Orders.

     All Hold Orders.  If all Securities of a Class are subject to Submitted
     ---------------                                                        
Hold Orders, all Submitted Bids will be rejected.

     Authorized Denominations Requirement.  If, as a result of the procedures
     ------------------------------------                                    
described above regarding Sufficient Bids and Insufficient Bids, any Existing
Securityholder would be entitled or required to sell, or any Potential
Securityholder would be entitled or required to purchase, a principal amount of
Securities that is not equal to an Authorized Denomination or an integral
multiple thereof, the Auction Agent will, in such manner as in its sole
discretion it will determine, round up or down the principal amount of
Securities to be purchased or sold by any Existing Securityholder or Potential
Securityholder so that the principal amount of Securities purchased or sold by
each Existing Securityholder or Potential Securityholder will be equal to an
Authorized Denomination or an integral multiple in excess thereof. If, as a
result of the procedures described above regarding Insufficient Bids, any
Potential Securityholder would be entitled or required to purchase less than a
principal amount of Securities equal to an Authorized Denomination or any
integral multiple thereof, the Auction Agent will, in such manner as in its sole
discretion it will determine, allocate Securities for purchase among Potential
Securityholders so that only Securities in an Authorized Denomination or any
integral multiples in excess thereof are purchased by any Potential
Securityholder, even if such allocation results in one or more of such Potential
Securityholders not purchasing any Securities.

     Based on the results of each Auction, the Auction Agent is to determine the
aggregate principal amount of Securities of each Class to be purchased and the
aggregate principal amount of Securities of each Class to be sold by Potential
Securityholders and Existing Securityholders on whose behalf each Broker-Dealer
submitted Bids or Sell Orders and, with respect to each Broker-Dealer, to the
extent that such aggregate principal amount of Securities to be sold differs
from such aggregate principal amount of Securities to be purchased, determine to
which other Broker-Dealer or Broker-Dealers acting for one or more purchasers
such Broker-Dealer will deliver, or from which Broker-Dealers acting for one or
more sellers such Broker-Dealer will receive, as the case may be, Securities.

     Any calculation by the Auction Agent (or the Trustee, if applicable) of the
Security Interest Rate, One-Month LIBOR, Three-Month LIBOR, the Maximum Auction
Rate, the All Hold Rate, the Net Loan Rate and the Non-Payment Rate will, in the
absence of manifest error, be binding on all other parties.

     Notwithstanding anything in any related Agreement or, a related Terms
Supplement to the contrary, no Auction is to be held on any Auction Date on
which there are insufficient moneys held by the Trustee under the related
Agreement and available to pay the principal of and interest due on the
applicable Security on the Note Remittance Date or Certificate Remittance Date
immediately following such Auction Date.

     Settlement Procedures

     The Auction Agent is required to advise each Broker-Dealer that submitted
an Order in an Auction of the Security Interest Rate for a Security for the next
Interest Period and, if such Order was a Bid or Sell Order, whether such Bid or
Sell Order was accepted or rejected, in whole or in part, by telephone not later
than 3:00 p.m., eastern time, on the Auction Date if the Interest Rate is the
Auction Rate and not later than 4:00 p.m. eastern time on the Auction Date if
the Interest Rate is the Net Loan Rate.  Each Broker-Dealer that submitted an
Order on behalf of a Bidder is required to then advise such Bidder of the
applicable Security Interest Rate for the next Interest Period and, if such
Order was a Bid or a Sell Order, whether such Bid or Sell Order was accepted or
rejected, in whole or in part, confirm purchases and sales with each Bidder
purchasing or selling Securities as a result of the Auction and advise each
Bidder purchasing or selling Securities as a result of the Auction to give
instructions to its Participant to pay the purchase price against delivery of
such Securities or to deliver such Securities against payment therefor, as
appropriate.  Pursuant to the 

                                      I-11
<PAGE>
 
Auction Agent Agreement, the Auction Agent is to record each transfer of
Securities on the Existing Securityholders Registry to be maintained by the
Auction Agent.

     In accordance with DTC's normal procedures, on the Business Day after the
Auction Date, the transactions described above will be executed through DTC, so
long as DTC is the depository, and the accounts of the respective Participants
at DTC will be debited and credited and Securities delivered as necessary to
effect the purchases and sales of Securities as determined in the Auction.
Purchasers are required to make payment through their Participants in same-day
funds to DTC against delivery through their Participants.  DTC will make payment
in accordance with its normal procedures,  which now provide  for payment
against delivery by its  Participants  in immediately available funds.

     If any Existing Securityholder selling Securities in an Auction fails to
deliver such Securities, the Broker-Dealer of any person that was to have
purchased Securities in such Auction may deliver to such person a principal
amount of Securities that is less than the principal amount of Securities that
otherwise was to be purchased by such person but in any event equal to an
Authorized Denomination or any integral multiple thereof.  In such event, the
principal amount of Securities to be delivered will be determined by such
Broker-Dealer.  Delivery of such lesser principal amount of Securities will
constitute good delivery.  Neither the Trustee nor the Auction Agent will have
any responsibility or liability with respect to the failure of a Potential
Securityholder, Existing Securityholder or their respective Broker-Dealer or
Participant to deliver the principal amount of Securities or to pay for the
Securities purchased or sold pursuant to an Auction or otherwise. For a further
description of the settlement procedures, see "SETTLEMENT PROCEDURES."

TRUSTEE NOT RESPONSIBLE FOR AUCTION AGENT, MARKET AGENT AND BROKER-DEALERS

     The Trustee shall not be liable or responsible for the actions of or
failure to act by the Auction Agent, Market Agent or any Broker-Dealer under the
related Agreement, the related Terms Supplement or under the Auction Agent
Agreement, the Market Agent Agreement or any Broker-Dealer Agreement.  The
Trustee may conclusively rely upon any information required to be furnished by
the Auction Agent, the Market Agent or any Broker-Dealer without undertaking any
independent review or investigation of the truth or accuracy of such
information.

CHANGES IN AUCTION TERMS

     Changes in Auction Period or Periods

     While any of the Securities are outstanding, the Administrator, may, from
time to time, change the length of the one or more Auction Periods in order to
conform with then current market practice with respect to similar securities or
to accommodate economic and financial factors that may affect or be relevant to
the length of the Auction Period and the interest rate borne by the Securities
(an "Auction Period Adjustment").  The Administrator will not initiate such
change in the length of the Auction Period unless it shall have received the
written consent from the Market Agent, which consent will not be unreasonably
withheld, not less than three days nor more than 20 days prior to the effective
date of an Auction Period Adjustment.  The Administrator will initiate an
Auction Period Adjustment by giving written notice to the Trustee, the Auction
Agent, the Market Agent, the Security Guaranty Insurer and DTC in substantially
the form of, or containing substantially the information contained in, the
related Agreement at least 10 days prior to the Auction Date for such Auction
Period.

     Any such Auction Period Adjustment shall not result in an Auction Period of
less than 7 days nor more than 91 days.  If any such Auction Period Adjustment
will result in an Auction Period of less than the number of days in the then
current Auction Period, the notice described above will be effective only if it
is accompanied by a written statement of the Trustee, the Auction Agent and DTC
to the effect that they are capable of performing their duties, if any, under
the related Agreement, the Auction Agent Agreement and any Broker-Dealer
Agreement with respect to such changed Auction Period.

     An Auction Period Adjustment will take effect only if (A) the Trustee and
the Auction Agent receive, by 11:00 a.m., eastern time, on the Business Day
before the Auction Date for the first such Auction Period, a certificate from
the 

                                      I-12
<PAGE>
 
Representative authorizing an Auction Period Adjustment specified in such
certificate, the certificate of the Market Agent described above and the written
statement of the Trustee, the Auction Agent DTC described above and (B)
Sufficient Bids exist at the Auction on the Auction Date for such first Auction
Period. If the condition referred to in (A) is not met, the Security Interest
Rate applicable for the next Auction Period will be determined pursuant to the
Auction Procedures and the Auction Period will be the Auction Period determined
without reference to the proposed change.  If the condition referred to in (A)
is met, but the condition referred to in (B) above is not met, the Security
Interest Rate applicable for the next Auction Period will be the lesser of the
Maximum Auction Rate and the Net Loan Rate and the Auction Period will be the
Auction Period determined without reference to the proposed change.

     Changes in the Auction Date

     The Market Agent, at the written direction of the Representative, may
specify an earlier Auction Date (but in no event more than five Business Days
earlier) than the Auction Date that would otherwise be determined in accordance
with the definition of "Auction Date" with respect to one or more specified
Auction Periods in order to conform with then current market practice with
respect to similar securities or to accommodate economic and financial factors
that may affect or be relevant to the day of the week constituting an Auction
Date and the interest rate borne on the Securities. The Representative will not
consent to such change in the Auction Date unless the Representative will have
received from the Market Agent not less than three days nor more than 20 days
prior to the effective date of such change a written request for consent
together with a certificate demonstrating the need for change in reliance on
such factors.  The Market Agent will provide notice of its determination to
specify an earlier Auction Date for one or more Auction Periods by means of a
written notice delivered at least 10 days prior to the proposed changed Auction
Date to the Trustee, the Auction Agent, the Trust, the Representative, and DTC.



     The changes in Auction terms described above may be made with respect to
any Class of the Securities. In connection with any change in Auction Terms
described above, the Auction Agent is to provide such further notice to such
parties as is specified in the Auction Agent Agreement.

                                      I-13
<PAGE>
 
                                                                     APPENDIX II



                             SETTLEMENT PROCEDURES


These Settlement Procedures apply separately to each Class of Securities and may
be different if specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.

     (e)  Not later than (i) 3:00 p.m. if the Security Interest Rate is the
Auction Rate or (2) 4:00 p.m. if the Security Interest Rate is the Net Loan
Rate, the Auction Agent is to notify by telephone each Broker-Dealer that
participated in the Auction held on such Auction Date and submitted an Order on
behalf of an Existing Securityholder or Potential Securityholder of:


         (i)  the Security Interest Rate fixed for the next Interest Period;



         (ii)  whether there were Sufficient Bids in such Auction;



         (iii)  if such Broker-Dealer (a "Seller's Broker-Dealer") submitted
     Bids or Sell Orders on behalf of an Existing Securityholder, whether such
     Bid or Sell Order was accepted or rejected, in whole or in part, and the
     principal amount of Securities, if any, to be sold by such Existing
     Securityholder;



         (iv)  if such Broker-Dealer (a "Buyer's Broker-Dealer") submitted a Bid
     on behalf of a Potential Securityholder, whether such Bid was accepted or
     rejected, in whole or in part, and the principal amount of Securities, if
     any, to be purchased by such Potential Securityholder;



         (v)  if the aggregate amount of Securities to be sold by all Existing
     Securityholders on whose behalf such Seller's Broker-Dealer submitted Bids
     or Sell Orders exceeds the aggregate principal amount of Securities to be
     purchased by all Potential Securityholders on whose behalf such Buyer's
     Broker-Dealer submitted a Bid, the name or names of one or more Buyer's
     Broker-Dealers and the name of the Participant, if any, of each such
     Buyer's Broker-Dealer (a "Participant") acting for one or more purchasers
     of such excess principal amount of Securities and the principal amount of
     Securities to be purchased from one or more Existing Securityholders on
     whose behalf such Seller's Broker-Dealer acted by one or more Potential
     Securityholders on whose behalf each of such Buyer's Broker-Dealers acted;



         (vi)  if the principal amount of Securities to be purchased by all
     Potential Securityholders on whose behalf such Buyer's Broker-Dealer
     submitted a Bid exceeds the amount of Securities to be sold by all Existing
     Securityholders on whose behalf such Seller's Broker-Dealer submitted a Bid
     or a Sell Order, the name or names of one or more Seller's Broker-Dealers
     (and the name of the Participant, if any, of each such Seller's Broker-
     Dealer) acting for one or more sellers of such excess principal amount of
     Securities and the principal amount of Securities to be sold to one or more
     Potential Securityholders on whose behalf such Buyer's Broker-Dealer acted
     by one or more Existing Securityholder on whose behalf each of such
     Seller's Broker-Dealers acted; and



         (vii)  the Auction Date for the next succeeding Auction.


     (f)  On each Auction Date, each Broker-Dealer that submitted an Order on
behalf of any Existing Securityholder or Potential Securityholder is to:


         (i)  advise each Existing Securityholder and Potential Securityholder
     on whose behalf such Broker-Dealer submitted a Bid or Sell Order in the
     Auction on such Auction Date whether such Bid or Sell Order was accepted or
     rejected, in whole or in part;



         (ii)  in the case of a Broker-Dealer that is a Buyer's Broker-Dealer,
     advise each Potential Securityholder on whose behalf such Buyer's Broker-
     Dealer submitted a Bid that was accepted, in whole or in part, to instruct
     such Potential Securityholder's Participant to pay to such Buyer's Broker-
     Dealer (or its 

                                      II-1
<PAGE>
 
     Participant) through DTC the amount necessary to purchase the principal
     amount of the Securities to be purchased pursuant to such Bid against
     receipt of such Securities together with accrued interest;



         (iii)  in the case of a Broker-Dealer that is a Seller's Broker-Dealer,
     instruct each Existing Securityholder on whose behalf such Seller's Broker-
     Dealer submitted a Sell Order that was accepted, in whole or in part, or a
     Bid that was accepted, in whole or in part, to instruct such Existing
     Securityholder's Participant to deliver to such Seller's Broker-Dealer (or
     its Participant) through DTC the principal amount of the Securities to be
     sold pursuant to such Order against payment therefor;



         (iv)  advise each Existing Securityholder on whose behalf such Broker-
     Dealer submitted an Order and each Potential Securityholder on whose behalf
     such Broker-Dealer submitted a Bid of the Security Interest Rate for the
     next Interest Period;



         (v)  advise each Existing Securityholder on whose behalf such Broker-
     Dealer submitted an Order of the next Auction Date; and



         (vi)  advise each Potential Securityholder on whose behalf such Broker-
     Dealer submitted a Bid that was accepted, in whole or in part, of the next
     Auction Date.


     (g)  On the basis of the information provided to it pursuant to paragraph
(a) above, each Broker-Dealer that submitted a Bid or Sell Order in an Auction
is required to allocate any funds received by it in connection with such Auction
pursuant to paragraph (b)(ii) above, and any Securities received by it in
connection with such Auction pursuant to paragraph (b)(iii) above, among the
Potential Securityholders, if any, on whose behalf such Broker-Dealer submitted
Bids, the Existing Securityholder, if any, on whose behalf such Broker-Dealer
submitted Bids or Sell Orders in such Auction, and any Broker-Dealers identified
to it by the Auction Agent following such Auction pursuant to paragraph (a)(v)
or (a)(vi) above.

     (h)  On each Auction Date:


         (i)  each Potential Securityholder and Existing Securityholder with an
     Order in the Auction on such Auction Date will instruct its Participant as
     provided in (b)(ii) or (b)(iii) above, as the case may be:



         (ii)  each Seller's Broker-Dealer that is not a Participant in DTC's
     system will instruct its Participant to deliver such Securities through DTC
     to a Buyer's Broker-Dealer (or its Participant) identified to such Seller's
     Broker-Dealer pursuant to (a)(v) above against payment therefor; and



         (iii)  each Buyer's Broker-Dealer that is not a Participant in DTC's
     system will instruct its Participant to pay through DTC to Seller's Broker-
     Dealer (or its Participant) identified following such Auction pursuant to
     (a)(vi) above the amount necessary to purchase the Securities to be
     purchased pursuant to (b)(ii) above against receipt of such Securities.


     (i)  On the Business Day following each Auction Date;


         (i)  each Participant for a Bidder in the Auction on such Auction Date
     referred to in (d)(i) above will instruct DTC to execute the transactions
     described under (b)(ii) or (b)(iii) above for such Auction, and DTC will
     execute such transactions;



         (ii)  each Seller's Broker-Dealer or its Participant will instruct DTC
     to execute the transactions described in (d)(ii) above for such Auction,
     and DTC will execute such transactions; and



         (iii)  each Buyer's Broker-Dealer or its Participant will instruct DTC
     to execute the transactions described in (d)(iii) above for such Auction,
     and DTC will execute such transactions.

                                      II-2
<PAGE>
 
     (j)  If an Existing Securityholder selling Securities in an Auction fails
to deliver such Securities (by authorized book-entry), a Broker-Dealer may
deliver to the Potential Securityholder on behalf of which it submitted a Bid
that was accepted a principal amount of Securities that is less than the
principal amount of Securities that otherwise was to be purchased by such
Potential Securityholder.  In such event, the principal amount of Securities to
be so delivered will be determined solely by such Broker-Dealer (but only in
Authorized Denominations).  Delivery of such lesser principal amount of
Securities will constitute good delivery.  Notwithstanding the foregoing terms
of this paragraph (f), any delivery or nondelivery of Securities which will
represent any departure from the results of an Auction, as determined by the
Auction Agent, will be of no effect unless and until the Auction Agent will have
been notified of such delivery or nondelivery in accordance with the provisions
of the Auction Agent Agreement and the Broker-Dealer Agreements.  Neither the
Trustee nor the Auction Agent will have any responsibility or liability with
respect to the failure of a Potential Securityholder, Existing Securityholder or
their Respective Broker-Dealer or Participant to take delivery of or deliver, as
the case may be, the principal amount of the Securities purchased or sold
pursuant to an Auction or otherwise.



572309

                                      II-3
<PAGE>
 
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
  NO DEALER, SALESPERSON OR OTHER INDIVIDUAL HAS BEEN AUTHORIZED TO GIVE ANY
INFORMATION OR TO MAKE ANY REPRESENTATIONS OTHER THAN THOSE CONTAINED IN THIS
PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT AND THE ACCOMPANYING PROSPECTUS IN CONNECTION WITH THE
OFFER MADE BY THIS PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT AND THE ACCOMPANYING PROSPECTUS AND,
IF GIVEN OR MADE, SUCH INFORMATION OR REPRESENTATIONS MUST NOT BE RELIED UPON
AS HAVING BEEN AUTHORIZED BY THE REPRESENTATIVE OR THE UNDERWRITERS. THIS PRO-
SPECTUS SUPPLEMENT AND THE ACCOMPANYING PROSPECTUS DO NOT CONSTITUTE AN OFFER
TO SELL, OR A SOLICITATION OF AN OFFER TO BUY, THE OFFERED CERTIFICATES IN ANY
JURISDICTION WHERE, OR TO ANY PERSON TO WHOM, IT IS UNLAWFUL TO MAKE SUCH OFFER
OR SOLICITATION.
 
                               TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                            PAGE
                                                                            ----
                             PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT
<S>                                                                         <C>
Summary of Terms...........................................................    4
Risk Factors...............................................................   46
Lending Programs...........................................................   49
The Representative and the Originators.....................................   53
The Loan Pools.............................................................   56
Maturity, Prepayment and Yield Considerations..............................   61
Description of the Certificates............................................   79
The MBIA Policies and MBIA.................................................   96
The Agreement..............................................................  100
Federal Income Tax Considerations..........................................  107
ERISA Considerations.......................................................  107
Legal Investment Considerations............................................  111
Underwriting...............................................................  112
Experts....................................................................  113
Legal Matters..............................................................  113
Rating of the Offered Certificates.........................................  113
Financial Information......................................................  114
Index of Principal Terms...................................................  115
Annex I-Global Clearance, Settlement and Tax Documentation Procedures......  A-1
                                   PROSPECTUS
Prospectus Supplement......................................................    3
Available Information......................................................    3
Reports to Certificateholders..............................................    4
Incorporation of Certain Documents by Reference............................    4
Summary of Terms...........................................................    5
Risk Factors...............................................................   21
The Trusts.................................................................   26
Use of Proceeds............................................................   39
The Representative and the Originators.....................................   39
The Single Family Loan Lending Program.....................................   39
Description of the Certificates............................................   43
Credit Enhancement.........................................................   50
Maturity, Prepayment and Yield Considerations..............................   55
The Agreements.............................................................   57
Certain Legal Aspects of the Mortgage Loans................................   67
Federal Income Tax Consequences............................................   76
ERISA Considerations.......................................................  100
Legal Investment Considerations............................................  102
Plan of Distribution.......................................................  102
Legal Matters..............................................................  103
Financial Information......................................................  103
Rating.....................................................................  103
Index of Principal Terms...................................................  105
Appendix I Auction Procedures..............................................  I-1
Appendix II Settlement Procedures.......................................... II-1
</TABLE>
 
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
                                 $1,300,000,000
 
                            LOGO THE MONEY STORE(R)
 
                             THE MONEY STORE TRUST
                                     1997-C
 
                               -----------------
 
                             PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT
 
                               -----------------
 
                       PRUDENTIAL SECURITIES INCORPORATED
               (Lead Manager for Pool I, II and IV Certificates)
 
                                LEHMAN BROTHERS
                    (Lead Manager for Pool III Certificates)
 
                              SALOMON BROTHERS INC
 
                              MERRILL LYNCH & CO.
 
                           MORGAN STANLEY DEAN WITTER
 
                               SEPTEMBER 26, 1997
 
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------


© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission